summaryrefslogtreecommitdiff
path: root/poky/documentation/ref-manual
diff options
context:
space:
mode:
authorAndrew Geissler <geissonator@yahoo.com>2020-09-18 22:11:35 +0300
committerAndrew Geissler <geissonator@yahoo.com>2020-10-06 01:10:26 +0300
commitc9f7865a347606a64696048817b0f09d9c3fcd31 (patch)
tree00db80fae3599061617c0cb052a57302620882ec /poky/documentation/ref-manual
parentd1a90aa35d35426789d8f4061166a6dd8d27a30e (diff)
downloadopenbmc-c9f7865a347606a64696048817b0f09d9c3fcd31.tar.xz
poky: subtree update:c67f57c09e..c6bc20857c
Adrian Freihofer (2): oe-publish-sdk: fix layers init via ssh oe-publish-sdk: add --keep-orig option Alexander Kanavin (68): meta-selftest: correct the virgl test for 5.8 kernels bison: upgrade 3.6.4 -> 3.7.1 util-linux: upgrade 2.35.2 -> 2.36 python3-numpy: upgrade 1.19.0 -> 1.19.1 python3-setuptools: upgrade 49.3.1 -> 49.6.0 rsync: upgrade 3.2.2 -> 3.2.3 util-linux: merge .inc into .bb acpica: upgrade 20200528 -> 20200717 asciidoc: upgrade 9.0.1 -> 9.0.2 cryptodev: upgrade 1.10 -> 1.11 diffoscope: upgrade 153 -> 156 epiphany: upgrade 3.36.3 -> 3.36.4 font-alias: upgrade 1.0.3 -> 1.0.4 gtk+3: upgrade 3.24.21 -> 3.24.22 libcheck: upgrade 0.15.0 -> 0.15.2 libinput: upgrade 1.16.0 -> 1.16.1 libpipeline: upgrade 1.5.2 -> 1.5.3 libx11: upgrade 1.6.9 -> 1.6.11 linux-firmware: upgrade 20200619 -> 20200721 man-pages: upgrade 5.07 -> 5.08 mc: upgrade 4.8.24 -> 4.8.25 mesa: upgrade 20.1.4 -> 20.1.5 piglit: upgrade to latest revision re2c: upgrade 2.0 -> 2.0.2 sysstat: upgrade 12.2.2 -> 12.4.0 vala: upgrade 0.48.7 -> 0.48.9 bootchart2: update 0.14.8 -> 0.14.9 harfbuzz: convert to meson, enable gobject introspection pango: update 1.44.7 -> 1.46.0 boost: update 1.73.0 -> 1.74.0 xev: update 1.2.3 -> 1.2.4 wpebackend-fdo: update 1.6.1 -> 1.7.1 gpgme: update 1.13.1 -> 1.14.0 libpsl: update 0.21.0 -> 0.21.1. gettext: update 0.20.2 -> 0.21 cmake: update 3.17.3 -> 3.18.1 linux-firmware: update 20200721 -> 20200817 meson: update 0.55.0 -> 0.55.1 systemd-boot: bump version to 246.2 json-glib: inherit upstream-version-is-even packagegroup-core-device-devel: remove oeqa/x32lib: rework to use readelf from the host oeqa/multilib: rework to use readelf from the host oeqa/multilib: un-skip the connman test poky.conf: do not install packagegroup-core-device-devel into qemu images glib-2.0: update 2.64.4 -> 2.64.5 cmake: upgrade 3.18.1 -> 3.18.2 libxcrypt: upgrade 4.4.16 -> 4.4.17 debianutils: upgrade 4.11 -> 4.11.1 enchant2: upgrade 2.2.8 -> 2.2.9 harfbuzz: upgrade 2.7.1 -> 2.7.2 libmpc: upgrade 1.1.0 -> 1.2.0 librepo: upgrade 1.12.0 -> 1.12.1 libuv: upgrade 1.38.1 -> 1.39.0 msmtp: upgrade 1.8.11 -> 1.8.12 ninja: upgrade 1.10.0 -> 1.10.1 p11-kit: upgrade 0.23.20 -> 0.23.21 pango: upgrade 1.46.0 -> 1.46.1 re2c: upgrade 2.0.2 -> 2.0.3 resolvconf: upgrade 1.82 -> 1.83 stress-ng: upgrade 0.11.18 -> 0.11.19 gnu-config: update to latest revision nasm: update 2.15.03 -> 2.15.05 libva-utils: fix upstream version check gnupg: update 2.2.21 -> 2.2.22 libx11: update 1.6.11 -> 1.6.12 mesa: update 20.1.5 -> 20.1.6 xserver-xorg: update 1.20.8 -> 1.20.9 Andrey Zhizhikin (1): insane: check for missing update-alternatives inherit Anibal Limon (1): recipes-kernel: linux-firmware add qcom-venus-{5.2,5.4} packages Aníbal Limón (1): recipes-graphics/xorg-xserver: Add patch to fix segfault when probe Armin Kuster (2): bind: update to 9.11.22 ESV core-image-sato: qemumips use 512 mem Bruce Ashfield (30): linux-yocto/5.4: update to v5.4.59 linux-yocto/5.8: update to v5.8.2 yocto-bsp: update to v5.4.56 yocto-bsp: update to v5.4.58 qemu: bump default reference kernel to v5.8 linux-yocto/5.8: fix perf and virtio_scsi warnings linux-yocto-rt/5.8: fix lttng-modules build linux-yocto/5.8: selftests/bpf: Prevent runqslower from racing on building bpftool linux-yocto/5.8: disable CONFIG_NFS_DISABLE_UDP_SUPPORT poky: set preferred version for linux-yocto to be v5.8 poky-tiny: set preferred version to 5.8 poky: add preferred version for linux-yocto-rt linux-yocto/5.8: update to v5.8.3 linux-yocto/5.4: update to v5.4.60 kernel: config cleanups for 5.8+ linux-yocto/5.4: update to v5.4.61 linux-yocto/5.8: update to v5.8.4 linux-yocto/5.8: disable IKHEADERS in default builds kernel-yocto: allow promotion of configuration warnings to errors kernel-yocto: checksum all modifications to available kernel fragments directories lttng-modules/devupstream: bump to latest 2.12 commits linux-yocto-dev: bump to v5.9+ linux-yocto/5.8: update to v5.8.5 kernel-devsrc: account for HOSTCC and HOSTCXX linux-yocto/config: netfilter: Enable nat for ipv4 and ipv6 linux-yocto/5.8: update to v5.8.8 linux-yocto/5.4: update to v5.4.64 linux-yocto/config: configuration warning cleanup linux-yocto/5.8: update to v5.8.9 linux-yocto/5.4: update to v5.4.65 Changhyeok Bae (2): iw: upgrade 5.4 -> 5.8 iputils: upgrade s20190709 -> s20200821 Chris Laplante (12): bitbake: compat.py: remove file since it no longer actually implements anything bitbake: COW: formatting bitbake: COW: migrate test suite into tests/cow cve-update-db-native: add progress handler cve-check/cve-update-db-native: use lockfile to fix usage under multiconfig cve-update-db-native: use context manager for cve_f cve-check: avoid FileNotFoundError if no do_cve_check task has run bitbake: utils: process_profilelog: use context manager bitbake: utils: fix UnboundLocalError when _print_exception raises cve-update-db-native: be less magical about checking whether the cve-check class is enabled cve-update-db-native: move -journal checking into do_fetch cve-update-db-native: remove unused variable Christophe GUIBOUT (1): initramfs-framework: support kernel cmdline with double quotes Denys Dmytriyenko (2): weston: upgrade 8.0.0 -> 9.0.0 cryptodev: bump 1 commit past 1.11 to fix 5.9-rc1+ Diego Sueiro (2): license_image.bbclass: Create symlink to the image license manifest dir license_image.bbclass: Fix symlink to the image license manifest dir creation Douglas Royds (1): tcmode-default: Drop gcc-cross-initial, gcc-crosssdk-initial references Frazer Clews (1): bitbake: lib: fix most undefined code picked up by pylint Geoff Parker (1): systemd-serialgetty: Replace sed quoting using ' with " to allow var expansion Jacob Kroon (1): gcc10: Don't default back to -fcommon Jean-Francois Dagenais (1): bitbake: siggen: clean_basepath: remove recipe full path when virtual:xyz present Jens Rehsack (1): lttng-modules: backport patches from 2.12.x to fix 5.4.64+ and 5.8.9+ builds Joe Slater (1): pseudo: fix renaming to self Jon Mason (4): cortex-m0plus.inc: change file permissions tune-cortexa55.inc: clean-up ARMv8.2a uses tune-cortexa57-cortexa53.inc: add CRC and set march tune-cortexa*: Cleanups Joshua Watt (8): wic: Add 512 Byte alignment to --offset oeqa: runtime_tests: Extra GPG debugging oeqa: sdk: Capture stderr output oeqa: reproducible: Fix test not producing diffs diffoscope: upgrade 156 -> 158 bitbake: bitbake: Add parsing torture test bitbake: cooker: Block SIGINT in worker processes sphinx: dev-manual: Clarify that virtual providers do not apply to runtime dependencies Kai Kang (1): dhcpcd: 9.1.4 -> 9.2.0 Kevin Hao (1): meta-yocto-bsp: Bump to the v5.8 kernel Khairul Rohaizzat Jamaluddin (1): wic/bootimg-efi: IMAGE_EFI_BOOT_FILES variable added to separate bootimg-efi and bootimg-partition Khem Raj (24): gcc-cross-canadian: Install gcc/g++ wrappers for musl uninative: Upgrade to 2.9 packagegroup-core-tools-profile: Disable lttng-modules for riscv64 lttng-modules: Disable on riscv64 kexec-tools: Fix build with -fno-common on ppc lttng-tools: Do not build for riscv64 util-linux: Allow update alternatives for additional apps lttng-tools: lttng-ust works on riscv64 json-glib: Backport a build fix with clang rpcbind: Use update-alternatives for rpcinfo go: Upgrade to 1.15 major release weston-init: Redefine weston service and add socket activation option musl: Upgrade to latest master libucontext: Recognise riscv32 architecture linuxloader.bbclass: Define riscv32 ldso for musl populate_sdk_ext: Do not assume local.conf will always exist weston: plane_add_prop() calls break musl atomic modesetting weston-init: Enable RDP screen share weston-init: Do not use fbdev backend weston-init: Select drm/fbdev backends for qemu machines oeqa/weston: Fix tests to run with systemd core-image-weston: Bump qemu memory to 512M go: Update to 1.15.2 minor release bind: Inherit update-alternatives Mark Hatle (6): package_tar.bbclass: Sync to the other package_* classes kernel.bbclass: Remove do_install[prefunc] no longer needed buildhistory.bbclass: Rework to use read_subpackage_metadata kernel.bbclass: Move away from calling package_get_auto_pr package.bbclass: hash equivalency and pr service bitbake: process.py: Handle SystemExit exception to eliminate backtrace Mark Morton (1): sphinx: test-manual code block, link, and format update Martin Jansa (7): devtool: expand SRC_URI when guessing recipe update mode image-artifact-names: introduce new bbclass and move some variables into it kernel.bbclass: use bash variables like imageType, base_name without {} kernel.bbclass: eliminate (initramfs_)symlink_name variables kernel.bbclass: use camelCase notation for bash variables in do_deploy *-initramfs: don't use .rootfs IMAGE_NAME_SUFFIX bitbake.conf: use ${TCMODE}-${TCLIBC} directory for CACHE Matt Madison (1): image.bbclass: fix REPRODUCIBLE_TIMESTAMP_ROOTFS reference Michael Gloff (2): sysvinit rc: Use PSPLASH_FIFO_DIR for progress fifo sysvinit: Remove ${B} assignment Michael Tretter (1): devtool: deploy-target: Fix size calculation for hard links Ming Liu (2): systemd: split systemd specific udev rules into its own package libubootenv: inherit uboot-config Mingli Yu (3): qemu: always define unknown_lock_type qemu: override DEBUG_BUILD bison: remove the parallel build patch Naveen Saini (1): lib/oe/recipeutils.py: add support for BBFILES_DYNAMIC Nicolas Dechesne (73): linux-libc-headers: kernel headers are installed in STAGING_KERNEL_BUILDDIR bitbake: sphinx: add initial build infrastructure bitbake: sphinx: initial sphinx support bitbake: sphinx: bitbake-user-manual: use builtin sphinx glossary bitbake: sphinx: switch to readthedocs theme bitbake: sphinx: override theme CSS bitbake: sphinx: fixup for links bitbake: sphinx: fix links inside notes bitbake: sphinx: fixes all remaining warnings bitbake: sphinx: Makefile.sphinx: add clean and publish targets bitbake: sphinx: tweak html output a bit bitbake: sphinx: add SPDX headers bitbake: sphinx: index: move the boilerplate at the end of the page bitbake: sphinx: conf: enable extlinks extension bitbake: sphinx: add releases page bitbake: sphinx: bitbake-user-manual: insert additional blank line after title bitbake: sphinx: last manual round of fixes/improvements bitbake: sphinx: update style for important, caution and warnings bitbake: sphinx: remove leading '/' bitbake: sphinx: theme_override: properly set font for verbatim text bitbake: bitbake-user-manual: fix bad links sphinx: add initial build infrastructure sphinx: initial sphinx support sphinx: ref-variables: use builtin sphinx glossary sphinx: overview-manual: add figures sphinx: switch to readthedocs theme sphinx: Add SPDX license headers sphinx: add CSS theme override sphinx: bsp-guide: add figures sphinx: add Yocto project logo sphinx: conf: update copyright sphinx: conf: add substitutions/global variables sphinx: add boilerplate file sphinx: add boilerplate to manuals sphinx: ref-manual: add revision history table sphinx: add a general index sphinx: conf.py: enable sphinx.ext.autosectionlabel sphinx: ref-manual: use builtin glossary for the Terms section sphinx: fix internal links sphinx: ref-manual: fix typo sphinx: fix custom term links sphinx: manual updates for some links sphinx: dev-manual add figures sphinx: kernel-dev: add figures sphinx: profile-manual: add figures sphinx: fix up bold text for informalexample container sphinx: ref-manual: add figures sphinx: sdk-manual: add figures sphinx: test-manual: add figures sphinx: toaster-manual: add figures sphinx: add links for Yocto project website sphinx: fix links when the link text should be displayed sphinx: add links to terms in the BitBake glossary sphinx: add links to section in the Bitbake manual sphinx: setup extlink for docs.yoctoproject.org sphinx: enable intersphinx extension sphinx: insert blank below between title and toc sphinx: fix up terms related to kernel-fitimage sphinx: conf: a few rendering tweaks sphinx: makefile: add publish target sphinx: conf: include CSS/JS files, the proper way sphinx: convert 'what I wish I'd known' sphinx: convert 'transitioning to a custom environment' sphinx: ref-manual: fix heading for oe-init-build-env sphinx: brief-yoctoprojectqs: fix up all remaining rendering issues sphinx: Makefile.sphinx improvements sphinx: convert bsp-guide sphinx: remove leading '/' sphinx: update style for important, caution and warnings sphinx: profile-manual: convert profile-manual sphinx: theme_override: properly set font for verbatim text sphinx: theme_override: add tying-it-together admonition sphinx: conf: exclude adt-manual/*.rst Oleksandr Kravchuk (1): ell: update to 0.33 Ovidiu Panait (1): libxml2: Fix CVE-2020-24977 Peter A. Bigot (2): bluez5: fix builds that require ell support timezone: include leap second data in tzdata-core Peter Bergin (1): systemd: avoid failing if no udev rules provided Pierre-Jean Texier (2): libubootenv: upgrade 0.3 -> 0.3.1 diffoscope: upgrade 158 -> 160 Quentin Schulz (16): sphinx: brief-yoctoprojectqs: remove redundant welcome sphinx: brief-yoctoprojectqs: fix ambiguous note for cyclone5 example sphinx: brief-yoctoprojectqs: add missing boilerplate sphinx: overview-manual: add link to AUH how-to section sphinx: overview-manual: fix bitbake basic explanation sphinx: brief-yoctoprojectqs: add note on branch consistency between layers sphinx: what-i-wish-id-known: update "don't be fooled by doc search results" sphinx: overview-manual: remove highlight in bold section sphinx: replace special quotes with single and double quotes sphinx: fix incorrect indentations sphinx: brief-yoctoprojectqs: put other distros note after Ubuntu-specific packages sphinx: fix a few typos or missing/too many words sphinx: "highlight" some variables, tasks or files sphinx: fix or add missing links and remove mention of Eclipse workflow ref-manual: examples: hello-autotools: upgrade to 2.10 ref-manual: examples: libxpm: add relative path to .inc Rahul Kumar (1): systemd-serialgetty: Fix sed expression quoting Rasmus Villemoes (1): kernel.bbclass: run do_symlink_kernsrc before do_patch Richard Purdie (74): nativesdk-sdk-provides-dummy: Add /bin/sh bitbake: fetch2/wget: Remove buffering parameter bitbake: cooker: Ensure parse_quit thread is closed down bitbake: cooker: Explictly shut down the sync thread bitbake: fetch2: Drop cups.org from wget status checks bitbake: build/msg: Cleanup verbose option handling bitbake: cooker/cookerdata/main: Improve loglevel handling bitbake: cookerdata: Ensure UI options are updated to the server bitbake: cooker/cookerdata: Ensure UI event log is updated from commandline bitbake: cooker: Defer configuration init to after UI connection bitbake: server/process: Move the socket code to server process only bitbake: main/server/process: Drop configuration object passing bitbake: cooker: Ensure BB_ORIGENV is updated by changes to configuration.env bitbake: server/process: Log extra threads at exit bitbake: server/process: Add bitbake-server and exec() a new server process bitbake: runqueue: Don't use sys.argv bitbake: cooker: Ensure cooker's enviroment is updated on updateConfig connman-gnome/matchbox-desktop: Remove file:// globbing selftest/recipetool: Drop globbing SRC_URI test, no longer supported local.conf.sample: Document memory resident bitbake bitbake: fetch2: Drop globbing supprt in file:// SRC_URIs bitbake: server/process: Use sys.executable for bitbake-server bitbake: process: Avoid bb.utils.timeout bitbake: utils: Drop broken timeout function bitbake: server/process: Fix typo in code causing tracebacks oeqa/selftest: Apply patch to fix cpio build with -fno-common runqemu: Show an error for conflicting graphics options lttng: Move platform logic to dedicated inc file patchelf: upgrade 0.11 -> 0.12 build-appliance/packagegroup-core-base-utils: Replace dhcp-client/dhcp-server with dhcpcd/kea selftest/prservice: Improve test failure message iputils: Adapt ${PN}-tftpd package dependency to PACKAGECONFIG bitbake: process/knotty: Improve early exception handling bitbake: cooker/cookerdata: Use BBHandledException, not sys.exit() bitbake: cookerdata: Fix exception raise statements bitbake: process: Avoid printing binary strings for leftover processes bitbake: server/process: Ensure logging is flushed bitbake: server/process: Don't show tracebacks if the lockfile is removed bitbake: cooker: Ensure parser replacement calls parser final_cleanup bitbake: cooker: Assign a name to the sync thread to aid debugging bitbake: server/process: Ensure we don't keep looping if some other server is started bitbake: server/process: Prefix the log data with pid/time information bitbake: server/process: Note when commands complete in logs bitbake: cooker: Ensure parser is cleaned up runqemu: Add a hook to allow it to renice bitbake: cooker: Avoid parser deadlocks bitbake: cooker: Ensure parser worker signal handlers are default selftest/signing: Ensure build path relocation is safe oeqa/concurrencytest: Improve builddir path manipulations bitbake: cooker/command: Fix disconnection handling bitbake: tinfoil: Ensure sockets don't leak even when exceptions occur bitbake: tests/fetch: Move away from problematic freedesktop.org urls bitbake: sphinx: Enhance the sphinx experience/nagivation with: bitbake: sphinx: theme_override: Use bold for emphasis text Revert "qemu: always define unknown_lock_type" Revert "core-image-sato: qemumips use 512 mem" sphinx: Organize top level docs sphinx: releases.rst: Add index/links to docs for previous releases sphinx: boilerplate.rst: Drop versions notes as we have better navigation now sphinx: boilerplate.rst: Sphinx puts the copyright elsewhere sphinx: history: Move revision history to its own section sphinx: manuals: Move boilerplate after toctree sphinx: Add support for multiple docs version sphinx: index.rst: Fix links sphinx: ref-system-requirements: Improve formatting of the notes sections, merging them sphinx: ref-manual links fixes and many other cleanups to import sphinx: dev-manual: Various URL, code block and other fixes to imported data sphinx: sdk-manual: Various URL, code block and other fixes to imported data sphinx: kernel-dev: Various URL, code block and other fixes to imported data sphinx: theme_override: Use bold for emphasis text sphinx: ref-tasks: Add populate_sdk_ext task definition sphinx: ref-manual/migration: Split each release into its own file sphinx: overview-manual: Various URL, code block and other fixes to imported data build-appliance-image: Update to master head revision Robert Yang (3): bitbake: cooker.py: Save prioritized BBFILES to BBFILES_PRIORITIZED bitbake: utils.py: get_file_layer(): Exit the loop when file is matched bitbake: utils.py: get_file_layer(): Improve performance Ross Burton (25): package.bbclass: explode the RPROVIDES so we don't think the versions are provides elfutils: silence a new QA warning insane: improve gnu-hash-style warning gdk-pixbuf: add tests PACKAGECONFIG debianutils: change SRC_URI to use snapshot.debian.org insane: only load real files as ELF autoconf: consolidate SRC_URI autoconf: consolidate DEPENDS kea: no need to depend on kea-native kea: don't use PACKAGECONFIG inappropriately kea: bump to 1.7.10 help2man: rewrite recipe local.conf.sample.extended: remove help2man reference curl: add vendors to CVE_PRODUCT to exclude false positives harfbuzz: update patch status harfbuzz: fix a build race around hb-version.h cmake: whitelist CVE-2016-10642 ncurses: remove config.cache qemu: fix CVE-2020-14364 cve-update-db-native: remove unused import cve-update-db-native: add more logging when fetching cve-update-db-native: use fetch task alsa-plugins: improve .la removal sato-screenshot: improve .la removal buildhistory-diff: use BUILDDIR to know where buildhistory is Saul Wold (1): gnupg: uprev 2.2.22 -> 2.2.23 Stacy Gaikovaia (2): bison: uprev from 3.7.1 to 3.7.2 valgrind: fix memcheck vgtests remove fullpath-after flags Steve Sakoman (1): xinput-calibrator: change SRC_URI to branch with libinput support Sumit Garg (1): insane: fix gnu-hash-style check TeohJayShen (1): oeqa/runtime: add test for matchbox-terminal Tim Orling (1): sphinx: toaster-manual: fix vars, links, code blocks Vijai Kumar K (2): image_types_wic: Add ASSUME_PROVIDED to WICVARS wic: misc: Add /bin to the list of searchpaths Yanfei Xu (1): kernel-yocto: only replace leading -I in include paths Yi Zhao (1): glib-networking: add ptest Zhixiong Chi (1): gnutls: CVE-2020-24659 akuster (8): log4cplus: move meta-oe pkg to core kea: Move from meta-networking maintainers.inc: Add me as kea & log4plus maintainer. dhcpcd: Move from meta-network as OE-Core needs a client maintainers.inc: Add me as dhcpcd maintainer dhcp: remove from core bind: Add 9.16.x bind: 9.11 remove hongxu (1): sysstat: fix installed-vs-shipped QA Issue in systemd zangrc (4): libcap:upgrade 2.42 -> 2.43 libcap-ng:upgrade 0.7.10 -> 0.7.11 libgpg-error:upgrade 1.38 -> 1.39 at-spi2-core:upgrade 2.36.0 -> 2.36.1 Signed-off-by: Andrew Geissler <geissonator@yahoo.com> Change-Id: I5542f5eea751a2641342e945725fd687cd74bebe
Diffstat (limited to 'poky/documentation/ref-manual')
-rw-r--r--poky/documentation/ref-manual/examples/hello-autotools/hello_2.10.bb9
-rw-r--r--poky/documentation/ref-manual/examples/hello-autotools/hello_2.3.bb8
-rw-r--r--poky/documentation/ref-manual/examples/libxpm/libxpm_3.5.6.bb2
-rw-r--r--poky/documentation/ref-manual/faq.rst451
-rw-r--r--poky/documentation/ref-manual/faq.xml2
-rw-r--r--poky/documentation/ref-manual/history.rst74
-rw-r--r--poky/documentation/ref-manual/migration-1.3.rst195
-rw-r--r--poky/documentation/ref-manual/migration-1.4.rst237
-rw-r--r--poky/documentation/ref-manual/migration-1.5.rst355
-rw-r--r--poky/documentation/ref-manual/migration-1.6.rst417
-rw-r--r--poky/documentation/ref-manual/migration-1.7.rst225
-rw-r--r--poky/documentation/ref-manual/migration-1.8.rst183
-rw-r--r--poky/documentation/ref-manual/migration-2.0.rst281
-rw-r--r--poky/documentation/ref-manual/migration-2.1.rst434
-rw-r--r--poky/documentation/ref-manual/migration-2.2.rst451
-rw-r--r--poky/documentation/ref-manual/migration-2.3.rst530
-rw-r--r--poky/documentation/ref-manual/migration-2.4.rst327
-rw-r--r--poky/documentation/ref-manual/migration-2.5.rst310
-rw-r--r--poky/documentation/ref-manual/migration-2.6.rst476
-rw-r--r--poky/documentation/ref-manual/migration-2.7.rst180
-rw-r--r--poky/documentation/ref-manual/migration-3.0.rst321
-rw-r--r--poky/documentation/ref-manual/migration-3.1.rst276
-rw-r--r--poky/documentation/ref-manual/migration-general.rst54
-rw-r--r--poky/documentation/ref-manual/migration.rst30
-rw-r--r--poky/documentation/ref-manual/ref-classes.rst2963
-rw-r--r--poky/documentation/ref-manual/ref-devtool-reference.rst625
-rw-r--r--poky/documentation/ref-manual/ref-features.rst353
-rw-r--r--poky/documentation/ref-manual/ref-images.rst139
-rw-r--r--poky/documentation/ref-manual/ref-images.xml4
-rw-r--r--poky/documentation/ref-manual/ref-kickstart.rst212
-rw-r--r--poky/documentation/ref-manual/ref-manual.rst31
-rw-r--r--poky/documentation/ref-manual/ref-qa-checks.rst533
-rw-r--r--poky/documentation/ref-manual/ref-release-process.rst193
-rw-r--r--poky/documentation/ref-manual/ref-structure.rst890
-rw-r--r--poky/documentation/ref-manual/ref-system-requirements.rst437
-rw-r--r--poky/documentation/ref-manual/ref-tasks.rst875
-rw-r--r--poky/documentation/ref-manual/ref-terms.rst397
-rw-r--r--poky/documentation/ref-manual/ref-terms.xml2
-rw-r--r--poky/documentation/ref-manual/ref-variables.rst8899
-rw-r--r--poky/documentation/ref-manual/ref-varlocality.rst166
-rw-r--r--poky/documentation/ref-manual/resources.rst197
41 files changed, 22731 insertions, 13 deletions
diff --git a/poky/documentation/ref-manual/examples/hello-autotools/hello_2.10.bb b/poky/documentation/ref-manual/examples/hello-autotools/hello_2.10.bb
new file mode 100644
index 000000000..aa2beb9a9
--- /dev/null
+++ b/poky/documentation/ref-manual/examples/hello-autotools/hello_2.10.bb
@@ -0,0 +1,9 @@
+DESCRIPTION = "GNU Helloworld application"
+SECTION = "examples"
+LICENSE = "GPLv3"
+LIC_FILES_CHKSUM = "file://COPYING;md5=d32239bcb673463ab874e80d47fae504"
+
+SRC_URI = "${GNU_MIRROR}/hello/hello-${PV}.tar.gz"
+SRC_URI[sha256sum] = "31e066137a962676e89f69d1b65382de95a7ef7d914b8cb956f41ea72e0f516b"
+
+inherit autotools-brokensep gettext
diff --git a/poky/documentation/ref-manual/examples/hello-autotools/hello_2.3.bb b/poky/documentation/ref-manual/examples/hello-autotools/hello_2.3.bb
deleted file mode 100644
index 5dfb0b30c..000000000
--- a/poky/documentation/ref-manual/examples/hello-autotools/hello_2.3.bb
+++ /dev/null
@@ -1,8 +0,0 @@
-DESCRIPTION = "GNU Helloworld application"
-SECTION = "examples"
-LICENSE = "GPLv3"
-LIC_FILES_CHKSUM = "file://COPYING;md5=adefda309052235aa5d1e99ce7557010"
-
-SRC_URI = "${GNU_MIRROR}/hello/hello-${PV}.tar.bz2"
-
-inherit autotools
diff --git a/poky/documentation/ref-manual/examples/libxpm/libxpm_3.5.6.bb b/poky/documentation/ref-manual/examples/libxpm/libxpm_3.5.6.bb
index b58d4d7bd..c0c898640 100644
--- a/poky/documentation/ref-manual/examples/libxpm/libxpm_3.5.6.bb
+++ b/poky/documentation/ref-manual/examples/libxpm/libxpm_3.5.6.bb
@@ -1,4 +1,4 @@
-require xorg-lib-common.inc
+require recipes-graphics/xorg-lib/xorg-lib-common.inc
DESCRIPTION = "X11 Pixmap library"
LICENSE = "X-BSD"
diff --git a/poky/documentation/ref-manual/faq.rst b/poky/documentation/ref-manual/faq.rst
new file mode 100644
index 000000000..2d2aaad0a
--- /dev/null
+++ b/poky/documentation/ref-manual/faq.rst
@@ -0,0 +1,451 @@
+.. SPDX-License-Identifier: CC-BY-2.0-UK
+
+***
+FAQ
+***
+
+**Q:** How does Poky differ from `OpenEmbedded <http://www.openembedded.org/>`__?
+
+**A:** The term ``Poky`` refers to the specific reference build
+system that the Yocto Project provides. Poky is based on
+:term:`OpenEmbedded-Core (OE-Core)` and :term:`BitBake`. Thus, the
+generic term used here for the build system is the "OpenEmbedded build
+system." Development in the Yocto Project using Poky is closely tied to
+OpenEmbedded, with changes always being merged to OE-Core or BitBake
+first before being pulled back into Poky. This practice benefits both
+projects immediately.
+
+**Q:** My development system does not meet the required Git, tar, and
+Python versions. In particular, I do not have Python 3.5.0 or greater.
+Can I still use the Yocto Project?
+
+**A:** You can get the required tools on your host development system a
+couple different ways (i.e. building a tarball or downloading a
+tarball). See the "`Required Git, tar, Python and gcc
+Versions <#required-git-tar-python-and-gcc-versions>`__" section for
+steps on how to update your build tools.
+
+**Q:** How can you claim Poky / OpenEmbedded-Core is stable?
+
+**A:** There are three areas that help with stability;
+
+- The Yocto Project team keeps :term:`OpenEmbedded-Core (OE-Core)` small and
+ focused, containing around 830 recipes as opposed to the thousands
+ available in other OpenEmbedded community layers. Keeping it small
+ makes it easy to test and maintain.
+
+- The Yocto Project team runs manual and automated tests using a small,
+ fixed set of reference hardware as well as emulated targets.
+
+- The Yocto Project uses an autobuilder, which provides continuous
+ build and integration tests.
+
+**Q:** How do I get support for my board added to the Yocto Project?
+
+**A:** Support for an additional board is added by creating a Board
+Support Package (BSP) layer for it. For more information on how to
+create a BSP layer, see the
+":ref:`dev-manual/dev-manual-common-tasks:understanding and creating layers`"
+section in the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual and the
+:doc:`../bsp-guide/bsp-guide`.
+
+Usually, if the board is not completely exotic, adding support in the
+Yocto Project is fairly straightforward.
+
+**Q:** Are there any products built using the OpenEmbedded build system?
+
+**A:** The software running on the `Vernier
+LabQuest <http://vernier.com/labquest/>`__ is built using the
+OpenEmbedded build system. See the `Vernier
+LabQuest <http://www.vernier.com/products/interfaces/labq/>`__ website
+for more information. There are a number of pre-production devices using
+the OpenEmbedded build system and the Yocto Project team announces them
+as soon as they are released.
+
+**Q:** What does the OpenEmbedded build system produce as output?
+
+**A:** Because you can use the same set of recipes to create output of
+various formats, the output of an OpenEmbedded build depends on how you
+start it. Usually, the output is a flashable image ready for the target
+device.
+
+**Q:** How do I add my package to the Yocto Project?
+
+**A:** To add a package, you need to create a BitBake recipe. For
+information on how to create a BitBake recipe, see the
+":ref:`dev-manual/dev-manual-common-tasks:writing a new recipe`"
+section in the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual.
+
+**Q:** Do I have to reflash my entire board with a new Yocto Project
+image when recompiling a package?
+
+**A:** The OpenEmbedded build system can build packages in various
+formats such as IPK for OPKG, Debian package (``.deb``), or RPM. You can
+then upgrade the packages using the package tools on the device, much
+like on a desktop distribution such as Ubuntu or Fedora. However,
+package management on the target is entirely optional.
+
+**Q:** I see the error
+'``chmod: XXXXX new permissions are r-xrwxrwx, not r-xr-xr-x``'. What is
+wrong?
+
+**A:** You are probably running the build on an NTFS filesystem. Use
+``ext2``, ``ext3``, or ``ext4`` instead.
+
+**Q:** I see lots of 404 responses for files when the OpenEmbedded build
+system is trying to download sources. Is something wrong?
+
+**A:** Nothing is wrong. The OpenEmbedded build system checks any
+configured source mirrors before downloading from the upstream sources.
+The build system does this searching for both source archives and
+pre-checked out versions of SCM-managed software. These checks help in
+large installations because it can reduce load on the SCM servers
+themselves. The address above is one of the default mirrors configured
+into the build system. Consequently, if an upstream source disappears,
+the team can place sources there so builds continue to work.
+
+**Q:** I have machine-specific data in a package for one machine only
+but the package is being marked as machine-specific in all cases, how do
+I prevent this?
+
+**A:** Set ``SRC_URI_OVERRIDES_PACKAGE_ARCH`` = "0" in the ``.bb`` file
+but make sure the package is manually marked as machine-specific for the
+case that needs it. The code that handles
+``SRC_URI_OVERRIDES_PACKAGE_ARCH`` is in the
+``meta/classes/base.bbclass`` file.
+
+**Q:** I'm behind a firewall and need to use a proxy server. How do I do
+that?
+
+**A:** Most source fetching by the OpenEmbedded build system is done by
+``wget`` and you therefore need to specify the proxy settings in a
+``.wgetrc`` file, which can be in your home directory if you are a
+single user or can be in ``/usr/local/etc/wgetrc`` as a global user
+file.
+
+Following is the applicable code for setting various proxy types in the
+``.wgetrc`` file. By default, these settings are disabled with comments.
+To use them, remove the comments: ::
+
+ # You can set the default proxies for Wget to use for http, https, and ftp.
+ # They will override the value in the environment.
+ #https_proxy = http://proxy.yoyodyne.com:18023/
+ #http_proxy = http://proxy.yoyodyne.com:18023/
+ #ftp_proxy = http://proxy.yoyodyne.com:18023/
+
+ # If you do not want to use proxy at all, set this to off.
+ #use_proxy = on
+
+The Yocto Project also includes a
+``meta-poky/conf/site.conf.sample`` file that shows how to configure CVS
+and Git proxy servers if needed. For more information on setting up
+various proxy types and configuring proxy servers, see the
+":yocto_wiki:`Working Behind a Network Proxy </wiki/Working_Behind_a_Network_Proxy>`"
+Wiki page.
+
+**Q:** What's the difference between target and target\ ``-native``?
+
+**A:** The ``*-native`` targets are designed to run on the system being
+used for the build. These are usually tools that are needed to assist
+the build in some way such as ``quilt-native``, which is used to apply
+patches. The non-native version is the one that runs on the target
+device.
+
+**Q:** I'm seeing random build failures. Help?!
+
+**A:** If the same build is failing in totally different and random
+ways, the most likely explanation is:
+
+- The hardware you are running the build on has some problem.
+
+- You are running the build under virtualization, in which case the
+ virtualization probably has bugs.
+
+The OpenEmbedded build system processes a massive amount of data that
+causes lots of network, disk and CPU activity and is sensitive to even
+single-bit failures in any of these areas. True random failures have
+always been traced back to hardware or virtualization issues.
+
+**Q:** When I try to build a native recipe, the build fails with
+``iconv.h`` problems.
+
+**A:** If you get an error message that indicates GNU ``libiconv`` is
+not in use but ``iconv.h`` has been included from ``libiconv``, you need
+to check to see if you have a previously installed version of the header
+file in ``/usr/local/include``.
+::
+
+ #error GNU libiconv not in use but included iconv.h is from libiconv
+
+If you find a previously installed
+file, you should either uninstall it or temporarily rename it and try
+the build again.
+
+This issue is just a single manifestation of "system leakage" issues
+caused when the OpenEmbedded build system finds and uses previously
+installed files during a native build. This type of issue might not be
+limited to ``iconv.h``. Be sure that leakage cannot occur from
+``/usr/local/include`` and ``/opt`` locations.
+
+**Q:** What do we need to ship for license compliance?
+
+**A:** This is a difficult question and you need to consult your lawyer
+for the answer for your specific case. It is worth bearing in mind that
+for GPL compliance, there needs to be enough information shipped to
+allow someone else to rebuild and produce the same end result you are
+shipping. This means sharing the source code, any patches applied to it,
+and also any configuration information about how that package was
+configured and built.
+
+You can find more information on licensing in the
+":ref:`overview-manual/overview-manual-development-environment:licensing`"
+section in the Yocto
+Project Overview and Concepts Manual and also in the
+":ref:`dev-manual/dev-manual-common-tasks:maintaining open source license compliance during your product's lifecycle`"
+section in the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual.
+
+**Q:** How do I disable the cursor on my touchscreen device?
+
+**A:** You need to create a form factor file as described in the
+":ref:`bsp-filelayout-misc-recipes`" section in
+the Yocto Project Board Support Packages (BSP) Developer's Guide. Set
+the ``HAVE_TOUCHSCREEN`` variable equal to one as follows:
+::
+
+ HAVE_TOUCHSCREEN=1
+
+**Q:** How do I make sure connected network interfaces are brought up by
+default?
+
+**A:** The default interfaces file provided by the netbase recipe does
+not automatically bring up network interfaces. Therefore, you will need
+to add a BSP-specific netbase that includes an interfaces file. See the
+":ref:`bsp-filelayout-misc-recipes`" section in
+the Yocto Project Board Support Packages (BSP) Developer's Guide for
+information on creating these types of miscellaneous recipe files.
+
+For example, add the following files to your layer: ::
+
+ meta-MACHINE/recipes-bsp/netbase/netbase/MACHINE/interfaces
+ meta-MACHINE/recipes-bsp/netbase/netbase_5.0.bbappend
+
+**Q:** How do I create images with more free space?
+
+**A:** By default, the OpenEmbedded build system creates images that are
+1.3 times the size of the populated root filesystem. To affect the image
+size, you need to set various configurations:
+
+- *Image Size:* The OpenEmbedded build system uses the
+ :term:`IMAGE_ROOTFS_SIZE` variable to define
+ the size of the image in Kbytes. The build system determines the size
+ by taking into account the initial root filesystem size before any
+ modifications such as requested size for the image and any requested
+ additional free disk space to be added to the image.
+
+- *Overhead:* Use the
+ :term:`IMAGE_OVERHEAD_FACTOR` variable
+ to define the multiplier that the build system applies to the initial
+ image size, which is 1.3 by default.
+
+- *Additional Free Space:* Use the
+ :term:`IMAGE_ROOTFS_EXTRA_SPACE`
+ variable to add additional free space to the image. The build system
+ adds this space to the image after it determines its
+ ``IMAGE_ROOTFS_SIZE``.
+
+**Q:** Why don't you support directories with spaces in the pathnames?
+
+**A:** The Yocto Project team has tried to do this before but too many
+of the tools the OpenEmbedded build system depends on, such as
+``autoconf``, break when they find spaces in pathnames. Until that
+situation changes, the team will not support spaces in pathnames.
+
+**Q:** How do I use an external toolchain?
+
+**A:** The toolchain configuration is very flexible and customizable. It
+is primarily controlled with the ``TCMODE`` variable. This variable
+controls which ``tcmode-*.inc`` file to include from the
+``meta/conf/distro/include`` directory within the :term:`Source Directory`.
+
+The default value of ``TCMODE`` is "default", which tells the
+OpenEmbedded build system to use its internally built toolchain (i.e.
+``tcmode-default.inc``). However, other patterns are accepted. In
+particular, "external-\*" refers to external toolchains. One example is
+the Sourcery G++ Toolchain. The support for this toolchain resides in
+the separate ``meta-sourcery`` layer at
+http://github.com/MentorEmbedded/meta-sourcery/.
+
+In addition to the toolchain configuration, you also need a
+corresponding toolchain recipe file. This recipe file needs to package
+up any pre-built objects in the toolchain such as ``libgcc``,
+``libstdcc++``, any locales, and ``libc``.
+
+**Q:** How does the OpenEmbedded build system obtain source code and
+will it work behind my firewall or proxy server?
+
+**A:** The way the build system obtains source code is highly
+configurable. You can setup the build system to get source code in most
+environments if HTTP transport is available.
+
+When the build system searches for source code, it first tries the local
+download directory. If that location fails, Poky tries
+:term:`PREMIRRORS`, the upstream source, and then
+:term:`MIRRORS` in that order.
+
+Assuming your distribution is "poky", the OpenEmbedded build system uses
+the Yocto Project source ``PREMIRRORS`` by default for SCM-based
+sources, upstreams for normal tarballs, and then falls back to a number
+of other mirrors including the Yocto Project source mirror if those
+fail.
+
+As an example, you could add a specific server for the build system to
+attempt before any others by adding something like the following to the
+``local.conf`` configuration file: ::
+
+ PREMIRRORS_prepend = "\
+ git://.*/.* http://www.yoctoproject.org/sources/ \n \
+ ftp://.*/.* http://www.yoctoproject.org/sources/ \n \
+ http://.*/.* http://www.yoctoproject.org/sources/ \n \
+ https://.*/.* http://www.yoctoproject.org/sources/ \n"
+
+These changes cause the build system to intercept Git, FTP, HTTP, and
+HTTPS requests and direct them to the ``http://`` sources mirror. You
+can use ``file://`` URLs to point to local directories or network shares
+as well.
+
+Aside from the previous technique, these options also exist:
+::
+
+ BB_NO_NETWORK = "1"
+
+This statement tells BitBake to issue an error
+instead of trying to access the Internet. This technique is useful if
+you want to ensure code builds only from local sources.
+
+Here is another technique:
+::
+
+ BB_FETCH_PREMIRRORONLY = "1"
+
+This statement
+limits the build system to pulling source from the ``PREMIRRORS`` only.
+Again, this technique is useful for reproducing builds.
+
+Here is another technique:
+::
+
+ BB_GENERATE_MIRROR_TARBALLS = "1"
+
+This
+statement tells the build system to generate mirror tarballs. This
+technique is useful if you want to create a mirror server. If not,
+however, the technique can simply waste time during the build.
+
+Finally, consider an example where you are behind an HTTP-only firewall.
+You could make the following changes to the ``local.conf`` configuration
+file as long as the ``PREMIRRORS`` server is current: ::
+
+ PREMIRRORS_prepend = "\
+ ftp://.*/.* http://www.yoctoproject.org/sources/ \n \
+ http://.*/.* http://www.yoctoproject.org/sources/ \n \
+ https://.*/.* http://www.yoctoproject.org/sources/ \n"
+ BB_FETCH_PREMIRRORONLY = "1"
+
+These changes would cause the build system to successfully fetch source
+over HTTP and any network accesses to anything other than the
+``PREMIRRORS`` would fail.
+
+The build system also honors the standard shell environment variables
+``http_proxy``, ``ftp_proxy``, ``https_proxy``, and ``all_proxy`` to
+redirect requests through proxy servers.
+
+.. note::
+
+ You can find more information on the
+ ":yocto_wiki:`Working Behind a Network Proxy </wiki/Working_Behind_a_Network_Proxy>`"
+ Wiki page.
+
+**Q:** Can I get rid of build output so I can start over?
+
+**A:** Yes - you can easily do this. When you use BitBake to build an
+image, all the build output goes into the directory created when you run
+the build environment setup script (i.e.
+````` <#structure-core-script>`__). By default, this :term:`Build Directory`
+is named ``build`` but can be named
+anything you want.
+
+Within the Build Directory, is the ``tmp`` directory. To remove all the
+build output yet preserve any source code or downloaded files from
+previous builds, simply remove the ``tmp`` directory.
+
+**Q:** Why do ``${bindir}`` and ``${libdir}`` have strange values for
+``-native`` recipes?
+
+**A:** Executables and libraries might need to be used from a directory
+other than the directory into which they were initially installed.
+Complicating this situation is the fact that sometimes these executables
+and libraries are compiled with the expectation of being run from that
+initial installation target directory. If this is the case, moving them
+causes problems.
+
+This scenario is a fundamental problem for package maintainers of
+mainstream Linux distributions as well as for the OpenEmbedded build
+system. As such, a well-established solution exists. Makefiles,
+Autotools configuration scripts, and other build systems are expected to
+respect environment variables such as ``bindir``, ``libdir``, and
+``sysconfdir`` that indicate where executables, libraries, and data
+reside when a program is actually run. They are also expected to respect
+a ``DESTDIR`` environment variable, which is prepended to all the other
+variables when the build system actually installs the files. It is
+understood that the program does not actually run from within
+``DESTDIR``.
+
+When the OpenEmbedded build system uses a recipe to build a
+target-architecture program (i.e. one that is intended for inclusion on
+the image being built), that program eventually runs from the root file
+system of that image. Thus, the build system provides a value of
+"/usr/bin" for ``bindir``, a value of "/usr/lib" for ``libdir``, and so
+forth.
+
+Meanwhile, ``DESTDIR`` is a path within the :term:`Build Directory`.
+However, when the recipe builds a
+native program (i.e. one that is intended to run on the build machine),
+that program is never installed directly to the build machine's root
+file system. Consequently, the build system uses paths within the Build
+Directory for ``DESTDIR``, ``bindir`` and related variables. To better
+understand this, consider the following two paths where the first is
+relatively normal and the second is not: ::
+
+ /home/maxtothemax/poky-bootchart2/build/tmp/work/i586-poky-linux/zlib/
+ 1.2.8-r0/sysroot-destdir/usr/bin
+
+ /home/maxtothemax/poky-bootchart2/build/tmp/work/x86_64-linux/
+ zlib-native/1.2.8-r0/sysroot-destdir/home/maxtothemax/poky-bootchart2/
+ build/tmp/sysroots/x86_64-linux/usr/bin
+
+.. note::
+
+ Due to these lengthy examples, the paths are artificially broken
+ across lines for readability.
+
+Even if the paths look unusual,
+they both are correct - the first for a target and the second for a
+native recipe. These paths are a consequence of the ``DESTDIR``
+mechanism and while they appear strange, they are correct and in
+practice very effective.
+
+**Q:** The files provided by my ``*-native`` recipe do not appear to be
+available to other recipes. Files are missing from the native sysroot,
+my recipe is installing to the wrong place, or I am getting permissions
+errors during the do_install task in my recipe! What is wrong?
+
+**A:** This situation results when a build system does not recognize the
+environment variables supplied to it by :term:`BitBake`. The
+incident that prompted this FAQ entry involved a Makefile that used an
+environment variable named ``BINDIR`` instead of the more standard
+variable ``bindir``. The makefile's hardcoded default value of
+"/usr/bin" worked most of the time, but not for the recipe's ``-native``
+variant. For another example, permissions errors might be caused by a
+Makefile that ignores ``DESTDIR`` or uses a different name for that
+environment variable. Check the the build system to see if these kinds
+of issues exist.
diff --git a/poky/documentation/ref-manual/faq.xml b/poky/documentation/ref-manual/faq.xml
index 98ae0a975..2f8fcf324 100644
--- a/poky/documentation/ref-manual/faq.xml
+++ b/poky/documentation/ref-manual/faq.xml
@@ -323,7 +323,7 @@
<qandaentry>
<question>
<para>
- What’s the difference between <replaceable>target</replaceable> and <replaceable>target</replaceable><filename>-native</filename>?
+ What's the difference between <replaceable>target</replaceable> and <replaceable>target</replaceable><filename>-native</filename>?
</para>
</question>
<answer>
diff --git a/poky/documentation/ref-manual/history.rst b/poky/documentation/ref-manual/history.rst
new file mode 100644
index 000000000..e962d9297
--- /dev/null
+++ b/poky/documentation/ref-manual/history.rst
@@ -0,0 +1,74 @@
+.. SPDX-License-Identifier: CC-BY-2.0-UK
+
+***********************
+Manual Revision History
+***********************
+
+.. list-table::
+ :widths: 10 15 40
+ :header-rows: 1
+
+ * - Revision
+ - Date
+ - Note
+ * - 0.9
+ - November 2010
+ - The initial document released with the Yocto Project 0.9 Release
+ * - 1.0
+ - April 2011
+ - Released with the Yocto Project 1.0 Release.
+ * - 1.1
+ - October 2011
+ - Released with the Yocto Project 1.1 Release.
+ * - 1.2
+ - April 2012
+ - Released with the Yocto Project 1.2 Release.
+ * - 1.3
+ - October 2012
+ - Released with the Yocto Project 1.3 Release.
+ * - 1.4
+ - April 2013
+ - Released with the Yocto Project 1.4 Release.
+ * - 1.5
+ - October 2013
+ - Released with the Yocto Project 1.5 Release.
+ * - 1.6
+ - April 2014
+ - Released with the Yocto Project 1.6 Release.
+ * - 1.7
+ - October 2014
+ - Released with the Yocto Project 1.7 Release.
+ * - 1.8
+ - April 2015
+ - Released with the Yocto Project 1.8 Release.
+ * - 2.0
+ - October 2015
+ - Released with the Yocto Project 2.0 Release.
+ * - 2.1
+ - April 2016
+ - Released with the Yocto Project 2.1 Release.
+ * - 2.2
+ - October 2016
+ - Released with the Yocto Project 2.2 Release.
+ * - 2.3
+ - May 2017
+ - Released with the Yocto Project 2.3 Release.
+ * - 2.4
+ - October 2017
+ - Released with the Yocto Project 2.4 Release.
+ * - 2.5
+ - May 2018
+ - Released with the Yocto Project 2.5 Release.
+ * - 2.6
+ - November 2018
+ - Released with the Yocto Project 2.6 Release.
+ * - 2.7
+ - May 2019
+ - Released with the Yocto Project 2.7 Release.
+ * - 3.0
+ - October 2019
+ - Released with the Yocto Project 3.0 Release.
+ * - 3.1
+ - April 2020
+ - Released with the Yocto Project 3.1 Release.
+
diff --git a/poky/documentation/ref-manual/migration-1.3.rst b/poky/documentation/ref-manual/migration-1.3.rst
new file mode 100644
index 000000000..ebbc23887
--- /dev/null
+++ b/poky/documentation/ref-manual/migration-1.3.rst
@@ -0,0 +1,195 @@
+.. SPDX-License-Identifier: CC-BY-2.0-UK
+
+Moving to the Yocto Project 1.3 Release
+=======================================
+
+This section provides migration information for moving to the Yocto
+Project 1.3 Release from the prior release.
+
+.. _1.3-local-configuration:
+
+Local Configuration
+-------------------
+
+Differences include changes for
+:term:`SSTATE_MIRRORS` and ``bblayers.conf``.
+
+.. _migration-1.3-sstate-mirrors:
+
+SSTATE_MIRRORS
+~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
+
+The shared state cache (sstate-cache), as pointed to by
+:term:`SSTATE_DIR`, by default now has two-character
+subdirectories to prevent issues arising from too many files in the same
+directory. Also, native sstate-cache packages, which are built to run on
+the host system, will go into a subdirectory named using the distro ID
+string. If you copy the newly structured sstate-cache to a mirror
+location (either local or remote) and then point to it in
+:term:`SSTATE_MIRRORS`, you need to append "PATH"
+to the end of the mirror URL so that the path used by BitBake before the
+mirror substitution is appended to the path used to access the mirror.
+Here is an example: ::
+
+ SSTATE_MIRRORS = "file://.* http://someserver.tld/share/sstate/PATH"
+
+.. _migration-1.3-bblayers-conf:
+
+bblayers.conf
+~~~~~~~~~~~~~
+
+The ``meta-yocto`` layer consists of two parts that correspond to the
+Poky reference distribution and the reference hardware Board Support
+Packages (BSPs), respectively: ``meta-yocto`` and ``meta-yocto-bsp``.
+When running BitBake for the first time after upgrading, your
+``conf/bblayers.conf`` file will be updated to handle this change and
+you will be asked to re-run or restart for the changes to take effect.
+
+.. _1.3-recipes:
+
+Recipes
+-------
+
+Differences include changes for the following:
+
+.. _migration-1.3-python-function-whitespace:
+
+Python Function Whitespace
+~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
+
+All Python functions must now use four spaces for indentation.
+Previously, an inconsistent mix of spaces and tabs existed, which made
+extending these functions using ``_append`` or ``_prepend`` complicated
+given that Python treats whitespace as syntactically significant. If you
+are defining or extending any Python functions (e.g.
+``populate_packages``, ``do_unpack``, ``do_patch`` and so forth) in
+custom recipes or classes, you need to ensure you are using consistent
+four-space indentation.
+
+.. _migration-1.3-proto=-in-src-uri:
+
+proto= in SRC_URI
+~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
+
+Any use of ``proto=`` in :term:`SRC_URI` needs to be
+changed to ``protocol=``. In particular, this applies to the following
+URIs:
+
+- ``svn://``
+
+- ``bzr://``
+
+- ``hg://``
+
+- ``osc://``
+
+Other URIs were already using ``protocol=``. This change improves
+consistency.
+
+.. _migration-1.3-nativesdk:
+
+nativesdk
+~~~~~~~~~
+
+The suffix ``nativesdk`` is now implemented as a prefix, which
+simplifies a lot of the packaging code for ``nativesdk`` recipes. All
+custom ``nativesdk`` recipes, which are relocatable packages that are
+native to :term:`SDK_ARCH`, and any references need to
+be updated to use ``nativesdk-*`` instead of ``*-nativesdk``.
+
+.. _migration-1.3-task-recipes:
+
+Task Recipes
+~~~~~~~~~~~~
+
+"Task" recipes are now known as "Package groups" and have been renamed
+from ``task-*.bb`` to ``packagegroup-*.bb``. Existing references to the
+previous ``task-*`` names should work in most cases as there is an
+automatic upgrade path for most packages. However, you should update
+references in your own recipes and configurations as they could be
+removed in future releases. You should also rename any custom ``task-*``
+recipes to ``packagegroup-*``, and change them to inherit
+``packagegroup`` instead of ``task``, as well as taking the opportunity
+to remove anything now handled by ``packagegroup.bbclass``, such as
+providing ``-dev`` and ``-dbg`` packages, setting
+:term:`LIC_FILES_CHKSUM`, and so forth. See the
+":ref:`packagegroup.bbclass <ref-classes-packagegroup>`" section for
+further details.
+
+.. _migration-1.3-image-features:
+
+IMAGE_FEATURES
+~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
+
+Image recipes that previously included "apps-console-core" in
+:term:`IMAGE_FEATURES` should now include "splash"
+instead to enable the boot-up splash screen. Retaining
+"apps-console-core" will still include the splash screen but generates a
+warning. The "apps-x11-core" and "apps-x11-games" ``IMAGE_FEATURES``
+features have been removed.
+
+.. _migration-1.3-removed-recipes:
+
+Removed Recipes
+~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
+
+The following recipes have been removed. For most of them, it is
+unlikely that you would have any references to them in your own
+:term:`Metadata`. However, you should check your metadata
+against this list to be sure:
+
+- ``libx11-trim``: Replaced by ``libx11``, which has a negligible
+ size difference with modern Xorg.
+
+- ``xserver-xorg-lite``: Use ``xserver-xorg``, which has a negligible
+ size difference when DRI and GLX modules are not installed.
+
+- ``xserver-kdrive``: Effectively unmaintained for many years.
+
+- ``mesa-xlib``: No longer serves any purpose.
+
+- ``galago``: Replaced by telepathy.
+
+- ``gail``: Functionality was integrated into GTK+ 2.13.
+
+- ``eggdbus``: No longer needed.
+
+- ``gcc-*-intermediate``: The build has been restructured to avoid
+ the need for this step.
+
+- ``libgsmd``: Unmaintained for many years. Functionality now
+ provided by ``ofono`` instead.
+
+- *contacts, dates, tasks, eds-tools*: Largely unmaintained PIM
+ application suite. It has been moved to ``meta-gnome`` in
+ ``meta-openembedded``.
+
+In addition to the previously listed changes, the ``meta-demoapps``
+directory has also been removed because the recipes in it were not being
+maintained and many had become obsolete or broken. Additionally, these
+recipes were not parsed in the default configuration. Many of these
+recipes are already provided in an updated and maintained form within
+the OpenEmbedded community layers such as ``meta-oe`` and
+``meta-gnome``. For the remainder, you can now find them in the
+``meta-extras`` repository, which is in the
+:yocto_git:`Source Repositories <>` at
+http://git.yoctoproject.org/cgit/cgit.cgi/meta-extras/.
+
+.. _1.3-linux-kernel-naming:
+
+Linux Kernel Naming
+-------------------
+
+The naming scheme for kernel output binaries has been changed to now
+include :term:`PE` as part of the filename:
+::
+
+ KERNEL_IMAGE_BASE_NAME ?= "${KERNEL_IMAGETYPE}-${PE}-${PV}-${PR}-${MACHINE}-${DATETIME}"
+
+Because the ``PE`` variable is not set by default, these binary files
+could result with names that include two dash characters. Here is an
+example: ::
+
+ bzImage--3.10.9+git0+cd502a8814_7144bcc4b8-r0-qemux86-64-20130830085431.bin
+
+
diff --git a/poky/documentation/ref-manual/migration-1.4.rst b/poky/documentation/ref-manual/migration-1.4.rst
new file mode 100644
index 000000000..a658bdff6
--- /dev/null
+++ b/poky/documentation/ref-manual/migration-1.4.rst
@@ -0,0 +1,237 @@
+Moving to the Yocto Project 1.4 Release
+=======================================
+
+This section provides migration information for moving to the Yocto
+Project 1.4 Release from the prior release.
+
+.. _migration-1.4-bitbake:
+
+BitBake
+-------
+
+Differences include the following:
+
+- *Comment Continuation:* If a comment ends with a line continuation
+ (\) character, then the next line must also be a comment. Any
+ instance where this is not the case, now triggers a warning. You must
+ either remove the continuation character, or be sure the next line is
+ a comment.
+
+- *Package Name Overrides:* The runtime package specific variables
+ :term:`RDEPENDS`,
+ :term:`RRECOMMENDS`,
+ :term:`RSUGGESTS`,
+ :term:`RPROVIDES`,
+ :term:`RCONFLICTS`,
+ :term:`RREPLACES`, :term:`FILES`,
+ :term:`ALLOW_EMPTY`, and the pre, post, install,
+ and uninstall script functions ``pkg_preinst``, ``pkg_postinst``,
+ ``pkg_prerm``, and ``pkg_postrm`` should always have a package name
+ override. For example, use ``RDEPENDS_${PN}`` for the main package
+ instead of ``RDEPENDS``. BitBake uses more strict checks when it
+ parses recipes.
+
+.. _migration-1.4-build-behavior:
+
+Build Behavior
+--------------
+
+Differences include the following:
+
+- *Shared State Code:* The shared state code has been optimized to
+ avoid running unnecessary tasks. For example, the following no longer
+ populates the target sysroot since that is not necessary:
+ ::
+
+ $ bitbake -c rootfs some-image
+
+ Instead, the system just needs to extract the
+ output package contents, re-create the packages, and construct the
+ root filesystem. This change is unlikely to cause any problems unless
+ you have missing declared dependencies.
+
+- *Scanning Directory Names:* When scanning for files in
+ :term:`SRC_URI`, the build system now uses
+ :term:`FILESOVERRIDES` instead of
+ :term:`OVERRIDES` for the directory names. In
+ general, the values previously in ``OVERRIDES`` are now in
+ ``FILESOVERRIDES`` as well. However, if you relied upon an additional
+ value you previously added to ``OVERRIDES``, you might now need to
+ add it to ``FILESOVERRIDES`` unless you are already adding it through
+ the :term:`MACHINEOVERRIDES` or
+ :term:`DISTROOVERRIDES` variables, as
+ appropriate. For more related changes, see the
+ "`Variables <#migration-1.4-variables>`__" section.
+
+.. _migration-1.4-proxies-and-fetching-source:
+
+Proxies and Fetching Source
+---------------------------
+
+A new ``oe-git-proxy`` script has been added to replace previous methods
+of handling proxies and fetching source from Git. See the
+``meta-yocto/conf/site.conf.sample`` file for information on how to use
+this script.
+
+.. _migration-1.4-custom-interfaces-file-netbase-change:
+
+Custom Interfaces File (netbase change)
+---------------------------------------
+
+If you have created your own custom ``etc/network/interfaces`` file by
+creating an append file for the ``netbase`` recipe, you now need to
+create an append file for the ``init-ifupdown`` recipe instead, which
+you can find in the :term:`Source Directory` at
+``meta/recipes-core/init-ifupdown``. For information on how to use
+append files, see the
+":ref:`dev-manual/dev-manual-common-tasks:using .bbappend files in your layer`"
+section in the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual.
+
+.. _migration-1.4-remote-debugging:
+
+Remote Debugging
+----------------
+
+Support for remote debugging with the Eclipse IDE is now separated into
+an image feature (``eclipse-debug``) that corresponds to the
+``packagegroup-core-eclipse-debug`` package group. Previously, the
+debugging feature was included through the ``tools-debug`` image
+feature, which corresponds to the ``packagegroup-core-tools-debug``
+package group.
+
+.. _migration-1.4-variables:
+
+Variables
+---------
+
+The following variables have changed:
+
+- ``SANITY_TESTED_DISTROS``: This variable now uses a distribution
+ ID, which is composed of the host distributor ID followed by the
+ release. Previously,
+ :term:`SANITY_TESTED_DISTROS` was
+ composed of the description field. For example, "Ubuntu 12.10"
+ becomes "Ubuntu-12.10". You do not need to worry about this change if
+ you are not specifically setting this variable, or if you are
+ specifically setting it to "".
+
+- ``SRC_URI``: The ``${``\ :term:`PN`\ ``}``,
+ ``${``\ :term:`PF`\ ``}``,
+ ``${``\ :term:`P`\ ``}``, and ``FILE_DIRNAME`` directories
+ have been dropped from the default value of the
+ :term:`FILESPATH` variable, which is used as the
+ search path for finding files referred to in
+ :term:`SRC_URI`. If you have a recipe that relied upon
+ these directories, which would be unusual, then you will need to add
+ the appropriate paths within the recipe or, alternatively, rearrange
+ the files. The most common locations are still covered by ``${BP}``,
+ ``${BPN}``, and "files", which all remain in the default value of
+ :term:`FILESPATH`.
+
+.. _migration-target-package-management-with-rpm:
+
+Target Package Management with RPM
+----------------------------------
+
+If runtime package management is enabled and the RPM backend is
+selected, Smart is now installed for package download, dependency
+resolution, and upgrades instead of Zypper. For more information on how
+to use Smart, run the following command on the target:
+::
+
+ smart --help
+
+.. _migration-1.4-recipes-moved:
+
+Recipes Moved
+-------------
+
+The following recipes were moved from their previous locations because
+they are no longer used by anything in the OpenEmbedded-Core:
+
+- ``clutter-box2d``: Now resides in the ``meta-oe`` layer.
+
+- ``evolution-data-server``: Now resides in the ``meta-gnome`` layer.
+
+- ``gthumb``: Now resides in the ``meta-gnome`` layer.
+
+- ``gtkhtml2``: Now resides in the ``meta-oe`` layer.
+
+- ``gupnp``: Now resides in the ``meta-multimedia`` layer.
+
+- ``gypsy``: Now resides in the ``meta-oe`` layer.
+
+- ``libcanberra``: Now resides in the ``meta-gnome`` layer.
+
+- ``libgdata``: Now resides in the ``meta-gnome`` layer.
+
+- ``libmusicbrainz``: Now resides in the ``meta-multimedia`` layer.
+
+- ``metacity``: Now resides in the ``meta-gnome`` layer.
+
+- ``polkit``: Now resides in the ``meta-oe`` layer.
+
+- ``zeroconf``: Now resides in the ``meta-networking`` layer.
+
+.. _migration-1.4-removals-and-renames:
+
+Removals and Renames
+--------------------
+
+The following list shows what has been removed or renamed:
+
+- ``evieext``: Removed because it has been removed from ``xserver``
+ since 2008.
+
+- *Gtk+ DirectFB:* Removed support because upstream Gtk+ no longer
+ supports it as of version 2.18.
+
+- ``libxfontcache / xfontcacheproto``: Removed because they were
+ removed from the Xorg server in 2008.
+
+- ``libxp / libxprintapputil / libxprintutil / printproto``: Removed
+ because the XPrint server was removed from Xorg in 2008.
+
+- ``libxtrap / xtrapproto``: Removed because their functionality was
+ broken upstream.
+
+- *linux-yocto 3.0 kernel:* Removed with linux-yocto 3.8 kernel being
+ added. The linux-yocto 3.2 and linux-yocto 3.4 kernels remain as part
+ of the release.
+
+- ``lsbsetup``: Removed with functionality now provided by
+ ``lsbtest``.
+
+- ``matchbox-stroke``: Removed because it was never more than a
+ proof-of-concept.
+
+- ``matchbox-wm-2 / matchbox-theme-sato-2``: Removed because they are
+ not maintained. However, ``matchbox-wm`` and ``matchbox-theme-sato``
+ are still provided.
+
+- ``mesa-dri``: Renamed to ``mesa``.
+
+- ``mesa-xlib``: Removed because it was no longer useful.
+
+- ``mutter``: Removed because nothing ever uses it and the recipe is
+ very old.
+
+- ``orinoco-conf``: Removed because it has become obsolete.
+
+- ``update-modules``: Removed because it is no longer used. The
+ kernel module ``postinstall`` and ``postrm`` scripts can now do the
+ same task without the use of this script.
+
+- ``web``: Removed because it is not maintained. Superseded by
+ ``web-webkit``.
+
+- ``xf86bigfontproto``: Removed because upstream it has been disabled
+ by default since 2007. Nothing uses ``xf86bigfontproto``.
+
+- ``xf86rushproto``: Removed because its dependency in ``xserver``
+ was spurious and it was removed in 2005.
+
+- ``zypper / libzypp / sat-solver``: Removed and been functionally
+ replaced with Smart (``python-smartpm``) when RPM packaging is used
+ and package management is enabled on the target.
+
diff --git a/poky/documentation/ref-manual/migration-1.5.rst b/poky/documentation/ref-manual/migration-1.5.rst
new file mode 100644
index 000000000..ce55199df
--- /dev/null
+++ b/poky/documentation/ref-manual/migration-1.5.rst
@@ -0,0 +1,355 @@
+Moving to the Yocto Project 1.5 Release
+=======================================
+
+This section provides migration information for moving to the Yocto
+Project 1.5 Release from the prior release.
+
+.. _migration-1.5-host-dependency-changes:
+
+Host Dependency Changes
+-----------------------
+
+The OpenEmbedded build system now has some additional requirements on
+the host system:
+
+- Python 2.7.3+
+
+- Tar 1.24+
+
+- Git 1.7.8+
+
+- Patched version of Make if you are using 3.82. Most distributions
+ that provide Make 3.82 use the patched version.
+
+If the Linux distribution you are using on your build host does not
+provide packages for these, you can install and use the Buildtools
+tarball, which provides an SDK-like environment containing them.
+
+For more information on this requirement, see the "`Required Git, tar,
+Python and gcc Versions <#required-git-tar-python-and-gcc-versions>`__"
+section.
+
+.. _migration-1.5-atom-pc-bsp:
+
+``atom-pc`` Board Support Package (BSP)
+---------------------------------------
+
+The ``atom-pc`` hardware reference BSP has been replaced by a
+``genericx86`` BSP. This BSP is not necessarily guaranteed to work on
+all x86 hardware, but it will run on a wider range of systems than the
+``atom-pc`` did.
+
+.. note::
+
+ Additionally, a
+ genericx86-64
+ BSP has been added for 64-bit Atom systems.
+
+.. _migration-1.5-bitbake:
+
+BitBake
+-------
+
+The following changes have been made that relate to BitBake:
+
+- BitBake now supports a ``_remove`` operator. The addition of this
+ operator means you will have to rename any items in recipe space
+ (functions, variables) whose names currently contain ``_remove_`` or
+ end with ``_remove`` to avoid unexpected behavior.
+
+- BitBake's global method pool has been removed. This method is not
+ particularly useful and led to clashes between recipes containing
+ functions that had the same name.
+
+- The "none" server backend has been removed. The "process" server
+ backend has been serving well as the default for a long time now.
+
+- The ``bitbake-runtask`` script has been removed.
+
+- ``${``\ :term:`P`\ ``}`` and
+ ``${``\ :term:`PF`\ ``}`` are no longer added to
+ :term:`PROVIDES` by default in ``bitbake.conf``.
+ These version-specific ``PROVIDES`` items were seldom used.
+ Attempting to use them could result in two versions being built
+ simultaneously rather than just one version due to the way BitBake
+ resolves dependencies.
+
+.. _migration-1.5-qa-warnings:
+
+QA Warnings
+-----------
+
+The following changes have been made to the package QA checks:
+
+- If you have customized :term:`ERROR_QA` or
+ :term:`WARN_QA` values in your configuration, check
+ that they contain all of the issues that you wish to be reported.
+ Previous Yocto Project versions contained a bug that meant that any
+ item not mentioned in ``ERROR_QA`` or ``WARN_QA`` would be treated as
+ a warning. Consequently, several important items were not already in
+ the default value of ``WARN_QA``. All of the possible QA checks are
+ now documented in the ":ref:`insane.bbclass <ref-classes-insane>`"
+ section.
+
+- An additional QA check has been added to check if
+ ``/usr/share/info/dir`` is being installed. Your recipe should delete
+ this file within :ref:`ref-tasks-install` if "make
+ install" is installing it.
+
+- If you are using the buildhistory class, the check for the package
+ version going backwards is now controlled using a standard QA check.
+ Thus, if you have customized your ``ERROR_QA`` or ``WARN_QA`` values
+ and still wish to have this check performed, you should add
+ "version-going-backwards" to your value for one or the other
+ variables depending on how you wish it to be handled. See the
+ documented QA checks in the
+ ":ref:`insane.bbclass <ref-classes-insane>`" section.
+
+.. _migration-1.5-directory-layout-changes:
+
+Directory Layout Changes
+------------------------
+
+The following directory changes exist:
+
+- Output SDK installer files are now named to include the image name
+ and tuning architecture through the :term:`SDK_NAME`
+ variable.
+
+- Images and related files are now installed into a directory that is
+ specific to the machine, instead of a parent directory containing
+ output files for multiple machines. The
+ :term:`DEPLOY_DIR_IMAGE` variable continues
+ to point to the directory containing images for the current
+ :term:`MACHINE` and should be used anywhere there is a
+ need to refer to this directory. The ``runqemu`` script now uses this
+ variable to find images and kernel binaries and will use BitBake to
+ determine the directory. Alternatively, you can set the
+ ``DEPLOY_DIR_IMAGE`` variable in the external environment.
+
+- When buildhistory is enabled, its output is now written under the
+ :term:`Build Directory` rather than
+ :term:`TMPDIR`. Doing so makes it easier to delete
+ ``TMPDIR`` and preserve the build history. Additionally, data for
+ produced SDKs is now split by :term:`IMAGE_NAME`.
+
+- The ``pkgdata`` directory produced as part of the packaging process
+ has been collapsed into a single machine-specific directory. This
+ directory is located under ``sysroots`` and uses a machine-specific
+ name (i.e. ``tmp/sysroots/machine/pkgdata``).
+
+.. _migration-1.5-shortened-git-srcrev-values:
+
+Shortened Git ``SRCREV`` Values
+-------------------------------
+
+BitBake will now shorten revisions from Git repositories from the normal
+40 characters down to 10 characters within :term:`SRCPV`
+for improved usability in path and file names. This change should be
+safe within contexts where these revisions are used because the chances
+of spatially close collisions is very low. Distant collisions are not a
+major issue in the way the values are used.
+
+.. _migration-1.5-image-features:
+
+``IMAGE_FEATURES``
+------------------
+
+The following changes have been made that relate to
+:term:`IMAGE_FEATURES`:
+
+- The value of ``IMAGE_FEATURES`` is now validated to ensure invalid
+ feature items are not added. Some users mistakenly add package names
+ to this variable instead of using
+ :term:`IMAGE_INSTALL` in order to have the
+ package added to the image, which does not work. This change is
+ intended to catch those kinds of situations. Valid ``IMAGE_FEATURES``
+ are drawn from ``PACKAGE_GROUP`` definitions,
+ :term:`COMPLEMENTARY_GLOB` and a new
+ "validitems" varflag on ``IMAGE_FEATURES``. The "validitems" varflag
+ change allows additional features to be added if they are not
+ provided using the previous two mechanisms.
+
+- The previously deprecated "apps-console-core" ``IMAGE_FEATURES`` item
+ is no longer supported. Add "splash" to ``IMAGE_FEATURES`` if you
+ wish to have the splash screen enabled, since this is all that
+ apps-console-core was doing.
+
+.. _migration-1.5-run:
+
+``/run``
+--------
+
+The ``/run`` directory from the Filesystem Hierarchy Standard 3.0 has
+been introduced. You can find some of the implications for this change
+`here <http://cgit.openembedded.org/openembedded-core/commit/?id=0e326280a15b0f2c4ef2ef4ec441f63f55b75873>`__.
+The change also means that recipes that install files to ``/var/run``
+must be changed. You can find a guide on how to make these changes
+`here <http://permalink.gmane.org/gmane.comp.handhelds.openembedded/58530>`__.
+
+.. _migration-1.5-removal-of-package-manager-database-within-image-recipes:
+
+Removal of Package Manager Database Within Image Recipes
+--------------------------------------------------------
+
+The image ``core-image-minimal`` no longer adds
+``remove_packaging_data_files`` to
+:term:`ROOTFS_POSTPROCESS_COMMAND`.
+This addition is now handled automatically when "package-management" is
+not in :term:`IMAGE_FEATURES`. If you have custom
+image recipes that make this addition, you should remove the lines, as
+they are not needed and might interfere with correct operation of
+postinstall scripts.
+
+.. _migration-1.5-images-now-rebuild-only-on-changes-instead-of-every-time:
+
+Images Now Rebuild Only on Changes Instead of Every Time
+--------------------------------------------------------
+
+The :ref:`ref-tasks-rootfs` and other related image
+construction tasks are no longer marked as "nostamp". Consequently, they
+will only be re-executed when their inputs have changed. Previous
+versions of the OpenEmbedded build system always rebuilt the image when
+requested rather when necessary.
+
+.. _migration-1.5-task-recipes:
+
+Task Recipes
+------------
+
+The previously deprecated ``task.bbclass`` has now been dropped. For
+recipes that previously inherited from this class, you should rename
+them from ``task-*`` to ``packagegroup-*`` and inherit packagegroup
+instead.
+
+For more information, see the
+":ref:`packagegroup.bbclass <ref-classes-packagegroup>`" section.
+
+.. _migration-1.5-busybox:
+
+BusyBox
+-------
+
+By default, we now split BusyBox into two binaries: one that is suid
+root for those components that need it, and another for the rest of the
+components. Splitting BusyBox allows for optimization that eliminates
+the ``tinylogin`` recipe as recommended by upstream. You can disable
+this split by setting
+:term:`BUSYBOX_SPLIT_SUID` to "0".
+
+.. _migration-1.5-automated-image-testing:
+
+Automated Image Testing
+-----------------------
+
+A new automated image testing framework has been added through the
+:ref:`testimage.bbclass <ref-classes-testimage*>` class. This
+framework replaces the older ``imagetest-qemu`` framework.
+
+You can learn more about performing automated image tests in the
+":ref:`dev-manual/dev-manual-common-tasks:performing automated runtime testing`"
+section in the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual.
+
+.. _migration-1.5-build-history:
+
+Build History
+-------------
+
+Following are changes to Build History:
+
+- Installed package sizes: ``installed-package-sizes.txt`` for an image
+ now records the size of the files installed by each package instead
+ of the size of each compressed package archive file.
+
+- The dependency graphs (``depends*.dot``) now use the actual package
+ names instead of replacing dashes, dots and plus signs with
+ underscores.
+
+- The ``buildhistory-diff`` and ``buildhistory-collect-srcrevs``
+ utilities have improved command-line handling. Use the ``--help``
+ option for each utility for more information on the new syntax.
+
+For more information on Build History, see the
+":ref:`dev-manual/dev-manual-common-tasks:maintaining build output quality`"
+section in the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual.
+
+.. _migration-1.5-udev:
+
+``udev``
+--------
+
+Following are changes to ``udev``:
+
+- ``udev`` no longer brings in ``udev-extraconf`` automatically through
+ :term:`RRECOMMENDS`, since this was originally
+ intended to be optional. If you need the extra rules, then add
+ ``udev-extraconf`` to your image.
+
+- ``udev`` no longer brings in ``pciutils-ids`` or ``usbutils-ids``
+ through ``RRECOMMENDS``. These are not needed by ``udev`` itself and
+ removing them saves around 350KB.
+
+.. _migration-1.5-removed-renamed-recipes:
+
+Removed and Renamed Recipes
+---------------------------
+
+- The ``linux-yocto`` 3.2 kernel has been removed.
+
+- ``libtool-nativesdk`` has been renamed to ``nativesdk-libtool``.
+
+- ``tinylogin`` has been removed. It has been replaced by a suid
+ portion of Busybox. See the "`BusyBox <#migration-1.5-busybox>`__"
+ section for more information.
+
+- ``external-python-tarball`` has been renamed to
+ ``buildtools-tarball``.
+
+- ``web-webkit`` has been removed. It has been functionally replaced by
+ ``midori``.
+
+- ``imake`` has been removed. It is no longer needed by any other
+ recipe.
+
+- ``transfig-native`` has been removed. It is no longer needed by any
+ other recipe.
+
+- ``anjuta-remote-run`` has been removed. Anjuta IDE integration has
+ not been officially supported for several releases.
+
+.. _migration-1.5-other-changes:
+
+Other Changes
+-------------
+
+Following is a list of short entries describing other changes:
+
+- ``run-postinsts``: Make this generic.
+
+- ``base-files``: Remove the unnecessary ``media/``\ xxx directories.
+
+- ``alsa-state``: Provide an empty ``asound.conf`` by default.
+
+- ``classes/image``: Ensure
+ :term:`BAD_RECOMMENDATIONS` supports
+ pre-renamed package names.
+
+- ``classes/rootfs_rpm``: Implement ``BAD_RECOMMENDATIONS`` for RPM.
+
+- ``systemd``: Remove ``systemd_unitdir`` if ``systemd`` is not in
+ :term:`DISTRO_FEATURES`.
+
+- ``systemd``: Remove ``init.d`` dir if ``systemd`` unit file is
+ present and ``sysvinit`` is not a distro feature.
+
+- ``libpam``: Deny all services for the ``OTHER`` entries.
+
+- ``image.bbclass``: Move ``runtime_mapping_rename`` to avoid conflict
+ with ``multilib``. See
+ `YOCTO #4993 <https://bugzilla.yoctoproject.org/show_bug.cgi?id=4993>`_
+ in Bugzilla for more information.
+
+- ``linux-dtb``: Use kernel build system to generate the ``dtb`` files.
+
+- ``kern-tools``: Switch from guilt to new ``kgit-s2q`` tool.
+
diff --git a/poky/documentation/ref-manual/migration-1.6.rst b/poky/documentation/ref-manual/migration-1.6.rst
new file mode 100644
index 000000000..b55be46e5
--- /dev/null
+++ b/poky/documentation/ref-manual/migration-1.6.rst
@@ -0,0 +1,417 @@
+Moving to the Yocto Project 1.6 Release
+=======================================
+
+This section provides migration information for moving to the Yocto
+Project 1.6 Release from the prior release.
+
+.. _migration-1.6-archiver-class:
+
+``archiver`` Class
+------------------
+
+The :ref:`archiver <ref-classes-archiver>` class has been rewritten
+and its configuration has been simplified. For more details on the
+source archiver, see the
+":ref:`dev-manual/dev-manual-common-tasks:maintaining open source license compliance during your product's lifecycle`"
+section in the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual.
+
+.. _migration-1.6-packaging-changes:
+
+Packaging Changes
+-----------------
+
+The following packaging changes have been made:
+
+- The ``binutils`` recipe no longer produces a ``binutils-symlinks``
+ package. ``update-alternatives`` is now used to handle the preferred
+ ``binutils`` variant on the target instead.
+
+- The tc (traffic control) utilities have been split out of the main
+ ``iproute2`` package and put into the ``iproute2-tc`` package.
+
+- The ``gtk-engines`` schemas have been moved to a dedicated
+ ``gtk-engines-schemas`` package.
+
+- The ``armv7a`` with thumb package architecture suffix has changed.
+ The suffix for these packages with the thumb optimization enabled is
+ "t2" as it should be. Use of this suffix was not the case in the 1.5
+ release. Architecture names will change within package feeds as a
+ result.
+
+.. _migration-1.6-bitbake:
+
+BitBake
+-------
+
+The following changes have been made to :term:`BitBake`.
+
+.. _migration-1.6-matching-branch-requirement-for-git-fetching:
+
+Matching Branch Requirement for Git Fetching
+~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
+
+When fetching source from a Git repository using
+:term:`SRC_URI`, BitBake will now validate the
+:term:`SRCREV` value against the branch. You can specify
+the branch using the following form: SRC_URI =
+"git://server.name/repository;branch=branchname" If you do not specify a
+branch, BitBake looks in the default "master" branch.
+
+Alternatively, if you need to bypass this check (e.g. if you are
+fetching a revision corresponding to a tag that is not on any branch),
+you can add ";nobranch=1" to the end of the URL within ``SRC_URI``.
+
+.. _migration-1.6-bitbake-deps:
+
+Python Definition substitutions
+~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
+
+BitBake had some previously deprecated Python definitions within its
+``bb`` module removed. You should use their sub-module counterparts
+instead:
+
+- ``bb.MalformedUrl``: Use ``bb.fetch.MalformedUrl``.
+
+- ``bb.encodeurl``: Use ``bb.fetch.encodeurl``.
+
+- ``bb.decodeurl``: Use ``bb.fetch.decodeurl``
+
+- ``bb.mkdirhier``: Use ``bb.utils.mkdirhier``.
+
+- ``bb.movefile``: Use ``bb.utils.movefile``.
+
+- ``bb.copyfile``: Use ``bb.utils.copyfile``.
+
+- ``bb.which``: Use ``bb.utils.which``.
+
+- ``bb.vercmp_string``: Use ``bb.utils.vercmp_string``.
+
+- ``bb.vercmp``: Use ``bb.utils.vercmp``.
+
+.. _migration-1.6-bitbake-fetcher:
+
+SVK Fetcher
+~~~~~~~~~~~
+
+The SVK fetcher has been removed from BitBake.
+
+.. _migration-1.6-bitbake-console-output:
+
+Console Output Error Redirection
+~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
+
+The BitBake console UI will now output errors to ``stderr`` instead of
+``stdout``. Consequently, if you are piping or redirecting the output of
+``bitbake`` to somewhere else, and you wish to retain the errors, you
+will need to add ``2>&1`` (or something similar) to the end of your
+``bitbake`` command line.
+
+.. _migration-1.6-task-taskname-overrides:
+
+``task-``\ taskname Overrides
+~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
+
+``task-``\ taskname overrides have been adjusted so that tasks whose
+names contain underscores have the underscores replaced by hyphens for
+the override so that they now function properly. For example, the task
+override for :ref:`ref-tasks-populate_sdk` is
+``task-populate-sdk``.
+
+.. _migration-1.6-variable-changes:
+
+Changes to Variables
+--------------------
+
+The following variables have changed. For information on the
+OpenEmbedded build system variables, see the "`Variables
+Glossary <#ref-variables-glos>`__" Chapter.
+
+.. _migration-1.6-variable-changes-TMPDIR:
+
+``TMPDIR``
+~~~~~~~~~~
+
+:term:`TMPDIR` can no longer be on an NFS mount. NFS does
+not offer full POSIX locking and inode consistency and can cause
+unexpected issues if used to store ``TMPDIR``.
+
+The check for this occurs on startup. If ``TMPDIR`` is detected on an
+NFS mount, an error occurs.
+
+.. _migration-1.6-variable-changes-PRINC:
+
+``PRINC``
+~~~~~~~~~
+
+The ``PRINC`` variable has been deprecated and triggers a warning if
+detected during a build. For :term:`PR` increments on changes,
+use the PR service instead. You can find out more about this service in
+the ":ref:`dev-manual/dev-manual-common-tasks:working with a pr service`"
+section in the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual.
+
+.. _migration-1.6-variable-changes-IMAGE_TYPES:
+
+``IMAGE_TYPES``
+~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
+
+The "sum.jffs2" option for :term:`IMAGE_TYPES` has
+been replaced by the "jffs2.sum" option, which fits the processing
+order.
+
+.. _migration-1.6-variable-changes-COPY_LIC_MANIFEST:
+
+``COPY_LIC_MANIFEST``
+~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
+
+The :term:`COPY_LIC_MANIFEST` variable must now
+be set to "1" rather than any value in order to enable it.
+
+.. _migration-1.6-variable-changes-COPY_LIC_DIRS:
+
+``COPY_LIC_DIRS``
+~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
+
+The :term:`COPY_LIC_DIRS` variable must now be set
+to "1" rather than any value in order to enable it.
+
+.. _migration-1.6-variable-changes-PACKAGE_GROUP:
+
+``PACKAGE_GROUP``
+~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
+
+The ``PACKAGE_GROUP`` variable has been renamed to
+:term:`FEATURE_PACKAGES` to more accurately
+reflect its purpose. You can still use ``PACKAGE_GROUP`` but the
+OpenEmbedded build system produces a warning message when it encounters
+the variable.
+
+.. _migration-1.6-variable-changes-variable-entry-behavior:
+
+Preprocess and Post Process Command Variable Behavior
+~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
+
+The following variables now expect a semicolon separated list of
+functions to call and not arbitrary shell commands:
+
+ - :term:`ROOTFS_PREPROCESS_COMMAND`
+ - :term:`ROOTFS_POSTPROCESS_COMMAND`
+ - :term:`SDK_POSTPROCESS_COMMAND`
+ - :term:`POPULATE_SDK_POST_TARGET_COMMAND`
+ - :term:`POPULATE_SDK_POST_HOST_COMMAND`
+ - :term:`IMAGE_POSTPROCESS_COMMAND`
+ - :term:`IMAGE_PREPROCESS_COMMAND`
+ - :term:`ROOTFS_POSTUNINSTALL_COMMAND`
+ - :term:`ROOTFS_POSTINSTALL_COMMAND`
+
+For
+migration purposes, you can simply wrap shell commands in a shell
+function and then call the function. Here is an example: ::
+
+ my_postprocess_function() {
+ echo "hello" > ${IMAGE_ROOTFS}/hello.txt
+ }
+ ROOTFS_POSTPROCESS_COMMAND += "my_postprocess_function; "
+
+.. _migration-1.6-package-test-ptest:
+
+Package Test (ptest)
+--------------------
+
+Package Tests (ptest) are built but not installed by default. For
+information on using Package Tests, see the
+":ref:`dev-manual/dev-manual-common-tasks:testing packages with ptest`"
+section in the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual. For information on the
+``ptest`` class, see the ":ref:`ptest.bbclass <ref-classes-ptest>`"
+section.
+
+.. _migration-1.6-build-changes:
+
+Build Changes
+-------------
+
+Separate build and source directories have been enabled by default for
+selected recipes where it is known to work (a whitelist) and for all
+recipes that inherit the :ref:`cmake <ref-classes-cmake>` class. In
+future releases the :ref:`autotools <ref-classes-autotools>` class
+will enable a separate build directory by default as well. Recipes
+building Autotools-based software that fails to build with a separate
+build directory should be changed to inherit from the
+:ref:`autotools-brokensep <ref-classes-autotools>` class instead of
+the ``autotools`` or ``autotools_stage``\ classes.
+
+.. _migration-1.6-building-qemu-native:
+
+``qemu-native``
+---------------
+
+``qemu-native`` now builds without SDL-based graphical output support by
+default. The following additional lines are needed in your
+``local.conf`` to enable it:
+::
+
+ PACKAGECONFIG_pn-qemu-native = "sdl"
+ ASSUME_PROVIDED += "libsdl-native"
+
+.. note::
+
+ The default
+ local.conf
+ contains these statements. Consequently, if you are building a
+ headless system and using a default
+ local.conf
+ file, you will need comment these two lines out.
+
+.. _migration-1.6-core-image-basic:
+
+``core-image-basic``
+--------------------
+
+``core-image-basic`` has been renamed to ``core-image-full-cmdline``.
+
+In addition to ``core-image-basic`` being renamed,
+``packagegroup-core-basic`` has been renamed to
+``packagegroup-core-full-cmdline`` to match.
+
+.. _migration-1.6-licensing:
+
+Licensing
+---------
+
+The top-level ``LICENSE`` file has been changed to better describe the
+license of the various components of :term:`OpenEmbedded-Core (OE-Core)`. However,
+the licensing itself remains unchanged.
+
+Normally, this change would not cause any side-effects. However, some
+recipes point to this file within
+:term:`LIC_FILES_CHKSUM` (as
+``${COREBASE}/LICENSE``) and thus the accompanying checksum must be
+changed from 3f40d7994397109285ec7b81fdeb3b58 to
+4d92cd373abda3937c2bc47fbc49d690. A better alternative is to have
+``LIC_FILES_CHKSUM`` point to a file describing the license that is
+distributed with the source that the recipe is building, if possible,
+rather than pointing to ``${COREBASE}/LICENSE``.
+
+.. _migration-1.6-cflags-options:
+
+``CFLAGS`` Options
+------------------
+
+The "-fpermissive" option has been removed from the default
+:term:`CFLAGS` value. You need to take action on
+individual recipes that fail when building with this option. You need to
+either patch the recipes to fix the issues reported by the compiler, or
+you need to add "-fpermissive" to ``CFLAGS`` in the recipes.
+
+.. _migration-1.6-custom-images:
+
+Custom Image Output Types
+-------------------------
+
+Custom image output types, as selected using
+:term:`IMAGE_FSTYPES`, must declare their
+dependencies on other image types (if any) using a new
+:term:`IMAGE_TYPEDEP` variable.
+
+.. _migration-1.6-do-package-write-task:
+
+Tasks
+-----
+
+The ``do_package_write`` task has been removed. The task is no longer
+needed.
+
+.. _migration-1.6-update-alternatives-provider:
+
+``update-alternative`` Provider
+-------------------------------
+
+The default ``update-alternatives`` provider has been changed from
+``opkg`` to ``opkg-utils``. This change resolves some troublesome
+circular dependencies. The runtime package has also been renamed from
+``update-alternatives-cworth`` to ``update-alternatives-opkg``.
+
+.. _migration-1.6-virtclass-overrides:
+
+``virtclass`` Overrides
+-----------------------
+
+The ``virtclass`` overrides are now deprecated. Use the equivalent class
+overrides instead (e.g. ``virtclass-native`` becomes ``class-native``.)
+
+.. _migration-1.6-removed-renamed-recipes:
+
+Removed and Renamed Recipes
+---------------------------
+
+The following recipes have been removed:
+
+- ``packagegroup-toolset-native`` - This recipe is largely unused.
+
+- ``linux-yocto-3.8`` - Support for the Linux yocto 3.8 kernel has been
+ dropped. Support for the 3.10 and 3.14 kernels have been added with
+ the ``linux-yocto-3.10`` and ``linux-yocto-3.14`` recipes.
+
+- ``ocf-linux`` - This recipe has been functionally replaced using
+ ``cryptodev-linux``.
+
+- ``genext2fs`` - ``genext2fs`` is no longer used by the build system
+ and is unmaintained upstream.
+
+- ``js`` - This provided an ancient version of Mozilla's javascript
+ engine that is no longer needed.
+
+- ``zaurusd`` - The recipe has been moved to the ``meta-handheld``
+ layer.
+
+- ``eglibc 2.17`` - Replaced by the ``eglibc 2.19`` recipe.
+
+- ``gcc 4.7.2`` - Replaced by the now stable ``gcc 4.8.2``.
+
+- ``external-sourcery-toolchain`` - this recipe is now maintained in
+ the ``meta-sourcery`` layer.
+
+- ``linux-libc-headers-yocto 3.4+git`` - Now using version 3.10 of the
+ ``linux-libc-headers`` by default.
+
+- ``meta-toolchain-gmae`` - This recipe is obsolete.
+
+- ``packagegroup-core-sdk-gmae`` - This recipe is obsolete.
+
+- ``packagegroup-core-standalone-gmae-sdk-target`` - This recipe is
+ obsolete.
+
+.. _migration-1.6-removed-classes:
+
+Removed Classes
+---------------
+
+The following classes have become obsolete and have been removed:
+
+- ``module_strip``
+
+- ``pkg_metainfo``
+
+- ``pkg_distribute``
+
+- ``image-empty``
+
+.. _migration-1.6-reference-bsps:
+
+Reference Board Support Packages (BSPs)
+---------------------------------------
+
+The following reference BSPs changes occurred:
+
+- The BeagleBoard (``beagleboard``) ARM reference hardware has been
+ replaced by the BeagleBone (``beaglebone``) hardware.
+
+- The RouterStation Pro (``routerstationpro``) MIPS reference hardware
+ has been replaced by the EdgeRouter Lite (``edgerouter``) hardware.
+
+The previous reference BSPs for the ``beagleboard`` and
+``routerstationpro`` machines are still available in a new
+``meta-yocto-bsp-old`` layer in the
+:yocto_git:`Source Repositories <>` at
+http://git.yoctoproject.org/cgit/cgit.cgi/meta-yocto-bsp-old/.
+
+
diff --git a/poky/documentation/ref-manual/migration-1.7.rst b/poky/documentation/ref-manual/migration-1.7.rst
new file mode 100644
index 000000000..82fd37d3a
--- /dev/null
+++ b/poky/documentation/ref-manual/migration-1.7.rst
@@ -0,0 +1,225 @@
+Moving to the Yocto Project 1.7 Release
+=======================================
+
+This section provides migration information for moving to the Yocto
+Project 1.7 Release from the prior release.
+
+.. _migration-1.7-changes-to-setting-qemu-packageconfig-options:
+
+Changes to Setting QEMU ``PACKAGECONFIG`` Options in ``local.conf``
+-------------------------------------------------------------------
+
+The QEMU recipe now uses a number of
+:term:`PACKAGECONFIG` options to enable various
+optional features. The method used to set defaults for these options
+means that existing ``local.conf`` files will need to be be modified to
+append to ``PACKAGECONFIG`` for ``qemu-native`` and ``nativesdk-qemu``
+instead of setting it. In other words, to enable graphical output for
+QEMU, you should now have these lines in ``local.conf``:
+::
+
+ PACKAGECONFIG_append_pn-qemu-native = " sdl"
+ PACKAGECONFIG_append_pn-nativesdk-qemu = " sdl"
+
+.. _migration-1.7-minimum-git-version:
+
+Minimum Git version
+-------------------
+
+The minimum :ref:`overview-manual/overview-manual-development-environment:git`
+version required on the
+build host is now 1.7.8 because the ``--list`` option is now required by
+BitBake's Git fetcher. As always, if your host distribution does not
+provide a version of Git that meets this requirement, you can use the
+``buildtools-tarball`` that does. See the "`Required Git, tar, Python
+and gcc Versions <#required-git-tar-python-and-gcc-versions>`__" section
+for more information.
+
+.. _migration-1.7-autotools-class-changes:
+
+Autotools Class Changes
+-----------------------
+
+The following :ref:`autotools <ref-classes-autotools>` class changes
+occurred:
+
+- *A separate build directory is now used by default:* The
+ ``autotools`` class has been changed to use a directory for building
+ (:term:`B`), which is separate from the source directory
+ (:term:`S`). This is commonly referred to as ``B != S``, or
+ an out-of-tree build.
+
+ If the software being built is already capable of building in a
+ directory separate from the source, you do not need to do anything.
+ However, if the software is not capable of being built in this
+ manner, you will need to either patch the software so that it can
+ build separately, or you will need to change the recipe to inherit
+ the :ref:`autotools-brokensep <ref-classes-autotools>` class
+ instead of the ``autotools`` or ``autotools_stage`` classes.
+
+- The ``--foreign`` option is no longer passed to ``automake`` when
+ running ``autoconf``: This option tells ``automake`` that a
+ particular software package does not follow the GNU standards and
+ therefore should not be expected to distribute certain files such as
+ ``ChangeLog``, ``AUTHORS``, and so forth. Because the majority of
+ upstream software packages already tell ``automake`` to enable
+ foreign mode themselves, the option is mostly superfluous. However,
+ some recipes will need patches for this change. You can easily make
+ the change by patching ``configure.ac`` so that it passes "foreign"
+ to ``AM_INIT_AUTOMAKE()``. See `this
+ commit <http://cgit.openembedded.org/openembedded-core/commit/?id=01943188f85ce6411717fb5bf702d609f55813f2>`__
+ for an example showing how to make the patch.
+
+.. _migration-1.7-binary-configuration-scripts-disabled:
+
+Binary Configuration Scripts Disabled
+-------------------------------------
+
+Some of the core recipes that package binary configuration scripts now
+disable the scripts due to the scripts previously requiring error-prone
+path substitution. Software that links against these libraries using
+these scripts should use the much more robust ``pkg-config`` instead.
+The list of recipes changed in this version (and their configuration
+scripts) is as follows:
+::
+
+ directfb (directfb-config)
+ freetype (freetype-config)
+ gpgme (gpgme-config)
+ libassuan (libassuan-config)
+ libcroco (croco-6.0-config)
+ libgcrypt (libgcrypt-config)
+ libgpg-error (gpg-error-config)
+ libksba (ksba-config)
+ libpcap (pcap-config)
+ libpcre (pcre-config)
+ libpng (libpng-config, libpng16-config)
+ libsdl (sdl-config)
+ libusb-compat (libusb-config)
+ libxml2 (xml2-config)
+ libxslt (xslt-config)
+ ncurses (ncurses-config)
+ neon (neon-config)
+ npth (npth-config)
+ pth (pth-config)
+ taglib (taglib-config)
+
+Additionally, support for ``pkg-config`` has been added to some recipes in the
+previous list in the rare cases where the upstream software package does
+not already provide it.
+
+.. _migration-1.7-glibc-replaces-eglibc:
+
+``eglibc 2.19`` Replaced with ``glibc 2.20``
+--------------------------------------------
+
+Because ``eglibc`` and ``glibc`` were already fairly close, this
+replacement should not require any significant changes to other software
+that links to ``eglibc``. However, there were a number of minor changes
+in ``glibc 2.20`` upstream that could require patching some software
+(e.g. the removal of the ``_BSD_SOURCE`` feature test macro).
+
+``glibc 2.20`` requires version 2.6.32 or greater of the Linux kernel.
+Thus, older kernels will no longer be usable in conjunction with it.
+
+For full details on the changes in ``glibc 2.20``, see the upstream
+release notes
+`here <https://sourceware.org/ml/libc-alpha/2014-09/msg00088.html>`__.
+
+.. _migration-1.7-kernel-module-autoloading:
+
+Kernel Module Autoloading
+-------------------------
+
+The :term:`module_autoload_* <module_autoload>` variable is now
+deprecated and a new
+:term:`KERNEL_MODULE_AUTOLOAD` variable
+should be used instead. Also, :term:`module_conf_* <module_conf>`
+must now be used in conjunction with a new
+:term:`KERNEL_MODULE_PROBECONF` variable.
+The new variables no longer require you to specify the module name as
+part of the variable name. This change not only simplifies usage but
+also allows the values of these variables to be appropriately
+incorporated into task signatures and thus trigger the appropriate tasks
+to re-execute when changed. You should replace any references to
+``module_autoload_*`` with ``KERNEL_MODULE_AUTOLOAD``, and add any
+modules for which ``module_conf_*`` is specified to
+``KERNEL_MODULE_PROBECONF``.
+
+.. _migration-1.7-qa-check-changes:
+
+QA Check Changes
+----------------
+
+The following changes have occurred to the QA check process:
+
+- Additional QA checks ``file-rdeps`` and ``build-deps`` have been
+ added in order to verify that file dependencies are satisfied (e.g.
+ package contains a script requiring ``/bin/bash``) and build-time
+ dependencies are declared, respectively. For more information, please
+ see the "`QA Error and Warning Messages <#ref-qa-checks>`__" chapter.
+
+- Package QA checks are now performed during a new
+ :ref:`ref-tasks-package_qa` task rather than being
+ part of the :ref:`ref-tasks-package` task. This allows
+ more parallel execution. This change is unlikely to be an issue
+ except for highly customized recipes that disable packaging tasks
+ themselves by marking them as ``noexec``. For those packages, you
+ will need to disable the ``do_package_qa`` task as well.
+
+- Files being overwritten during the
+ :ref:`ref-tasks-populate_sysroot` task now
+ trigger an error instead of a warning. Recipes should not be
+ overwriting files written to the sysroot by other recipes. If you
+ have these types of recipes, you need to alter them so that they do
+ not overwrite these files.
+
+ You might now receive this error after changes in configuration or
+ metadata resulting in orphaned files being left in the sysroot. If
+ you do receive this error, the way to resolve the issue is to delete
+ your :term:`TMPDIR` or to move it out of the way and
+ then re-start the build. Anything that has been fully built up to
+ that point and does not need rebuilding will be restored from the
+ shared state cache and the rest of the build will be able to proceed
+ as normal.
+
+.. _migration-1.7-removed-recipes:
+
+Removed Recipes
+---------------
+
+The following recipes have been removed:
+
+- ``x-load``: This recipe has been superseded by U-boot SPL for all
+ Cortex-based TI SoCs. For legacy boards, the ``meta-ti`` layer, which
+ contains a maintained recipe, should be used instead.
+
+- ``ubootchart``: This recipe is obsolete. A ``bootchart2`` recipe has
+ been added to functionally replace it.
+
+- ``linux-yocto 3.4``: Support for the linux-yocto 3.4 kernel has been
+ dropped. Support for the 3.10 and 3.14 kernels remains, while support
+ for version 3.17 has been added.
+
+- ``eglibc`` has been removed in favor of ``glibc``. See the
+ "```eglibc 2.19`` Replaced with
+ ``glibc 2.20`` <#migration-1.7-glibc-replaces-eglibc>`__" section for
+ more information.
+
+.. _migration-1.7-miscellaneous-changes:
+
+Miscellaneous Changes
+---------------------
+
+The following miscellaneous change occurred:
+
+- The build history feature now writes ``build-id.txt`` instead of
+ ``build-id``. Additionally, ``build-id.txt`` now contains the full
+ build header as printed by BitBake upon starting the build. You
+ should manually remove old "build-id" files from your existing build
+ history repositories to avoid confusion. For information on the build
+ history feature, see the
+ ":ref:`dev-manual/dev-manual-common-tasks:maintaining build output quality`"
+ section in the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual.
+
+
diff --git a/poky/documentation/ref-manual/migration-1.8.rst b/poky/documentation/ref-manual/migration-1.8.rst
new file mode 100644
index 000000000..d601e6b63
--- /dev/null
+++ b/poky/documentation/ref-manual/migration-1.8.rst
@@ -0,0 +1,183 @@
+Moving to the Yocto Project 1.8 Release
+=======================================
+
+This section provides migration information for moving to the Yocto
+Project 1.8 Release from the prior release.
+
+.. _migration-1.8-removed-recipes:
+
+Removed Recipes
+---------------
+
+The following recipes have been removed:
+
+- ``owl-video``: Functionality replaced by ``gst-player``.
+
+- ``gaku``: Functionality replaced by ``gst-player``.
+
+- ``gnome-desktop``: This recipe is now available in ``meta-gnome`` and
+ is no longer needed.
+
+- ``gsettings-desktop-schemas``: This recipe is now available in
+ ``meta-gnome`` and is no longer needed.
+
+- ``python-argparse``: The ``argparse`` module is already provided in
+ the default Python distribution in a package named
+ ``python-argparse``. Consequently, the separate ``python-argparse``
+ recipe is no longer needed.
+
+- ``telepathy-python, libtelepathy, telepathy-glib, telepathy-idle, telepathy-mission-control``:
+ All these recipes have moved to ``meta-oe`` and are consequently no
+ longer needed by any recipes in OpenEmbedded-Core.
+
+- ``linux-yocto_3.10`` and ``linux-yocto_3.17``: Support for the
+ linux-yocto 3.10 and 3.17 kernels has been dropped. Support for the
+ 3.14 kernel remains, while support for 3.19 kernel has been added.
+
+- ``poky-feed-config-opkg``: This recipe has become obsolete and is no
+ longer needed. Use ``distro-feed-config`` from ``meta-oe`` instead.
+
+- ``libav 0.8.x``: ``libav 9.x`` is now used.
+
+- ``sed-native``: No longer needed. A working version of ``sed`` is
+ expected to be provided by the host distribution.
+
+.. _migration-1.8-bluez:
+
+BlueZ 4.x / 5.x Selection
+-------------------------
+
+Proper built-in support for selecting BlueZ 5.x in preference to the
+default of 4.x now exists. To use BlueZ 5.x, simply add "bluez5" to your
+:term:`DISTRO_FEATURES` value. If you had
+previously added append files (``*.bbappend``) to make this selection,
+you can now remove them.
+
+Additionally, a ``bluetooth`` class has been added to make selection of
+the appropriate bluetooth support within a recipe a little easier. If
+you wish to make use of this class in a recipe, add something such as
+the following: ::
+
+ inherit bluetooth
+ PACKAGECONFIG ??= "${@bb.utils.contains('DISTRO_FEATURES', 'bluetooth', '${BLUEZ}', '', d)}"
+ PACKAGECONFIG[bluez4] = "--enable-bluetooth,--disable-bluetooth,bluez4"
+ PACKAGECONFIG[bluez5] = "--enable-bluez5,--disable-bluez5,bluez5"
+
+.. _migration-1.8-kernel-build-changes:
+
+Kernel Build Changes
+--------------------
+
+The kernel build process was changed to place the source in a common
+shared work area and to place build artifacts separately in the source
+code tree. In theory, migration paths have been provided for most common
+usages in kernel recipes but this might not work in all cases. In
+particular, users need to ensure that ``${S}`` (source files) and
+``${B}`` (build artifacts) are used correctly in functions such as
+:ref:`ref-tasks-configure` and
+:ref:`ref-tasks-install`. For kernel recipes that do not
+inherit from ``kernel-yocto`` or include ``linux-yocto.inc``, you might
+wish to refer to the ``linux.inc`` file in the ``meta-oe`` layer for the
+kinds of changes you need to make. For reference, here is the
+`commit <http://cgit.openembedded.org/meta-openembedded/commit/meta-oe/recipes-kernel/linux/linux.inc?id=fc7132ede27ac67669448d3d2845ce7d46c6a1ee>`__
+where the ``linux.inc`` file in ``meta-oe`` was updated.
+
+Recipes that rely on the kernel source code and do not inherit the
+module classes might need to add explicit dependencies on the
+``do_shared_workdir`` kernel task, for example: ::
+
+ do_configure[depends] += "virtual/kernel:do_shared_workdir"
+
+.. _migration-1.8-ssl:
+
+SSL 3.0 is Now Disabled in OpenSSL
+----------------------------------
+
+SSL 3.0 is now disabled when building OpenSSL. Disabling SSL 3.0 avoids
+any lingering instances of the POODLE vulnerability. If you feel you
+must re-enable SSL 3.0, then you can add an append file (``*.bbappend``)
+for the ``openssl`` recipe to remove "-no-ssl3" from
+:term:`EXTRA_OECONF`.
+
+.. _migration-1.8-default-sysroot-poisoning:
+
+Default Sysroot Poisoning
+-------------------------
+
+``gcc's`` default sysroot and include directories are now "poisoned". In
+other words, the sysroot and include directories are being redirected to
+a non-existent location in order to catch when host directories are
+being used due to the correct options not being passed. This poisoning
+applies both to the cross-compiler used within the build and to the
+cross-compiler produced in the SDK.
+
+If this change causes something in the build to fail, it almost
+certainly means the various compiler flags and commands are not being
+passed correctly to the underlying piece of software. In such cases, you
+need to take corrective steps.
+
+.. _migration-1.8-rebuild-improvements:
+
+Rebuild Improvements
+--------------------
+
+Changes have been made to the :ref:`base <ref-classes-base>`,
+:ref:`autotools <ref-classes-autotools>`, and
+:ref:`cmake <ref-classes-cmake>` classes to clean out generated files
+when the :ref:`ref-tasks-configure` task needs to be
+re-executed.
+
+One of the improvements is to attempt to run "make clean" during the
+``do_configure`` task if a ``Makefile`` exists. Some software packages
+do not provide a working clean target within their make files. If you
+have such recipes, you need to set
+:term:`CLEANBROKEN` to "1" within the recipe, for example: ::
+
+ CLEANBROKEN = "1"
+
+.. _migration-1.8-qa-check-and-validation-changes:
+
+QA Check and Validation Changes
+-------------------------------
+
+The following QA Check and Validation Changes have occurred:
+
+- Usage of ``PRINC`` previously triggered a warning. It now triggers an
+ error. You should remove any remaining usage of ``PRINC`` in any
+ recipe or append file.
+
+- An additional QA check has been added to detect usage of ``${D}`` in
+ :term:`FILES` values where :term:`D` values
+ should not be used at all. The same check ensures that ``$D`` is used
+ in ``pkg_preinst/pkg_postinst/pkg_prerm/pkg_postrm`` functions
+ instead of ``${D}``.
+
+- :term:`S` now needs to be set to a valid value within a
+ recipe. If ``S`` is not set in the recipe, the directory is not
+ automatically created. If ``S`` does not point to a directory that
+ exists at the time the :ref:`ref-tasks-unpack` task
+ finishes, a warning will be shown.
+
+- :term:`LICENSE` is now validated for correct
+ formatting of multiple licenses. If the format is invalid (e.g.
+ multiple licenses are specified with no operators to specify how the
+ multiple licenses interact), then a warning will be shown.
+
+.. _migration-1.8-miscellaneous-changes:
+
+Miscellaneous Changes
+---------------------
+
+The following miscellaneous changes have occurred:
+
+- The ``send-error-report`` script now expects a "-s" option to be
+ specified before the server address. This assumes a server address is
+ being specified.
+
+- The ``oe-pkgdata-util`` script now expects a "-p" option to be
+ specified before the ``pkgdata`` directory, which is now optional. If
+ the ``pkgdata`` directory is not specified, the script will run
+ BitBake to query :term:`PKGDATA_DIR` from the
+ build environment.
+
+
diff --git a/poky/documentation/ref-manual/migration-2.0.rst b/poky/documentation/ref-manual/migration-2.0.rst
new file mode 100644
index 000000000..570486ba0
--- /dev/null
+++ b/poky/documentation/ref-manual/migration-2.0.rst
@@ -0,0 +1,281 @@
+Moving to the Yocto Project 2.0 Release
+=======================================
+
+This section provides migration information for moving to the Yocto
+Project 2.0 Release from the prior release.
+
+.. _migration-2.0-gcc-5:
+
+GCC 5
+-----
+
+The default compiler is now GCC 5.2. This change has required fixes for
+compilation errors in a number of other recipes.
+
+One important example is a fix for when the Linux kernel freezes at boot
+time on ARM when built with GCC 5. If you are using your own kernel
+recipe or source tree and building for ARM, you will likely need to
+apply this
+`patch <https://git.kernel.org/cgit/linux/kernel/git/torvalds/linux.git/commit?id=a077224fd35b2f7fbc93f14cf67074fc792fbac2>`__.
+The standard ``linux-yocto`` kernel source tree already has a workaround
+for the same issue.
+
+For further details, see https://gcc.gnu.org/gcc-5/changes.html
+and the porting guide at
+https://gcc.gnu.org/gcc-5/porting_to.html.
+
+Alternatively, you can switch back to GCC 4.9 or 4.8 by setting
+``GCCVERSION`` in your configuration, as follows:
+::
+
+ GCCVERSION = "4.9%"
+
+.. _migration-2.0-Gstreamer-0.10-removed:
+
+Gstreamer 0.10 Removed
+----------------------
+
+Gstreamer 0.10 has been removed in favor of Gstreamer 1.x. As part of
+the change, recipes for Gstreamer 0.10 and related software are now
+located in ``meta-multimedia``. This change results in Qt4 having Phonon
+and Gstreamer support in QtWebkit disabled by default.
+
+.. _migration-2.0-removed-recipes:
+
+Removed Recipes
+---------------
+
+The following recipes have been moved or removed:
+
+- ``bluez4``: The recipe is obsolete and has been moved due to
+ ``bluez5`` becoming fully integrated. The ``bluez4`` recipe now
+ resides in ``meta-oe``.
+
+- ``gamin``: The recipe is obsolete and has been removed.
+
+- ``gnome-icon-theme``: The recipe's functionally has been replaced by
+ ``adwaita-icon-theme``.
+
+- Gstreamer 0.10 Recipes: Recipes for Gstreamer 0.10 have been removed
+ in favor of the recipes for Gstreamer 1.x.
+
+- ``insserv``: The recipe is obsolete and has been removed.
+
+- ``libunique``: The recipe is no longer used and has been moved to
+ ``meta-oe``.
+
+- ``midori``: The recipe's functionally has been replaced by
+ ``epiphany``.
+
+- ``python-gst``: The recipe is obsolete and has been removed since it
+ only contains bindings for Gstreamer 0.10.
+
+- ``qt-mobility``: The recipe is obsolete and has been removed since it
+ requires ``Gstreamer 0.10``, which has been replaced.
+
+- ``subversion``: All 1.6.x versions of this recipe have been removed.
+
+- ``webkit-gtk``: The older 1.8.3 version of this recipe has been
+ removed in favor of ``webkitgtk``.
+
+.. _migration-2.0-bitbake-datastore-improvements:
+
+BitBake datastore improvements
+------------------------------
+
+The method by which BitBake's datastore handles overrides has changed.
+Overrides are now applied dynamically and ``bb.data.update_data()`` is
+now a no-op. Thus, ``bb.data.update_data()`` is no longer required in
+order to apply the correct overrides. In practice, this change is
+unlikely to require any changes to Metadata. However, these minor
+changes in behavior exist:
+
+- All potential overrides are now visible in the variable history as
+ seen when you run the following:
+ ::
+
+ $ bitbake -e
+
+- ``d.delVar('``\ VARNAME\ ``')`` and
+ ``d.setVar('``\ VARNAME\ ``', None)`` result in the variable and all
+ of its overrides being cleared out. Before the change, only the
+ non-overridden values were cleared.
+
+.. _migration-2.0-shell-message-function-changes:
+
+Shell Message Function Changes
+------------------------------
+
+The shell versions of the BitBake message functions (i.e. ``bbdebug``,
+``bbnote``, ``bbwarn``, ``bbplain``, ``bberror``, and ``bbfatal``) are
+now connected through to their BitBake equivalents ``bb.debug()``,
+``bb.note()``, ``bb.warn()``, ``bb.plain()``, ``bb.error()``, and
+``bb.fatal()``, respectively. Thus, those message functions that you
+would expect to be printed by the BitBake UI are now actually printed.
+In practice, this change means two things:
+
+- If you now see messages on the console that you did not previously
+ see as a result of this change, you might need to clean up the calls
+ to ``bbwarn``, ``bberror``, and so forth. Or, you might want to
+ simply remove the calls.
+
+- The ``bbfatal`` message function now suppresses the full error log in
+ the UI, which means any calls to ``bbfatal`` where you still wish to
+ see the full error log should be replaced by ``die`` or
+ ``bbfatal_log``.
+
+.. _migration-2.0-extra-development-debug-package-cleanup:
+
+Extra Development/Debug Package Cleanup
+---------------------------------------
+
+The following recipes have had extra ``dev/dbg`` packages removed:
+
+- ``acl``
+
+- ``apmd``
+
+- ``aspell``
+
+- ``attr``
+
+- ``augeas``
+
+- ``bzip2``
+
+- ``cogl``
+
+- ``curl``
+
+- ``elfutils``
+
+- ``gcc-target``
+
+- ``libgcc``
+
+- ``libtool``
+
+- ``libxmu``
+
+- ``opkg``
+
+- ``pciutils``
+
+- ``rpm``
+
+- ``sysfsutils``
+
+- ``tiff``
+
+- ``xz``
+
+All of the above recipes now conform to the standard packaging scheme
+where a single ``-dev``, ``-dbg``, and ``-staticdev`` package exists per
+recipe.
+
+.. _migration-2.0-recipe-maintenance-tracking-data-moved-to-oe-core:
+
+Recipe Maintenance Tracking Data Moved to OE-Core
+-------------------------------------------------
+
+Maintenance tracking data for recipes that was previously part of
+``meta-yocto`` has been moved to :term:`OpenEmbedded-Core (OE-Core)`. The change
+includes ``package_regex.inc`` and ``distro_alias.inc``, which are
+typically enabled when using the ``distrodata`` class. Additionally, the
+contents of ``upstream_tracking.inc`` has now been split out to the
+relevant recipes.
+
+.. _migration-2.0-automatic-stale-sysroot-file-cleanup:
+
+Automatic Stale Sysroot File Cleanup
+------------------------------------
+
+Stale files from recipes that no longer exist in the current
+configuration are now automatically removed from sysroot as well as
+removed from any other place managed by shared state. This automatic
+cleanup means that the build system now properly handles situations such
+as renaming the build system side of recipes, removal of layers from
+``bblayers.conf``, and :term:`DISTRO_FEATURES`
+changes.
+
+Additionally, work directories for old versions of recipes are now
+pruned. If you wish to disable pruning old work directories, you can set
+the following variable in your configuration:
+::
+
+ SSTATE_PRUNE_OBSOLETEWORKDIR = "0"
+
+.. _migration-2.0-linux-yocto-kernel-metadata-repository-now-split-from-source:
+
+``linux-yocto`` Kernel Metadata Repository Now Split from Source
+----------------------------------------------------------------
+
+The ``linux-yocto`` tree has up to now been a combined set of kernel
+changes and configuration (meta) data carried in a single tree. While
+this format is effective at keeping kernel configuration and source
+modifications synchronized, it is not always obvious to developers how
+to manipulate the Metadata as compared to the source.
+
+Metadata processing has now been removed from the
+:ref:`kernel-yocto <ref-classes-kernel-yocto>` class and the external
+Metadata repository ``yocto-kernel-cache``, which has always been used
+to seed the ``linux-yocto`` "meta" branch. This separate ``linux-yocto``
+cache repository is now the primary location for this data. Due to this
+change, ``linux-yocto`` is no longer able to process combined trees.
+Thus, if you need to have your own combined kernel repository, you must
+do the split there as well and update your recipes accordingly. See the
+``meta/recipes-kernel/linux/linux-yocto_4.1.bb`` recipe for an example.
+
+.. _migration-2.0-additional-qa-checks:
+
+Additional QA checks
+--------------------
+
+The following QA checks have been added:
+
+- Added a "host-user-contaminated" check for ownership issues for
+ packaged files outside of ``/home``. The check looks for files that
+ are incorrectly owned by the user that ran BitBake instead of owned
+ by a valid user in the target system.
+
+- Added an "invalid-chars" check for invalid (non-UTF8) characters in
+ recipe metadata variable values (i.e.
+ :term:`DESCRIPTION`,
+ :term:`SUMMARY`, :term:`LICENSE`, and
+ :term:`SECTION`). Some package managers do not support
+ these characters.
+
+- Added an "invalid-packageconfig" check for any options specified in
+ :term:`PACKAGECONFIG` that do not match any
+ ``PACKAGECONFIG`` option defined for the recipe.
+
+.. _migration-2.0-miscellaneous:
+
+Miscellaneous Changes
+---------------------
+
+These additional changes exist:
+
+- ``gtk-update-icon-cache`` has been renamed to ``gtk-icon-utils``.
+
+- The ``tools-profile`` :term:`IMAGE_FEATURES`
+ item as well as its corresponding packagegroup and
+ ``packagegroup-core-tools-profile`` no longer bring in ``oprofile``.
+ Bringing in ``oprofile`` was originally added to aid compilation on
+ resource-constrained targets. However, this aid has not been widely
+ used and is not likely to be used going forward due to the more
+ powerful target platforms and the existence of better
+ cross-compilation tools.
+
+- The :term:`IMAGE_FSTYPES` variable's default
+ value now specifies ``ext4`` instead of ``ext3``.
+
+- All support for the ``PRINC`` variable has been removed.
+
+- The ``packagegroup-core-full-cmdline`` packagegroup no longer brings
+ in ``lighttpd`` due to the fact that bringing in ``lighttpd`` is not
+ really in line with the packagegroup's purpose, which is to add full
+ versions of command-line tools that by default are provided by
+ ``busybox``.
+
+
diff --git a/poky/documentation/ref-manual/migration-2.1.rst b/poky/documentation/ref-manual/migration-2.1.rst
new file mode 100644
index 000000000..a1fd3ea81
--- /dev/null
+++ b/poky/documentation/ref-manual/migration-2.1.rst
@@ -0,0 +1,434 @@
+Moving to the Yocto Project 2.1 Release
+=======================================
+
+This section provides migration information for moving to the Yocto
+Project 2.1 Release from the prior release.
+
+.. _migration-2.1-variable-expansion-in-python-functions:
+
+Variable Expansion in Python Functions
+--------------------------------------
+
+Variable expressions, such as ``${``\ VARNAME\ ``}`` no longer expand
+automatically within Python functions. Suppressing expansion was done to
+allow Python functions to construct shell scripts or other code for
+situations in which you do not want such expressions expanded. For any
+existing code that relies on these expansions, you need to change the
+expansions to expand the value of individual variables through
+``d.getVar()``. To alternatively expand more complex expressions, use
+``d.expand()``.
+
+.. _migration-2.1-overrides-must-now-be-lower-case:
+
+Overrides Must Now be Lower-Case
+--------------------------------
+
+The convention for overrides has always been for them to be lower-case
+characters. This practice is now a requirement as BitBake's datastore
+now assumes lower-case characters in order to give a slight performance
+boost during parsing. In practical terms, this requirement means that
+anything that ends up in :term:`OVERRIDES` must now
+appear in lower-case characters (e.g. values for ``MACHINE``,
+``TARGET_ARCH``, ``DISTRO``, and also recipe names if
+``_pn-``\ recipename overrides are to be effective).
+
+.. _migration-2.1-expand-parameter-to-getvar-and-getvarflag-now-mandatory:
+
+Expand Parameter to ``getVar()`` and ``getVarFlag()`` is Now Mandatory
+----------------------------------------------------------------------
+
+The expand parameter to ``getVar()`` and ``getVarFlag()`` previously
+defaulted to False if not specified. Now, however, no default exists so
+one must be specified. You must change any ``getVar()`` calls that do
+not specify the final expand parameter to calls that do specify the
+parameter. You can run the following ``sed`` command at the base of a
+layer to make this change:
+::
+
+ sed -e 's:\(\.getVar([^,()]*\)):\1, False):g' -i `grep -ril getVar *`
+ sed -e 's:\(\.getVarFlag([^,()]*,[^,()]*\)):\1, False):g' -i `grep -ril getVarFlag *`
+
+.. note::
+
+ The reason for this change is that it prepares the way for changing
+ the default to True in a future Yocto Project release. This future
+ change is a much more sensible default than False. However, the
+ change needs to be made gradually as a sudden change of the default
+ would potentially cause side-effects that would be difficult to
+ detect.
+
+.. _migration-2.1-makefile-environment-changes:
+
+Makefile Environment Changes
+----------------------------
+
+:term:`EXTRA_OEMAKE` now defaults to "" instead of
+"-e MAKEFLAGS=". Setting ``EXTRA_OEMAKE`` to "-e MAKEFLAGS=" by default
+was a historical accident that has required many classes (e.g.
+``autotools``, ``module``) and recipes to override this default in order
+to work with sensible build systems. When upgrading to the release, you
+must edit any recipe that relies upon this old default by either setting
+``EXTRA_OEMAKE`` back to "-e MAKEFLAGS=" or by explicitly setting any
+required variable value overrides using ``EXTRA_OEMAKE``, which is
+typically only needed when a Makefile sets a default value for a
+variable that is inappropriate for cross-compilation using the "="
+operator rather than the "?=" operator.
+
+.. _migration-2.1-libexecdir-reverted-to-prefix-libexec:
+
+``libexecdir`` Reverted to ``${prefix}/libexec``
+------------------------------------------------
+
+The use of ``${libdir}/${BPN}`` as ``libexecdir`` is different as
+compared to all other mainstream distributions, which either uses
+``${prefix}/libexec`` or ``${libdir}``. The use is also contrary to the
+GNU Coding Standards (i.e.
+https://www.gnu.org/prep/standards/html_node/Directory-Variables.html)
+that suggest ``${prefix}/libexec`` and also notes that any
+package-specific nesting should be done by the package itself. Finally,
+having ``libexecdir`` change between recipes makes it very difficult for
+different recipes to invoke binaries that have been installed into
+``libexecdir``. The Filesystem Hierarchy Standard (i.e.
+http://refspecs.linuxfoundation.org/FHS_3.0/fhs/ch04s07.html) now
+recognizes the use of ``${prefix}/libexec/``, giving distributions the
+choice between ``${prefix}/lib`` or ``${prefix}/libexec`` without
+breaking FHS.
+
+.. _migration-2.1-ac-cv-sizeof-off-t-no-longer-cached-in-site-files:
+
+``ac_cv_sizeof_off_t`` is No Longer Cached in Site Files
+--------------------------------------------------------
+
+For recipes inheriting the :ref:`autotools <ref-classes-autotools>`
+class, ``ac_cv_sizeof_off_t`` is no longer cached in the site files for
+``autoconf``. The reason for this change is because the
+``ac_cv_sizeof_off_t`` value is not necessarily static per architecture
+as was previously assumed. Rather, the value changes based on whether
+large file support is enabled. For most software that uses ``autoconf``,
+this change should not be a problem. However, if you have a recipe that
+bypasses the standard :ref:`ref-tasks-configure` task
+from the ``autotools`` class and the software the recipe is building
+uses a very old version of ``autoconf``, the recipe might be incapable
+of determining the correct size of ``off_t`` during ``do_configure``.
+
+The best course of action is to patch the software as necessary to allow
+the default implementation from the ``autotools`` class to work such
+that ``autoreconf`` succeeds and produces a working configure script,
+and to remove the overridden ``do_configure`` task such that the default
+implementation does get used.
+
+.. _migration-2.1-image-generation-split-out-from-filesystem-generation:
+
+Image Generation is Now Split Out from Filesystem Generation
+------------------------------------------------------------
+
+Previously, for image recipes the :ref:`ref-tasks-rootfs`
+task assembled the filesystem and then from that filesystem generated
+images. With this Yocto Project release, image generation is split into
+separate ```do_image_*`` <#ref-tasks-image>`__ tasks for clarity both in
+operation and in the code.
+
+For most cases, this change does not present any problems. However, if
+you have made customizations that directly modify the ``do_rootfs`` task
+or that mention ``do_rootfs``, you might need to update those changes.
+In particular, if you had added any tasks after ``do_rootfs``, you
+should make edits so that those tasks are after the
+```do_image_complete`` <#ref-tasks-image-complete>`__ task rather than
+after ``do_rootfs`` so that the your added tasks run at the correct
+time.
+
+A minor part of this restructuring is that the post-processing
+definitions and functions have been moved from the
+:ref:`image <ref-classes-image>` class to the
+:ref:`rootfs-postcommands <ref-classes-rootfs*>` class. Functionally,
+however, they remain unchanged.
+
+.. _migration-2.1-removed-recipes:
+
+Removed Recipes
+---------------
+
+The following recipes have been removed in the 2.1 release:
+
+- ``gcc`` version 4.8: Versions 4.9 and 5.3 remain.
+
+- ``qt4``: All support for Qt 4.x has been moved out to a separate
+ ``meta-qt4`` layer because Qt 4 is no longer supported upstream.
+
+- ``x11vnc``: Moved to the ``meta-oe`` layer.
+
+- ``linux-yocto-3.14``: No longer supported.
+
+- ``linux-yocto-3.19``: No longer supported.
+
+- ``libjpeg``: Replaced by the ``libjpeg-turbo`` recipe.
+
+- ``pth``: Became obsolete.
+
+- ``liboil``: Recipe is no longer needed and has been moved to the
+ ``meta-multimedia`` layer.
+
+- ``gtk-theme-torturer``: Recipe is no longer needed and has been moved
+ to the ``meta-gnome`` layer.
+
+- ``gnome-mime-data``: Recipe is no longer needed and has been moved to
+ the ``meta-gnome`` layer.
+
+- ``udev``: Replaced by the ``eudev`` recipe for compatibility when
+ using ``sysvinit`` with newer kernels.
+
+- ``python-pygtk``: Recipe became obsolete.
+
+- ``adt-installer``: Recipe became obsolete. See the "`ADT
+ Removed <#migration-2.1-adt-removed>`__" section for more
+ information.
+
+.. _migration-2.1-class-changes:
+
+Class Changes
+-------------
+
+The following classes have changed:
+
+- ``autotools_stage``: Removed because the
+ :ref:`autotools <ref-classes-autotools>` class now provides its
+ functionality. Recipes that inherited from ``autotools_stage`` should
+ now inherit from ``autotools`` instead.
+
+- ``boot-directdisk``: Merged into the ``image-vm`` class. The
+ ``boot-directdisk`` class was rarely directly used. Consequently,
+ this change should not cause any issues.
+
+- ``bootimg``: Merged into the
+ :ref:`image-live <ref-classes-image-live>` class. The ``bootimg``
+ class was rarely directly used. Consequently, this change should not
+ cause any issues.
+
+- ``packageinfo``: Removed due to its limited use by the Hob UI, which
+ has itself been removed.
+
+.. _migration-2.1-build-system-ui-changes:
+
+Build System User Interface Changes
+-----------------------------------
+
+The following changes have been made to the build system user interface:
+
+- *Hob GTK+-based UI*: Removed because it is unmaintained and based on
+ the outdated GTK+ 2 library. The Toaster web-based UI is much more
+ capable and is actively maintained. See the
+ ":ref:`toaster-manual/toaster-manual-setup-and-use:using the toaster web interface`"
+ section in the Toaster User Manual for more information on this
+ interface.
+
+- *"puccho" BitBake UI*: Removed because is unmaintained and no longer
+ useful.
+
+.. _migration-2.1-adt-removed:
+
+ADT Removed
+-----------
+
+The Application Development Toolkit (ADT) has been removed because its
+functionality almost completely overlapped with the :ref:`standard
+SDK <sdk-manual/sdk-using:using the standard sdk>` and the
+:ref:`extensible SDK <sdk-manual/sdk-extensible:using the extensible sdk>`. For
+information on these SDKs and how to build and use them, see the
+:doc:`../sdk-manual/sdk-manual` manual.
+
+.. note::
+
+ The Yocto Project Eclipse IDE Plug-in is still supported and is not
+ affected by this change.
+
+.. _migration-2.1-poky-reference-distribution-changes:
+
+Poky Reference Distribution Changes
+-----------------------------------
+
+The following changes have been made for the Poky distribution:
+
+- The ``meta-yocto`` layer has been renamed to ``meta-poky`` to better
+ match its purpose, which is to provide the Poky reference
+ distribution. The ``meta-yocto-bsp`` layer retains its original name
+ since it provides reference machines for the Yocto Project and it is
+ otherwise unrelated to Poky. References to ``meta-yocto`` in your
+ ``conf/bblayers.conf`` should automatically be updated, so you should
+ not need to change anything unless you are relying on this naming
+ elsewhere.
+
+- The :ref:`uninative <ref-classes-uninative>` class is now enabled
+ by default in Poky. This class attempts to isolate the build system
+ from the host distribution's C library and makes re-use of native
+ shared state artifacts across different host distributions practical.
+ With this class enabled, a tarball containing a pre-built C library
+ is downloaded at the start of the build.
+
+ The ``uninative`` class is enabled through the
+ ``meta/conf/distro/include/yocto-uninative.inc`` file, which for
+ those not using the Poky distribution, can include to easily enable
+ the same functionality.
+
+ Alternatively, if you wish to build your own ``uninative`` tarball,
+ you can do so by building the ``uninative-tarball`` recipe, making it
+ available to your build machines (e.g. over HTTP/HTTPS) and setting a
+ similar configuration as the one set by ``yocto-uninative.inc``.
+
+- Static library generation, for most cases, is now disabled by default
+ in the Poky distribution. Disabling this generation saves some build
+ time as well as the size used for build output artifacts.
+
+ Disabling this library generation is accomplished through a
+ ``meta/conf/distro/include/no-static-libs.inc``, which for those not
+ using the Poky distribution can easily include to enable the same
+ functionality.
+
+ Any recipe that needs to opt-out of having the "--disable-static"
+ option specified on the configure command line either because it is
+ not a supported option for the configure script or because static
+ libraries are needed should set the following variable:
+ DISABLE_STATIC = ""
+
+- The separate ``poky-tiny`` distribution now uses the musl C library
+ instead of a heavily pared down ``glibc``. Using musl results in a
+ smaller distribution and facilitates much greater maintainability
+ because musl is designed to have a small footprint.
+
+ If you have used ``poky-tiny`` and have customized the ``glibc``
+ configuration you will need to redo those customizations with musl
+ when upgrading to the new release.
+
+.. _migration-2.1-packaging-changes:
+
+Packaging Changes
+-----------------
+
+The following changes have been made to packaging:
+
+- The ``runuser`` and ``mountpoint`` binaries, which were previously in
+ the main ``util-linux`` package, have been split out into the
+ ``util-linux-runuser`` and ``util-linux-mountpoint`` packages,
+ respectively.
+
+- The ``python-elementtree`` package has been merged into the
+ ``python-xml`` package.
+
+.. _migration-2.1-tuning-file-changes:
+
+Tuning File Changes
+-------------------
+
+The following changes have been made to the tuning files:
+
+- The "no-thumb-interwork" tuning feature has been dropped from the ARM
+ tune include files. Because interworking is required for ARM EABI,
+ attempting to disable it through a tuning feature no longer makes
+ sense.
+
+ .. note::
+
+ Support for ARM OABI was deprecated in gcc 4.7.
+
+- The ``tune-cortexm*.inc`` and ``tune-cortexr4.inc`` files have been
+ removed because they are poorly tested. Until the OpenEmbedded build
+ system officially gains support for CPUs without an MMU, these tuning
+ files would probably be better maintained in a separate layer if
+ needed.
+
+.. _migration-2.1-supporting-gobject-introspection:
+
+Supporting GObject Introspection
+--------------------------------
+
+This release supports generation of GLib Introspective Repository (GIR)
+files through GObject introspection, which is the standard mechanism for
+accessing GObject-based software from runtime environments. You can
+enable, disable, and test the generation of this data. See the
+":ref:`dev-manual/dev-manual-common-tasks:enabling gobject introspection support`"
+section in the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual for more
+information.
+
+.. _migration-2.1-miscellaneous-changes:
+
+Miscellaneous Changes
+---------------------
+
+These additional changes exist:
+
+- The minimum Git version has been increased to 1.8.3.1. If your host
+ distribution does not provide a sufficiently recent version, you can
+ install the buildtools, which will provide it. See the "`Required
+ Git, tar, Python and gcc
+ Versions <#required-git-tar-python-and-gcc-versions>`__" section for
+ more information on the buildtools tarball.
+
+- The buggy and incomplete support for the RPM version 4 package
+ manager has been removed. The well-tested and maintained support for
+ RPM version 5 remains.
+
+- Previously, the following list of packages were removed if
+ package-management was not in
+ :term:`IMAGE_FEATURES`, regardless of any
+ dependencies:
+ ::
+
+ update-rc.d
+ base-passwd
+ shadow
+ update-alternatives
+
+ run-postinsts With the Yocto Project 2.1 release, these packages are
+ only removed if "read-only-rootfs" is in ``IMAGE_FEATURES``, since
+ they might still be needed for a read-write image even in the absence
+ of a package manager (e.g. if users need to be added, modified, or
+ removed at runtime).
+
+- The
+ :ref:`devtool modify <sdk-manual/sdk-extensible:use \`\`devtool modify\`\` to modify the source of an existing component>`
+ command now defaults to extracting the source since that is most
+ commonly expected. The "-x" or "--extract" options are now no-ops. If
+ you wish to provide your own existing source tree, you will now need
+ to specify either the "-n" or "--no-extract" options when running
+ ``devtool modify``.
+
+- If the formfactor for a machine is either not supplied or does not
+ specify whether a keyboard is attached, then the default is to assume
+ a keyboard is attached rather than assume no keyboard. This change
+ primarily affects the Sato UI.
+
+- The ``.debug`` directory packaging is now automatic. If your recipe
+ builds software that installs binaries into directories other than
+ the standard ones, you no longer need to take care of setting
+ ``FILES_${PN}-dbg`` to pick up the resulting ``.debug`` directories
+ as these directories are automatically found and added.
+
+- Inaccurate disk and CPU percentage data has been dropped from
+ ``buildstats`` output. This data has been replaced with
+ ``getrusage()`` data and corrected IO statistics. You will probably
+ need to update any custom code that reads the ``buildstats`` data.
+
+- The ``meta/conf/distro/include/package_regex.inc`` is now deprecated.
+ The contents of this file have been moved to individual recipes.
+
+ .. note::
+
+ Because this file will likely be removed in a future Yocto Project
+ release, it is suggested that you remove any references to the
+ file that might be in your configuration.
+
+- The ``v86d/uvesafb`` has been removed from the ``genericx86`` and
+ ``genericx86-64`` reference machines, which are provided by the
+ ``meta-yocto-bsp`` layer. Most modern x86 boards do not rely on this
+ file and it only adds kernel error messages during startup. If you do
+ still need to support ``uvesafb``, you can simply add ``v86d`` to
+ your image.
+
+- Build sysroot paths are now removed from debug symbol files. Removing
+ these paths means that remote GDB using an unstripped build system
+ sysroot will no longer work (although this was never documented to
+ work). The supported method to accomplish something similar is to set
+ ``IMAGE_GEN_DEBUGFS`` to "1", which will generate a companion debug
+ image containing unstripped binaries and associated debug sources
+ alongside the image.
+
+
diff --git a/poky/documentation/ref-manual/migration-2.2.rst b/poky/documentation/ref-manual/migration-2.2.rst
new file mode 100644
index 000000000..59d0eeeb9
--- /dev/null
+++ b/poky/documentation/ref-manual/migration-2.2.rst
@@ -0,0 +1,451 @@
+Moving to the Yocto Project 2.2 Release
+=======================================
+
+This section provides migration information for moving to the Yocto
+Project 2.2 Release from the prior release.
+
+.. _migration-2.2-minimum-kernel-version:
+
+Minimum Kernel Version
+----------------------
+
+The minimum kernel version for the target system and for SDK is now
+3.2.0, due to the upgrade to ``glibc 2.24``. Specifically, for
+AArch64-based targets the version is 3.14. For Nios II-based targets,
+the minimum kernel version is 3.19.
+
+.. note::
+
+ For x86 and x86_64, you can reset
+ OLDEST_KERNEL
+ to anything down to 2.6.32 if desired.
+
+.. _migration-2.2-staging-directories-in-sysroot-simplified:
+
+Staging Directories in Sysroot Has Been Simplified
+--------------------------------------------------
+
+The way directories are staged in sysroot has been simplified and
+introduces the new :term:`SYSROOT_DIRS`,
+:term:`SYSROOT_DIRS_NATIVE`, and
+:term:`SYSROOT_DIRS_BLACKLIST`. See the
+`v2 patch series on the OE-Core Mailing
+List <http://lists.openembedded.org/pipermail/openembedded-core/2016-May/121365.html>`__
+for additional information.
+
+.. _migration-2.2-removal-of-old-images-from-tmp-deploy-now-enabled:
+
+Removal of Old Images and Other Files in ``tmp/deploy`` Now Enabled
+-------------------------------------------------------------------
+
+Removal of old images and other files in ``tmp/deploy/`` is now enabled
+by default due to a new staging method used for those files. As a result
+of this change, the ``RM_OLD_IMAGE`` variable is now redundant.
+
+.. _migration-2.2-python-changes:
+
+Python Changes
+--------------
+
+The following changes for Python occurred:
+
+.. _migration-2.2-bitbake-now-requires-python-3.4:
+
+BitBake Now Requires Python 3.4+
+~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
+
+BitBake requires Python 3.4 or greater.
+
+.. _migration-2.2-utf-8-locale-required-on-build-host:
+
+UTF-8 Locale Required on Build Host
+~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
+
+A UTF-8 locale is required on the build host due to Python 3. Since
+C.UTF-8 is not a standard, the default is en_US.UTF-8.
+
+.. _migration-2.2-metadata-now-must-use-python-3-syntax:
+
+Metadata Must Now Use Python 3 Syntax
+~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
+
+The metadata is now required to use Python 3 syntax. For help preparing
+metadata, see any of the many Python 3 porting guides available.
+Alternatively, you can reference the conversion commits for Bitbake and
+you can use :term:`OpenEmbedded-Core (OE-Core)` as a guide for changes. Following are
+particular areas of interest:
+
+ - subprocess command-line pipes needing locale decoding
+
+ - the syntax for octal values changed
+
+ - the ``iter*()`` functions changed name \* iterators now return views, not lists
+
+ - changed names for Python modules
+
+.. _migration-2.2-target-python-recipes-switched-to-python-3:
+
+Target Python Recipes Switched to Python 3
+~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
+
+Most target Python recipes have now been switched to Python 3.
+Unfortunately, systems using RPM as a package manager and providing
+online package-manager support through SMART still require Python 2.
+
+.. note::
+
+ Python 2 and recipes that use it can still be built for the target as
+ with previous versions.
+
+.. _migration-2.2-buildtools-tarball-includes-python-3:
+
+``buildtools-tarball`` Includes Python 3
+~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
+
+``buildtools-tarball`` now includes Python 3.
+
+.. _migration-2.2-uclibc-replaced-by-musl:
+
+uClibc Replaced by musl
+-----------------------
+
+uClibc has been removed in favor of musl. Musl has matured, is better
+maintained, and is compatible with a wider range of applications as
+compared to uClibc.
+
+.. _migration-2.2-B-no-longer-default-working-directory-for-tasks:
+
+``${B}`` No Longer Default Working Directory for Tasks
+------------------------------------------------------
+
+``${``\ :term:`B`\ ``}`` is no longer the default working
+directory for tasks. Consequently, any custom tasks you define now need
+to either have the
+``[``\ :ref:`dirs <bitbake:bitbake-user-manual/bitbake-user-manual-metadata:variable flags>`\ ``]`` flag
+set, or the task needs to change into the appropriate working directory
+manually (e.g using ``cd`` for a shell task).
+
+.. note::
+
+ The preferred method is to use the
+ [dirs]
+ flag.
+
+.. _migration-2.2-runqemu-ported-to-python:
+
+``runqemu`` Ported to Python
+----------------------------
+
+``runqemu`` has been ported to Python and has changed behavior in some
+cases. Previous usage patterns continue to be supported.
+
+The new ``runqemu`` is a Python script. Machine knowledge is no longer
+hardcoded into ``runqemu``. You can choose to use the ``qemuboot``
+configuration file to define the BSP's own arguments and to make it
+bootable with ``runqemu``. If you use a configuration file, use the
+following form:
+::
+
+ image-name-machine.qemuboot.conf
+
+The configuration file
+enables fine-grained tuning of options passed to QEMU without the
+``runqemu`` script hard-coding any knowledge about different machines.
+Using a configuration file is particularly convenient when trying to use
+QEMU with machines other than the ``qemu*`` machines in
+:term:`OpenEmbedded-Core (OE-Core)`. The ``qemuboot.conf`` file is generated by the
+``qemuboot`` class when the root filesystem is being build (i.e. build
+rootfs). QEMU boot arguments can be set in BSP's configuration file and
+the ``qemuboot`` class will save them to ``qemuboot.conf``.
+
+If you want to use ``runqemu`` without a configuration file, use the
+following command form:
+::
+
+ $ runqemu machine rootfs kernel [options]
+
+Supported machines are as follows:
+
+ - qemuarm
+ - qemuarm64
+ - qemux86
+ - qemux86-64
+ - qemuppc
+ - qemumips
+ - qemumips64
+ - qemumipsel
+ - qemumips64el
+
+Consider the
+following example, which uses the ``qemux86-64`` machine, provides a
+root filesystem, provides an image, and uses the ``nographic`` option: ::
+
+ $ runqemu qemux86-64 tmp/deploy/images/qemux86-64/core-image-minimal-qemux86-64.ext4 tmp/deploy/images/qemux86-64/bzImage nographic
+
+Following is a list of variables that can be set in configuration files
+such as ``bsp.conf`` to enable the BSP to be booted by ``runqemu``:
+
+.. note::
+
+ "QB" means "QEMU Boot".
+
+::
+
+ QB_SYSTEM_NAME: QEMU name (e.g. "qemu-system-i386")
+ QB_OPT_APPEND: Options to append to QEMU (e.g. "-show-cursor")
+ QB_DEFAULT_KERNEL: Default kernel to boot (e.g. "bzImage")
+ QB_DEFAULT_FSTYPE: Default FSTYPE to boot (e.g. "ext4")
+ QB_MEM: Memory (e.g. "-m 512")
+ QB_MACHINE: QEMU machine (e.g. "-machine virt")
+ QB_CPU: QEMU cpu (e.g. "-cpu qemu32")
+ QB_CPU_KVM: Similar to QB_CPU except used for kvm support (e.g. "-cpu kvm64")
+ QB_KERNEL_CMDLINE_APPEND: Options to append to the kernel's -append
+ option (e.g. "console=ttyS0 console=tty")
+ QB_DTB: QEMU dtb name
+ QB_AUDIO_DRV: QEMU audio driver (e.g. "alsa", set it when support audio)
+ QB_AUDIO_OPT: QEMU audio option (e.g. "-soundhw ac97,es1370"), which is used
+ when QB_AUDIO_DRV is set.
+ QB_KERNEL_ROOT: Kernel's root (e.g. /dev/vda)
+ QB_TAP_OPT: Network option for 'tap' mode (e.g.
+ "-netdev tap,id=net0,ifname=@TAP@,script=no,downscript=no -device virtio-net-device,netdev=net0").
+ runqemu will replace "@TAP@" with the one that is used, such as tap0, tap1 ...
+ QB_SLIRP_OPT: Network option for SLIRP mode (e.g. "-netdev user,id=net0 -device virtio-net-device,netdev=net0")
+ QB_ROOTFS_OPT: Used as rootfs (e.g.
+ "-drive id=disk0,file=@ROOTFS@,if=none,format=raw -device virtio-blk-device,drive=disk0").
+ runqemu will replace "@ROOTFS@" with the one which is used, such as
+ core-image-minimal-qemuarm64.ext4.
+ QB_SERIAL_OPT: Serial port (e.g. "-serial mon:stdio")
+ QB_TCPSERIAL_OPT: tcp serial port option (e.g.
+ " -device virtio-serial-device -chardev socket,id=virtcon,port=@PORT@,host=127.0.0.1 -device virtconsole,chardev=virtcon"
+ runqemu will replace "@PORT@" with the port number which is used.
+
+To use ``runqemu``, set :term:`IMAGE_CLASSES` as
+follows and run ``runqemu``:
+
+.. note::
+
+ For command-line syntax, use
+ runqemu help
+ .
+
+::
+
+ IMAGE_CLASSES += "qemuboot"
+
+.. _migration-2.2-default-linker-hash-style-changed:
+
+Default Linker Hash Style Changed
+---------------------------------
+
+The default linker hash style for ``gcc-cross`` is now "sysv" in order
+to catch recipes that are building software without using the
+OpenEmbedded :term:`LDFLAGS`. This change could result in
+seeing some "No GNU_HASH in the elf binary" QA issues when building such
+recipes. You need to fix these recipes so that they use the expected
+``LDFLAGS``. Depending on how the software is built, the build system
+used by the software (e.g. a Makefile) might need to be patched.
+However, sometimes making this fix is as simple as adding the following
+to the recipe:
+::
+
+ TARGET_CC_ARCH += "${LDFLAGS}"
+
+.. _migration-2.2-kernel-image-base-name-no-longer-uses-kernel-imagetype:
+
+``KERNEL_IMAGE_BASE_NAME`` no Longer Uses ``KERNEL_IMAGETYPE``
+--------------------------------------------------------------
+
+The ``KERNEL_IMAGE_BASE_NAME`` variable no longer uses the
+:term:`KERNEL_IMAGETYPE` variable to create the
+image's base name. Because the OpenEmbedded build system can now build
+multiple kernel image types, this part of the kernel image base name as
+been removed leaving only the following:
+::
+
+ KERNEL_IMAGE_BASE_NAME ?= "${PKGE}-${PKGV}-${PKGR}-${MACHINE}-${DATETIME}"
+
+If you have recipes or
+classes that use ``KERNEL_IMAGE_BASE_NAME`` directly, you might need to
+update the references to ensure they continue to work.
+
+.. _migration-2.2-bitbake-changes:
+
+BitBake Changes
+---------------
+
+The following changes took place for BitBake:
+
+- The "goggle" UI and standalone image-writer tool have been removed as
+ they both require GTK+ 2.0 and were not being maintained.
+
+- The Perforce fetcher now supports :term:`SRCREV` for
+ specifying the source revision to use, be it
+ ``${``\ :term:`AUTOREV`\ ``}``, changelist number,
+ p4date, or label, in preference to separate
+ :term:`SRC_URI` parameters to specify these. This
+ change is more in-line with how the other fetchers work for source
+ control systems. Recipes that fetch from Perforce will need to be
+ updated to use ``SRCREV`` in place of specifying the source revision
+ within ``SRC_URI``.
+
+- Some of BitBake's internal code structures for accessing the recipe
+ cache needed to be changed to support the new multi-configuration
+ functionality. These changes will affect external tools that use
+ BitBake's tinfoil module. For information on these changes, see the
+ changes made to the scripts supplied with OpenEmbedded-Core:
+ `1 <http://git.yoctoproject.org/cgit/cgit.cgi/poky/commit/?id=189371f8393971d00bca0fceffd67cc07784f6ee>`__
+ and
+ `2 <http://git.yoctoproject.org/cgit/cgit.cgi/poky/commit/?id=4a5aa7ea4d07c2c90a1654b174873abb018acc67>`__.
+
+- The task management code has been rewritten to avoid using ID
+ indirection in order to improve performance. This change is unlikely
+ to cause any problems for most users. However, the setscene
+ verification function as pointed to by
+ ``BB_SETSCENE_VERIFY_FUNCTION`` needed to change signature.
+ Consequently, a new variable named ``BB_SETSCENE_VERIFY_FUNCTION2``
+ has been added allowing multiple versions of BitBake to work with
+ suitably written metadata, which includes OpenEmbedded-Core and Poky.
+ Anyone with custom BitBake task scheduler code might also need to
+ update the code to handle the new structure.
+
+.. _migration-2.2-swabber-has-been-removed:
+
+Swabber has Been Removed
+------------------------
+
+Swabber, a tool that was intended to detect host contamination in the
+build process, has been removed, as it has been unmaintained and unused
+for some time and was never particularly effective. The OpenEmbedded
+build system has since incorporated a number of mechanisms including
+enhanced QA checks that mean that there is less of a need for such a
+tool.
+
+.. _migration-2.2-removed-recipes:
+
+Removed Recipes
+---------------
+
+The following recipes have been removed:
+
+- ``augeas``: No longer needed and has been moved to ``meta-oe``.
+
+- ``directfb``: Unmaintained and has been moved to ``meta-oe``.
+
+- ``gcc``: Removed 4.9 version. Versions 5.4 and 6.2 are still present.
+
+- ``gnome-doc-utils``: No longer needed.
+
+- ``gtk-doc-stub``: Replaced by ``gtk-doc``.
+
+- ``gtk-engines``: No longer needed and has been moved to
+ ``meta-gnome``.
+
+- ``gtk-sato-engine``: Became obsolete.
+
+- ``libglade``: No longer needed and has been moved to ``meta-oe``.
+
+- ``libmad``: Unmaintained and functionally replaced by ``libmpg123``.
+ ``libmad`` has been moved to ``meta-oe``.
+
+- ``libowl``: Became obsolete.
+
+- ``libxsettings-client``: No longer needed.
+
+- ``oh-puzzles``: Functionally replaced by ``puzzles``.
+
+- ``oprofileui``: Became obsolete. OProfile has been largely supplanted
+ by perf.
+
+- ``packagegroup-core-directfb.bb``: Removed.
+
+- ``core-image-directfb.bb``: Removed.
+
+- ``pointercal``: No longer needed and has been moved to ``meta-oe``.
+
+- ``python-imaging``: No longer needed and moved to ``meta-python``
+
+- ``python-pyrex``: No longer needed and moved to ``meta-python``.
+
+- ``sato-icon-theme``: Became obsolete.
+
+- ``swabber-native``: Swabber has been removed. See the `entry on
+ Swabber <#migration-2.2-swabber-has-been-removed>`__.
+
+- ``tslib``: No longer needed and has been moved to ``meta-oe``.
+
+- ``uclibc``: Removed in favor of musl.
+
+- ``xtscal``: No longer needed and moved to ``meta-oe``
+
+.. _migration-2.2-removed-classes:
+
+Removed Classes
+---------------
+
+The following classes have been removed:
+
+- ``distutils-native-base``: No longer needed.
+
+- ``distutils3-native-base``: No longer needed.
+
+- ``sdl``: Only set :term:`DEPENDS` and
+ :term:`SECTION`, which are better set within the
+ recipe instead.
+
+- ``sip``: Mostly unused.
+
+- ``swabber``: See the `entry on
+ Swabber <#migration-2.2-swabber-has-been-removed>`__.
+
+.. _migration-2.2-minor-packaging-changes:
+
+Minor Packaging Changes
+-----------------------
+
+The following minor packaging changes have occurred:
+
+- ``grub``: Split ``grub-editenv`` into its own package.
+
+- ``systemd``: Split container and vm related units into a new package,
+ systemd-container.
+
+- ``util-linux``: Moved ``prlimit`` to a separate
+ ``util-linux-prlimit`` package.
+
+.. _migration-2.2-miscellaneous-changes:
+
+Miscellaneous Changes
+---------------------
+
+The following miscellaneous changes have occurred:
+
+- ``package_regex.inc``: Removed because the definitions
+ ``package_regex.inc`` previously contained have been moved to their
+ respective recipes.
+
+- Both ``devtool add`` and ``recipetool create`` now use a fixed
+ :term:`SRCREV` by default when fetching from a Git
+ repository. You can override this in either case to use
+ ``${``\ :term:`AUTOREV`\ ``}`` instead by using the
+ ``-a`` or ``DASHDASHautorev`` command-line option
+
+- ``distcc``: GTK+ UI is now disabled by default.
+
+- ``packagegroup-core-tools-testapps``: Removed Piglit.
+
+- ``image.bbclass``: Renamed COMPRESS(ION) to CONVERSION. This change
+ means that ``COMPRESSIONTYPES``, ``COMPRESS_DEPENDS`` and
+ ``COMPRESS_CMD`` are deprecated in favor of ``CONVERSIONTYPES``,
+ ``CONVERSION_DEPENDS`` and ``CONVERSION_CMD``. The ``COMPRESS*``
+ variable names will still work in the 2.2 release but metadata that
+ does not need to be backwards-compatible should be changed to use the
+ new names as the ``COMPRESS*`` ones will be removed in a future
+ release.
+
+- ``gtk-doc``: A full version of ``gtk-doc`` is now made available.
+ However, some old software might not be capable of using the current
+ version of ``gtk-doc`` to build documentation. You need to change
+ recipes that build such software so that they explicitly disable
+ building documentation with ``gtk-doc``.
+
+
diff --git a/poky/documentation/ref-manual/migration-2.3.rst b/poky/documentation/ref-manual/migration-2.3.rst
new file mode 100644
index 000000000..7f34f0cd7
--- /dev/null
+++ b/poky/documentation/ref-manual/migration-2.3.rst
@@ -0,0 +1,530 @@
+Moving to the Yocto Project 2.3 Release
+=======================================
+
+This section provides migration information for moving to the Yocto
+Project 2.3 Release from the prior release.
+
+.. _migration-2.3-recipe-specific-sysroots:
+
+Recipe-specific Sysroots
+------------------------
+
+The OpenEmbedded build system now uses one sysroot per recipe to resolve
+long-standing issues with configuration script auto-detection of
+undeclared dependencies. Consequently, you might find that some of your
+previously written custom recipes are missing declared dependencies,
+particularly those dependencies that are incidentally built earlier in a
+typical build process and thus are already likely to be present in the
+shared sysroot in previous releases.
+
+Consider the following:
+
+- *Declare Build-Time Dependencies:* Because of this new feature, you
+ must explicitly declare all build-time dependencies for your recipe.
+ If you do not declare these dependencies, they are not populated into
+ the sysroot for the recipe.
+
+- *Specify Pre-Installation and Post-Installation Native Tool
+ Dependencies:* You must specifically specify any special native tool
+ dependencies of ``pkg_preinst`` and ``pkg_postinst`` scripts by using
+ the :term:`PACKAGE_WRITE_DEPS` variable.
+ Specifying these dependencies ensures that these tools are available
+ if these scripts need to be run on the build host during the
+ :ref:`ref-tasks-rootfs` task.
+
+ As an example, see the ``dbus`` recipe. You will see that this recipe
+ has a ``pkg_postinst`` that calls ``systemctl`` if "systemd" is in
+ :term:`DISTRO_FEATURES`. In the example,
+ ``systemd-systemctl-native`` is added to ``PACKAGE_WRITE_DEPS``,
+ which is also conditional on "systemd" being in ``DISTRO_FEATURES``.
+
+- Examine Recipes that Use ``SSTATEPOSTINSTFUNCS``: You need to
+ examine any recipe that uses ``SSTATEPOSTINSTFUNCS`` and determine
+ steps to take.
+
+ Functions added to ``SSTATEPOSTINSTFUNCS`` are still called as they
+ were in previous Yocto Project releases. However, since a separate
+ sysroot is now being populated for every recipe and if existing
+ functions being called through ``SSTATEPOSTINSTFUNCS`` are doing
+ relocation, then you will need to change these to use a
+ post-installation script that is installed by a function added to
+ :term:`SYSROOT_PREPROCESS_FUNCS`.
+
+ For an example, see the ``pixbufcache`` class in ``meta/classes/`` in
+ the :ref:`overview-manual/overview-manual-development-environment:yocto project source repositories`.
+
+ .. note::
+
+ The
+ SSTATEPOSTINSTFUNCS
+ variable itself is now deprecated in favor of the
+ do_populate_sysroot[postfuncs]
+ task. Consequently, if you do still have any function or functions
+ that need to be called after the sysroot component is created for
+ a recipe, then you would be well advised to take steps to use a
+ post installation script as described previously. Taking these
+ steps prepares your code for when
+ SSTATEPOSTINSTFUNCS
+ is removed in a future Yocto Project release.
+
+- *Specify the Sysroot when Using Certain External Scripts:* Because
+ the shared sysroot is now gone, the scripts
+ ``oe-find-native-sysroot`` and ``oe-run-native`` have been changed
+ such that you need to specify which recipe's
+ :term:`STAGING_DIR_NATIVE` is used.
+
+.. note::
+
+ You can find more information on how recipe-specific sysroots work in
+ the "
+ staging.bbclass
+ " section.
+
+.. _migration-2.3-path-variable:
+
+``PATH`` Variable
+-----------------
+
+Within the environment used to run build tasks, the environment variable
+``PATH`` is now sanitized such that the normal native binary paths
+(``/bin``, ``/sbin``, ``/usr/bin`` and so forth) are removed and a
+directory containing symbolic links linking only to the binaries from
+the host mentioned in the :term:`HOSTTOOLS` and
+:term:`HOSTTOOLS_NONFATAL` variables is added
+to ``PATH``.
+
+Consequently, any native binaries provided by the host that you need to
+call needs to be in one of these two variables at the configuration
+level.
+
+Alternatively, you can add a native recipe (i.e. ``-native``) that
+provides the binary to the recipe's :term:`DEPENDS`
+value.
+
+.. note::
+
+ PATH
+ is not sanitized in the same way within
+ devshell
+ . If it were, you would have difficulty running host tools for
+ development and debugging within the shell.
+
+.. _migration-2.3-scripts:
+
+Changes to Scripts
+------------------
+
+The following changes to scripts took place:
+
+- ``oe-find-native-sysroot``: The usage for the
+ ``oe-find-native-sysroot`` script has changed to the following:
+ ::
+
+ $ . oe-find-native-sysroot recipe
+
+ You must now supply a recipe for recipe
+ as part of the command. Prior to the Yocto Project &DISTRO; release, it
+ was not necessary to provide the script with the command.
+
+- ``oe-run-native``: The usage for the ``oe-run-native`` script has
+ changed to the following:
+ ::
+
+ $ oe-run-native native_recipe tool
+
+ You must
+ supply the name of the native recipe and the tool you want to run as
+ part of the command. Prior to the Yocto Project DISTRO release, it
+ was not necessary to provide the native recipe with the command.
+
+- ``cleanup-workdir``: The ``cleanup-workdir`` script has been
+ removed because the script was found to be deleting files it should
+ not have, which lead to broken build trees. Rather than trying to
+ delete portions of :term:`TMPDIR` and getting it wrong,
+ it is recommended that you delete ``TMPDIR`` and have it restored
+ from shared state (sstate) on subsequent builds.
+
+- ``wipe-sysroot``: The ``wipe-sysroot`` script has been removed as
+ it is no longer needed with recipe-specific sysroots.
+
+.. _migration-2.3-functions:
+
+Changes to Functions
+--------------------
+
+The previously deprecated ``bb.data.getVar()``, ``bb.data.setVar()``,
+and related functions have been removed in favor of ``d.getVar()``,
+``d.setVar()``, and so forth.
+
+You need to fix any references to these old functions.
+
+.. _migration-2.3-bitbake-changes:
+
+BitBake Changes
+---------------
+
+The following changes took place for BitBake:
+
+- *BitBake's Graphical Dependency Explorer UI Replaced:* BitBake's
+ graphical dependency explorer UI ``depexp`` was replaced by
+ ``taskexp`` ("Task Explorer"), which provides a graphical way of
+ exploring the ``task-depends.dot`` file. The data presented by Task
+ Explorer is much more accurate than the data that was presented by
+ ``depexp``. Being able to visualize the data is an often requested
+ feature as standard ``*.dot`` file viewers cannot usual cope with the
+ size of the ``task-depends.dot`` file.
+
+- *BitBake "-g" Output Changes:* The ``package-depends.dot`` and
+ ``pn-depends.dot`` files as previously generated using the
+ ``bitbake -g`` command have been removed. A ``recipe-depends.dot``
+ file is now generated as a collapsed version of ``task-depends.dot``
+ instead.
+
+ The reason for this change is because ``package-depends.dot`` and
+ ``pn-depends.dot`` largely date back to a time before task-based
+ execution and do not take into account task-level dependencies
+ between recipes, which could be misleading.
+
+- *Mirror Variable Splitting Changes:* Mirror variables including
+ :term:`MIRRORS`, :term:`PREMIRRORS`,
+ and :term:`SSTATE_MIRRORS` can now separate
+ values entirely with spaces. Consequently, you no longer need "\\n".
+ BitBake looks for pairs of values, which simplifies usage. There
+ should be no change required to existing mirror variable values
+ themselves.
+
+- *The Subversion (SVN) Fetcher Uses an "ssh" Parameter and Not an
+ "rsh" Parameter:* The SVN fetcher now takes an "ssh" parameter
+ instead of an "rsh" parameter. This new optional parameter is used
+ when the "protocol" parameter is set to "svn+ssh". You can only use
+ the new parameter to specify the ``ssh`` program used by SVN. The SVN
+ fetcher passes the new parameter through the ``SVN_SSH`` environment
+ variable during the :ref:`ref-tasks-fetch` task.
+
+ See the ":ref:`bitbake:svn-fetcher`"
+ section in the BitBake
+ User Manual for additional information.
+
+- ``BB_SETSCENE_VERIFY_FUNCTION`` and ``BB_SETSCENE_VERIFY_FUNCTION2``
+ Removed: Because the mechanism they were part of is no longer
+ necessary with recipe-specific sysroots, the
+ ``BB_SETSCENE_VERIFY_FUNCTION`` and ``BB_SETSCENE_VERIFY_FUNCTION2``
+ variables have been removed.
+
+.. _migration-2.3-absolute-symlinks:
+
+Absolute Symbolic Links
+-----------------------
+
+Absolute symbolic links (symlinks) within staged files are no longer
+permitted and now trigger an error. Any explicit creation of symlinks
+can use the ``lnr`` script, which is a replacement for ``ln -r``.
+
+If the build scripts in the software that the recipe is building are
+creating a number of absolute symlinks that need to be corrected, you
+can inherit ``relative_symlinks`` within the recipe to turn those
+absolute symlinks into relative symlinks.
+
+.. _migration-2.3-gplv2-and-gplv3-moves:
+
+GPLv2 Versions of GPLv3 Recipes Moved
+-------------------------------------
+
+Older GPLv2 versions of GPLv3 recipes have moved to a separate
+``meta-gplv2`` layer.
+
+If you use :term:`INCOMPATIBLE_LICENSE` to
+exclude GPLv3 or set :term:`PREFERRED_VERSION`
+to substitute a GPLv2 version of a GPLv3 recipe, then you must add the
+``meta-gplv2`` layer to your configuration.
+
+.. note::
+
+ You can find
+ meta-gplv2
+ layer in the OpenEmbedded layer index at
+ .
+
+These relocated GPLv2 recipes do not receive the same level of
+maintenance as other core recipes. The recipes do not get security fixes
+and upstream no longer maintains them. In fact, the upstream community
+is actively hostile towards people that use the old versions of the
+recipes. Moving these recipes into a separate layer both makes the
+different needs of the recipes clearer and clearly identifies the number
+of these recipes.
+
+.. note::
+
+ The long-term solution might be to move to BSD-licensed replacements
+ of the GPLv3 components for those that need to exclude GPLv3-licensed
+ components from the target system. This solution will be investigated
+ for future Yocto Project releases.
+
+.. _migration-2.3-package-management-changes:
+
+Package Management Changes
+--------------------------
+
+The following package management changes took place:
+
+- Smart package manager is replaced by DNF package manager. Smart has
+ become unmaintained upstream, is not ported to Python 3.x.
+ Consequently, Smart needed to be replaced. DNF is the only feasible
+ candidate.
+
+ The change in functionality is that the on-target runtime package
+ management from remote package feeds is now done with a different
+ tool that has a different set of command-line options. If you have
+ scripts that call the tool directly, or use its API, they need to be
+ fixed.
+
+ For more information, see the `DNF
+ Documentation <http://dnf.readthedocs.io/en/latest/>`__.
+
+- Rpm 5.x is replaced with Rpm 4.x. This is done for two major reasons:
+
+ - DNF is API-incompatible with Rpm 5.x and porting it and
+ maintaining the port is non-trivial.
+
+ - Rpm 5.x itself has limited maintenance upstream, and the Yocto
+ Project is one of the very few remaining users.
+
+- Berkeley DB 6.x is removed and Berkeley DB 5.x becomes the default:
+
+ - Version 6.x of Berkeley DB has largely been rejected by the open
+ source community due to its AGPLv3 license. As a result, most
+ mainstream open source projects that require DB are still
+ developed and tested with DB 5.x.
+
+ - In OE-core, the only thing that was requiring DB 6.x was Rpm 5.x.
+ Thus, no reason exists to continue carrying DB 6.x in OE-core.
+
+- ``createrepo`` is replaced with ``createrepo_c``.
+
+ ``createrepo_c`` is the current incarnation of the tool that
+ generates remote repository metadata. It is written in C as compared
+ to ``createrepo``, which is written in Python. ``createrepo_c`` is
+ faster and is maintained.
+
+- Architecture-independent RPM packages are "noarch" instead of "all".
+
+ This change was made because too many places in DNF/RPM4 stack
+ already make that assumption. Only the filenames and the architecture
+ tag has changed. Nothing else has changed in OE-core system,
+ particularly in the :ref:`allarch.bbclass <ref-classes-allarch>`
+ class.
+
+- Signing of remote package feeds using ``PACKAGE_FEED_SIGN`` is not
+ currently supported. This issue will be fully addressed in a future
+ Yocto Project release. See `defect
+ 11209 <https://bugzilla.yoctoproject.org/show_bug.cgi?id=11209>`__
+ for more information on a solution to package feed signing with RPM
+ in the Yocto Project 2.3 release.
+
+- OPKG now uses the libsolv backend for resolving package dependencies
+ by default. This is vastly superior to OPKG's internal ad-hoc solver
+ that was previously used. This change does have a small impact on
+ disk (around 500 KB) and memory footprint.
+
+ .. note::
+
+ For further details on this change, see the
+ commit message
+ .
+
+.. _migration-2.3-removed-recipes:
+
+Removed Recipes
+---------------
+
+The following recipes have been removed:
+
+- ``linux-yocto 4.8``: Version 4.8 has been removed. Versions 4.1
+ (LTSI), 4.4 (LTS), 4.9 (LTS/LTSI) and 4.10 are now present.
+
+- ``python-smartpm``: Functionally replaced by ``dnf``.
+
+- ``createrepo``: Replaced by the ``createrepo-c`` recipe.
+
+- ``rpmresolve``: No longer needed with the move to RPM 4 as RPM
+ itself is used instead.
+
+- ``gstreamer``: Removed the GStreamer Git version recipes as they
+ have been stale. ``1.10.``\ x recipes are still present.
+
+- ``alsa-conf-base``: Merged into ``alsa-conf`` since ``libasound``
+ depended on both. Essentially, no way existed to install only one of
+ these.
+
+- ``tremor``: Moved to ``meta-multimedia``. Fixed-integer Vorbis
+ decoding is not needed by current hardware. Thus, GStreamer's ivorbis
+ plugin has been disabled by default eliminating the need for the
+ ``tremor`` recipe in :term:`OpenEmbedded-Core (OE-Core)`.
+
+- ``gummiboot``: Replaced by ``systemd-boot``.
+
+.. _migration-2.3-wic-changes:
+
+Wic Changes
+-----------
+
+The following changes have been made to Wic:
+
+.. note::
+
+ For more information on Wic, see the "
+ Creating Partitioned Images Using Wic
+ " section in the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual.
+
+- *Default Output Directory Changed:* Wic's default output directory is
+ now the current directory by default instead of the unusual
+ ``/var/tmp/wic``.
+
+ The "-o" and "--outdir" options remain unchanged and are used to
+ specify your preferred output directory if you do not want to use the
+ default directory.
+
+- *fsimage Plug-in Removed:* The Wic fsimage plugin has been removed as
+ it duplicates functionality of the rawcopy plugin.
+
+.. _migration-2.3-qa-changes:
+
+QA Changes
+----------
+
+The following QA checks have changed:
+
+- ``unsafe-references-in-binaries``: The
+ ``unsafe-references-in-binaries`` QA check, which was disabled by
+ default, has now been removed. This check was intended to detect
+ binaries in ``/bin`` that link to libraries in ``/usr/lib`` and have
+ the case where the user has ``/usr`` on a separate filesystem to
+ ``/``.
+
+ The removed QA check was buggy. Additionally, ``/usr`` residing on a
+ separate partition from ``/`` is now a rare configuration.
+ Consequently, ``unsafe-references-in-binaries`` was removed.
+
+- ``file-rdeps``: The ``file-rdeps`` QA check is now an error by
+ default instead of a warning. Because it is an error instead of a
+ warning, you need to address missing runtime dependencies.
+
+ For additional information, see the
+ :ref:`insane <ref-classes-insane>` class and the "`Errors and
+ Warnings <#qa-errors-and-warnings>`__" section.
+
+.. _migration-2.3-miscellaneous-changes:
+
+Miscellaneous Changes
+---------------------
+
+The following miscellaneous changes have occurred:
+
+- In this release, a number of recipes have been changed to ignore the
+ ``largefile`` :term:`DISTRO_FEATURES` item,
+ enabling large file support unconditionally. This feature has always
+ been enabled by default. Disabling the feature has not been widely
+ tested.
+
+ .. note::
+
+ Future releases of the Yocto Project will remove entirely the
+ ability to disable the
+ largefile
+ feature, which would make it unconditionally enabled everywhere.
+
+- If the :term:`DISTRO_VERSION` value contains
+ the value of the :term:`DATE` variable, which is the
+ default between Poky releases, the ``DATE`` value is explicitly
+ excluded from ``/etc/issue`` and ``/etc/issue.net``, which is
+ displayed at the login prompt, in order to avoid conflicts with
+ Multilib enabled. Regardless, the ``DATE`` value is inaccurate if the
+ ``base-files`` recipe is restored from shared state (sstate) rather
+ than rebuilt.
+
+ If you need the build date recorded in ``/etc/issue*`` or anywhere
+ else in your image, a better method is to define a post-processing
+ function to do it and have the function called from
+ :term:`ROOTFS_POSTPROCESS_COMMAND`.
+ Doing so ensures the value is always up-to-date with the created
+ image.
+
+- Dropbear's ``init`` script now disables DSA host keys by default.
+ This change is in line with the systemd service file, which supports
+ RSA keys only, and with recent versions of OpenSSH, which deprecates
+ DSA host keys.
+
+- The :ref:`buildhistory <ref-classes-buildhistory>` class now
+ correctly uses tabs as separators between all columns in
+ ``installed-package-sizes.txt`` in order to aid import into other
+ tools.
+
+- The ``USE_LDCONFIG`` variable has been replaced with the "ldconfig"
+ ``DISTRO_FEATURES`` feature. Distributions that previously set:
+ ::
+
+ USE_LDCONFIG = "0"
+
+ should now instead use the following:
+
+ ::
+
+ DISTRO_FEATURES_BACKFILL_CONSIDERED_append = " ldconfig"
+
+- The default value of
+ :term:`COPYLEFT_LICENSE_INCLUDE` now
+ includes all versions of AGPL licenses in addition to GPL and LGPL.
+
+ .. note::
+
+ The default list is not intended to be guaranteed as a complete
+ safe list. You should seek legal advice based on what you are
+ distributing if you are unsure.
+
+- Kernel module packages are now suffixed with the kernel version in
+ order to allow module packages from multiple kernel versions to
+ co-exist on a target system. If you wish to return to the previous
+ naming scheme that does not include the version suffix, use the
+ following:
+ ::
+
+ KERNEL_MODULE_PACKAGE_SUFFIX to ""
+
+- Removal of ``libtool`` ``*.la`` files is now enabled by default. The
+ ``*.la`` files are not actually needed on Linux and relocating them
+ is an unnecessary burden.
+
+ If you need to preserve these ``.la`` files (e.g. in a custom
+ distribution), you must change
+ :term:`INHERIT_DISTRO` such that
+ "remove-libtool" is not included in the value.
+
+- Extensible SDKs built for GCC 5+ now refuse to install on a
+ distribution where the host GCC version is 4.8 or 4.9. This change
+ resulted from the fact that the installation is known to fail due to
+ the way the ``uninative`` shared state (sstate) package is built. See
+ the :ref:`uninative <ref-classes-uninative>` class for additional
+ information.
+
+- All native and nativesdk recipes now use a separate
+ ``DISTRO_FEATURES`` value instead of sharing the value used by
+ recipes for the target, in order to avoid unnecessary rebuilds.
+
+ The ``DISTRO_FEATURES`` for ``native`` recipes is
+ :term:`DISTRO_FEATURES_NATIVE` added to
+ an intersection of ``DISTRO_FEATURES`` and
+ :term:`DISTRO_FEATURES_FILTER_NATIVE`.
+
+ For nativesdk recipes, the corresponding variables are
+ :term:`DISTRO_FEATURES_NATIVESDK`
+ and
+ :term:`DISTRO_FEATURES_FILTER_NATIVESDK`.
+
+- The ``FILESDIR`` variable, which was previously deprecated and rarely
+ used, has now been removed. You should change any recipes that set
+ ``FILESDIR`` to set :term:`FILESPATH` instead.
+
+- The ``MULTIMACH_HOST_SYS`` variable has been removed as it is no
+ longer needed with recipe-specific sysroots.
+
+
diff --git a/poky/documentation/ref-manual/migration-2.4.rst b/poky/documentation/ref-manual/migration-2.4.rst
new file mode 100644
index 000000000..260b3204b
--- /dev/null
+++ b/poky/documentation/ref-manual/migration-2.4.rst
@@ -0,0 +1,327 @@
+Moving to the Yocto Project 2.4 Release
+=======================================
+
+This section provides migration information for moving to the Yocto
+Project 2.4 Release from the prior release.
+
+.. _migration-2.4-memory-resident-mode:
+
+Memory Resident Mode
+--------------------
+
+A persistent mode is now available in BitBake's default operation,
+replacing its previous "memory resident mode" (i.e.
+``oe-init-build-env-memres``). Now you only need to set
+:term:`BB_SERVER_TIMEOUT` to a timeout (in
+seconds) and BitBake's server stays resident for that amount of time
+between invocations. The ``oe-init-build-env-memres`` script has been
+removed since a separate environment setup script is no longer needed.
+
+.. _migration-2.4-packaging-changes:
+
+Packaging Changes
+-----------------
+
+This section provides information about packaging changes that have
+occurred:
+
+- ``python3`` Changes:
+
+ - The main "python3" package now brings in all of the standard
+ Python 3 distribution rather than a subset. This behavior matches
+ what is expected based on traditional Linux distributions. If you
+ wish to install a subset of Python 3, specify ``python-core`` plus
+ one or more of the individual packages that are still produced.
+
+ - ``python3``: The ``bz2.py``, ``lzma.py``, and
+ ``_compression.py`` scripts have been moved from the
+ ``python3-misc`` package to the ``python3-compression`` package.
+
+- ``binutils``: The ``libbfd`` library is now packaged in a separate
+ "libbfd" package. This packaging saves space when certain tools (e.g.
+ ``perf``) are installed. In such cases, the tools only need
+ ``libbfd`` rather than all the packages in ``binutils``.
+
+- ``util-linux`` Changes:
+
+ - The ``su`` program is now packaged in a separate "util-linux-su"
+ package, which is only built when "pam" is listed in the
+ :term:`DISTRO_FEATURES` variable.
+ ``util-linux`` should not be installed unless it is needed because
+ ``su`` is normally provided through the shadow file format. The
+ main ``util-linux`` package has runtime dependencies (i.e.
+ :term:`RDEPENDS`) on the ``util-linux-su`` package
+ when "pam" is in ``DISTRO_FEATURES``.
+
+ - The ``switch_root`` program is now packaged in a separate
+ "util-linux-switch-root" package for small initramfs images that
+ do not need the whole ``util-linux`` package or the busybox
+ binary, which are both much larger than ``switch_root``. The main
+ ``util-linux`` package has a recommended runtime dependency (i.e.
+ :term:`RRECOMMENDS`) on the
+ ``util-linux-switch-root`` package.
+
+ - The ``ionice`` program is now packaged in a separate
+ "util-linux-ionice" package. The main ``util-linux`` package has a
+ recommended runtime dependency (i.e. ``RRECOMMENDS``) on the
+ ``util-linux-ionice`` package.
+
+- ``initscripts``: The ``sushell`` program is now packaged in a
+ separate "initscripts-sushell" package. This packaging change allows
+ systems to pull ``sushell`` in when ``selinux`` is enabled. The
+ change also eliminates needing to pull in the entire ``initscripts``
+ package. The main ``initscripts`` package has a runtime dependency
+ (i.e. ``RDEPENDS``) on the ``sushell`` package when "selinux" is in
+ ``DISTRO_FEATURES``.
+
+- ``glib-2.0``: The ``glib-2.0`` package now has a recommended
+ runtime dependency (i.e. ``RRECOMMENDS``) on the ``shared-mime-info``
+ package, since large portions of GIO are not useful without the MIME
+ database. You can remove the dependency by using the
+ :term:`BAD_RECOMMENDATIONS` variable if
+ ``shared-mime-info`` is too large and is not required.
+
+- *Go Standard Runtime:* The Go standard runtime has been split out
+ from the main ``go`` recipe into a separate ``go-runtime`` recipe.
+
+.. _migration-2.4-removed-recipes:
+
+Removed Recipes
+---------------
+
+The following recipes have been removed:
+
+- ``acpitests``: This recipe is not maintained.
+
+- ``autogen-native``: No longer required by Grub, oe-core, or
+ meta-oe.
+
+- ``bdwgc``: Nothing in OpenEmbedded-Core requires this recipe. It
+ has moved to meta-oe.
+
+- ``byacc``: This recipe was only needed by rpm 5.x and has moved to
+ meta-oe.
+
+- ``gcc (5.4)``: The 5.4 series dropped the recipe in favor of 6.3 /
+ 7.2.
+
+- ``gnome-common``: Deprecated upstream and no longer needed.
+
+- ``go-bootstrap-native``: Go 1.9 does its own bootstrapping so this
+ recipe has been removed.
+
+- ``guile``: This recipe was only needed by ``autogen-native`` and
+ ``remake``. The recipe is no longer needed by either of these
+ programs.
+
+- ``libclass-isa-perl``: This recipe was previously needed for LSB 4,
+ no longer needed.
+
+- ``libdumpvalue-perl``: This recipe was previously needed for LSB 4,
+ no longer needed.
+
+- ``libenv-perl``: This recipe was previously needed for LSB 4, no
+ longer needed.
+
+- ``libfile-checktree-perl``: This recipe was previously needed for
+ LSB 4, no longer needed.
+
+- ``libi18n-collate-perl``: This recipe was previously needed for LSB
+ 4, no longer needed.
+
+- ``libiconv``: This recipe was only needed for ``uclibc``, which was
+ removed in the previous release. ``glibc`` and ``musl`` have their
+ own implementations. ``meta-mingw`` still needs ``libiconv``, so it
+ has been moved to ``meta-mingw``.
+
+- ``libpng12``: This recipe was previously needed for LSB. The
+ current ``libpng`` is 1.6.x.
+
+- ``libpod-plainer-perl``: This recipe was previously needed for LSB
+ 4, no longer needed.
+
+- ``linux-yocto (4.1)``: This recipe was removed in favor of 4.4,
+ 4.9, 4.10 and 4.12.
+
+- ``mailx``: This recipe was previously only needed for LSB
+ compatibility, and upstream is defunct.
+
+- ``mesa (git version only)``: The git version recipe was stale with
+ respect to the release version.
+
+- ``ofono (git version only)``: The git version recipe was stale with
+ respect to the release version.
+
+- ``portmap``: This recipe is obsolete and is superseded by
+ ``rpcbind``.
+
+- ``python3-pygpgme``: This recipe is old and unmaintained. It was
+ previously required by ``dnf``, which has switched to official
+ ``gpgme`` Python bindings.
+
+- ``python-async``: This recipe has been removed in favor of the
+ Python 3 version.
+
+- ``python-gitdb``: This recipe has been removed in favor of the
+ Python 3 version.
+
+- ``python-git``: This recipe was removed in favor of the Python 3
+ version.
+
+- ``python-mako``: This recipe was removed in favor of the Python 3
+ version.
+
+- ``python-pexpect``: This recipe was removed in favor of the Python
+ 3 version.
+
+- ``python-ptyprocess``: This recipe was removed in favor of Python
+ the 3 version.
+
+- ``python-pycurl``: Nothing is using this recipe in
+ OpenEmbedded-Core (i.e. ``meta-oe``).
+
+- ``python-six``: This recipe was removed in favor of the Python 3
+ version.
+
+- ``python-smmap``: This recipe was removed in favor of the Python 3
+ version.
+
+- ``remake``: Using ``remake`` as the provider of ``virtual/make`` is
+ broken. Consequently, this recipe is not needed in OpenEmbedded-Core.
+
+.. _migration-2.4-kernel-device-tree-move:
+
+Kernel Device Tree Move
+-----------------------
+
+Kernel Device Tree support is now easier to enable in a kernel recipe.
+The Device Tree code has moved to a
+:ref:`kernel-devicetree <ref-classes-kernel-devicetree>` class.
+Functionality is automatically enabled for any recipe that inherits the
+:ref:`kernel <ref-classes-kernel>` class and sets the
+:term:`KERNEL_DEVICETREE` variable. The
+previous mechanism for doing this,
+``meta/recipes-kernel/linux/linux-dtb.inc``, is still available to avoid
+breakage, but triggers a deprecation warning. Future releases of the
+Yocto Project will remove ``meta/recipes-kernel/linux/linux-dtb.inc``.
+It is advisable to remove any ``require`` statements that request
+``meta/recipes-kernel/linux/linux-dtb.inc`` from any custom kernel
+recipes you might have. This will avoid breakage in post 2.4 releases.
+
+.. _migration-2.4-package-qa-changes:
+
+Package QA Changes
+------------------
+
+The following package QA changes took place:
+
+- The "unsafe-references-in-scripts" QA check has been removed.
+
+- If you refer to ``${COREBASE}/LICENSE`` within
+ :term:`LIC_FILES_CHKSUM` you receive a
+ warning because this file is a description of the license for
+ OE-Core. Use ``${COMMON_LICENSE_DIR}/MIT`` if your recipe is
+ MIT-licensed and you cannot use the preferred method of referring to
+ a file within the source tree.
+
+.. _migration-2.4-readme-changes:
+
+``README`` File Changes
+-----------------------
+
+The following are changes to ``README`` files:
+
+- The main Poky ``README`` file has been moved to the ``meta-poky``
+ layer and has been renamed ``README.poky``. A symlink has been
+ created so that references to the old location work.
+
+- The ``README.hardware`` file has been moved to ``meta-yocto-bsp``. A
+ symlink has been created so that references to the old location work.
+
+- A ``README.qemu`` file has been created with coverage of the
+ ``qemu*`` machines.
+
+.. _migration-2.4-miscellaneous-changes:
+
+Miscellaneous Changes
+---------------------
+
+The following are additional changes:
+
+- The ``ROOTFS_PKGMANAGE_BOOTSTRAP`` variable and any references to it
+ have been removed. You should remove this variable from any custom
+ recipes.
+
+- The ``meta-yocto`` directory has been removed.
+
+ .. note::
+
+ In the Yocto Project 2.1 release
+ meta-yocto
+ was renamed to
+ meta-poky
+ and the
+ meta-yocto
+ subdirectory remained to avoid breaking existing configurations.
+
+- The ``maintainers.inc`` file, which tracks maintainers by listing a
+ primary person responsible for each recipe in OE-Core, has been moved
+ from ``meta-poky`` to OE-Core (i.e. from
+ ``meta-poky/conf/distro/include`` to ``meta/conf/distro/include``).
+
+- The :ref:`buildhistory <ref-classes-buildhistory>` class now makes
+ a single commit per build rather than one commit per subdirectory in
+ the repository. This behavior assumes the commits are enabled with
+ :term:`BUILDHISTORY_COMMIT` = "1", which
+ is typical. Previously, the ``buildhistory`` class made one commit
+ per subdirectory in the repository in order to make it easier to see
+ the changes for a particular subdirectory. To view a particular
+ change, specify that subdirectory as the last parameter on the
+ ``git show`` or ``git diff`` commands.
+
+- The ``x86-base.inc`` file, which is included by all x86-based machine
+ configurations, now sets :term:`IMAGE_FSTYPES`
+ using ``?=`` to "live" rather than appending with ``+=``. This change
+ makes the default easier to override.
+
+- BitBake fires multiple "BuildStarted" events when multiconfig is
+ enabled (one per configuration). For more information, see the
+ ":ref:`Events <bitbake:bitbake-user-manual/bitbake-user-manual-metadata:events>`" section in the BitBake User
+ Manual.
+
+- By default, the ``security_flags.inc`` file sets a
+ :term:`GCCPIE` variable with an option to enable
+ Position Independent Executables (PIE) within ``gcc``. Enabling PIE
+ in the GNU C Compiler (GCC), makes Return Oriented Programming (ROP)
+ attacks much more difficult to execute.
+
+- OE-Core now provides a ``bitbake-layers`` plugin that implements a
+ "create-layer" subcommand. The implementation of this subcommand has
+ resulted in the ``yocto-layer`` script being deprecated and will
+ likely be removed in the next Yocto Project release.
+
+- The ``vmdk``, ``vdi``, and ``qcow2`` image file types are now used in
+ conjunction with the "wic" image type through ``CONVERSION_CMD``.
+ Consequently, the equivalent image types are now ``wic.vmdk``,
+ ``wic.vdi``, and ``wic.qcow2``, respectively.
+
+- ``do_image_<type>[depends]`` has replaced ``IMAGE_DEPENDS_<type>``.
+ If you have your own classes that implement custom image types, then
+ you need to update them.
+
+- OpenSSL 1.1 has been introduced. However, the default is still 1.0.x
+ through the :term:`PREFERRED_VERSION`
+ variable. This preference is set is due to the remaining
+ compatibility issues with other software. The
+ :term:`PROVIDES` variable in the openssl 1.0 recipe
+ now includes "openssl10" as a marker that can be used in
+ :term:`DEPENDS` within recipes that build software
+ that still depend on OpenSSL 1.0.
+
+- To ensure consistent behavior, BitBake's "-r" and "-R" options (i.e.
+ prefile and postfile), which are used to read or post-read additional
+ configuration files from the command line, now only affect the
+ current BitBake command. Before these BitBake changes, these options
+ would "stick" for future executions.
+
+
diff --git a/poky/documentation/ref-manual/migration-2.5.rst b/poky/documentation/ref-manual/migration-2.5.rst
new file mode 100644
index 000000000..a2adc1775
--- /dev/null
+++ b/poky/documentation/ref-manual/migration-2.5.rst
@@ -0,0 +1,310 @@
+Moving to the Yocto Project 2.5 Release
+=======================================
+
+This section provides migration information for moving to the Yocto
+Project 2.5 Release from the prior release.
+
+.. _migration-2.5-packaging-changes:
+
+Packaging Changes
+-----------------
+
+This section provides information about packaging changes that have
+occurred:
+
+- ``bind-libs``: The libraries packaged by the bind recipe are in a
+ separate ``bind-libs`` package.
+
+- ``libfm-gtk``: The ``libfm`` GTK+ bindings are split into a
+ separate ``libfm-gtk`` package.
+
+- ``flex-libfl``: The flex recipe splits out libfl into a separate
+ ``flex-libfl`` package to avoid too many dependencies being pulled in
+ where only the library is needed.
+
+- ``grub-efi``: The ``grub-efi`` configuration is split into a
+ separate ``grub-bootconf`` recipe. However, the dependency
+ relationship from ``grub-efi`` is through a virtual/grub-bootconf
+ provider making it possible to have your own recipe provide the
+ dependency. Alternatively, you can use a BitBake append file to bring
+ the configuration back into the ``grub-efi`` recipe.
+
+- *armv7a Legacy Package Feed Support:* Legacy support is removed for
+ transitioning from ``armv7a`` to ``armv7a-vfp-neon`` in package
+ feeds, which was previously enabled by setting
+ ``PKGARCHCOMPAT_ARMV7A``. This transition occurred in 2011 and active
+ package feeds should by now be updated to the new naming.
+
+.. _migration-2.5-removed-recipes:
+
+Removed Recipes
+---------------
+
+The following recipes have been removed:
+
+- ``gcc``: The version 6.4 recipes are replaced by 7.x.
+
+- ``gst-player``: Renamed to ``gst-examples`` as per upstream.
+
+- ``hostap-utils``: This software package is obsolete.
+
+- ``latencytop``: This recipe is no longer maintained upstream. The
+ last release was in 2009.
+
+- ``libpfm4``: The only file that requires this recipe is
+ ``oprofile``, which has been removed.
+
+- ``linux-yocto``: The version 4.4, 4.9, and 4.10 recipes have been
+ removed. Versions 4.12, 4.14, and 4.15 remain.
+
+- ``man``: This recipe has been replaced by modern ``man-db``
+
+- ``mkelfimage``: This tool has been removed in the upstream coreboot
+ project, and is no longer needed with the removal of the ELF image
+ type.
+
+- ``nativesdk-postinst-intercept``: This recipe is not maintained.
+
+- ``neon``: This software package is no longer maintained upstream
+ and is no longer needed by anything in OpenEmbedded-Core.
+
+- ``oprofile``: The functionality of this recipe is replaced by
+ ``perf`` and keeping compatibility on an ongoing basis with ``musl``
+ is difficult.
+
+- ``pax``: This software package is obsolete.
+
+- ``stat``: This software package is not maintained upstream.
+ ``coreutils`` provides a modern stat binary.
+
+- ``zisofs-tools-native``: This recipe is no longer needed because
+ the compressed ISO image feature has been removed.
+
+.. _migration-2.5-scripts-and-tools-changes:
+
+Scripts and Tools Changes
+-------------------------
+
+The following are changes to scripts and tools:
+
+- ``yocto-bsp``, ``yocto-kernel``, and ``yocto-layer``: The
+ ``yocto-bsp``, ``yocto-kernel``, and ``yocto-layer`` scripts
+ previously shipped with poky but not in OpenEmbedded-Core have been
+ removed. These scripts are not maintained and are outdated. In many
+ cases, they are also limited in scope. The
+ ``bitbake-layers create-layer`` command is a direct replacement for
+ ``yocto-layer``. See the documentation to create a BSP or kernel
+ recipe in the ":ref:`bsp-guide/bsp:bsp kernel recipe example`" section.
+
+- ``devtool finish``: ``devtool finish`` now exits with an error if
+ there are uncommitted changes or a rebase/am in progress in the
+ recipe's source repository. If this error occurs, there might be
+ uncommitted changes that will not be included in updates to the
+ patches applied by the recipe. A -f/--force option is provided for
+ situations that the uncommitted changes are inconsequential and you
+ want to proceed regardless.
+
+- ``scripts/oe-setup-rpmrepo`` script: The functionality of
+ ``scripts/oe-setup-rpmrepo`` is replaced by
+ ``bitbake package-index``.
+
+- ``scripts/test-dependencies.sh`` script: The script is largely made
+ obsolete by the recipe-specific sysroots functionality introduced in
+ the previous release.
+
+.. _migration-2.5-bitbake-changes:
+
+BitBake Changes
+---------------
+
+The following are BitBake changes:
+
+- The ``--runall`` option has changed. There are two different
+ behaviors people might want:
+
+ - *Behavior A:* For a given target (or set of targets) look through
+ the task graph and run task X only if it is present and will be
+ built.
+
+ - *Behavior B:* For a given target (or set of targets) look through
+ the task graph and run task X if any recipe in the taskgraph has
+ such a target, even if it is not in the original task graph.
+
+ The ``--runall`` option now performs "Behavior B". Previously
+ ``--runall`` behaved like "Behavior A". A ``--runonly`` option has
+ been added to retain the ability to perform "Behavior A".
+
+- Several explicit "run this task for all recipes in the dependency
+ tree" tasks have been removed (e.g. ``fetchall``, ``checkuriall``,
+ and the ``*all`` tasks provided by the ``distrodata`` and
+ ``archiver`` classes). There is a BitBake option to complete this for
+ any arbitrary task. For example:
+ ::
+
+ bitbake <target> -c fetchall
+
+ should now be replaced with:
+ ::
+
+ bitbake <target> --runall=fetch
+
+.. _migration-2.5-python-and-python3-changes:
+
+Python and Python 3 Changes
+---------------------------
+
+The following are auto-packaging changes to Python and Python 3:
+
+The script-managed ``python-*-manifest.inc`` files that were previously
+used to generate Python and Python 3 packages have been replaced with a
+JSON-based file that is easier to read and maintain. A new task is
+available for maintainers of the Python recipes to update the JSON file
+when upgrading to new Python versions. You can now edit the file
+directly instead of having to edit a script and run it to update the
+file.
+
+One particular change to note is that the Python recipes no longer have
+build-time provides for their packages. This assumes ``python-foo`` is
+one of the packages provided by the Python recipe. You can no longer run
+``bitbake python-foo`` or have a
+:term:`DEPENDS` on ``python-foo``,
+but doing either of the following causes the package to work as
+expected: ::
+
+ IMAGE_INSTALL_append = " python-foo"
+
+or ::
+
+ RDEPENDS_${PN} = "python-foo"
+
+The earlier build-time provides behavior was a quirk of the
+way the Python manifest file was created. For more information on this
+change please see `this
+commit <http://git.yoctoproject.org/cgit/cgit.cgi/poky/commit/?id=8d94b9db221d1def42f091b991903faa2d1651ce>`__.
+
+.. _migration-2.5-miscellaneous-changes:
+
+Miscellaneous Changes
+---------------------
+
+The following are additional changes:
+
+- The ``kernel`` class supports building packages for multiple kernels.
+ If your kernel recipe or ``.bbappend`` file mentions packaging at
+ all, you should replace references to the kernel in package names
+ with ``${KERNEL_PACKAGE_NAME}``. For example, if you disable
+ automatic installation of the kernel image using
+ ``RDEPENDS_kernel-base = ""`` you can avoid warnings using
+ ``RDEPENDS_${KERNEL_PACKAGE_NAME}-base = ""`` instead.
+
+- The ``buildhistory`` class commits changes to the repository by
+ default so you no longer need to set ``BUILDHISTORY_COMMIT = "1"``.
+ If you want to disable commits you need to set
+ ``BUILDHISTORY_COMMIT = "0"`` in your configuration.
+
+- The ``beaglebone`` reference machine has been renamed to
+ ``beaglebone-yocto``. The ``beaglebone-yocto`` BSP is a reference
+ implementation using only mainline components available in
+ OpenEmbedded-Core and ``meta-yocto-bsp``, whereas Texas Instruments
+ maintains a full-featured BSP in the ``meta-ti`` layer. This rename
+ avoids the previous name clash that existed between the two BSPs.
+
+- The ``update-alternatives`` class no longer works with SysV ``init``
+ scripts because this usage has been problematic. Also, the
+ ``sysklogd`` recipe no longer uses ``update-alternatives`` because it
+ is incompatible with other implementations.
+
+- By default, the :ref:`cmake <ref-classes-cmake>` class uses
+ ``ninja`` instead of ``make`` for building. This improves build
+ performance. If a recipe is broken with ``ninja``, then the recipe
+ can set ``OECMAKE_GENERATOR = "Unix Makefiles"`` to change back to
+ ``make``.
+
+- The previously deprecated ``base_*`` functions have been removed in
+ favor of their replacements in ``meta/lib/oe`` and
+ ``bitbake/lib/bb``. These are typically used from recipes and
+ classes. Any references to the old functions must be updated. The
+ following table shows the removed functions and their replacements:
+
+ +------------------------------+----------------------------------------------------------+
+ | *Removed* | *Replacement* |
+ +==============================+==========================================================+
+ | base_path_join() | oe.path.join() |
+ +------------------------------+----------------------------------------------------------+
+ | base_path_relative() | oe.path.relative() |
+ +------------------------------+----------------------------------------------------------+
+ | base_path_out() | oe.path.format_display() |
+ +------------------------------+----------------------------------------------------------+
+ | base_read_file() | oe.utils.read_file() |
+ +------------------------------+----------------------------------------------------------+
+ | base_ifelse() | oe.utils.ifelse() |
+ +------------------------------+----------------------------------------------------------+
+ | base_conditional() | oe.utils.conditional() |
+ +------------------------------+----------------------------------------------------------+
+ | base_less_or_equal() | oe.utils.less_or_equal() |
+ +------------------------------+----------------------------------------------------------+
+ | base_version_less_or_equal() | oe.utils.version_less_or_equal() |
+ +------------------------------+----------------------------------------------------------+
+ | base_contains() | bb.utils.contains() |
+ +------------------------------+----------------------------------------------------------+
+ | base_both_contain() | oe.utils.both_contain() |
+ +------------------------------+----------------------------------------------------------+
+ | base_prune_suffix() | oe.utils.prune_suffix() |
+ +------------------------------+----------------------------------------------------------+
+ | oe_filter() | oe.utils.str_filter() |
+ +------------------------------+----------------------------------------------------------+
+ | oe_filter_out() | oe.utils.str_filter_out() (or use the \_remove operator) |
+ +------------------------------+----------------------------------------------------------+
+
+- Using ``exit 1`` to explicitly defer a postinstall script until first
+ boot is now deprecated since it is not an obvious mechanism and can
+ mask actual errors. If you want to explicitly defer a postinstall to
+ first boot on the target rather than at ``rootfs`` creation time, use
+ ``pkg_postinst_ontarget()`` or call
+ ``postinst_intercept delay_to_first_boot`` from ``pkg_postinst()``.
+ Any failure of a ``pkg_postinst()`` script (including ``exit 1``)
+ will trigger a warning during ``do_rootfs``.
+
+ For more information, see the
+ ":ref:`dev-manual/dev-manual-common-tasks:post-installation scripts`"
+ section in the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual.
+
+- The ``elf`` image type has been removed. This image type was removed
+ because the ``mkelfimage`` tool that was required to create it is no
+ longer provided by coreboot upstream and required updating every time
+ ``binutils`` updated.
+
+- Support for .iso image compression (previously enabled through
+ ``COMPRESSISO = "1"``) has been removed. The userspace tools
+ (``zisofs-tools``) are unmaintained and ``squashfs`` provides better
+ performance and compression. In order to build a live image with
+ squashfs+lz4 compression enabled you should now set
+ ``LIVE_ROOTFS_TYPE = "squashfs-lz4"`` and ensure that ``live`` is in
+ ``IMAGE_FSTYPES``.
+
+- Recipes with an unconditional dependency on ``libpam`` are only
+ buildable with ``pam`` in ``DISTRO_FEATURES``. If the dependency is
+ truly optional then it is recommended that the dependency be
+ conditional upon ``pam`` being in ``DISTRO_FEATURES``.
+
+- For EFI-based machines, the bootloader (``grub-efi`` by default) is
+ installed into the image at /boot. Wic can be used to split the
+ bootloader into separate boot and rootfs partitions if necessary.
+
+- Patches whose context does not match exactly (i.e. where patch
+ reports "fuzz" when applying) will generate a warning. For an example
+ of this see `this
+ commit <http://git.yoctoproject.org/cgit/cgit.cgi/poky/commit/?id=cc97bc08125b63821ce3f616771830f77c456f57>`__.
+
+- Layers are expected to set ``LAYERSERIES_COMPAT_layername`` to match
+ the version(s) of OpenEmbedded-Core they are compatible with. This is
+ specified as codenames using spaces to separate multiple values (e.g.
+ "rocko sumo"). If a layer does not set
+ ``LAYERSERIES_COMPAT_layername``, a warning will is shown. If a layer
+ sets a value that does not include the current version ("sumo" for
+ the 2.5 release), then an error will be produced.
+
+- The ``TZ`` environment variable is set to "UTC" within the build
+ environment in order to fix reproducibility problems in some recipes.
+
+
diff --git a/poky/documentation/ref-manual/migration-2.6.rst b/poky/documentation/ref-manual/migration-2.6.rst
new file mode 100644
index 000000000..f16aaaa97
--- /dev/null
+++ b/poky/documentation/ref-manual/migration-2.6.rst
@@ -0,0 +1,476 @@
+Moving to the Yocto Project 2.6 Release
+=======================================
+
+This section provides migration information for moving to the Yocto
+Project 2.6 Release from the prior release.
+
+.. _migration-2.6-gcc-changes:
+
+GCC 8.2 is Now Used by Default
+------------------------------
+
+The GNU Compiler Collection version 8.2 is now used by default for
+compilation. For more information on what has changed in the GCC 8.x
+release, see https://gcc.gnu.org/gcc-8/changes.html.
+
+If you still need to compile with version 7.x, GCC 7.3 is also provided.
+You can select this version by setting the and can be selected by
+setting the :term:`GCCVERSION` variable to "7.%" in
+your configuration.
+
+.. _migration-2.6-removed-recipes:
+
+Removed Recipes
+---------------
+
+The following recipes have been removed:
+
+- *beecrypt*: No longer needed since moving to RPM 4.
+- *bigreqsproto*: Replaced by ``xorgproto``.
+- *calibrateproto*: Removed in favor of ``xinput``.
+- *compositeproto*: Replaced by ``xorgproto``.
+- *damageproto*: Replaced by ``xorgproto``.
+- *dmxproto*: Replaced by ``xorgproto``.
+- *dri2proto*: Replaced by ``xorgproto``.
+- *dri3proto*: Replaced by ``xorgproto``.
+- *eee-acpi-scripts*: Became obsolete.
+- *fixesproto*: Replaced by ``xorgproto``.
+- *fontsproto*: Replaced by ``xorgproto``.
+- *fstests*: Became obsolete.
+- *gccmakedep*: No longer used.
+- *glproto*: Replaced by ``xorgproto``.
+- *gnome-desktop3*: No longer needed. This recipe has moved to ``meta-oe``.
+- *icon-naming-utils*: No longer used since the Sato theme was removed in 2016.
+- *inputproto*: Replaced by ``xorgproto``.
+- *kbproto*: Replaced by ``xorgproto``.
+- *libusb-compat*: Became obsolete.
+- *libuser*: Became obsolete.
+- *libnfsidmap*: No longer an external requirement since ``nfs-utils`` 2.2.1. ``libnfsidmap`` is now integrated.
+- *libxcalibrate*: No longer needed with ``xinput``
+- *mktemp*: Became obsolete. The ``mktemp`` command is provided by both ``busybox`` and ``coreutils``.
+- *ossp-uuid*: Is not being maintained and has mostly been replaced by ``uuid.h`` in ``util-linux``.
+- *pax-utils*: No longer needed. Previous QA tests that did use this recipe are now done at build time.
+- *pcmciautils*: Became obsolete.
+- *pixz*: No longer needed. ``xz`` now supports multi-threaded compression.
+- *presentproto*: Replaced by ``xorgproto``.
+- *randrproto*: Replaced by ``xorgproto``.
+- *recordproto*: Replaced by ``xorgproto``.
+- *renderproto*: Replaced by ``xorgproto``.
+- *resourceproto*: Replaced by ``xorgproto``.
+- *scrnsaverproto*: Replaced by ``xorgproto``.
+- *trace-cmd*: Became obsolete. ``perf`` replaced this recipe's functionally.
+- *videoproto*: Replaced by ``xorgproto``.
+- *wireless-tools*: Became obsolete. Superseded by ``iw``.
+- *xcmiscproto*: Replaced by ``xorgproto``.
+- *xextproto*: Replaced by ``xorgproto``.
+- *xf86dgaproto*: Replaced by ``xorgproto``.
+- *xf86driproto*: Replaced by ``xorgproto``.
+- *xf86miscproto*: Replaced by ``xorgproto``.
+- *xf86-video-omapfb*: Became obsolete. Use kernel modesetting driver instead.
+- *xf86-video-omap*: Became obsolete. Use kernel modesetting driver instead.
+- *xf86vidmodeproto*: Replaced by ``xorgproto``.
+- *xineramaproto*: Replaced by ``xorgproto``.
+- *xproto*: Replaced by ``xorgproto``.
+- *yasm*: No longer needed since previous usages are now satisfied by ``nasm``.
+
+.. _migration-2.6-packaging-changes:
+
+Packaging Changes
+-----------------
+
+The following packaging changes have been made:
+
+- *cmake*: ``cmake.m4`` and ``toolchain`` files have been moved to
+ the main package.
+
+- *iptables*: The ``iptables`` modules have been split into
+ separate packages.
+
+- *alsa-lib*: ``libasound`` is now in the main ``alsa-lib`` package
+ instead of ``libasound``.
+
+- *glibc*: ``libnss-db`` is now in its own package along with a
+ ``/var/db/makedbs.sh`` script to update databases.
+
+- *python and python3*: The main package has been removed from
+ the recipe. You must install specific packages or ``python-modules``
+ / ``python3-modules`` for everything.
+
+- *systemtap*: Moved ``systemtap-exporter`` into its own package.
+
+.. _migration-2.6-xorg-protocol-dependencies:
+
+XOrg Protocol dependencies
+--------------------------
+
+The ``*proto`` upstream repositories have been combined into one
+"xorgproto" repository. Thus, the corresponding recipes have also been
+combined into a single ``xorgproto`` recipe. Any recipes that depend
+upon the older ``*proto`` recipes need to be changed to depend on the
+newer ``xorgproto`` recipe instead.
+
+For names of recipes removed because of this repository change, see the
+`Removed Recipes <#migration-2.6-removed-recipes>`__ section.
+
+.. _migration-2.6-distutils-distutils3-fetching-dependencies:
+
+``distutils`` and ``distutils3`` Now Prevent Fetching Dependencies During the ``do_configure`` Task
+---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
+
+Previously, it was possible for Python recipes that inherited the
+:ref:`distutils <ref-classes-distutils>` and
+:ref:`distutils3 <ref-classes-distutils3>` classes to fetch code
+during the :ref:`ref-tasks-configure` task to satisfy
+dependencies mentioned in ``setup.py`` if those dependencies were not
+provided in the sysroot (i.e. recipes providing the dependencies were
+missing from :term:`DEPENDS`).
+
+.. note::
+
+ This change affects classes beyond just the two mentioned (i.e.
+ distutils
+ and
+ distutils3
+ ). Any recipe that inherits
+ distutils\*
+ classes are affected. For example, the
+ setuptools
+ and
+ setuptools3
+ recipes are affected since they inherit the
+ distutils\*
+ classes.
+
+Fetching these types of dependencies that are not provided in the
+sysroot negatively affects the ability to reproduce builds. This type of
+fetching is now explicitly disabled. Consequently, any missing
+dependencies in Python recipes that use these classes now result in an
+error during the ``do_configure`` task.
+
+.. _migration-2.6-linux-yocto-configuration-audit-issues-now-correctly-reported:
+
+``linux-yocto`` Configuration Audit Issues Now Correctly Reported
+-----------------------------------------------------------------
+
+Due to a bug, the kernel configuration audit functionality was not
+writing out any resulting warnings during the build. This issue is now
+corrected. You might notice these warnings now if you have a custom
+kernel configuration with a ``linux-yocto`` style kernel recipe.
+
+.. _migration-2.6-image-kernel-artifact-naming-changes:
+
+Image/Kernel Artifact Naming Changes
+------------------------------------
+
+The following changes have been made:
+
+- Name variables (e.g. :term:`IMAGE_NAME`) use a new
+ ``IMAGE_VERSION_SUFFIX`` variable instead of
+ :term:`DATETIME`. Using ``IMAGE_VERSION_SUFFIX``
+ allows easier and more direct changes.
+
+ The ``IMAGE_VERSION_SUFFIX`` variable is set in the ``bitbake.conf``
+ configuration file as follows:
+ ::
+
+ IMAGE_VERSION_SUFFIX = "-${DATETIME}"
+
+- Several variables have changed names for consistency:
+ ::
+
+ Old Variable Name New Variable Name
+ ========================================================
+ KERNEL_IMAGE_BASE_NAME :term:`KERNEL_IMAGE_NAME`
+ KERNEL_IMAGE_SYMLINK_NAME :term:`KERNEL_IMAGE_LINK_NAME`
+ MODULE_TARBALL_BASE_NAME :term:`MODULE_TARBALL_NAME`
+ MODULE_TARBALL_SYMLINK_NAME :term:`MODULE_TARBALL_LINK_NAME`
+ INITRAMFS_BASE_NAME :term:`INITRAMFS_NAME`
+
+- The ``MODULE_IMAGE_BASE_NAME`` variable has been removed. The module
+ tarball name is now controlled directly with the
+ :term:`MODULE_TARBALL_NAME` variable.
+
+- The :term:`KERNEL_DTB_NAME` and
+ :term:`KERNEL_DTB_LINK_NAME` variables
+ have been introduced to control kernel Device Tree Binary (DTB)
+ artifact names instead of mangling ``KERNEL_IMAGE_*`` variables.
+
+- The :term:`KERNEL_FIT_NAME` and
+ :term:`KERNEL_FIT_LINK_NAME` variables
+ have been introduced to specify the name of flattened image tree
+ (FIT) kernel images similar to other deployed artifacts.
+
+- The :term:`MODULE_TARBALL_NAME` and
+ :term:`MODULE_TARBALL_LINK_NAME`
+ variable values no longer include the "module-" prefix or ".tgz"
+ suffix. These parts are now hardcoded so that the values are
+ consistent with other artifact naming variables.
+
+- Added the :term:`INITRAMFS_LINK_NAME`
+ variable so that the symlink can be controlled similarly to other
+ artifact types.
+
+- :term:`INITRAMFS_NAME` now uses
+ "${PKGE}-${PKGV}-${PKGR}-${MACHINE}${IMAGE_VERSION_SUFFIX}" instead
+ of "${PV}-${PR}-${MACHINE}-${DATETIME}", which makes it consistent
+ with other variables.
+
+.. _migration-2.6-serial-console-deprecated:
+
+``SERIAL_CONSOLE`` Deprecated
+-----------------------------
+
+The :term:`SERIAL_CONSOLE` variable has been
+functionally replaced by the
+:term:`SERIAL_CONSOLES` variable for some time.
+With the Yocto Project 2.6 release, ``SERIAL_CONSOLE`` has been
+officially deprecated.
+
+``SERIAL_CONSOLE`` will continue to work as before for the 2.6 release.
+However, for the sake of future compatibility, it is recommended that
+you replace all instances of ``SERIAL_CONSOLE`` with
+``SERIAL_CONSOLES``.
+
+.. note::
+
+ The only difference in usage is that
+ SERIAL_CONSOLES
+ expects entries to be separated using semicolons as compared to
+ SERIAL_CONSOLE
+ , which expects spaces.
+
+.. _migration-2.6-poky-sets-unknown-configure-option-to-qa-error:
+
+Configure Script Reports Unknown Options as Errors
+--------------------------------------------------
+
+If the configure script reports an unknown option, this now triggers a
+QA error instead of a warning. Any recipes that previously got away with
+specifying such unknown options now need to be fixed.
+
+.. _migration-2.6-override-changes:
+
+Override Changes
+----------------
+
+The following changes have occurred:
+
+- The ``virtclass-native`` and ``virtclass-nativesdk`` Overrides Have
+ Been Removed: The ``virtclass-native`` and ``virtclass-nativesdk``
+ overrides have been deprecated since 2012 in favor of
+ ``class-native`` and ``class-nativesdk``, respectively. Both
+ ``virtclass-native`` and ``virtclass-nativesdk`` are now dropped.
+
+ .. note::
+
+ The
+ virtclass-multilib-
+ overrides for multilib are still valid.
+
+- The ``forcevariable`` Override Now Has a Higher Priority Than
+ ``libc`` Overrides: The ``forcevariable`` override is documented to
+ be the highest priority override. However, due to a long-standing
+ quirk of how :term:`OVERRIDES` is set, the ``libc``
+ overrides (e.g. ``libc-glibc``, ``libc-musl``, and so forth)
+ erroneously had a higher priority. This issue is now corrected.
+
+ It is likely this change will not cause any problems. However, it is
+ possible with some unusual configurations that you might see a change
+ in behavior if you were relying on the previous behavior. Be sure to
+ check how you use ``forcevariable`` and ``libc-*`` overrides in your
+ custom layers and configuration files to ensure they make sense.
+
+- The ``build-${BUILD_OS}`` Override Has Been Removed: The
+ ``build-${BUILD_OS}``, which is typically ``build-linux``, override
+ has been removed because building on a host operating system other
+ than a recent version of Linux is neither supported nor recommended.
+ Dropping the override avoids giving the impression that other host
+ operating systems might be supported.
+
+- The "_remove" operator now preserves whitespace. Consequently, when
+ specifying list items to remove, be aware that leading and trailing
+ whitespace resulting from the removal is retained.
+
+ See the ":ref:`bitbake:removing-override-style-syntax`"
+ section in the BitBake User Manual for a detailed example.
+
+.. _migration-2.6-systemd-configuration-now-split-out-to-system-conf:
+
+``systemd`` Configuration is Now Split Into ``systemd-conf``
+------------------------------------------------------------
+
+The configuration for the ``systemd`` recipe has been moved into a
+``system-conf`` recipe. Moving this configuration to a separate recipe
+avoids the ``systemd`` recipe from becoming machine-specific for cases
+where machine-specific configurations need to be applied (e.g. for
+``qemu*`` machines).
+
+Currently, the new recipe packages the following files:
+::
+
+ ${sysconfdir}/machine-id
+ ${sysconfdir}/systemd/coredump.conf
+ ${sysconfdir}/systemd/journald.conf
+ ${sysconfdir}/systemd/logind.conf
+ ${sysconfdir}/systemd/system.conf
+ ${sysconfdir}/systemd/user.conf
+
+If you previously used bbappend files to append the ``systemd`` recipe to
+change any of the listed files, you must do so for the ``systemd-conf``
+recipe instead.
+
+.. _migration-2.6-automatic-testing-changes:
+
+Automatic Testing Changes
+-------------------------
+
+This section provides information about automatic testing changes:
+
+- ``TEST_IMAGE`` Variable Removed: Prior to this release, you set the
+ ``TEST_IMAGE`` variable to "1" to enable automatic testing for
+ successfully built images. The ``TEST_IMAGE`` variable no longer
+ exists and has been replaced by the
+ :term:`TESTIMAGE_AUTO` variable.
+
+- Inheriting the ``testimage`` and ``testsdk`` Classes: Best
+ practices now dictate that you use the
+ :term:`IMAGE_CLASSES` variable rather than the
+ :term:`INHERIT` variable when you inherit the
+ :ref:`testimage <ref-classes-testimage*>` and
+ :ref:`testsdk <ref-classes-testsdk>` classes used for automatic
+ testing.
+
+.. _migration-2.6-openssl-changes:
+
+OpenSSL Changes
+---------------
+
+`OpenSSL <https://www.openssl.org/>`__ has been upgraded from 1.0 to
+1.1. By default, this upgrade could cause problems for recipes that have
+both versions in their dependency chains. The problem is that both
+versions cannot be installed together at build time.
+
+.. note::
+
+ It is possible to have both versions of the library at runtime.
+
+.. _migration-2.6-bitbake-changes:
+
+BitBake Changes
+---------------
+
+The server logfile ``bitbake-cookerdaemon.log`` is now always placed in
+the :term:`Build Directory` instead of the current
+directory.
+
+.. _migration-2.6-security-changes:
+
+Security Changes
+----------------
+
+The Poky distribution now uses security compiler flags by default.
+Inclusion of these flags could cause new failures due to stricter
+checking for various potential security issues in code.
+
+.. _migration-2.6-post-installation-changes:
+
+Post Installation Changes
+-------------------------
+
+You must explicitly mark post installs to defer to the target. If you
+want to explicitly defer a postinstall to first boot on the target
+rather than at rootfs creation time, use ``pkg_postinst_ontarget()`` or
+call ``postinst_intercept delay_to_first_boot`` from ``pkg_postinst()``.
+Any failure of a ``pkg_postinst()`` script (including exit 1) triggers
+an error during the :ref:`ref-tasks-rootfs` task.
+
+For more information on post-installation behavior, see the
+":ref:`dev-manual/dev-manual-common-tasks:post-installation scripts`"
+section in the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual.
+
+.. _migration-2.6-python-3-profile-guided-optimizations:
+
+Python 3 Profile-Guided Optimization
+------------------------------------
+
+The ``python3`` recipe now enables profile-guided optimization. Using
+this optimization requires a little extra build time in exchange for
+improved performance on the target at runtime. Additionally, the
+optimization is only enabled if the current
+:term:`MACHINE` has support for user-mode emulation in
+QEMU (i.e. "qemu-usermode" is in
+:term:`MACHINE_FEATURES`, which it is by
+default).
+
+If you wish to disable Python profile-guided optimization regardless of
+the value of ``MACHINE_FEATURES``, then ensure that
+:term:`PACKAGECONFIG` for the ``python3`` recipe
+does not contain "pgo". You could accomplish the latter using the
+following at the configuration level:
+::
+
+ PACKAGECONFIG_remove_pn-python3 = "pgo"
+
+Alternatively, you can set ``PACKAGECONFIG`` using an append file
+for the ``python3`` recipe.
+
+.. _migration-2.6-miscellaneous-changes:
+
+Miscellaneous Changes
+---------------------
+
+The following miscellaneous changes occurred:
+
+- Default to using the Thumb-2 instruction set for armv7a and above. If
+ you have any custom recipes that build software that needs to be
+ built with the ARM instruction set, change the recipe to set the
+ instruction set as follows:
+ ::
+
+ ARM_INSTRUCTION_SET = "arm"
+
+- ``run-postinsts`` no longer uses ``/etc/*-postinsts`` for
+ ``dpkg/opkg`` in favor of built-in postinst support. RPM behavior
+ remains unchanged.
+
+- The ``NOISO`` and ``NOHDD`` variables are no longer used. You now
+ control building ``*.iso`` and ``*.hddimg`` image types directly by
+ using the :term:`IMAGE_FSTYPES` variable.
+
+- The ``scripts/contrib/mkefidisk.sh`` has been removed in favor of
+ Wic.
+
+- ``kernel-modules`` has been removed from
+ :term:`RRECOMMENDS` for ``qemumips`` and
+ ``qemumips64`` machines. Removal also impacts the ``x86-base.inc``
+ file.
+
+ .. note::
+
+ genericx86
+ and
+ genericx86-64
+ retain
+ kernel-modules
+ as part of the
+ RRECOMMENDS
+ variable setting.
+
+- The ``LGPLv2_WHITELIST_GPL-3.0`` variable has been removed. If you
+ are setting this variable in your configuration, set or append it to
+ the ``WHITELIST_GPL-3.0`` variable instead.
+
+- ``${ASNEEDED}`` is now included in the
+ :term:`TARGET_LDFLAGS` variable directly. The
+ remaining definitions from ``meta/conf/distro/include/as-needed.inc``
+ have been moved to corresponding recipes.
+
+- Support for DSA host keys has been dropped from the OpenSSH recipes.
+ If you are still using DSA keys, you must switch over to a more
+ secure algorithm as recommended by OpenSSH upstream.
+
+- The ``dhcp`` recipe now uses the ``dhcpd6.conf`` configuration file
+ in ``dhcpd6.service`` for IPv6 DHCP rather than re-using
+ ``dhcpd.conf``, which is now reserved for IPv4.
+
+
diff --git a/poky/documentation/ref-manual/migration-2.7.rst b/poky/documentation/ref-manual/migration-2.7.rst
new file mode 100644
index 000000000..7e628fc3e
--- /dev/null
+++ b/poky/documentation/ref-manual/migration-2.7.rst
@@ -0,0 +1,180 @@
+Moving to the Yocto Project 2.7 Release
+=======================================
+
+This section provides migration information for moving to the Yocto
+Project 2.7 Release from the prior release.
+
+.. _migration-2.7-bitbake-changes:
+
+BitBake Changes
+---------------
+
+The following changes have been made to BitBake:
+
+- BitBake now checks anonymous Python functions and pure Python
+ functions (e.g. ``def funcname:``) in the metadata for tab
+ indentation. If found, BitBake produces a warning.
+
+- Bitbake now checks
+ :term:`BBFILE_COLLECTIONS` for duplicate
+ entries and triggers an error if any are found.
+
+.. _migration-2.7-eclipse-support-dropped:
+
+Eclipse Support Removed
+-----------------------
+
+Support for the Eclipse IDE has been removed. Support continues for
+those releases prior to 2.7 that did include support. The 2.7 release
+does not include the Eclipse Yocto plugin.
+
+.. _migration-2.7-qemu-native-splits-system-and-user-mode-parts:
+
+``qemu-native`` Splits the System and User-Mode Parts
+-----------------------------------------------------
+
+The system and user-mode parts of ``qemu-native`` are now split.
+``qemu-native`` provides the user-mode components and
+``qemu-system-native`` provides the system components. If you have
+recipes that depend on QEMU's system emulation functionality at build
+time, they should now depend upon ``qemu-system-native`` instead of
+``qemu-native``.
+
+.. _migration-2.7-upstream-tracking.inc-removed:
+
+The ``upstream-tracking.inc`` File Has Been Removed
+---------------------------------------------------
+
+The previously deprecated ``upstream-tracking.inc`` file is now removed.
+Any ``UPSTREAM_TRACKING*`` variables are now set in the corresponding
+recipes instead.
+
+Remove any references you have to the ``upstream-tracking.inc`` file in
+your configuration.
+
+.. _migration-2.7-distro-features-libc-removed:
+
+The ``DISTRO_FEATURES_LIBC`` Variable Has Been Removed
+------------------------------------------------------
+
+The ``DISTRO_FEATURES_LIBC`` variable is no longer used. The ability to
+configure glibc using kconfig has been removed for quite some time
+making the ``libc-*`` features set no longer effective.
+
+Remove any references you have to ``DISTRO_FEATURES_LIBC`` in your own
+layers.
+
+.. _migration-2.7-license-values:
+
+License Value Corrections
+-------------------------
+
+The following corrections have been made to the
+:term:`LICENSE` values set by recipes:
+
+- *socat*: Corrected ``LICENSE`` to be "GPLv2" rather than "GPLv2+".
+- *libgfortran*: Set license to "GPL-3.0-with-GCC-exception".
+- *elfutils*: Removed "Elfutils-Exception" and set to "GPLv2" for shared libraries
+
+.. _migration-2.7-packaging-changes:
+
+Packaging Changes
+-----------------
+
+This section provides information about packaging changes.
+
+- ``bind``: The ``nsupdate`` binary has been moved to the
+ ``bind-utils`` package.
+
+- Debug split: The default debug split has been changed to create
+ separate source packages (i.e. package_name\ ``-dbg`` and
+ package_name\ ``-src``). If you are currently using ``dbg-pkgs`` in
+ :term:`IMAGE_FEATURES` to bring in debug
+ symbols and you still need the sources, you must now also add
+ ``src-pkgs`` to ``IMAGE_FEATURES``. Source packages remain in the
+ target portion of the SDK by default, unless you have set your own
+ value for :term:`SDKIMAGE_FEATURES` that
+ does not include ``src-pkgs``.
+
+- Mount all using ``util-linux``: ``/etc/default/mountall`` has moved
+ into the -mount sub-package.
+
+- Splitting binaries using ``util-linux``: ``util-linux`` now splits
+ each binary into its own package for fine-grained control. The main
+ ``util-linux`` package pulls in the individual binary packages using
+ the :term:`RRECOMMENDS` and
+ :term:`RDEPENDS` variables. As a result, existing
+ images should not see any changes assuming
+ :term:`NO_RECOMMENDATIONS` is not set.
+
+- ``netbase/base-files``: ``/etc/hosts`` has moved from ``netbase`` to
+ ``base-files``.
+
+- ``tzdata``: The main package has been converted to an empty meta
+ package that pulls in all ``tzdata`` packages by default.
+
+- ``lrzsz``: This package has been removed from
+ ``packagegroup-self-hosted`` and
+ ``packagegroup-core-tools-testapps``. The X/Y/ZModem support is less
+ likely to be needed on modern systems. If you are relying on these
+ packagegroups to include the ``lrzsz`` package in your image, you now
+ need to explicitly add the package.
+
+.. _migration-2.7-removed-recipes:
+
+Removed Recipes
+---------------
+
+The following recipes have been removed:
+
+- *gcc*: Drop version 7.3 recipes. Version 8.3 now remains.
+- *linux-yocto*: Drop versions 4.14 and 4.18 recipes. Versions 4.19 and 5.0 remain.
+- *go*: Drop version 1.9 recipes. Versions 1.11 and 1.12 remain.
+- *xvideo-tests*: Became obsolete.
+- *libart-lgpl*: Became obsolete.
+- *gtk-icon-utils-native*: These tools are now provided by gtk+3-native
+- *gcc-cross-initial*: No longer needed. gcc-cross/gcc-crosssdk is now used instead.
+- *gcc-crosssdk-initial*: No longer needed. gcc-cross/gcc-crosssdk is now used instead.
+- *glibc-initial*: Removed because the benefits of having it for site_config are currently outweighed by the cost of building the recipe.
+
+.. _migration-2.7-removed-classes:
+
+Removed Classes
+---------------
+
+The following classes have been removed:
+
+- *distutils-tools*: This class was never used.
+- *bugzilla.bbclass*: Became obsolete.
+- *distrodata*: This functionally has been replaced by a more modern tinfoil-based implementation.
+
+.. _migration-2.7-miscellaneous-changes:
+
+Miscellaneous Changes
+---------------------
+
+The following miscellaneous changes occurred:
+
+- The ``distro`` subdirectory of the Poky repository has been removed
+ from the top-level ``scripts`` directory.
+
+- Perl now builds for the target using
+ `perl-cross <http://arsv.github.io/perl-cross/>`_ for better
+ maintainability and improved build performance. This change should
+ not present any problems unless you have heavily customized your Perl
+ recipe.
+
+- ``arm-tunes``: Removed the "-march" option if mcpu is already added.
+
+- ``update-alternatives``: Convert file renames to
+ :term:`PACKAGE_PREPROCESS_FUNCS`
+
+- ``base/pixbufcache``: Obsolete ``sstatecompletions`` code has been
+ removed.
+
+- :ref:`native <ref-classes-native>` class:
+ :term:`RDEPENDS` handling has been enabled.
+
+- ``inetutils``: This recipe has rsh disabled.
+
+
diff --git a/poky/documentation/ref-manual/migration-3.0.rst b/poky/documentation/ref-manual/migration-3.0.rst
new file mode 100644
index 000000000..e1305dfcc
--- /dev/null
+++ b/poky/documentation/ref-manual/migration-3.0.rst
@@ -0,0 +1,321 @@
+Moving to the Yocto Project 3.0 Release
+=======================================
+
+This section provides migration information for moving to the Yocto
+Project 3.0 Release from the prior release.
+
+.. _migration-3.0-init-system-selection:
+
+Init System Selection
+---------------------
+
+Changing the init system manager previously required setting a number of
+different variables. You can now change the manager by setting the
+``INIT_MANAGER`` variable and the corresponding include files (i.e.
+``conf/distro/include/init-manager-*.conf``). Include files are provided
+for four values: "none", "sysvinit", "systemd", and "mdev-busybox". The
+default value, "none", for ``INIT_MANAGER`` should allow your current
+settings to continue working. However, it is advisable to explicitly set
+``INIT_MANAGER``.
+
+.. _migration-3.0-lsb-support-removed:
+
+LSB Support Removed
+-------------------
+
+Linux Standard Base (LSB) as a standard is not current, and is not well
+suited for embedded applications. Support can be continued in a separate
+layer if needed. However, presently LSB support has been removed from
+the core.
+
+As a result of this change, the ``poky-lsb`` derivative distribution
+configuration that was also used for testing alternative configurations
+has been replaced with a ``poky-altcfg`` distribution that has LSB parts
+removed.
+
+.. _migration-3.0-removed-recipes:
+
+Removed Recipes
+---------------
+
+The following recipes have been removed.
+
+- ``core-image-lsb-dev``: Part of removed LSB support.
+
+- ``core-image-lsb``: Part of removed LSB support.
+
+- ``core-image-lsb-sdk``: Part of removed LSB support.
+
+- ``cve-check-tool``: Functionally replaced by the ``cve-update-db``
+ recipe and ``cve-check`` class.
+
+- ``eglinfo``: No longer maintained. ``eglinfo`` from ``mesa-demos`` is
+ an adequate and maintained alternative.
+
+- ``gcc-8.3``: Version 8.3 removed. Replaced by 9.2.
+
+- ``gnome-themes-standard``: Only needed by gtk+ 2.x, which has been
+ removed.
+
+- ``gtk+``: GTK+ 2 is obsolete and has been replaced by gtk+3.
+
+- ``irda-utils``: Has become obsolete. IrDA support has been removed
+ from the Linux kernel in version 4.17 and later.
+
+- ``libnewt-python``: ``libnewt`` Python support merged into main
+ ``libnewt`` recipe.
+
+- ``libsdl``: Replaced by newer ``libsdl2``.
+
+- ``libx11-diet``: Became obsolete.
+
+- ``libxx86dga``: Removed obsolete client library.
+
+- ``libxx86misc``: Removed. Library is redundant.
+
+- ``linux-yocto``: Version 5.0 removed, which is now redundant (5.2 /
+ 4.19 present).
+
+- ``lsbinitscripts``: Part of removed LSB support.
+
+- ``lsb``: Part of removed LSB support.
+
+- ``lsbtest``: Part of removed LSB support.
+
+- ``openssl10``: Replaced by newer ``openssl`` version 1.1.
+
+- ``packagegroup-core-lsb``: Part of removed LSB support.
+
+- ``python-nose``: Removed the Python 2.x version of the recipe.
+
+- ``python-numpy``: Removed the Python 2.x version of the recipe.
+
+- ``python-scons``: Removed the Python 2.x version of the recipe.
+
+- ``source-highlight``: No longer needed.
+
+- ``stress``: Replaced by ``stress-ng``.
+
+- ``vulkan``: Split into ``vulkan-loader``, ``vulkan-headers``, and
+ ``vulkan-tools``.
+
+- ``weston-conf``: Functionality moved to ``weston-init``.
+
+.. _migration-3.0-packaging-changes:
+
+Packaging Changes
+-----------------
+
+The following packaging changes have occurred.
+
+- The `Epiphany <https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/GNOME_Web>`__ browser
+ has been dropped from ``packagegroup-self-hosted`` as it has not been
+ needed inside ``build-appliance-image`` for quite some time and was
+ causing resource problems.
+
+- ``libcap-ng`` Python support has been moved to a separate
+ ``libcap-ng-python`` recipe to streamline the build process when the
+ Python bindings are not needed.
+
+- ``libdrm`` now packages the file ``amdgpu.ids`` into a separate
+ ``libdrm-amdgpu`` package.
+
+- ``python3``: The ``runpy`` module is now in the ``python3-core``
+ package as it is required to support the common "python3 -m" command
+ usage.
+
+- ``distcc`` now provides separate ``distcc-client`` and
+ ``distcc-server`` packages as typically one or the other are needed,
+ rather than both.
+
+- ``python*-setuptools`` recipes now separately package the
+ ``pkg_resources`` module in a ``python-pkg-resources`` /
+ ``python3-pkg-resources`` package as the module is useful independent
+ of the rest of the setuptools package. The main ``python-setuptools``
+ / ``python3-setuptools`` package depends on this new package so you
+ should only need to update dependencies unless you want to take
+ advantage of the increased granularity.
+
+.. _migration-3.0-cve-checking:
+
+CVE Checking
+------------
+
+``cve-check-tool`` has been functionally replaced by a new
+``cve-update-db`` recipe and functionality built into the ``cve-check``
+class. The result uses NVD JSON data feeds rather than the deprecated
+XML feeds that ``cve-check-tool`` was using, supports CVSSv3 scoring,
+and makes other improvements.
+
+Additionally, the ``CVE_CHECK_CVE_WHITELIST`` variable has been replaced
+by ``CVE_CHECK_WHITELIST``.
+
+.. _migration-3.0-bitbake-changes:
+
+Bitbake Changes
+---------------
+
+The following BitBake changes have occurred.
+
+- ``addtask`` statements now properly validate dependent tasks.
+ Previously, an invalid task was silently ignored. With this change,
+ the invalid task generates a warning.
+
+- Other invalid ``addtask`` and ``deltask`` usages now trigger these
+ warnings: "multiple target tasks arguments with addtask / deltask",
+ and "multiple before/after clauses".
+
+- The "multiconfig" prefix is now shortened to "mc". "multiconfig" will
+ continue to work, however it may be removed in a future release.
+
+- The ``bitbake -g`` command no longer generates a
+ ``recipe-depends.dot`` file as the contents (i.e. a reprocessed
+ version of ``task-depends.dot``) were confusing.
+
+- The ``bb.build.FuncFailed`` exception, previously raised by
+ ``bb.build.exec_func()`` when certain other exceptions have occurred,
+ has been removed. The real underlying exceptions will be raised
+ instead. If you have calls to ``bb.build.exec_func()`` in custom
+ classes or ``tinfoil-using`` scripts, any references to
+ ``bb.build.FuncFailed`` should be cleaned up.
+
+- Additionally, the ``bb.build.exec_func()`` no longer accepts the
+ "pythonexception" parameter. The function now always raises
+ exceptions. Remove this argument in any calls to
+ ``bb.build.exec_func()`` in custom classes or scripts.
+
+- The
+ :term:`bitbake:BB_SETSCENE_VERIFY_FUNCTION2`
+ is no longer used. In the unlikely event that you have any references
+ to it, they should be removed.
+
+- The ``RunQueueExecuteScenequeue`` and ``RunQueueExecuteTasks`` events
+ have been removed since setscene tasks are now executed as part of
+ the normal runqueue. Any event handling code in custom classes or
+ scripts that handles these two events need to be updated.
+
+- The arguments passed to functions used with
+ :term:`bitbake:BB_HASHCHECK_FUNCTION`
+ have changed. If you are using your own custom hash check function,
+ see
+ http://git.yoctoproject.org/cgit/cgit.cgi/poky/commit/?id=40a5e193c4ba45c928fccd899415ea56b5417725
+ for details.
+
+- Task specifications in ``BB_TASKDEPDATA`` and class implementations
+ used in signature generator classes now use "<fn>:<task>" everywhere
+ rather than the "." delimiter that was being used in some places.
+ This change makes it consistent with all areas in the code. Custom
+ signature generator classes and code that reads ``BB_TASKDEPDATA``
+ need to be updated to use ':' as a separator rather than '.'.
+
+.. _migration-3.0-sanity-checks:
+
+Sanity Checks
+-------------
+
+The following sanity check changes occurred.
+
+- :term:`SRC_URI` is now checked for usage of two
+ problematic items:
+
+ - "${PN}" prefix/suffix use - Warnings always appear if ${PN} is
+ used. You must fix the issue regardless of whether multiconfig or
+ anything else that would cause prefixing/suffixing to happen.
+
+ - Github archive tarballs - these are not guaranteed to be stable.
+ Consequently, it is likely that the tarballs will be refreshed and
+ thus the SRC_URI checksums will fail to apply. It is recommended
+ that you fetch either an official release tarball or a specific
+ revision from the actual Git repository instead.
+
+ Either one of these items now trigger a warning by default. If you
+ wish to disable this check, remove ``src-uri-bad`` from
+ :term:`WARN_QA`.
+
+- The ``file-rdeps`` runtime dependency check no longer expands
+ :term:`RDEPENDS` recursively as there is no mechanism
+ to ensure they can be fully computed, and thus races sometimes result
+ in errors either showing up or not. Thus, you might now see errors
+ for missing runtime dependencies that were previously satisfied
+ recursively. Here is an example: package A contains a shell script
+ starting with ``#!/bin/bash`` but has no dependency on bash. However,
+ package A depends on package B, which does depend on bash. You need
+ to add the missing dependency or dependencies to resolve the warning.
+
+- Setting ``DEPENDS_${PN}`` anywhere (i.e. typically in a recipe) now
+ triggers an error. The error is triggered because
+ :term:`DEPENDS` is not a package-specific variable
+ unlike RDEPENDS. You should set ``DEPENDS`` instead.
+
+- systemd currently does not work well with the musl C library because
+ only upstream officially supports linking the library with glibc.
+ Thus, a warning is shown when building systemd in conjunction with
+ musl.
+
+.. _migration-3.0-miscellaneous-changes:
+
+Miscellaneous Changes
+---------------------
+
+The following miscellaneous changes have occurred.
+
+- The ``gnome`` class has been removed because it now does very little.
+ You should update recipes that previously inherited this class to do
+ the following: inherit gnomebase gtk-icon-cache gconf mime
+
+- The ``meta/recipes-kernel/linux/linux-dtb.inc`` file has been
+ removed. This file was previously deprecated in favor of setting
+ :term:`KERNEL_DEVICETREE` in any kernel
+ recipe and only produced a warning. Remove any ``include`` or
+ ``require`` statements pointing to this file.
+
+- :term:`TARGET_CFLAGS`,
+ :term:`TARGET_CPPFLAGS`,
+ :term:`TARGET_CXXFLAGS`, and
+ :term:`TARGET_LDFLAGS` are no longer exported
+ to the external environment. This change did not require any changes
+ to core recipes, which is a good indicator that no changes will be
+ required. However, if for some reason the software being built by one
+ of your recipes is expecting these variables to be set, then building
+ the recipe will fail. In such cases, you must either export the
+ variable or variables in the recipe or change the scripts so that
+ exporting is not necessary.
+
+- You must change the host distro identifier used in
+ :term:`NATIVELSBSTRING` to use all lowercase
+ characters even if it does not contain a version number. This change
+ is necessary only if you are not using ``uninative`` and
+ :term:`SANITY_TESTED_DISTROS`.
+
+- In the ``base-files`` recipe, writing the hostname into
+ ``/etc/hosts`` and ``/etc/hostname`` is now done within the main
+ :ref:`ref-tasks-install` function rather than in the
+ ``do_install_basefilesissue`` function. The reason for the change is
+ because ``do_install_basefilesissue`` is more easily overridden
+ without having to duplicate the hostname functionality. If you have
+ done the latter (e.g. in a ``base-files`` bbappend), then you should
+ remove it from your customized ``do_install_basefilesissue``
+ function.
+
+- The ``wic --expand`` command now uses commas to separate "key:value"
+ pairs rather than hyphens.
+
+ .. note::
+
+ The wic command-line help is not updated.
+
+ You must update any scripts or commands where you use
+ ``wic --expand`` with multiple "key:value" pairs.
+
+- UEFI image variable settings have been moved from various places to a
+ central ``conf/image-uefi.conf``. This change should not influence
+ any existing configuration as the ``meta/conf/image-uefi.conf`` in
+ the core metadata sets defaults that can be overridden in the same
+ manner as before.
+
+- ``conf/distro/include/world-broken.inc`` has been removed. For cases
+ where certain recipes need to be disabled when using the musl C
+ library, these recipes now have ``COMPATIBLE_HOST_libc-musl`` set
+ with a comment that explains why.
+
+
diff --git a/poky/documentation/ref-manual/migration-3.1.rst b/poky/documentation/ref-manual/migration-3.1.rst
new file mode 100644
index 000000000..92c8c7761
--- /dev/null
+++ b/poky/documentation/ref-manual/migration-3.1.rst
@@ -0,0 +1,276 @@
+Moving to the Yocto Project 3.1 Release
+=======================================
+
+This section provides migration information for moving to the Yocto
+Project 3.1 Release from the prior release.
+
+.. _migration-3.1-minimum-system-requirements:
+
+Minimum system requirements
+---------------------------
+
+The following versions / requirements of build host components have been
+updated:
+
+- gcc 5.0
+
+- python 3.5
+
+- tar 1.28
+
+- ``rpcgen`` is now required on the host (part of the ``libc-dev-bin``
+ package on Ubuntu, Debian and related distributions, and the
+ ``glibc`` package on RPM-based distributions).
+
+Additionally, the ``makeinfo`` and ``pod2man`` tools are *no longer*
+required on the host.
+
+.. _migration-3.1-mpc8315e-rdb-removed:
+
+mpc8315e-rdb machine removed
+----------------------------
+
+The MPC8315E-RDB machine is old/obsolete and unobtainable, thus given
+the maintenance burden the ``mpc8315e-rdb`` machine configuration that
+supported it has been removed in this release. The removal does leave a
+gap in official PowerPC reference hardware support; this may change in
+future if a suitable machine with accompanying support resources is
+found.
+
+.. _migration-3.1-python-2-removed:
+
+Python 2 removed
+----------------
+
+Due to the expiration of upstream support in January 2020, support for
+Python 2 has now been removed; it is recommended that you use Python 3
+instead. If absolutely needed there is a meta-python2 community layer
+containing Python 2, related classes and various Python 2-based modules,
+however it should not be considered as supported.
+
+.. _migration-3.1-reproducible-builds:
+
+Reproducible builds now enabled by default
+------------------------------------------
+
+In order to avoid unnecessary differences in output files (aiding binary
+reproducibility), the Poky distribution configuration
+(``DISTRO = "poky"``) now inherits the ``reproducible_build`` class by
+default.
+
+.. _migration-3.1-ptest-feature-impact:
+
+Impact of ptest feature is now more significant
+-----------------------------------------------
+
+The Poky distribution configuration (``DISTRO = "poky"``) enables ptests
+by default to enable runtime testing of various components. In this
+release, a dependency needed to be added that has resulted in a
+significant increase in the number of components that will be built just
+when building a simple image such as core-image-minimal. If you do not
+need runtime tests enabled for core components, then it is recommended
+that you remove "ptest" from
+:term:`DISTRO_FEATURES` to save a significant
+amount of build time e.g. by adding the following in your configuration:
+::
+
+ DISTRO_FEATURES_remove = "ptest"
+
+.. _migration-3.1-removed-recipes:
+
+Removed recipes
+---------------
+
+The following recipes have been removed:
+
+- ``chkconfig``: obsolete
+
+- ``console-tools``: obsolete
+
+- ``enchant``: replaced by ``enchant2``
+
+- ``foomatic-filters``: obsolete
+
+- ``libidn``: no longer needed, moved to meta-oe
+
+- ``libmodulemd``: replaced by ``libmodulemd-v1``
+
+- ``linux-yocto``: drop 4.19, 5.2 version recipes (5.4 now provided)
+
+- ``nspr``: no longer needed, moved to meta-oe
+
+- ``nss``: no longer needed, moved to meta-oe
+
+- ``python``: Python 2 removed (Python 3 preferred)
+
+- ``python-setuptools``: Python 2 version removed (python3-setuptools
+ preferred)
+
+- ``sysprof``: no longer needed, moved to meta-oe
+
+- ``texi2html``: obsolete
+
+- ``u-boot-fw-utils``: functionally replaced by ``libubootenv``
+
+.. _migration-3.1-features-check:
+
+features_check class replaces distro_features_check
+---------------------------------------------------
+
+The ``distro_features_check`` class has had its functionality expanded,
+now supporting ``ANY_OF_MACHINE_FEATURES``,
+``REQUIRED_MACHINE_FEATURES``, ``CONFLICT_MACHINE_FEATURES``,
+``ANY_OF_COMBINED_FEATURES``, ``REQUIRED_COMBINED_FEATURES``,
+``CONFLICT_COMBINED_FEATURES``. As a result the class has now been
+renamed to ``features_check``; the ``distro_features_check`` class still
+exists but generates a warning and redirects to the new class. In
+preparation for a future removal of the old class it is recommended that
+you update recipes currently inheriting ``distro_features_check`` to
+inherit ``features_check`` instead.
+
+.. _migration-3.1-removed-classes:
+
+Removed classes
+---------------
+
+The following classes have been removed:
+
+- ``distutils-base``: moved to meta-python2
+
+- ``distutils``: moved to meta-python2
+
+- ``libc-common``: merged into the glibc recipe as nothing else used
+ it.
+
+- ``python-dir``: moved to meta-python2
+
+- ``pythonnative``: moved to meta-python2
+
+- ``setuptools``: moved to meta-python2
+
+- ``tinderclient``: dropped as it was obsolete.
+
+.. _migration-3.1-src-uri-checksums:
+
+SRC_URI checksum behaviour
+--------------------------
+
+Previously, recipes by tradition included both SHA256 and MD5 checksums
+for remotely fetched files in :term:`SRC_URI`, even
+though only one is actually mandated. However, the MD5 checksum does not
+add much given its inherent weakness; thus when a checksum fails only
+the SHA256 sum will now be printed. The md5sum will still be verified if
+it is specified.
+
+.. _migration-3.1-npm:
+
+npm fetcher changes
+-------------------
+
+The npm fetcher has been completely reworked in this release. The npm
+fetcher now only fetches the package source itself and no longer the
+dependencies; there is now also an npmsw fetcher which explicitly
+fetches the shrinkwrap file and the dependencies. This removes the
+slightly awkward ``NPM_LOCKDOWN`` and ``NPM_SHRINKWRAP`` variables which
+pointed to local files; the lockdown file is no longer needed at all.
+Additionally, the package name in ``npm://`` entries in
+:term:`SRC_URI` is now specified using a ``package``
+parameter instead of the earlier ``name`` which overlapped with the
+generic ``name`` parameter. All recipes using the npm fetcher will need
+to be changed as a result.
+
+An example of the new scheme: ::
+
+ SRC_URI = "npm://registry.npmjs.org;package=array-flatten;version=1.1.1 \\
+ npmsw://${THISDIR}/npm-shrinkwrap.json"
+
+Another example where the sources are fetched from git rather than an npm repository: ::
+
+ SRC_URI = "git://github.com/foo/bar.git;protocol=https \
+ npmsw://${THISDIR}/npm-shrinkwrap.json"
+
+devtool and recipetool have also been updated to match with the npm
+fetcher changes. Other than producing working and more complete recipes
+for npm sources, there is also a minor change to the command line for
+devtool: the ``--fetch-dev`` option has been renamed to ``--npm-dev`` as
+it is npm-specific.
+
+.. _migration-3.1-packaging-changes:
+
+Packaging changes
+-----------------
+
+- ``intltool`` has been removed from ``packagegroup-core-sdk`` as it is
+ rarely needed to build modern software - gettext can do most of the
+ things it used to be needed for. ``intltool`` has also been removed
+ from ``packagegroup-core-self-hosted`` as it is not needed to for
+ standard builds.
+
+- git: ``git-am``, ``git-difftool``, ``git-submodule``, and
+ ``git-request-pull`` are no longer perl-based, so are now installed
+ with the main ``git`` package instead of within ``git-perltools``.
+
+- The ``ldconfig`` binary built as part of glibc has now been moved to
+ its own ``ldconfig`` package (note no ``glibc-`` prefix). This
+ package is in the :term:`RRECOMMENDS` of the main
+ ``glibc`` package if ``ldconfig`` is present in
+ :term:`DISTRO_FEATURES`.
+
+- ``libevent`` now splits each shared library into its own package (as
+ Debian does). Since these are shared libraries and will be pulled in
+ through the normal shared library dependency handling, there should
+ be no impact to existing configurations other than less unnecessary
+ libraries being installed in some cases.
+
+- linux-firmware now has a new package for ``bcm4366c`` and includes
+ available NVRAM config files into the ``bcm43340``, ``bcm43362``,
+ ``bcm43430`` and ``bcm4356-pcie`` packages.
+
+- ``harfbuzz`` now splits the new ``libharfbuzz-subset.so`` library
+ into its own package to reduce the main package size in cases where
+ ``libharfbuzz-subset.so`` is not needed.
+
+.. _migration-3.1-package-qa-warnings:
+
+Additional warnings
+-------------------
+
+Warnings will now be shown at ``do_package_qa`` time in the following
+circumstances:
+
+- A recipe installs ``.desktop`` files containing ``MimeType`` keys but
+ does not inherit the new ``mime-xdg`` class
+
+- A recipe installs ``.xml`` files into ``${datadir}/mime/packages``
+ but does not inherit the ``mime`` class
+
+.. _migration-3.1-x86-live-wic:
+
+``wic`` image type now used instead of ``live`` by default for x86
+------------------------------------------------------------------
+
+``conf/machine/include/x86-base.inc`` (inherited by most x86 machine
+configurations) now specifies ``wic`` instead of ``live`` by default in
+:term:`IMAGE_FSTYPES`. The ``live`` image type will
+likely be removed in a future release so it is recommended that you use
+``wic`` instead.
+
+.. _migration-3.1-misc:
+
+Miscellaneous changes
+---------------------
+
+- The undocumented ``SRC_DISTRIBUTE_LICENSES`` variable has now been
+ removed in favour of a new ``AVAILABLE_LICENSES`` variable which is
+ dynamically set based upon license files found in
+ ``${COMMON_LICENSE_DIR}`` and ``${LICENSE_PATH}``.
+
+- The tune definition for big-endian microblaze machines is now
+ ``microblaze`` instead of ``microblazeeb``.
+
+- ``newlib`` no longer has built-in syscalls. ``libgloss`` should then
+ provide the syscalls, ``crt0.o`` and other functions that are no
+ longer part of ``newlib`` itself. If you are using
+ ``TCLIBC = "newlib"`` this now means that you must link applications
+ with both ``newlib`` and ``libgloss``, whereas before ``newlib``
+ would run in many configurations by itself.
diff --git a/poky/documentation/ref-manual/migration-general.rst b/poky/documentation/ref-manual/migration-general.rst
new file mode 100644
index 000000000..182482ec4
--- /dev/null
+++ b/poky/documentation/ref-manual/migration-general.rst
@@ -0,0 +1,54 @@
+General Migration Considerations
+================================
+
+Some considerations are not tied to a specific Yocto Project release.
+This section presents information you should consider when migrating to
+any new Yocto Project release.
+
+- *Dealing with Customized Recipes*:
+
+ Issues could arise if you take
+ older recipes that contain customizations and simply copy them
+ forward expecting them to work after you migrate to new Yocto Project
+ metadata. For example, suppose you have a recipe in your layer that
+ is a customized version of a core recipe copied from the earlier
+ release, rather than through the use of an append file. When you
+ migrate to a newer version of Yocto Project, the metadata (e.g.
+ perhaps an include file used by the recipe) could have changed in a
+ way that would break the build. Say, for example, a function is
+ removed from an include file and the customized recipe tries to call
+ that function.
+
+ You could "forward-port" all your customizations in your recipe so
+ that everything works for the new release. However, this is not the
+ optimal solution as you would have to repeat this process with each
+ new release if changes occur that give rise to problems.
+
+ The better solution (where practical) is to use append files
+ (``*.bbappend``) to capture any customizations you want to make to a
+ recipe. Doing so, isolates your changes from the main recipe making
+ them much more manageable. However, sometimes it is not practical to
+ use an append file. A good example of this is when introducing a
+ newer or older version of a recipe in another layer.
+
+- *Updating Append Files*:
+
+ Since append files generally only contain
+ your customizations, they often do not need to be adjusted for new
+ releases. However, if the ``.bbappend`` file is specific to a
+ particular version of the recipe (i.e. its name does not use the %
+ wildcard) and the version of the recipe to which it is appending has
+ changed, then you will at a minimum need to rename the append file to
+ match the name of the recipe file. A mismatch between an append file
+ and its corresponding recipe file (``.bb``) will trigger an error
+ during parsing.
+
+ Depending on the type of customization the append file applies, other
+ incompatibilities might occur when you upgrade. For example, if your
+ append file applies a patch and the recipe to which it is appending
+ is updated to a newer version, the patch might no longer apply. If
+ this is the case and assuming the patch is still needed, you must
+ modify the patch file so that it does apply.
+
+
+
diff --git a/poky/documentation/ref-manual/migration.rst b/poky/documentation/ref-manual/migration.rst
new file mode 100644
index 000000000..6c6119dae
--- /dev/null
+++ b/poky/documentation/ref-manual/migration.rst
@@ -0,0 +1,30 @@
+.. SPDX-License-Identifier: CC-BY-2.0-UK
+
+******************************************
+Migrating to a Newer Yocto Project Release
+******************************************
+
+This chapter provides information you can use to migrate work to a newer
+Yocto Project release. You can find the same information in the release
+notes for a given release.
+
+.. toctree::
+
+ migration-general
+ migration-1.3
+ migration-1.4
+ migration-1.5
+ migration-1.6
+ migration-1.7
+ migration-1.8
+ migration-2.0
+ migration-2.1
+ migration-2.2
+ migration-2.3
+ migration-2.4
+ migration-2.5
+ migration-2.6
+ migration-2.7
+ migration-3.0
+ migration-3.1
+
diff --git a/poky/documentation/ref-manual/ref-classes.rst b/poky/documentation/ref-manual/ref-classes.rst
new file mode 100644
index 000000000..60ce8efd2
--- /dev/null
+++ b/poky/documentation/ref-manual/ref-classes.rst
@@ -0,0 +1,2963 @@
+.. SPDX-License-Identifier: CC-BY-2.0-UK
+
+*******
+Classes
+*******
+
+Class files are used to abstract common functionality and share it
+amongst multiple recipe (``.bb``) files. To use a class file, you simply
+make sure the recipe inherits the class. In most cases, when a recipe
+inherits a class it is enough to enable its features. There are cases,
+however, where in the recipe you might need to set variables or override
+some default behavior.
+
+Any :term:`Metadata` usually found in a recipe can also be
+placed in a class file. Class files are identified by the extension
+``.bbclass`` and are usually placed in a ``classes/`` directory beneath
+the ``meta*/`` directory found in the :term:`Source Directory`.
+Class files can also be pointed to by
+:term:`BUILDDIR` (e.g. ``build/``) in the same way as
+``.conf`` files in the ``conf`` directory. Class files are searched for
+in :term:`BBPATH` using the same method by which ``.conf``
+files are searched.
+
+This chapter discusses only the most useful and important classes. Other
+classes do exist within the ``meta/classes`` directory in the Source
+Directory. You can reference the ``.bbclass`` files directly for more
+information.
+
+.. _ref-classes-allarch:
+
+``allarch.bbclass``
+===================
+
+The ``allarch`` class is inherited by recipes that do not produce
+architecture-specific output. The class disables functionality that is
+normally needed for recipes that produce executable binaries (such as
+building the cross-compiler and a C library as pre-requisites, and
+splitting out of debug symbols during packaging).
+
+.. note::
+
+ Unlike some distro recipes (e.g. Debian), OpenEmbedded recipes that
+ produce packages that depend on tunings through use of the
+ :term:`RDEPENDS` and
+ :term:`TUNE_PKGARCH` variables, should never be
+ configured for all architectures using ``allarch``. This is the case
+ even if the recipes do not produce architecture-specific output.
+
+ Configuring such recipes for all architectures causes the
+ ```do_package_write_*`` tasks to
+ have different signatures for the machines with different tunings.
+ Additionally, unnecessary rebuilds occur every time an image for a
+ different ``MACHINE`` is built even when the recipe never changes.
+
+By default, all recipes inherit the :ref:`base <ref-classes-base>` and
+:ref:`package <ref-classes-package>` classes, which enable
+functionality needed for recipes that produce executable output. If your
+recipe, for example, only produces packages that contain configuration
+files, media files, or scripts (e.g. Python and Perl), then it should
+inherit the ``allarch`` class.
+
+.. _ref-classes-archiver:
+
+``archiver.bbclass``
+====================
+
+The ``archiver`` class supports releasing source code and other
+materials with the binaries.
+
+For more details on the source archiver, see the
+":ref:`dev-manual/dev-manual-common-tasks:maintaining open source license compliance during your product's lifecycle`"
+section in the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual. You can also see
+the :term:`ARCHIVER_MODE` variable for information
+about the variable flags (varflags) that help control archive creation.
+
+.. _ref-classes-autotools:
+
+``autotools*.bbclass``
+======================
+
+The ``autotools*`` classes support Autotooled packages.
+
+The ``autoconf``, ``automake``, and ``libtool`` packages bring
+standardization. This class defines a set of tasks (e.g. ``configure``,
+``compile`` and so forth) that work for all Autotooled packages. It
+should usually be enough to define a few standard variables and then
+simply ``inherit autotools``. These classes can also work with software
+that emulates Autotools. For more information, see the
+":ref:`new-recipe-autotooled-package`" section
+in the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual.
+
+By default, the ``autotools*`` classes use out-of-tree builds (i.e.
+``autotools.bbclass`` building with ``B != S``).
+
+If the software being built by a recipe does not support using
+out-of-tree builds, you should have the recipe inherit the
+``autotools-brokensep`` class. The ``autotools-brokensep`` class behaves
+the same as the ``autotools`` class but builds with :term:`B`
+== :term:`S`. This method is useful when out-of-tree build
+support is either not present or is broken.
+
+.. note::
+
+ It is recommended that out-of-tree support be fixed and used if at
+ all possible.
+
+It's useful to have some idea of how the tasks defined by the
+``autotools*`` classes work and what they do behind the scenes.
+
+- :ref:`ref-tasks-configure` - Regenerates the
+ configure script (using ``autoreconf``) and then launches it with a
+ standard set of arguments used during cross-compilation. You can pass
+ additional parameters to ``configure`` through the ``EXTRA_OECONF``
+ or :term:`PACKAGECONFIG_CONFARGS`
+ variables.
+
+- :ref:`ref-tasks-compile` - Runs ``make`` with
+ arguments that specify the compiler and linker. You can pass
+ additional arguments through the ``EXTRA_OEMAKE`` variable.
+
+- :ref:`ref-tasks-install` - Runs ``make install`` and
+ passes in ``${``\ :term:`D`\ ``}`` as ``DESTDIR``.
+
+.. _ref-classes-base:
+
+``base.bbclass``
+================
+
+The ``base`` class is special in that every ``.bb`` file implicitly
+inherits the class. This class contains definitions for standard basic
+tasks such as fetching, unpacking, configuring (empty by default),
+compiling (runs any ``Makefile`` present), installing (empty by default)
+and packaging (empty by default). These classes are often overridden or
+extended by other classes such as the
+:ref:`autotools <ref-classes-autotools>` class or the
+:ref:`package <ref-classes-package>` class.
+
+The class also contains some commonly used functions such as
+``oe_runmake``, which runs ``make`` with the arguments specified in
+:term:`EXTRA_OEMAKE` variable as well as the
+arguments passed directly to ``oe_runmake``.
+
+.. _ref-classes-bash-completion:
+
+``bash-completion.bbclass``
+===========================
+
+Sets up packaging and dependencies appropriate for recipes that build
+software that includes bash-completion data.
+
+.. _ref-classes-bin-package:
+
+``bin_package.bbclass``
+=======================
+
+The ``bin_package`` class is a helper class for recipes that extract the
+contents of a binary package (e.g. an RPM) and install those contents
+rather than building the binary from source. The binary package is
+extracted and new packages in the configured output package format are
+created. Extraction and installation of proprietary binaries is a good
+example use for this class.
+
+.. note::
+
+ For RPMs and other packages that do not contain a subdirectory, you
+ should specify an appropriate fetcher parameter to point to the
+ subdirectory. For example, if BitBake is using the Git fetcher (
+ git://
+ ), the "subpath" parameter limits the checkout to a specific subpath
+ of the tree. Here is an example where
+ ${BP}
+ is used so that the files are extracted into the subdirectory
+ expected by the default value of
+ S
+ :
+ ::
+
+ SRC_URI = "git://example.com/downloads/somepackage.rpm;subpath=${BP}"
+
+
+ See the "
+ Fetchers
+ " section in the BitBake User Manual for more information on
+ supported BitBake Fetchers.
+
+.. _ref-classes-binconfig:
+
+``binconfig.bbclass``
+=====================
+
+The ``binconfig`` class helps to correct paths in shell scripts.
+
+Before ``pkg-config`` had become widespread, libraries shipped shell
+scripts to give information about the libraries and include paths needed
+to build software (usually named ``LIBNAME-config``). This class assists
+any recipe using such scripts.
+
+During staging, the OpenEmbedded build system installs such scripts into
+the ``sysroots/`` directory. Inheriting this class results in all paths
+in these scripts being changed to point into the ``sysroots/`` directory
+so that all builds that use the script use the correct directories for
+the cross compiling layout. See the
+:term:`BINCONFIG_GLOB` variable for more
+information.
+
+.. _ref-classes-binconfig-disabled:
+
+``binconfig-disabled.bbclass``
+==============================
+
+An alternative version of the :ref:`binconfig <ref-classes-binconfig>`
+class, which disables binary configuration scripts by making them return
+an error in favor of using ``pkg-config`` to query the information. The
+scripts to be disabled should be specified using the
+:term:`BINCONFIG` variable within the recipe inheriting
+the class.
+
+.. _ref-classes-blacklist:
+
+``blacklist.bbclass``
+=====================
+
+The ``blacklist`` class prevents the OpenEmbedded build system from
+building specific recipes (blacklists them). To use this class, inherit
+the class globally and set :term:`PNBLACKLIST` for
+each recipe you wish to blacklist. Specify the :term:`PN`
+value as a variable flag (varflag) and provide a reason, which is
+reported, if the package is requested to be built as the value. For
+example, if you want to blacklist a recipe called "exoticware", you add
+the following to your ``local.conf`` or distribution configuration:
+::
+
+ INHERIT += "blacklist"
+ PNBLACKLIST[exoticware] = "Not supported by our organization."
+
+.. _ref-classes-buildhistory:
+
+``buildhistory.bbclass``
+========================
+
+The ``buildhistory`` class records a history of build output metadata,
+which can be used to detect possible regressions as well as used for
+analysis of the build output. For more information on using Build
+History, see the
+":ref:`dev-manual/dev-manual-common-tasks:maintaining build output quality`"
+section in the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual.
+
+.. _ref-classes-buildstats:
+
+``buildstats.bbclass``
+======================
+
+The ``buildstats`` class records performance statistics about each task
+executed during the build (e.g. elapsed time, CPU usage, and I/O usage).
+
+When you use this class, the output goes into the
+:term:`BUILDSTATS_BASE` directory, which defaults
+to ``${TMPDIR}/buildstats/``. You can analyze the elapsed time using
+``scripts/pybootchartgui/pybootchartgui.py``, which produces a cascading
+chart of the entire build process and can be useful for highlighting
+bottlenecks.
+
+Collecting build statistics is enabled by default through the
+:term:`USER_CLASSES` variable from your
+``local.conf`` file. Consequently, you do not have to do anything to
+enable the class. However, if you want to disable the class, simply
+remove "buildstats" from the ``USER_CLASSES`` list.
+
+.. _ref-classes-buildstats-summary:
+
+``buildstats-summary.bbclass``
+==============================
+
+When inherited globally, prints statistics at the end of the build on
+sstate re-use. In order to function, this class requires the
+:ref:`buildstats <ref-classes-buildstats>` class be enabled.
+
+.. _ref-classes-ccache:
+
+``ccache.bbclass``
+==================
+
+The ``ccache`` class enables the C/C++ Compiler Cache for the build.
+This class is used to give a minor performance boost during the build.
+However, using the class can lead to unexpected side-effects. Thus, it
+is recommended that you do not use this class. See
+http://ccache.samba.org/ for information on the C/C++ Compiler
+Cache.
+
+.. _ref-classes-chrpath:
+
+``chrpath.bbclass``
+===================
+
+The ``chrpath`` class is a wrapper around the "chrpath" utility, which
+is used during the build process for ``nativesdk``, ``cross``, and
+``cross-canadian`` recipes to change ``RPATH`` records within binaries
+in order to make them relocatable.
+
+.. _ref-classes-clutter:
+
+``clutter.bbclass``
+===================
+
+The ``clutter`` class consolidates the major and minor version naming
+and other common items used by Clutter and related recipes.
+
+.. note::
+
+ Unlike some other classes related to specific libraries, recipes
+ building other software that uses Clutter do not need to inherit this
+ class unless they use the same recipe versioning scheme that the
+ Clutter and related recipes do.
+
+.. _ref-classes-cmake:
+
+``cmake.bbclass``
+=================
+
+The ``cmake`` class allows for recipes that need to build software using
+the `CMake <https://cmake.org/overview/>`__ build system. You can use
+the :term:`EXTRA_OECMAKE` variable to specify
+additional configuration options to be passed using the ``cmake``
+command line.
+
+On the occasion that you would be installing custom CMake toolchain
+files supplied by the application being built, you should install them
+to the preferred CMake Module directory: ``${D}${datadir}/cmake/``
+Modules during
+:ref:`ref-tasks-install`.
+
+.. _ref-classes-cml1:
+
+``cml1.bbclass``
+================
+
+The ``cml1`` class provides basic support for the Linux kernel style
+build configuration system.
+
+.. _ref-classes-compress_doc:
+
+``compress_doc.bbclass``
+========================
+
+Enables compression for man pages and info pages. This class is intended
+to be inherited globally. The default compression mechanism is gz (gzip)
+but you can select an alternative mechanism by setting the
+:term:`DOC_COMPRESS` variable.
+
+.. _ref-classes-copyleft_compliance:
+
+``copyleft_compliance.bbclass``
+===============================
+
+The ``copyleft_compliance`` class preserves source code for the purposes
+of license compliance. This class is an alternative to the ``archiver``
+class and is still used by some users even though it has been deprecated
+in favor of the :ref:`archiver <ref-classes-archiver>` class.
+
+.. _ref-classes-copyleft_filter:
+
+``copyleft_filter.bbclass``
+===========================
+
+A class used by the :ref:`archiver <ref-classes-archiver>` and
+:ref:`copyleft_compliance <ref-classes-copyleft_compliance>` classes
+for filtering licenses. The ``copyleft_filter`` class is an internal
+class and is not intended to be used directly.
+
+.. _ref-classes-core-image:
+
+``core-image.bbclass``
+======================
+
+The ``core-image`` class provides common definitions for the
+``core-image-*`` image recipes, such as support for additional
+:term:`IMAGE_FEATURES`.
+
+.. _ref-classes-cpan:
+
+``cpan*.bbclass``
+=================
+
+The ``cpan*`` classes support Perl modules.
+
+Recipes for Perl modules are simple. These recipes usually only need to
+point to the source's archive and then inherit the proper class file.
+Building is split into two methods depending on which method the module
+authors used.
+
+- Modules that use old ``Makefile.PL``-based build system require
+ ``cpan.bbclass`` in their recipes.
+
+- Modules that use ``Build.PL``-based build system require using
+ ``cpan_build.bbclass`` in their recipes.
+
+Both build methods inherit the ``cpan-base`` class for basic Perl
+support.
+
+.. _ref-classes-cross:
+
+``cross.bbclass``
+=================
+
+The ``cross`` class provides support for the recipes that build the
+cross-compilation tools.
+
+.. _ref-classes-cross-canadian:
+
+``cross-canadian.bbclass``
+==========================
+
+The ``cross-canadian`` class provides support for the recipes that build
+the Canadian Cross-compilation tools for SDKs. See the
+":ref:`overview-manual/overview-manual-concepts:cross-development toolchain generation`"
+section in the Yocto Project Overview and Concepts Manual for more
+discussion on these cross-compilation tools.
+
+.. _ref-classes-crosssdk:
+
+``crosssdk.bbclass``
+====================
+
+The ``crosssdk`` class provides support for the recipes that build the
+cross-compilation tools used for building SDKs. See the
+":ref:`overview-manual/overview-manual-concepts:cross-development toolchain generation`"
+section in the Yocto Project Overview and Concepts Manual for more
+discussion on these cross-compilation tools.
+
+.. _ref-classes-debian:
+
+``debian.bbclass``
+==================
+
+The ``debian`` class renames output packages so that they follow the
+Debian naming policy (i.e. ``glibc`` becomes ``libc6`` and
+``glibc-devel`` becomes ``libc6-dev``.) Renaming includes the library
+name and version as part of the package name.
+
+If a recipe creates packages for multiple libraries (shared object files
+of ``.so`` type), use the :term:`LEAD_SONAME`
+variable in the recipe to specify the library on which to apply the
+naming scheme.
+
+.. _ref-classes-deploy:
+
+``deploy.bbclass``
+==================
+
+The ``deploy`` class handles deploying files to the
+:term:`DEPLOY_DIR_IMAGE` directory. The main
+function of this class is to allow the deploy step to be accelerated by
+shared state. Recipes that inherit this class should define their own
+:ref:`ref-tasks-deploy` function to copy the files to be
+deployed to :term:`DEPLOYDIR`, and use ``addtask`` to
+add the task at the appropriate place, which is usually after
+:ref:`ref-tasks-compile` or
+:ref:`ref-tasks-install`. The class then takes care of
+staging the files from ``DEPLOYDIR`` to ``DEPLOY_DIR_IMAGE``.
+
+.. _ref-classes-devshell:
+
+``devshell.bbclass``
+====================
+
+The ``devshell`` class adds the ``do_devshell`` task. Distribution
+policy dictates whether to include this class. See the ":ref:`platdev-appdev-devshell`"
+section in the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual for more
+information about using ``devshell``.
+
+.. _ref-classes-devupstream:
+
+``devupstream.bbclass``
+=======================
+
+The ``devupstream`` class uses
+:term:`BBCLASSEXTEND` to add a variant of the
+recipe that fetches from an alternative URI (e.g. Git) instead of a
+tarball. Following is an example:
+::
+
+ BBCLASSEXTEND = "devupstream:target"
+ SRC_URI_class-devupstream = "git://git.example.com/example"
+ SRCREV_class-devupstream = "abcd1234"
+
+Adding the above statements to your recipe creates a variant that has
+:term:`DEFAULT_PREFERENCE` set to "-1".
+Consequently, you need to select the variant of the recipe to use it.
+Any development-specific adjustments can be done by using the
+``class-devupstream`` override. Here is an example:
+::
+
+ DEPENDS_append_class-devupstream = " gperf-native"
+ do_configure_prepend_class-devupstream() {
+ touch ${S}/README
+ }
+
+The class
+currently only supports creating a development variant of the target
+recipe, not ``native`` or ``nativesdk`` variants.
+
+The ``BBCLASSEXTEND`` syntax (i.e. ``devupstream:target``) provides
+support for ``native`` and ``nativesdk`` variants. Consequently, this
+functionality can be added in a future release.
+
+Support for other version control systems such as Subversion is limited
+due to BitBake's automatic fetch dependencies (e.g.
+``subversion-native``).
+
+.. _ref-classes-distro_features_check:
+
+``distro_features_check.bbclass``
+=================================
+
+The ``distro_features_check`` class allows individual recipes to check
+for required and conflicting
+:term:`DISTRO_FEATURES`.
+
+This class provides support for the
+:term:`REQUIRED_DISTRO_FEATURES` and
+:term:`CONFLICT_DISTRO_FEATURES`
+variables. If any conditions specified in the recipe using the above
+variables are not met, the recipe will be skipped.
+
+.. _ref-classes-distutils:
+
+``distutils*.bbclass``
+======================
+
+The ``distutils*`` classes support recipes for Python version 2.x
+extensions, which are simple. These recipes usually only need to point
+to the source's archive and then inherit the proper class. Building is
+split into two methods depending on which method the module authors
+used.
+
+- Extensions that use an Autotools-based build system require Autotools
+ and the classes based on ``distutils`` in their recipes.
+
+- Extensions that use build systems based on ``distutils`` require the
+ ``distutils`` class in their recipes.
+
+- Extensions that use build systems based on ``setuptools`` require the
+ :ref:`setuptools <ref-classes-setuptools>` class in their recipes.
+
+The ``distutils-common-base`` class is required by some of the
+``distutils*`` classes to provide common Python2 support.
+
+.. _ref-classes-distutils3:
+
+``distutils3*.bbclass``
+=======================
+
+The ``distutils3*`` classes support recipes for Python version 3.x
+extensions, which are simple. These recipes usually only need to point
+to the source's archive and then inherit the proper class. Building is
+split into three methods depending on which method the module authors
+used.
+
+- Extensions that use an Autotools-based build system require Autotools
+ and ``distutils``-based classes in their recipes.
+
+- Extensions that use ``distutils``-based build systems require the
+ ``distutils`` class in their recipes.
+
+- Extensions that use build systems based on ``setuptools3`` require
+ the :ref:`setuptools3 <ref-classes-setuptools>` class in their
+ recipes.
+
+The ``distutils3*`` classes either inherit their corresponding
+``distutils*`` class or replicate them using a Python3 version instead
+(e.g. ``distutils3-base`` inherits ``distutils-common-base``, which is
+the same as ``distutils-base`` but inherits ``python3native`` instead of
+``pythonnative``).
+
+.. _ref-classes-externalsrc:
+
+``externalsrc.bbclass``
+=======================
+
+The ``externalsrc`` class supports building software from source code
+that is external to the OpenEmbedded build system. Building software
+from an external source tree means that the build system's normal fetch,
+unpack, and patch process is not used.
+
+By default, the OpenEmbedded build system uses the :term:`S`
+and :term:`B` variables to locate unpacked recipe source code
+and to build it, respectively. When your recipe inherits the
+``externalsrc`` class, you use the
+:term:`EXTERNALSRC` and
+:term:`EXTERNALSRC_BUILD` variables to
+ultimately define ``S`` and ``B``.
+
+By default, this class expects the source code to support recipe builds
+that use the :term:`B` variable to point to the directory in
+which the OpenEmbedded build system places the generated objects built
+from the recipes. By default, the ``B`` directory is set to the
+following, which is separate from the source directory (``S``):
+::
+
+ ${WORKDIR}/${BPN}/{PV}/
+
+See these variables for more information:
+:term:`WORKDIR`, :term:`BPN`, and
+:term:`PV`,
+
+For more information on the ``externalsrc`` class, see the comments in
+``meta/classes/externalsrc.bbclass`` in the :term:`Source Directory`.
+For information on how to use the
+``externalsrc`` class, see the
+":ref:`dev-manual/dev-manual-common-tasks:building software from an external source`"
+section in the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual.
+
+.. _ref-classes-extrausers:
+
+``extrausers.bbclass``
+======================
+
+The ``extrausers`` class allows additional user and group configuration
+to be applied at the image level. Inheriting this class either globally
+or from an image recipe allows additional user and group operations to
+be performed using the
+:term:`EXTRA_USERS_PARAMS` variable.
+
+.. note::
+
+ The user and group operations added using the
+ extrausers
+ class are not tied to a specific recipe outside of the recipe for the
+ image. Thus, the operations can be performed across the image as a
+ whole. Use the
+ useradd
+ class to add user and group configuration to a specific recipe.
+
+Here is an example that uses this class in an image recipe:
+::
+
+ inherit extrausers
+ EXTRA_USERS_PARAMS = "\
+ useradd -p '' tester; \
+ groupadd developers; \
+ userdel nobody; \
+ groupdel -g video; \
+ groupmod -g 1020 developers; \
+ usermod -s /bin/sh tester; \
+ "
+
+Here is an example that adds two users named "tester-jim" and "tester-sue" and assigns
+passwords:
+::
+
+ inherit extrausers
+ EXTRA_USERS_PARAMS = "\
+ useradd -P tester01 tester-jim; \
+ useradd -P tester01 tester-sue; \
+ "
+
+Finally, here is an example that sets the root password to "1876*18":
+::
+
+ inherit extrausers
+ EXTRA_USERS_PARAMS = "\
+ usermod -P 1876*18 root; \
+ "
+
+.. _ref-classes-fontcache:
+
+``fontcache.bbclass``
+=====================
+
+The ``fontcache`` class generates the proper post-install and
+post-remove (postinst and postrm) scriptlets for font packages. These
+scriptlets call ``fc-cache`` (part of ``Fontconfig``) to add the fonts
+to the font information cache. Since the cache files are
+architecture-specific, ``fc-cache`` runs using QEMU if the postinst
+scriptlets need to be run on the build host during image creation.
+
+If the fonts being installed are in packages other than the main
+package, set :term:`FONT_PACKAGES` to specify the
+packages containing the fonts.
+
+.. _ref-classes-fs-uuid:
+
+``fs-uuid.bbclass``
+===================
+
+The ``fs-uuid`` class extracts UUID from
+``${``\ :term:`ROOTFS`\ ``}``, which must have been built
+by the time that this function gets called. The ``fs-uuid`` class only
+works on ``ext`` file systems and depends on ``tune2fs``.
+
+.. _ref-classes-gconf:
+
+``gconf.bbclass``
+=================
+
+The ``gconf`` class provides common functionality for recipes that need
+to install GConf schemas. The schemas will be put into a separate
+package (``${``\ :term:`PN`\ ``}-gconf``) that is created
+automatically when this class is inherited. This package uses the
+appropriate post-install and post-remove (postinst/postrm) scriptlets to
+register and unregister the schemas in the target image.
+
+.. _ref-classes-gettext:
+
+``gettext.bbclass``
+===================
+
+The ``gettext`` class provides support for building software that uses
+the GNU ``gettext`` internationalization and localization system. All
+recipes building software that use ``gettext`` should inherit this
+class.
+
+.. _ref-classes-gnomebase:
+
+``gnomebase.bbclass``
+=====================
+
+The ``gnomebase`` class is the base class for recipes that build
+software from the GNOME stack. This class sets
+:term:`SRC_URI` to download the source from the GNOME
+mirrors as well as extending :term:`FILES` with the typical
+GNOME installation paths.
+
+.. _ref-classes-gobject-introspection:
+
+``gobject-introspection.bbclass``
+=================================
+
+Provides support for recipes building software that supports GObject
+introspection. This functionality is only enabled if the
+"gobject-introspection-data" feature is in
+:term:`DISTRO_FEATURES` as well as
+"qemu-usermode" being in
+:term:`MACHINE_FEATURES`.
+
+.. note::
+
+ This functionality is backfilled by default and, if not applicable,
+ should be disabled through
+ DISTRO_FEATURES_BACKFILL_CONSIDERED
+ or
+ MACHINE_FEATURES_BACKFILL_CONSIDERED
+ , respectively.
+
+.. _ref-classes-grub-efi:
+
+``grub-efi.bbclass``
+====================
+
+The ``grub-efi`` class provides ``grub-efi``-specific functions for
+building bootable images.
+
+This class supports several variables:
+
+- :term:`INITRD`: Indicates list of filesystem images to
+ concatenate and use as an initial RAM disk (initrd) (optional).
+
+- :term:`ROOTFS`: Indicates a filesystem image to include
+ as the root filesystem (optional).
+
+- :term:`GRUB_GFXSERIAL`: Set this to "1" to have
+ graphics and serial in the boot menu.
+
+- :term:`LABELS`: A list of targets for the automatic
+ configuration.
+
+- :term:`APPEND`: An override list of append strings for
+ each ``LABEL``.
+
+- :term:`GRUB_OPTS`: Additional options to add to the
+ configuration (optional). Options are delimited using semi-colon
+ characters (``;``).
+
+- :term:`GRUB_TIMEOUT`: Timeout before executing
+ the default ``LABEL`` (optional).
+
+.. _ref-classes-gsettings:
+
+``gsettings.bbclass``
+=====================
+
+The ``gsettings`` class provides common functionality for recipes that
+need to install GSettings (glib) schemas. The schemas are assumed to be
+part of the main package. Appropriate post-install and post-remove
+(postinst/postrm) scriptlets are added to register and unregister the
+schemas in the target image.
+
+.. _ref-classes-gtk-doc:
+
+``gtk-doc.bbclass``
+===================
+
+The ``gtk-doc`` class is a helper class to pull in the appropriate
+``gtk-doc`` dependencies and disable ``gtk-doc``.
+
+.. _ref-classes-gtk-icon-cache:
+
+``gtk-icon-cache.bbclass``
+==========================
+
+The ``gtk-icon-cache`` class generates the proper post-install and
+post-remove (postinst/postrm) scriptlets for packages that use GTK+ and
+install icons. These scriptlets call ``gtk-update-icon-cache`` to add
+the fonts to GTK+'s icon cache. Since the cache files are
+architecture-specific, ``gtk-update-icon-cache`` is run using QEMU if
+the postinst scriptlets need to be run on the build host during image
+creation.
+
+.. _ref-classes-gtk-immodules-cache:
+
+``gtk-immodules-cache.bbclass``
+===============================
+
+The ``gtk-immodules-cache`` class generates the proper post-install and
+post-remove (postinst/postrm) scriptlets for packages that install GTK+
+input method modules for virtual keyboards. These scriptlets call
+``gtk-update-icon-cache`` to add the input method modules to the cache.
+Since the cache files are architecture-specific,
+``gtk-update-icon-cache`` is run using QEMU if the postinst scriptlets
+need to be run on the build host during image creation.
+
+If the input method modules being installed are in packages other than
+the main package, set
+:term:`GTKIMMODULES_PACKAGES` to specify
+the packages containing the modules.
+
+.. _ref-classes-gzipnative:
+
+``gzipnative.bbclass``
+======================
+
+The ``gzipnative`` class enables the use of different native versions of
+``gzip`` and ``pigz`` rather than the versions of these tools from the
+build host.
+
+.. _ref-classes-icecc:
+
+``icecc.bbclass``
+=================
+
+The ``icecc`` class supports
+`Icecream <https://github.com/icecc/icecream>`__, which facilitates
+taking compile jobs and distributing them among remote machines.
+
+The class stages directories with symlinks from ``gcc`` and ``g++`` to
+``icecc``, for both native and cross compilers. Depending on each
+configure or compile, the OpenEmbedded build system adds the directories
+at the head of the ``PATH`` list and then sets the ``ICECC_CXX`` and
+``ICEC_CC`` variables, which are the paths to the ``g++`` and ``gcc``
+compilers, respectively.
+
+For the cross compiler, the class creates a ``tar.gz`` file that
+contains the Yocto Project toolchain and sets ``ICECC_VERSION``, which
+is the version of the cross-compiler used in the cross-development
+toolchain, accordingly.
+
+The class handles all three different compile stages (i.e native
+,cross-kernel and target) and creates the necessary environment
+``tar.gz`` file to be used by the remote machines. The class also
+supports SDK generation.
+
+If :term:`ICECC_PATH` is not set in your
+``local.conf`` file, then the class tries to locate the ``icecc`` binary
+using ``which``. If :term:`ICECC_ENV_EXEC` is set
+in your ``local.conf`` file, the variable should point to the
+``icecc-create-env`` script provided by the user. If you do not point to
+a user-provided script, the build system uses the default script
+provided by the recipe ``icecc-create-env-native.bb``.
+
+.. note::
+
+ This script is a modified version and not the one that comes with
+ icecc.
+
+If you do not want the Icecream distributed compile support to apply to
+specific recipes or classes, you can effectively "blacklist" them by
+listing the recipes and classes using the
+:term:`ICECC_USER_PACKAGE_BL` and
+:term:`ICECC_USER_CLASS_BL`, variables,
+respectively, in your ``local.conf`` file. Doing so causes the
+OpenEmbedded build system to handle these compilations locally.
+
+Additionally, you can list recipes using the
+:term:`ICECC_USER_PACKAGE_WL` variable in
+your ``local.conf`` file to force ``icecc`` to be enabled for recipes
+using an empty :term:`PARALLEL_MAKE` variable.
+
+Inheriting the ``icecc`` class changes all sstate signatures.
+Consequently, if a development team has a dedicated build system that
+populates :term:`SSTATE_MIRRORS` and they want to
+reuse sstate from ``SSTATE_MIRRORS``, then all developers and the build
+system need to either inherit the ``icecc`` class or nobody should.
+
+At the distribution level, you can inherit the ``icecc`` class to be
+sure that all builders start with the same sstate signatures. After
+inheriting the class, you can then disable the feature by setting the
+:term:`ICECC_DISABLED` variable to "1" as follows:
+::
+
+ INHERIT_DISTRO_append = " icecc"
+ ICECC_DISABLED ??= "1"
+
+This practice
+makes sure everyone is using the same signatures but also requires
+individuals that do want to use Icecream to enable the feature
+individually as follows in your ``local.conf`` file:
+::
+
+ ICECC_DISABLED = ""
+
+.. _ref-classes-image:
+
+``image.bbclass``
+=================
+
+The ``image`` class helps support creating images in different formats.
+First, the root filesystem is created from packages using one of the
+``rootfs*.bbclass`` files (depending on the package format used) and
+then one or more image files are created.
+
+- The ``IMAGE_FSTYPES`` variable controls the types of images to
+ generate.
+
+- The ``IMAGE_INSTALL`` variable controls the list of packages to
+ install into the image.
+
+For information on customizing images, see the
+":ref:`usingpoky-extend-customimage`" section
+in the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual. For information on how
+images are created, see the
+":ref:`images-dev-environment`" section in the
+Yocto Project Overview and Concpets Manual.
+
+.. _ref-classes-image-buildinfo:
+
+``image-buildinfo.bbclass``
+===========================
+
+The ``image-buildinfo`` class writes information to the target
+filesystem on ``/etc/build``.
+
+.. _ref-classes-image_types:
+
+``image_types.bbclass``
+=======================
+
+The ``image_types`` class defines all of the standard image output types
+that you can enable through the
+:term:`IMAGE_FSTYPES` variable. You can use this
+class as a reference on how to add support for custom image output
+types.
+
+By default, the :ref:`image <ref-classes-image>` class automatically
+enables the ``image_types`` class. The ``image`` class uses the
+``IMGCLASSES`` variable as follows:
+::
+
+ IMGCLASSES = "rootfs_${IMAGE_PKGTYPE} image_types ${IMAGE_CLASSES}"
+ IMGCLASSES += "${@['populate_sdk_base', 'populate_sdk_ext']['linux' in d.getVar("SDK_OS")]}"
+ IMGCLASSES += "${@bb.utils.contains_any('IMAGE_FSTYPES', 'live iso hddimg', 'image-live', '', d)}"
+ IMGCLASSES += "${@bb.utils.contains('IMAGE_FSTYPES', 'container', 'image-container', '', d)}"
+ IMGCLASSES += "image_types_wic"
+ IMGCLASSES += "rootfs-postcommands"
+ IMGCLASSES += "image-postinst-intercepts"
+ inherit ${IMGCLASSES}
+
+The ``image_types`` class also handles conversion and compression of images.
+
+.. note::
+
+ To build a VMware VMDK image, you need to add "wic.vmdk" to
+ IMAGE_FSTYPES
+ . This would also be similar for Virtual Box Virtual Disk Image
+ ("vdi") and QEMU Copy On Write Version 2 ("qcow2") images.
+
+.. _ref-classes-image-live:
+
+``image-live.bbclass``
+======================
+
+This class controls building "live" (i.e. HDDIMG and ISO) images. Live
+images contain syslinux for legacy booting, as well as the bootloader
+specified by :term:`EFI_PROVIDER` if
+:term:`MACHINE_FEATURES` contains "efi".
+
+Normally, you do not use this class directly. Instead, you add "live" to
+:term:`IMAGE_FSTYPES`.
+
+.. _ref-classes-image-mklibs:
+
+``image-mklibs.bbclass``
+========================
+
+The ``image-mklibs`` class enables the use of the ``mklibs`` utility
+during the :ref:`ref-tasks-rootfs` task, which optimizes
+the size of libraries contained in the image.
+
+By default, the class is enabled in the ``local.conf.template`` using
+the :term:`USER_CLASSES` variable as follows:
+::
+
+ USER_CLASSES ?= "buildstats image-mklibs image-prelink"
+
+.. _ref-classes-image-prelink:
+
+``image-prelink.bbclass``
+=========================
+
+The ``image-prelink`` class enables the use of the ``prelink`` utility
+during the :ref:`ref-tasks-rootfs` task, which optimizes
+the dynamic linking of shared libraries to reduce executable startup
+time.
+
+By default, the class is enabled in the ``local.conf.template`` using
+the :term:`USER_CLASSES` variable as follows:
+::
+
+ USER_CLASSES ?= "buildstats image-mklibs image-prelink"
+
+.. _ref-classes-insane:
+
+``insane.bbclass``
+==================
+
+The ``insane`` class adds a step to the package generation process so
+that output quality assurance checks are generated by the OpenEmbedded
+build system. A range of checks are performed that check the build's
+output for common problems that show up during runtime. Distribution
+policy usually dictates whether to include this class.
+
+You can configure the sanity checks so that specific test failures
+either raise a warning or an error message. Typically, failures for new
+tests generate a warning. Subsequent failures for the same test would
+then generate an error message once the metadata is in a known and good
+condition. See the "`QA Error and Warning Messages <#ref-qa-checks>`__"
+Chapter for a list of all the warning and error messages you might
+encounter using a default configuration.
+
+Use the :term:`WARN_QA` and
+:term:`ERROR_QA` variables to control the behavior of
+these checks at the global level (i.e. in your custom distro
+configuration). However, to skip one or more checks in recipes, you
+should use :term:`INSANE_SKIP`. For example, to skip
+the check for symbolic link ``.so`` files in the main package of a
+recipe, add the following to the recipe. You need to realize that the
+package name override, in this example ``${PN}``, must be used:
+::
+
+ INSANE_SKIP_${PN} += "dev-so"
+
+Please keep in mind that the QA checks
+exist in order to detect real or potential problems in the packaged
+output. So exercise caution when disabling these checks.
+
+The following list shows the tests you can list with the ``WARN_QA`` and
+``ERROR_QA`` variables:
+
+- ``already-stripped:`` Checks that produced binaries have not
+ already been stripped prior to the build system extracting debug
+ symbols. It is common for upstream software projects to default to
+ stripping debug symbols for output binaries. In order for debugging
+ to work on the target using ``-dbg`` packages, this stripping must be
+ disabled.
+
+- ``arch:`` Checks the Executable and Linkable Format (ELF) type, bit
+ size, and endianness of any binaries to ensure they match the target
+ architecture. This test fails if any binaries do not match the type
+ since there would be an incompatibility. The test could indicate that
+ the wrong compiler or compiler options have been used. Sometimes
+ software, like bootloaders, might need to bypass this check.
+
+- ``buildpaths:`` Checks for paths to locations on the build host
+ inside the output files. Currently, this test triggers too many false
+ positives and thus is not normally enabled.
+
+- ``build-deps:`` Determines if a build-time dependency that is
+ specified through :term:`DEPENDS`, explicit
+ :term:`RDEPENDS`, or task-level dependencies exists
+ to match any runtime dependency. This determination is particularly
+ useful to discover where runtime dependencies are detected and added
+ during packaging. If no explicit dependency has been specified within
+ the metadata, at the packaging stage it is too late to ensure that
+ the dependency is built, and thus you can end up with an error when
+ the package is installed into the image during the
+ :ref:`ref-tasks-rootfs` task because the auto-detected
+ dependency was not satisfied. An example of this would be where the
+ :ref:`update-rc.d <ref-classes-update-rc.d>` class automatically
+ adds a dependency on the ``initscripts-functions`` package to
+ packages that install an initscript that refers to
+ ``/etc/init.d/functions``. The recipe should really have an explicit
+ ``RDEPENDS`` for the package in question on ``initscripts-functions``
+ so that the OpenEmbedded build system is able to ensure that the
+ ``initscripts`` recipe is actually built and thus the
+ ``initscripts-functions`` package is made available.
+
+- ``compile-host-path:`` Checks the
+ :ref:`ref-tasks-compile` log for indications that
+ paths to locations on the build host were used. Using such paths
+ might result in host contamination of the build output.
+
+- ``debug-deps:`` Checks that all packages except ``-dbg`` packages
+ do not depend on ``-dbg`` packages, which would cause a packaging
+ bug.
+
+- ``debug-files:`` Checks for ``.debug`` directories in anything but
+ the ``-dbg`` package. The debug files should all be in the ``-dbg``
+ package. Thus, anything packaged elsewhere is incorrect packaging.
+
+- ``dep-cmp:`` Checks for invalid version comparison statements in
+ runtime dependency relationships between packages (i.e. in
+ :term:`RDEPENDS`,
+ :term:`RRECOMMENDS`,
+ :term:`RSUGGESTS`,
+ :term:`RPROVIDES`,
+ :term:`RREPLACES`, and
+ :term:`RCONFLICTS` variable values). Any invalid
+ comparisons might trigger failures or undesirable behavior when
+ passed to the package manager.
+
+- ``desktop:`` Runs the ``desktop-file-validate`` program against any
+ ``.desktop`` files to validate their contents against the
+ specification for ``.desktop`` files.
+
+- ``dev-deps:`` Checks that all packages except ``-dev`` or
+ ``-staticdev`` packages do not depend on ``-dev`` packages, which
+ would be a packaging bug.
+
+- ``dev-so:`` Checks that the ``.so`` symbolic links are in the
+ ``-dev`` package and not in any of the other packages. In general,
+ these symlinks are only useful for development purposes. Thus, the
+ ``-dev`` package is the correct location for them. Some very rare
+ cases do exist for dynamically loaded modules where these symlinks
+ are needed instead in the main package.
+
+- ``file-rdeps:`` Checks that file-level dependencies identified by
+ the OpenEmbedded build system at packaging time are satisfied. For
+ example, a shell script might start with the line ``#!/bin/bash``.
+ This line would translate to a file dependency on ``/bin/bash``. Of
+ the three package managers that the OpenEmbedded build system
+ supports, only RPM directly handles file-level dependencies,
+ resolving them automatically to packages providing the files.
+ However, the lack of that functionality in the other two package
+ managers does not mean the dependencies do not still need resolving.
+ This QA check attempts to ensure that explicitly declared
+ :term:`RDEPENDS` exist to handle any file-level
+ dependency detected in packaged files.
+
+- ``files-invalid:`` Checks for :term:`FILES` variable
+ values that contain "//", which is invalid.
+
+- ``host-user-contaminated:`` Checks that no package produced by the
+ recipe contains any files outside of ``/home`` with a user or group
+ ID that matches the user running BitBake. A match usually indicates
+ that the files are being installed with an incorrect UID/GID, since
+ target IDs are independent from host IDs. For additional information,
+ see the section describing the
+ :ref:`ref-tasks-install` task.
+
+- ``incompatible-license:`` Report when packages are excluded from
+ being created due to being marked with a license that is in
+ :term:`INCOMPATIBLE_LICENSE`.
+
+- ``install-host-path:`` Checks the
+ :ref:`ref-tasks-install` log for indications that
+ paths to locations on the build host were used. Using such paths
+ might result in host contamination of the build output.
+
+- ``installed-vs-shipped:`` Reports when files have been installed
+ within ``do_install`` but have not been included in any package by
+ way of the :term:`FILES` variable. Files that do not
+ appear in any package cannot be present in an image later on in the
+ build process. Ideally, all installed files should be packaged or not
+ installed at all. These files can be deleted at the end of
+ ``do_install`` if the files are not needed in any package.
+
+- ``invalid-chars:`` Checks that the recipe metadata variables
+ :term:`DESCRIPTION`,
+ :term:`SUMMARY`, :term:`LICENSE`, and
+ :term:`SECTION` do not contain non-UTF-8 characters.
+ Some package managers do not support such characters.
+
+- ``invalid-packageconfig:`` Checks that no undefined features are
+ being added to :term:`PACKAGECONFIG`. For
+ example, any name "foo" for which the following form does not exist:
+ ::
+
+ PACKAGECONFIG[foo] = "..."
+
+- ``la:`` Checks ``.la`` files for any ``TMPDIR`` paths. Any ``.la``
+ file containing these paths is incorrect since ``libtool`` adds the
+ correct sysroot prefix when using the files automatically itself.
+
+- ``ldflags:`` Ensures that the binaries were linked with the
+ :term:`LDFLAGS` options provided by the build system.
+ If this test fails, check that the ``LDFLAGS`` variable is being
+ passed to the linker command.
+
+- ``libdir:`` Checks for libraries being installed into incorrect
+ (possibly hardcoded) installation paths. For example, this test will
+ catch recipes that install ``/lib/bar.so`` when ``${base_libdir}`` is
+ "lib32". Another example is when recipes install
+ ``/usr/lib64/foo.so`` when ``${libdir}`` is "/usr/lib".
+
+- ``libexec:`` Checks if a package contains files in
+ ``/usr/libexec``. This check is not performed if the ``libexecdir``
+ variable has been set explicitly to ``/usr/libexec``.
+
+- ``packages-list:`` Checks for the same package being listed
+ multiple times through the :term:`PACKAGES` variable
+ value. Installing the package in this manner can cause errors during
+ packaging.
+
+- ``perm-config:`` Reports lines in ``fs-perms.txt`` that have an
+ invalid format.
+
+- ``perm-line:`` Reports lines in ``fs-perms.txt`` that have an
+ invalid format.
+
+- ``perm-link:`` Reports lines in ``fs-perms.txt`` that specify
+ 'link' where the specified target already exists.
+
+- ``perms:`` Currently, this check is unused but reserved.
+
+- ``pkgconfig:`` Checks ``.pc`` files for any
+ :term:`TMPDIR`/:term:`WORKDIR` paths.
+ Any ``.pc`` file containing these paths is incorrect since
+ ``pkg-config`` itself adds the correct sysroot prefix when the files
+ are accessed.
+
+- ``pkgname:`` Checks that all packages in
+ :term:`PACKAGES` have names that do not contain
+ invalid characters (i.e. characters other than 0-9, a-z, ., +, and
+ -).
+
+- ``pkgv-undefined:`` Checks to see if the ``PKGV`` variable is
+ undefined during :ref:`ref-tasks-package`.
+
+- ``pkgvarcheck:`` Checks through the variables
+ :term:`RDEPENDS`,
+ :term:`RRECOMMENDS`,
+ :term:`RSUGGESTS`,
+ :term:`RCONFLICTS`,
+ :term:`RPROVIDES`,
+ :term:`RREPLACES`, :term:`FILES`,
+ :term:`ALLOW_EMPTY`, ``pkg_preinst``,
+ ``pkg_postinst``, ``pkg_prerm`` and ``pkg_postrm``, and reports if
+ there are variable sets that are not package-specific. Using these
+ variables without a package suffix is bad practice, and might
+ unnecessarily complicate dependencies of other packages within the
+ same recipe or have other unintended consequences.
+
+- ``pn-overrides:`` Checks that a recipe does not have a name
+ (:term:`PN`) value that appears in
+ :term:`OVERRIDES`. If a recipe is named such that
+ its ``PN`` value matches something already in ``OVERRIDES`` (e.g.
+ ``PN`` happens to be the same as :term:`MACHINE` or
+ :term:`DISTRO`), it can have unexpected consequences.
+ For example, assignments such as ``FILES_${PN} = "xyz"`` effectively
+ turn into ``FILES = "xyz"``.
+
+- ``rpaths:`` Checks for rpaths in the binaries that contain build
+ system paths such as ``TMPDIR``. If this test fails, bad ``-rpath``
+ options are being passed to the linker commands and your binaries
+ have potential security issues.
+
+- ``split-strip:`` Reports that splitting or stripping debug symbols
+ from binaries has failed.
+
+- ``staticdev:`` Checks for static library files (``*.a``) in
+ non-``staticdev`` packages.
+
+- ``symlink-to-sysroot:`` Checks for symlinks in packages that point
+ into :term:`TMPDIR` on the host. Such symlinks will
+ work on the host, but are clearly invalid when running on the target.
+
+- ``textrel:`` Checks for ELF binaries that contain relocations in
+ their ``.text`` sections, which can result in a performance impact at
+ runtime. See the explanation for the
+ ```ELF binary`` <#qa-issue-textrel>`__ message for more information
+ regarding runtime performance issues.
+
+- ``unlisted-pkg-lics:`` Checks that all declared licenses applying
+ for a package are also declared on the recipe level (i.e. any license
+ in ``LICENSE_*`` should appear in :term:`LICENSE`).
+
+- ``useless-rpaths:`` Checks for dynamic library load paths (rpaths)
+ in the binaries that by default on a standard system are searched by
+ the linker (e.g. ``/lib`` and ``/usr/lib``). While these paths will
+ not cause any breakage, they do waste space and are unnecessary.
+
+- ``var-undefined:`` Reports when variables fundamental to packaging
+ (i.e. :term:`WORKDIR`,
+ :term:`DEPLOY_DIR`, :term:`D`,
+ :term:`PN`, and :term:`PKGD`) are undefined
+ during :ref:`ref-tasks-package`.
+
+- ``version-going-backwards:`` If Build History is enabled, reports
+ when a package being written out has a lower version than the
+ previously written package under the same name. If you are placing
+ output packages into a feed and upgrading packages on a target system
+ using that feed, the version of a package going backwards can result
+ in the target system not correctly upgrading to the "new" version of
+ the package.
+
+ .. note::
+
+ If you are not using runtime package management on your target
+ system, then you do not need to worry about this situation.
+
+- ``xorg-driver-abi:`` Checks that all packages containing Xorg
+ drivers have ABI dependencies. The ``xserver-xorg`` recipe provides
+ driver ABI names. All drivers should depend on the ABI versions that
+ they have been built against. Driver recipes that include
+ ``xorg-driver-input.inc`` or ``xorg-driver-video.inc`` will
+ automatically get these versions. Consequently, you should only need
+ to explicitly add dependencies to binary driver recipes.
+
+.. _ref-classes-insserv:
+
+``insserv.bbclass``
+===================
+
+The ``insserv`` class uses the ``insserv`` utility to update the order
+of symbolic links in ``/etc/rc?.d/`` within an image based on
+dependencies specified by LSB headers in the ``init.d`` scripts
+themselves.
+
+.. _ref-classes-kernel:
+
+``kernel.bbclass``
+==================
+
+The ``kernel`` class handles building Linux kernels. The class contains
+code to build all kernel trees. All needed headers are staged into the
+``STAGING_KERNEL_DIR`` directory to allow out-of-tree module builds
+using the :ref:`module <ref-classes-module>` class.
+
+This means that each built kernel module is packaged separately and
+inter-module dependencies are created by parsing the ``modinfo`` output.
+If all modules are required, then installing the ``kernel-modules``
+package installs all packages with modules and various other kernel
+packages such as ``kernel-vmlinux``.
+
+The ``kernel`` class contains logic that allows you to embed an initial
+RAM filesystem (initramfs) image when you build the kernel image. For
+information on how to build an initramfs, see the
+":ref:`building-an-initramfs-image`" section in
+the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual.
+
+Various other classes are used by the ``kernel`` and ``module`` classes
+internally including the :ref:`kernel-arch <ref-classes-kernel-arch>`,
+:ref:`module-base <ref-classes-module-base>`, and
+:ref:`linux-kernel-base <ref-classes-linux-kernel-base>` classes.
+
+.. _ref-classes-kernel-arch:
+
+``kernel-arch.bbclass``
+=======================
+
+The ``kernel-arch`` class sets the ``ARCH`` environment variable for
+Linux kernel compilation (including modules).
+
+.. _ref-classes-kernel-devicetree:
+
+``kernel-devicetree.bbclass``
+=============================
+
+The ``kernel-devicetree`` class, which is inherited by the
+:ref:`kernel <ref-classes-kernel>` class, supports device tree
+generation.
+
+.. _ref-classes-kernel-fitimage:
+
+``kernel-fitimage.bbclass``
+===========================
+
+The ``kernel-fitimage`` class provides support to pack a kernel Image,
+device trees and a RAM disk into a single FIT image. In theory, a FIT
+image can support any number of kernels, RAM disks and device-trees.
+However, ``kernel-fitimage`` currently only supports
+limited usescases: just one kernel image, an optional RAM disk, and
+any number of device tree.
+
+To create a FIT image, it is required that :term:`KERNEL_CLASSES`
+is set to "kernel-fitimage" and :term:`KERNEL_IMAGETYPE`
+is set to "fitImage".
+
+The options for the device tree compiler passed to mkimage -D feature
+when creating the FIT image are specified using the
+:term:`UBOOT_MKIMAGE_DTCOPTS` variable.
+
+Only a single kernel can be added to the FIT image created by
+``kernel-fitimage`` and the kernel image in FIT is mandatory. The
+address where the kernel image is to be loaded by U-boot is
+specified by :term:`UBOOT_LOADADDRESS` and the entrypoint by
+:term:`UBOOT_ENTRYPOINT`.
+
+Multiple device trees can be added to the FIT image created by
+``kernel-fitimage`` and the device tree is optional.
+The address where the device tree is to be loaded by U-boot is
+specified by :term:`UBOOT_DTBO_LOADADDRESS` for device tree overlays
+and by `:term:`UBOOT_DTB_LOADADDRESS` for device tree binaries.
+
+Only a single RAM disk can be added to the FIT image created by
+``kernel-fitimage`` and the RAM disk in FIT is optional.
+The address where the RAM disk image is to be loaded by U-boot
+is specified by :term:`UBOOT_RD_LOADADDRESS` and the entrypoint by
+:term:`UBOOT_RD_ENTRYPOINT`. The ramdisk is added to FIT image when
+:term:`INITRAMFS_IMAGE` is specified.
+
+The FIT image generated by ``kernel-fitimage`` class is signed when the
+variables :term:`UBOOT_SIGN_ENABLE`, :term:`UBOOT_MKIMAGE_DTCOPTS`,
+:term:`UBOOT_SIGN_KEYDIR` and :term:`UBOOT_SIGN_KEYNAME` are set
+appropriately. The default values used for :term:`FIT_HASH_ALG` and
+:term:`FIT_SIGN_ALG` in ``kernel-fitimage`` are "sha256" and
+"rsa2048" respectively.
+
+
+.. _ref-classes-kernel-grub:
+
+``kernel-grub.bbclass``
+=======================
+
+The ``kernel-grub`` class updates the boot area and the boot menu with
+the kernel as the priority boot mechanism while installing a RPM to
+update the kernel on a deployed target.
+
+.. _ref-classes-kernel-module-split:
+
+``kernel-module-split.bbclass``
+===============================
+
+The ``kernel-module-split`` class provides common functionality for
+splitting Linux kernel modules into separate packages.
+
+.. _ref-classes-kernel-uboot:
+
+``kernel-uboot.bbclass``
+========================
+
+The ``kernel-uboot`` class provides support for building from
+vmlinux-style kernel sources.
+
+.. _ref-classes-kernel-uimage:
+
+``kernel-uimage.bbclass``
+=========================
+
+The ``kernel-uimage`` class provides support to pack uImage.
+
+.. _ref-classes-kernel-yocto:
+
+``kernel-yocto.bbclass``
+========================
+
+The ``kernel-yocto`` class provides common functionality for building
+from linux-yocto style kernel source repositories.
+
+.. _ref-classes-kernelsrc:
+
+``kernelsrc.bbclass``
+=====================
+
+The ``kernelsrc`` class sets the Linux kernel source and version.
+
+.. _ref-classes-lib_package:
+
+``lib_package.bbclass``
+=======================
+
+The ``lib_package`` class supports recipes that build libraries and
+produce executable binaries, where those binaries should not be
+installed by default along with the library. Instead, the binaries are
+added to a separate ``${``\ :term:`PN`\ ``}-bin`` package to
+make their installation optional.
+
+.. _ref-classes-libc*:
+
+``libc*.bbclass``
+=================
+
+The ``libc*`` classes support recipes that build packages with ``libc``:
+
+- The ``libc-common`` class provides common support for building with
+ ``libc``.
+
+- The ``libc-package`` class supports packaging up ``glibc`` and
+ ``eglibc``.
+
+.. _ref-classes-license:
+
+``license.bbclass``
+===================
+
+The ``license`` class provides license manifest creation and license
+exclusion. This class is enabled by default using the default value for
+the :term:`INHERIT_DISTRO` variable.
+
+.. _ref-classes-linux-kernel-base:
+
+``linux-kernel-base.bbclass``
+=============================
+
+The ``linux-kernel-base`` class provides common functionality for
+recipes that build out of the Linux kernel source tree. These builds
+goes beyond the kernel itself. For example, the Perf recipe also
+inherits this class.
+
+.. _ref-classes-linuxloader:
+
+``linuxloader.bbclass``
+=======================
+
+Provides the function ``linuxloader()``, which gives the value of the
+dynamic loader/linker provided on the platform. This value is used by a
+number of other classes.
+
+.. _ref-classes-logging:
+
+``logging.bbclass``
+===================
+
+The ``logging`` class provides the standard shell functions used to log
+messages for various BitBake severity levels (i.e. ``bbplain``,
+``bbnote``, ``bbwarn``, ``bberror``, ``bbfatal``, and ``bbdebug``).
+
+This class is enabled by default since it is inherited by the ``base``
+class.
+
+.. _ref-classes-meta:
+
+``meta.bbclass``
+================
+
+The ``meta`` class is inherited by recipes that do not build any output
+packages themselves, but act as a "meta" target for building other
+recipes.
+
+.. _ref-classes-metadata_scm:
+
+``metadata_scm.bbclass``
+========================
+
+The ``metadata_scm`` class provides functionality for querying the
+branch and revision of a Source Code Manager (SCM) repository.
+
+The :ref:`base <ref-classes-base>` class uses this class to print the
+revisions of each layer before starting every build. The
+``metadata_scm`` class is enabled by default because it is inherited by
+the ``base`` class.
+
+.. _ref-classes-migrate_localcount:
+
+``migrate_localcount.bbclass``
+==============================
+
+The ``migrate_localcount`` class verifies a recipe's localcount data and
+increments it appropriately.
+
+.. _ref-classes-mime:
+
+``mime.bbclass``
+================
+
+The ``mime`` class generates the proper post-install and post-remove
+(postinst/postrm) scriptlets for packages that install MIME type files.
+These scriptlets call ``update-mime-database`` to add the MIME types to
+the shared database.
+
+.. _ref-classes-mirrors:
+
+``mirrors.bbclass``
+===================
+
+The ``mirrors`` class sets up some standard
+:term:`MIRRORS` entries for source code mirrors. These
+mirrors provide a fall-back path in case the upstream source specified
+in :term:`SRC_URI` within recipes is unavailable.
+
+This class is enabled by default since it is inherited by the
+:ref:`base <ref-classes-base>` class.
+
+.. _ref-classes-module:
+
+``module.bbclass``
+==================
+
+The ``module`` class provides support for building out-of-tree Linux
+kernel modules. The class inherits the
+:ref:`module-base <ref-classes-module-base>` and
+:ref:`kernel-module-split <ref-classes-kernel-module-split>` classes,
+and implements the :ref:`ref-tasks-compile` and
+:ref:`ref-tasks-install` tasks. The class provides
+everything needed to build and package a kernel module.
+
+For general information on out-of-tree Linux kernel modules, see the
+":ref:`kernel-dev/kernel-dev-common:incorporating out-of-tree modules`"
+section in the Yocto Project Linux Kernel Development Manual.
+
+.. _ref-classes-module-base:
+
+``module-base.bbclass``
+=======================
+
+The ``module-base`` class provides the base functionality for building
+Linux kernel modules. Typically, a recipe that builds software that
+includes one or more kernel modules and has its own means of building
+the module inherits this class as opposed to inheriting the
+:ref:`module <ref-classes-module>` class.
+
+.. _ref-classes-multilib*:
+
+``multilib*.bbclass``
+=====================
+
+The ``multilib*`` classes provide support for building libraries with
+different target optimizations or target architectures and installing
+them side-by-side in the same image.
+
+For more information on using the Multilib feature, see the
+":ref:`combining-multiple-versions-library-files-into-one-image`"
+section in the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual.
+
+.. _ref-classes-native:
+
+``native.bbclass``
+==================
+
+The ``native`` class provides common functionality for recipes that
+build tools to run on the `build host <#hardware-build-system-term>`__
+(i.e. tools that use the compiler or other tools from the build host).
+
+You can create a recipe that builds tools that run natively on the host
+a couple different ways:
+
+- Create a myrecipe\ ``-native.bb`` recipe that inherits the ``native``
+ class. If you use this method, you must order the inherit statement
+ in the recipe after all other inherit statements so that the
+ ``native`` class is inherited last.
+
+ .. note::
+
+ When creating a recipe this way, the recipe name must follow this
+ naming convention:
+ ::
+
+ myrecipe-native.bb
+
+
+ Not using this naming convention can lead to subtle problems
+ caused by existing code that depends on that naming convention.
+
+- Create or modify a target recipe that contains the following:
+ ::
+
+ BBCLASSEXTEND = "native"
+
+ Inside the
+ recipe, use ``_class-native`` and ``_class-target`` overrides to
+ specify any functionality specific to the respective native or target
+ case.
+
+Although applied differently, the ``native`` class is used with both
+methods. The advantage of the second method is that you do not need to
+have two separate recipes (assuming you need both) for native and
+target. All common parts of the recipe are automatically shared.
+
+.. _ref-classes-nativesdk:
+
+``nativesdk.bbclass``
+=====================
+
+The ``nativesdk`` class provides common functionality for recipes that
+wish to build tools to run as part of an SDK (i.e. tools that run on
+:term:`SDKMACHINE`).
+
+You can create a recipe that builds tools that run on the SDK machine a
+couple different ways:
+
+- Create a ``nativesdk-``\ myrecipe\ ``.bb`` recipe that inherits the
+ ``nativesdk`` class. If you use this method, you must order the
+ inherit statement in the recipe after all other inherit statements so
+ that the ``nativesdk`` class is inherited last.
+
+- Create a ``nativesdk`` variant of any recipe by adding the following:
+ ::
+
+ BBCLASSEXTEND = "nativesdk"
+
+ Inside the
+ recipe, use ``_class-nativesdk`` and ``_class-target`` overrides to
+ specify any functionality specific to the respective SDK machine or
+ target case.
+
+.. note::
+
+ When creating a recipe, you must follow this naming convention:
+ ::
+
+ nativesdk-myrecipe.bb
+
+
+ Not doing so can lead to subtle problems because code exists that
+ depends on the naming convention.
+
+Although applied differently, the ``nativesdk`` class is used with both
+methods. The advantage of the second method is that you do not need to
+have two separate recipes (assuming you need both) for the SDK machine
+and the target. All common parts of the recipe are automatically shared.
+
+.. _ref-classes-nopackages:
+
+``nopackages.bbclass``
+======================
+
+Disables packaging tasks for those recipes and classes where packaging
+is not needed.
+
+.. _ref-classes-npm:
+
+``npm.bbclass``
+===============
+
+Provides support for building Node.js software fetched using the `node
+package manager (NPM) <https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Npm_(software)>`__.
+
+.. note::
+
+ Currently, recipes inheriting this class must use the
+ npm://
+ fetcher to have dependencies fetched and packaged automatically.
+
+For information on how to create NPM packages, see the
+":ref:`dev-manual/dev-manual-common-tasks:creating node package manager (npm) packages`"
+section in the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual.
+
+.. _ref-classes-oelint:
+
+``oelint.bbclass``
+==================
+
+The ``oelint`` class is an obsolete lint checking tool that exists in
+``meta/classes`` in the :term:`Source Directory`.
+
+A number of classes exist that could be generally useful in OE-Core but
+are never actually used within OE-Core itself. The ``oelint`` class is
+one such example. However, being aware of this class can reduce the
+proliferation of different versions of similar classes across multiple
+layers.
+
+.. _ref-classes-own-mirrors:
+
+``own-mirrors.bbclass``
+=======================
+
+The ``own-mirrors`` class makes it easier to set up your own
+:term:`PREMIRRORS` from which to first fetch source
+before attempting to fetch it from the upstream specified in
+:term:`SRC_URI` within each recipe.
+
+To use this class, inherit it globally and specify
+:term:`SOURCE_MIRROR_URL`. Here is an example:
+::
+
+ INHERIT += "own-mirrors"
+ SOURCE_MIRROR_URL = "http://example.com/my-source-mirror"
+
+You can specify only a single URL
+in ``SOURCE_MIRROR_URL``.
+
+.. _ref-classes-package:
+
+``package.bbclass``
+===================
+
+The ``package`` class supports generating packages from a build's
+output. The core generic functionality is in ``package.bbclass``. The
+code specific to particular package types resides in these
+package-specific classes:
+:ref:`package_deb <ref-classes-package_deb>`,
+:ref:`package_rpm <ref-classes-package_rpm>`,
+:ref:`package_ipk <ref-classes-package_ipk>`, and
+:ref:`package_tar <ref-classes-package_tar>`.
+
+.. note::
+
+ The
+ package_tar
+ class is broken and not supported. It is recommended that you do not
+ use this class.
+
+You can control the list of resulting package formats by using the
+``PACKAGE_CLASSES`` variable defined in your ``conf/local.conf``
+configuration file, which is located in the :term:`Build Directory`.
+When defining the variable, you can
+specify one or more package types. Since images are generated from
+packages, a packaging class is needed to enable image generation. The
+first class listed in this variable is used for image generation.
+
+If you take the optional step to set up a repository (package feed) on
+the development host that can be used by DNF, you can install packages
+from the feed while you are running the image on the target (i.e.
+runtime installation of packages). For more information, see the
+":ref:`dev-manual/dev-manual-common-tasks:using runtime package management`"
+section in the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual.
+
+The package-specific class you choose can affect build-time performance
+and has space ramifications. In general, building a package with IPK
+takes about thirty percent less time as compared to using RPM to build
+the same or similar package. This comparison takes into account a
+complete build of the package with all dependencies previously built.
+The reason for this discrepancy is because the RPM package manager
+creates and processes more :term:`Metadata` than the IPK package
+manager. Consequently, you might consider setting ``PACKAGE_CLASSES`` to
+"package_ipk" if you are building smaller systems.
+
+Before making your package manager decision, however, you should
+consider some further things about using RPM:
+
+- RPM starts to provide more abilities than IPK due to the fact that it
+ processes more Metadata. For example, this information includes
+ individual file types, file checksum generation and evaluation on
+ install, sparse file support, conflict detection and resolution for
+ Multilib systems, ACID style upgrade, and repackaging abilities for
+ rollbacks.
+
+- For smaller systems, the extra space used for the Berkeley Database
+ and the amount of metadata when using RPM can affect your ability to
+ perform on-device upgrades.
+
+You can find additional information on the effects of the package class
+at these two Yocto Project mailing list links:
+
+- https://lists.yoctoproject.org/pipermail/poky/2011-May/006362.html
+
+- https://lists.yoctoproject.org/pipermail/poky/2011-May/006363.html
+
+.. _ref-classes-package_deb:
+
+``package_deb.bbclass``
+=======================
+
+The ``package_deb`` class provides support for creating packages that
+use the Debian (i.e. ``.deb``) file format. The class ensures the
+packages are written out in a ``.deb`` file format to the
+``${``\ :term:`DEPLOY_DIR_DEB`\ ``}`` directory.
+
+This class inherits the :ref:`package <ref-classes-package>` class and
+is enabled through the :term:`PACKAGE_CLASSES`
+variable in the ``local.conf`` file.
+
+.. _ref-classes-package_ipk:
+
+``package_ipk.bbclass``
+=======================
+
+The ``package_ipk`` class provides support for creating packages that
+use the IPK (i.e. ``.ipk``) file format. The class ensures the packages
+are written out in a ``.ipk`` file format to the
+``${``\ :term:`DEPLOY_DIR_IPK`\ ``}`` directory.
+
+This class inherits the :ref:`package <ref-classes-package>` class and
+is enabled through the :term:`PACKAGE_CLASSES`
+variable in the ``local.conf`` file.
+
+.. _ref-classes-package_rpm:
+
+``package_rpm.bbclass``
+=======================
+
+The ``package_rpm`` class provides support for creating packages that
+use the RPM (i.e. ``.rpm``) file format. The class ensures the packages
+are written out in a ``.rpm`` file format to the
+``${``\ :term:`DEPLOY_DIR_RPM`\ ``}`` directory.
+
+This class inherits the :ref:`package <ref-classes-package>` class and
+is enabled through the :term:`PACKAGE_CLASSES`
+variable in the ``local.conf`` file.
+
+.. _ref-classes-package_tar:
+
+``package_tar.bbclass``
+=======================
+
+The ``package_tar`` class provides support for creating tarballs. The
+class ensures the packages are written out in a tarball format to the
+``${``\ :term:`DEPLOY_DIR_TAR`\ ``}`` directory.
+
+This class inherits the :ref:`package <ref-classes-package>` class and
+is enabled through the :term:`PACKAGE_CLASSES`
+variable in the ``local.conf`` file.
+
+.. note::
+
+ You cannot specify the
+ package_tar
+ class first using the
+ PACKAGE_CLASSES
+ variable. You must use
+ .deb
+ ,
+ .ipk
+ , or
+ .rpm
+ file formats for your image or SDK.
+
+.. _ref-classes-packagedata:
+
+``packagedata.bbclass``
+=======================
+
+The ``packagedata`` class provides common functionality for reading
+``pkgdata`` files found in :term:`PKGDATA_DIR`. These
+files contain information about each output package produced by the
+OpenEmbedded build system.
+
+This class is enabled by default because it is inherited by the
+:ref:`package <ref-classes-package>` class.
+
+.. _ref-classes-packagegroup:
+
+``packagegroup.bbclass``
+========================
+
+The ``packagegroup`` class sets default values appropriate for package
+group recipes (e.g. ``PACKAGES``, ``PACKAGE_ARCH``, ``ALLOW_EMPTY``, and
+so forth). It is highly recommended that all package group recipes
+inherit this class.
+
+For information on how to use this class, see the
+":ref:`usingpoky-extend-customimage-customtasks`"
+section in the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual.
+
+Previously, this class was called the ``task`` class.
+
+.. _ref-classes-patch:
+
+``patch.bbclass``
+=================
+
+The ``patch`` class provides all functionality for applying patches
+during the :ref:`ref-tasks-patch` task.
+
+This class is enabled by default because it is inherited by the
+:ref:`base <ref-classes-base>` class.
+
+.. _ref-classes-perlnative:
+
+``perlnative.bbclass``
+======================
+
+When inherited by a recipe, the ``perlnative`` class supports using the
+native version of Perl built by the build system rather than using the
+version provided by the build host.
+
+.. _ref-classes-pixbufcache:
+
+``pixbufcache.bbclass``
+=======================
+
+The ``pixbufcache`` class generates the proper post-install and
+post-remove (postinst/postrm) scriptlets for packages that install
+pixbuf loaders, which are used with ``gdk-pixbuf``. These scriptlets
+call ``update_pixbuf_cache`` to add the pixbuf loaders to the cache.
+Since the cache files are architecture-specific, ``update_pixbuf_cache``
+is run using QEMU if the postinst scriptlets need to be run on the build
+host during image creation.
+
+If the pixbuf loaders being installed are in packages other than the
+recipe's main package, set
+:term:`PIXBUF_PACKAGES` to specify the packages
+containing the loaders.
+
+.. _ref-classes-pkgconfig:
+
+``pkgconfig.bbclass``
+=====================
+
+The ``pkgconfig`` class provides a standard way to get header and
+library information by using ``pkg-config``. This class aims to smooth
+integration of ``pkg-config`` into libraries that use it.
+
+During staging, BitBake installs ``pkg-config`` data into the
+``sysroots/`` directory. By making use of sysroot functionality within
+``pkg-config``, the ``pkgconfig`` class no longer has to manipulate the
+files.
+
+.. _ref-classes-populate-sdk:
+
+``populate_sdk.bbclass``
+========================
+
+The ``populate_sdk`` class provides support for SDK-only recipes. For
+information on advantages gained when building a cross-development
+toolchain using the :ref:`ref-tasks-populate_sdk`
+task, see the ":ref:`sdk-manual/sdk-appendix-obtain:building an sdk installer`"
+section in the Yocto Project Application Development and the Extensible
+Software Development Kit (eSDK) manual.
+
+.. _ref-classes-populate-sdk-*:
+
+``populate_sdk_*.bbclass``
+==========================
+
+The ``populate_sdk_*`` classes support SDK creation and consist of the
+following classes:
+
+- ``populate_sdk_base``: The base class supporting SDK creation under
+ all package managers (i.e. DEB, RPM, and opkg).
+
+- ``populate_sdk_deb``: Supports creation of the SDK given the Debian
+ package manager.
+
+- ``populate_sdk_rpm``: Supports creation of the SDK given the RPM
+ package manager.
+
+- ``populate_sdk_ipk``: Supports creation of the SDK given the opkg
+ (IPK format) package manager.
+
+- ``populate_sdk_ext``: Supports extensible SDK creation under all
+ package managers.
+
+The ``populate_sdk_base`` class inherits the appropriate
+``populate_sdk_*`` (i.e. ``deb``, ``rpm``, and ``ipk``) based on
+:term:`IMAGE_PKGTYPE`.
+
+The base class ensures all source and destination directories are
+established and then populates the SDK. After populating the SDK, the
+``populate_sdk_base`` class constructs two sysroots:
+``${``\ :term:`SDK_ARCH`\ ``}-nativesdk``, which
+contains the cross-compiler and associated tooling, and the target,
+which contains a target root filesystem that is configured for the SDK
+usage. These two images reside in :term:`SDK_OUTPUT`,
+which consists of the following:
+::
+
+ ${SDK_OUTPUT}/${SDK_ARCH}-nativesdk-pkgs
+ ${SDK_OUTPUT}/${SDKTARGETSYSROOT}/target-pkgs
+
+Finally, the base populate SDK class creates the toolchain environment
+setup script, the tarball of the SDK, and the installer.
+
+The respective ``populate_sdk_deb``, ``populate_sdk_rpm``, and
+``populate_sdk_ipk`` classes each support the specific type of SDK.
+These classes are inherited by and used with the ``populate_sdk_base``
+class.
+
+For more information on the cross-development toolchain generation, see
+the ":ref:`overview-manual/overview-manual-concepts:cross-development toolchain generation`"
+section in the Yocto Project Overview and Concepts Manual. For
+information on advantages gained when building a cross-development
+toolchain using the :ref:`ref-tasks-populate_sdk`
+task, see the
+":ref:`sdk-manual/sdk-appendix-obtain:building an sdk installer`"
+section in the Yocto Project Application Development and the Extensible
+Software Development Kit (eSDK) manual.
+
+.. _ref-classes-prexport:
+
+``prexport.bbclass``
+====================
+
+The ``prexport`` class provides functionality for exporting
+:term:`PR` values.
+
+.. note::
+
+ This class is not intended to be used directly. Rather, it is enabled
+ when using "
+ bitbake-prserv-tool export
+ ".
+
+.. _ref-classes-primport:
+
+``primport.bbclass``
+====================
+
+The ``primport`` class provides functionality for importing
+:term:`PR` values.
+
+.. note::
+
+ This class is not intended to be used directly. Rather, it is enabled
+ when using "
+ bitbake-prserv-tool import
+ ".
+
+.. _ref-classes-prserv:
+
+``prserv.bbclass``
+==================
+
+The ``prserv`` class provides functionality for using a :ref:`PR
+service <dev-manual/dev-manual-common-tasks:working with a pr service>` in order to
+automatically manage the incrementing of the :term:`PR`
+variable for each recipe.
+
+This class is enabled by default because it is inherited by the
+:ref:`package <ref-classes-package>` class. However, the OpenEmbedded
+build system will not enable the functionality of this class unless
+:term:`PRSERV_HOST` has been set.
+
+.. _ref-classes-ptest:
+
+``ptest.bbclass``
+=================
+
+The ``ptest`` class provides functionality for packaging and installing
+runtime tests for recipes that build software that provides these tests.
+
+This class is intended to be inherited by individual recipes. However,
+the class' functionality is largely disabled unless "ptest" appears in
+:term:`DISTRO_FEATURES`. See the
+":ref:`dev-manual/dev-manual-common-tasks:testing packages with ptest`"
+section in the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual for more information
+on ptest.
+
+.. _ref-classes-ptest-gnome:
+
+``ptest-gnome.bbclass``
+=======================
+
+Enables package tests (ptests) specifically for GNOME packages, which
+have tests intended to be executed with ``gnome-desktop-testing``.
+
+For information on setting up and running ptests, see the
+":ref:`dev-manual/dev-manual-common-tasks:testing packages with ptest`"
+section in the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual.
+
+.. _ref-classes-python-dir:
+
+``python-dir.bbclass``
+======================
+
+The ``python-dir`` class provides the base version, location, and site
+package location for Python.
+
+.. _ref-classes-python3native:
+
+``python3native.bbclass``
+=========================
+
+The ``python3native`` class supports using the native version of Python
+3 built by the build system rather than support of the version provided
+by the build host.
+
+.. _ref-classes-pythonnative:
+
+``pythonnative.bbclass``
+========================
+
+When inherited by a recipe, the ``pythonnative`` class supports using
+the native version of Python built by the build system rather than using
+the version provided by the build host.
+
+.. _ref-classes-qemu:
+
+``qemu.bbclass``
+================
+
+The ``qemu`` class provides functionality for recipes that either need
+QEMU or test for the existence of QEMU. Typically, this class is used to
+run programs for a target system on the build host using QEMU's
+application emulation mode.
+
+.. _ref-classes-recipe_sanity:
+
+``recipe_sanity.bbclass``
+=========================
+
+The ``recipe_sanity`` class checks for the presence of any host system
+recipe prerequisites that might affect the build (e.g. variables that
+are set or software that is present).
+
+.. _ref-classes-relocatable:
+
+``relocatable.bbclass``
+=======================
+
+The ``relocatable`` class enables relocation of binaries when they are
+installed into the sysroot.
+
+This class makes use of the :ref:`chrpath <ref-classes-chrpath>` class
+and is used by both the :ref:`cross <ref-classes-cross>` and
+:ref:`native <ref-classes-native>` classes.
+
+.. _ref-classes-remove-libtool:
+
+``remove-libtool.bbclass``
+==========================
+
+The ``remove-libtool`` class adds a post function to the
+:ref:`ref-tasks-install` task to remove all ``.la`` files
+installed by ``libtool``. Removing these files results in them being
+absent from both the sysroot and target packages.
+
+If a recipe needs the ``.la`` files to be installed, then the recipe can
+override the removal by setting ``REMOVE_LIBTOOL_LA`` to "0" as follows:
+::
+
+ REMOVE_LIBTOOL_LA = "0"
+
+.. note::
+
+ The
+ remove-libtool
+ class is not enabled by default.
+
+.. _ref-classes-report-error:
+
+``report-error.bbclass``
+========================
+
+The ``report-error`` class supports enabling the :ref:`error reporting
+tool <dev-manual/dev-manual-common-tasks:using the error reporting tool>`",
+which allows you to submit build error information to a central database.
+
+The class collects debug information for recipe, recipe version, task,
+machine, distro, build system, target system, host distro, branch,
+commit, and log. From the information, report files using a JSON format
+are created and stored in
+``${``\ :term:`LOG_DIR`\ ``}/error-report``.
+
+.. _ref-classes-rm-work:
+
+``rm_work.bbclass``
+===================
+
+The ``rm_work`` class supports deletion of temporary workspace, which
+can ease your hard drive demands during builds.
+
+The OpenEmbedded build system can use a substantial amount of disk space
+during the build process. A portion of this space is the work files
+under the ``${TMPDIR}/work`` directory for each recipe. Once the build
+system generates the packages for a recipe, the work files for that
+recipe are no longer needed. However, by default, the build system
+preserves these files for inspection and possible debugging purposes. If
+you would rather have these files deleted to save disk space as the
+build progresses, you can enable ``rm_work`` by adding the following to
+your ``local.conf`` file, which is found in the :term:`Build Directory`.
+::
+
+ INHERIT += "rm_work"
+
+If you are
+modifying and building source code out of the work directory for a
+recipe, enabling ``rm_work`` will potentially result in your changes to
+the source being lost. To exclude some recipes from having their work
+directories deleted by ``rm_work``, you can add the names of the recipe
+or recipes you are working on to the ``RM_WORK_EXCLUDE`` variable, which
+can also be set in your ``local.conf`` file. Here is an example:
+::
+
+ RM_WORK_EXCLUDE += "busybox glibc"
+
+.. _ref-classes-rootfs*:
+
+``rootfs*.bbclass``
+===================
+
+The ``rootfs*`` classes support creating the root filesystem for an
+image and consist of the following classes:
+
+- The ``rootfs-postcommands`` class, which defines filesystem
+ post-processing functions for image recipes.
+
+- The ``rootfs_deb`` class, which supports creation of root filesystems
+ for images built using ``.deb`` packages.
+
+- The ``rootfs_rpm`` class, which supports creation of root filesystems
+ for images built using ``.rpm`` packages.
+
+- The ``rootfs_ipk`` class, which supports creation of root filesystems
+ for images built using ``.ipk`` packages.
+
+- The ``rootfsdebugfiles`` class, which installs additional files found
+ on the build host directly into the root filesystem.
+
+The root filesystem is created from packages using one of the
+``rootfs*.bbclass`` files as determined by the
+:term:`PACKAGE_CLASSES` variable.
+
+For information on how root filesystem images are created, see the
+:ref:`image-generation-dev-environment`"
+section in the Yocto Project Overview and Concepts Manual.
+
+.. _ref-classes-sanity:
+
+``sanity.bbclass``
+==================
+
+The ``sanity`` class checks to see if prerequisite software is present
+on the host system so that users can be notified of potential problems
+that might affect their build. The class also performs basic user
+configuration checks from the ``local.conf`` configuration file to
+prevent common mistakes that cause build failures. Distribution policy
+usually determines whether to include this class.
+
+.. _ref-classes-scons:
+
+``scons.bbclass``
+=================
+
+The ``scons`` class supports recipes that need to build software that
+uses the SCons build system. You can use the
+:term:`EXTRA_OESCONS` variable to specify
+additional configuration options you want to pass SCons command line.
+
+.. _ref-classes-sdl:
+
+``sdl.bbclass``
+===============
+
+The ``sdl`` class supports recipes that need to build software that uses
+the Simple DirectMedia Layer (SDL) library.
+
+.. _ref-classes-setuptools:
+
+``setuptools.bbclass``
+======================
+
+The ``setuptools`` class supports Python version 2.x extensions that use
+build systems based on ``setuptools``. If your recipe uses these build
+systems, the recipe needs to inherit the ``setuptools`` class.
+
+.. _ref-classes-setuptools3:
+
+``setuptools3.bbclass``
+=======================
+
+The ``setuptools3`` class supports Python version 3.x extensions that
+use build systems based on ``setuptools3``. If your recipe uses these
+build systems, the recipe needs to inherit the ``setuptools3`` class.
+
+.. _ref-classes-sign_rpm:
+
+``sign_rpm.bbclass``
+====================
+
+The ``sign_rpm`` class supports generating signed RPM packages.
+
+.. _ref-classes-sip:
+
+``sip.bbclass``
+===============
+
+The ``sip`` class supports recipes that build or package SIP-based
+Python bindings.
+
+.. _ref-classes-siteconfig:
+
+``siteconfig.bbclass``
+======================
+
+The ``siteconfig`` class provides functionality for handling site
+configuration. The class is used by the
+:ref:`autotools <ref-classes-autotools>` class to accelerate the
+:ref:`ref-tasks-configure` task.
+
+.. _ref-classes-siteinfo:
+
+``siteinfo.bbclass``
+====================
+
+The ``siteinfo`` class provides information about the targets that might
+be needed by other classes or recipes.
+
+As an example, consider Autotools, which can require tests that must
+execute on the target hardware. Since this is not possible in general
+when cross compiling, site information is used to provide cached test
+results so these tests can be skipped over but still make the correct
+values available. The ``meta/site directory`` contains test results
+sorted into different categories such as architecture, endianness, and
+the ``libc`` used. Site information provides a list of files containing
+data relevant to the current build in the ``CONFIG_SITE`` variable that
+Autotools automatically picks up.
+
+The class also provides variables like ``SITEINFO_ENDIANNESS`` and
+``SITEINFO_BITS`` that can be used elsewhere in the metadata.
+
+.. _ref-classes-spdx:
+
+``spdx.bbclass``
+================
+
+The ``spdx`` class integrates real-time license scanning, generation of
+SPDX standard output, and verification of license information during the
+build.
+
+.. note::
+
+ This class is currently at the prototype stage in the 1.6 release.
+
+.. _ref-classes-sstate:
+
+``sstate.bbclass``
+==================
+
+The ``sstate`` class provides support for Shared State (sstate). By
+default, the class is enabled through the
+:term:`INHERIT_DISTRO` variable's default value.
+
+For more information on sstate, see the
+":ref:`overview-manual/overview-manual-concepts:shared state cache`"
+section in the Yocto Project Overview and Concepts Manual.
+
+.. _ref-classes-staging:
+
+``staging.bbclass``
+===================
+
+The ``staging`` class installs files into individual recipe work
+directories for sysroots. The class contains the following key tasks:
+
+- The :ref:`ref-tasks-populate_sysroot` task,
+ which is responsible for handing the files that end up in the recipe
+ sysroots.
+
+- The
+ :ref:`ref-tasks-prepare_recipe_sysroot`
+ task (a "partner" task to the ``populate_sysroot`` task), which
+ installs the files into the individual recipe work directories (i.e.
+ :term:`WORKDIR`).
+
+The code in the ``staging`` class is complex and basically works in two
+stages:
+
+- *Stage One:* The first stage addresses recipes that have files they
+ want to share with other recipes that have dependencies on the
+ originating recipe. Normally these dependencies are installed through
+ the :ref:`ref-tasks-install` task into
+ ``${``\ :term:`D`\ ``}``. The ``do_populate_sysroot`` task
+ copies a subset of these files into ``${SYSROOT_DESTDIR}``. This
+ subset of files is controlled by the
+ :term:`SYSROOT_DIRS`,
+ :term:`SYSROOT_DIRS_NATIVE`, and
+ :term:`SYSROOT_DIRS_BLACKLIST`
+ variables.
+
+ .. note::
+
+ Additionally, a recipe can customize the files further by
+ declaring a processing function in the
+ SYSROOT_PREPROCESS_FUNCS
+ variable.
+
+ A shared state (sstate) object is built from these files and the
+ files are placed into a subdirectory of
+ ```tmp/sysroots-components/`` <#structure-build-tmp-sysroots-components>`__.
+ The files are scanned for hardcoded paths to the original
+ installation location. If the location is found in text files, the
+ hardcoded locations are replaced by tokens and a list of the files
+ needing such replacements is created. These adjustments are referred
+ to as "FIXMEs". The list of files that are scanned for paths is
+ controlled by the :term:`SSTATE_SCAN_FILES`
+ variable.
+
+- *Stage Two:* The second stage addresses recipes that want to use
+ something from another recipe and declare a dependency on that recipe
+ through the :term:`DEPENDS` variable. The recipe will
+ have a
+ :ref:`ref-tasks-prepare_recipe_sysroot`
+ task and when this task executes, it creates the ``recipe-sysroot``
+ and ``recipe-sysroot-native`` in the recipe work directory (i.e.
+ :term:`WORKDIR`). The OpenEmbedded build system
+ creates hard links to copies of the relevant files from
+ ``sysroots-components`` into the recipe work directory.
+
+ .. note::
+
+ If hard links are not possible, the build system uses actual
+ copies.
+
+ The build system then addresses any "FIXMEs" to paths as defined from
+ the list created in the first stage.
+
+ Finally, any files in ``${bindir}`` within the sysroot that have the
+ prefix "``postinst-``" are executed.
+
+ .. note::
+
+ Although such sysroot post installation scripts are not
+ recommended for general use, the files do allow some issues such
+ as user creation and module indexes to be addressed.
+
+ Because recipes can have other dependencies outside of ``DEPENDS``
+ (e.g. ``do_unpack[depends] += "tar-native:do_populate_sysroot"``),
+ the sysroot creation function ``extend_recipe_sysroot`` is also added
+ as a pre-function for those tasks whose dependencies are not through
+ ``DEPENDS`` but operate similarly.
+
+ When installing dependencies into the sysroot, the code traverses the
+ dependency graph and processes dependencies in exactly the same way
+ as the dependencies would or would not be when installed from sstate.
+ This processing means, for example, a native tool would have its
+ native dependencies added but a target library would not have its
+ dependencies traversed or installed. The same sstate dependency code
+ is used so that builds should be identical regardless of whether
+ sstate was used or not. For a closer look, see the
+ ``setscene_depvalid()`` function in the
+ :ref:`sstate <ref-classes-sstate>` class.
+
+ The build system is careful to maintain manifests of the files it
+ installs so that any given dependency can be installed as needed. The
+ sstate hash of the installed item is also stored so that if it
+ changes, the build system can reinstall it.
+
+.. _ref-classes-syslinux:
+
+``syslinux.bbclass``
+====================
+
+The ``syslinux`` class provides syslinux-specific functions for building
+bootable images.
+
+The class supports the following variables:
+
+- :term:`INITRD`: Indicates list of filesystem images to
+ concatenate and use as an initial RAM disk (initrd). This variable is
+ optional.
+
+- :term:`ROOTFS`: Indicates a filesystem image to include
+ as the root filesystem. This variable is optional.
+
+- :term:`AUTO_SYSLINUXMENU`: Enables creating
+ an automatic menu when set to "1".
+
+- :term:`LABELS`: Lists targets for automatic
+ configuration.
+
+- :term:`APPEND`: Lists append string overrides for each
+ label.
+
+- :term:`SYSLINUX_OPTS`: Lists additional options
+ to add to the syslinux file. Semicolon characters separate multiple
+ options.
+
+- :term:`SYSLINUX_SPLASH`: Lists a background
+ for the VGA boot menu when you are using the boot menu.
+
+- :term:`SYSLINUX_DEFAULT_CONSOLE`: Set
+ to "console=ttyX" to change kernel boot default console.
+
+- :term:`SYSLINUX_SERIAL`: Sets an alternate
+ serial port. Or, turns off serial when the variable is set with an
+ empty string.
+
+- :term:`SYSLINUX_SERIAL_TTY`: Sets an
+ alternate "console=tty..." kernel boot argument.
+
+.. _ref-classes-systemd:
+
+``systemd.bbclass``
+===================
+
+The ``systemd`` class provides support for recipes that install systemd
+unit files.
+
+The functionality for this class is disabled unless you have "systemd"
+in :term:`DISTRO_FEATURES`.
+
+Under this class, the recipe or Makefile (i.e. whatever the recipe is
+calling during the :ref:`ref-tasks-install` task)
+installs unit files into
+``${``\ :term:`D`\ ``}${systemd_unitdir}/system``. If the unit
+files being installed go into packages other than the main package, you
+need to set :term:`SYSTEMD_PACKAGES` in your
+recipe to identify the packages in which the files will be installed.
+
+You should set :term:`SYSTEMD_SERVICE` to the
+name of the service file. You should also use a package name override to
+indicate the package to which the value applies. If the value applies to
+the recipe's main package, use ``${``\ :term:`PN`\ ``}``. Here
+is an example from the connman recipe:
+::
+
+ SYSTEMD_SERVICE_${PN} = "connman.service"
+
+Services are set up to start on boot automatically
+unless you have set
+:term:`SYSTEMD_AUTO_ENABLE` to "disable".
+
+For more information on ``systemd``, see the
+":ref:`dev-manual/dev-manual-common-tasks:selecting an initialization manager`"
+section in the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual.
+
+.. _ref-classes-systemd-boot:
+
+``systemd-boot.bbclass``
+========================
+
+The ``systemd-boot`` class provides functions specific to the
+systemd-boot bootloader for building bootable images. This is an
+internal class and is not intended to be used directly.
+
+.. note::
+
+ The
+ systemd-boot
+ class is a result from merging the
+ gummiboot
+ class used in previous Yocto Project releases with the
+ systemd
+ project.
+
+Set the :term:`EFI_PROVIDER` variable to
+"systemd-boot" to use this class. Doing so creates a standalone EFI
+bootloader that is not dependent on systemd.
+
+For information on more variables used and supported in this class, see
+the :term:`SYSTEMD_BOOT_CFG`,
+:term:`SYSTEMD_BOOT_ENTRIES`, and
+:term:`SYSTEMD_BOOT_TIMEOUT` variables.
+
+You can also see the `Systemd-boot
+documentation <http://www.freedesktop.org/wiki/Software/systemd/systemd-boot/>`__
+for more information.
+
+.. _ref-classes-terminal:
+
+``terminal.bbclass``
+====================
+
+The ``terminal`` class provides support for starting a terminal session.
+The :term:`OE_TERMINAL` variable controls which
+terminal emulator is used for the session.
+
+Other classes use the ``terminal`` class anywhere a separate terminal
+session needs to be started. For example, the
+:ref:`patch <ref-classes-patch>` class assuming
+:term:`PATCHRESOLVE` is set to "user", the
+:ref:`cml1 <ref-classes-cml1>` class, and the
+:ref:`devshell <ref-classes-devshell>` class all use the ``terminal``
+class.
+
+.. _ref-classes-testimage*:
+
+``testimage*.bbclass``
+======================
+
+The ``testimage*`` classes support running automated tests against
+images using QEMU and on actual hardware. The classes handle loading the
+tests and starting the image. To use the classes, you need to perform
+steps to set up the environment.
+
+.. note::
+
+ Best practices include using
+ IMAGE_CLASSES
+ rather than
+ INHERIT
+ to inherit the
+ testimage
+ class for automated image testing.
+
+The tests are commands that run on the target system over ``ssh``. Each
+test is written in Python and makes use of the ``unittest`` module.
+
+The ``testimage.bbclass`` runs tests on an image when called using the
+following:
+::
+
+ $ bitbake -c testimage image
+
+The ``testimage-auto`` class
+runs tests on an image after the image is constructed (i.e.
+:term:`TESTIMAGE_AUTO` must be set to "1").
+
+For information on how to enable, run, and create new tests, see the
+":ref:`dev-manual/dev-manual-common-tasks:performing automated runtime testing`"
+section in the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual.
+
+.. _ref-classes-testsdk:
+
+``testsdk.bbclass``
+===================
+
+This class supports running automated tests against software development
+kits (SDKs). The ``testsdk`` class runs tests on an SDK when called
+using the following:
+::
+
+ $ bitbake -c testsdk image
+
+.. note::
+
+ Best practices include using
+ IMAGE_CLASSES
+ rather than
+ INHERIT
+ to inherit the
+ testsdk
+ class for automated SDK testing.
+
+.. _ref-classes-texinfo:
+
+``texinfo.bbclass``
+===================
+
+This class should be inherited by recipes whose upstream packages invoke
+the ``texinfo`` utilities at build-time. Native and cross recipes are
+made to use the dummy scripts provided by ``texinfo-dummy-native``, for
+improved performance. Target architecture recipes use the genuine
+Texinfo utilities. By default, they use the Texinfo utilities on the
+host system.
+
+.. note::
+
+ If you want to use the Texinfo recipe shipped with the build system,
+ you can remove "texinfo-native" from
+ ASSUME_PROVIDED
+ and makeinfo from
+ SANITY_REQUIRED_UTILITIES
+ .
+
+.. _ref-classes-tinderclient:
+
+``tinderclient.bbclass``
+========================
+
+The ``tinderclient`` class submits build results to an external
+Tinderbox instance.
+
+.. note::
+
+ This class is currently unmaintained.
+
+.. _ref-classes-toaster:
+
+``toaster.bbclass``
+===================
+
+The ``toaster`` class collects information about packages and images and
+sends them as events that the BitBake user interface can receive. The
+class is enabled when the Toaster user interface is running.
+
+This class is not intended to be used directly.
+
+.. _ref-classes-toolchain-scripts:
+
+``toolchain-scripts.bbclass``
+=============================
+
+The ``toolchain-scripts`` class provides the scripts used for setting up
+the environment for installed SDKs.
+
+.. _ref-classes-typecheck:
+
+``typecheck.bbclass``
+=====================
+
+The ``typecheck`` class provides support for validating the values of
+variables set at the configuration level against their defined types.
+The OpenEmbedded build system allows you to define the type of a
+variable using the "type" varflag. Here is an example:
+::
+
+ IMAGE_FEATURES[type] = "list"
+
+.. _ref-classes-uboot-config:
+
+``uboot-config.bbclass``
+========================
+
+The ``uboot-config`` class provides support for U-Boot configuration for
+a machine. Specify the machine in your recipe as follows:
+::
+
+ UBOOT_CONFIG ??= <default>
+ UBOOT_CONFIG[foo] = "config,images"
+
+You can also specify the machine using this method:
+::
+
+ UBOOT_MACHINE = "config"
+
+See the :term:`UBOOT_CONFIG` and :term:`UBOOT_MACHINE` variables for additional
+information.
+
+.. _ref-classes-uninative:
+
+``uninative.bbclass``
+=====================
+
+Attempts to isolate the build system from the host distribution's C
+library in order to make re-use of native shared state artifacts across
+different host distributions practical. With this class enabled, a
+tarball containing a pre-built C library is downloaded at the start of
+the build. In the Poky reference distribution this is enabled by default
+through ``meta/conf/distro/include/yocto-uninative.inc``. Other
+distributions that do not derive from poky can also
+"``require conf/distro/include/yocto-uninative.inc``" to use this.
+Alternatively if you prefer, you can build the uninative-tarball recipe
+yourself, publish the resulting tarball (e.g. via HTTP) and set
+``UNINATIVE_URL`` and ``UNINATIVE_CHECKSUM`` appropriately. For an
+example, see the ``meta/conf/distro/include/yocto-uninative.inc``.
+
+The ``uninative`` class is also used unconditionally by the extensible
+SDK. When building the extensible SDK, ``uninative-tarball`` is built
+and the resulting tarball is included within the SDK.
+
+.. _ref-classes-update-alternatives:
+
+``update-alternatives.bbclass``
+===============================
+
+The ``update-alternatives`` class helps the alternatives system when
+multiple sources provide the same command. This situation occurs when
+several programs that have the same or similar function are installed
+with the same name. For example, the ``ar`` command is available from
+the ``busybox``, ``binutils`` and ``elfutils`` packages. The
+``update-alternatives`` class handles renaming the binaries so that
+multiple packages can be installed without conflicts. The ``ar`` command
+still works regardless of which packages are installed or subsequently
+removed. The class renames the conflicting binary in each package and
+symlinks the highest priority binary during installation or removal of
+packages.
+
+To use this class, you need to define a number of variables:
+
+- :term:`ALTERNATIVE`
+
+- :term:`ALTERNATIVE_LINK_NAME`
+
+- :term:`ALTERNATIVE_TARGET`
+
+- :term:`ALTERNATIVE_PRIORITY`
+
+These variables list alternative commands needed by a package, provide
+pathnames for links, default links for targets, and so forth. For
+details on how to use this class, see the comments in the
+:yocto_git:`update-alternatives.bbclass </cgit/cgit.cgi/poky/tree/meta/classes/update-alternatives.bbclass>`
+file.
+
+.. note::
+
+ You can use the
+ update-alternatives
+ command directly in your recipes. However, this class simplifies
+ things in most cases.
+
+.. _ref-classes-update-rc.d:
+
+``update-rc.d.bbclass``
+=======================
+
+The ``update-rc.d`` class uses ``update-rc.d`` to safely install an
+initialization script on behalf of the package. The OpenEmbedded build
+system takes care of details such as making sure the script is stopped
+before a package is removed and started when the package is installed.
+
+Three variables control this class: ``INITSCRIPT_PACKAGES``,
+``INITSCRIPT_NAME`` and ``INITSCRIPT_PARAMS``. See the variable links
+for details.
+
+.. _ref-classes-useradd:
+
+``useradd*.bbclass``
+====================
+
+The ``useradd*`` classes support the addition of users or groups for
+usage by the package on the target. For example, if you have packages
+that contain system services that should be run under their own user or
+group, you can use these classes to enable creation of the user or
+group. The ``meta-skeleton/recipes-skeleton/useradd/useradd-example.bb``
+recipe in the :term:`Source Directory` provides a simple
+example that shows how to add three users and groups to two packages.
+See the ``useradd-example.bb`` recipe for more information on how to use
+these classes.
+
+The ``useradd_base`` class provides basic functionality for user or
+groups settings.
+
+The ``useradd*`` classes support the
+:term:`USERADD_PACKAGES`,
+:term:`USERADD_PARAM`,
+:term:`GROUPADD_PARAM`, and
+:term:`GROUPMEMS_PARAM` variables.
+
+The ``useradd-staticids`` class supports the addition of users or groups
+that have static user identification (``uid``) and group identification
+(``gid``) values.
+
+The default behavior of the OpenEmbedded build system for assigning
+``uid`` and ``gid`` values when packages add users and groups during
+package install time is to add them dynamically. This works fine for
+programs that do not care what the values of the resulting users and
+groups become. In these cases, the order of the installation determines
+the final ``uid`` and ``gid`` values. However, if non-deterministic
+``uid`` and ``gid`` values are a problem, you can override the default,
+dynamic application of these values by setting static values. When you
+set static values, the OpenEmbedded build system looks in
+:term:`BBPATH` for ``files/passwd`` and ``files/group``
+files for the values.
+
+To use static ``uid`` and ``gid`` values, you need to set some
+variables. See the :term:`USERADDEXTENSION`,
+:term:`USERADD_UID_TABLES`,
+:term:`USERADD_GID_TABLES`, and
+:term:`USERADD_ERROR_DYNAMIC` variables.
+You can also see the :ref:`useradd <ref-classes-useradd>` class for
+additional information.
+
+.. note::
+
+ You do not use the
+ useradd-staticids
+ class directly. You either enable or disable the class by setting the
+ USERADDEXTENSION
+ variable. If you enable or disable the class in a configured system,
+ TMPDIR
+ might contain incorrect
+ uid
+ and
+ gid
+ values. Deleting the
+ TMPDIR
+ directory will correct this condition.
+
+.. _ref-classes-utility-tasks:
+
+``utility-tasks.bbclass``
+=========================
+
+The ``utility-tasks`` class provides support for various "utility" type
+tasks that are applicable to all recipes, such as
+:ref:`ref-tasks-clean` and
+:ref:`ref-tasks-listtasks`.
+
+This class is enabled by default because it is inherited by the
+:ref:`base <ref-classes-base>` class.
+
+.. _ref-classes-utils:
+
+``utils.bbclass``
+=================
+
+The ``utils`` class provides some useful Python functions that are
+typically used in inline Python expressions (e.g. ``${@...}``). One
+example use is for ``bb.utils.contains()``.
+
+This class is enabled by default because it is inherited by the
+:ref:`base <ref-classes-base>` class.
+
+.. _ref-classes-vala:
+
+``vala.bbclass``
+================
+
+The ``vala`` class supports recipes that need to build software written
+using the Vala programming language.
+
+.. _ref-classes-waf:
+
+``waf.bbclass``
+===============
+
+The ``waf`` class supports recipes that need to build software that uses
+the Waf build system. You can use the
+:term:`EXTRA_OECONF` or
+:term:`PACKAGECONFIG_CONFARGS` variables
+to specify additional configuration options to be passed on the Waf
+command line.
diff --git a/poky/documentation/ref-manual/ref-devtool-reference.rst b/poky/documentation/ref-manual/ref-devtool-reference.rst
new file mode 100644
index 000000000..eaca45ae2
--- /dev/null
+++ b/poky/documentation/ref-manual/ref-devtool-reference.rst
@@ -0,0 +1,625 @@
+.. SPDX-License-Identifier: CC-BY-2.0-UK
+
+***************************
+``devtool`` Quick Reference
+***************************
+
+The ``devtool`` command-line tool provides a number of features that
+help you build, test, and package software. This command is available
+alongside the ``bitbake`` command. Additionally, the ``devtool`` command
+is a key part of the extensible SDK.
+
+This chapter provides a Quick Reference for the ``devtool`` command. For
+more information on how to apply the command when using the extensible
+SDK, see the ":doc:`../sdk-manual/sdk-extensible`" chapter in the Yocto
+Project Application Development and the Extensible Software Development
+Kit (eSDK) manual.
+
+.. _devtool-getting-help:
+
+Getting Help
+============
+
+The ``devtool`` command line is organized similarly to Git in that it
+has a number of sub-commands for each function. You can run
+``devtool --help`` to see all the commands:
+::
+
+ $ devtool -h
+ NOTE: Starting bitbake server...
+ usage: devtool [--basepath BASEPATH] [--bbpath BBPATH] [-d] [-q] [--color COLOR] [-h] <subcommand> ...
+
+ OpenEmbedded development tool
+
+ options:
+ --basepath BASEPATH Base directory of SDK / build directory
+ --bbpath BBPATH Explicitly specify the BBPATH, rather than getting it from the metadata
+ -d, --debug Enable debug output
+ -q, --quiet Print only errors
+ --color COLOR Colorize output (where COLOR is auto, always, never)
+ -h, --help show this help message and exit
+
+ subcommands:
+ Beginning work on a recipe:
+ add Add a new recipe
+ modify Modify the source for an existing recipe
+ upgrade Upgrade an existing recipe
+ Getting information:
+ status Show workspace status
+ latest-version Report the latest version of an existing recipe
+ check-upgrade-status Report upgradability for multiple (or all) recipes
+ search Search available recipes
+ Working on a recipe in the workspace:
+ build Build a recipe
+ rename Rename a recipe file in the workspace
+ edit-recipe Edit a recipe file
+ find-recipe Find a recipe file
+ configure-help Get help on configure script options
+ update-recipe Apply changes from external source tree to recipe
+ reset Remove a recipe from your workspace
+ finish Finish working on a recipe in your workspace
+ Testing changes on target:
+ deploy-target Deploy recipe output files to live target machine
+ undeploy-target Undeploy recipe output files in live target machine
+ build-image Build image including workspace recipe packages
+ Advanced:
+ create-workspace Set up workspace in an alternative location
+ extract Extract the source for an existing recipe
+ sync Synchronize the source tree for an existing recipe
+ menuconfig Alter build-time configuration for a recipe
+ import Import exported tar archive into workspace
+ export Export workspace into a tar archive
+ other:
+ selftest-reverse Reverse value (for selftest)
+ pluginfile Print the filename of this plugin
+ bbdir Print the BBPATH directory of this plugin
+ count How many times have this plugin been registered.
+ multiloaded How many times have this plugin been initialized
+ Use devtool <subcommand> --help to get help on a specific command
+
+As directed in the general help output, you can
+get more syntax on a specific command by providing the command name and
+using "--help":
+::
+
+ $ devtool add --help
+ NOTE: Starting bitbake server...
+ usage: devtool add [-h] [--same-dir | --no-same-dir] [--fetch URI] [--npm-dev] [--version VERSION] [--no-git] [--srcrev SRCREV | --autorev] [--srcbranch SRCBRANCH] [--binary] [--also-native] [--src-subdir SUBDIR] [--mirrors]
+ [--provides PROVIDES]
+ [recipename] [srctree] [fetchuri]
+
+ Adds a new recipe to the workspace to build a specified source tree. Can optionally fetch a remote URI and unpack it to create the source tree.
+
+ arguments:
+ recipename Name for new recipe to add (just name - no version, path or extension). If not specified, will attempt to auto-detect it.
+ srctree Path to external source tree. If not specified, a subdirectory of /media/build1/poky/build/workspace/sources will be used.
+ fetchuri Fetch the specified URI and extract it to create the source tree
+
+ options:
+ -h, --help show this help message and exit
+ --same-dir, -s Build in same directory as source
+ --no-same-dir Force build in a separate build directory
+ --fetch URI, -f URI Fetch the specified URI and extract it to create the source tree (deprecated - pass as positional argument instead)
+ --npm-dev For npm, also fetch devDependencies
+ --version VERSION, -V VERSION
+ Version to use within recipe (PV)
+ --no-git, -g If fetching source, do not set up source tree as a git repository
+ --srcrev SRCREV, -S SRCREV
+ Source revision to fetch if fetching from an SCM such as git (default latest)
+ --autorev, -a When fetching from a git repository, set SRCREV in the recipe to a floating revision instead of fixed
+ --srcbranch SRCBRANCH, -B SRCBRANCH
+ Branch in source repository if fetching from an SCM such as git (default master)
+ --binary, -b Treat the source tree as something that should be installed verbatim (no compilation, same directory structure). Useful with binary packages e.g. RPMs.
+ --also-native Also add native variant (i.e. support building recipe for the build host as well as the target machine)
+ --src-subdir SUBDIR Specify subdirectory within source tree to use
+ --mirrors Enable PREMIRRORS and MIRRORS for source tree fetching (disable by default).
+ --provides PROVIDES, -p PROVIDES
+ Specify an alias for the item provided by the recipe. E.g. virtual/libgl
+
+.. _devtool-the-workspace-layer-structure:
+
+The Workspace Layer Structure
+=============================
+
+``devtool`` uses a "Workspace" layer in which to accomplish builds. This
+layer is not specific to any single ``devtool`` command but is rather a
+common working area used across the tool.
+
+The following figure shows the workspace structure:
+
+.. image:: figures/build-workspace-directory.png
+ :align: center
+ :scale: 70%
+
+::
+
+ attic - A directory created if devtool believes it must preserve
+ anything when you run "devtool reset". For example, if you
+ run "devtool add", make changes to the recipe, and then
+ run "devtool reset", devtool takes notice that the file has
+ been changed and moves it into the attic should you still
+ want the recipe.
+
+ README - Provides information on what is in workspace layer and how to
+ manage it.
+
+ .devtool_md5 - A checksum file used by devtool.
+
+ appends - A directory that contains *.bbappend files, which point to
+ external source.
+
+ conf - A configuration directory that contains the layer.conf file.
+
+ recipes - A directory containing recipes. This directory contains a
+ folder for each directory added whose name matches that of the
+ added recipe. devtool places the recipe.bb file
+ within that sub-directory.
+
+ sources - A directory containing a working copy of the source files used
+ when building the recipe. This is the default directory used
+ as the location of the source tree when you do not provide a
+ source tree path. This directory contains a folder for each
+ set of source files matched to a corresponding recipe.
+
+.. _devtool-adding-a-new-recipe-to-the-workspace:
+
+Adding a New Recipe to the Workspace Layer
+==========================================
+
+Use the ``devtool add`` command to add a new recipe to the workspace
+layer. The recipe you add should not exist - ``devtool`` creates it for
+you. The source files the recipe uses should exist in an external area.
+
+The following example creates and adds a new recipe named ``jackson`` to
+a workspace layer the tool creates. The source code built by the recipes
+resides in ``/home/user/sources/jackson``:
+::
+
+ $ devtool add jackson /home/user/sources/jackson
+
+If you add a recipe and the workspace layer does not exist, the command
+creates the layer and populates it as described in "`The Workspace Layer
+Structure <#devtool-the-workspace-layer-structure>`__" section.
+
+Running ``devtool add`` when the workspace layer exists causes the tool
+to add the recipe, append files, and source files into the existing
+workspace layer. The ``.bbappend`` file is created to point to the
+external source tree.
+
+.. note::
+
+ If your recipe has runtime dependencies defined, you must be sure
+ that these packages exist on the target hardware before attempting to
+ run your application. If dependent packages (e.g. libraries) do not
+ exist on the target, your application, when run, will fail to find
+ those functions. For more information, see the
+ ":ref:`ref-manual/ref-devtool-reference:deploying your software on the target machine`"
+ section.
+
+By default, ``devtool add`` uses the latest revision (i.e. master) when
+unpacking files from a remote URI. In some cases, you might want to
+specify a source revision by branch, tag, or commit hash. You can
+specify these options when using the ``devtool add`` command:
+
+- To specify a source branch, use the ``--srcbranch`` option:
+ ::
+
+ $ devtool add --srcbranch DISTRO_NAME_NO_CAP jackson /home/user/sources/jackson
+
+ In the previous example, you are checking out the DISTRO_NAME_NO_CAP
+ branch.
+
+- To specify a specific tag or commit hash, use the ``--srcrev``
+ option:
+ ::
+
+ $ devtool add --srcrev DISTRO_REL_TAG jackson /home/user/sources/jackson
+ $ devtool add --srcrev some_commit_hash /home/user/sources/jackson
+
+ The previous examples check out the
+ DISTRO_REL_TAG tag and the commit associated with the
+ some_commit_hash hash.
+
+.. note::
+
+ If you prefer to use the latest revision every time the recipe is
+ built, use the options --autorev or -a.
+
+.. _devtool-extracting-the-source-for-an-existing-recipe:
+
+Extracting the Source for an Existing Recipe
+============================================
+
+Use the ``devtool extract`` command to extract the source for an
+existing recipe. When you use this command, you must supply the root
+name of the recipe (i.e. no version, paths, or extensions), and you must
+supply the directory to which you want the source extracted.
+
+Additional command options let you control the name of a development
+branch into which you can checkout the source and whether or not to keep
+a temporary directory, which is useful for debugging.
+
+.. _devtool-synchronizing-a-recipes-extracted-source-tree:
+
+Synchronizing a Recipe's Extracted Source Tree
+==============================================
+
+Use the ``devtool sync`` command to synchronize a previously extracted
+source tree for an existing recipe. When you use this command, you must
+supply the root name of the recipe (i.e. no version, paths, or
+extensions), and you must supply the directory to which you want the
+source extracted.
+
+Additional command options let you control the name of a development
+branch into which you can checkout the source and whether or not to keep
+a temporary directory, which is useful for debugging.
+
+.. _devtool-modifying-a-recipe:
+
+Modifying an Existing Recipe
+============================
+
+Use the ``devtool modify`` command to begin modifying the source of an
+existing recipe. This command is very similar to the
+```add`` <#devtool-adding-a-new-recipe-to-the-workspace>`__ command
+except that it does not physically create the recipe in the workspace
+layer because the recipe already exists in an another layer.
+
+The ``devtool modify`` command extracts the source for a recipe, sets it
+up as a Git repository if the source had not already been fetched from
+Git, checks out a branch for development, and applies any patches from
+the recipe as commits on top. You can use the following command to
+checkout the source files:
+::
+
+ $ devtool modify recipe
+
+Using the above command form, ``devtool`` uses the existing recipe's
+:term:`SRC_URI` statement to locate the upstream source,
+extracts the source into the default sources location in the workspace.
+The default development branch used is "devtool".
+
+.. _devtool-edit-an-existing-recipe:
+
+Edit an Existing Recipe
+=======================
+
+Use the ``devtool edit-recipe`` command to run the default editor, which
+is identified using the ``EDITOR`` variable, on the specified recipe.
+
+When you use the ``devtool edit-recipe`` command, you must supply the
+root name of the recipe (i.e. no version, paths, or extensions). Also,
+the recipe file itself must reside in the workspace as a result of the
+``devtool add`` or ``devtool upgrade`` commands. However, you can
+override that requirement by using the "-a" or "--any-recipe" option.
+Using either of these options allows you to edit any recipe regardless
+of its location.
+
+.. _devtool-updating-a-recipe:
+
+Updating a Recipe
+=================
+
+Use the ``devtool update-recipe`` command to update your recipe with
+patches that reflect changes you make to the source files. For example,
+if you know you are going to work on some code, you could first use the
+```devtool modify`` <#devtool-modifying-a-recipe>`__ command to extract
+the code and set up the workspace. After which, you could modify,
+compile, and test the code.
+
+When you are satisfied with the results and you have committed your
+changes to the Git repository, you can then run the
+``devtool update-recipe`` to create the patches and update the recipe:
+::
+
+ $ devtool update-recipe recipe
+
+If you run the ``devtool update-recipe``
+without committing your changes, the command ignores the changes.
+
+Often, you might want to apply customizations made to your software in
+your own layer rather than apply them to the original recipe. If so, you
+can use the ``-a`` or ``--append`` option with the
+``devtool update-recipe`` command. These options allow you to specify
+the layer into which to write an append file:
+::
+
+ $ devtool update-recipe recipe -a base-layer-directory
+
+The ``*.bbappend`` file is created at the
+appropriate path within the specified layer directory, which may or may
+not be in your ``bblayers.conf`` file. If an append file already exists,
+the command updates it appropriately.
+
+.. _devtool-checking-on-the-upgrade-status-of-a-recipe:
+
+Checking on the Upgrade Status of a Recipe
+==========================================
+
+Upstream recipes change over time. Consequently, you might find that you
+need to determine if you can upgrade a recipe to a newer version.
+
+To check on the upgrade status of a recipe, use the
+``devtool check-upgrade-status`` command. The command displays a table
+of your current recipe versions, the latest upstream versions, the email
+address of the recipe's maintainer, and any additional information such
+as commit hash strings and reasons you might not be able to upgrade a
+particular recipe.
+
+.. note::
+
+ - For the ``oe-core`` layer, recipe maintainers come from the
+ `maintainers.inc <http://git.yoctoproject.org/cgit/cgit.cgi/poky/tree/meta/conf/distro/include/maintainers.inc>`_
+ file.
+
+ - If the recipe is using the :ref:`bitbake:git-fetcher`
+ rather than a
+ tarball, the commit hash points to the commit that matches the
+ recipe's latest version tag.
+
+As with all ``devtool`` commands, you can get help on the individual
+command:
+::
+
+ $ devtool check-upgrade-status -h
+ NOTE: Starting bitbake server...
+ usage: devtool check-upgrade-status [-h] [--all] [recipe [recipe ...]]
+
+ Prints a table of recipes together with versions currently provided by recipes, and latest upstream versions, when there is a later version available
+
+ arguments:
+ recipe Name of the recipe to report (omit to report upgrade info for all recipes)
+
+ options:
+ -h, --help show this help message and exit
+ --all, -a Show all recipes, not just recipes needing upgrade
+
+Unless you provide a specific recipe name on the command line, the
+command checks all recipes in all configured layers.
+
+Following is a partial example table that reports on all the recipes.
+Notice the reported reason for not upgrading the ``base-passwd`` recipe.
+In this example, while a new version is available upstream, you do not
+want to use it because the dependency on ``cdebconf`` is not easily
+satisfied.
+
+.. note::
+
+ When a reason for not upgrading displays, the reason is usually
+ written into the recipe using the RECIPE_NO_UPDATE_REASON
+ variable. See the base-passwd.bb recipe for an example.
+
+::
+
+ $ devtool check-upgrade-status ...
+ NOTE: acpid 2.0.30 2.0.31 Ross Burton <ross.burton@intel.com>
+ NOTE: u-boot-fw-utils 2018.11 2019.01 Marek Vasut <marek.vasut@gmail.com> d3689267f92c5956e09cc7d1baa4700141662bff
+ NOTE: u-boot-tools 2018.11 2019.01 Marek Vasut <marek.vasut@gmail.com> d3689267f92c5956e09cc7d1baa4700141662bff . . .
+ NOTE: base-passwd 3.5.29 3.5.45 Anuj Mittal <anuj.mittal@intel.com> cannot be updated due to: Version 3.5.38 requires cdebconf for update-passwd utility
+ NOTE: busybox 1.29.2 1.30.0 Andrej Valek <andrej.valek@siemens.com>
+ NOTE: dbus-test 1.12.10 1.12.12 Chen Qi <Qi.Chen@windriver.com>
+
+.. _devtool-upgrading-a-recipe:
+
+Upgrading a Recipe
+==================
+
+As software matures, upstream recipes are upgraded to newer versions. As
+a developer, you need to keep your local recipes up-to-date with the
+upstream version releases. Several methods exist by which you can
+upgrade recipes. You can read about them in the ":ref:`gs-upgrading-recipes`"
+section of the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual. This section
+overviews the ``devtool upgrade`` command.
+
+Before you upgrade a recipe, you can check on its upgrade status. See
+the ":ref:`devtool-checking-on-the-upgrade-status-of-a-recipe`" section
+for more information.
+
+The ``devtool upgrade`` command upgrades an existing recipe to a more
+recent version of the recipe upstream. The command puts the upgraded
+recipe file along with any associated files into a "workspace" and, if
+necessary, extracts the source tree to a specified location. During the
+upgrade, patches associated with the recipe are rebased or added as
+needed.
+
+When you use the ``devtool upgrade`` command, you must supply the root
+name of the recipe (i.e. no version, paths, or extensions), and you must
+supply the directory to which you want the source extracted. Additional
+command options let you control things such as the version number to
+which you want to upgrade (i.e. the :term:`PV`), the source
+revision to which you want to upgrade (i.e. the
+:term:`SRCREV`), whether or not to apply patches, and so
+forth.
+
+You can read more on the ``devtool upgrade`` workflow in the
+":ref:`sdk-devtool-use-devtool-upgrade-to-create-a-version-of-the-recipe-that-supports-a-newer-version-of-the-software`"
+section in the Yocto Project Application Development and the Extensible
+Software Development Kit (eSDK) manual. You can also see an example of
+how to use ``devtool upgrade`` in the ":ref:`gs-using-devtool-upgrade`"
+section in the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual.
+
+.. _devtool-resetting-a-recipe:
+
+Resetting a Recipe
+==================
+
+Use the ``devtool reset`` command to remove a recipe and its
+configuration (e.g. the corresponding ``.bbappend`` file) from the
+workspace layer. Realize that this command deletes the recipe and the
+append file. The command does not physically move them for you.
+Consequently, you must be sure to physically relocate your updated
+recipe and the append file outside of the workspace layer before running
+the ``devtool reset`` command.
+
+If the ``devtool reset`` command detects that the recipe or the append
+files have been modified, the command preserves the modified files in a
+separate "attic" subdirectory under the workspace layer.
+
+Here is an example that resets the workspace directory that contains the
+``mtr`` recipe:
+::
+
+ $ devtool reset mtr
+ NOTE: Cleaning sysroot for recipe mtr...
+ NOTE: Leaving source tree /home/scottrif/poky/build/workspace/sources/mtr as-is; if you no longer need it then please delete it manually
+ $
+
+.. _devtool-building-your-recipe:
+
+Building Your Recipe
+====================
+
+Use the ``devtool build`` command to build your recipe. The
+``devtool build`` command is equivalent to the
+``bitbake -c populate_sysroot`` command.
+
+When you use the ``devtool build`` command, you must supply the root
+name of the recipe (i.e. do not provide versions, paths, or extensions).
+You can use either the "-s" or the "--disable-parallel-make" options to
+disable parallel makes during the build. Here is an example:
+::
+
+ $ devtool build recipe
+
+.. _devtool-building-your-image:
+
+Building Your Image
+===================
+
+Use the ``devtool build-image`` command to build an image, extending it
+to include packages from recipes in the workspace. Using this command is
+useful when you want an image that ready for immediate deployment onto a
+device for testing. For proper integration into a final image, you need
+to edit your custom image recipe appropriately.
+
+When you use the ``devtool build-image`` command, you must supply the
+name of the image. This command has no command line options:
+::
+
+ $ devtool build-image image
+
+.. _devtool-deploying-your-software-on-the-target-machine:
+
+Deploying Your Software on the Target Machine
+=============================================
+
+Use the ``devtool deploy-target`` command to deploy the recipe's build
+output to the live target machine:
+::
+
+ $ devtool deploy-target recipe target
+
+The target is the address of the target machine, which must be running
+an SSH server (i.e. ``user@hostname[:destdir]``).
+
+This command deploys all files installed during the
+:ref:`ref-tasks-install` task. Furthermore, you do not
+need to have package management enabled within the target machine. If
+you do, the package manager is bypassed.
+
+.. note::
+
+ The ``deploy-target`` functionality is for development only. You
+ should never use it to update an image that will be used in
+ production.
+
+Some conditions exist that could prevent a deployed application from
+behaving as expected. When both of the following conditions exist, your
+application has the potential to not behave correctly when run on the
+target:
+
+- You are deploying a new application to the target and the recipe you
+ used to build the application had correctly defined runtime
+ dependencies.
+
+- The target does not physically have the packages on which the
+ application depends installed.
+
+If both of these conditions exist, your application will not behave as
+expected. The reason for this misbehavior is because the
+``devtool deploy-target`` command does not deploy the packages (e.g.
+libraries) on which your new application depends. The assumption is that
+the packages are already on the target. Consequently, when a runtime
+call is made in the application for a dependent function (e.g. a library
+call), the function cannot be found.
+
+To be sure you have all the dependencies local to the target, you need
+to be sure that the packages are pre-deployed (installed) on the target
+before attempting to run your application.
+
+.. _devtool-removing-your-software-from-the-target-machine:
+
+Removing Your Software from the Target Machine
+==============================================
+
+Use the ``devtool undeploy-target`` command to remove deployed build
+output from the target machine. For the ``devtool undeploy-target``
+command to work, you must have previously used the
+":ref:`devtool deploy-target <ref-manual/ref-devtool-reference:deploying your software on the target machine>`"
+command.
+::
+
+ $ devtool undeploy-target recipe target
+
+The target is the
+address of the target machine, which must be running an SSH server (i.e.
+``user@hostname``).
+
+.. _devtool-creating-the-workspace:
+
+Creating the Workspace Layer in an Alternative Location
+=======================================================
+
+Use the ``devtool create-workspace`` command to create a new workspace
+layer in your :term:`Build Directory`. When you create a
+new workspace layer, it is populated with the ``README`` file and the
+``conf`` directory only.
+
+The following example creates a new workspace layer in your current
+working and by default names the workspace layer "workspace":
+::
+
+ $ devtool create-workspace
+
+You can create a workspace layer anywhere by supplying a pathname with
+the command. The following command creates a new workspace layer named
+"new-workspace":
+::
+
+ $ devtool create-workspace /home/scottrif/new-workspace
+
+.. _devtool-get-the-status-of-the-recipes-in-your-workspace:
+
+Get the Status of the Recipes in Your Workspace
+===============================================
+
+Use the ``devtool status`` command to list the recipes currently in your
+workspace. Information includes the paths to their respective external
+source trees.
+
+The ``devtool status`` command has no command-line options:
+::
+
+ $ devtool status
+
+Following is sample output after using
+:ref:`devtool add <ref-manual/ref-devtool-reference:adding a new recipe to the workspace layer>`
+to create and add the ``mtr_0.86.bb`` recipe to the ``workspace`` directory:
+::
+
+ $ devtool status mtr
+ :/home/scottrif/poky/build/workspace/sources/mtr (/home/scottrif/poky/build/workspace/recipes/mtr/mtr_0.86.bb)
+ $
+
+.. _devtool-search-for-available-target-recipes:
+
+Search for Available Target Recipes
+===================================
+
+Use the ``devtool search`` command to search for available target
+recipes. The command matches the recipe name, package name, description,
+and installed files. The command displays the recipe name as a result of
+a match.
+
+When you use the ``devtool search`` command, you must supply a keyword.
+The command uses the keyword when searching for a match.
diff --git a/poky/documentation/ref-manual/ref-features.rst b/poky/documentation/ref-manual/ref-features.rst
new file mode 100644
index 000000000..ae5a0e3b2
--- /dev/null
+++ b/poky/documentation/ref-manual/ref-features.rst
@@ -0,0 +1,353 @@
+.. SPDX-License-Identifier: CC-BY-2.0-UK
+
+********
+Features
+********
+
+This chapter provides a reference of shipped machine and distro features
+you can include as part of your image, a reference on image features you
+can select, and a reference on feature backfilling.
+
+Features provide a mechanism for working out which packages should be
+included in the generated images. Distributions can select which
+features they want to support through the ``DISTRO_FEATURES`` variable,
+which is set or appended to in a distribution's configuration file such
+as ``poky.conf``, ``poky-tiny.conf``, ``poky-lsb.conf`` and so forth.
+Machine features are set in the ``MACHINE_FEATURES`` variable, which is
+set in the machine configuration file and specifies the hardware
+features for a given machine.
+
+These two variables combine to work out which kernel modules, utilities,
+and other packages to include. A given distribution can support a
+selected subset of features so some machine features might not be
+included if the distribution itself does not support them.
+
+One method you can use to determine which recipes are checking to see if
+a particular feature is contained or not is to ``grep`` through the
+:term:`Metadata` for the feature. Here is an example that
+discovers the recipes whose build is potentially changed based on a
+given feature:
+::
+
+ $ cd poky
+ $ git grep 'contains.*MACHINE_FEATURES.*feature'
+
+.. _ref-features-machine:
+
+Machine Features
+================
+
+The items below are features you can use with
+:term:`MACHINE_FEATURES`. Features do not have a
+one-to-one correspondence to packages, and they can go beyond simply
+controlling the installation of a package or packages. Sometimes a
+feature can influence how certain recipes are built. For example, a
+feature might determine whether a particular configure option is
+specified within the :ref:`ref-tasks-configure` task
+for a particular recipe.
+
+This feature list only represents features as shipped with the Yocto
+Project metadata:
+
+- *acpi:* Hardware has ACPI (x86/x86_64 only)
+
+- *alsa:* Hardware has ALSA audio drivers
+
+- *apm:* Hardware uses APM (or APM emulation)
+
+- *bluetooth:* Hardware has integrated BT
+
+- *efi:* Support for booting through EFI
+
+- *ext2:* Hardware HDD or Microdrive
+
+- *keyboard:* Hardware has a keyboard
+
+- *pcbios:* Support for booting through BIOS
+
+- *pci:* Hardware has a PCI bus
+
+- *pcmcia:* Hardware has PCMCIA or CompactFlash sockets
+
+- *phone:* Mobile phone (voice) support
+
+- *qvga:* Machine has a QVGA (320x240) display
+
+- *rtc:* Machine has a Real-Time Clock
+
+- *screen:* Hardware has a screen
+
+- *serial:* Hardware has serial support (usually RS232)
+
+- *touchscreen:* Hardware has a touchscreen
+
+- *usbgadget:* Hardware is USB gadget device capable
+
+- *usbhost:* Hardware is USB Host capable
+
+- *vfat:* FAT file system support
+
+- *wifi:* Hardware has integrated WiFi
+
+.. _ref-features-distro:
+
+Distro Features
+===============
+
+The items below are features you can use with
+:term:`DISTRO_FEATURES` to enable features across
+your distribution. Features do not have a one-to-one correspondence to
+packages, and they can go beyond simply controlling the installation of
+a package or packages. In most cases, the presence or absence of a
+feature translates to the appropriate option supplied to the configure
+script during the :ref:`ref-tasks-configure` task for
+the recipes that optionally support the feature.
+
+Some distro features are also machine features. These select features
+make sense to be controlled both at the machine and distribution
+configuration level. See the
+:term:`COMBINED_FEATURES` variable for more
+information.
+
+This list only represents features as shipped with the Yocto Project
+metadata:
+
+- *alsa:* Include ALSA support (OSS compatibility kernel modules
+ installed if available).
+
+- *api-documentation:* Enables generation of API documentation during
+ recipe builds. The resulting documentation is added to SDK tarballs
+ when the ``bitbake -c populate_sdk`` command is used. See the
+ ":ref:`sdk-manual/sdk-appendix-customizing-standard:adding api documentation to the standard sdk`"
+ section in the Yocto Project Application Development and the
+ Extensible Software Development Kit (eSDK) manual.
+
+- *bluetooth:* Include bluetooth support (integrated BT only).
+
+- *cramfs:* Include CramFS support.
+
+- *directfb:* Include DirectFB support.
+
+- *ext2:* Include tools for supporting for devices with internal
+ HDD/Microdrive for storing files (instead of Flash only devices).
+
+- *ipsec:* Include IPSec support.
+
+- *ipv6:* Include IPv6 support.
+
+- *keyboard:* Include keyboard support (e.g. keymaps will be loaded
+ during boot).
+
+- *ldconfig:* Include support for ldconfig and ``ld.so.conf`` on the
+ target.
+
+- *nfs:* Include NFS client support (for mounting NFS exports on
+ device).
+
+- *opengl:* Include the Open Graphics Library, which is a
+ cross-language, multi-platform application programming interface used
+ for rendering two and three-dimensional graphics.
+
+- *pci:* Include PCI bus support.
+
+- *pcmcia:* Include PCMCIA/CompactFlash support.
+
+- *ppp:* Include PPP dialup support.
+
+- *ptest:* Enables building the package tests where supported by
+ individual recipes. For more information on package tests, see the
+ ":ref:`dev-manual/dev-manual-common-tasks:testing packages with ptest`" section
+ in the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual.
+
+- *smbfs:* Include SMB networks client support (for mounting
+ Samba/Microsoft Windows shares on device).
+
+- *systemd:* Include support for this ``init`` manager, which is a full
+ replacement of for ``init`` with parallel starting of services,
+ reduced shell overhead, and other features. This ``init`` manager is
+ used by many distributions.
+
+- *usbgadget:* Include USB Gadget Device support (for USB
+ networking/serial/storage).
+
+- *usbhost:* Include USB Host support (allows to connect external
+ keyboard, mouse, storage, network etc).
+
+- *usrmerge:* Merges the ``/bin``, ``/sbin``, ``/lib``, and ``/lib64``
+ directories into their respective counterparts in the ``/usr``
+ directory to provide better package and application compatibility.
+
+- *wayland:* Include the Wayland display server protocol and the
+ library that supports it.
+
+- *wifi:* Include WiFi support (integrated only).
+
+- *x11:* Include the X server and libraries.
+
+.. _ref-features-image:
+
+Image Features
+==============
+
+The contents of images generated by the OpenEmbedded build system can be
+controlled by the :term:`IMAGE_FEATURES` and
+:term:`EXTRA_IMAGE_FEATURES` variables that
+you typically configure in your image recipes. Through these variables,
+you can add several different predefined packages such as development
+utilities or packages with debug information needed to investigate
+application problems or profile applications.
+
+The following image features are available for all images:
+
+- *allow-empty-password:* Allows Dropbear and OpenSSH to accept root
+ logins and logins from accounts having an empty password string.
+
+- *dbg-pkgs:* Installs debug symbol packages for all packages installed
+ in a given image.
+
+- *debug-tweaks:* Makes an image suitable for development (e.g. allows
+ root logins without passwords and enables post-installation logging).
+ See the 'allow-empty-password', 'empty-root-password', and
+ 'post-install-logging' features in this list for additional
+ information.
+
+- *dev-pkgs:* Installs development packages (headers and extra library
+ links) for all packages installed in a given image.
+
+- *doc-pkgs:* Installs documentation packages for all packages
+ installed in a given image.
+
+- *empty-root-password:* Sets the root password to an empty string,
+ which allows logins with a blank password.
+
+- *package-management:* Installs package management tools and preserves
+ the package manager database.
+
+- *post-install-logging:* Enables logging postinstall script runs to
+ the ``/var/log/postinstall.log`` file on first boot of the image on
+ the target system.
+
+ .. note::
+
+ To make the
+ /var/log
+ directory on the target persistent, use the
+ VOLATILE_LOG_DIR
+ variable by setting it to "no".
+
+- *ptest-pkgs:* Installs ptest packages for all ptest-enabled recipes.
+
+- *read-only-rootfs:* Creates an image whose root filesystem is
+ read-only. See the
+ ":ref:`dev-manual/dev-manual-common-tasks:creating a read-only root filesystem`"
+ section in the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual for more
+ information.
+
+- *splash:* Enables showing a splash screen during boot. By default,
+ this screen is provided by ``psplash``, which does allow
+ customization. If you prefer to use an alternative splash screen
+ package, you can do so by setting the ``SPLASH`` variable to a
+ different package name (or names) within the image recipe or at the
+ distro configuration level.
+
+- *staticdev-pkgs:* Installs static development packages, which are
+ static libraries (i.e. ``*.a`` files), for all packages installed in
+ a given image.
+
+Some image features are available only when you inherit the
+:ref:`core-image <ref-classes-core-image>` class. The current list of
+these valid features is as follows:
+
+- *hwcodecs:* Installs hardware acceleration codecs.
+
+- *nfs-server:* Installs an NFS server.
+
+- *perf:* Installs profiling tools such as ``perf``, ``systemtap``, and
+ ``LTTng``. For general information on user-space tools, see the
+ :doc:`../sdk-manual/sdk-manual` manual.
+
+- *ssh-server-dropbear:* Installs the Dropbear minimal SSH server.
+
+- *ssh-server-openssh:* Installs the OpenSSH SSH server, which is more
+ full-featured than Dropbear. Note that if both the OpenSSH SSH server
+ and the Dropbear minimal SSH server are present in
+ ``IMAGE_FEATURES``, then OpenSSH will take precedence and Dropbear
+ will not be installed.
+
+- *tools-debug:* Installs debugging tools such as ``strace`` and
+ ``gdb``. For information on GDB, see the
+ ":ref:`platdev-gdb-remotedebug`" section
+ in the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual. For information on
+ tracing and profiling, see the :doc:`../profile-manual/profile-manual`.
+
+- *tools-sdk:* Installs a full SDK that runs on the device.
+
+- *tools-testapps:* Installs device testing tools (e.g. touchscreen
+ debugging).
+
+- *x11:* Installs the X server.
+
+- *x11-base:* Installs the X server with a minimal environment.
+
+- *x11-sato:* Installs the OpenedHand Sato environment.
+
+.. _ref-features-backfill:
+
+Feature Backfilling
+===================
+
+Sometimes it is necessary in the OpenEmbedded build system to extend
+:term:`MACHINE_FEATURES` or
+:term:`DISTRO_FEATURES` to control functionality
+that was previously enabled and not able to be disabled. For these
+cases, we need to add an additional feature item to appear in one of
+these variables, but we do not want to force developers who have
+existing values of the variables in their configuration to add the new
+feature in order to retain the same overall level of functionality.
+Thus, the OpenEmbedded build system has a mechanism to automatically
+"backfill" these added features into existing distro or machine
+configurations. You can see the list of features for which this is done
+by finding the
+:term:`DISTRO_FEATURES_BACKFILL` and
+:term:`MACHINE_FEATURES_BACKFILL`
+variables in the ``meta/conf/bitbake.conf`` file.
+
+Because such features are backfilled by default into all configurations
+as described in the previous paragraph, developers who wish to disable
+the new features need to be able to selectively prevent the backfilling
+from occurring. They can do this by adding the undesired feature or
+features to the
+:term:`DISTRO_FEATURES_BACKFILL_CONSIDERED`
+or
+:term:`MACHINE_FEATURES_BACKFILL_CONSIDERED`
+variables for distro features and machine features respectively.
+
+Here are two examples to help illustrate feature backfilling:
+
+- *The "pulseaudio" distro feature option*: Previously, PulseAudio
+ support was enabled within the Qt and GStreamer frameworks. Because
+ of this, the feature is backfilled and thus enabled for all distros
+ through the ``DISTRO_FEATURES_BACKFILL`` variable in the
+ ``meta/conf/bitbake.conf`` file. However, your distro needs to
+ disable the feature. You can disable the feature without affecting
+ other existing distro configurations that need PulseAudio support by
+ adding "pulseaudio" to ``DISTRO_FEATURES_BACKFILL_CONSIDERED`` in
+ your distro's ``.conf`` file. Adding the feature to this variable
+ when it also exists in the ``DISTRO_FEATURES_BACKFILL`` variable
+ prevents the build system from adding the feature to your
+ configuration's ``DISTRO_FEATURES``, effectively disabling the
+ feature for that particular distro.
+
+- *The "rtc" machine feature option*: Previously, real time clock (RTC)
+ support was enabled for all target devices. Because of this, the
+ feature is backfilled and thus enabled for all machines through the
+ ``MACHINE_FEATURES_BACKFILL`` variable in the
+ ``meta/conf/bitbake.conf`` file. However, your target device does not
+ have this capability. You can disable RTC support for your device
+ without affecting other machines that need RTC support by adding the
+ feature to your machine's ``MACHINE_FEATURES_BACKFILL_CONSIDERED``
+ list in the machine's ``.conf`` file. Adding the feature to this
+ variable when it also exists in the ``MACHINE_FEATURES_BACKFILL``
+ variable prevents the build system from adding the feature to your
+ configuration's ``MACHINE_FEATURES``, effectively disabling RTC
+ support for that particular machine.
diff --git a/poky/documentation/ref-manual/ref-images.rst b/poky/documentation/ref-manual/ref-images.rst
new file mode 100644
index 000000000..f0229c3bb
--- /dev/null
+++ b/poky/documentation/ref-manual/ref-images.rst
@@ -0,0 +1,139 @@
+.. SPDX-License-Identifier: CC-BY-2.0-UK
+
+******
+Images
+******
+
+The OpenEmbedded build system provides several example images to satisfy
+different needs. When you issue the ``bitbake`` command you provide a
+"top-level" recipe that essentially begins the build for the type of
+image you want.
+
+.. note::
+
+ Building an image without GNU General Public License Version 3
+ (GPLv3), GNU Lesser General Public License Version 3 (LGPLv3), and
+ the GNU Affero General Public License Version 3 (AGPL-3.0) components
+ is only supported for minimal and base images. Furthermore, if you
+ are going to build an image using non-GPLv3 and similarly licensed
+ components, you must make the following changes in the
+ local.conf
+ file before using the BitBake command to build the minimal or base
+ image:
+ ::
+
+ 1. Comment out the EXTRA_IMAGE_FEATURES line
+ 2. Set INCOMPATIBLE_LICENSE = "GPL-3.0 LGPL-3.0 AGPL-3.0"
+
+
+From within the ``poky`` Git repository, you can use the following
+command to display the list of directories within the :term:`Source Directory`
+that contain image recipe files: ::
+
+ $ ls meta*/recipes*/images/*.bb
+
+Following is a list of supported recipes:
+
+- ``build-appliance-image``: An example virtual machine that contains
+ all the pieces required to run builds using the build system as well
+ as the build system itself. You can boot and run the image using
+ either the `VMware
+ Player <http://www.vmware.com/products/player/overview.html>`__ or
+ `VMware
+ Workstation <http://www.vmware.com/products/workstation/overview.html>`__.
+ For more information on this image, see the :yocto_home:`Build
+ Appliance <software-item/build-appliance>` page
+ on the Yocto Project website.
+
+- ``core-image-base``: A console-only image that fully supports the
+ target device hardware.
+
+- ``core-image-clutter``: An image with support for the Open GL-based
+ toolkit Clutter, which enables development of rich and animated
+ graphical user interfaces.
+
+- ``core-image-full-cmdline``: A console-only image with more
+ full-featured Linux system functionality installed.
+
+- ``core-image-lsb``: An image that conforms to the Linux Standard Base
+ (LSB) specification. This image requires a distribution configuration
+ that enables LSB compliance (e.g. ``poky-lsb``). If you build
+ ``core-image-lsb`` without that configuration, the image will not be
+ LSB-compliant.
+
+- ``core-image-lsb-dev``: A ``core-image-lsb`` image that is suitable
+ for development work using the host. The image includes headers and
+ libraries you can use in a host development environment. This image
+ requires a distribution configuration that enables LSB compliance
+ (e.g. ``poky-lsb``). If you build ``core-image-lsb-dev`` without that
+ configuration, the image will not be LSB-compliant.
+
+- ``core-image-lsb-sdk``: A ``core-image-lsb`` that includes everything
+ in the cross-toolchain but also includes development headers and
+ libraries to form a complete standalone SDK. This image requires a
+ distribution configuration that enables LSB compliance (e.g.
+ ``poky-lsb``). If you build ``core-image-lsb-sdk`` without that
+ configuration, the image will not be LSB-compliant. This image is
+ suitable for development using the target.
+
+- ``core-image-minimal``: A small image just capable of allowing a
+ device to boot.
+
+- ``core-image-minimal-dev``: A ``core-image-minimal`` image suitable
+ for development work using the host. The image includes headers and
+ libraries you can use in a host development environment.
+
+- ``core-image-minimal-initramfs``: A ``core-image-minimal`` image that
+ has the Minimal RAM-based Initial Root Filesystem (initramfs) as part
+ of the kernel, which allows the system to find the first "init"
+ program more efficiently. See the
+ :term:`PACKAGE_INSTALL` variable for
+ additional information helpful when working with initramfs images.
+
+- ``core-image-minimal-mtdutils``: A ``core-image-minimal`` image that
+ has support for the Minimal MTD Utilities, which let the user
+ interact with the MTD subsystem in the kernel to perform operations
+ on flash devices.
+
+- ``core-image-rt``: A ``core-image-minimal`` image plus a real-time
+ test suite and tools appropriate for real-time use.
+
+- ``core-image-rt-sdk``: A ``core-image-rt`` image that includes
+ everything in the cross-toolchain. The image also includes
+ development headers and libraries to form a complete stand-alone SDK
+ and is suitable for development using the target.
+
+- ``core-image-sato``: An image with Sato support, a mobile environment
+ and visual style that works well with mobile devices. The image
+ supports X11 with a Sato theme and applications such as a terminal,
+ editor, file manager, media player, and so forth.
+
+- ``core-image-sato-dev``: A ``core-image-sato`` image suitable for
+ development using the host. The image includes libraries needed to
+ build applications on the device itself, testing and profiling tools,
+ and debug symbols. This image was formerly ``core-image-sdk``.
+
+- ``core-image-sato-sdk``: A ``core-image-sato`` image that includes
+ everything in the cross-toolchain. The image also includes
+ development headers and libraries to form a complete standalone SDK
+ and is suitable for development using the target.
+
+- ``core-image-testmaster``: A "master" image designed to be used for
+ automated runtime testing. Provides a "known good" image that is
+ deployed to a separate partition so that you can boot into it and use
+ it to deploy a second image to be tested. You can find more
+ information about runtime testing in the
+ ":ref:`dev-manual/dev-manual-common-tasks:performing automated runtime testing`"
+ section in the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual.
+
+- ``core-image-testmaster-initramfs``: A RAM-based Initial Root
+ Filesystem (initramfs) image tailored for use with the
+ ``core-image-testmaster`` image.
+
+- ``core-image-weston``: A very basic Wayland image with a terminal.
+ This image provides the Wayland protocol libraries and the reference
+ Weston compositor. For more information, see the
+ ":ref:`dev-manual/dev-manual-common-tasks:using wayland and weston`"
+ section in the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual.
+
+- ``core-image-x11``: A very basic X11 image with a terminal.
diff --git a/poky/documentation/ref-manual/ref-images.xml b/poky/documentation/ref-manual/ref-images.xml
index aaeda5522..6f10a6fd2 100644
--- a/poky/documentation/ref-manual/ref-images.xml
+++ b/poky/documentation/ref-manual/ref-images.xml
@@ -9,7 +9,7 @@
<para>
The OpenEmbedded build system provides several example
images to satisfy different needs.
- When you issue the <filename>bitbake</filename> command you provide a “top-level” recipe
+ When you issue the <filename>bitbake</filename> command you provide a "top-level" recipe
that essentially begins the build for the type of image you want.
</para>
@@ -100,7 +100,7 @@
<listitem><para id='images-core-image-minimal-initramfs'><filename>core-image-minimal-initramfs</filename>:
A <filename>core-image-minimal</filename> image that has the Minimal RAM-based
Initial Root Filesystem (initramfs) as part of the kernel,
- which allows the system to find the first “init” program more efficiently.
+ which allows the system to find the first "init" program more efficiently.
See the
<link linkend='var-PACKAGE_INSTALL'><filename>PACKAGE_INSTALL</filename></link>
variable for additional information helpful when working with
diff --git a/poky/documentation/ref-manual/ref-kickstart.rst b/poky/documentation/ref-manual/ref-kickstart.rst
new file mode 100644
index 000000000..45222de05
--- /dev/null
+++ b/poky/documentation/ref-manual/ref-kickstart.rst
@@ -0,0 +1,212 @@
+.. SPDX-License-Identifier: CC-BY-2.0-UK
+
+*******************************************
+OpenEmbedded Kickstart (``.wks``) Reference
+*******************************************
+
+.. _openembedded-kickstart-wks-reference:
+
+Introduction
+============
+
+The current Wic implementation supports only the basic kickstart
+partitioning commands: ``partition`` (or ``part`` for short) and
+``bootloader``.
+
+.. note::
+
+ Future updates will implement more commands and options. If you use
+ anything that is not specifically supported, results can be
+ unpredictable.
+
+This chapter provides a reference on the available kickstart commands.
+The information lists the commands, their syntax, and meanings.
+Kickstart commands are based on the Fedora kickstart versions but with
+modifications to reflect Wic capabilities. You can see the original
+documentation for those commands at the following link:
+http://pykickstart.readthedocs.io/en/latest/kickstart-docs.html
+
+Command: part or partition
+==========================
+
+Either of these commands creates a partition on the system and uses the
+following syntax:
+::
+
+ part [mntpoint]
+ partition [mntpoint]
+
+If you do not
+provide mntpoint, Wic creates a partition but does not mount it.
+
+The ``mntpoint`` is where the partition is mounted and must be in one of
+the following forms:
+
+- ``/path``: For example, "/", "/usr", or "/home"
+
+- ``swap``: The created partition is used as swap space
+
+Specifying a mntpoint causes the partition to automatically be mounted.
+Wic achieves this by adding entries to the filesystem table (fstab)
+during image generation. In order for Wic to generate a valid fstab, you
+must also provide one of the ``--ondrive``, ``--ondisk``, or
+``--use-uuid`` partition options as part of the command.
+
+.. note::
+
+ The mount program must understand the PARTUUID syntax you use with
+ --use-uuid
+ and non-root
+ mountpoint
+ , including swap. The busybox versions of these application are
+ currently excluded.
+
+Here is an example that uses "/" as the mountpoint. The command uses
+``--ondisk`` to force the partition onto the ``sdb`` disk: part /
+--source rootfs --ondisk sdb --fstype=ext3 --label platform --align 1024
+
+Here is a list that describes other supported options you can use with
+the ``part`` and ``partition`` commands:
+
+- ``--size``: The minimum partition size in MBytes. Specify an
+ integer value such as 500. Do not append the number with "MB". You do
+ not need this option if you use ``--source``.
+
+- ``--fixed-size``: The exact partition size in MBytes. You cannot
+ specify with ``--size``. An error occurs when assembling the disk
+ image if the partition data is larger than ``--fixed-size``.
+
+- ``--source``: This option is a Wic-specific option that names the
+ source of the data that populates the partition. The most common
+ value for this option is "rootfs", but you can use any value that
+ maps to a valid source plugin. For information on the source plugins,
+ see the ":ref:`dev-manual/dev-manual-common-tasks:using the wic plugin interface`"
+ section in the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual.
+
+ If you use ``--source rootfs``, Wic creates a partition as large as
+ needed and fills it with the contents of the root filesystem pointed
+ to by the ``-r`` command-line option or the equivalent rootfs derived
+ from the ``-e`` command-line option. The filesystem type used to
+ create the partition is driven by the value of the ``--fstype``
+ option specified for the partition. See the entry on ``--fstype``
+ that follows for more information.
+
+ If you use ``--source plugin-name``, Wic creates a partition as large
+ as needed and fills it with the contents of the partition that is
+ generated by the specified plugin name using the data pointed to by
+ the ``-r`` command-line option or the equivalent rootfs derived from
+ the ``-e`` command-line option. Exactly what those contents are and
+ filesystem type used are dependent on the given plugin
+ implementation.
+
+ If you do not use the ``--source`` option, the ``wic`` command
+ creates an empty partition. Consequently, you must use the ``--size``
+ option to specify the size of the empty partition.
+
+- ``--ondisk`` or ``--ondrive``: Forces the partition to be created
+ on a particular disk.
+
+- ``--fstype``: Sets the file system type for the partition. Valid
+ values are:
+
+ - ``ext4``
+
+ - ``ext3``
+
+ - ``ext2``
+
+ - ``btrfs``
+
+ - ``squashfs``
+
+ - ``swap``
+
+- ``--fsoptions``: Specifies a free-form string of options to be used
+ when mounting the filesystem. This string is copied into the
+ ``/etc/fstab`` file of the installed system and should be enclosed in
+ quotes. If not specified, the default string is "defaults".
+
+- ``--label label``: Specifies the label to give to the filesystem to
+ be made on the partition. If the given label is already in use by
+ another filesystem, a new label is created for the partition.
+
+- ``--active``: Marks the partition as active.
+
+- ``--align (in KBytes)``: This option is a Wic-specific option that
+ says to start partitions on boundaries given x KBytes.
+
+- ``--no-table``: This option is a Wic-specific option. Using the
+ option reserves space for the partition and causes it to become
+ populated. However, the partition is not added to the partition
+ table.
+
+- ``--exclude-path``: This option is a Wic-specific option that
+ excludes the given relative path from the resulting image. This
+ option is only effective with the rootfs source plugin.
+
+- ``--extra-space``: This option is a Wic-specific option that adds
+ extra space after the space filled by the content of the partition.
+ The final size can exceed the size specified by the ``--size``
+ option. The default value is 10 Mbytes.
+
+- ``--overhead-factor``: This option is a Wic-specific option that
+ multiplies the size of the partition by the option's value. You must
+ supply a value greater than or equal to "1". The default value is
+ "1.3".
+
+- ``--part-name``: This option is a Wic-specific option that
+ specifies a name for GPT partitions.
+
+- ``--part-type``: This option is a Wic-specific option that
+ specifies the partition type globally unique identifier (GUID) for
+ GPT partitions. You can find the list of partition type GUIDs at
+ http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/GUID_Partition_Table#Partition_type_GUIDs.
+
+- ``--use-uuid``: This option is a Wic-specific option that causes
+ Wic to generate a random GUID for the partition. The generated
+ identifier is used in the bootloader configuration to specify the
+ root partition.
+
+- ``--uuid``: This option is a Wic-specific option that specifies the
+ partition UUID.
+
+- ``--fsuuid``: This option is a Wic-specific option that specifies
+ the filesystem UUID. You can generate or modify
+ :term:`WKS_FILE` with this option if a preconfigured
+ filesystem UUID is added to the kernel command line in the bootloader
+ configuration before you run Wic.
+
+- ``--system-id``: This option is a Wic-specific option that
+ specifies the partition system ID, which is a one byte long,
+ hexadecimal parameter with or without the 0x prefix.
+
+- ``--mkfs-extraopts``: This option specifies additional options to
+ pass to the ``mkfs`` utility. Some default options for certain
+ filesystems do not take effect. See Wic's help on kickstart (i.e.
+ ``wic help kickstart``).
+
+Command: bootloader
+===================
+
+This command specifies how the bootloader should be configured and
+supports the following options:
+
+.. note::
+
+ Bootloader functionality and boot partitions are implemented by the
+ various
+ --source
+ plugins that implement bootloader functionality. The bootloader
+ command essentially provides a means of modifying bootloader
+ configuration.
+
+- ``--timeout``: Specifies the number of seconds before the
+ bootloader times out and boots the default option.
+
+- ``--append``: Specifies kernel parameters. These parameters will be
+ added to the syslinux ``APPEND`` or ``grub`` kernel command line.
+
+- ``--configfile``: Specifies a user-defined configuration file for
+ the bootloader. You can provide a full pathname for the file or a
+ file that exists in the ``canned-wks`` folder. This option overrides
+ all other bootloader options.
diff --git a/poky/documentation/ref-manual/ref-manual.rst b/poky/documentation/ref-manual/ref-manual.rst
new file mode 100644
index 000000000..a106af21d
--- /dev/null
+++ b/poky/documentation/ref-manual/ref-manual.rst
@@ -0,0 +1,31 @@
+.. SPDX-License-Identifier: CC-BY-2.0-UK
+
+==============================
+Yocto Project Reference Manual
+==============================
+
+|
+
+.. toctree::
+ :caption: Table of Contents
+ :numbered:
+
+ ref-system-requirements
+ ref-terms
+ ref-release-process
+ migration
+ ref-structure
+ ref-classes
+ ref-tasks
+ ref-devtool-reference
+ ref-kickstart
+ ref-qa-checks
+ ref-images
+ ref-features
+ ref-variables
+ ref-varlocality
+ faq
+ resources
+ history
+
+.. include:: /boilerplate.rst
diff --git a/poky/documentation/ref-manual/ref-qa-checks.rst b/poky/documentation/ref-manual/ref-qa-checks.rst
new file mode 100644
index 000000000..3e76ac150
--- /dev/null
+++ b/poky/documentation/ref-manual/ref-qa-checks.rst
@@ -0,0 +1,533 @@
+.. SPDX-License-Identifier: CC-BY-2.0-UK
+
+*****************************
+QA Error and Warning Messages
+*****************************
+
+.. _qa-introduction:
+
+Introduction
+============
+
+When building a recipe, the OpenEmbedded build system performs various
+QA checks on the output to ensure that common issues are detected and
+reported. Sometimes when you create a new recipe to build new software,
+it will build with no problems. When this is not the case, or when you
+have QA issues building any software, it could take a little time to
+resolve them.
+
+While it is tempting to ignore a QA message or even to disable QA
+checks, it is best to try and resolve any reported QA issues. This
+chapter provides a list of the QA messages and brief explanations of the
+issues you could encounter so that you can properly resolve problems.
+
+The next section provides a list of all QA error and warning messages
+based on a default configuration. Each entry provides the message or
+error form along with an explanation.
+
+.. note::
+
+ - At the end of each message, the name of the associated QA test (as
+ listed in the ":ref:`insane.bbclass <ref-classes-insane>`"
+ section) appears within square brackets.
+
+ - As mentioned, this list of error and warning messages is for QA
+ checks only. The list does not cover all possible build errors or
+ warnings you could encounter.
+
+ - Because some QA checks are disabled by default, this list does not
+ include all possible QA check errors and warnings.
+
+.. _qa-errors-and-warnings:
+
+Errors and Warnings
+===================
+
+- ``<packagename>: <path> is using libexec please relocate to <libexecdir> [libexec]``
+
+ The specified package contains files in ``/usr/libexec`` when the
+ distro configuration uses a different path for ``<libexecdir>`` By
+ default, ``<libexecdir>`` is ``$prefix/libexec``. However, this
+ default can be changed (e.g. ``${libdir}``).
+
+  
+
+- ``package <packagename> contains bad RPATH <rpath> in file <file> [rpaths]``
+
+ The specified binary produced by the recipe contains dynamic library
+ load paths (rpaths) that contain build system paths such as
+ :term:`TMPDIR`, which are incorrect for the target and
+ could potentially be a security issue. Check for bad ``-rpath``
+ options being passed to the linker in your
+ :ref:`ref-tasks-compile` log. Depending on the build
+ system used by the software being built, there might be a configure
+ option to disable rpath usage completely within the build of the
+ software.
+
+  
+
+- ``<packagename>: <file> contains probably-redundant RPATH <rpath> [useless-rpaths]``
+
+ The specified binary produced by the recipe contains dynamic library
+ load paths (rpaths) that on a standard system are searched by default
+ by the linker (e.g. ``/lib`` and ``/usr/lib``). While these paths
+ will not cause any breakage, they do waste space and are unnecessary.
+ Depending on the build system used by the software being built, there
+ might be a configure option to disable rpath usage completely within
+ the build of the software.
+
+  
+
+- ``<packagename> requires <files>, but no providers in its RDEPENDS [file-rdeps]``
+
+ A file-level dependency has been identified from the specified
+ package on the specified files, but there is no explicit
+ corresponding entry in :term:`RDEPENDS`. If
+ particular files are required at runtime then ``RDEPENDS`` should be
+ declared in the recipe to ensure the packages providing them are
+ built.
+
+  
+
+- ``<packagename1> rdepends on <packagename2>, but it isn't a build dependency? [build-deps]``
+
+ A runtime dependency exists between the two specified packages, but
+ there is nothing explicit within the recipe to enable the
+ OpenEmbedded build system to ensure that dependency is satisfied.
+ This condition is usually triggered by an
+ :term:`RDEPENDS` value being added at the packaging
+ stage rather than up front, which is usually automatic based on the
+ contents of the package. In most cases, you should change the recipe
+ to add an explicit ``RDEPENDS`` for the dependency.
+
+  
+
+- ``non -dev/-dbg/nativesdk- package contains symlink .so: <packagename> path '<path>' [dev-so]``
+
+ Symlink ``.so`` files are for development only, and should therefore
+ go into the ``-dev`` package. This situation might occur if you add
+ ``*.so*`` rather than ``*.so.*`` to a non-dev package. Change
+ :term:`FILES` (and possibly
+ :term:`PACKAGES`) such that the specified ``.so``
+ file goes into an appropriate ``-dev`` package.
+
+  
+
+- ``non -staticdev package contains static .a library: <packagename> path '<path>' [staticdev]``
+
+ Static ``.a`` library files should go into a ``-staticdev`` package.
+ Change :term:`FILES` (and possibly
+ :term:`PACKAGES`) such that the specified ``.a`` file
+ goes into an appropriate ``-staticdev`` package.
+
+  
+
+- ``<packagename>: found library in wrong location [libdir]``
+
+ The specified file may have been installed into an incorrect
+ (possibly hardcoded) installation path. For example, this test will
+ catch recipes that install ``/lib/bar.so`` when ``${base_libdir}`` is
+ "lib32". Another example is when recipes install
+ ``/usr/lib64/foo.so`` when ``${libdir}`` is "/usr/lib". False
+ positives occasionally exist. For these cases add "libdir" to
+ :term:`INSANE_SKIP` for the package.
+
+  
+
+- ``non debug package contains .debug directory: <packagename> path <path> [debug-files]``
+
+ The specified package contains a ``.debug`` directory, which should
+ not appear in anything but the ``-dbg`` package. This situation might
+ occur if you add a path which contains a ``.debug`` directory and do
+ not explicitly add the ``.debug`` directory to the ``-dbg`` package.
+ If this is the case, add the ``.debug`` directory explicitly to
+ ``FILES_${PN}-dbg``. See :term:`FILES` for additional
+ information on ``FILES``.
+
+  
+
+- ``Architecture did not match (<machine_arch> to <file_arch>) on <file> [arch]``
+
+ By default, the OpenEmbedded build system checks the Executable and
+ Linkable Format (ELF) type, bit size, and endianness of any binaries
+ to ensure they match the target architecture. This test fails if any
+ binaries do not match the type since there would be an
+ incompatibility. The test could indicate that the wrong compiler or
+ compiler options have been used. Sometimes software, like
+ bootloaders, might need to bypass this check. If the file you receive
+ the error for is firmware that is not intended to be executed within
+ the target operating system or is intended to run on a separate
+ processor within the device, you can add "arch" to
+ :term:`INSANE_SKIP` for the package. Another
+ option is to check the :ref:`ref-tasks-compile` log
+ and verify that the compiler options being used are correct.
+
+  
+
+- ``Bit size did not match (<machine_bits> to <file_bits>) <recipe> on <file> [arch]``
+
+ By default, the OpenEmbedded build system checks the Executable and
+ Linkable Format (ELF) type, bit size, and endianness of any binaries
+ to ensure they match the target architecture. This test fails if any
+ binaries do not match the type since there would be an
+ incompatibility. The test could indicate that the wrong compiler or
+ compiler options have been used. Sometimes software, like
+ bootloaders, might need to bypass this check. If the file you receive
+ the error for is firmware that is not intended to be executed within
+ the target operating system or is intended to run on a separate
+ processor within the device, you can add "arch" to
+ :term:`INSANE_SKIP` for the package. Another
+ option is to check the :ref:`ref-tasks-compile` log
+ and verify that the compiler options being used are correct.
+
+  
+
+- ``Endianness did not match (<machine_endianness> to <file_endianness>) on <file> [arch]``
+
+ By default, the OpenEmbedded build system checks the Executable and
+ Linkable Format (ELF) type, bit size, and endianness of any binaries
+ to ensure they match the target architecture. This test fails if any
+ binaries do not match the type since there would be an
+ incompatibility. The test could indicate that the wrong compiler or
+ compiler options have been used. Sometimes software, like
+ bootloaders, might need to bypass this check. If the file you receive
+ the error for is firmware that is not intended to be executed within
+ the target operating system or is intended to run on a separate
+ processor within the device, you can add "arch" to
+ :term:`INSANE_SKIP` for the package. Another
+ option is to check the :ref:`ref-tasks-compile` log
+ and verify that the compiler options being used are correct.
+
+  
+
+- ``ELF binary '<file>' has relocations in .text [textrel]``
+
+ The specified ELF binary contains relocations in its ``.text``
+ sections. This situation can result in a performance impact at
+ runtime.
+
+ Typically, the way to solve this performance issue is to add "-fPIC"
+ or "-fpic" to the compiler command-line options. For example, given
+ software that reads :term:`CFLAGS` when you build it,
+ you could add the following to your recipe:
+ ::
+
+ CFLAGS_append = " -fPIC "
+
+ For more information on text relocations at runtime, see
+ http://www.akkadia.org/drepper/textrelocs.html.
+
+  
+
+- ``No GNU_HASH in the elf binary: '<file>' [ldflags]``
+
+ This indicates that binaries produced when building the recipe have
+ not been linked with the :term:`LDFLAGS` options
+ provided by the build system. Check to be sure that the ``LDFLAGS``
+ variable is being passed to the linker command. A common workaround
+ for this situation is to pass in ``LDFLAGS`` using
+ :term:`TARGET_CC_ARCH` within the recipe as
+ follows:
+ ::
+
+ TARGET_CC_ARCH += "${LDFLAGS}"
+
+  
+
+- ``Package <packagename> contains Xorg driver (<driver>) but no xorg-abi- dependencies [xorg-driver-abi]``
+
+ The specified package contains an Xorg driver, but does not have a
+ corresponding ABI package dependency. The xserver-xorg recipe
+ provides driver ABI names. All drivers should depend on the ABI
+ versions that they have been built against. Driver recipes that
+ include ``xorg-driver-input.inc`` or ``xorg-driver-video.inc`` will
+ automatically get these versions. Consequently, you should only need
+ to explicitly add dependencies to binary driver recipes.
+
+  
+
+- ``The /usr/share/info/dir file is not meant to be shipped in a particular package. [infodir]``
+
+ The ``/usr/share/info/dir`` should not be packaged. Add the following
+ line to your :ref:`ref-tasks-install` task or to your
+ ``do_install_append`` within the recipe as follows:
+ ::
+
+ rm ${D}${infodir}/dir
+  
+
+- ``Symlink <path> in <packagename> points to TMPDIR [symlink-to-sysroot]``
+
+ The specified symlink points into :term:`TMPDIR` on the
+ host. Such symlinks will work on the host. However, they are clearly
+ invalid when running on the target. You should either correct the
+ symlink to use a relative path or remove the symlink.
+
+  
+
+- ``<file> failed sanity test (workdir) in path <path> [la]``
+
+ The specified ``.la`` file contains :term:`TMPDIR`
+ paths. Any ``.la`` file containing these paths is incorrect since
+ ``libtool`` adds the correct sysroot prefix when using the files
+ automatically itself.
+
+  
+
+- ``<file> failed sanity test (tmpdir) in path <path> [pkgconfig]``
+
+ The specified ``.pc`` file contains
+ :term:`TMPDIR`\ ``/``\ :term:`WORKDIR`
+ paths. Any ``.pc`` file containing these paths is incorrect since
+ ``pkg-config`` itself adds the correct sysroot prefix when the files
+ are accessed.
+
+  
+
+- ``<packagename> rdepends on <debug_packagename> [debug-deps]``
+
+ A dependency exists between the specified non-dbg package (i.e. a
+ package whose name does not end in ``-dbg``) and a package that is a
+ ``dbg`` package. The ``dbg`` packages contain debug symbols and are
+ brought in using several different methods:
+
+ - Using the ``dbg-pkgs``
+ :term:`IMAGE_FEATURES` value.
+
+ - Using :term:`IMAGE_INSTALL`.
+
+ - As a dependency of another ``dbg`` package that was brought in
+ using one of the above methods.
+
+ The dependency might have been automatically added because the
+ ``dbg`` package erroneously contains files that it should not contain
+ (e.g. a non-symlink ``.so`` file) or it might have been added
+ manually (e.g. by adding to :term:`RDEPENDS`).
+
+  
+
+- ``<packagename> rdepends on <dev_packagename> [dev-deps]``
+
+ A dependency exists between the specified non-dev package (a package
+ whose name does not end in ``-dev``) and a package that is a ``dev``
+ package. The ``dev`` packages contain development headers and are
+ usually brought in using several different methods:
+
+ - Using the ``dev-pkgs``
+ :term:`IMAGE_FEATURES` value.
+
+ - Using :term:`IMAGE_INSTALL`.
+
+ - As a dependency of another ``dev`` package that was brought in
+ using one of the above methods.
+
+ The dependency might have been automatically added (because the
+ ``dev`` package erroneously contains files that it should not have
+ (e.g. a non-symlink ``.so`` file) or it might have been added
+ manually (e.g. by adding to :term:`RDEPENDS`).
+
+  
+
+- ``<var>_<packagename> is invalid: <comparison> (<value>) only comparisons <, =, >, <=, and >= are allowed [dep-cmp]``
+
+ If you are adding a versioned dependency relationship to one of the
+ dependency variables (:term:`RDEPENDS`,
+ :term:`RRECOMMENDS`,
+ :term:`RSUGGESTS`,
+ :term:`RPROVIDES`,
+ :term:`RREPLACES`, or
+ :term:`RCONFLICTS`), you must only use the named
+ comparison operators. Change the versioned dependency values you are
+ adding to match those listed in the message.
+
+  
+
+- ``<recipename>: The compile log indicates that host include and/or library paths were used. Please check the log '<logfile>' for more information. [compile-host-path]``
+
+ The log for the :ref:`ref-tasks-compile` task
+ indicates that paths on the host were searched for files, which is
+ not appropriate when cross-compiling. Look for "is unsafe for
+ cross-compilation" or "CROSS COMPILE Badness" in the specified log
+ file.
+
+  
+
+- ``<recipename>: The install log indicates that host include and/or library paths were used. Please check the log '<logfile>' for more information. [install-host-path]``
+
+ The log for the :ref:`ref-tasks-install` task
+ indicates that paths on the host were searched for files, which is
+ not appropriate when cross-compiling. Look for "is unsafe for
+ cross-compilation" or "CROSS COMPILE Badness" in the specified log
+ file.
+
+  
+
+- ``This autoconf log indicates errors, it looked at host include and/or library paths while determining system capabilities. Rerun configure task after fixing this. The path was '<path>'``
+
+ The log for the :ref:`ref-tasks-configure` task
+ indicates that paths on the host were searched for files, which is
+ not appropriate when cross-compiling. Look for "is unsafe for
+ cross-compilation" or "CROSS COMPILE Badness" in the specified log
+ file.
+
+  
+
+- ``<packagename> doesn't match the [a-z0-9.+-]+ regex [pkgname]``
+
+ The convention within the OpenEmbedded build system (sometimes
+ enforced by the package manager itself) is to require that package
+ names are all lower case and to allow a restricted set of characters.
+ If your recipe name does not match this, or you add packages to
+ :term:`PACKAGES` that do not conform to the
+ convention, then you will receive this error. Rename your recipe. Or,
+ if you have added a non-conforming package name to ``PACKAGES``,
+ change the package name appropriately.
+
+  
+
+- ``<recipe>: configure was passed unrecognized options: <options> [unknown-configure-option]``
+
+ The configure script is reporting that the specified options are
+ unrecognized. This situation could be because the options were
+ previously valid but have been removed from the configure script. Or,
+ there was a mistake when the options were added and there is another
+ option that should be used instead. If you are unsure, consult the
+ upstream build documentation, the ``./configure --help`` output, and
+ the upstream change log or release notes. Once you have worked out
+ what the appropriate change is, you can update
+ :term:`EXTRA_OECONF`,
+ :term:`PACKAGECONFIG_CONFARGS`, or the
+ individual :term:`PACKAGECONFIG` option values
+ accordingly.
+
+  
+
+- ``Recipe <recipefile> has PN of "<recipename>" which is in OVERRIDES, this can result in unexpected behavior. [pn-overrides]``
+
+ The specified recipe has a name (:term:`PN`) value that
+ appears in :term:`OVERRIDES`. If a recipe is named
+ such that its ``PN`` value matches something already in ``OVERRIDES``
+ (e.g. ``PN`` happens to be the same as :term:`MACHINE`
+ or :term:`DISTRO`), it can have unexpected
+ consequences. For example, assignments such as
+ ``FILES_${PN} = "xyz"`` effectively turn into ``FILES = "xyz"``.
+ Rename your recipe (or if ``PN`` is being set explicitly, change the
+ ``PN`` value) so that the conflict does not occur. See
+ :term:`FILES` for additional information.
+
+  
+
+- ``<recipefile>: Variable <variable> is set as not being package specific, please fix this. [pkgvarcheck]``
+
+ Certain variables (:term:`RDEPENDS`,
+ :term:`RRECOMMENDS`,
+ :term:`RSUGGESTS`,
+ :term:`RCONFLICTS`,
+ :term:`RPROVIDES`,
+ :term:`RREPLACES`, :term:`FILES`,
+ ``pkg_preinst``, ``pkg_postinst``, ``pkg_prerm``, ``pkg_postrm``, and
+ :term:`ALLOW_EMPTY`) should always be set specific
+ to a package (i.e. they should be set with a package name override
+ such as ``RDEPENDS_${PN} = "value"`` rather than
+ ``RDEPENDS = "value"``). If you receive this error, correct any
+ assignments to these variables within your recipe.
+
+  
+
+- ``File '<file>' from <recipename> was already stripped, this will prevent future debugging! [already-stripped]``
+
+ Produced binaries have already been stripped prior to the build
+ system extracting debug symbols. It is common for upstream software
+ projects to default to stripping debug symbols for output binaries.
+ In order for debugging to work on the target using ``-dbg`` packages,
+ this stripping must be disabled.
+
+ Depending on the build system used by the software being built,
+ disabling this stripping could be as easy as specifying an additional
+ configure option. If not, disabling stripping might involve patching
+ the build scripts. In the latter case, look for references to "strip"
+ or "STRIP", or the "-s" or "-S" command-line options being specified
+ on the linker command line (possibly through the compiler command
+ line if preceded with "-Wl,").
+
+ .. note::
+
+ Disabling stripping here does not mean that the final packaged
+ binaries will be unstripped. Once the OpenEmbedded build system
+ splits out debug symbols to the
+ -dbg
+ package, it will then strip the symbols from the binaries.
+
+  
+
+- ``<packagename> is listed in PACKAGES multiple times, this leads to packaging errors. [packages-list]``
+
+ Package names must appear only once in the
+ :term:`PACKAGES` variable. You might receive this
+ error if you are attempting to add a package to ``PACKAGES`` that is
+ already in the variable's value.
+
+  
+
+- ``FILES variable for package <packagename> contains '//' which is invalid. Attempting to fix this but you should correct the metadata. [files-invalid]``
+
+ The string "//" is invalid in a Unix path. Correct all occurrences
+ where this string appears in a :term:`FILES` variable so
+ that there is only a single "/".
+
+  
+
+- ``<recipename>: Files/directories were installed but not shipped in any package [installed-vs-shipped]``
+
+ Files have been installed within the
+ :ref:`ref-tasks-install` task but have not been
+ included in any package by way of the :term:`FILES`
+ variable. Files that do not appear in any package cannot be present
+ in an image later on in the build process. You need to do one of the
+ following:
+
+ - Add the files to ``FILES`` for the package you want them to appear
+ in (e.g. ``FILES_${``\ :term:`PN`\ ``}`` for the main
+ package).
+
+ - Delete the files at the end of the ``do_install`` task if the
+ files are not needed in any package.
+
+  
+
+- ``<oldpackage>-<oldpkgversion> was registered as shlib provider for <library>, changing it to <newpackage>-<newpkgversion> because it was built later``
+
+ This message means that both ``<oldpackage>`` and ``<newpackage>``
+ provide the specified shared library. You can expect this message
+ when a recipe has been renamed. However, if that is not the case, the
+ message might indicate that a private version of a library is being
+ erroneously picked up as the provider for a common library. If that
+ is the case, you should add the library's ``.so`` file name to
+ :term:`PRIVATE_LIBS` in the recipe that provides
+ the private version of the library.
+
+- ``LICENSE_<packagename> includes licenses (<licenses>) that are not listed in LICENSE [unlisted-pkg-lics]``
+
+ The :term:`LICENSE` of the recipe should be a superset
+ of all the licenses of all packages produced by this recipe. In other
+ words, any license in ``LICENSE_*`` should also appear in
+ :term:`LICENSE`.
+
+  
+
+Configuring and Disabling QA Checks
+===================================
+
+You can configure the QA checks globally so that specific check failures
+either raise a warning or an error message, using the
+:term:`WARN_QA` and :term:`ERROR_QA`
+variables, respectively. You can also disable checks within a particular
+recipe using :term:`INSANE_SKIP`. For information on
+how to work with the QA checks, see the
+":ref:`insane.bbclass <ref-classes-insane>`" section.
+
+.. note::
+
+ Please keep in mind that the QA checks exist in order to detect real
+ or potential problems in the packaged output. So exercise caution
+ when disabling these checks.
diff --git a/poky/documentation/ref-manual/ref-release-process.rst b/poky/documentation/ref-manual/ref-release-process.rst
new file mode 100644
index 000000000..be041e725
--- /dev/null
+++ b/poky/documentation/ref-manual/ref-release-process.rst
@@ -0,0 +1,193 @@
+.. SPDX-License-Identifier: CC-BY-2.0-UK
+
+*****************************************************
+Yocto Project Releases and the Stable Release Process
+*****************************************************
+
+The Yocto Project release process is predictable and consists of both
+major and minor (point) releases. This brief chapter provides
+information on how releases are named, their life cycle, and their
+stability.
+
+Major and Minor Release Cadence
+===============================
+
+The Yocto Project delivers major releases (e.g. DISTRO) using a six
+month cadence roughly timed each April and October of the year.
+Following are examples of some major YP releases with their codenames
+also shown. See the "`Major Release
+Codenames <#major-release-codenames>`__" section for information on
+codenames used with major releases.
+
+ - 2.2 (Morty)
+ - 2.1 (Krogoth)
+ - 2.0 (Jethro)
+
+While the cadence is never perfect, this timescale facilitates
+regular releases that have strong QA cycles while not overwhelming users
+with too many new releases. The cadence is predictable and avoids many
+major holidays in various geographies.
+
+The Yocto project delivers minor (point) releases on an unscheduled
+basis and are usually driven by the accumulation of enough significant
+fixes or enhancements to the associated major release. Following are
+some example past point releases:
+
+ - 2.1.1
+ - 2.1.2
+ - 2.2.1
+
+The point release
+indicates a point in the major release branch where a full QA cycle and
+release process validates the content of the new branch.
+
+.. note::
+
+ Realize that there can be patches merged onto the stable release
+ branches as and when they become available.
+
+Major Release Codenames
+=======================
+
+Each major release receives a codename that identifies the release in
+the :ref:`overview-manual/overview-manual-development-environment:yocto project source repositories`.
+The concept is that branches of :term:`Metadata` with the same
+codename are likely to be compatible and thus work together.
+
+.. note::
+
+ Codenames are associated with major releases because a Yocto Project
+ release number (e.g. DISTRO) could conflict with a given layer or
+ company versioning scheme. Codenames are unique, interesting, and
+ easily identifiable.
+
+Releases are given a nominal release version as well but the codename is
+used in repositories for this reason. You can find information on Yocto
+Project releases and codenames at
+https://wiki.yoctoproject.org/wiki/Releases.
+
+Stable Release Process
+======================
+
+Once released, the release enters the stable release process at which
+time a person is assigned as the maintainer for that stable release.
+This maintainer monitors activity for the release by investigating and
+handling nominated patches and backport activity. Only fixes and
+enhancements that have first been applied on the "master" branch (i.e.
+the current, in-development branch) are considered for backporting to a
+stable release.
+
+.. note::
+
+ The current Yocto Project policy regarding backporting is to consider
+ bug fixes and security fixes only. Policy dictates that features are
+ not backported to a stable release. This policy means generic recipe
+ version upgrades are unlikely to be accepted for backporting. The
+ exception to this policy occurs when a strong reason exists such as
+ the fix happens to also be the preferred upstream approach.
+
+Stable release branches have strong maintenance for about a year after
+their initial release. Should significant issues be found for any
+release regardless of its age, fixes could be backported to older
+releases. For issues that are not backported given an older release,
+Community LTS trees and branches exist where community members share
+patches for older releases. However, these types of patches do not go
+through the same release process as do point releases. You can find more
+information about stable branch maintenance at
+https://wiki.yoctoproject.org/wiki/Stable_branch_maintenance.
+
+Testing and Quality Assurance
+=============================
+
+Part of the Yocto Project development and release process is quality
+assurance through the execution of test strategies. Test strategies
+provide the Yocto Project team a way to ensure a release is validated.
+Additionally, because the test strategies are visible to you as a
+developer, you can validate your projects. This section overviews the
+available test infrastructure used in the Yocto Project. For information
+on how to run available tests on your projects, see the
+":ref:`dev-manual/dev-manual-common-tasks:performing automated runtime testing`"
+section in the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual.
+
+The QA/testing infrastructure is woven into the project to the point
+where core developers take some of it for granted. The infrastructure
+consists of the following pieces:
+
+- ``bitbake-selftest``: A standalone command that runs unit tests on
+ key pieces of BitBake and its fetchers.
+
+- :ref:`sanity.bbclass <ref-classes-sanity>`: This automatically
+ included class checks the build environment for missing tools (e.g.
+ ``gcc``) or common misconfigurations such as
+ :term:`MACHINE` set incorrectly.
+
+- :ref:`insane.bbclass <ref-classes-insane>`: This class checks the
+ generated output from builds for sanity. For example, if building for
+ an ARM target, did the build produce ARM binaries. If, for example,
+ the build produced PPC binaries then there is a problem.
+
+- :ref:`testimage.bbclass <ref-classes-testimage*>`: This class
+ performs runtime testing of images after they are built. The tests
+ are usually used with :doc:`QEMU <../dev-manual/dev-manual-qemu>`
+ to boot the images and check the combined runtime result boot
+ operation and functions. However, the test can also use the IP
+ address of a machine to test.
+
+- :ref:`ptest <dev-manual/dev-manual-common-tasks:testing packages with ptest>`:
+ Runs tests against packages produced during the build for a given
+ piece of software. The test allows the packages to be be run within a
+ target image.
+
+- ``oe-selftest``: Tests combination BitBake invocations. These tests
+ operate outside the OpenEmbedded build system itself. The
+ ``oe-selftest`` can run all tests by default or can run selected
+ tests or test suites.
+
+ .. note::
+
+ Running
+ oe-selftest
+ requires host packages beyond the "Essential" grouping. See the "
+ Required Packages for the Build Host
+ " section for more information.
+
+Originally, much of this testing was done manually. However, significant
+effort has been made to automate the tests so that more people can use
+them and the Yocto Project development team can run them faster and more
+efficiently.
+
+The Yocto Project's main Autobuilder (https://autobuilder.yoctoproject.org/)
+publicly tests each Yocto Project release's code in the
+:term:`OpenEmbedded-Core (OE-Core)`, Poky, and BitBake repositories. The testing
+occurs for both the current state of the "master" branch and also for
+submitted patches. Testing for submitted patches usually occurs in the
+"ross/mut" branch in the ``poky-contrib`` repository (i.e. the
+master-under-test branch) or in the "master-next" branch in the ``poky``
+repository.
+
+.. note::
+
+ You can find all these branches in the Yocto Project
+ Source Repositories
+ .
+
+Testing within these public branches ensures in a publicly visible way
+that all of the main supposed architectures and recipes in OE-Core
+successfully build and behave properly.
+
+Various features such as ``multilib``, sub architectures (e.g. ``x32``,
+``poky-tiny``, ``musl``, ``no-x11`` and and so forth),
+``bitbake-selftest``, and ``oe-selftest`` are tested as part of the QA
+process of a release. Complete testing and validation for a release
+takes the Autobuilder workers several hours.
+
+.. note::
+
+ The Autobuilder workers are non-homogeneous, which means regular
+ testing across a variety of Linux distributions occurs. The
+ Autobuilder is limited to only testing QEMU-based setups and not real
+ hardware.
+
+Finally, in addition to the Autobuilder's tests, the Yocto Project QA
+team also performs testing on a variety of platforms, which includes
+actual hardware, to ensure expected results.
diff --git a/poky/documentation/ref-manual/ref-structure.rst b/poky/documentation/ref-manual/ref-structure.rst
new file mode 100644
index 000000000..48a443331
--- /dev/null
+++ b/poky/documentation/ref-manual/ref-structure.rst
@@ -0,0 +1,890 @@
+.. SPDX-License-Identifier: CC-BY-2.0-UK
+
+**************************
+Source Directory Structure
+**************************
+
+The :term:`Source Directory` consists of numerous files,
+directories and subdirectories; understanding their locations and
+contents is key to using the Yocto Project effectively. This chapter
+describes the Source Directory and gives information about those files
+and directories.
+
+For information on how to establish a local Source Directory on your
+development system, see the
+":ref:`dev-manual/dev-manual-start:locating yocto project source files`"
+section in the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual.
+
+.. note::
+
+ The OpenEmbedded build system does not support file or directory
+ names that contain spaces. Be sure that the Source Directory you use
+ does not contain these types of names.
+
+.. _structure-core:
+
+Top-Level Core Components
+=========================
+
+This section describes the top-level components of the :term:`Source Directory`.
+
+.. _structure-core-bitbake:
+
+``bitbake/``
+------------
+
+This directory includes a copy of BitBake for ease of use. The copy
+usually matches the current stable BitBake release from the BitBake
+project. BitBake, a :term:`Metadata` interpreter, reads the
+Yocto Project Metadata and runs the tasks defined by that data. Failures
+are usually caused by errors in your Metadata and not from BitBake
+itself; consequently, most users do not need to worry about BitBake.
+
+When you run the ``bitbake`` command, the main BitBake executable (which
+resides in the ``bitbake/bin/`` directory) starts. Sourcing the
+environment setup script (i.e. :ref:`structure-core-script`) places
+the ``scripts/`` and ``bitbake/bin/`` directories (in that order) into
+the shell's ``PATH`` environment variable.
+
+For more information on BitBake, see the :doc:`BitBake User Manual
+<bitbake:index>`.
+
+.. _structure-core-build:
+
+``build/``
+----------
+
+This directory contains user configuration files and the output
+generated by the OpenEmbedded build system in its standard configuration
+where the source tree is combined with the output. The :term:`Build Directory`
+is created initially when you ``source``
+the OpenEmbedded build environment setup script (i.e.
+:ref:`structure-core-script`).
+
+It is also possible to place output and configuration files in a
+directory separate from the :term:`Source Directory` by
+providing a directory name when you ``source`` the setup script. For
+information on separating output from your local Source Directory files
+(commonly described as an "out of tree" build), see the
+":ref:`structure-core-script`" section.
+
+.. _handbook:
+
+``documentation/``
+------------------
+
+This directory holds the source for the Yocto Project documentation as
+well as templates and tools that allow you to generate PDF and HTML
+versions of the manuals. Each manual is contained in its own sub-folder;
+for example, the files for this reference manual reside in the
+``ref-manual/`` directory.
+
+.. _structure-core-meta:
+
+``meta/``
+---------
+
+This directory contains the minimal, underlying OpenEmbedded-Core
+metadata. The directory holds recipes, common classes, and machine
+configuration for strictly emulated targets (``qemux86``, ``qemuarm``,
+and so forth.)
+
+.. _structure-core-meta-poky:
+
+``meta-poky/``
+--------------
+
+Designed above the ``meta/`` content, this directory adds just enough
+metadata to define the Poky reference distribution.
+
+.. _structure-core-meta-yocto-bsp:
+
+``meta-yocto-bsp/``
+-------------------
+
+This directory contains the Yocto Project reference hardware Board
+Support Packages (BSPs). For more information on BSPs, see the
+:doc:`../bsp-guide/bsp-guide`.
+
+.. _structure-meta-selftest:
+
+``meta-selftest/``
+------------------
+
+This directory adds additional recipes and append files used by the
+OpenEmbedded selftests to verify the behavior of the build system. You
+do not have to add this layer to your ``bblayers.conf`` file unless you
+want to run the selftests.
+
+.. _structure-meta-skeleton:
+
+``meta-skeleton/``
+------------------
+
+This directory contains template recipes for BSP and kernel development.
+
+.. _structure-core-scripts:
+
+``scripts/``
+------------
+
+This directory contains various integration scripts that implement extra
+functionality in the Yocto Project environment (e.g. QEMU scripts). The
+:ref:`structure-core-script` script prepends this directory to the
+shell's ``PATH`` environment variable.
+
+The ``scripts`` directory has useful scripts that assist in contributing
+back to the Yocto Project, such as ``create-pull-request`` and
+``send-pull-request``.
+
+.. _structure-core-script:
+
+``oe-init-build-env``
+---------------------
+
+This script sets up the OpenEmbedded build environment. Running this
+script with the ``source`` command in a shell makes changes to ``PATH``
+and sets other core BitBake variables based on the current working
+directory. You need to run an environment setup script before running
+BitBake commands. The script uses other scripts within the ``scripts``
+directory to do the bulk of the work.
+
+When you run this script, your Yocto Project environment is set up, a
+:term:`Build Directory` is created, your working
+directory becomes the Build Directory, and you are presented with some
+simple suggestions as to what to do next, including a list of some
+possible targets to build. Here is an example:
+::
+
+ $ source oe-init-build-env
+
+ ### Shell environment set up for builds. ###
+
+ You can now run 'bitbake <target>'
+
+ Common targets are:
+ core-image-minimal
+ core-image-sato
+ meta-toolchain
+ meta-ide-support
+
+ You can also run generated qemu images with a command like 'runqemu qemux86-64'
+
+The default output of the ``oe-init-build-env`` script is from the
+``conf-notes.txt`` file, which is found in the ``meta-poky`` directory
+within the :term:`Source Directory`. If you design a
+custom distribution, you can include your own version of this
+configuration file to mention the targets defined by your distribution.
+See the
+":ref:`dev-manual/dev-manual-common-tasks:creating a custom template configuration directory`"
+section in the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual for more
+information.
+
+By default, running this script without a Build Directory argument
+creates the ``build/`` directory in your current working directory. If
+you provide a Build Directory argument when you ``source`` the script,
+you direct the OpenEmbedded build system to create a Build Directory of
+your choice. For example, the following command creates a Build
+Directory named ``mybuilds/`` that is outside of the :term:`Source Directory`:
+::
+
+ $ source OE_INIT_FILE ~/mybuilds
+
+The OpenEmbedded build system uses the template configuration files, which
+are found by default in the ``meta-poky/conf/`` directory in the Source
+Directory. See the
+":ref:`dev-manual/dev-manual-common-tasks:creating a custom template configuration directory`"
+section in the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual for more
+information.
+
+.. note::
+
+ The OpenEmbedded build system does not support file or directory
+ names that contain spaces. If you attempt to run the
+ OE_INIT_FILE
+ script from a Source Directory that contains spaces in either the
+ filenames or directory names, the script returns an error indicating
+ no such file or directory. Be sure to use a Source Directory free of
+ names containing spaces.
+
+.. _structure-basic-top-level:
+
+``LICENSE, README, and README.hardware``
+----------------------------------------
+
+These files are standard top-level files.
+
+.. _structure-build:
+
+The Build Directory - ``build/``
+================================
+
+The OpenEmbedded build system creates the :term:`Build Directory`
+when you run the build environment setup
+script :ref:`structure-core-script`. If you do not give the Build
+Directory a specific name when you run the setup script, the name
+defaults to ``build/``.
+
+For subsequent parsing and processing, the name of the Build directory
+is available via the :term:`TOPDIR` variable.
+
+.. _structure-build-buildhistory:
+
+``build/buildhistory/``
+-----------------------
+
+The OpenEmbedded build system creates this directory when you enable
+build history via the ``buildhistory`` class file. The directory
+organizes build information into image, packages, and SDK
+subdirectories. For information on the build history feature, see the
+":ref:`dev-manual/dev-manual-common-tasks:maintaining build output quality`"
+section in the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual.
+
+.. _structure-build-conf-local.conf:
+
+``build/conf/local.conf``
+-------------------------
+
+This configuration file contains all the local user configurations for
+your build environment. The ``local.conf`` file contains documentation
+on the various configuration options. Any variable set here overrides
+any variable set elsewhere within the environment unless that variable
+is hard-coded within a file (e.g. by using '=' instead of '?='). Some
+variables are hard-coded for various reasons but such variables are
+relatively rare.
+
+At a minimum, you would normally edit this file to select the target
+``MACHINE``, which package types you wish to use
+(:term:`PACKAGE_CLASSES`), and the location from
+which you want to access downloaded files (``DL_DIR``).
+
+If ``local.conf`` is not present when you start the build, the
+OpenEmbedded build system creates it from ``local.conf.sample`` when you
+``source`` the top-level build environment setup script
+:ref:`structure-core-script`.
+
+The source ``local.conf.sample`` file used depends on the
+``$TEMPLATECONF`` script variable, which defaults to ``meta-poky/conf/``
+when you are building from the Yocto Project development environment,
+and to ``meta/conf/`` when you are building from the OpenEmbedded-Core
+environment. Because the script variable points to the source of the
+``local.conf.sample`` file, this implies that you can configure your
+build environment from any layer by setting the variable in the
+top-level build environment setup script as follows:
+::
+
+ TEMPLATECONF=your_layer/conf
+
+Once the build process gets the sample
+file, it uses ``sed`` to substitute final
+``${``\ :term:`OEROOT`\ ``}`` values for all
+``##OEROOT##`` values.
+
+.. note::
+
+ You can see how the
+ TEMPLATECONF
+ variable is used by looking at the
+ scripts/oe-setup-builddir
+ script in the
+ Source Directory
+ . You can find the Yocto Project version of the
+ local.conf.sample
+ file in the
+ meta-poky/conf
+ directory.
+
+.. _structure-build-conf-bblayers.conf:
+
+``build/conf/bblayers.conf``
+----------------------------
+
+This configuration file defines
+:ref:`layers <dev-manual/dev-manual-common-tasks:understanding and creating layers>`,
+which are directory trees, traversed (or walked) by BitBake. The
+``bblayers.conf`` file uses the :term:`BBLAYERS`
+variable to list the layers BitBake tries to find.
+
+If ``bblayers.conf`` is not present when you start the build, the
+OpenEmbedded build system creates it from ``bblayers.conf.sample`` when
+you ``source`` the top-level build environment setup script (i.e.
+:ref:`structure-core-script`).
+
+As with the ``local.conf`` file, the source ``bblayers.conf.sample``
+file used depends on the ``$TEMPLATECONF`` script variable, which
+defaults to ``meta-poky/conf/`` when you are building from the Yocto
+Project development environment, and to ``meta/conf/`` when you are
+building from the OpenEmbedded-Core environment. Because the script
+variable points to the source of the ``bblayers.conf.sample`` file, this
+implies that you can base your build from any layer by setting the
+variable in the top-level build environment setup script as follows:
+::
+
+ TEMPLATECONF=your_layer/conf
+
+Once the build process gets the sample file, it uses ``sed`` to substitute final
+``${``\ :term:`OEROOT`\ ``}`` values for all ``##OEROOT##`` values.
+
+.. note::
+
+ You can see how the
+ TEMPLATECONF
+ variable
+ scripts/oe-setup-builddir
+ script in the
+ Source Directory
+ . You can find the Yocto Project version of the
+ bblayers.conf.sample
+ file in the
+ meta-poky/conf/
+ directory.
+
+.. _structure-build-conf-sanity_info:
+
+``build/cache/sanity_info``
+---------------------------
+
+This file indicates the state of the sanity checks and is created during
+the build.
+
+.. _structure-build-downloads:
+
+``build/downloads/``
+--------------------
+
+This directory contains downloaded upstream source tarballs. You can
+reuse the directory for multiple builds or move the directory to another
+location. You can control the location of this directory through the
+``DL_DIR`` variable.
+
+.. _structure-build-sstate-cache:
+
+``build/sstate-cache/``
+-----------------------
+
+This directory contains the shared state cache. You can reuse the
+directory for multiple builds or move the directory to another location.
+You can control the location of this directory through the
+``SSTATE_DIR`` variable.
+
+.. _structure-build-tmp:
+
+``build/tmp/``
+--------------
+
+The OpenEmbedded build system creates and uses this directory for all
+the build system's output. The :term:`TMPDIR` variable
+points to this directory.
+
+BitBake creates this directory if it does not exist. As a last resort,
+to clean up a build and start it from scratch (other than the
+downloads), you can remove everything in the ``tmp`` directory or get
+rid of the directory completely. If you do, you should also completely
+remove the ``build/sstate-cache`` directory.
+
+.. _structure-build-tmp-buildstats:
+
+``build/tmp/buildstats/``
+-------------------------
+
+This directory stores the build statistics.
+
+.. _structure-build-tmp-cache:
+
+``build/tmp/cache/``
+--------------------
+
+When BitBake parses the metadata (recipes and configuration files), it
+caches the results in ``build/tmp/cache/`` to speed up future builds.
+The results are stored on a per-machine basis.
+
+During subsequent builds, BitBake checks each recipe (together with, for
+example, any files included or appended to it) to see if they have been
+modified. Changes can be detected, for example, through file
+modification time (mtime) changes and hashing of file contents. If no
+changes to the file are detected, then the parsed result stored in the
+cache is reused. If the file has changed, it is reparsed.
+
+.. _structure-build-tmp-deploy:
+
+``build/tmp/deploy/``
+---------------------
+
+This directory contains any "end result" output from the OpenEmbedded
+build process. The :term:`DEPLOY_DIR` variable points
+to this directory. For more detail on the contents of the ``deploy``
+directory, see the
+":ref:`images-dev-environment`" and
+":ref:`sdk-dev-environment`" sections in the Yocto
+Project Overview and Concepts Manual.
+
+.. _structure-build-tmp-deploy-deb:
+
+``build/tmp/deploy/deb/``
+-------------------------
+
+This directory receives any ``.deb`` packages produced by the build
+process. The packages are sorted into feeds for different architecture
+types.
+
+.. _structure-build-tmp-deploy-rpm:
+
+``build/tmp/deploy/rpm/``
+-------------------------
+
+This directory receives any ``.rpm`` packages produced by the build
+process. The packages are sorted into feeds for different architecture
+types.
+
+.. _structure-build-tmp-deploy-ipk:
+
+``build/tmp/deploy/ipk/``
+-------------------------
+
+This directory receives ``.ipk`` packages produced by the build process.
+
+.. _structure-build-tmp-deploy-licenses:
+
+``build/tmp/deploy/licenses/``
+------------------------------
+
+This directory receives package licensing information. For example, the
+directory contains sub-directories for ``bash``, ``busybox``, and
+``glibc`` (among others) that in turn contain appropriate ``COPYING``
+license files with other licensing information. For information on
+licensing, see the
+":ref:`dev-manual/dev-manual-common-tasks:maintaining open source license compliance during your product's lifecycle`"
+section in the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual.
+
+.. _structure-build-tmp-deploy-images:
+
+``build/tmp/deploy/images/``
+----------------------------
+
+This directory is populated with the basic output objects of the build
+(think of them as the "generated artifacts" of the build process),
+including things like the boot loader image, kernel, root filesystem and
+more. If you want to flash the resulting image from a build onto a
+device, look here for the necessary components.
+
+Be careful when deleting files in this directory. You can safely delete
+old images from this directory (e.g. ``core-image-*``). However, the
+kernel (``*zImage*``, ``*uImage*``, etc.), bootloader and other
+supplementary files might be deployed here prior to building an image.
+Because these files are not directly produced from the image, if you
+delete them they will not be automatically re-created when you build the
+image again.
+
+If you do accidentally delete files here, you will need to force them to
+be re-created. In order to do that, you will need to know the target
+that produced them. For example, these commands rebuild and re-create
+the kernel files:
+::
+
+ $ bitbake -c clean virtual/kernel
+ $ bitbake virtual/kernel
+
+.. _structure-build-tmp-deploy-sdk:
+
+``build/tmp/deploy/sdk/``
+-------------------------
+
+The OpenEmbedded build system creates this directory to hold toolchain
+installer scripts which, when executed, install the sysroot that matches
+your target hardware. You can find out more about these installers in
+the ":ref:`sdk-manual/sdk-appendix-obtain:building an sdk installer`"
+section in the Yocto Project Application Development and the Extensible
+Software Development Kit (eSDK) manual.
+
+.. _structure-build-tmp-sstate-control:
+
+``build/tmp/sstate-control/``
+-----------------------------
+
+The OpenEmbedded build system uses this directory for the shared state
+manifest files. The shared state code uses these files to record the
+files installed by each sstate task so that the files can be removed
+when cleaning the recipe or when a newer version is about to be
+installed. The build system also uses the manifests to detect and
+produce a warning when files from one task are overwriting those from
+another.
+
+.. _structure-build-tmp-sysroots-components:
+
+``build/tmp/sysroots-components/``
+----------------------------------
+
+This directory is the location of the sysroot contents that the task
+:ref:`ref-tasks-prepare_recipe_sysroot`
+links or copies into the recipe-specific sysroot for each recipe listed
+in :term:`DEPENDS`. Population of this directory is
+handled through shared state, while the path is specified by the
+:term:`COMPONENTS_DIR` variable. Apart from a few
+unusual circumstances, handling of the ``sysroots-components`` directory
+should be automatic, and recipes should not directly reference
+``build/tmp/sysroots-components``.
+
+.. _structure-build-tmp-sysroots:
+
+``build/tmp/sysroots/``
+-----------------------
+
+Previous versions of the OpenEmbedded build system used to create a
+global shared sysroot per machine along with a native sysroot. Beginning
+with the DISTRO version of the Yocto Project, sysroots exist in
+recipe-specific :term:`WORKDIR` directories. Thus, the
+``build/tmp/sysroots/`` directory is unused.
+
+.. note::
+
+ The
+ build/tmp/sysroots/
+ directory can still be populated using the
+ bitbake build-sysroots
+ command and can be used for compatibility in some cases. However, in
+ general it is not recommended to populate this directory. Individual
+ recipe-specific sysroots should be used.
+
+.. _structure-build-tmp-stamps:
+
+``build/tmp/stamps/``
+---------------------
+
+This directory holds information that BitBake uses for accounting
+purposes to track what tasks have run and when they have run. The
+directory is sub-divided by architecture, package name, and version.
+Following is an example:
+stamps/all-poky-linux/distcc-config/1.0-r0.do_build-2fdd....2do Although
+the files in the directory are empty of data, BitBake uses the filenames
+and timestamps for tracking purposes.
+
+For information on how BitBake uses stamp files to determine if a task
+should be rerun, see the
+":ref:`overview-manual/overview-manual-concepts:stamp files and the rerunning of tasks`"
+section in the Yocto Project Overview and Concepts Manual.
+
+.. _structure-build-tmp-log:
+
+``build/tmp/log/``
+------------------
+
+This directory contains general logs that are not otherwise placed using
+the package's ``WORKDIR``. Examples of logs are the output from the
+``do_check_pkg`` or ``do_distro_check`` tasks. Running a build does not
+necessarily mean this directory is created.
+
+.. _structure-build-tmp-work:
+
+``build/tmp/work/``
+-------------------
+
+This directory contains architecture-specific work sub-directories for
+packages built by BitBake. All tasks execute from the appropriate work
+directory. For example, the source for a particular package is unpacked,
+patched, configured and compiled all within its own work directory.
+Within the work directory, organization is based on the package group
+and version for which the source is being compiled as defined by the
+:term:`WORKDIR`.
+
+It is worth considering the structure of a typical work directory. As an
+example, consider ``linux-yocto-kernel-3.0`` on the machine ``qemux86``
+built within the Yocto Project. For this package, a work directory of
+``tmp/work/qemux86-poky-linux/linux-yocto/3.0+git1+<.....>``, referred
+to as the ``WORKDIR``, is created. Within this directory, the source is
+unpacked to ``linux-qemux86-standard-build`` and then patched by Quilt.
+(See the ":ref:`using-a-quilt-workflow`" section in
+the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual for more information.) Within
+the ``linux-qemux86-standard-build`` directory, standard Quilt
+directories ``linux-3.0/patches`` and ``linux-3.0/.pc`` are created, and
+standard Quilt commands can be used.
+
+There are other directories generated within ``WORKDIR``. The most
+important directory is ``WORKDIR/temp/``, which has log files for each
+task (``log.do_*.pid``) and contains the scripts BitBake runs for each
+task (``run.do_*.pid``). The ``WORKDIR/image/`` directory is where "make
+install" places its output that is then split into sub-packages within
+``WORKDIR/packages-split/``.
+
+.. _structure-build-tmp-work-tunearch-recipename-version:
+
+``build/tmp/work/tunearch/recipename/version/``
+-----------------------------------------------
+
+The recipe work directory - ``${WORKDIR}``.
+
+As described earlier in the
+"```build/tmp/sysroots/`` <#structure-build-tmp-sysroots>`__" section,
+beginning with the DISTRO release of the Yocto Project, the OpenEmbedded
+build system builds each recipe in its own work directory (i.e.
+:term:`WORKDIR`). The path to the work directory is
+constructed using the architecture of the given build (e.g.
+:term:`TUNE_PKGARCH`,
+:term:`MACHINE_ARCH`, or "allarch"), the recipe
+name, and the version of the recipe (i.e.
+:term:`PE`\ ``:``\ :term:`PV`\ ``-``\ :term:`PR`).
+
+A number of key subdirectories exist within each recipe work directory:
+
+- ``${WORKDIR}/temp``: Contains the log files of each task executed for
+ this recipe, the "run" files for each executed task, which contain
+ the code run, and a ``log.task_order`` file, which lists the order in
+ which tasks were executed.
+
+- ``${WORKDIR}/image``: Contains the output of the
+ :ref:`ref-tasks-install` task, which corresponds to
+ the ``${``\ :term:`D`\ ``}`` variable in that task.
+
+- ``${WORKDIR}/pseudo``: Contains the pseudo database and log for any
+ tasks executed under pseudo for the recipe.
+
+- ``${WORKDIR}/sysroot-destdir``: Contains the output of the
+ :ref:`ref-tasks-populate_sysroot` task.
+
+- ``${WORKDIR}/package``: Contains the output of the
+ :ref:`ref-tasks-package` task before the output is
+ split into individual packages.
+
+- ``${WORKDIR}/packages-split``: Contains the output of the
+ ``do_package`` task after the output has been split into individual
+ packages. Subdirectories exist for each individual package created by
+ the recipe.
+
+- ``${WORKDIR}/recipe-sysroot``: A directory populated with the target
+ dependencies of the recipe. This directory looks like the target
+ filesystem and contains libraries that the recipe might need to link
+ against (e.g. the C library).
+
+- ``${WORKDIR}/recipe-sysroot-native``: A directory populated with the
+ native dependencies of the recipe. This directory contains the tools
+ the recipe needs to build (e.g. the compiler, Autoconf, libtool, and
+ so forth).
+
+- ``${WORKDIR}/build``: This subdirectory applies only to recipes that
+ support builds where the source is separate from the build artifacts.
+ The OpenEmbedded build system uses this directory as a separate build
+ directory (i.e. ``${``\ :term:`B`\ ``}``).
+
+.. _structure-build-work-shared:
+
+``build/tmp/work-shared/``
+--------------------------
+
+For efficiency, the OpenEmbedded build system creates and uses this
+directory to hold recipes that share a work directory with other
+recipes. In practice, this is only used for ``gcc`` and its variants
+(e.g. ``gcc-cross``, ``libgcc``, ``gcc-runtime``, and so forth).
+
+.. _structure-meta:
+
+The Metadata - ``meta/``
+========================
+
+As mentioned previously, :term:`Metadata` is the core of the
+Yocto Project. Metadata has several important subdivisions:
+
+.. _structure-meta-classes:
+
+``meta/classes/``
+-----------------
+
+This directory contains the ``*.bbclass`` files. Class files are used to
+abstract common code so it can be reused by multiple packages. Every
+package inherits the ``base.bbclass`` file. Examples of other important
+classes are ``autotools.bbclass``, which in theory allows any
+Autotool-enabled package to work with the Yocto Project with minimal
+effort. Another example is ``kernel.bbclass`` that contains common code
+and functions for working with the Linux kernel. Functions like image
+generation or packaging also have their specific class files such as
+``image.bbclass``, ``rootfs_*.bbclass`` and ``package*.bbclass``.
+
+For reference information on classes, see the
+":ref:`ref-manual/ref-classes:Classes`" chapter.
+
+.. _structure-meta-conf:
+
+``meta/conf/``
+--------------
+
+This directory contains the core set of configuration files that start
+from ``bitbake.conf`` and from which all other configuration files are
+included. See the include statements at the end of the ``bitbake.conf``
+file and you will note that even ``local.conf`` is loaded from there.
+While ``bitbake.conf`` sets up the defaults, you can often override
+these by using the (``local.conf``) file, machine file or the
+distribution configuration file.
+
+.. _structure-meta-conf-machine:
+
+``meta/conf/machine/``
+----------------------
+
+This directory contains all the machine configuration files. If you set
+``MACHINE = "qemux86"``, the OpenEmbedded build system looks for a
+``qemux86.conf`` file in this directory. The ``include`` directory
+contains various data common to multiple machines. If you want to add
+support for a new machine to the Yocto Project, look in this directory.
+
+.. _structure-meta-conf-distro:
+
+``meta/conf/distro/``
+---------------------
+
+The contents of this directory controls any distribution-specific
+configurations. For the Yocto Project, the ``defaultsetup.conf`` is the
+main file here. This directory includes the versions and the ``SRCDATE``
+definitions for applications that are configured here. An example of an
+alternative configuration might be ``poky-bleeding.conf``. Although this
+file mainly inherits its configuration from Poky.
+
+.. _structure-meta-conf-machine-sdk:
+
+``meta/conf/machine-sdk/``
+--------------------------
+
+The OpenEmbedded build system searches this directory for configuration
+files that correspond to the value of
+:term:`SDKMACHINE`. By default, 32-bit and 64-bit x86
+files ship with the Yocto Project that support some SDK hosts. However,
+it is possible to extend that support to other SDK hosts by adding
+additional configuration files in this subdirectory within another
+layer.
+
+.. _structure-meta-files:
+
+``meta/files/``
+---------------
+
+This directory contains common license files and several text files used
+by the build system. The text files contain minimal device information
+and lists of files and directories with known permissions.
+
+.. _structure-meta-lib:
+
+``meta/lib/``
+-------------
+
+This directory contains OpenEmbedded Python library code used during the
+build process.
+
+.. _structure-meta-recipes-bsp:
+
+``meta/recipes-bsp/``
+---------------------
+
+This directory contains anything linking to specific hardware or
+hardware configuration information such as "u-boot" and "grub".
+
+.. _structure-meta-recipes-connectivity:
+
+``meta/recipes-connectivity/``
+------------------------------
+
+This directory contains libraries and applications related to
+communication with other devices.
+
+.. _structure-meta-recipes-core:
+
+``meta/recipes-core/``
+----------------------
+
+This directory contains what is needed to build a basic working Linux
+image including commonly used dependencies.
+
+.. _structure-meta-recipes-devtools:
+
+``meta/recipes-devtools/``
+--------------------------
+
+This directory contains tools that are primarily used by the build
+system. The tools, however, can also be used on targets.
+
+.. _structure-meta-recipes-extended:
+
+``meta/recipes-extended/``
+--------------------------
+
+This directory contains non-essential applications that add features
+compared to the alternatives in core. You might need this directory for
+full tool functionality or for Linux Standard Base (LSB) compliance.
+
+.. _structure-meta-recipes-gnome:
+
+``meta/recipes-gnome/``
+-----------------------
+
+This directory contains all things related to the GTK+ application
+framework.
+
+.. _structure-meta-recipes-graphics:
+
+``meta/recipes-graphics/``
+--------------------------
+
+This directory contains X and other graphically related system
+libraries.
+
+.. _structure-meta-recipes-kernel:
+
+``meta/recipes-kernel/``
+------------------------
+
+This directory contains the kernel and generic applications and
+libraries that have strong kernel dependencies.
+
+.. _structure-meta-recipes-lsb4:
+
+``meta/recipes-lsb4/``
+----------------------
+
+This directory contains recipes specifically added to support the Linux
+Standard Base (LSB) version 4.x.
+
+.. _structure-meta-recipes-multimedia:
+
+``meta/recipes-multimedia/``
+----------------------------
+
+This directory contains codecs and support utilities for audio, images
+and video.
+
+.. _structure-meta-recipes-rt:
+
+``meta/recipes-rt/``
+--------------------
+
+This directory contains package and image recipes for using and testing
+the ``PREEMPT_RT`` kernel.
+
+.. _structure-meta-recipes-sato:
+
+``meta/recipes-sato/``
+----------------------
+
+This directory contains the Sato demo/reference UI/UX and its associated
+applications and configuration data.
+
+.. _structure-meta-recipes-support:
+
+``meta/recipes-support/``
+-------------------------
+
+This directory contains recipes used by other recipes, but that are not
+directly included in images (i.e. dependencies of other recipes).
+
+.. _structure-meta-site:
+
+``meta/site/``
+--------------
+
+This directory contains a list of cached results for various
+architectures. Because certain "autoconf" test results cannot be
+determined when cross-compiling due to the tests not able to run on a
+live system, the information in this directory is passed to "autoconf"
+for the various architectures.
+
+.. _structure-meta-recipes-txt:
+
+``meta/recipes.txt``
+--------------------
+
+This file is a description of the contents of ``recipes-*``.
diff --git a/poky/documentation/ref-manual/ref-system-requirements.rst b/poky/documentation/ref-manual/ref-system-requirements.rst
new file mode 100644
index 000000000..56218e4eb
--- /dev/null
+++ b/poky/documentation/ref-manual/ref-system-requirements.rst
@@ -0,0 +1,437 @@
+.. SPDX-License-Identifier: CC-BY-2.0-UK
+
+*******************
+System Requirements
+*******************
+
+Welcome to the Yocto Project Reference Manual! This manual provides
+reference information for the current release of the Yocto Project, and
+is most effectively used after you have an understanding of the basics
+of the Yocto Project. The manual is neither meant to be read as a
+starting point to the Yocto Project, nor read from start to finish.
+Rather, use this manual to find variable definitions, class
+descriptions, and so forth as needed during the course of using the
+Yocto Project.
+
+For introductory information on the Yocto Project, see the
+:yocto_home:`Yocto Project Website <>` and the
+":ref:`overview-manual/overview-manual-development-environment:the yocto project development environment`"
+chapter in the Yocto Project Overview and Concepts Manual.
+
+If you want to use the Yocto Project to quickly build an image without
+having to understand concepts, work through the
+:doc:`../brief-yoctoprojectqs/brief-yoctoprojectqs` document. You can find "how-to"
+information in the :doc:`../dev-manual/dev-manual`. You can find Yocto Project overview
+and conceptual information in the :doc:`../overview-manual/overview-manual`.
+
+.. note::
+
+ For more information about the Yocto Project Documentation set, see
+ the "
+ Links and Related Documentation
+ " section.
+
+.. _detailed-supported-distros:
+
+Supported Linux Distributions
+=============================
+
+Currently, the Yocto Project is supported on the following
+distributions:
+
+- Ubuntu 16.04 (LTS)
+
+- Ubuntu 18.04 (LTS)
+
+- Ubuntu 20.04
+
+- Fedora 30
+
+- Fedora 31
+
+- Fedora 32
+
+- CentOS 7.x
+
+- CentOS 8.x
+
+- Debian GNU/Linux 8.x (Jessie)
+
+- Debian GNU/Linux 9.x (Stretch)
+
+- Debian GNU/Linux 10.x (Buster)
+
+- OpenSUSE Leap 15.1
+
+
+.. note::
+
+ - While the Yocto Project Team attempts to ensure all Yocto Project
+ releases are one hundred percent compatible with each officially
+ supported Linux distribution, instances might exist where you
+ encounter a problem while using the Yocto Project on a specific
+ distribution.
+
+ - Yocto Project releases are tested against the stable Linux
+ distributions in the above list. The Yocto Project should work
+ on other distributions but validation is not performed against
+ them.
+
+ - In particular, the Yocto Project does not support and currently
+ has no plans to support rolling-releases or development
+ distributions due to their constantly changing nature. We welcome
+ patches and bug reports, but keep in mind that our priority is on
+ the supported platforms listed below.
+
+ - You may use Windows Subsystem For Linux v2 to set up a build host
+ using Windows 10, but validation is not performed against build
+ hosts using WSLv2.
+
+ - The Yocto Project is not compatible with WSLv1, it is
+ compatible but not officially supported nor validated with
+ WSLv2, if you still decide to use WSL please upgrade to WSLv2.
+
+ - If you encounter problems, please go to `Yocto Project
+ Bugzilla <http://bugzilla.yoctoproject.org>`__ and submit a bug. We are
+ interested in hearing about your experience. For information on
+ how to submit a bug, see the Yocto Project
+ :yocto_wiki:`Bugzilla wiki page </wiki/Bugzilla_Configuration_and_Bug_Tracking>`
+ and the ":ref:`dev-manual/dev-manual-common-tasks:submitting a defect against the yocto project`"
+ section in the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual.
+
+
+Required Packages for the Build Host
+====================================
+
+The list of packages you need on the host development system can be
+large when covering all build scenarios using the Yocto Project. This
+section describes required packages according to Linux distribution and
+function.
+
+.. _ubuntu-packages:
+
+Ubuntu and Debian
+-----------------
+
+The following list shows the required packages by function given a
+supported Ubuntu or Debian Linux distribution:
+
+.. note::
+
+ - If your build system has the ``oss4-dev`` package installed, you
+ might experience QEMU build failures due to the package installing
+ its own custom ``/usr/include/linux/soundcard.h`` on the Debian
+ system. If you run into this situation, either of the following
+ solutions exist:
+ ::
+
+ $ sudo apt-get build-dep qemu
+ $ sudo apt-get remove oss4-dev
+
+ - For Debian-8, ``python3-git`` and ``pylint3`` are no longer
+ available via ``apt-get``.
+ ::
+
+ $ sudo pip3 install GitPython pylint==1.9.5
+
+- *Essentials:* Packages needed to build an image on a headless system:
+ ::
+
+ $ sudo apt-get install &UBUNTU_HOST_PACKAGES_ESSENTIAL;
+
+- *Documentation:* Packages needed if you are going to build out the
+ Yocto Project documentation manuals:
+ ::
+
+ $ sudo apt-get install make xsltproc docbook-utils fop dblatex xmlto
+
+Fedora Packages
+---------------
+
+The following list shows the required packages by function given a
+supported Fedora Linux distribution:
+
+- *Essentials:* Packages needed to build an image for a headless
+ system:
+ ::
+
+ $ sudo dnf install &FEDORA_HOST_PACKAGES_ESSENTIAL;
+
+- *Documentation:* Packages needed if you are going to build out the
+ Yocto Project documentation manuals:
+ ::
+
+ $ sudo dnf install docbook-style-dsssl docbook-style-xsl \
+ docbook-dtds docbook-utils fop libxslt dblatex xmlto
+
+openSUSE Packages
+-----------------
+
+The following list shows the required packages by function given a
+supported openSUSE Linux distribution:
+
+- *Essentials:* Packages needed to build an image for a headless
+ system:
+ ::
+
+ $ sudo zypper install &OPENSUSE_HOST_PACKAGES_ESSENTIAL;
+
+- *Documentation:* Packages needed if you are going to build out the
+ Yocto Project documentation manuals: $ sudo zypper install dblatex
+ xmlto
+
+CentOS-7 Packages
+-----------------
+
+The following list shows the required packages by function given a
+supported CentOS-7 Linux distribution:
+
+- *Essentials:* Packages needed to build an image for a headless
+ system:
+ ::
+
+ $ sudo yum install &CENTOS7_HOST_PACKAGES_ESSENTIAL;
+
+ .. note::
+
+ - Extra Packages for Enterprise Linux (i.e. ``epel-release``) is
+ a collection of packages from Fedora built on RHEL/CentOS for
+ easy installation of packages not included in enterprise Linux
+ by default. You need to install these packages separately.
+
+ - The ``makecache`` command consumes additional Metadata from
+ ``epel-release``.
+
+- *Documentation:* Packages needed if you are going to build out the
+ Yocto Project documentation manuals:
+ ::
+
+ $ sudo yum install docbook-style-dsssl docbook-style-xsl \
+ docbook-dtds docbook-utils fop libxslt dblatex xmlto
+
+CentOS-8 Packages
+-----------------
+
+The following list shows the required packages by function given a
+supported CentOS-8 Linux distribution:
+
+- *Essentials:* Packages needed to build an image for a headless
+ system:
+ ::
+
+ $ sudo dnf install &CENTOS8_HOST_PACKAGES_ESSENTIAL;
+
+ .. note::
+
+ - Extra Packages for Enterprise Linux (i.e. ``epel-release``) is
+ a collection of packages from Fedora built on RHEL/CentOS for
+ easy installation of packages not included in enterprise Linux
+ by default. You need to install these packages separately.
+
+ - The ``PowerTools`` repo provides additional packages such as
+ ``rpcgen`` and ``texinfo``.
+
+ - The ``makecache`` command consumes additional Metadata from
+ ``epel-release``.
+
+- *Documentation:* Packages needed if you are going to build out the
+ Yocto Project documentation manuals:
+ ::
+
+ $ sudo dnf install docbook-style-dsssl docbook-style-xsl \\
+ docbook-dtds docbook-utils fop libxslt dblatex xmlto
+
+Required Git, tar, Python and gcc Versions
+==========================================
+
+In order to use the build system, your host development system must meet
+the following version requirements for Git, tar, and Python:
+
+- Git 1.8.3.1 or greater
+
+- tar 1.28 or greater
+
+- Python 3.5.0 or greater
+
+If your host development system does not meet all these requirements,
+you can resolve this by installing a ``buildtools`` tarball that
+contains these tools. You can get the tarball one of two ways: download
+a pre-built tarball or use BitBake to build the tarball.
+
+In addition, your host development system must meet the following
+version requirement for gcc:
+
+- gcc 5.0 or greater
+
+If your host development system does not meet this requirement, you can
+resolve this by installing a ``buildtools-extended`` tarball that
+contains additional tools, the equivalent of ``buildtools-essential``.
+
+Installing a Pre-Built ``buildtools`` Tarball with ``install-buildtools`` script
+--------------------------------------------------------------------------------
+
+The ``install-buildtools`` script is the easiest of the three methods by
+which you can get these tools. It downloads a pre-built buildtools
+installer and automatically installs the tools for you:
+
+1. Execute the ``install-buildtools`` script. Here is an example:
+ ::
+
+ $ cd poky
+ $ scripts/install-buildtools --without-extended-buildtools \
+ --base-url https://downloads.yoctoproject.org/releases/yocto \
+ --release yocto-&DISTRO; \
+ --installer-version &DISTRO;
+
+ During execution, the buildtools tarball will be downloaded, the
+ checksum of the download will be verified, the installer will be run
+ for you, and some basic checks will be run to to make sure the
+ installation is functional.
+
+ To avoid the need of ``sudo`` privileges, the ``install-buildtools``
+ script will by default tell the installer to install in:
+ ::
+
+ /path/to/poky/buildtools
+
+ If your host development system needs the additional tools provided
+ in the ``buildtools-extended`` tarball, you can instead execute the
+ ``install-buildtools`` script with the default parameters:
+ ::
+
+ $ cd poky
+ $ scripts/install-buildtools
+
+2. Source the tools environment setup script by using a command like the
+ following:
+ ::
+
+ $ source /path/to/poky/buildtools/environment-setup-x86_64-pokysdk-linux
+
+ Of course, you need to supply your installation directory and be sure to
+ use the right file (i.e. i586 or x86_64).
+
+ After you have sourced the setup script, the tools are added to
+ ``PATH`` and any other environment variables required to run the
+ tools are initialized. The results are working versions versions of
+ Git, tar, Python and ``chrpath``. And in the case of the
+ ``buildtools-extended`` tarball, additional working versions of tools
+ including ``gcc``, ``make`` and the other tools included in
+ ``packagegroup-core-buildessential``.
+
+Downloading a Pre-Built ``buildtools`` Tarball
+----------------------------------------------
+
+Downloading and running a pre-built buildtools installer is the easiest
+of the two methods by which you can get these tools:
+
+1. Locate and download the ``*.sh`` at &YOCTO_RELEASE_DL_URL;/buildtools/
+
+2. Execute the installation script. Here is an example for the
+ traditional installer:
+ ::
+
+ $ sh ~/Downloads/x86_64-buildtools-nativesdk-standalone-DISTRO.sh
+
+ Here is an example for the extended installer:
+ ::
+
+ $ sh ~/Downloads/x86_64-buildtools-extended-nativesdk-standalone-DISTRO.sh
+
+ During execution, a prompt appears that allows you to choose the
+ installation directory. For example, you could choose the following:
+ /home/your-username/buildtools
+
+3. Source the tools environment setup script by using a command like the
+ following:
+ ::
+
+ $ source /home/your_username/buildtools/environment-setup-i586-poky-linux
+
+ Of
+ course, you need to supply your installation directory and be sure to
+ use the right file (i.e. i585 or x86-64).
+
+ After you have sourced the setup script, the tools are added to
+ ``PATH`` and any other environment variables required to run the
+ tools are initialized. The results are working versions versions of
+ Git, tar, Python and ``chrpath``. And in the case of the
+ ``buildtools-extended`` tarball, additional working versions of tools
+ including ``gcc``, ``make`` and the other tools included in
+ ``packagegroup-core-buildessential``.
+
+Building Your Own ``buildtools`` Tarball
+----------------------------------------
+
+Building and running your own buildtools installer applies only when you
+have a build host that can already run BitBake. In this case, you use
+that machine to build the ``.sh`` file and then take steps to transfer
+and run it on a machine that does not meet the minimal Git, tar, and
+Python (or gcc) requirements.
+
+Here are the steps to take to build and run your own buildtools
+installer:
+
+1. On the machine that is able to run BitBake, be sure you have set up
+ your build environment with the setup script
+ (:ref:`structure-core-script`).
+
+2. Run the BitBake command to build the tarball:
+ ::
+
+ $ bitbake buildtools-tarball
+
+ or run the BitBake command to build the extended tarball:
+ ::
+
+ $ bitbake buildtools-extended-tarball
+
+ .. note::
+
+ The
+ SDKMACHINE
+ variable in your
+ local.conf
+ file determines whether you build tools for a 32-bit or 64-bit
+ system.
+
+ Once the build completes, you can find the ``.sh`` file that installs
+ the tools in the ``tmp/deploy/sdk`` subdirectory of the
+ :term:`Build Directory`. The installer file has the string
+ "buildtools" (or "buildtools-extended") in the name.
+
+3. Transfer the ``.sh`` file from the build host to the machine that
+ does not meet the Git, tar, or Python (or gcc) requirements.
+
+4. On the machine that does not meet the requirements, run the ``.sh``
+ file to install the tools. Here is an example for the traditional
+ installer:
+ ::
+
+ $ sh ~/Downloads/x86_64-buildtools-nativesdk-standalone-&DISTRO;.sh
+
+ Here is an example for the extended installer:
+ ::
+
+ $ sh ~/Downloads/x86_64-buildtools-extended-nativesdk-standalone-&DISTRO;.sh
+
+ During execution, a prompt appears that allows you to choose the
+ installation directory. For example, you could choose the following:
+ /home/your_username/buildtools
+
+5. Source the tools environment setup script by using a command like the
+ following:
+ ::
+
+ $ source /home/your_username/buildtools/environment-setup-x86_64-poky-linux
+
+ Of course, you need to supply your installation directory and be sure to
+ use the right file (i.e. i586 or x86_64).
+
+ After you have sourced the setup script, the tools are added to
+ ``PATH`` and any other environment variables required to run the
+ tools are initialized. The results are working versions versions of
+ Git, tar, Python and ``chrpath``. And in the case of the
+ ``buildtools-extended`` tarball, additional working versions of tools
+ including ``gcc``, ``make`` and the other tools included in
+ ``packagegroup-core-buildessential``.
diff --git a/poky/documentation/ref-manual/ref-tasks.rst b/poky/documentation/ref-manual/ref-tasks.rst
new file mode 100644
index 000000000..dcdff05dc
--- /dev/null
+++ b/poky/documentation/ref-manual/ref-tasks.rst
@@ -0,0 +1,875 @@
+.. SPDX-License-Identifier: CC-BY-2.0-UK
+
+*****
+Tasks
+*****
+
+Tasks are units of execution for BitBake. Recipes (``.bb`` files) use
+tasks to complete configuring, compiling, and packaging software. This
+chapter provides a reference of the tasks defined in the OpenEmbedded
+build system.
+
+Normal Recipe Build Tasks
+=========================
+
+The following sections describe normal tasks associated with building a
+recipe. For more information on tasks and dependencies, see the
+":ref:`Tasks <bitbake:bitbake-user-manual/bitbake-user-manual-metadata:tasks>`" and
+":ref:`Dependencies <bitbake:bitbake-user-manual/bitbake-user-manual-execution:dependencies>`" sections in the
+BitBake User Manual.
+
+.. _ref-tasks-build:
+
+``do_build``
+------------
+
+The default task for all recipes. This task depends on all other normal
+tasks required to build a recipe.
+
+.. _ref-tasks-compile:
+
+``do_compile``
+--------------
+
+Compiles the source code. This task runs with the current working
+directory set to ``${``\ :term:`B`\ ``}``.
+
+The default behavior of this task is to run the ``oe_runmake`` function
+if a makefile (``Makefile``, ``makefile``, or ``GNUmakefile``) is found.
+If no such file is found, the ``do_compile`` task does nothing.
+
+.. _ref-tasks-compile_ptest_base:
+
+``do_compile_ptest_base``
+-------------------------
+
+Compiles the runtime test suite included in the software being built.
+
+.. _ref-tasks-configure:
+
+``do_configure``
+----------------
+
+Configures the source by enabling and disabling any build-time and
+configuration options for the software being built. The task runs with
+the current working directory set to ``${``\ :term:`B`\ ``}``.
+
+The default behavior of this task is to run ``oe_runmake clean`` if a
+makefile (``Makefile``, ``makefile``, or ``GNUmakefile``) is found and
+:term:`CLEANBROKEN` is not set to "1". If no such
+file is found or the ``CLEANBROKEN`` variable is set to "1", the
+``do_configure`` task does nothing.
+
+.. _ref-tasks-configure_ptest_base:
+
+``do_configure_ptest_base``
+---------------------------
+
+Configures the runtime test suite included in the software being built.
+
+.. _ref-tasks-deploy:
+
+``do_deploy``
+-------------
+
+Writes output files that are to be deployed to
+``${``\ :term:`DEPLOY_DIR_IMAGE`\ ``}``. The
+task runs with the current working directory set to
+``${``\ :term:`B`\ ``}``.
+
+Recipes implementing this task should inherit the
+:ref:`deploy <ref-classes-deploy>` class and should write the output
+to ``${``\ :term:`DEPLOYDIR`\ ``}``, which is not to be
+confused with ``${DEPLOY_DIR}``. The ``deploy`` class sets up
+``do_deploy`` as a shared state (sstate) task that can be accelerated
+through sstate use. The sstate mechanism takes care of copying the
+output from ``${DEPLOYDIR}`` to ``${DEPLOY_DIR_IMAGE}``.
+
+.. note::
+
+ Do not write the output directly to
+ ${DEPLOY_DIR_IMAGE}
+ , as this causes the sstate mechanism to malfunction.
+
+The ``do_deploy`` task is not added as a task by default and
+consequently needs to be added manually. If you want the task to run
+after :ref:`ref-tasks-compile`, you can add it by doing
+the following: addtask deploy after do_compile Adding ``do_deploy``
+after other tasks works the same way.
+
+.. note::
+
+ You do not need to add
+ before do_build
+ to the
+ addtask
+ command (though it is harmless), because the
+ base
+ class contains the following:
+ ::
+
+ do_build[recrdeptask] += "do_deploy"
+
+
+ See the "
+ Dependencies
+ " section in the BitBake User Manual for more information.
+
+If the ``do_deploy`` task re-executes, any previous output is removed
+(i.e. "cleaned").
+
+.. _ref-tasks-fetch:
+
+``do_fetch``
+------------
+
+Fetches the source code. This task uses the
+:term:`SRC_URI` variable and the argument's prefix to
+determine the correct :ref:`fetcher <bitbake:bb-fetchers>`
+module.
+
+.. _ref-tasks-image:
+
+``do_image``
+------------
+
+Starts the image generation process. The ``do_image`` task runs after
+the OpenEmbedded build system has run the
+:ref:`ref-tasks-rootfs` task during which packages are
+identified for installation into the image and the root filesystem is
+created, complete with post-processing.
+
+The ``do_image`` task performs pre-processing on the image through the
+:term:`IMAGE_PREPROCESS_COMMAND` and
+dynamically generates supporting ``do_image_*`` tasks as needed.
+
+For more information on image creation, see the ":ref:`image-generation-dev-environment`"
+section in the Yocto Project Overview and Concepts Manual.
+
+.. _ref-tasks-image-complete:
+
+``do_image_complete``
+---------------------
+
+Completes the image generation process. The ``do_image_complete`` task
+runs after the OpenEmbedded build system has run the
+:ref:`ref-tasks-image` task during which image
+pre-processing occurs and through dynamically generated ``do_image_*``
+tasks the image is constructed.
+
+The ``do_image_complete`` task performs post-processing on the image
+through the
+:term:`IMAGE_POSTPROCESS_COMMAND`.
+
+For more information on image creation, see the
+":ref:`image-generation-dev-environment`"
+section in the Yocto Project Overview and Concepts Manual.
+
+.. _ref-tasks-install:
+
+``do_install``
+--------------
+
+Copies files that are to be packaged into the holding area
+``${``\ :term:`D`\ ``}``. This task runs with the current
+working directory set to ``${``\ :term:`B`\ ``}``, which is the
+compilation directory. The ``do_install`` task, as well as other tasks
+that either directly or indirectly depend on the installed files (e.g.
+:ref:`ref-tasks-package`, ``do_package_write_*``, and
+:ref:`ref-tasks-rootfs`), run under
+:ref:`fakeroot <overview-manual/overview-manual-concepts:fakeroot and pseudo>`.
+
+.. note::
+
+ When installing files, be careful not to set the owner and group IDs
+ of the installed files to unintended values. Some methods of copying
+ files, notably when using the recursive ``cp`` command, can preserve
+ the UID and/or GID of the original file, which is usually not what
+ you want. The ``host-user-contaminated`` QA check checks for files
+ that probably have the wrong ownership.
+
+ Safe methods for installing files include the following:
+
+ - The ``install`` utility. This utility is the preferred method.
+
+ - The ``cp`` command with the "--no-preserve=ownership" option.
+
+ - The ``tar`` command with the "--no-same-owner" option. See the
+ ``bin_package.bbclass`` file in the ``meta/classes`` directory of
+ the :term:`Source Directory` for an example.
+
+.. _ref-tasks-install_ptest_base:
+
+``do_install_ptest_base``
+-------------------------
+
+Copies the runtime test suite files from the compilation directory to a
+holding area.
+
+.. _ref-tasks-package:
+
+``do_package``
+--------------
+
+Analyzes the content of the holding area
+``${``\ :term:`D`\ ``}`` and splits the content into subsets
+based on available packages and files. This task makes use of the
+:term:`PACKAGES` and :term:`FILES`
+variables.
+
+The ``do_package`` task, in conjunction with the
+:ref:`ref-tasks-packagedata` task, also saves some
+important package metadata. For additional information, see the
+:term:`PKGDESTWORK` variable and the
+":ref:`overview-manual/overview-manual-concepts:automatically added runtime dependencies`"
+section in the Yocto Project Overview and Concepts Manual.
+
+.. _ref-tasks-package_qa:
+
+``do_package_qa``
+-----------------
+
+Runs QA checks on packaged files. For more information on these checks,
+see the :ref:`insane <ref-classes-insane>` class.
+
+.. _ref-tasks-package_write_deb:
+
+``do_package_write_deb``
+------------------------
+
+Creates Debian packages (i.e. ``*.deb`` files) and places them in the
+``${``\ :term:`DEPLOY_DIR_DEB`\ ``}`` directory in
+the package feeds area. For more information, see the
+":ref:`package-feeds-dev-environment`" section in
+the Yocto Project Overview and Concepts Manual.
+
+.. _ref-tasks-package_write_ipk:
+
+``do_package_write_ipk``
+------------------------
+
+Creates IPK packages (i.e. ``*.ipk`` files) and places them in the
+``${``\ :term:`DEPLOY_DIR_IPK`\ ``}`` directory in
+the package feeds area. For more information, see the
+":ref:`package-feeds-dev-environment`" section in
+the Yocto Project Overview and Concepts Manual.
+
+.. _ref-tasks-package_write_rpm:
+
+``do_package_write_rpm``
+------------------------
+
+Creates RPM packages (i.e. ``*.rpm`` files) and places them in the
+``${``\ :term:`DEPLOY_DIR_RPM`\ ``}`` directory in
+the package feeds area. For more information, see the
+":ref:`package-feeds-dev-environment`" section in
+the Yocto Project Overview and Concepts Manual.
+
+.. _ref-tasks-package_write_tar:
+
+``do_package_write_tar``
+------------------------
+
+Creates tarballs and places them in the
+``${``\ :term:`DEPLOY_DIR_TAR`\ ``}`` directory in
+the package feeds area. For more information, see the
+":ref:`package-feeds-dev-environment`" section in
+the Yocto Project Overview and Concepts Manual.
+
+.. _ref-tasks-packagedata:
+
+``do_packagedata``
+------------------
+
+Saves package metadata generated by the
+:ref:`ref-tasks-package` task in
+:term:`PKGDATA_DIR` to make it available globally.
+
+.. _ref-tasks-patch:
+
+``do_patch``
+------------
+
+Locates patch files and applies them to the source code.
+
+After fetching and unpacking source files, the build system uses the
+recipe's :term:`SRC_URI` statements
+to locate and apply patch files to the source code.
+
+.. note::
+
+ The build system uses the
+ FILESPATH
+ variable to determine the default set of directories when searching
+ for patches.
+
+Patch files, by default, are ``*.patch`` and ``*.diff`` files created
+and kept in a subdirectory of the directory holding the recipe file. For
+example, consider the
+:yocto_git:`bluez5 </cgit/cgit.cgi/poky/tree/meta/recipes-connectivity/bluez5>`
+recipe from the OE-Core layer (i.e. ``poky/meta``):
+::
+
+ poky/meta/recipes-connectivity/bluez5
+
+This recipe has two patch files located here:
+::
+
+ poky/meta/recipes-connectivity/bluez5/bluez5
+
+In the ``bluez5`` recipe, the ``SRC_URI`` statements point to the source
+and patch files needed to build the package.
+
+.. note::
+
+ In the case for the
+ bluez5_5.48.bb
+ recipe, the
+ SRC_URI
+ statements are from an include file
+ bluez5.inc
+ .
+
+As mentioned earlier, the build system treats files whose file types are
+``.patch`` and ``.diff`` as patch files. However, you can use the
+"apply=yes" parameter with the ``SRC_URI`` statement to indicate any
+file as a patch file:
+::
+
+ SRC_URI = " \\
+ git://path_to_repo/some_package \\
+ file://file;apply=yes \\
+ "
+
+Conversely, if you have a directory full of patch files and you want to
+exclude some so that the ``do_patch`` task does not apply them during
+the patch phase, you can use the "apply=no" parameter with the
+``SRC_URI`` statement:
+::
+
+ SRC_URI = " \
+ git://path_to_repo/some_package \
+ file://path_to_lots_of_patch_files \
+ file://path_to_lots_of_patch_files/patch_file5;apply=no \
+ "
+
+In the
+previous example, assuming all the files in the directory holding the
+patch files end with either ``.patch`` or ``.diff``, every file would be
+applied as a patch by default except for the patch_file5 patch.
+
+You can find out more about the patching process in the
+":ref:`patching-dev-environment`" section in
+the Yocto Project Overview and Concepts Manual and the
+":ref:`new-recipe-patching-code`" section in the
+Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual.
+
+.. _ref-tasks-populate_lic:
+
+``do_populate_lic``
+-------------------
+
+Writes license information for the recipe that is collected later when
+the image is constructed.
+
+.. _ref-tasks-populate_sdk:
+
+``do_populate_sdk``
+-------------------
+
+Creates the file and directory structure for an installable SDK. See the
+":ref:`sdk-generation-dev-environment`"
+section in the Yocto Project Overview and Concepts Manual for more
+information.
+
+.. _ref-tasks-populate_sdk_ext:
+
+``do_populate_sdk_ext``
+-----------------------
+
+Creates the file and directory structure for an installable extensible
+SDK (eSDK). See the ":ref:`sdk-generation-dev-environment`"
+section in the Yocto Project Overview and Concepts Manual for more
+information.
+
+
+.. _ref-tasks-populate_sysroot:
+
+``do_populate_sysroot``
+-----------------------
+
+Stages (copies) a subset of the files installed by the
+:ref:`ref-tasks-install` task into the appropriate
+sysroot. For information on how to access these files from other
+recipes, see the :term:`STAGING_DIR* <STAGING_DIR_HOST>` variables.
+Directories that would typically not be needed by other recipes at build
+time (e.g. ``/etc``) are not copied by default.
+
+For information on what directories are copied by default, see the
+:term:`SYSROOT_DIRS* <SYSROOT_DIRS>` variables. You can change
+these variables inside your recipe if you need to make additional (or
+fewer) directories available to other recipes at build time.
+
+The ``do_populate_sysroot`` task is a shared state (sstate) task, which
+means that the task can be accelerated through sstate use. Realize also
+that if the task is re-executed, any previous output is removed (i.e.
+"cleaned").
+
+.. _ref-tasks-prepare_recipe_sysroot:
+
+``do_prepare_recipe_sysroot``
+-----------------------------
+
+Installs the files into the individual recipe specific sysroots (i.e.
+``recipe-sysroot`` and ``recipe-sysroot-native`` under
+``${``\ :term:`WORKDIR`\ ``}`` based upon the
+dependencies specified by :term:`DEPENDS`). See the
+":ref:`staging <ref-classes-staging>`" class for more information.
+
+.. _ref-tasks-rm_work:
+
+``do_rm_work``
+--------------
+
+Removes work files after the OpenEmbedded build system has finished with
+them. You can learn more by looking at the
+":ref:`rm_work.bbclass <ref-classes-rm-work>`" section.
+
+.. _ref-tasks-unpack:
+
+``do_unpack``
+-------------
+
+Unpacks the source code into a working directory pointed to by
+``${``\ :term:`WORKDIR`\ ``}``. The :term:`S`
+variable also plays a role in where unpacked source files ultimately
+reside. For more information on how source files are unpacked, see the
+":ref:`source-fetching-dev-environment`"
+section in the Yocto Project Overview and Concepts Manual and also see
+the ``WORKDIR`` and ``S`` variable descriptions.
+
+Manually Called Tasks
+=====================
+
+These tasks are typically manually triggered (e.g. by using the
+``bitbake -c`` command-line option):
+
+.. _ref-tasks-checkpkg:
+
+``do_checkpkg``
+---------------
+
+Provides information about the recipe including its upstream version and
+status. The upstream version and status reveals whether or not a version
+of the recipe exists upstream and a status of not updated, updated, or
+unknown.
+
+To check the upstream version and status of a recipe, use the following
+devtool commands:
+::
+
+ $ devtool latest-version
+ $ devtool check-upgrade-status
+
+See the ":ref:`ref-manual/ref-devtool-reference:\`\`devtool\`\` quick reference`"
+chapter for more information on
+``devtool``. See the ":ref:`devtool-checking-on-the-upgrade-status-of-a-recipe`"
+section for information on checking the upgrade status of a recipe.
+
+To build the ``checkpkg`` task, use the ``bitbake`` command with the
+"-c" option and task name:
+::
+
+ $ bitbake core-image-minimal -c checkpkg
+
+By default, the results are stored in :term:`$LOG_DIR <LOG_DIR>` (e.g.
+``$BUILD_DIR/tmp/log``).
+
+.. _ref-tasks-checkuri:
+
+``do_checkuri``
+---------------
+
+Validates the :term:`SRC_URI` value.
+
+.. _ref-tasks-clean:
+
+``do_clean``
+------------
+
+Removes all output files for a target from the
+:ref:`ref-tasks-unpack` task forward (i.e. ``do_unpack``,
+:ref:`ref-tasks-configure`,
+:ref:`ref-tasks-compile`,
+:ref:`ref-tasks-install`, and
+:ref:`ref-tasks-package`).
+
+You can run this task using BitBake as follows:
+::
+
+ $ bitbake -c clean recipe
+
+Running this task does not remove the
+:ref:`sstate <overview-manual/overview-manual-concepts:shared state cache>` cache files.
+Consequently, if no changes have been made and the recipe is rebuilt
+after cleaning, output files are simply restored from the sstate cache.
+If you want to remove the sstate cache files for the recipe, you need to
+use the :ref:`ref-tasks-cleansstate` task instead
+(i.e. ``bitbake -c cleansstate`` recipe).
+
+.. _ref-tasks-cleanall:
+
+``do_cleanall``
+---------------
+
+Removes all output files, shared state
+(:ref:`sstate <overview-manual/overview-manual-concepts:shared state cache>`) cache, and
+downloaded source files for a target (i.e. the contents of
+:term:`DL_DIR`). Essentially, the ``do_cleanall`` task is
+identical to the :ref:`ref-tasks-cleansstate` task
+with the added removal of downloaded source files.
+
+You can run this task using BitBake as follows:
+::
+
+ $ bitbake -c cleanall recipe
+
+Typically, you would not normally use the ``cleanall`` task. Do so only
+if you want to start fresh with the :ref:`ref-tasks-fetch`
+task.
+
+.. _ref-tasks-cleansstate:
+
+``do_cleansstate``
+------------------
+
+Removes all output files and shared state
+(:ref:`sstate <overview-manual/overview-manual-concepts:shared state cache>`) cache for a
+target. Essentially, the ``do_cleansstate`` task is identical to the
+:ref:`ref-tasks-clean` task with the added removal of
+shared state (`:ref:`sstate <overview-manual/overview-manual-concepts:shared state cache>`)
+cache.
+
+You can run this task using BitBake as follows:
+::
+
+ $ bitbake -c cleansstate recipe
+
+When you run the ``do_cleansstate`` task, the OpenEmbedded build system
+no longer uses any sstate. Consequently, building the recipe from
+scratch is guaranteed.
+
+.. note::
+
+ The
+ do_cleansstate
+ task cannot remove sstate from a remote sstate mirror. If you need to
+ build a target from scratch using remote mirrors, use the "-f" option
+ as follows:
+ ::
+
+ $ bitbake -f -c do_cleansstate target
+
+
+.. _ref-tasks-devpyshell:
+
+``do_devpyshell``
+-----------------
+
+Starts a shell in which an interactive Python interpreter allows you to
+interact with the BitBake build environment. From within this shell, you
+can directly examine and set bits from the data store and execute
+functions as if within the BitBake environment. See the ":ref:`platdev-appdev-devpyshell`" section in
+the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual for more information about
+using ``devpyshell``.
+
+.. _ref-tasks-devshell:
+
+``do_devshell``
+---------------
+
+Starts a shell whose environment is set up for development, debugging,
+or both. See the ":ref:`platdev-appdev-devshell`" section in the
+Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual for more information about using
+``devshell``.
+
+.. _ref-tasks-listtasks:
+
+``do_listtasks``
+----------------
+
+Lists all defined tasks for a target.
+
+.. _ref-tasks-package_index:
+
+``do_package_index``
+--------------------
+
+Creates or updates the index in the `:ref:`package-feeds-dev-environment` area.
+
+.. note::
+
+ This task is not triggered with the
+ bitbake -c
+ command-line option as are the other tasks in this section. Because
+ this task is specifically for the
+ package-index
+ recipe, you run it using
+ bitbake package-index
+ .
+
+Image-Related Tasks
+===================
+
+The following tasks are applicable to image recipes.
+
+.. _ref-tasks-bootimg:
+
+``do_bootimg``
+--------------
+
+Creates a bootable live image. See the
+:term:`IMAGE_FSTYPES` variable for additional
+information on live image types.
+
+.. _ref-tasks-bundle_initramfs:
+
+``do_bundle_initramfs``
+-----------------------
+
+Combines an initial RAM disk (initramfs) image and kernel together to
+form a single image. The
+:term:`CONFIG_INITRAMFS_SOURCE` variable
+has some more information about these types of images.
+
+.. _ref-tasks-rootfs:
+
+``do_rootfs``
+-------------
+
+Creates the root filesystem (file and directory structure) for an image.
+See the ":ref:`image-generation-dev-environment`"
+section in the Yocto Project Overview and Concepts Manual for more
+information on how the root filesystem is created.
+
+.. _ref-tasks-testimage:
+
+``do_testimage``
+----------------
+
+Boots an image and performs runtime tests within the image. For
+information on automatically testing images, see the
+":ref:`dev-manual/dev-manual-common-tasks:performing automated runtime testing`"
+section in the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual.
+
+.. _ref-tasks-testimage_auto:
+
+``do_testimage_auto``
+---------------------
+
+Boots an image and performs runtime tests within the image immediately
+after it has been built. This task is enabled when you set
+:term:`TESTIMAGE_AUTO` equal to "1".
+
+For information on automatically testing images, see the
+":ref:`dev-manual/dev-manual-common-tasks:performing automated runtime testing`"
+section in the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual.
+
+Kernel-Related Tasks
+====================
+
+The following tasks are applicable to kernel recipes. Some of these
+tasks (e.g. the :ref:`ref-tasks-menuconfig` task) are
+also applicable to recipes that use Linux kernel style configuration
+such as the BusyBox recipe.
+
+.. _ref-tasks-compile_kernelmodules:
+
+``do_compile_kernelmodules``
+----------------------------
+
+Runs the step that builds the kernel modules (if needed). Building a
+kernel consists of two steps: 1) the kernel (``vmlinux``) is built, and
+2) the modules are built (i.e. ``make modules``).
+
+.. _ref-tasks-diffconfig:
+
+``do_diffconfig``
+-----------------
+
+When invoked by the user, this task creates a file containing the
+differences between the original config as produced by
+:ref:`ref-tasks-kernel_configme` task and the
+changes made by the user with other methods (i.e. using
+(:ref:`ref-tasks-kernel_menuconfig`). Once the
+file of differences is created, it can be used to create a config
+fragment that only contains the differences. You can invoke this task
+from the command line as follows:
+::
+
+ $ bitbake linux-yocto -c diffconfig
+
+For more information, see the
+":ref:`kernel-dev/kernel-dev-common:creating configuration fragments`"
+section in the Yocto Project Linux Kernel Development Manual.
+
+.. _ref-tasks-kernel_checkout:
+
+``do_kernel_checkout``
+----------------------
+
+Converts the newly unpacked kernel source into a form with which the
+OpenEmbedded build system can work. Because the kernel source can be
+fetched in several different ways, the ``do_kernel_checkout`` task makes
+sure that subsequent tasks are given a clean working tree copy of the
+kernel with the correct branches checked out.
+
+.. _ref-tasks-kernel_configcheck:
+
+``do_kernel_configcheck``
+-------------------------
+
+Validates the configuration produced by the
+:ref:`ref-tasks-kernel_menuconfig` task. The
+``do_kernel_configcheck`` task produces warnings when a requested
+configuration does not appear in the final ``.config`` file or when you
+override a policy configuration in a hardware configuration fragment.
+You can run this task explicitly and view the output by using the
+following command:
+::
+
+ $ bitbake linux-yocto -c kernel_configcheck -f
+
+For more information, see the
+":ref:`kernel-dev/kernel-dev-common:validating configuration`"
+section in the Yocto Project Linux Kernel Development Manual.
+
+.. _ref-tasks-kernel_configme:
+
+``do_kernel_configme``
+----------------------
+
+After the kernel is patched by the :ref:`ref-tasks-patch`
+task, the ``do_kernel_configme`` task assembles and merges all the
+kernel config fragments into a merged configuration that can then be
+passed to the kernel configuration phase proper. This is also the time
+during which user-specified defconfigs are applied if present, and where
+configuration modes such as ``--allnoconfig`` are applied.
+
+.. _ref-tasks-kernel_menuconfig:
+
+``do_kernel_menuconfig``
+------------------------
+
+Invoked by the user to manipulate the ``.config`` file used to build a
+linux-yocto recipe. This task starts the Linux kernel configuration
+tool, which you then use to modify the kernel configuration.
+
+.. note::
+
+ You can also invoke this tool from the command line as follows:
+ ::
+
+ $ bitbake linux-yocto -c menuconfig
+
+
+See the ":ref:`kernel-dev/kernel-dev-common:using \`\`menuconfig\`\``"
+section in the Yocto Project Linux Kernel Development Manual for more
+information on this configuration tool.
+
+.. _ref-tasks-kernel_metadata:
+
+``do_kernel_metadata``
+----------------------
+
+Collects all the features required for a given kernel build, whether the
+features come from :term:`SRC_URI` or from Git
+repositories. After collection, the ``do_kernel_metadata`` task
+processes the features into a series of config fragments and patches,
+which can then be applied by subsequent tasks such as
+:ref:`ref-tasks-patch` and
+:ref:`ref-tasks-kernel_configme`.
+
+.. _ref-tasks-menuconfig:
+
+``do_menuconfig``
+-----------------
+
+Runs ``make menuconfig`` for the kernel. For information on
+``menuconfig``, see the
+":ref:`kernel-dev/kernel-dev-common:using \`\`menuconfig\`\``"
+section in the Yocto Project Linux Kernel Development Manual.
+
+.. _ref-tasks-savedefconfig:
+
+``do_savedefconfig``
+--------------------
+
+When invoked by the user, creates a defconfig file that can be used
+instead of the default defconfig. The saved defconfig contains the
+differences between the default defconfig and the changes made by the
+user using other methods (i.e. the
+:ref:`ref-tasks-kernel_menuconfig` task. You
+can invoke the task using the following command:
+::
+
+ $ bitbake linux-yocto -c savedefconfig
+
+.. _ref-tasks-shared_workdir:
+
+``do_shared_workdir``
+---------------------
+
+After the kernel has been compiled but before the kernel modules have
+been compiled, this task copies files required for module builds and
+which are generated from the kernel build into the shared work
+directory. With these copies successfully copied, the
+:ref:`ref-tasks-compile_kernelmodules` task
+can successfully build the kernel modules in the next step of the build.
+
+.. _ref-tasks-sizecheck:
+
+``do_sizecheck``
+----------------
+
+After the kernel has been built, this task checks the size of the
+stripped kernel image against
+:term:`KERNEL_IMAGE_MAXSIZE`. If that
+variable was set and the size of the stripped kernel exceeds that size,
+the kernel build produces a warning to that effect.
+
+.. _ref-tasks-strip:
+
+``do_strip``
+------------
+
+If ``KERNEL_IMAGE_STRIP_EXTRA_SECTIONS`` is defined, this task strips
+the sections named in that variable from ``vmlinux``. This stripping is
+typically used to remove nonessential sections such as ``.comment``
+sections from a size-sensitive configuration.
+
+.. _ref-tasks-validate_branches:
+
+``do_validate_branches``
+------------------------
+
+After the kernel is unpacked but before it is patched, this task makes
+sure that the machine and metadata branches as specified by the
+:term:`SRCREV` variables actually exist on the specified
+branches. If these branches do not exist and
+:term:`AUTOREV` is not being used, the
+``do_validate_branches`` task fails during the build.
+
+Miscellaneous Tasks
+===================
+
+The following sections describe miscellaneous tasks.
+
+.. _ref-tasks-spdx:
+
+``do_spdx``
+-----------
+
+A build stage that takes the source code and scans it on a remote
+FOSSOLOGY server in order to produce an SPDX document. This task applies
+only to the :ref:`spdx <ref-classes-spdx>` class.
diff --git a/poky/documentation/ref-manual/ref-terms.rst b/poky/documentation/ref-manual/ref-terms.rst
new file mode 100644
index 000000000..6e7e5169c
--- /dev/null
+++ b/poky/documentation/ref-manual/ref-terms.rst
@@ -0,0 +1,397 @@
+.. SPDX-License-Identifier: CC-BY-2.0-UK
+
+*******************
+Yocto Project Terms
+*******************
+
+Following is a list of terms and definitions users new to the Yocto Project
+development environment might find helpful. While some of these terms are
+universal, the list includes them just in case:
+
+.. glossary::
+
+ Append Files
+ Files that append build information to a recipe file. Append files are
+ known as BitBake append files and ``.bbappend`` files. The OpenEmbedded
+ build system expects every append file to have a corresponding recipe
+ (``.bb``) file. Furthermore, the append file and corresponding recipe file
+ must use the same root filename. The filenames can differ only in the
+ file type suffix used (e.g. ``formfactor_0.0.bb`` and
+ ``formfactor_0.0.bbappend``).
+
+ Information in append files extends or overrides the information in the
+ similarly-named recipe file. For an example of an append file in use, see
+ the ":ref:`dev-manual/dev-manual-common-tasks:Using .bbappend Files in
+ Your Layer`" section in the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual.
+
+ When you name an append file, you can use the "``%``" wildcard character
+ to allow for matching recipe names. For example, suppose you have an
+ append file named as follows:
+ ::
+
+ busybox_1.21.%.bbappend
+
+ That append file
+ would match any ``busybox_1.21.``\ x\ ``.bb`` version of the recipe. So,
+ the append file would match any of the following recipe names:
+
+ .. code-block:: shell
+
+ busybox_1.21.1.bb
+ busybox_1.21.2.bb
+ busybox_1.21.3.bb
+ busybox_1.21.10.bb
+ busybox_1.21.25.bb
+
+ .. note::
+
+ The use of the " % " character is limited in that it only works
+ directly in front of the .bbappend portion of the append file's
+ name. You cannot use the wildcard character in any other location of
+ the name.
+
+ BitBake
+ The task executor and scheduler used by the OpenEmbedded build system to
+ build images. For more information on BitBake, see the :doc:`BitBake User
+ Manual <bitbake:index>`.
+
+ Board Support Package (BSP)
+ A group of drivers, definitions, and other components that provide support
+ for a specific hardware configuration. For more information on BSPs, see
+ the :ref:`bsp-guide/bsp-guide:Yocto Project Board Support Package
+ Developer's Guide`.
+
+ Build Directory
+ This term refers to the area used by the OpenEmbedded build system for
+ builds. The area is created when you ``source`` the setup environment
+ script that is found in the Source Directory
+ (i.e. :ref:`ref-manual/ref-structure:\`\`oe-init-build-env\`\``). The
+ :term:`TOPDIR` variable points to the Build Directory.
+
+ You have a lot of flexibility when creating the Build Directory.
+ Following are some examples that show how to create the directory. The
+ examples assume your :term:`Source Directory` is named ``poky``:
+
+ - Create the Build Directory inside your Source Directory and let
+ the name of the Build Directory default to ``build``:
+
+ .. code-block:: shell
+
+ $ cd $HOME/poky
+ $ source oe-init-build-env
+
+ - Create the Build Directory inside your home directory and
+ specifically name it ``test-builds``:
+
+ .. code-block:: shell
+
+ $ cd $HOME
+ $ source poky/oe-init-build-env test-builds
+
+ - Provide a directory path and specifically name the Build
+ Directory. Any intermediate folders in the pathname must exist.
+ This next example creates a Build Directory named
+ ``YP-POKYVERSION`` in your home directory within the existing
+ directory ``mybuilds``:
+
+ .. code-block:: shell
+
+ $ cd $HOME
+ $ source $HOME/poky/oe-init-build-env $HOME/mybuilds/YP-POKYVERSION
+
+ .. note::
+
+ By default, the Build Directory contains :term:`TMPDIR` , which is a
+ temporary directory the build system uses for its work. TMPDIR cannot
+ be under NFS. Thus, by default, the Build Directory cannot be under
+ NFS. However, if you need the Build Directory to be under NFS, you can
+ set this up by setting TMPDIR in your local.conf file to use a local
+ drive. Doing so effectively separates TMPDIR from TOPDIR , which is the
+ Build Directory.
+
+ Build Host
+ The system used to build images in a Yocto Project Development
+ environment. The build system is sometimes referred to as the development
+ host.
+
+ Classes
+ Files that provide for logic encapsulation and inheritance so that
+ commonly used patterns can be defined once and then easily used in
+ multiple recipes. For reference information on the Yocto Project classes,
+ see the ":ref:`ref-manual/ref-classes:Classes`" chapter. Class files end with the
+ ``.bbclass`` filename extension.
+
+ Configuration File
+ Files that hold global definitions of variables, user-defined variables,
+ and hardware configuration information. These files tell the OpenEmbedded
+ build system what to build and what to put into the image to support a
+ particular platform.
+
+ Configuration files end with a ``.conf`` filename extension. The
+ :file:`conf/local.conf` configuration file in the :term:`Build Directory`
+ contains user-defined variables that affect every build. The
+ :file:`meta-poky/conf/distro/poky.conf` configuration file defines Yocto
+ "distro" configuration variables used only when building with this
+ policy. Machine configuration files, which are located throughout the
+ :term:`Source Directory`, define variables for specific hardware and are
+ only used when building for that target (e.g. the
+ :file:`machine/beaglebone.conf` configuration file defines variables for
+ the Texas Instruments ARM Cortex-A8 development board).
+
+ Container Layer
+ Layers that hold other layers. An example of a container layer is
+ OpenEmbedded's `meta-openembedded
+ <https://github.com/openembedded/meta-openembedded>`_ layer. The
+ ``meta-openembedded`` layer contains many ``meta-*`` layers.
+
+ Cross-Development Toolchain
+ In general, a cross-development toolchain is a collection of software
+ development tools and utilities that run on one architecture and allow you
+ to develop software for a different, or targeted, architecture. These
+ toolchains contain cross-compilers, linkers, and debuggers that are
+ specific to the target architecture.
+
+ The Yocto Project supports two different cross-development toolchains:
+
+ - A toolchain only used by and within BitBake when building an image for a
+ target architecture.
+
+ - A relocatable toolchain used outside of BitBake by developers when
+ developing applications that will run on a targeted device.
+
+ Creation of these toolchains is simple and automated. For information on
+ toolchain concepts as they apply to the Yocto Project, see the
+ ":ref:`overview-manual/overview-manual-concepts:Cross-Development
+ Toolchain Generation`" section in the Yocto Project Overview and Concepts
+ Manual. You can also find more information on using the relocatable
+ toolchain in the :ref:`sdk-manual/sdk-manual:Yocto Project Application
+ Development and the Extensible Software Development Kit (eSDK)` manual.
+
+ Extensible Software Development Kit (eSDK)
+ A custom SDK for application developers. This eSDK allows developers to
+ incorporate their library and programming changes back into the image to
+ make their code available to other application developers.
+
+ For information on the eSDK, see the :ref:`sdk-manual/sdk-manual:Yocto
+ Project Application Development and the Extensible Software Development
+ Kit (eSDK)` manual.
+
+ Image
+ An image is an artifact of the BitBake build process given a collection of
+ recipes and related Metadata. Images are the binary output that run on
+ specific hardware or QEMU and are used for specific use-cases. For a list
+ of the supported image types that the Yocto Project provides, see the
+ ":ref:`ref-manual/ref-images:Images`" chapter.
+
+ Layer
+ A collection of related recipes. Layers allow you to consolidate related
+ metadata to customize your build. Layers also isolate information used
+ when building for multiple architectures. Layers are hierarchical in
+ their ability to override previous specifications. You can include any
+ number of available layers from the Yocto Project and customize the build
+ by adding your layers after them. You can search the Layer Index for
+ layers used within Yocto Project.
+
+ For introductory information on layers, see the
+ ":ref:`overview-manual/overview-manual-yp-intro:The Yocto Project Layer
+ Model`" section in the Yocto Project Overview and Concepts Manual. For
+ more detailed information on layers, see the
+ ":ref:`dev-manual/dev-manual-common-tasks:Understanding and Creating
+ Layers`" section in the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual. For a
+ discussion specifically on BSP Layers, see the ":ref:`bsp-guide/bsp:BSP
+ Layers`" section in the Yocto Project Board Support Packages (BSP)
+ Developer's Guide.
+
+ Metadata
+ A key element of the Yocto Project is the Metadata that
+ is used to construct a Linux distribution and is contained in the
+ files that the :term:`OpenEmbedded Build System`
+ parses when building an image. In general, Metadata includes recipes,
+ configuration files, and other information that refers to the build
+ instructions themselves, as well as the data used to control what
+ things get built and the effects of the build. Metadata also includes
+ commands and data used to indicate what versions of software are
+ used, from where they are obtained, and changes or additions to the
+ software itself (patches or auxiliary files) that are used to fix
+ bugs or customize the software for use in a particular situation.
+ OpenEmbedded-Core is an important set of validated metadata.
+
+ In the context of the kernel ("kernel Metadata"), the term refers to
+ the kernel config fragments and features contained in the
+ :yocto_git:`yocto-kernel-cache </cgit/cgit.cgi/yocto-kernel-cache>`
+ Git repository.
+
+ OpenEmbedded-Core (OE-Core)
+ OE-Core is metadata comprised of
+ foundational recipes, classes, and associated files that are meant to
+ be common among many different OpenEmbedded-derived systems,
+ including the Yocto Project. OE-Core is a curated subset of an
+ original repository developed by the OpenEmbedded community that has
+ been pared down into a smaller, core set of continuously validated
+ recipes. The result is a tightly controlled and an quality-assured
+ core set of recipes.
+
+ You can see the Metadata in the ``meta`` directory of the Yocto
+ Project :yocto_git:`Source Repositories <>`.
+
+ OpenEmbedded Build System
+ The build system specific to the Yocto
+ Project. The OpenEmbedded build system is based on another project
+ known as "Poky", which uses :term:`BitBake` as the task
+ executor. Throughout the Yocto Project documentation set, the
+ OpenEmbedded build system is sometimes referred to simply as "the
+ build system". If other build systems, such as a host or target build
+ system are referenced, the documentation clearly states the
+ difference.
+
+ .. note::
+
+ For some historical information about Poky, see the
+ Poky
+ term.
+
+ Package
+ In the context of the Yocto Project, this term refers to a
+ recipe's packaged output produced by BitBake (i.e. a "baked recipe").
+ A package is generally the compiled binaries produced from the
+ recipe's sources. You "bake" something by running it through BitBake.
+
+ It is worth noting that the term "package" can, in general, have
+ subtle meanings. For example, the packages referred to in the
+ "`Required Packages for the Build
+ Host <#required-packages-for-the-build-host>`__" section are compiled
+ binaries that, when installed, add functionality to your Linux
+ distribution.
+
+ Another point worth noting is that historically within the Yocto
+ Project, recipes were referred to as packages - thus, the existence
+ of several BitBake variables that are seemingly mis-named, (e.g.
+ :term:`PR`, :term:`PV`, and
+ :term:`PE`).
+
+ Package Groups
+ Arbitrary groups of software Recipes. You use
+ package groups to hold recipes that, when built, usually accomplish a
+ single task. For example, a package group could contain the recipes
+ for a company's proprietary or value-add software. Or, the package
+ group could contain the recipes that enable graphics. A package group
+ is really just another recipe. Because package group files are
+ recipes, they end with the ``.bb`` filename extension.
+
+ Poky
+ Poky, which is pronounced *Pock*-ee, is a reference embedded
+ distribution and a reference test configuration. Poky provides the
+ following:
+
+ - A base-level functional distro used to illustrate how to customize
+ a distribution.
+
+ - A means by which to test the Yocto Project components (i.e. Poky
+ is used to validate the Yocto Project).
+
+ - A vehicle through which you can download the Yocto Project.
+
+ Poky is not a product level distro. Rather, it is a good starting
+ point for customization.
+
+ .. note::
+
+ Poky began as an open-source project initially developed by
+ OpenedHand. OpenedHand developed Poky from the existing
+ OpenEmbedded build system to create a commercially supportable
+ build system for embedded Linux. After Intel Corporation acquired
+ OpenedHand, the poky project became the basis for the Yocto
+ Project's build system.
+
+ Recipe
+ A set of instructions for building packages. A recipe
+ describes where you get source code, which patches to apply, how to
+ configure the source, how to compile it and so on. Recipes also
+ describe dependencies for libraries or for other recipes. Recipes
+ represent the logical unit of execution, the software to build, the
+ images to build, and use the ``.bb`` file extension.
+
+ Reference Kit
+ A working example of a system, which includes a
+ :term:`BSP<Board Support Package (BSP)>` as well as a
+ :term:`build host<Build Host>` and other components, that can
+ work on specific hardware.
+
+ Source Directory
+ This term refers to the directory structure
+ created as a result of creating a local copy of the ``poky`` Git
+ repository ``git://git.yoctoproject.org/poky`` or expanding a
+ released ``poky`` tarball.
+
+ .. note::
+
+ Creating a local copy of the
+ poky
+ Git repository is the recommended method for setting up your
+ Source Directory.
+
+ Sometimes you might hear the term "poky directory" used to refer to
+ this directory structure.
+
+ .. note::
+
+ The OpenEmbedded build system does not support file or directory
+ names that contain spaces. Be sure that the Source Directory you
+ use does not contain these types of names.
+
+ The Source Directory contains BitBake, Documentation, Metadata and
+ other files that all support the Yocto Project. Consequently, you
+ must have the Source Directory in place on your development system in
+ order to do any development using the Yocto Project.
+
+ When you create a local copy of the Git repository, you can name the
+ repository anything you like. Throughout much of the documentation,
+ "poky" is used as the name of the top-level folder of the local copy
+ of the poky Git repository. So, for example, cloning the ``poky`` Git
+ repository results in a local Git repository whose top-level folder
+ is also named "poky".
+
+ While it is not recommended that you use tarball expansion to set up
+ the Source Directory, if you do, the top-level directory name of the
+ Source Directory is derived from the Yocto Project release tarball.
+ For example, downloading and unpacking
+ :yocto_dl:`releases/yocto/&DISTRO_REL_TAG;/&YOCTO_POKY;.tar.bz2`
+ results in a Source Directory whose root folder is named ``poky``.
+
+ It is important to understand the differences between the Source
+ Directory created by unpacking a released tarball as compared to
+ cloning ``git://git.yoctoproject.org/poky``. When you unpack a
+ tarball, you have an exact copy of the files based on the time of
+ release - a fixed release point. Any changes you make to your local
+ files in the Source Directory are on top of the release and will
+ remain local only. On the other hand, when you clone the ``poky`` Git
+ repository, you have an active development repository with access to
+ the upstream repository's branches and tags. In this case, any local
+ changes you make to the local Source Directory can be later applied
+ to active development branches of the upstream ``poky`` Git
+ repository.
+
+ For more information on concepts related to Git repositories,
+ branches, and tags, see the
+ ":ref:`overview-manual/overview-manual-development-environment:repositories, tags, and branches`"
+ section in the Yocto Project Overview and Concepts Manual.
+
+ Task
+ A unit of execution for BitBake (e.g.
+ :ref:`ref-tasks-compile`,
+ :ref:`ref-tasks-fetch`,
+ :ref:`ref-tasks-patch`, and so forth).
+
+ Toaster
+ A web interface to the Yocto Project's :term:`OpenEmbedded Build System`.
+ The interface enables you to
+ configure and run your builds. Information about builds is collected
+ and stored in a database. For information on Toaster, see the
+ :doc:`../toaster-manual/toaster-manual`.
+
+ Upstream
+ A reference to source code or repositories that are not
+ local to the development system but located in a master area that is
+ controlled by the maintainer of the source code. For example, in
+ order for a developer to work on a particular piece of code, they
+ need to first get a copy of it from an "upstream" source.
diff --git a/poky/documentation/ref-manual/ref-terms.xml b/poky/documentation/ref-manual/ref-terms.xml
index d2605c62a..2a0452bd7 100644
--- a/poky/documentation/ref-manual/ref-terms.xml
+++ b/poky/documentation/ref-manual/ref-terms.xml
@@ -365,7 +365,7 @@
You use package groups to hold recipes that, when built,
usually accomplish a single task.
For example, a package group could contain the recipes for a
- company’s proprietary or value-add software.
+ company's proprietary or value-add software.
Or, the package group could contain the recipes that enable
graphics.
A package group is really just another recipe.
diff --git a/poky/documentation/ref-manual/ref-variables.rst b/poky/documentation/ref-manual/ref-variables.rst
new file mode 100644
index 000000000..625a37c15
--- /dev/null
+++ b/poky/documentation/ref-manual/ref-variables.rst
@@ -0,0 +1,8899 @@
+.. SPDX-License-Identifier: CC-BY-2.0-UK
+
+******************
+Variables Glossary
+******************
+
+This chapter lists common variables used in the OpenEmbedded build
+system and gives an overview of their function and contents.
+
+`A <#var-ABIEXTENSION>`__ :term:`B` `C <#var-CACHE>`__
+:term:`D` `E <#var-EFI_PROVIDER>`__ `F <#var-FEATURE_PACKAGES>`__
+`G <#var-GCCPIE>`__ `H <#var-HOMEPAGE>`__ `I <#var-ICECC_DISABLED>`__
+`K <#var-KARCH>`__ `L <#var-LABELS>`__ `M <#var-MACHINE>`__
+`N <#var-NATIVELSBSTRING>`__ `O <#var-OBJCOPY>`__ :term:`P`
+`R <#var-RANLIB>`__ :term:`S` :term:`T`
+`U <#var-UBOOT_CONFIG>`__ `V <#var-VOLATILE_LOG_DIR>`__
+`W <#var-WARN_QA>`__ `X <#var-XSERVER>`__
+
+.. glossary::
+
+ ABIEXTENSION
+ Extension to the Application Binary Interface (ABI) field of the GNU
+ canonical architecture name (e.g. "eabi").
+
+ ABI extensions are set in the machine include files. For example, the
+ ``meta/conf/machine/include/arm/arch-arm.inc`` file sets the
+ following extension:
+ ::
+
+ ABIEXTENSION = "eabi"
+
+ ALLOW_EMPTY
+ Specifies whether to produce an output package even if it is empty.
+ By default, BitBake does not produce empty packages. This default
+ behavior can cause issues when there is an
+ :term:`RDEPENDS` or some other hard runtime
+ requirement on the existence of the package.
+
+ Like all package-controlling variables, you must always use them in
+ conjunction with a package name override, as in:
+ ::
+
+ ALLOW_EMPTY_${PN} = "1"
+ ALLOW_EMPTY_${PN}-dev = "1"
+ ALLOW_EMPTY_${PN}-staticdev = "1"
+
+ ALTERNATIVE
+ Lists commands in a package that need an alternative binary naming
+ scheme. Sometimes the same command is provided in multiple packages.
+ When this occurs, the OpenEmbedded build system needs to use the
+ alternatives system to create a different binary naming scheme so the
+ commands can co-exist.
+
+ To use the variable, list out the package's commands that also exist
+ as part of another package. For example, if the ``busybox`` package
+ has four commands that also exist as part of another package, you
+ identify them as follows:
+ ::
+
+ ALTERNATIVE_busybox = "sh sed test bracket"
+
+ For more information on the alternatives system, see the
+ ":ref:`update-alternatives.bbclass <ref-classes-update-alternatives>`"
+ section.
+
+ ALTERNATIVE_LINK_NAME
+ Used by the alternatives system to map duplicated commands to actual
+ locations. For example, if the ``bracket`` command provided by the
+ ``busybox`` package is duplicated through another package, you must
+ use the ``ALTERNATIVE_LINK_NAME`` variable to specify the actual
+ location:
+ ::
+
+ ALTERNATIVE_LINK_NAME[bracket] = "/usr/bin/["
+
+ In this example, the binary for the ``bracket`` command (i.e. ``[``)
+ from the ``busybox`` package resides in ``/usr/bin/``.
+
+ .. note::
+
+ If ALTERNATIVE_LINK_NAME is not defined, it defaults to ${bindir}/ name.
+
+ For more information on the alternatives system, see the
+ ":ref:`update-alternatives.bbclass <ref-classes-update-alternatives>`"
+ section.
+
+ ALTERNATIVE_PRIORITY
+ Used by the alternatives system to create default priorities for
+ duplicated commands. You can use the variable to create a single
+ default regardless of the command name or package, a default for
+ specific duplicated commands regardless of the package, or a default
+ for specific commands tied to particular packages. Here are the
+ available syntax forms:
+ ::
+
+ ALTERNATIVE_PRIORITY = "priority"
+ ALTERNATIVE_PRIORITY[name] = "priority"
+ ALTERNATIVE_PRIORITY_pkg[name] = "priority"
+
+ For more information on the alternatives system, see the
+ ":ref:`update-alternatives.bbclass <ref-classes-update-alternatives>`"
+ section.
+
+ ALTERNATIVE_TARGET
+ Used by the alternatives system to create default link locations for
+ duplicated commands. You can use the variable to create a single
+ default location for all duplicated commands regardless of the
+ command name or package, a default for specific duplicated commands
+ regardless of the package, or a default for specific commands tied to
+ particular packages. Here are the available syntax forms:
+ ::
+
+ ALTERNATIVE_TARGET = "target"
+ ALTERNATIVE_TARGET[name] = "target"
+ ALTERNATIVE_TARGET_pkg[name] = "target"
+
+ .. note::
+
+ If ``ALTERNATIVE_TARGET`` is not defined, it inherits the value
+ from the :term:`ALTERNATIVE_LINK_NAME` variable.
+
+ If ``ALTERNATIVE_LINK_NAME`` and ``ALTERNATIVE_TARGET`` are the
+ same, the target for ``ALTERNATIVE_TARGET`` has "``.{BPN}``"
+ appended to it.
+
+ Finally, if the file referenced has not been renamed, the
+ alternatives system will rename it to avoid the need to rename
+ alternative files in the :ref:`ref-tasks-install`
+ task while retaining support for the command if necessary.
+
+ For more information on the alternatives system, see the
+ ":ref:`update-alternatives.bbclass <ref-classes-update-alternatives>`"
+ section.
+
+ APPEND
+ An override list of append strings for each target specified with
+ :term:`LABELS`.
+
+ See the :ref:`grub-efi <ref-classes-grub-efi>` class for more
+ information on how this variable is used.
+
+ AR
+ The minimal command and arguments used to run ``ar``.
+
+ ARCHIVER_MODE
+ When used with the :ref:`archiver <ref-classes-archiver>` class,
+ determines the type of information used to create a released archive.
+ You can use this variable to create archives of patched source,
+ original source, configured source, and so forth by employing the
+ following variable flags (varflags):
+ ::
+
+ ARCHIVER_MODE[src] = "original" # Uses original (unpacked) source files.
+ ARCHIVER_MODE[src] = "patched" # Uses patched source files. This is the default.
+ ARCHIVER_MODE[src] = "configured" # Uses configured source files.
+ ARCHIVER_MODE[diff] = "1" # Uses patches between do_unpack and do_patch.
+ ARCHIVER_MODE[diff-exclude] ?= "file file ..." # Lists files and directories to exclude from diff.
+ ARCHIVER_MODE[dumpdata] = "1" # Uses environment data.
+ ARCHIVER_MODE[recipe] = "1" # Uses recipe and include files.
+ ARCHIVER_MODE[srpm] = "1" # Uses RPM package files.
+
+ For information on how the variable works, see the
+ ``meta/classes/archiver.bbclass`` file in the :term:`Source Directory`.
+
+ AS
+ Minimal command and arguments needed to run the assembler.
+
+ ASSUME_PROVIDED
+ Lists recipe names (:term:`PN` values) BitBake does not
+ attempt to build. Instead, BitBake assumes these recipes have already
+ been built.
+
+ In OpenEmbedded-Core, ``ASSUME_PROVIDED`` mostly specifies native
+ tools that should not be built. An example is ``git-native``, which
+ when specified, allows for the Git binary from the host to be used
+ rather than building ``git-native``.
+
+ ASSUME_SHLIBS
+ Provides additional ``shlibs`` provider mapping information, which
+ adds to or overwrites the information provided automatically by the
+ system. Separate multiple entries using spaces.
+
+ As an example, use the following form to add an ``shlib`` provider of
+ shlibname in packagename with the optional version:
+ ::
+
+ shlibname:packagename[_version]
+
+ Here is an example that adds a shared library named ``libEGL.so.1``
+ as being provided by the ``libegl-implementation`` package:
+ ::
+
+ ASSUME_SHLIBS = "libEGL.so.1:libegl-implementation"
+
+ AUTHOR
+ The email address used to contact the original author or authors in
+ order to send patches and forward bugs.
+
+ AUTO_LIBNAME_PKGS
+ When the :ref:`debian <ref-classes-debian>` class is inherited,
+ which is the default behavior, ``AUTO_LIBNAME_PKGS`` specifies which
+ packages should be checked for libraries and renamed according to
+ Debian library package naming.
+
+ The default value is "${PACKAGES}", which causes the debian class to
+ act on all packages that are explicitly generated by the recipe.
+
+ AUTO_SYSLINUXMENU
+ Enables creating an automatic menu for the syslinux bootloader. You
+ must set this variable in your recipe. The
+ :ref:`syslinux <ref-classes-syslinux>` class checks this variable.
+
+ AUTOREV
+ When ``SRCREV`` is set to the value of this variable, it specifies to
+ use the latest source revision in the repository. Here is an example:
+ ::
+
+ SRCREV = "${AUTOREV}"
+
+ If you use the previous statement to retrieve the latest version of
+ software, you need to be sure :term:`PV` contains
+ ``${``\ :term:`SRCPV`\ ``}``. For example, suppose you
+ have a kernel recipe that inherits the
+ :ref:`kernel <ref-classes-kernel>` class and you use the previous
+ statement. In this example, ``${SRCPV}`` does not automatically get
+ into ``PV``. Consequently, you need to change ``PV`` in your recipe
+ so that it does contain ``${SRCPV}``.
+
+ For more information see the
+ ":ref:`dev-manual/dev-manual-common-tasks:automatically incrementing a package version number`"
+ section in the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual.
+
+ AVAILABLE_LICENSES
+ List of licenses found in the directories specified by
+ :term:`COMMON_LICENSE_DIR` and
+ :term:`LICENSE_PATH`.
+
+ .. note::
+
+ It is assumed that all changes to
+ COMMON_LICENSE_DIR
+ and
+ LICENSE_PATH
+ have been done before
+ AVAILABLE_LICENSES
+ is defined (in
+ license.bbclass
+ ).
+
+ AVAILTUNES
+ The list of defined CPU and Application Binary Interface (ABI)
+ tunings (i.e. "tunes") available for use by the OpenEmbedded build
+ system.
+
+ The list simply presents the tunes that are available. Not all tunes
+ may be compatible with a particular machine configuration, or with
+ each other in a
+ :ref:`Multilib <dev-manual/dev-manual-common-tasks:combining multiple versions of library files into one image>`
+ configuration.
+
+ To add a tune to the list, be sure to append it with spaces using the
+ "+=" BitBake operator. Do not simply replace the list by using the
+ "=" operator. See the
+ ":ref:`Basic Syntax <bitbake:bitbake-user-manual/bitbake-user-manual-metadata:basic syntax>`" section in the BitBake
+ User Manual for more information.
+
+ B
+ The directory within the :term:`Build Directory` in
+ which the OpenEmbedded build system places generated objects during a
+ recipe's build process. By default, this directory is the same as the
+ :term:`S` directory, which is defined as:
+ ::
+
+ S = "${WORKDIR}/${BP}"
+
+ You can separate the (``S``) directory and the directory pointed to
+ by the ``B`` variable. Most Autotools-based recipes support
+ separating these directories. The build system defaults to using
+ separate directories for ``gcc`` and some kernel recipes.
+
+ BAD_RECOMMENDATIONS
+ Lists "recommended-only" packages to not install. Recommended-only
+ packages are packages installed only through the
+ :term:`RRECOMMENDS` variable. You can prevent any
+ of these "recommended" packages from being installed by listing them
+ with the ``BAD_RECOMMENDATIONS`` variable:
+ ::
+
+ BAD_RECOMMENDATIONS = "package_name package_name package_name ..."
+
+ You can set this variable globally in your ``local.conf`` file or you
+ can attach it to a specific image recipe by using the recipe name
+ override:
+ ::
+
+ BAD_RECOMMENDATIONS_pn-target_image = "package_name"
+
+ It is important to realize that if you choose to not install packages
+ using this variable and some other packages are dependent on them
+ (i.e. listed in a recipe's :term:`RDEPENDS`
+ variable), the OpenEmbedded build system ignores your request and
+ will install the packages to avoid dependency errors.
+
+ Support for this variable exists only when using the IPK and RPM
+ packaging backend. Support does not exist for DEB.
+
+ See the :term:`NO_RECOMMENDATIONS` and the
+ :term:`PACKAGE_EXCLUDE` variables for related
+ information.
+
+ BASE_LIB
+ The library directory name for the CPU or Application Binary
+ Interface (ABI) tune. The ``BASE_LIB`` applies only in the Multilib
+ context. See the ":ref:`dev-manual/dev-manual-common-tasks:combining multiple versions of library files into one image`"
+ section in the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual for information
+ on Multilib.
+
+ The ``BASE_LIB`` variable is defined in the machine include files in
+ the :term:`Source Directory`. If Multilib is not
+ being used, the value defaults to "lib".
+
+ BASE_WORKDIR
+ Points to the base of the work directory for all recipes. The default
+ value is "${TMPDIR}/work".
+
+ BB_ALLOWED_NETWORKS
+ Specifies a space-delimited list of hosts that the fetcher is allowed
+ to use to obtain the required source code. Following are
+ considerations surrounding this variable:
+
+ - This host list is only used if ``BB_NO_NETWORK`` is either not set
+ or set to "0".
+
+ - Limited support for wildcard matching against the beginning of
+ host names exists. For example, the following setting matches
+ ``git.gnu.org``, ``ftp.gnu.org``, and ``foo.git.gnu.org``.
+ ::
+
+ BB_ALLOWED_NETWORKS = "*.gnu.org"
+
+ .. note::
+
+ The use of the "``*``" character only works at the beginning of
+ a host name and it must be isolated from the remainder of the
+ host name. You cannot use the wildcard character in any other
+ location of the name or combined with the front part of the
+ name.
+
+ For example, ``*.foo.bar`` is supported, while ``*aa.foo.bar``
+ is not.
+
+ - Mirrors not in the host list are skipped and logged in debug.
+
+ - Attempts to access networks not in the host list cause a failure.
+
+ Using ``BB_ALLOWED_NETWORKS`` in conjunction with
+ :term:`PREMIRRORS` is very useful. Adding the host
+ you want to use to ``PREMIRRORS`` results in the source code being
+ fetched from an allowed location and avoids raising an error when a
+ host that is not allowed is in a :term:`SRC_URI`
+ statement. This is because the fetcher does not attempt to use the
+ host listed in ``SRC_URI`` after a successful fetch from the
+ ``PREMIRRORS`` occurs.
+
+ BB_DANGLINGAPPENDS_WARNONLY
+ Defines how BitBake handles situations where an append file
+ (``.bbappend``) has no corresponding recipe file (``.bb``). This
+ condition often occurs when layers get out of sync (e.g. ``oe-core``
+ bumps a recipe version and the old recipe no longer exists and the
+ other layer has not been updated to the new version of the recipe
+ yet).
+
+ The default fatal behavior is safest because it is the sane reaction
+ given something is out of sync. It is important to realize when your
+ changes are no longer being applied.
+
+ You can change the default behavior by setting this variable to "1",
+ "yes", or "true" in your ``local.conf`` file, which is located in the
+ :term:`Build Directory`: Here is an example:
+ ::
+
+ BB_DANGLINGAPPENDS_WARNONLY = "1"
+
+ BB_DISKMON_DIRS
+ Monitors disk space and available inodes during the build and allows
+ you to control the build based on these parameters.
+
+ Disk space monitoring is disabled by default. To enable monitoring,
+ add the ``BB_DISKMON_DIRS`` variable to your ``conf/local.conf`` file
+ found in the :term:`Build Directory`. Use the
+ following form:
+ ::
+
+ BB_DISKMON_DIRS = "action,dir,threshold [...]"
+
+ where:
+
+ action is:
+ ABORT: Immediately abort the build when
+ a threshold is broken.
+ STOPTASKS: Stop the build after the currently
+ executing tasks have finished when
+ a threshold is broken.
+ WARN: Issue a warning but continue the
+ build when a threshold is broken.
+ Subsequent warnings are issued as
+ defined by the BB_DISKMON_WARNINTERVAL
+ variable, which must be defined in
+ the conf/local.conf file.
+
+ dir is:
+ Any directory you choose. You can specify one or
+ more directories to monitor by separating the
+ groupings with a space. If two directories are
+ on the same device, only the first directory
+ is monitored.
+
+ threshold is:
+ Either the minimum available disk space,
+ the minimum number of free inodes, or
+ both. You must specify at least one. To
+ omit one or the other, simply omit the value.
+ Specify the threshold using G, M, K for Gbytes,
+ Mbytes, and Kbytes, respectively. If you do
+ not specify G, M, or K, Kbytes is assumed by
+ default. Do not use GB, MB, or KB.
+
+ Here are some examples:
+ ::
+
+ BB_DISKMON_DIRS = "ABORT,${TMPDIR},1G,100K WARN,${SSTATE_DIR},1G,100K"
+ BB_DISKMON_DIRS = "STOPTASKS,${TMPDIR},1G"
+ BB_DISKMON_DIRS = "ABORT,${TMPDIR},,100K"
+
+ The first example works only if you also provide the
+ :term:`BB_DISKMON_WARNINTERVAL`
+ variable in the ``conf/local.conf``. This example causes the build
+ system to immediately abort when either the disk space in
+ ``${TMPDIR}`` drops below 1 Gbyte or the available free inodes drops
+ below 100 Kbytes. Because two directories are provided with the
+ variable, the build system also issue a warning when the disk space
+ in the ``${SSTATE_DIR}`` directory drops below 1 Gbyte or the number
+ of free inodes drops below 100 Kbytes. Subsequent warnings are issued
+ during intervals as defined by the ``BB_DISKMON_WARNINTERVAL``
+ variable.
+
+ The second example stops the build after all currently executing
+ tasks complete when the minimum disk space in the ``${TMPDIR}``
+ directory drops below 1 Gbyte. No disk monitoring occurs for the free
+ inodes in this case.
+
+ The final example immediately aborts the build when the number of
+ free inodes in the ``${TMPDIR}`` directory drops below 100 Kbytes. No
+ disk space monitoring for the directory itself occurs in this case.
+
+ BB_DISKMON_WARNINTERVAL
+ Defines the disk space and free inode warning intervals. To set these
+ intervals, define the variable in your ``conf/local.conf`` file in
+ the :term:`Build Directory`.
+
+ If you are going to use the ``BB_DISKMON_WARNINTERVAL`` variable, you
+ must also use the :term:`BB_DISKMON_DIRS`
+ variable and define its action as "WARN". During the build,
+ subsequent warnings are issued each time disk space or number of free
+ inodes further reduces by the respective interval.
+
+ If you do not provide a ``BB_DISKMON_WARNINTERVAL`` variable and you
+ do use ``BB_DISKMON_DIRS`` with the "WARN" action, the disk
+ monitoring interval defaults to the following:
+ ::
+
+ BB_DISKMON_WARNINTERVAL = "50M,5K"
+
+ When specifying the variable in your configuration file, use the
+ following form:
+ ::
+
+ BB_DISKMON_WARNINTERVAL = "disk_space_interval,disk_inode_interval"
+
+ where:
+
+ disk_space_interval is:
+ An interval of memory expressed in either
+ G, M, or K for Gbytes, Mbytes, or Kbytes,
+ respectively. You cannot use GB, MB, or KB.
+
+ disk_inode_interval is:
+ An interval of free inodes expressed in either
+ G, M, or K for Gbytes, Mbytes, or Kbytes,
+ respectively. You cannot use GB, MB, or KB.
+
+ Here is an example:
+ ::
+
+ BB_DISKMON_DIRS = "WARN,${SSTATE_DIR},1G,100K"
+ BB_DISKMON_WARNINTERVAL = "50M,5K"
+
+ These variables cause the
+ OpenEmbedded build system to issue subsequent warnings each time the
+ available disk space further reduces by 50 Mbytes or the number of
+ free inodes further reduces by 5 Kbytes in the ``${SSTATE_DIR}``
+ directory. Subsequent warnings based on the interval occur each time
+ a respective interval is reached beyond the initial warning (i.e. 1
+ Gbytes and 100 Kbytes).
+
+ BB_GENERATE_MIRROR_TARBALLS
+ Causes tarballs of the source control repositories (e.g. Git
+ repositories), including metadata, to be placed in the
+ :term:`DL_DIR` directory.
+
+ For performance reasons, creating and placing tarballs of these
+ repositories is not the default action by the OpenEmbedded build
+ system.
+ ::
+
+ BB_GENERATE_MIRROR_TARBALLS = "1"
+
+ Set this variable in your
+ ``local.conf`` file in the :term:`Build Directory`.
+
+ Once you have the tarballs containing your source files, you can
+ clean up your ``DL_DIR`` directory by deleting any Git or other
+ source control work directories.
+
+ BB_NUMBER_THREADS
+ The maximum number of tasks BitBake should run in parallel at any one
+ time. The OpenEmbedded build system automatically configures this
+ variable to be equal to the number of cores on the build system. For
+ example, a system with a dual core processor that also uses
+ hyper-threading causes the ``BB_NUMBER_THREADS`` variable to default
+ to "4".
+
+ For single socket systems (i.e. one CPU), you should not have to
+ override this variable to gain optimal parallelism during builds.
+ However, if you have very large systems that employ multiple physical
+ CPUs, you might want to make sure the ``BB_NUMBER_THREADS`` variable
+ is not set higher than "20".
+
+ For more information on speeding up builds, see the
+ ":ref:`dev-manual/dev-manual-common-tasks:speeding up a build`"
+ section in the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual.
+
+ BB_SERVER_TIMEOUT
+ Specifies the time (in seconds) after which to unload the BitBake
+ server due to inactivity. Set ``BB_SERVER_TIMEOUT`` to determine how
+ long the BitBake server stays resident between invocations.
+
+ For example, the following statement in your ``local.conf`` file
+ instructs the server to be unloaded after 20 seconds of inactivity:
+ ::
+
+ BB_SERVER_TIMEOUT = "20"
+
+ If you want the server to never be unloaded,
+ set ``BB_SERVER_TIMEOUT`` to "-1".
+
+ BBCLASSEXTEND
+ Allows you to extend a recipe so that it builds variants of the
+ software. Common variants for recipes exist such as "natives" like
+ ``quilt-native``, which is a copy of Quilt built to run on the build
+ system; "crosses" such as ``gcc-cross``, which is a compiler built to
+ run on the build machine but produces binaries that run on the target
+ :term:`MACHINE`; "nativesdk", which targets the SDK
+ machine instead of ``MACHINE``; and "mulitlibs" in the form
+ "``multilib:``\ multilib_name".
+
+ To build a different variant of the recipe with a minimal amount of
+ code, it usually is as simple as adding the following to your recipe:
+ ::
+
+ BBCLASSEXTEND =+ "native nativesdk"
+ BBCLASSEXTEND =+ "multilib:multilib_name"
+
+ .. note::
+
+ Internally, the ``BBCLASSEXTEND`` mechanism generates recipe
+ variants by rewriting variable values and applying overrides such
+ as ``_class-native``. For example, to generate a native version of
+ a recipe, a :term:`DEPENDS` on "foo" is rewritten
+ to a ``DEPENDS`` on "foo-native".
+
+ Even when using ``BBCLASSEXTEND``, the recipe is only parsed once.
+ Parsing once adds some limitations. For example, it is not
+ possible to include a different file depending on the variant,
+ since ``include`` statements are processed when the recipe is
+ parsed.
+
+ BBFILE_COLLECTIONS
+ Lists the names of configured layers. These names are used to find
+ the other ``BBFILE_*`` variables. Typically, each layer will append
+ its name to this variable in its ``conf/layer.conf`` file.
+
+ BBFILE_PATTERN
+ Variable that expands to match files from
+ :term:`BBFILES` in a particular layer. This variable
+ is used in the ``conf/layer.conf`` file and must be suffixed with the
+ name of the specific layer (e.g. ``BBFILE_PATTERN_emenlow``).
+
+ BBFILE_PRIORITY
+ Assigns the priority for recipe files in each layer.
+
+ This variable is useful in situations where the same recipe appears
+ in more than one layer. Setting this variable allows you to
+ prioritize a layer against other layers that contain the same recipe
+ - effectively letting you control the precedence for the multiple
+ layers. The precedence established through this variable stands
+ regardless of a recipe's version (:term:`PV` variable). For
+ example, a layer that has a recipe with a higher ``PV`` value but for
+ which the ``BBFILE_PRIORITY`` is set to have a lower precedence still
+ has a lower precedence.
+
+ A larger value for the ``BBFILE_PRIORITY`` variable results in a
+ higher precedence. For example, the value 6 has a higher precedence
+ than the value 5. If not specified, the ``BBFILE_PRIORITY`` variable
+ is set based on layer dependencies (see the ``LAYERDEPENDS`` variable
+ for more information. The default priority, if unspecified for a
+ layer with no dependencies, is the lowest defined priority + 1 (or 1
+ if no priorities are defined).
+
+ .. tip::
+
+ You can use the command
+ bitbake-layers show-layers
+ to list all configured layers along with their priorities.
+
+ BBFILES
+ A space-separated list of recipe files BitBake uses to build
+ software.
+
+ When specifying recipe files, you can pattern match using Python's
+ `glob <https://docs.python.org/3/library/glob.html>`_ syntax.
+ For details on the syntax, see the documentation by following the
+ previous link.
+
+ BBFILES_DYNAMIC
+ Activates content when identified layers are present. You identify
+ the layers by the collections that the layers define.
+
+ Use the ``BBFILES_DYNAMIC`` variable to avoid ``.bbappend`` files
+ whose corresponding ``.bb`` file is in a layer that attempts to
+ modify other layers through ``.bbappend`` but does not want to
+ introduce a hard dependency on those other layers.
+
+ Use the following form for ``BBFILES_DYNAMIC``:
+ collection_name:filename_pattern The following example identifies two
+ collection names and two filename patterns:
+ ::
+
+ BBFILES_DYNAMIC += " \
+ clang-layer:${LAYERDIR}/bbappends/meta-clang/*/*/*.bbappend \
+ core:${LAYERDIR}/bbappends/openembedded-core/meta/*/*/*.bbappend \
+ "
+
+ This next example shows an error message that occurs because invalid
+ entries are found, which cause parsing to abort:
+ ::
+
+ ERROR: BBFILES_DYNAMIC entries must be of the form <collection name>:<filename pattern>, not:
+ /work/my-layer/bbappends/meta-security-isafw/*/*/*.bbappend
+ /work/my-layer/bbappends/openembedded-core/meta/*/*/*.bbappend
+
+ BBINCLUDELOGS
+ Variable that controls how BitBake displays logs on build failure.
+
+ BBINCLUDELOGS_LINES
+ If :term:`BBINCLUDELOGS` is set, specifies the
+ maximum number of lines from the task log file to print when
+ reporting a failed task. If you do not set ``BBINCLUDELOGS_LINES``,
+ the entire log is printed.
+
+ BBLAYERS
+ Lists the layers to enable during the build. This variable is defined
+ in the ``bblayers.conf`` configuration file in the :term:`Build Directory`.
+ Here is an example:
+ ::
+
+ BBLAYERS = " \
+ /home/scottrif/poky/meta \ /home/scottrif/poky/meta-poky \
+ /home/scottrif/poky/meta-yocto-bsp \
+ /home/scottrif/poky/meta-mykernel \
+ "
+
+ This example enables four layers, one of which is a custom,
+ user-defined layer named ``meta-mykernel``.
+
+ BBMASK
+ Prevents BitBake from processing recipes and recipe append files.
+
+ You can use the ``BBMASK`` variable to "hide" these ``.bb`` and
+ ``.bbappend`` files. BitBake ignores any recipe or recipe append
+ files that match any of the expressions. It is as if BitBake does not
+ see them at all. Consequently, matching files are not parsed or
+ otherwise used by BitBake.
+
+ The values you provide are passed to Python's regular expression
+ compiler. Consequently, the syntax follows Python's Regular
+ Expression (re) syntax. The expressions are compared against the full
+ paths to the files. For complete syntax information, see Python's
+ documentation at http://docs.python.org/3/library/re.html#re.
+
+ The following example uses a complete regular expression to tell
+ BitBake to ignore all recipe and recipe append files in the
+ ``meta-ti/recipes-misc/`` directory:
+ ::
+
+ BBMASK = "meta-ti/recipes-misc/"
+
+ If you want to mask out multiple directories or recipes, you can
+ specify multiple regular expression fragments. This next example
+ masks out multiple directories and individual recipes: ::
+
+ BBMASK += "/meta-ti/recipes-misc/ meta-ti/recipes-ti/packagegroup/"
+ BBMASK += "/meta-oe/recipes-support/"
+ BBMASK += "/meta-foo/.*/openldap"
+ BBMASK += "opencv.*\.bbappend"
+ BBMASK += "lzma"
+
+ .. note::
+
+ When specifying a directory name, use the trailing slash character
+ to ensure you match just that directory name.
+
+ BBMULTICONFIG
+ Specifies each additional separate configuration when you are
+ building targets with multiple configurations. Use this variable in
+ your ``conf/local.conf`` configuration file. Specify a
+ multiconfigname for each configuration file you are using. For
+ example, the following line specifies three configuration files:
+ ::
+
+ BBMULTICONFIG = "configA configB configC"
+
+ Each configuration file you
+ use must reside in the :term:`Build Directory`
+ ``conf/multiconfig`` directory (e.g.
+ build_directory\ ``/conf/multiconfig/configA.conf``).
+
+ For information on how to use ``BBMULTICONFIG`` in an environment
+ that supports building targets with multiple configurations, see the
+ ":ref:`dev-building-images-for-multiple-targets-using-multiple-configurations`"
+ section in the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual.
+
+ BBPATH
+ Used by BitBake to locate ``.bbclass`` and configuration files. This
+ variable is analogous to the ``PATH`` variable.
+
+ .. note::
+
+ If you run BitBake from a directory outside of the
+ Build Directory
+ , you must be sure to set
+ BBPATH
+ to point to the Build Directory. Set the variable as you would any
+ environment variable and then run BitBake:
+ ::
+
+ $ BBPATH = "build_directory"
+ $ export BBPATH
+ $ bitbake target
+
+
+ BBSERVER
+ If defined in the BitBake environment, ``BBSERVER`` points to the
+ BitBake remote server.
+
+ Use the following format to export the variable to the BitBake
+ environment:
+ ::
+
+ export BBSERVER=localhost:$port
+
+ By default, ``BBSERVER`` also appears in
+ :term:`bitbake:BB_HASHBASE_WHITELIST`.
+ Consequently, ``BBSERVER`` is excluded from checksum and dependency
+ data.
+
+ BINCONFIG
+ When inheriting the
+ :ref:`binconfig-disabled <ref-classes-binconfig-disabled>` class,
+ this variable specifies binary configuration scripts to disable in
+ favor of using ``pkg-config`` to query the information. The
+ ``binconfig-disabled`` class will modify the specified scripts to
+ return an error so that calls to them can be easily found and
+ replaced.
+
+ To add multiple scripts, separate them by spaces. Here is an example
+ from the ``libpng`` recipe:
+ ::
+
+ BINCONFIG = "${bindir}/libpng-config ${bindir}/libpng16-config"
+
+ BINCONFIG_GLOB
+ When inheriting the :ref:`binconfig <ref-classes-binconfig>` class,
+ this variable specifies a wildcard for configuration scripts that
+ need editing. The scripts are edited to correct any paths that have
+ been set up during compilation so that they are correct for use when
+ installed into the sysroot and called by the build processes of other
+ recipes.
+
+ .. note::
+
+ The
+ BINCONFIG_GLOB
+ variable uses
+ shell globbing
+ , which is recognition and expansion of wildcards during pattern
+ matching. Shell globbing is very similar to
+ fnmatch
+ and
+ glob
+ .
+
+ For more information on how this variable works, see
+ ``meta/classes/binconfig.bbclass`` in the :term:`Source Directory`.
+ You can also find general
+ information on the class in the
+ ":ref:`binconfig.bbclass <ref-classes-binconfig>`" section.
+
+ BP
+ The base recipe name and version but without any special recipe name
+ suffix (i.e. ``-native``, ``lib64-``, and so forth). ``BP`` is
+ comprised of the following:
+ ::
+
+ ${BPN}-${PV}
+
+ BPN
+ This variable is a version of the :term:`PN` variable with
+ common prefixes and suffixes removed, such as ``nativesdk-``,
+ ``-cross``, ``-native``, and multilib's ``lib64-`` and ``lib32-``.
+ The exact lists of prefixes and suffixes removed are specified by the
+ :term:`MLPREFIX` and
+ :term:`SPECIAL_PKGSUFFIX` variables,
+ respectively.
+
+ BUGTRACKER
+ Specifies a URL for an upstream bug tracking website for a recipe.
+ The OpenEmbedded build system does not use this variable. Rather, the
+ variable is a useful pointer in case a bug in the software being
+ built needs to be manually reported.
+
+ BUILD_ARCH
+ Specifies the architecture of the build host (e.g. ``i686``). The
+ OpenEmbedded build system sets the value of ``BUILD_ARCH`` from the
+ machine name reported by the ``uname`` command.
+
+ BUILD_AS_ARCH
+ Specifies the architecture-specific assembler flags for the build
+ host. By default, the value of ``BUILD_AS_ARCH`` is empty.
+
+ BUILD_CC_ARCH
+ Specifies the architecture-specific C compiler flags for the build
+ host. By default, the value of ``BUILD_CC_ARCH`` is empty.
+
+ BUILD_CCLD
+ Specifies the linker command to be used for the build host when the C
+ compiler is being used as the linker. By default, ``BUILD_CCLD``
+ points to GCC and passes as arguments the value of
+ :term:`BUILD_CC_ARCH`, assuming
+ ``BUILD_CC_ARCH`` is set.
+
+ BUILD_CFLAGS
+ Specifies the flags to pass to the C compiler when building for the
+ build host. When building in the ``-native`` context,
+ :term:`CFLAGS` is set to the value of this variable by
+ default.
+
+ BUILD_CPPFLAGS
+ Specifies the flags to pass to the C preprocessor (i.e. to both the C
+ and the C++ compilers) when building for the build host. When
+ building in the ``-native`` context, :term:`CPPFLAGS`
+ is set to the value of this variable by default.
+
+ BUILD_CXXFLAGS
+ Specifies the flags to pass to the C++ compiler when building for the
+ build host. When building in the ``-native`` context,
+ :term:`CXXFLAGS` is set to the value of this variable
+ by default.
+
+ BUILD_FC
+ Specifies the Fortran compiler command for the build host. By
+ default, ``BUILD_FC`` points to Gfortran and passes as arguments the
+ value of :term:`BUILD_CC_ARCH`, assuming
+ ``BUILD_CC_ARCH`` is set.
+
+ BUILD_LD
+ Specifies the linker command for the build host. By default,
+ ``BUILD_LD`` points to the GNU linker (ld) and passes as arguments
+ the value of :term:`BUILD_LD_ARCH`, assuming
+ ``BUILD_LD_ARCH`` is set.
+
+ BUILD_LD_ARCH
+ Specifies architecture-specific linker flags for the build host. By
+ default, the value of ``BUILD_LD_ARCH`` is empty.
+
+ BUILD_LDFLAGS
+ Specifies the flags to pass to the linker when building for the build
+ host. When building in the ``-native`` context,
+ :term:`LDFLAGS` is set to the value of this variable
+ by default.
+
+ BUILD_OPTIMIZATION
+ Specifies the optimization flags passed to the C compiler when
+ building for the build host or the SDK. The flags are passed through
+ the :term:`BUILD_CFLAGS` and
+ :term:`BUILDSDK_CFLAGS` default values.
+
+ The default value of the ``BUILD_OPTIMIZATION`` variable is "-O2
+ -pipe".
+
+ BUILD_OS
+ Specifies the operating system in use on the build host (e.g.
+ "linux"). The OpenEmbedded build system sets the value of
+ ``BUILD_OS`` from the OS reported by the ``uname`` command - the
+ first word, converted to lower-case characters.
+
+ BUILD_PREFIX
+ The toolchain binary prefix used for native recipes. The OpenEmbedded
+ build system uses the ``BUILD_PREFIX`` value to set the
+ :term:`TARGET_PREFIX` when building for
+ ``native`` recipes.
+
+ BUILD_STRIP
+ Specifies the command to be used to strip debugging symbols from
+ binaries produced for the build host. By default, ``BUILD_STRIP``
+ points to
+ ``${``\ :term:`BUILD_PREFIX`\ ``}strip``.
+
+ BUILD_SYS
+ Specifies the system, including the architecture and the operating
+ system, to use when building for the build host (i.e. when building
+ ``native`` recipes).
+
+ The OpenEmbedded build system automatically sets this variable based
+ on :term:`BUILD_ARCH`,
+ :term:`BUILD_VENDOR`, and
+ :term:`BUILD_OS`. You do not need to set the
+ ``BUILD_SYS`` variable yourself.
+
+ BUILD_VENDOR
+ Specifies the vendor name to use when building for the build host.
+ The default value is an empty string ("").
+
+ BUILDDIR
+ Points to the location of the :term:`Build Directory`.
+ You can define this directory indirectly through the
+ ````` <#structure-core-script>`__ script by passing in a Build
+ Directory path when you run the script. If you run the script and do
+ not provide a Build Directory path, the ``BUILDDIR`` defaults to
+ ``build`` in the current directory.
+
+ BUILDHISTORY_COMMIT
+ When inheriting the :ref:`buildhistory <ref-classes-buildhistory>`
+ class, this variable specifies whether or not to commit the build
+ history output in a local Git repository. If set to "1", this local
+ repository will be maintained automatically by the ``buildhistory``
+ class and a commit will be created on every build for changes to each
+ top-level subdirectory of the build history output (images, packages,
+ and sdk). If you want to track changes to build history over time,
+ you should set this value to "1".
+
+ By default, the ``buildhistory`` class does not commit the build
+ history output in a local Git repository:
+ ::
+
+ BUILDHISTORY_COMMIT ?= "0"
+
+ BUILDHISTORY_COMMIT_AUTHOR
+ When inheriting the :ref:`buildhistory <ref-classes-buildhistory>`
+ class, this variable specifies the author to use for each Git commit.
+ In order for the ``BUILDHISTORY_COMMIT_AUTHOR`` variable to work, the
+ :term:`BUILDHISTORY_COMMIT` variable must
+ be set to "1".
+
+ Git requires that the value you provide for the
+ ``BUILDHISTORY_COMMIT_AUTHOR`` variable takes the form of "name
+ email@host". Providing an email address or host that is not valid
+ does not produce an error.
+
+ By default, the ``buildhistory`` class sets the variable as follows:
+ ::
+
+ BUILDHISTORY_COMMIT_AUTHOR ?= "buildhistory <buildhistory@${DISTRO}>"
+
+ BUILDHISTORY_DIR
+ When inheriting the :ref:`buildhistory <ref-classes-buildhistory>`
+ class, this variable specifies the directory in which build history
+ information is kept. For more information on how the variable works,
+ see the ``buildhistory.class``.
+
+ By default, the ``buildhistory`` class sets the directory as follows:
+ ::
+
+ BUILDHISTORY_DIR ?= "${TOPDIR}/buildhistory"
+
+ BUILDHISTORY_FEATURES
+ When inheriting the :ref:`buildhistory <ref-classes-buildhistory>`
+ class, this variable specifies the build history features to be
+ enabled. For more information on how build history works, see the
+ ":ref:`dev-manual/dev-manual-common-tasks:maintaining build output quality`"
+ section in the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual.
+
+ You can specify these features in the form of a space-separated list:
+
+ - *image:* Analysis of the contents of images, which includes the
+ list of installed packages among other things.
+
+ - *package:* Analysis of the contents of individual packages.
+
+ - *sdk:* Analysis of the contents of the software development kit
+ (SDK).
+
+ - *task:* Save output file signatures for
+ :ref:`shared state <overview-manual/overview-manual-concepts:shared state cache>`
+ (sstate) tasks.
+ This saves one file per task and lists the SHA-256 checksums for
+ each file staged (i.e. the output of the task).
+
+ By default, the ``buildhistory`` class enables the following
+ features:
+ ::
+
+ BUILDHISTORY_FEATURES ?= "image package sdk"
+
+ BUILDHISTORY_IMAGE_FILES
+ When inheriting the :ref:`buildhistory <ref-classes-buildhistory>`
+ class, this variable specifies a list of paths to files copied from
+ the image contents into the build history directory under an
+ "image-files" directory in the directory for the image, so that you
+ can track the contents of each file. The default is to copy
+ ``/etc/passwd`` and ``/etc/group``, which allows you to monitor for
+ changes in user and group entries. You can modify the list to include
+ any file. Specifying an invalid path does not produce an error.
+ Consequently, you can include files that might not always be present.
+
+ By default, the ``buildhistory`` class provides paths to the
+ following files:
+ ::
+
+ BUILDHISTORY_IMAGE_FILES ?= "/etc/passwd /etc/group"
+
+ BUILDHISTORY_PUSH_REPO
+ When inheriting the :ref:`buildhistory <ref-classes-buildhistory>`
+ class, this variable optionally specifies a remote repository to
+ which build history pushes Git changes. In order for
+ ``BUILDHISTORY_PUSH_REPO`` to work,
+ :term:`BUILDHISTORY_COMMIT` must be set to
+ "1".
+
+ The repository should correspond to a remote address that specifies a
+ repository as understood by Git, or alternatively to a remote name
+ that you have set up manually using ``git remote`` within the local
+ repository.
+
+ By default, the ``buildhistory`` class sets the variable as follows:
+ ::
+
+ BUILDHISTORY_PUSH_REPO ?= ""
+
+ BUILDSDK_CFLAGS
+ Specifies the flags to pass to the C compiler when building for the
+ SDK. When building in the ``nativesdk-`` context,
+ :term:`CFLAGS` is set to the value of this variable by
+ default.
+
+ BUILDSDK_CPPFLAGS
+ Specifies the flags to pass to the C pre-processor (i.e. to both the
+ C and the C++ compilers) when building for the SDK. When building in
+ the ``nativesdk-`` context, :term:`CPPFLAGS` is set
+ to the value of this variable by default.
+
+ BUILDSDK_CXXFLAGS
+ Specifies the flags to pass to the C++ compiler when building for the
+ SDK. When building in the ``nativesdk-`` context,
+ :term:`CXXFLAGS` is set to the value of this variable
+ by default.
+
+ BUILDSDK_LDFLAGS
+ Specifies the flags to pass to the linker when building for the SDK.
+ When building in the ``nativesdk-`` context,
+ :term:`LDFLAGS` is set to the value of this variable
+ by default.
+
+ BUILDSTATS_BASE
+ Points to the location of the directory that holds build statistics
+ when you use and enable the
+ :ref:`buildstats <ref-classes-buildstats>` class. The
+ ``BUILDSTATS_BASE`` directory defaults to
+ ``${``\ :term:`TMPDIR`\ ``}/buildstats/``.
+
+ BUSYBOX_SPLIT_SUID
+ For the BusyBox recipe, specifies whether to split the output
+ executable file into two parts: one for features that require
+ ``setuid root``, and one for the remaining features (i.e. those that
+ do not require ``setuid root``).
+
+ The ``BUSYBOX_SPLIT_SUID`` variable defaults to "1", which results in
+ splitting the output executable file. Set the variable to "0" to get
+ a single output executable file.
+
+ CACHE
+ Specifies the directory BitBake uses to store a cache of the
+ :term:`Metadata` so it does not need to be parsed every time
+ BitBake is started.
+
+ CC
+ The minimal command and arguments used to run the C compiler.
+
+ CFLAGS
+ Specifies the flags to pass to the C compiler. This variable is
+ exported to an environment variable and thus made visible to the
+ software being built during the compilation step.
+
+ Default initialization for ``CFLAGS`` varies depending on what is
+ being built:
+
+ - :term:`TARGET_CFLAGS` when building for the
+ target
+
+ - :term:`BUILD_CFLAGS` when building for the
+ build host (i.e. ``-native``)
+
+ - :term:`BUILDSDK_CFLAGS` when building for
+ an SDK (i.e. ``nativesdk-``)
+
+ CLASSOVERRIDE
+ An internal variable specifying the special class override that
+ should currently apply (e.g. "class-target", "class-native", and so
+ forth). The classes that use this variable (e.g.
+ :ref:`native <ref-classes-native>`,
+ :ref:`nativesdk <ref-classes-nativesdk>`, and so forth) set the
+ variable to appropriate values.
+
+ .. note::
+
+ CLASSOVERRIDE
+ gets its default "class-target" value from the
+ bitbake.conf
+ file.
+
+ As an example, the following override allows you to install extra
+ files, but only when building for the target:
+ ::
+
+ do_install_append_class-target() {
+ install my-extra-file ${D}${sysconfdir}
+ }
+
+ Here is an example where ``FOO`` is set to
+ "native" when building for the build host, and to "other" when not
+ building for the build host:
+ ::
+
+ FOO_class-native = "native"
+ FOO = "other"
+
+ The underlying mechanism behind ``CLASSOVERRIDE`` is simply
+ that it is included in the default value of
+ :term:`OVERRIDES`.
+
+ CLEANBROKEN
+ If set to "1" within a recipe, ``CLEANBROKEN`` specifies that the
+ ``make clean`` command does not work for the software being built.
+ Consequently, the OpenEmbedded build system will not try to run
+ ``make clean`` during the :ref:`ref-tasks-configure`
+ task, which is the default behavior.
+
+ COMBINED_FEATURES
+ Provides a list of hardware features that are enabled in both
+ :term:`MACHINE_FEATURES` and
+ :term:`DISTRO_FEATURES`. This select list of
+ features contains features that make sense to be controlled both at
+ the machine and distribution configuration level. For example, the
+ "bluetooth" feature requires hardware support but should also be
+ optional at the distribution level, in case the hardware supports
+ Bluetooth but you do not ever intend to use it.
+
+ COMMON_LICENSE_DIR
+ Points to ``meta/files/common-licenses`` in the
+ :term:`Source Directory`, which is where generic license
+ files reside.
+
+ COMPATIBLE_HOST
+ A regular expression that resolves to one or more hosts (when the
+ recipe is native) or one or more targets (when the recipe is
+ non-native) with which a recipe is compatible. The regular expression
+ is matched against :term:`HOST_SYS`. You can use the
+ variable to stop recipes from being built for classes of systems with
+ which the recipes are not compatible. Stopping these builds is
+ particularly useful with kernels. The variable also helps to increase
+ parsing speed since the build system skips parsing recipes not
+ compatible with the current system.
+
+ COMPATIBLE_MACHINE
+ A regular expression that resolves to one or more target machines
+ with which a recipe is compatible. The regular expression is matched
+ against :term:`MACHINEOVERRIDES`. You can use
+ the variable to stop recipes from being built for machines with which
+ the recipes are not compatible. Stopping these builds is particularly
+ useful with kernels. The variable also helps to increase parsing
+ speed since the build system skips parsing recipes not compatible
+ with the current machine.
+
+ COMPLEMENTARY_GLOB
+ Defines wildcards to match when installing a list of complementary
+ packages for all the packages explicitly (or implicitly) installed in
+ an image.
+
+ .. note::
+
+ The
+ COMPLEMENTARY_GLOB
+ variable uses Unix filename pattern matching (
+ fnmatch
+ ), which is similar to the Unix style pathname pattern expansion (
+ glob
+ ).
+
+ The resulting list of complementary packages is associated with an
+ item that can be added to
+ :term:`IMAGE_FEATURES`. An example usage of
+ this is the "dev-pkgs" item that when added to ``IMAGE_FEATURES``
+ will install -dev packages (containing headers and other development
+ files) for every package in the image.
+
+ To add a new feature item pointing to a wildcard, use a variable flag
+ to specify the feature item name and use the value to specify the
+ wildcard. Here is an example:
+ ::
+
+ COMPLEMENTARY_GLOB[dev-pkgs] = '*-dev'
+
+ COMPONENTS_DIR
+ Stores sysroot components for each recipe. The OpenEmbedded build
+ system uses ``COMPONENTS_DIR`` when constructing recipe-specific
+ sysroots for other recipes.
+
+ The default is
+ "``${``\ :term:`STAGING_DIR`\ ``}-components``."
+ (i.e.
+ "``${``\ :term:`TMPDIR`\ ``}/sysroots-components``").
+
+ CONF_VERSION
+ Tracks the version of the local configuration file (i.e.
+ ``local.conf``). The value for ``CONF_VERSION`` increments each time
+ ``build/conf/`` compatibility changes.
+
+ CONFFILES
+ Identifies editable or configurable files that are part of a package.
+ If the Package Management System (PMS) is being used to update
+ packages on the target system, it is possible that configuration
+ files you have changed after the original installation and that you
+ now want to remain unchanged are overwritten. In other words,
+ editable files might exist in the package that you do not want reset
+ as part of the package update process. You can use the ``CONFFILES``
+ variable to list the files in the package that you wish to prevent
+ the PMS from overwriting during this update process.
+
+ To use the ``CONFFILES`` variable, provide a package name override
+ that identifies the resulting package. Then, provide a
+ space-separated list of files. Here is an example:
+ ::
+
+ CONFFILES_${PN} += "${sysconfdir}/file1 \
+ ${sysconfdir}/file2 ${sysconfdir}/file3"
+
+ A relationship exists between the ``CONFFILES`` and ``FILES``
+ variables. The files listed within ``CONFFILES`` must be a subset of
+ the files listed within ``FILES``. Because the configuration files
+ you provide with ``CONFFILES`` are simply being identified so that
+ the PMS will not overwrite them, it makes sense that the files must
+ already be included as part of the package through the ``FILES``
+ variable.
+
+ .. note::
+
+ When specifying paths as part of the
+ CONFFILES
+ variable, it is good practice to use appropriate path variables.
+ For example,
+ ${sysconfdir}
+ rather than
+ /etc
+ or
+ ${bindir}
+ rather than
+ /usr/bin
+ . You can find a list of these variables at the top of the
+ meta/conf/bitbake.conf
+ file in the
+ Source Directory
+ .
+
+ CONFIG_INITRAMFS_SOURCE
+ Identifies the initial RAM filesystem (initramfs) source files. The
+ OpenEmbedded build system receives and uses this kernel Kconfig
+ variable as an environment variable. By default, the variable is set
+ to null ("").
+
+ The ``CONFIG_INITRAMFS_SOURCE`` can be either a single cpio archive
+ with a ``.cpio`` suffix or a space-separated list of directories and
+ files for building the initramfs image. A cpio archive should contain
+ a filesystem archive to be used as an initramfs image. Directories
+ should contain a filesystem layout to be included in the initramfs
+ image. Files should contain entries according to the format described
+ by the ``usr/gen_init_cpio`` program in the kernel tree.
+
+ If you specify multiple directories and files, the initramfs image
+ will be the aggregate of all of them.
+
+ For information on creating an initramfs, see the
+ ":ref:`building-an-initramfs-image`" section
+ in the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual.
+
+ CONFIG_SITE
+ A list of files that contains ``autoconf`` test results relevant to
+ the current build. This variable is used by the Autotools utilities
+ when running ``configure``.
+
+ CONFIGURE_FLAGS
+ The minimal arguments for GNU configure.
+
+ CONFLICT_DISTRO_FEATURES
+ When inheriting the
+ :ref:`distro_features_check <ref-classes-distro_features_check>`
+ class, this variable identifies distribution features that would be
+ in conflict should the recipe be built. In other words, if the
+ ``CONFLICT_DISTRO_FEATURES`` variable lists a feature that also
+ appears in ``DISTRO_FEATURES`` within the current configuration, an
+ error occurs and the build stops.
+
+ COPYLEFT_LICENSE_EXCLUDE
+ A space-separated list of licenses to exclude from the source
+ archived by the :ref:`archiver <ref-classes-archiver>` class. In
+ other words, if a license in a recipe's
+ :term:`LICENSE` value is in the value of
+ ``COPYLEFT_LICENSE_EXCLUDE``, then its source is not archived by the
+ class.
+
+ .. note::
+
+ The
+ COPYLEFT_LICENSE_EXCLUDE
+ variable takes precedence over the
+ COPYLEFT_LICENSE_INCLUDE
+ variable.
+
+ The default value, which is "CLOSED Proprietary", for
+ ``COPYLEFT_LICENSE_EXCLUDE`` is set by the
+ :ref:`copyleft_filter <ref-classes-copyleft_filter>` class, which
+ is inherited by the ``archiver`` class.
+
+ COPYLEFT_LICENSE_INCLUDE
+ A space-separated list of licenses to include in the source archived
+ by the :ref:`archiver <ref-classes-archiver>` class. In other
+ words, if a license in a recipe's :term:`LICENSE`
+ value is in the value of ``COPYLEFT_LICENSE_INCLUDE``, then its
+ source is archived by the class.
+
+ The default value is set by the
+ :ref:`copyleft_filter <ref-classes-copyleft_filter>` class, which
+ is inherited by the ``archiver`` class. The default value includes
+ "GPL*", "LGPL*", and "AGPL*".
+
+ COPYLEFT_PN_EXCLUDE
+ A list of recipes to exclude in the source archived by the
+ :ref:`archiver <ref-classes-archiver>` class. The
+ ``COPYLEFT_PN_EXCLUDE`` variable overrides the license inclusion and
+ exclusion caused through the
+ :term:`COPYLEFT_LICENSE_INCLUDE` and
+ :term:`COPYLEFT_LICENSE_EXCLUDE`
+ variables, respectively.
+
+ The default value, which is "" indicating to not explicitly exclude
+ any recipes by name, for ``COPYLEFT_PN_EXCLUDE`` is set by the
+ :ref:`copyleft_filter <ref-classes-copyleft_filter>` class, which
+ is inherited by the ``archiver`` class.
+
+ COPYLEFT_PN_INCLUDE
+ A list of recipes to include in the source archived by the
+ :ref:`archiver <ref-classes-archiver>` class. The
+ ``COPYLEFT_PN_INCLUDE`` variable overrides the license inclusion and
+ exclusion caused through the
+ :term:`COPYLEFT_LICENSE_INCLUDE` and
+ :term:`COPYLEFT_LICENSE_EXCLUDE`
+ variables, respectively.
+
+ The default value, which is "" indicating to not explicitly include
+ any recipes by name, for ``COPYLEFT_PN_INCLUDE`` is set by the
+ :ref:`copyleft_filter <ref-classes-copyleft_filter>` class, which
+ is inherited by the ``archiver`` class.
+
+ COPYLEFT_RECIPE_TYPES
+ A space-separated list of recipe types to include in the source
+ archived by the :ref:`archiver <ref-classes-archiver>` class.
+ Recipe types are ``target``, ``native``, ``nativesdk``, ``cross``,
+ ``crosssdk``, and ``cross-canadian``.
+
+ The default value, which is "target*", for ``COPYLEFT_RECIPE_TYPES``
+ is set by the :ref:`copyleft_filter <ref-classes-copyleft_filter>`
+ class, which is inherited by the ``archiver`` class.
+
+ COPY_LIC_DIRS
+ If set to "1" along with the
+ :term:`COPY_LIC_MANIFEST` variable, the
+ OpenEmbedded build system copies into the image the license files,
+ which are located in ``/usr/share/common-licenses``, for each
+ package. The license files are placed in directories within the image
+ itself during build time.
+
+ .. note::
+
+ The
+ COPY_LIC_DIRS
+ does not offer a path for adding licenses for newly installed
+ packages to an image, which might be most suitable for read-only
+ filesystems that cannot be upgraded. See the
+ LICENSE_CREATE_PACKAGE
+ variable for additional information. You can also reference the "
+ Providing License Text
+ " section in the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual for
+ information on providing license text.
+
+ COPY_LIC_MANIFEST
+ If set to "1", the OpenEmbedded build system copies the license
+ manifest for the image to
+ ``/usr/share/common-licenses/license.manifest`` within the image
+ itself during build time.
+
+ .. note::
+
+ The
+ COPY_LIC_MANIFEST
+ does not offer a path for adding licenses for newly installed
+ packages to an image, which might be most suitable for read-only
+ filesystems that cannot be upgraded. See the
+ LICENSE_CREATE_PACKAGE
+ variable for additional information. You can also reference the "
+ Providing License Text
+ " section in the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual for
+ information on providing license text.
+
+ CORE_IMAGE_EXTRA_INSTALL
+ Specifies the list of packages to be added to the image. You should
+ only set this variable in the ``local.conf`` configuration file found
+ in the :term:`Build Directory`.
+
+ This variable replaces ``POKY_EXTRA_INSTALL``, which is no longer
+ supported.
+
+ COREBASE
+ Specifies the parent directory of the OpenEmbedded-Core Metadata
+ layer (i.e. ``meta``).
+
+ It is an important distinction that ``COREBASE`` points to the parent
+ of this layer and not the layer itself. Consider an example where you
+ have cloned the Poky Git repository and retained the ``poky`` name
+ for your local copy of the repository. In this case, ``COREBASE``
+ points to the ``poky`` folder because it is the parent directory of
+ the ``poky/meta`` layer.
+
+ COREBASE_FILES
+ Lists files from the :term:`COREBASE` directory that
+ should be copied other than the layers listed in the
+ ``bblayers.conf`` file. The ``COREBASE_FILES`` variable exists for
+ the purpose of copying metadata from the OpenEmbedded build system
+ into the extensible SDK.
+
+ Explicitly listing files in ``COREBASE`` is needed because it
+ typically contains build directories and other files that should not
+ normally be copied into the extensible SDK. Consequently, the value
+ of ``COREBASE_FILES`` is used in order to only copy the files that
+ are actually needed.
+
+ CPP
+ The minimal command and arguments used to run the C preprocessor.
+
+ CPPFLAGS
+ Specifies the flags to pass to the C pre-processor (i.e. to both the
+ C and the C++ compilers). This variable is exported to an environment
+ variable and thus made visible to the software being built during the
+ compilation step.
+
+ Default initialization for ``CPPFLAGS`` varies depending on what is
+ being built:
+
+ - :term:`TARGET_CPPFLAGS` when building for
+ the target
+
+ - :term:`BUILD_CPPFLAGS` when building for the
+ build host (i.e. ``-native``)
+
+ - :term:`BUILDSDK_CPPFLAGS` when building
+ for an SDK (i.e. ``nativesdk-``)
+
+ CROSS_COMPILE
+ The toolchain binary prefix for the target tools. The
+ ``CROSS_COMPILE`` variable is the same as the
+ :term:`TARGET_PREFIX` variable.
+
+ .. note::
+
+ The OpenEmbedded build system sets the
+ CROSS_COMPILE
+ variable only in certain contexts (e.g. when building for kernel
+ and kernel module recipes).
+
+ CVSDIR
+ The directory in which files checked out under the CVS system are
+ stored.
+
+ CXX
+ The minimal command and arguments used to run the C++ compiler.
+
+ CXXFLAGS
+ Specifies the flags to pass to the C++ compiler. This variable is
+ exported to an environment variable and thus made visible to the
+ software being built during the compilation step.
+
+ Default initialization for ``CXXFLAGS`` varies depending on what is
+ being built:
+
+ - :term:`TARGET_CXXFLAGS` when building for
+ the target
+
+ - :term:`BUILD_CXXFLAGS` when building for the
+ build host (i.e. ``-native``)
+
+ - :term:`BUILDSDK_CXXFLAGS` when building
+ for an SDK (i.e. ``nativesdk-``)
+
+ D
+ The destination directory. The location in the :term:`Build Directory`
+ where components are installed by the
+ :ref:`ref-tasks-install` task. This location defaults
+ to:
+ ::
+
+ ${WORKDIR}/image
+
+ .. note::
+
+ Tasks that read from or write to this directory should run under
+ fakeroot
+ .
+
+ DATE
+ The date the build was started. Dates appear using the year, month,
+ and day (YMD) format (e.g. "20150209" for February 9th, 2015).
+
+ DATETIME
+ The date and time on which the current build started. The format is
+ suitable for timestamps.
+
+ DEBIAN_NOAUTONAME
+ When the :ref:`debian <ref-classes-debian>` class is inherited,
+ which is the default behavior, ``DEBIAN_NOAUTONAME`` specifies a
+ particular package should not be renamed according to Debian library
+ package naming. You must use the package name as an override when you
+ set this variable. Here is an example from the ``fontconfig`` recipe:
+ ::
+
+ DEBIAN_NOAUTONAME_fontconfig-utils = "1"
+
+ DEBIANNAME
+ When the :ref:`debian <ref-classes-debian>` class is inherited,
+ which is the default behavior, ``DEBIANNAME`` allows you to override
+ the library name for an individual package. Overriding the library
+ name in these cases is rare. You must use the package name as an
+ override when you set this variable. Here is an example from the
+ ``dbus`` recipe:
+ ::
+
+ DEBIANNAME_${PN} = "dbus-1"
+
+ DEBUG_BUILD
+ Specifies to build packages with debugging information. This
+ influences the value of the ``SELECTED_OPTIMIZATION`` variable.
+
+ DEBUG_OPTIMIZATION
+ The options to pass in ``TARGET_CFLAGS`` and ``CFLAGS`` when
+ compiling a system for debugging. This variable defaults to "-O
+ -fno-omit-frame-pointer ${DEBUG_FLAGS} -pipe".
+
+ DEFAULT_PREFERENCE
+ Specifies a weak bias for recipe selection priority.
+
+ The most common usage of this is variable is to set it to "-1" within
+ a recipe for a development version of a piece of software. Using the
+ variable in this way causes the stable version of the recipe to build
+ by default in the absence of ``PREFERRED_VERSION`` being used to
+ build the development version.
+
+ .. note::
+
+ The bias provided by
+ DEFAULT_PREFERENCE
+ is weak and is overridden by
+ BBFILE_PRIORITY
+ if that variable is different between two layers that contain
+ different versions of the same recipe.
+
+ DEFAULTTUNE
+ The default CPU and Application Binary Interface (ABI) tunings (i.e.
+ the "tune") used by the OpenEmbedded build system. The
+ ``DEFAULTTUNE`` helps define
+ :term:`TUNE_FEATURES`.
+
+ The default tune is either implicitly or explicitly set by the
+ machine (:term:`MACHINE`). However, you can override
+ the setting using available tunes as defined with
+ :term:`AVAILTUNES`.
+
+ DEPENDS
+ Lists a recipe's build-time dependencies. These are dependencies on
+ other recipes whose contents (e.g. headers and shared libraries) are
+ needed by the recipe at build time.
+
+ As an example, consider a recipe ``foo`` that contains the following
+ assignment:
+ ::
+
+ DEPENDS = "bar"
+
+ The practical effect of the previous
+ assignment is that all files installed by bar will be available in
+ the appropriate staging sysroot, given by the
+ :term:`STAGING_DIR* <STAGING_DIR>` variables, by the time the
+ :ref:`ref-tasks-configure` task for ``foo`` runs.
+ This mechanism is implemented by having ``do_configure`` depend on
+ the :ref:`ref-tasks-populate_sysroot` task of
+ each recipe listed in ``DEPENDS``, through a
+ ``[``\ :ref:`deptask <bitbake:bitbake-user-manual/bitbake-user-manual-metadata:variable flags>`\ ``]``
+ declaration in the :ref:`base <ref-classes-base>` class.
+
+ .. note::
+
+ It seldom is necessary to reference, for example,
+ STAGING_DIR_HOST
+ explicitly. The standard classes and build-related variables are
+ configured to automatically use the appropriate staging sysroots.
+
+ As another example, ``DEPENDS`` can also be used to add utilities
+ that run on the build machine during the build. For example, a recipe
+ that makes use of a code generator built by the recipe ``codegen``
+ might have the following:
+ ::
+
+ DEPENDS = "codegen-native"
+
+ For more
+ information, see the :ref:`native <ref-classes-native>` class and
+ the :term:`EXTRANATIVEPATH` variable.
+
+ .. note::
+
+ - ``DEPENDS`` is a list of recipe names. Or, to be more precise,
+ it is a list of :term:`PROVIDES` names, which
+ usually match recipe names. Putting a package name such as
+ "foo-dev" in ``DEPENDS`` does not make sense. Use "foo"
+ instead, as this will put files from all the packages that make
+ up ``foo``, which includes those from ``foo-dev``, into the
+ sysroot.
+
+ - One recipe having another recipe in ``DEPENDS`` does not by
+ itself add any runtime dependencies between the packages
+ produced by the two recipes. However, as explained in the
+ ":ref:`overview-manual/overview-manual-concepts:automatically added runtime dependencies`"
+ section in the Yocto Project Overview and Concepts Manual,
+ runtime dependencies will often be added automatically, meaning
+ ``DEPENDS`` alone is sufficient for most recipes.
+
+ - Counterintuitively, ``DEPENDS`` is often necessary even for
+ recipes that install precompiled components. For example, if
+ ``libfoo`` is a precompiled library that links against
+ ``libbar``, then linking against ``libfoo`` requires both
+ ``libfoo`` and ``libbar`` to be available in the sysroot.
+ Without a ``DEPENDS`` from the recipe that installs ``libfoo``
+ to the recipe that installs ``libbar``, other recipes might
+ fail to link against ``libfoo``.
+
+ For information on runtime dependencies, see the
+ :term:`RDEPENDS` variable. You can also see the
+ ":ref:`Tasks <bitbake:bitbake-user-manual/bitbake-user-manual-metadata:tasks>`" and
+ ":ref:`Dependencies <bitbake:bitbake-user-manual/bitbake-user-manual-execution:dependencies>`" sections in the
+ BitBake User Manual for additional information on tasks and
+ dependencies.
+
+ DEPLOY_DIR
+ Points to the general area that the OpenEmbedded build system uses to
+ place images, packages, SDKs, and other output files that are ready
+ to be used outside of the build system. By default, this directory
+ resides within the :term:`Build Directory` as
+ ``${TMPDIR}/deploy``.
+
+ For more information on the structure of the Build Directory, see
+ ":ref:`ref-manual/ref-structure:the build directory - \`\`build/\`\``" section.
+ For more detail on the contents of the ``deploy`` directory, see the
+ ":ref:`Images <images-dev-environment>`", ":ref:`Package
+ Feeds <package-feeds-dev-environment>`", and
+ ":ref:`sdk-dev-environment`" sections all in the
+ Yocto Project Overview and Concepts Manual.
+
+ DEPLOY_DIR_DEB
+ Points to the area that the OpenEmbedded build system uses to place
+ Debian packages that are ready to be used outside of the build
+ system. This variable applies only when
+ :term:`PACKAGE_CLASSES` contains
+ "package_deb".
+
+ The BitBake configuration file initially defines the
+ ``DEPLOY_DIR_DEB`` variable as a sub-folder of
+ :term:`DEPLOY_DIR`:
+ ::
+
+ DEPLOY_DIR_DEB = "${DEPLOY_DIR}/deb"
+
+ The :ref:`package_deb <ref-classes-package_deb>` class uses the
+ ``DEPLOY_DIR_DEB`` variable to make sure the
+ :ref:`ref-tasks-package_write_deb` task
+ writes Debian packages into the appropriate folder. For more
+ information on how packaging works, see the ":ref:`Package
+ Feeds <package-feeds-dev-environment>`" section
+ in the Yocto Project Overview and Concepts Manual.
+
+ DEPLOY_DIR_IMAGE
+ Points to the area that the OpenEmbedded build system uses to place
+ images and other associated output files that are ready to be
+ deployed onto the target machine. The directory is machine-specific
+ as it contains the ``${MACHINE}`` name. By default, this directory
+ resides within the :term:`Build Directory` as
+ ``${DEPLOY_DIR}/images/${MACHINE}/``.
+
+ For more information on the structure of the Build Directory, see
+ ":ref:`ref-manual/ref-structure:the build directory - \`\`build/\`\``" section.
+ For more detail on the contents of the ``deploy`` directory, see the
+ ":ref:`Images <images-dev-environment>`" and
+ ":ref:`sdk-dev-environment`" sections both in
+ the Yocto Project Overview and Concepts Manual.
+
+ DEPLOY_DIR_IPK
+ Points to the area that the OpenEmbedded build system uses to place
+ IPK packages that are ready to be used outside of the build system.
+ This variable applies only when
+ :term:`PACKAGE_CLASSES` contains
+ "package_ipk".
+
+ The BitBake configuration file initially defines this variable as a
+ sub-folder of :term:`DEPLOY_DIR`:
+ ::
+
+ DEPLOY_DIR_IPK = "${DEPLOY_DIR}/ipk"
+
+ The :ref:`package_ipk <ref-classes-package_ipk>` class uses the
+ ``DEPLOY_DIR_IPK`` variable to make sure the
+ :ref:`ref-tasks-package_write_ipk` task
+ writes IPK packages into the appropriate folder. For more information
+ on how packaging works, see the ":ref:`Package
+ Feeds <package-feeds-dev-environment>`" section
+ in the Yocto Project Overview and Concepts Manual.
+
+ DEPLOY_DIR_RPM
+ Points to the area that the OpenEmbedded build system uses to place
+ RPM packages that are ready to be used outside of the build system.
+ This variable applies only when
+ :term:`PACKAGE_CLASSES` contains
+ "package_rpm".
+
+ The BitBake configuration file initially defines this variable as a
+ sub-folder of :term:`DEPLOY_DIR`:
+ ::
+
+ DEPLOY_DIR_RPM = "${DEPLOY_DIR}/rpm"
+
+ The :ref:`package_rpm <ref-classes-package_rpm>` class uses the
+ ``DEPLOY_DIR_RPM`` variable to make sure the
+ :ref:`ref-tasks-package_write_rpm` task
+ writes RPM packages into the appropriate folder. For more information
+ on how packaging works, see the ":ref:`Package
+ Feeds <package-feeds-dev-environment>`" section
+ in the Yocto Project Overview and Concepts Manual.
+
+ DEPLOY_DIR_TAR
+ Points to the area that the OpenEmbedded build system uses to place
+ tarballs that are ready to be used outside of the build system. This
+ variable applies only when
+ :term:`PACKAGE_CLASSES` contains
+ "package_tar".
+
+ The BitBake configuration file initially defines this variable as a
+ sub-folder of :term:`DEPLOY_DIR`:
+ ::
+
+ DEPLOY_DIR_TAR = "${DEPLOY_DIR}/tar"
+
+ The :ref:`package_tar <ref-classes-package_tar>` class uses the
+ ``DEPLOY_DIR_TAR`` variable to make sure the
+ :ref:`ref-tasks-package_write_tar` task
+ writes TAR packages into the appropriate folder. For more information
+ on how packaging works, see the ":ref:`Package
+ Feeds <package-feeds-dev-environment>`" section
+ in the Yocto Project Overview and Concepts Manual.
+
+ DEPLOYDIR
+ When inheriting the :ref:`deploy <ref-classes-deploy>` class, the
+ ``DEPLOYDIR`` points to a temporary work area for deployed files that
+ is set in the ``deploy`` class as follows:
+ ::
+
+ DEPLOYDIR = "${WORKDIR}/deploy-${:term:`PN`}"
+
+ Recipes inheriting the ``deploy`` class should copy files to be
+ deployed into ``DEPLOYDIR``, and the class will take care of copying
+ them into :term:`DEPLOY_DIR_IMAGE`
+ afterwards.
+
+ DESCRIPTION
+ The package description used by package managers. If not set,
+ ``DESCRIPTION`` takes the value of the :term:`SUMMARY`
+ variable.
+
+ DISTRO
+ The short name of the distribution. For information on the long name
+ of the distribution, see the :term:`DISTRO_NAME`
+ variable.
+
+ The ``DISTRO`` variable corresponds to a distribution configuration
+ file whose root name is the same as the variable's argument and whose
+ filename extension is ``.conf``. For example, the distribution
+ configuration file for the Poky distribution is named ``poky.conf``
+ and resides in the ``meta-poky/conf/distro`` directory of the
+ :term:`Source Directory`.
+
+ Within that ``poky.conf`` file, the ``DISTRO`` variable is set as
+ follows:
+ ::
+
+ DISTRO = "poky"
+
+ Distribution configuration files are located in a ``conf/distro``
+ directory within the :term:`Metadata` that contains the
+ distribution configuration. The value for ``DISTRO`` must not contain
+ spaces, and is typically all lower-case.
+
+ .. note::
+
+ If the
+ DISTRO
+ variable is blank, a set of default configurations are used, which
+ are specified within
+ meta/conf/distro/defaultsetup.conf
+ also in the Source Directory.
+
+ DISTRO_CODENAME
+ Specifies a codename for the distribution being built.
+
+ DISTRO_EXTRA_RDEPENDS
+ Specifies a list of distro-specific packages to add to all images.
+ This variable takes affect through ``packagegroup-base`` so the
+ variable only really applies to the more full-featured images that
+ include ``packagegroup-base``. You can use this variable to keep
+ distro policy out of generic images. As with all other distro
+ variables, you set this variable in the distro ``.conf`` file.
+
+ DISTRO_EXTRA_RRECOMMENDS
+ Specifies a list of distro-specific packages to add to all images if
+ the packages exist. The packages might not exist or be empty (e.g.
+ kernel modules). The list of packages are automatically installed but
+ you can remove them.
+
+ DISTRO_FEATURES
+ The software support you want in your distribution for various
+ features. You define your distribution features in the distribution
+ configuration file.
+
+ In most cases, the presence or absence of a feature in
+ ``DISTRO_FEATURES`` is translated to the appropriate option supplied
+ to the configure script during the
+ :ref:`ref-tasks-configure` task for recipes that
+ optionally support the feature. For example, specifying "x11" in
+ ``DISTRO_FEATURES``, causes every piece of software built for the
+ target that can optionally support X11 to have its X11 support
+ enabled.
+
+ Two more examples are Bluetooth and NFS support. For a more complete
+ list of features that ships with the Yocto Project and that you can
+ provide with this variable, see the "`Distro
+ Features <#ref-features-distro>`__" section.
+
+ DISTRO_FEATURES_BACKFILL
+ Features to be added to ``DISTRO_FEATURES`` if not also present in
+ ``DISTRO_FEATURES_BACKFILL_CONSIDERED``.
+
+ This variable is set in the ``meta/conf/bitbake.conf`` file. It is
+ not intended to be user-configurable. It is best to just reference
+ the variable to see which distro features are being backfilled for
+ all distro configurations. See the "`Feature
+ Backfilling <#ref-features-backfill>`__" section for more
+ information.
+
+ DISTRO_FEATURES_BACKFILL_CONSIDERED
+ Features from ``DISTRO_FEATURES_BACKFILL`` that should not be
+ backfilled (i.e. added to ``DISTRO_FEATURES``) during the build. See
+ the "`Feature Backfilling <#ref-features-backfill>`__" section for
+ more information.
+
+ DISTRO_FEATURES_DEFAULT
+ A convenience variable that gives you the default list of distro
+ features with the exception of any features specific to the C library
+ (``libc``).
+
+ When creating a custom distribution, you might find it useful to be
+ able to reuse the default
+ :term:`DISTRO_FEATURES` options without the
+ need to write out the full set. Here is an example that uses
+ ``DISTRO_FEATURES_DEFAULT`` from a custom distro configuration file:
+ ::
+
+ DISTRO_FEATURES ?= "${DISTRO_FEATURES_DEFAULT} myfeature"
+
+ DISTRO_FEATURES_FILTER_NATIVE
+ Specifies a list of features that if present in the target
+ :term:`DISTRO_FEATURES` value should be
+ included in ``DISTRO_FEATURES`` when building native recipes. This
+ variable is used in addition to the features filtered using the
+ :term:`DISTRO_FEATURES_NATIVE`
+ variable.
+
+ DISTRO_FEATURES_FILTER_NATIVESDK
+ Specifies a list of features that if present in the target
+ :term:`DISTRO_FEATURES` value should be
+ included in ``DISTRO_FEATURES`` when building nativesdk recipes. This
+ variable is used in addition to the features filtered using the
+ :term:`DISTRO_FEATURES_NATIVESDK`
+ variable.
+
+ DISTRO_FEATURES_NATIVE
+ Specifies a list of features that should be included in
+ :term:`DISTRO_FEATURES` when building native
+ recipes. This variable is used in addition to the features filtered
+ using the
+ :term:`DISTRO_FEATURES_FILTER_NATIVE`
+ variable.
+
+ DISTRO_FEATURES_NATIVESDK
+ Specifies a list of features that should be included in
+ :term:`DISTRO_FEATURES` when building
+ nativesdk recipes. This variable is used in addition to the features
+ filtered using the
+ :term:`DISTRO_FEATURES_FILTER_NATIVESDK`
+ variable.
+
+ DISTRO_NAME
+ The long name of the distribution. For information on the short name
+ of the distribution, see the :term:`DISTRO` variable.
+
+ The ``DISTRO_NAME`` variable corresponds to a distribution
+ configuration file whose root name is the same as the variable's
+ argument and whose filename extension is ``.conf``. For example, the
+ distribution configuration file for the Poky distribution is named
+ ``poky.conf`` and resides in the ``meta-poky/conf/distro`` directory
+ of the :term:`Source Directory`.
+
+ Within that ``poky.conf`` file, the ``DISTRO_NAME`` variable is set
+ as follows:
+ ::
+
+ DISTRO_NAME = "Poky (Yocto Project Reference Distro)"
+
+ Distribution configuration files are located in a ``conf/distro``
+ directory within the :term:`Metadata` that contains the
+ distribution configuration.
+
+ .. note::
+
+ If the
+ DISTRO_NAME
+ variable is blank, a set of default configurations are used, which
+ are specified within
+ meta/conf/distro/defaultsetup.conf
+ also in the Source Directory.
+
+ DISTRO_VERSION
+ The version of the distribution.
+
+ DISTROOVERRIDES
+ A colon-separated list of overrides specific to the current
+ distribution. By default, this list includes the value of
+ :term:`DISTRO`.
+
+ You can extend ``DISTROOVERRIDES`` to add extra overrides that should
+ apply to the distribution.
+
+ The underlying mechanism behind ``DISTROOVERRIDES`` is simply that it
+ is included in the default value of
+ :term:`OVERRIDES`.
+
+ DL_DIR
+ The central download directory used by the build process to store
+ downloads. By default, ``DL_DIR`` gets files suitable for mirroring
+ for everything except Git repositories. If you want tarballs of Git
+ repositories, use the
+ :term:`BB_GENERATE_MIRROR_TARBALLS`
+ variable.
+
+ You can set this directory by defining the ``DL_DIR`` variable in the
+ ``conf/local.conf`` file. This directory is self-maintaining and you
+ should not have to touch it. By default, the directory is
+ ``downloads`` in the :term:`Build Directory`.
+ ::
+
+ #DL_DIR ?= "${TOPDIR}/downloads"
+
+ To specify a different download directory,
+ simply remove the comment from the line and provide your directory.
+
+ During a first build, the system downloads many different source code
+ tarballs from various upstream projects. Downloading can take a
+ while, particularly if your network connection is slow. Tarballs are
+ all stored in the directory defined by ``DL_DIR`` and the build
+ system looks there first to find source tarballs.
+
+ .. note::
+
+ When wiping and rebuilding, you can preserve this directory to
+ speed up this part of subsequent builds.
+
+ You can safely share this directory between multiple builds on the
+ same development machine. For additional information on how the build
+ process gets source files when working behind a firewall or proxy
+ server, see this specific question in the
+ "`FAQ <#how-does-the-yocto-project-obtain-source-code-and-will-it-work-behind-my-firewall-or-proxy-server>`__"
+ chapter. You can also refer to the
+ ":yocto_wiki:`Working Behind a Network Proxy </wiki/Working_Behind_a_Network_Proxy>`"
+ Wiki page.
+
+ DOC_COMPRESS
+ When inheriting the :ref:`compress_doc <ref-classes-compress_doc>`
+ class, this variable sets the compression policy used when the
+ OpenEmbedded build system compresses man pages and info pages. By
+ default, the compression method used is gz (gzip). Other policies
+ available are xz and bz2.
+
+ For information on policies and on how to use this variable, see the
+ comments in the ``meta/classes/compress_doc.bbclass`` file.
+
+ EFI_PROVIDER
+ When building bootable images (i.e. where ``hddimg``, ``iso``, or
+ ``wic.vmdk`` is in :term:`IMAGE_FSTYPES`), the
+ ``EFI_PROVIDER`` variable specifies the EFI bootloader to use. The
+ default is "grub-efi", but "systemd-boot" can be used instead.
+
+ See the :ref:`systemd-boot <ref-classes-systemd-boot>` and
+ :ref:`image-live <ref-classes-image-live>` classes for more
+ information.
+
+ ENABLE_BINARY_LOCALE_GENERATION
+ Variable that controls which locales for ``glibc`` are generated
+ during the build (useful if the target device has 64Mbytes of RAM or
+ less).
+
+ ERR_REPORT_DIR
+ When used with the :ref:`report-error <ref-classes-report-error>`
+ class, specifies the path used for storing the debug files created by
+ the :ref:`error reporting
+ tool <dev-manual/dev-manual-common-tasks:using the error reporting tool>`, which
+ allows you to submit build errors you encounter to a central
+ database. By default, the value of this variable is
+ ``${``\ :term:`LOG_DIR`\ ``}/error-report``.
+
+ You can set ``ERR_REPORT_DIR`` to the path you want the error
+ reporting tool to store the debug files as follows in your
+ ``local.conf`` file:
+ ::
+
+ ERR_REPORT_DIR = "path"
+
+ ERROR_QA
+ Specifies the quality assurance checks whose failures are reported as
+ errors by the OpenEmbedded build system. You set this variable in
+ your distribution configuration file. For a list of the checks you
+ can control with this variable, see the
+ ":ref:`insane.bbclass <ref-classes-insane>`" section.
+
+ EXCLUDE_FROM_SHLIBS
+ Triggers the OpenEmbedded build system's shared libraries resolver to
+ exclude an entire package when scanning for shared libraries.
+
+ .. note::
+
+ The shared libraries resolver's functionality results in part from
+ the internal function
+ package_do_shlibs
+ , which is part of the
+ do_package
+ task. You should be aware that the shared libraries resolver might
+ implicitly define some dependencies between packages.
+
+ The ``EXCLUDE_FROM_SHLIBS`` variable is similar to the
+ :term:`PRIVATE_LIBS` variable, which excludes a
+ package's particular libraries only and not the whole package.
+
+ Use the ``EXCLUDE_FROM_SHLIBS`` variable by setting it to "1" for a
+ particular package:
+ ::
+
+ EXCLUDE_FROM_SHLIBS = "1"
+
+ EXCLUDE_FROM_WORLD
+ Directs BitBake to exclude a recipe from world builds (i.e.
+ ``bitbake world``). During world builds, BitBake locates, parses and
+ builds all recipes found in every layer exposed in the
+ ``bblayers.conf`` configuration file.
+
+ To exclude a recipe from a world build using this variable, set the
+ variable to "1" in the recipe.
+
+ .. note::
+
+ Recipes added to
+ EXCLUDE_FROM_WORLD
+ may still be built during a world build in order to satisfy
+ dependencies of other recipes. Adding a recipe to
+ EXCLUDE_FROM_WORLD
+ only ensures that the recipe is not explicitly added to the list
+ of build targets in a world build.
+
+ EXTENDPE
+ Used with file and pathnames to create a prefix for a recipe's
+ version based on the recipe's :term:`PE` value. If ``PE``
+ is set and greater than zero for a recipe, ``EXTENDPE`` becomes that
+ value (e.g if ``PE`` is equal to "1" then ``EXTENDPE`` becomes "1").
+ If a recipe's ``PE`` is not set (the default) or is equal to zero,
+ ``EXTENDPE`` becomes "".
+
+ See the :term:`STAMP` variable for an example.
+
+ EXTENDPKGV
+ The full package version specification as it appears on the final
+ packages produced by a recipe. The variable's value is normally used
+ to fix a runtime dependency to the exact same version of another
+ package in the same recipe:
+ ::
+
+ RDEPENDS_${PN}-additional-module = "${PN} (= ${EXTENDPKGV})"
+
+ The dependency relationships are intended to force the package
+ manager to upgrade these types of packages in lock-step.
+
+ EXTERNAL_KERNEL_TOOLS
+ When set, the ``EXTERNAL_KERNEL_TOOLS`` variable indicates that these
+ tools are not in the source tree.
+
+ When kernel tools are available in the tree, they are preferred over
+ any externally installed tools. Setting the ``EXTERNAL_KERNEL_TOOLS``
+ variable tells the OpenEmbedded build system to prefer the installed
+ external tools. See the
+ :ref:`kernel-yocto <ref-classes-kernel-yocto>` class in
+ ``meta/classes`` to see how the variable is used.
+
+ EXTERNALSRC
+ When inheriting the :ref:`externalsrc <ref-classes-externalsrc>`
+ class, this variable points to the source tree, which is outside of
+ the OpenEmbedded build system. When set, this variable sets the
+ :term:`S` variable, which is what the OpenEmbedded build
+ system uses to locate unpacked recipe source code.
+
+ For more information on ``externalsrc.bbclass``, see the
+ ":ref:`externalsrc.bbclass <ref-classes-externalsrc>`" section. You
+ can also find information on how to use this variable in the
+ ":ref:`dev-manual/dev-manual-common-tasks:building software from an external source`"
+ section in the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual.
+
+ EXTERNALSRC_BUILD
+ When inheriting the :ref:`externalsrc <ref-classes-externalsrc>`
+ class, this variable points to the directory in which the recipe's
+ source code is built, which is outside of the OpenEmbedded build
+ system. When set, this variable sets the :term:`B` variable,
+ which is what the OpenEmbedded build system uses to locate the Build
+ Directory.
+
+ For more information on ``externalsrc.bbclass``, see the
+ ":ref:`externalsrc.bbclass <ref-classes-externalsrc>`" section. You
+ can also find information on how to use this variable in the
+ ":ref:`dev-manual/dev-manual-common-tasks:building software from an external source`"
+ section in the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual.
+
+ EXTRA_AUTORECONF
+ For recipes inheriting the :ref:`autotools <ref-classes-autotools>`
+ class, you can use ``EXTRA_AUTORECONF`` to specify extra options to
+ pass to the ``autoreconf`` command that is executed during the
+ :ref:`ref-tasks-configure` task.
+
+ The default value is "--exclude=autopoint".
+
+ EXTRA_IMAGE_FEATURES
+ A list of additional features to include in an image. When listing
+ more than one feature, separate them with a space.
+
+ Typically, you configure this variable in your ``local.conf`` file,
+ which is found in the :term:`Build Directory`.
+ Although you can use this variable from within a recipe, best
+ practices dictate that you do not.
+
+ .. note::
+
+ To enable primary features from within the image recipe, use the
+ IMAGE_FEATURES
+ variable.
+
+ Here are some examples of features you can add:
+
+ - "dbg-pkgs" - Adds -dbg packages for all installed packages including
+ symbol information for debugging and profiling.
+
+ - "debug-tweaks" - Makes an image suitable for debugging. For example, allows root logins without passwords and
+ enables post-installation logging. See the 'allow-empty-password' and
+ 'post-install-logging' features in the "`Image
+ Features <#ref-features-image>`__" section for more information.
+ - "dev-pkgs" - Adds -dev packages for all installed packages. This is
+ useful if you want to develop against the libraries in the image.
+ - "read-only-rootfs" - Creates an image whose root filesystem is
+ read-only. See the
+ ":ref:`dev-manual/dev-manual-common-tasks:creating a read-only root filesystem`"
+ section in the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual for more
+ information
+ - "tools-debug" - Adds debugging tools such as gdb and strace.
+ - "tools-sdk" - Adds development tools such as gcc, make,
+ pkgconfig and so forth.
+ - "tools-testapps" - Adds useful testing tools
+ such as ts_print, aplay, arecord and so forth.
+
+ For a complete list of image features that ships with the Yocto
+ Project, see the "`Image Features <#ref-features-image>`__" section.
+
+ For an example that shows how to customize your image by using this
+ variable, see the ":ref:`usingpoky-extend-customimage-imagefeatures`"
+ section in the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual.
+
+ EXTRA_IMAGECMD
+ Specifies additional options for the image creation command that has
+ been specified in :term:`IMAGE_CMD`. When setting
+ this variable, use an override for the associated image type. Here is
+ an example:
+ ::
+
+ EXTRA_IMAGECMD_ext3 ?= "-i 4096"
+
+ EXTRA_IMAGEDEPENDS
+ A list of recipes to build that do not provide packages for
+ installing into the root filesystem.
+
+ Sometimes a recipe is required to build the final image but is not
+ needed in the root filesystem. You can use the ``EXTRA_IMAGEDEPENDS``
+ variable to list these recipes and thus specify the dependencies. A
+ typical example is a required bootloader in a machine configuration.
+
+ .. note::
+
+ To add packages to the root filesystem, see the various
+ \*RDEPENDS and \*RRECOMMENDS
+ variables.
+
+ EXTRANATIVEPATH
+ A list of subdirectories of
+ ``${``\ :term:`STAGING_BINDIR_NATIVE`\ ``}``
+ added to the beginning of the environment variable ``PATH``. As an
+ example, the following prepends
+ "${STAGING_BINDIR_NATIVE}/foo:${STAGING_BINDIR_NATIVE}/bar:" to
+ ``PATH``:
+ ::
+
+ EXTRANATIVEPATH = "foo bar"
+
+ EXTRA_OECMAKE
+ Additional `CMake <https://cmake.org/overview/>`__ options. See the
+ :ref:`cmake <ref-classes-cmake>` class for additional information.
+
+ EXTRA_OECONF
+ Additional ``configure`` script options. See
+ :term:`PACKAGECONFIG_CONFARGS` for
+ additional information on passing configure script options.
+
+ EXTRA_OEMAKE
+ Additional GNU ``make`` options.
+
+ Because the ``EXTRA_OEMAKE`` defaults to "", you need to set the
+ variable to specify any required GNU options.
+
+ :term:`PARALLEL_MAKE` and
+ :term:`PARALLEL_MAKEINST` also make use of
+ ``EXTRA_OEMAKE`` to pass the required flags.
+
+ EXTRA_OESCONS
+ When inheriting the :ref:`scons <ref-classes-scons>` class, this
+ variable specifies additional configuration options you want to pass
+ to the ``scons`` command line.
+
+ EXTRA_USERS_PARAMS
+ When inheriting the :ref:`extrausers <ref-classes-extrausers>`
+ class, this variable provides image level user and group operations.
+ This is a more global method of providing user and group
+ configuration as compared to using the
+ :ref:`useradd <ref-classes-useradd>` class, which ties user and
+ group configurations to a specific recipe.
+
+ The set list of commands you can configure using the
+ ``EXTRA_USERS_PARAMS`` is shown in the ``extrausers`` class. These
+ commands map to the normal Unix commands of the same names:
+ ::
+
+ # EXTRA_USERS_PARAMS = "\
+ # useradd -p '' tester; \
+ # groupadd developers; \
+ # userdel nobody; \
+ # groupdel -g video; \
+ # groupmod -g 1020 developers; \
+ # usermod -s /bin/sh tester; \
+ # "
+
+ FEATURE_PACKAGES
+ Defines one or more packages to include in an image when a specific
+ item is included in :term:`IMAGE_FEATURES`.
+ When setting the value, ``FEATURE_PACKAGES`` should have the name of
+ the feature item as an override. Here is an example:
+ ::
+
+ FEATURE_PACKAGES_widget = "package1 package2"
+
+ In this example, if "widget" were added to ``IMAGE_FEATURES``,
+ package1 and package2 would be included in the image.
+
+ .. note::
+
+ Packages installed by features defined through
+ FEATURE_PACKAGES
+ are often package groups. While similarly named, you should not
+ confuse the
+ FEATURE_PACKAGES
+ variable with package groups, which are discussed elsewhere in the
+ documentation.
+
+ FEED_DEPLOYDIR_BASE_URI
+ Points to the base URL of the server and location within the
+ document-root that provides the metadata and packages required by
+ OPKG to support runtime package management of IPK packages. You set
+ this variable in your ``local.conf`` file.
+
+ Consider the following example:
+ ::
+
+ FEED_DEPLOYDIR_BASE_URI = "http://192.168.7.1/BOARD-dir"
+
+ This example assumes you are serving
+ your packages over HTTP and your databases are located in a directory
+ named ``BOARD-dir``, which is underneath your HTTP server's
+ document-root. In this case, the OpenEmbedded build system generates
+ a set of configuration files for you in your target that work with
+ the feed.
+
+ FILES
+ The list of files and directories that are placed in a package. The
+ :term:`PACKAGES` variable lists the packages
+ generated by a recipe.
+
+ To use the ``FILES`` variable, provide a package name override that
+ identifies the resulting package. Then, provide a space-separated
+ list of files or paths that identify the files you want included as
+ part of the resulting package. Here is an example:
+ ::
+
+ FILES_${PN} += "${bindir}/mydir1 ${bindir}/mydir2/myfile"
+
+ .. note::
+
+ - When specifying files or paths, you can pattern match using
+ Python's
+ `glob <https://docs.python.org/3/library/glob.html>`_
+ syntax. For details on the syntax, see the documentation by
+ following the previous link.
+
+ - When specifying paths as part of the ``FILES`` variable, it is
+ good practice to use appropriate path variables. For example,
+ use ``${sysconfdir}`` rather than ``/etc``, or ``${bindir}``
+ rather than ``/usr/bin``. You can find a list of these
+ variables at the top of the ``meta/conf/bitbake.conf`` file in
+ the :term:`Source Directory`. You will also
+ find the default values of the various ``FILES_*`` variables in
+ this file.
+
+ If some of the files you provide with the ``FILES`` variable are
+ editable and you know they should not be overwritten during the
+ package update process by the Package Management System (PMS), you
+ can identify these files so that the PMS will not overwrite them. See
+ the :term:`CONFFILES` variable for information on
+ how to identify these files to the PMS.
+
+ FILES_SOLIBSDEV
+ Defines the file specification to match
+ :term:`SOLIBSDEV`. In other words,
+ ``FILES_SOLIBSDEV`` defines the full path name of the development
+ symbolic link (symlink) for shared libraries on the target platform.
+
+ The following statement from the ``bitbake.conf`` shows how it is
+ set:
+ ::
+
+ FILES_SOLIBSDEV ?= "${base_libdir}/lib*${SOLIBSDEV} ${libdir}/lib*${SOLIBSDEV}"
+
+ FILESEXTRAPATHS
+ Extends the search path the OpenEmbedded build system uses when
+ looking for files and patches as it processes recipes and append
+ files. The default directories BitBake uses when it processes recipes
+ are initially defined by the :term:`FILESPATH`
+ variable. You can extend ``FILESPATH`` variable by using
+ ``FILESEXTRAPATHS``.
+
+ Best practices dictate that you accomplish this by using
+ ``FILESEXTRAPATHS`` from within a ``.bbappend`` file and that you
+ prepend paths as follows:
+ ::
+
+ FILESEXTRAPATHS_prepend := "${THISDIR}/${PN}:"
+
+ In the above example, the build system first
+ looks for files in a directory that has the same name as the
+ corresponding append file.
+
+ .. note::
+
+ When extending ``FILESEXTRAPATHS``, be sure to use the immediate
+ expansion (``:=``) operator. Immediate expansion makes sure that
+ BitBake evaluates :term:`THISDIR` at the time the
+ directive is encountered rather than at some later time when
+ expansion might result in a directory that does not contain the
+ files you need.
+
+ Also, include the trailing separating colon character if you are
+ prepending. The trailing colon character is necessary because you
+ are directing BitBake to extend the path by prepending directories
+ to the search path.
+
+ Here is another common use:
+ ::
+
+ FILESEXTRAPATHS_prepend := "${THISDIR}/files:"
+
+ In this example, the build system extends the
+ ``FILESPATH`` variable to include a directory named ``files`` that is
+ in the same directory as the corresponding append file.
+
+ This next example specifically adds three paths:
+ ::
+
+ FILESEXTRAPATHS_prepend := "path_1:path_2:path_3:"
+
+ A final example shows how you can extend the search path and include
+ a :term:`MACHINE`-specific override, which is useful
+ in a BSP layer:
+ ::
+
+ FILESEXTRAPATHS_prepend_intel-x86-common := "${THISDIR}/${PN}:"
+
+ The previous statement appears in the
+ ``linux-yocto-dev.bbappend`` file, which is found in the
+ :ref:`overview-manual/overview-manual-development-environment:yocto project source repositories` in
+ ``meta-intel/common/recipes-kernel/linux``. Here, the machine
+ override is a special :term:`PACKAGE_ARCH`
+ definition for multiple ``meta-intel`` machines.
+
+ .. note::
+
+ For a layer that supports a single BSP, the override could just be
+ the value of
+ MACHINE
+ .
+
+ By prepending paths in ``.bbappend`` files, you allow multiple append
+ files that reside in different layers but are used for the same
+ recipe to correctly extend the path.
+
+ FILESOVERRIDES
+ A subset of :term:`OVERRIDES` used by the
+ OpenEmbedded build system for creating
+ :term:`FILESPATH`. The ``FILESOVERRIDES`` variable
+ uses overrides to automatically extend the
+ :term:`FILESPATH` variable. For an example of how
+ that works, see the :term:`FILESPATH` variable
+ description. Additionally, you find more information on how overrides
+ are handled in the
+ ":ref:`bitbake:bitbake-user-manual/bitbake-user-manual-metadata:conditional syntax (overrides)`"
+ section of the BitBake User Manual.
+
+ By default, the ``FILESOVERRIDES`` variable is defined as:
+ ::
+
+ FILESOVERRIDES = "${TRANSLATED_TARGET_ARCH}:${MACHINEOVERRIDES}:${DISTROOVERRIDES}"
+
+ .. note::
+
+ Do not hand-edit the
+ FILESOVERRIDES
+ variable. The values match up with expected overrides and are used
+ in an expected manner by the build system.
+
+ FILESPATH
+ The default set of directories the OpenEmbedded build system uses
+ when searching for patches and files.
+
+ During the build process, BitBake searches each directory in
+ ``FILESPATH`` in the specified order when looking for files and
+ patches specified by each ``file://`` URI in a recipe's
+ :term:`SRC_URI` statements.
+
+ The default value for the ``FILESPATH`` variable is defined in the
+ ``base.bbclass`` class found in ``meta/classes`` in the
+ :term:`Source Directory`:
+ ::
+
+ FILESPATH = "${@base_set_filespath(["${FILE_DIRNAME}/${BP}", \
+ "${FILE_DIRNAME}/${BPN}", "${FILE_DIRNAME}/files"], d)}"
+
+ The
+ ``FILESPATH`` variable is automatically extended using the overrides
+ from the :term:`FILESOVERRIDES` variable.
+
+ .. note::
+
+ - Do not hand-edit the ``FILESPATH`` variable. If you want the
+ build system to look in directories other than the defaults,
+ extend the ``FILESPATH`` variable by using the
+ :term:`FILESEXTRAPATHS` variable.
+
+ - Be aware that the default ``FILESPATH`` directories do not map
+ to directories in custom layers where append files
+ (``.bbappend``) are used. If you want the build system to find
+ patches or files that reside with your append files, you need
+ to extend the ``FILESPATH`` variable by using the
+ ``FILESEXTRAPATHS`` variable.
+
+ You can take advantage of this searching behavior in useful ways. For
+ example, consider a case where the following directory structure
+ exists for general and machine-specific configurations:
+ ::
+
+ files/defconfig
+ files/MACHINEA/defconfig
+ files/MACHINEB/defconfig
+
+ Also in the example, the ``SRC_URI`` statement contains
+ "file://defconfig". Given this scenario, you can set
+ :term:`MACHINE` to "MACHINEA" and cause the build
+ system to use files from ``files/MACHINEA``. Set ``MACHINE`` to
+ "MACHINEB" and the build system uses files from ``files/MACHINEB``.
+ Finally, for any machine other than "MACHINEA" and "MACHINEB", the
+ build system uses files from ``files/defconfig``.
+
+ You can find out more about the patching process in the
+ ":ref:`patching-dev-environment`" section
+ in the Yocto Project Overview and Concepts Manual and the
+ ":ref:`new-recipe-patching-code`" section in
+ the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual. See the
+ :ref:`ref-tasks-patch` task as well.
+
+ FILESYSTEM_PERMS_TABLES
+ Allows you to define your own file permissions settings table as part
+ of your configuration for the packaging process. For example, suppose
+ you need a consistent set of custom permissions for a set of groups
+ and users across an entire work project. It is best to do this in the
+ packages themselves but this is not always possible.
+
+ By default, the OpenEmbedded build system uses the ``fs-perms.txt``,
+ which is located in the ``meta/files`` folder in the :term:`Source Directory`.
+ If you create your own file
+ permissions setting table, you should place it in your layer or the
+ distro's layer.
+
+ You define the ``FILESYSTEM_PERMS_TABLES`` variable in the
+ ``conf/local.conf`` file, which is found in the :term:`Build Directory`,
+ to point to your custom
+ ``fs-perms.txt``. You can specify more than a single file permissions
+ setting table. The paths you specify to these files must be defined
+ within the :term:`BBPATH` variable.
+
+ For guidance on how to create your own file permissions settings
+ table file, examine the existing ``fs-perms.txt``.
+
+ FIT_HASH_ALG
+ Specifies the hash algorithm used in creating the FIT Image. For e.g. sha256.
+
+ FIT_SIGN_ALG
+ Specifies the signature algorithm used in creating the FIT Image.
+ For e.g. rsa2048.
+
+ FONT_EXTRA_RDEPENDS
+ When inheriting the :ref:`fontcache <ref-classes-fontcache>` class,
+ this variable specifies the runtime dependencies for font packages.
+ By default, the ``FONT_EXTRA_RDEPENDS`` is set to "fontconfig-utils".
+
+ FONT_PACKAGES
+ When inheriting the :ref:`fontcache <ref-classes-fontcache>` class,
+ this variable identifies packages containing font files that need to
+ be cached by Fontconfig. By default, the ``fontcache`` class assumes
+ that fonts are in the recipe's main package (i.e.
+ ``${``\ :term:`PN`\ ``}``). Use this variable if fonts you
+ need are in a package other than that main package.
+
+ FORCE_RO_REMOVE
+ Forces the removal of the packages listed in ``ROOTFS_RO_UNNEEDED``
+ during the generation of the root filesystem.
+
+ Set the variable to "1" to force the removal of these packages.
+
+ FULL_OPTIMIZATION
+ The options to pass in ``TARGET_CFLAGS`` and ``CFLAGS`` when
+ compiling an optimized system. This variable defaults to "-O2 -pipe
+ ${DEBUG_FLAGS}".
+
+ GCCPIE
+ Enables Position Independent Executables (PIE) within the GNU C
+ Compiler (GCC). Enabling PIE in the GCC makes Return Oriented
+ Programming (ROP) attacks much more difficult to execute.
+
+ By default the ``security_flags.inc`` file enables PIE by setting the
+ variable as follows:
+ ::
+
+ GCCPIE ?= "--enable-default-pie"
+
+ GCCVERSION
+ Specifies the default version of the GNU C Compiler (GCC) used for
+ compilation. By default, ``GCCVERSION`` is set to "8.x" in the
+ ``meta/conf/distro/include/tcmode-default.inc`` include file:
+ ::
+
+ GCCVERSION ?= "8.%"
+
+ You can override this value by setting it in a
+ configuration file such as the ``local.conf``.
+
+ GDB
+ The minimal command and arguments to run the GNU Debugger.
+
+ GITDIR
+ The directory in which a local copy of a Git repository is stored
+ when it is cloned.
+
+ GLIBC_GENERATE_LOCALES
+ Specifies the list of GLIBC locales to generate should you not wish
+ to generate all LIBC locals, which can be time consuming.
+
+ .. note::
+
+ If you specifically remove the locale
+ en_US.UTF-8
+ , you must set
+ IMAGE_LINGUAS
+ appropriately.
+
+ You can set ``GLIBC_GENERATE_LOCALES`` in your ``local.conf`` file.
+ By default, all locales are generated.
+ ::
+
+ GLIBC_GENERATE_LOCALES = "en_GB.UTF-8 en_US.UTF-8"
+
+ GROUPADD_PARAM
+ When inheriting the :ref:`useradd <ref-classes-useradd>` class,
+ this variable specifies for a package what parameters should be
+ passed to the ``groupadd`` command if you wish to add a group to the
+ system when the package is installed.
+
+ Here is an example from the ``dbus`` recipe:
+ ::
+
+ GROUPADD_PARAM_${PN} = "-r netdev"
+
+ For information on the standard Linux shell command
+ ``groupadd``, see http://linux.die.net/man/8/groupadd.
+
+ GROUPMEMS_PARAM
+ When inheriting the :ref:`useradd <ref-classes-useradd>` class,
+ this variable specifies for a package what parameters should be
+ passed to the ``groupmems`` command if you wish to modify the members
+ of a group when the package is installed.
+
+ For information on the standard Linux shell command ``groupmems``,
+ see http://linux.die.net/man/8/groupmems.
+
+ GRUB_GFXSERIAL
+ Configures the GNU GRand Unified Bootloader (GRUB) to have graphics
+ and serial in the boot menu. Set this variable to "1" in your
+ ``local.conf`` or distribution configuration file to enable graphics
+ and serial in the menu.
+
+ See the :ref:`grub-efi <ref-classes-grub-efi>` class for more
+ information on how this variable is used.
+
+ GRUB_OPTS
+ Additional options to add to the GNU GRand Unified Bootloader (GRUB)
+ configuration. Use a semi-colon character (``;``) to separate
+ multiple options.
+
+ The ``GRUB_OPTS`` variable is optional. See the
+ :ref:`grub-efi <ref-classes-grub-efi>` class for more information
+ on how this variable is used.
+
+ GRUB_TIMEOUT
+ Specifies the timeout before executing the default ``LABEL`` in the
+ GNU GRand Unified Bootloader (GRUB).
+
+ The ``GRUB_TIMEOUT`` variable is optional. See the
+ :ref:`grub-efi <ref-classes-grub-efi>` class for more information
+ on how this variable is used.
+
+ GTKIMMODULES_PACKAGES
+ When inheriting the
+ :ref:`gtk-immodules-cache <ref-classes-gtk-immodules-cache>` class,
+ this variable specifies the packages that contain the GTK+ input
+ method modules being installed when the modules are in packages other
+ than the main package.
+
+ HOMEPAGE
+ Website where more information about the software the recipe is
+ building can be found.
+
+ HOST_ARCH
+ The name of the target architecture, which is normally the same as
+ :term:`TARGET_ARCH`. The OpenEmbedded build system
+ supports many architectures. Here is an example list of architectures
+ supported. This list is by no means complete as the architecture is
+ configurable:
+
+ - arm
+ - i586
+ - x86_64
+ - powerpc
+ - powerpc64
+ - mips
+ - mipsel
+
+ HOST_CC_ARCH
+ Specifies architecture-specific compiler flags that are passed to the
+ C compiler.
+
+ Default initialization for ``HOST_CC_ARCH`` varies depending on what
+ is being built:
+
+ - :term:`TARGET_CC_ARCH` when building for the
+ target
+
+ - ``BUILD_CC_ARCH`` when building for the build host (i.e.
+ ``-native``)
+
+ - ``BUILDSDK_CC_ARCH`` when building for an SDK (i.e.
+ ``nativesdk-``)
+
+ HOST_OS
+ Specifies the name of the target operating system, which is normally
+ the same as the :term:`TARGET_OS`. The variable can
+ be set to "linux" for ``glibc``-based systems and to "linux-musl" for
+ ``musl``. For ARM/EABI targets, there are also "linux-gnueabi" and
+ "linux-musleabi" values possible.
+
+ HOST_PREFIX
+ Specifies the prefix for the cross-compile toolchain. ``HOST_PREFIX``
+ is normally the same as :term:`TARGET_PREFIX`.
+
+ HOST_SYS
+ Specifies the system, including the architecture and the operating
+ system, for which the build is occurring in the context of the
+ current recipe.
+
+ The OpenEmbedded build system automatically sets this variable based
+ on :term:`HOST_ARCH`,
+ :term:`HOST_VENDOR`, and
+ :term:`HOST_OS` variables.
+
+ .. note::
+
+ You do not need to set the variable yourself.
+
+ Consider these two examples:
+
+ - Given a native recipe on a 32-bit x86 machine running Linux, the
+ value is "i686-linux".
+
+ - Given a recipe being built for a little-endian MIPS target running
+ Linux, the value might be "mipsel-linux".
+
+ HOSTTOOLS
+ A space-separated list (filter) of tools on the build host that
+ should be allowed to be called from within build tasks. Using this
+ filter helps reduce the possibility of host contamination. If a tool
+ specified in the value of ``HOSTTOOLS`` is not found on the build
+ host, the OpenEmbedded build system produces an error and the build
+ is not started.
+
+ For additional information, see
+ :term:`HOSTTOOLS_NONFATAL`.
+
+ HOSTTOOLS_NONFATAL
+ A space-separated list (filter) of tools on the build host that
+ should be allowed to be called from within build tasks. Using this
+ filter helps reduce the possibility of host contamination. Unlike
+ :term:`HOSTTOOLS`, the OpenEmbedded build system
+ does not produce an error if a tool specified in the value of
+ ``HOSTTOOLS_NONFATAL`` is not found on the build host. Thus, you can
+ use ``HOSTTOOLS_NONFATAL`` to filter optional host tools.
+
+ HOST_VENDOR
+ Specifies the name of the vendor. ``HOST_VENDOR`` is normally the
+ same as :term:`TARGET_VENDOR`.
+
+ ICECC_DISABLED
+ Disables or enables the ``icecc`` (Icecream) function. For more
+ information on this function and best practices for using this
+ variable, see the ":ref:`icecc.bbclass <ref-classes-icecc>`"
+ section.
+
+ Setting this variable to "1" in your ``local.conf`` disables the
+ function:
+ ::
+
+ ICECC_DISABLED ??= "1"
+
+ To enable the function, set the variable as follows:
+ ::
+
+ ICECC_DISABLED = ""
+
+ ICECC_ENV_EXEC
+ Points to the ``icecc-create-env`` script that you provide. This
+ variable is used by the :ref:`icecc <ref-classes-icecc>` class. You
+ set this variable in your ``local.conf`` file.
+
+ If you do not point to a script that you provide, the OpenEmbedded
+ build system uses the default script provided by the
+ ``icecc-create-env.bb`` recipe, which is a modified version and not
+ the one that comes with ``icecc``.
+
+ ICECC_PARALLEL_MAKE
+ Extra options passed to the ``make`` command during the
+ :ref:`ref-tasks-compile` task that specify parallel
+ compilation. This variable usually takes the form of "-j x", where x
+ represents the maximum number of parallel threads ``make`` can run.
+
+ .. note::
+
+ The options passed affect builds on all enabled machines on the
+ network, which are machines running the
+ iceccd
+ daemon.
+
+ If your enabled machines support multiple cores, coming up with the
+ maximum number of parallel threads that gives you the best
+ performance could take some experimentation since machine speed,
+ network lag, available memory, and existing machine loads can all
+ affect build time. Consequently, unlike the
+ :term:`PARALLEL_MAKE` variable, there is no
+ rule-of-thumb for setting ``ICECC_PARALLEL_MAKE`` to achieve optimal
+ performance.
+
+ If you do not set ``ICECC_PARALLEL_MAKE``, the build system does not
+ use it (i.e. the system does not detect and assign the number of
+ cores as is done with ``PARALLEL_MAKE``).
+
+ ICECC_PATH
+ The location of the ``icecc`` binary. You can set this variable in
+ your ``local.conf`` file. If your ``local.conf`` file does not define
+ this variable, the :ref:`icecc <ref-classes-icecc>` class attempts
+ to define it by locating ``icecc`` using ``which``.
+
+ ICECC_USER_CLASS_BL
+ Identifies user classes that you do not want the Icecream distributed
+ compile support to consider. This variable is used by the
+ :ref:`icecc <ref-classes-icecc>` class. You set this variable in
+ your ``local.conf`` file.
+
+ When you list classes using this variable, you are "blacklisting"
+ them from distributed compilation across remote hosts. Any classes
+ you list will be distributed and compiled locally.
+
+ ICECC_USER_PACKAGE_BL
+ Identifies user recipes that you do not want the Icecream distributed
+ compile support to consider. This variable is used by the
+ :ref:`icecc <ref-classes-icecc>` class. You set this variable in
+ your ``local.conf`` file.
+
+ When you list packages using this variable, you are "blacklisting"
+ them from distributed compilation across remote hosts. Any packages
+ you list will be distributed and compiled locally.
+
+ ICECC_USER_PACKAGE_WL
+ Identifies user recipes that use an empty
+ :term:`PARALLEL_MAKE` variable that you want to
+ force remote distributed compilation on using the Icecream
+ distributed compile support. This variable is used by the
+ :ref:`icecc <ref-classes-icecc>` class. You set this variable in
+ your ``local.conf`` file.
+
+ IMAGE_BASENAME
+ The base name of image output files. This variable defaults to the
+ recipe name (``${``\ :term:`PN`\ ``}``).
+
+ IMAGE_BOOT_FILES
+ A space-separated list of files installed into the boot partition
+ when preparing an image using the Wic tool with the
+ ``bootimg-partition`` or ``bootimg-efi`` source plugin. By default,
+ the files are
+ installed under the same name as the source files. To change the
+ installed name, separate it from the original name with a semi-colon
+ (;). Source files need to be located in
+ :term:`DEPLOY_DIR_IMAGE`. Here are two
+ examples:
+ ::
+
+ IMAGE_BOOT_FILES = "u-boot.img uImage;kernel"
+ IMAGE_BOOT_FILES = "u-boot.${UBOOT_SUFFIX} ${KERNEL_IMAGETYPE}"
+
+ Alternatively, source files can be picked up using a glob pattern. In
+ this case, the destination file must have the same name as the base
+ name of the source file path. To install files into a directory
+ within the target location, pass its name after a semi-colon (;).
+ Here are two examples:
+ ::
+
+ IMAGE_BOOT_FILES = "bcm2835-bootfiles/*"
+ IMAGE_BOOT_FILES = "bcm2835-bootfiles/*;boot/"
+
+ The first example
+ installs all files from ``${DEPLOY_DIR_IMAGE}/bcm2835-bootfiles``
+ into the root of the target partition. The second example installs
+ the same files into a ``boot`` directory within the target partition.
+
+ You can find information on how to use the Wic tool in the
+ ":ref:`dev-manual/dev-manual-common-tasks:creating partitioned images using wic`"
+ section of the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual. Reference
+ material for Wic is located in the
+ ":doc:`../ref-manual/ref-kickstart`" chapter.
+
+ IMAGE_CLASSES
+ A list of classes that all images should inherit. You typically use
+ this variable to specify the list of classes that register the
+ different types of images the OpenEmbedded build system creates.
+
+ The default value for ``IMAGE_CLASSES`` is ``image_types``. You can
+ set this variable in your ``local.conf`` or in a distribution
+ configuration file.
+
+ For more information, see ``meta/classes/image_types.bbclass`` in the
+ :term:`Source Directory`.
+
+ IMAGE_CMD
+ Specifies the command to create the image file for a specific image
+ type, which corresponds to the value set set in
+ :term:`IMAGE_FSTYPES`, (e.g. ``ext3``,
+ ``btrfs``, and so forth). When setting this variable, you should use
+ an override for the associated type. Here is an example:
+ ::
+
+ IMAGE_CMD_jffs2 = "mkfs.jffs2 --root=${IMAGE_ROOTFS} \
+ --faketime --output=${DEPLOY_DIR_IMAGE}/${IMAGE_NAME}.rootfs.jffs2 \
+ ${EXTRA_IMAGECMD}"
+
+ You typically do not need to set this variable unless you are adding
+ support for a new image type. For more examples on how to set this
+ variable, see the :ref:`image_types <ref-classes-image_types>`
+ class file, which is ``meta/classes/image_types.bbclass``.
+
+ IMAGE_DEVICE_TABLES
+ Specifies one or more files that contain custom device tables that
+ are passed to the ``makedevs`` command as part of creating an image.
+ These files list basic device nodes that should be created under
+ ``/dev`` within the image. If ``IMAGE_DEVICE_TABLES`` is not set,
+ ``files/device_table-minimal.txt`` is used, which is located by
+ :term:`BBPATH`. For details on how you should write
+ device table files, see ``meta/files/device_table-minimal.txt`` as an
+ example.
+
+ IMAGE_FEATURES
+ The primary list of features to include in an image. Typically, you
+ configure this variable in an image recipe. Although you can use this
+ variable from your ``local.conf`` file, which is found in the
+ :term:`Build Directory`, best practices dictate that you do
+ not.
+
+ .. note::
+
+ To enable extra features from outside the image recipe, use the
+ EXTRA_IMAGE_FEATURES
+ variable.
+
+ For a list of image features that ships with the Yocto Project, see
+ the "`Image Features <#ref-features-image>`__" section.
+
+ For an example that shows how to customize your image by using this
+ variable, see the ":ref:`usingpoky-extend-customimage-imagefeatures`"
+ section in the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual.
+
+ IMAGE_FSTYPES
+ Specifies the formats the OpenEmbedded build system uses during the
+ build when creating the root filesystem. For example, setting
+ ``IMAGE_FSTYPES`` as follows causes the build system to create root
+ filesystems using two formats: ``.ext3`` and ``.tar.bz2``:
+ ::
+
+ IMAGE_FSTYPES = "ext3 tar.bz2"
+
+ For the complete list of supported image formats from which you can
+ choose, see :term:`IMAGE_TYPES`.
+
+ .. note::
+
+ - If an image recipe uses the "inherit image" line and you are
+ setting ``IMAGE_FSTYPES`` inside the recipe, you must set
+ ``IMAGE_FSTYPES`` prior to using the "inherit image" line.
+
+ - Due to the way the OpenEmbedded build system processes this
+ variable, you cannot update its contents by using ``_append``
+ or ``_prepend``. You must use the ``+=`` operator to add one or
+ more options to the ``IMAGE_FSTYPES`` variable.
+
+ IMAGE_INSTALL
+ Used by recipes to specify the packages to install into an image
+ through the :ref:`image <ref-classes-image>` class. Use the
+ ``IMAGE_INSTALL`` variable with care to avoid ordering issues.
+
+ Image recipes set ``IMAGE_INSTALL`` to specify the packages to
+ install into an image through ``image.bbclass``. Additionally,
+ "helper" classes such as the
+ :ref:`core-image <ref-classes-core-image>` class exist that can
+ take lists used with ``IMAGE_FEATURES`` and turn them into
+ auto-generated entries in ``IMAGE_INSTALL`` in addition to its
+ default contents.
+
+ When you use this variable, it is best to use it as follows:
+ ::
+
+ IMAGE_INSTALL_append = " package-name"
+
+ Be sure to include the space
+ between the quotation character and the start of the package name or
+ names.
+
+ .. note::
+
+ - When working with a
+ ```core-image-minimal-initramfs`` <#images-core-image-minimal-initramfs>`__
+ image, do not use the ``IMAGE_INSTALL`` variable to specify
+ packages for installation. Instead, use the
+ :term:`PACKAGE_INSTALL` variable, which
+ allows the initial RAM filesystem (initramfs) recipe to use a
+ fixed set of packages and not be affected by ``IMAGE_INSTALL``.
+ For information on creating an initramfs, see the
+ ":ref:`building-an-initramfs-image`"
+ section in the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual.
+
+ - Using ``IMAGE_INSTALL`` with the
+ :ref:`+= <bitbake:appending-and-prepending>`
+ BitBake operator within the ``/conf/local.conf`` file or from
+ within an image recipe is not recommended. Use of this operator
+ in these ways can cause ordering issues. Since
+ ``core-image.bbclass`` sets ``IMAGE_INSTALL`` to a default
+ value using the
+ :ref:`?= <bitbake:bitbake-user-manual/bitbake-user-manual-metadata:setting a default value (?=)>`
+ operator, using a ``+=`` operation against ``IMAGE_INSTALL``
+ results in unexpected behavior when used within
+ ``conf/local.conf``. Furthermore, the same operation from
+ within an image recipe may or may not succeed depending on the
+ specific situation. In both these cases, the behavior is
+ contrary to how most users expect the ``+=`` operator to work.
+
+ IMAGE_LINGUAS
+ Specifies the list of locales to install into the image during the
+ root filesystem construction process. The OpenEmbedded build system
+ automatically splits locale files, which are used for localization,
+ into separate packages. Setting the ``IMAGE_LINGUAS`` variable
+ ensures that any locale packages that correspond to packages already
+ selected for installation into the image are also installed. Here is
+ an example:
+ ::
+
+ IMAGE_LINGUAS = "pt-br de-de"
+
+ In this example, the build system ensures any Brazilian Portuguese
+ and German locale files that correspond to packages in the image are
+ installed (i.e. ``*-locale-pt-br`` and ``*-locale-de-de`` as well as
+ ``*-locale-pt`` and ``*-locale-de``, since some software packages
+ only provide locale files by language and not by country-specific
+ language).
+
+ See the :term:`GLIBC_GENERATE_LOCALES`
+ variable for information on generating GLIBC locales.
+
+ IMAGE_MANIFEST
+ The manifest file for the image. This file lists all the installed
+ packages that make up the image. The file contains package
+ information on a line-per-package basis as follows:
+ ::
+
+ packagename packagearch version
+
+ The :ref:`image <ref-classes-image>` class defines the manifest
+ file as follows:
+ ::
+
+ IMAGE_MANIFEST ="${DEPLOY_DIR_IMAGE}/${IMAGE_NAME}.rootfs.manifest"
+
+ The location is
+ derived using the :term:`DEPLOY_DIR_IMAGE`
+ and :term:`IMAGE_NAME` variables. You can find
+ information on how the image is created in the ":ref:`image-generation-dev-environment`"
+ section in the Yocto Project Overview and Concepts Manual.
+
+ IMAGE_NAME
+ The name of the output image files minus the extension. This variable
+ is derived using the :term:`IMAGE_BASENAME`,
+ :term:`MACHINE`, and :term:`DATETIME`
+ variables:
+ ::
+
+ IMAGE_NAME = "${IMAGE_BASENAME}-${MACHINE}-${DATETIME}"
+
+ IMAGE_OVERHEAD_FACTOR
+ Defines a multiplier that the build system applies to the initial
+ image size for cases when the multiplier times the returned disk
+ usage value for the image is greater than the sum of
+ ``IMAGE_ROOTFS_SIZE`` and ``IMAGE_ROOTFS_EXTRA_SPACE``. The result of
+ the multiplier applied to the initial image size creates free disk
+ space in the image as overhead. By default, the build process uses a
+ multiplier of 1.3 for this variable. This default value results in
+ 30% free disk space added to the image when this method is used to
+ determine the final generated image size. You should be aware that
+ post install scripts and the package management system uses disk
+ space inside this overhead area. Consequently, the multiplier does
+ not produce an image with all the theoretical free disk space. See
+ ``IMAGE_ROOTFS_SIZE`` for information on how the build system
+ determines the overall image size.
+
+ The default 30% free disk space typically gives the image enough room
+ to boot and allows for basic post installs while still leaving a
+ small amount of free disk space. If 30% free space is inadequate, you
+ can increase the default value. For example, the following setting
+ gives you 50% free space added to the image:
+ ::
+
+ IMAGE_OVERHEAD_FACTOR = "1.5"
+
+ Alternatively, you can ensure a specific amount of free disk space is
+ added to the image by using the ``IMAGE_ROOTFS_EXTRA_SPACE``
+ variable.
+
+ IMAGE_PKGTYPE
+ Defines the package type (i.e. DEB, RPM, IPK, or TAR) used by the
+ OpenEmbedded build system. The variable is defined appropriately by
+ the :ref:`package_deb <ref-classes-package_deb>`,
+ :ref:`package_rpm <ref-classes-package_rpm>`,
+ :ref:`package_ipk <ref-classes-package_ipk>`, or
+ :ref:`package_tar <ref-classes-package_tar>` class.
+
+ .. note::
+
+ The
+ package_tar
+ class is broken and is not supported. It is recommended that you
+ do not use it.
+
+ The :ref:`populate_sdk_* <ref-classes-populate-sdk-*>` and
+ :ref:`image <ref-classes-image>` classes use the ``IMAGE_PKGTYPE``
+ for packaging up images and SDKs.
+
+ You should not set the ``IMAGE_PKGTYPE`` manually. Rather, the
+ variable is set indirectly through the appropriate
+ :ref:`package_* <ref-classes-package>` class using the
+ :term:`PACKAGE_CLASSES` variable. The
+ OpenEmbedded build system uses the first package type (e.g. DEB, RPM,
+ or IPK) that appears with the variable
+
+ .. note::
+
+ Files using the
+ .tar
+ format are never used as a substitute packaging format for DEB,
+ RPM, and IPK formatted files for your image or SDK.
+
+ IMAGE_POSTPROCESS_COMMAND
+ Specifies a list of functions to call once the OpenEmbedded build
+ system creates the final image output files. You can specify
+ functions separated by semicolons:
+ ::
+
+ IMAGE_POSTPROCESS_COMMAND += "function; ... "
+
+ If you need to pass the root filesystem path to a command within the
+ function, you can use ``${IMAGE_ROOTFS}``, which points to the
+ directory that becomes the root filesystem image. See the
+ :term:`IMAGE_ROOTFS` variable for more
+ information.
+
+ IMAGE_PREPROCESS_COMMAND
+ Specifies a list of functions to call before the OpenEmbedded build
+ system creates the final image output files. You can specify
+ functions separated by semicolons:
+ ::
+
+ IMAGE_PREPROCESS_COMMAND += "function; ... "
+
+ If you need to pass the root filesystem path to a command within the
+ function, you can use ``${IMAGE_ROOTFS}``, which points to the
+ directory that becomes the root filesystem image. See the
+ :term:`IMAGE_ROOTFS` variable for more
+ information.
+
+ IMAGE_ROOTFS
+ The location of the root filesystem while it is under construction
+ (i.e. during the :ref:`ref-tasks-rootfs` task). This
+ variable is not configurable. Do not change it.
+
+ IMAGE_ROOTFS_ALIGNMENT
+ Specifies the alignment for the output image file in Kbytes. If the
+ size of the image is not a multiple of this value, then the size is
+ rounded up to the nearest multiple of the value. The default value is
+ "1". See :term:`IMAGE_ROOTFS_SIZE` for
+ additional information.
+
+ IMAGE_ROOTFS_EXTRA_SPACE
+ Defines additional free disk space created in the image in Kbytes. By
+ default, this variable is set to "0". This free disk space is added
+ to the image after the build system determines the image size as
+ described in ``IMAGE_ROOTFS_SIZE``.
+
+ This variable is particularly useful when you want to ensure that a
+ specific amount of free disk space is available on a device after an
+ image is installed and running. For example, to be sure 5 Gbytes of
+ free disk space is available, set the variable as follows:
+ ::
+
+ IMAGE_ROOTFS_EXTRA_SPACE = "5242880"
+
+ For example, the Yocto Project Build Appliance specifically requests
+ 40 Gbytes of extra space with the line:
+ ::
+
+ IMAGE_ROOTFS_EXTRA_SPACE = "41943040"
+
+ IMAGE_ROOTFS_SIZE
+ Defines the size in Kbytes for the generated image. The OpenEmbedded
+ build system determines the final size for the generated image using
+ an algorithm that takes into account the initial disk space used for
+ the generated image, a requested size for the image, and requested
+ additional free disk space to be added to the image. Programatically,
+ the build system determines the final size of the generated image as
+ follows:
+ ::
+
+ if (image-du * overhead) < rootfs-size:
+ internal-rootfs-size = rootfs-size + xspace
+ else:
+ internal-rootfs-size = (image-du * overhead) + xspace
+ where:
+ image-du = Returned value of the du command on the image.
+ overhead = IMAGE_OVERHEAD_FACTOR
+ rootfs-size = IMAGE_ROOTFS_SIZE
+ internal-rootfs-size = Initial root filesystem size before any modifications.
+ xspace = IMAGE_ROOTFS_EXTRA_SPACE
+
+ See the :term:`IMAGE_OVERHEAD_FACTOR`
+ and :term:`IMAGE_ROOTFS_EXTRA_SPACE`
+ variables for related information.
+
+ IMAGE_TYPEDEP
+ Specifies a dependency from one image type on another. Here is an
+ example from the :ref:`image-live <ref-classes-image-live>` class:
+ ::
+
+ IMAGE_TYPEDEP_live = "ext3"
+
+ In the previous example, the variable ensures that when "live" is
+ listed with the :term:`IMAGE_FSTYPES` variable,
+ the OpenEmbedded build system produces an ``ext3`` image first since
+ one of the components of the live image is an ``ext3`` formatted
+ partition containing the root filesystem.
+
+ IMAGE_TYPES
+ Specifies the complete list of supported image types by default:
+
+ - btrfs
+ - container
+ - cpio
+ - cpio.gz
+ - cpio.lz4
+ - cpio.lzma
+ - cpio.xz
+ - cramfs
+ - ext2
+ - ext2.bz2
+ - ext2.gz
+ - ext2.lzma
+ - ext3
+ - ext3.gz
+ - ext4
+ - ext4.gz
+ - f2fs
+ - hddimg
+ - iso
+ - jffs2
+ - jffs2.sum
+ - multiubi
+ - squashfs
+ - squashfs-lz4
+ - squashfs-lzo
+ - squashfs-xz
+ - tar
+ - tar.bz2
+ - tar.gz
+ - tar.lz4
+ - tar.xz
+ - tar.zst
+ - ubi
+ - ubifs
+ - wic
+ - wic.bz2
+ - wic.gz
+ - wic.lzma
+
+ For more information about these types of images, see
+ ``meta/classes/image_types*.bbclass`` in the :term:`Source Directory`.
+
+ INC_PR
+ Helps define the recipe revision for recipes that share a common
+ ``include`` file. You can think of this variable as part of the
+ recipe revision as set from within an include file.
+
+ Suppose, for example, you have a set of recipes that are used across
+ several projects. And, within each of those recipes the revision (its
+ :term:`PR` value) is set accordingly. In this case, when
+ the revision of those recipes changes, the burden is on you to find
+ all those recipes and be sure that they get changed to reflect the
+ updated version of the recipe. In this scenario, it can get
+ complicated when recipes that are used in many places and provide
+ common functionality are upgraded to a new revision.
+
+ A more efficient way of dealing with this situation is to set the
+ ``INC_PR`` variable inside the ``include`` files that the recipes
+ share and then expand the ``INC_PR`` variable within the recipes to
+ help define the recipe revision.
+
+ The following provides an example that shows how to use the
+ ``INC_PR`` variable given a common ``include`` file that defines the
+ variable. Once the variable is defined in the ``include`` file, you
+ can use the variable to set the ``PR`` values in each recipe. You
+ will notice that when you set a recipe's ``PR`` you can provide more
+ granular revisioning by appending values to the ``INC_PR`` variable:
+ ::
+
+ recipes-graphics/xorg-font/xorg-font-common.inc:INC_PR = "r2"
+ recipes-graphics/xorg-font/encodings_1.0.4.bb:PR = "${INC_PR}.1"
+ recipes-graphics/xorg-font/font-util_1.3.0.bb:PR = "${INC_PR}.0"
+ recipes-graphics/xorg-font/font-alias_1.0.3.bb:PR = "${INC_PR}.3"
+
+ The
+ first line of the example establishes the baseline revision to be
+ used for all recipes that use the ``include`` file. The remaining
+ lines in the example are from individual recipes and show how the
+ ``PR`` value is set.
+
+ INCOMPATIBLE_LICENSE
+ Specifies a space-separated list of license names (as they would
+ appear in :term:`LICENSE`) that should be excluded
+ from the build. Recipes that provide no alternatives to listed
+ incompatible licenses are not built. Packages that are individually
+ licensed with the specified incompatible licenses will be deleted.
+
+ .. note::
+
+ This functionality is only regularly tested using the following
+ setting:
+ ::
+
+ INCOMPATIBLE_LICENSE = "GPL-3.0 LGPL-3.0 AGPL-3.0"
+
+
+ Although you can use other settings, you might be required to
+ remove dependencies on or provide alternatives to components that
+ are required to produce a functional system image.
+
+ .. note::
+
+ It is possible to define a list of licenses that are allowed to be
+ used instead of the licenses that are excluded. To do this, define
+ a variable
+ COMPATIBLE_LICENSES
+ with the names of the licences that are allowed. Then define
+ INCOMPATIBLE_LICENSE
+ as:
+ ::
+
+ INCOMPATIBLE_LICENSE = "${@' '.join(sorted(set(d.getVar('AVAILABLE_LICENSES').split()) - set(d.getVar('COMPATIBLE_LICENSES').split())))}"
+
+
+ This will result in
+ INCOMPATIBLE_LICENSE
+ containing the names of all licences from
+ AVAILABLE_LICENSES
+ except the ones specified in
+ COMPATIBLE_LICENSES
+ , thus only allowing the latter licences to be used.
+
+ INHERIT
+ Causes the named class or classes to be inherited globally. Anonymous
+ functions in the class or classes are not executed for the base
+ configuration and in each individual recipe. The OpenEmbedded build
+ system ignores changes to ``INHERIT`` in individual recipes.
+
+ For more information on ``INHERIT``, see the
+ :ref:`bitbake:bitbake-user-manual/bitbake-user-manual-metadata:\`\`inherit\`\` configuration directive`"
+ section in the Bitbake User Manual.
+
+ INHERIT_DISTRO
+ Lists classes that will be inherited at the distribution level. It is
+ unlikely that you want to edit this variable.
+
+ The default value of the variable is set as follows in the
+ ``meta/conf/distro/defaultsetup.conf`` file:
+ ::
+
+ INHERIT_DISTRO ?= "debian devshell sstate license"
+
+ INHIBIT_DEFAULT_DEPS
+ Prevents the default dependencies, namely the C compiler and standard
+ C library (libc), from being added to :term:`DEPENDS`.
+ This variable is usually used within recipes that do not require any
+ compilation using the C compiler.
+
+ Set the variable to "1" to prevent the default dependencies from
+ being added.
+
+ INHIBIT_PACKAGE_DEBUG_SPLIT
+ Prevents the OpenEmbedded build system from splitting out debug
+ information during packaging. By default, the build system splits out
+ debugging information during the
+ :ref:`ref-tasks-package` task. For more information on
+ how debug information is split out, see the
+ :term:`PACKAGE_DEBUG_SPLIT_STYLE`
+ variable.
+
+ To prevent the build system from splitting out debug information
+ during packaging, set the ``INHIBIT_PACKAGE_DEBUG_SPLIT`` variable as
+ follows:
+ ::
+
+ INHIBIT_PACKAGE_DEBUG_SPLIT = "1"
+
+ INHIBIT_PACKAGE_STRIP
+ If set to "1", causes the build to not strip binaries in resulting
+ packages and prevents the ``-dbg`` package from containing the source
+ files.
+
+ By default, the OpenEmbedded build system strips binaries and puts
+ the debugging symbols into ``${``\ :term:`PN`\ ``}-dbg``.
+ Consequently, you should not set ``INHIBIT_PACKAGE_STRIP`` when you
+ plan to debug in general.
+
+ INHIBIT_SYSROOT_STRIP
+ If set to "1", causes the build to not strip binaries in the
+ resulting sysroot.
+
+ By default, the OpenEmbedded build system strips binaries in the
+ resulting sysroot. When you specifically set the
+ ``INHIBIT_SYSROOT_STRIP`` variable to "1" in your recipe, you inhibit
+ this stripping.
+
+ If you want to use this variable, include the
+ :ref:`staging <ref-classes-staging>` class. This class uses a
+ ``sys_strip()`` function to test for the variable and acts
+ accordingly.
+
+ .. note::
+
+ Use of the
+ INHIBIT_SYSROOT_STRIP
+ variable occurs in rare and special circumstances. For example,
+ suppose you are building bare-metal firmware by using an external
+ GCC toolchain. Furthermore, even if the toolchain's binaries are
+ strippable, other files exist that are needed for the build that
+ are not strippable.
+
+ INITRAMFS_FSTYPES
+ Defines the format for the output image of an initial RAM filesystem
+ (initramfs), which is used during boot. Supported formats are the
+ same as those supported by the
+ :term:`IMAGE_FSTYPES` variable.
+
+ The default value of this variable, which is set in the
+ ``meta/conf/bitbake.conf`` configuration file in the
+ :term:`Source Directory`, is "cpio.gz". The Linux kernel's
+ initramfs mechanism, as opposed to the initial RAM filesystem
+ `initrd <https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Initrd>`__ mechanism, expects
+ an optionally compressed cpio archive.
+
+ INITRAMFS_IMAGE
+ Specifies the :term:`PROVIDES` name of an image
+ recipe that is used to build an initial RAM filesystem (initramfs)
+ image. In other words, the ``INITRAMFS_IMAGE`` variable causes an
+ additional recipe to be built as a dependency to whatever root
+ filesystem recipe you might be using (e.g. ``core-image-sato``). The
+ initramfs image recipe you provide should set
+ :term:`IMAGE_FSTYPES` to
+ :term:`INITRAMFS_FSTYPES`.
+
+ An initramfs image provides a temporary root filesystem used for
+ early system initialization (e.g. loading of modules needed to locate
+ and mount the "real" root filesystem).
+
+ .. note::
+
+ See the
+ meta/recipes-core/images/core-image-minimal-initramfs.bb
+ recipe in the
+ Source Directory
+ for an example initramfs recipe. To select this sample recipe as
+ the one built to provide the initramfs image, set
+ INITRAMFS_IMAGE
+ to "core-image-minimal-initramfs".
+
+ You can also find more information by referencing the
+ ``meta-poky/conf/local.conf.sample.extended`` configuration file in
+ the Source Directory, the :ref:`image <ref-classes-image>` class,
+ and the :ref:`kernel <ref-classes-kernel>` class to see how to use
+ the ``INITRAMFS_IMAGE`` variable.
+
+ If ``INITRAMFS_IMAGE`` is empty, which is the default, then no
+ initramfs image is built.
+
+ For more information, you can also see the
+ :term:`INITRAMFS_IMAGE_BUNDLE`
+ variable, which allows the generated image to be bundled inside the
+ kernel image. Additionally, for information on creating an initramfs
+ image, see the ":ref:`building-an-initramfs-image`" section
+ in the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual.
+
+ INITRAMFS_IMAGE_BUNDLE
+ Controls whether or not the image recipe specified by
+ :term:`INITRAMFS_IMAGE` is run through an
+ extra pass
+ (:ref:`ref-tasks-bundle_initramfs`) during
+ kernel compilation in order to build a single binary that contains
+ both the kernel image and the initial RAM filesystem (initramfs)
+ image. This makes use of the
+ :term:`CONFIG_INITRAMFS_SOURCE` kernel
+ feature.
+
+ .. note::
+
+ Using an extra compilation pass to bundle the initramfs avoids a
+ circular dependency between the kernel recipe and the initramfs
+ recipe should the initramfs include kernel modules. Should that be
+ the case, the initramfs recipe depends on the kernel for the
+ kernel modules, and the kernel depends on the initramfs recipe
+ since the initramfs is bundled inside the kernel image.
+
+ The combined binary is deposited into the ``tmp/deploy`` directory,
+ which is part of the :term:`Build Directory`.
+
+ Setting the variable to "1" in a configuration file causes the
+ OpenEmbedded build system to generate a kernel image with the
+ initramfs specified in ``INITRAMFS_IMAGE`` bundled within:
+ ::
+
+ INITRAMFS_IMAGE_BUNDLE = "1"
+
+ By default, the
+ :ref:`kernel <ref-classes-kernel>` class sets this variable to a
+ null string as follows:
+ ::
+
+ INITRAMFS_IMAGE_BUNDLE ?= ""
+
+ .. note::
+
+ You must set the
+ INITRAMFS_IMAGE_BUNDLE
+ variable in a configuration file. You cannot set the variable in a
+ recipe file.
+
+ See the
+ :yocto_git:`local.conf.sample.extended </cgit/cgit.cgi/poky/tree/meta-poky/conf/local.conf.sample.extended>`
+ file for additional information. Also, for information on creating an
+ initramfs, see the ":ref:`building-an-initramfs-image`" section
+ in the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual.
+
+ INITRAMFS_LINK_NAME
+ The link name of the initial RAM filesystem image. This variable is
+ set in the ``meta/classes/kernel-artifact-names.bbclass`` file as
+ follows:
+ ::
+
+ INITRAMFS_LINK_NAME ?= "initramfs-${KERNEL_ARTIFACT_LINK_NAME}"
+
+ The value of the
+ ``KERNEL_ARTIFACT_LINK_NAME`` variable, which is set in the same
+ file, has the following value:
+ ::
+
+ KERNEL_ARTIFACT_LINK_NAME ?= "${MACHINE}"
+
+ See the :term:`MACHINE` variable for additional
+ information.
+
+ INITRAMFS_NAME
+ The base name of the initial RAM filesystem image. This variable is
+ set in the ``meta/classes/kernel-artifact-names.bbclass`` file as
+ follows:
+ ::
+
+ INITRAMFS_NAME ?= "initramfs-${KERNEL_ARTIFACT_NAME}"
+
+ The value of the :term:`KERNEL_ARTIFACT_NAME`
+ variable, which is set in the same file, has the following value:
+ ::
+
+ KERNEL_ARTIFACT_NAME ?= "${PKGE}-${PKGV}-${PKGR}-${MACHINE}${IMAGE_VERSION_SUFFIX}"
+
+ INITRD
+ Indicates list of filesystem images to concatenate and use as an
+ initial RAM disk (``initrd``).
+
+ The ``INITRD`` variable is an optional variable used with the
+ :ref:`image-live <ref-classes-image-live>` class.
+
+ INITRD_IMAGE
+ When building a "live" bootable image (i.e. when
+ :term:`IMAGE_FSTYPES` contains "live"),
+ ``INITRD_IMAGE`` specifies the image recipe that should be built to
+ provide the initial RAM disk image. The default value is
+ "core-image-minimal-initramfs".
+
+ See the :ref:`image-live <ref-classes-image-live>` class for more
+ information.
+
+ INITSCRIPT_NAME
+ The filename of the initialization script as installed to
+ ``${sysconfdir}/init.d``.
+
+ This variable is used in recipes when using ``update-rc.d.bbclass``.
+ The variable is mandatory.
+
+ INITSCRIPT_PACKAGES
+ A list of the packages that contain initscripts. If multiple packages
+ are specified, you need to append the package name to the other
+ ``INITSCRIPT_*`` as an override.
+
+ This variable is used in recipes when using ``update-rc.d.bbclass``.
+ The variable is optional and defaults to the :term:`PN`
+ variable.
+
+ INITSCRIPT_PARAMS
+ Specifies the options to pass to ``update-rc.d``. Here is an example:
+ ::
+
+ INITSCRIPT_PARAMS = "start 99 5 2 . stop 20 0 1 6 ."
+
+ In this example, the script has a runlevel of 99, starts the script
+ in initlevels 2 and 5, and stops the script in levels 0, 1 and 6.
+
+ The variable's default value is "defaults", which is set in the
+ :ref:`update-rc.d <ref-classes-update-rc.d>` class.
+
+ The value in ``INITSCRIPT_PARAMS`` is passed through to the
+ ``update-rc.d`` command. For more information on valid parameters,
+ please see the ``update-rc.d`` manual page at
+ http://www.tin.org/bin/man.cgi?section=8&topic=update-rc.d.
+
+ INSANE_SKIP
+ Specifies the QA checks to skip for a specific package within a
+ recipe. For example, to skip the check for symbolic link ``.so``
+ files in the main package of a recipe, add the following to the
+ recipe. The package name override must be used, which in this example
+ is ``${PN}``:
+ ::
+
+ INSANE_SKIP_${PN} += "dev-so"
+
+ See the ":ref:`insane.bbclass <ref-classes-insane>`" section for a
+ list of the valid QA checks you can specify using this variable.
+
+ INSTALL_TIMEZONE_FILE
+ By default, the ``tzdata`` recipe packages an ``/etc/timezone`` file.
+ Set the ``INSTALL_TIMEZONE_FILE`` variable to "0" at the
+ configuration level to disable this behavior.
+
+ IPK_FEED_URIS
+ When the IPK backend is in use and package management is enabled on
+ the target, you can use this variable to set up ``opkg`` in the
+ target image to point to package feeds on a nominated server. Once
+ the feed is established, you can perform installations or upgrades
+ using the package manager at runtime.
+
+ KARCH
+ Defines the kernel architecture used when assembling the
+ configuration. Architectures supported for this release are:
+
+ - powerpc
+ - i386
+ - x86_64
+ - arm
+ - qemu
+ - mips
+
+ You define the ``KARCH`` variable in the :ref:`kernel-dev/kernel-dev-advanced:bsp descriptions`.
+
+ KBRANCH
+ A regular expression used by the build process to explicitly identify
+ the kernel branch that is validated, patched, and configured during a
+ build. You must set this variable to ensure the exact kernel branch
+ you want is being used by the build process.
+
+ Values for this variable are set in the kernel's recipe file and the
+ kernel's append file. For example, if you are using the
+ ``linux-yocto_4.12`` kernel, the kernel recipe file is the
+ ``meta/recipes-kernel/linux/linux-yocto_4.12.bb`` file. ``KBRANCH``
+ is set as follows in that kernel recipe file:
+ ::
+
+ KBRANCH ?= "standard/base"
+
+ This variable is also used from the kernel's append file to identify
+ the kernel branch specific to a particular machine or target
+ hardware. Continuing with the previous kernel example, the kernel's
+ append file (i.e. ``linux-yocto_4.12.bbappend``) is located in the
+ BSP layer for a given machine. For example, the append file for the
+ Beaglebone, EdgeRouter, and generic versions of both 32 and 64-bit IA
+ machines (``meta-yocto-bsp``) is named
+ ``meta-yocto-bsp/recipes-kernel/linux/linux-yocto_4.12.bbappend``.
+ Here are the related statements from that append file:
+ ::
+
+ KBRANCH_genericx86 = "standard/base"
+ KBRANCH_genericx86-64 = "standard/base"
+ KBRANCH_edgerouter = "standard/edgerouter"
+ KBRANCH_beaglebone = "standard/beaglebone"
+
+ The ``KBRANCH`` statements
+ identify the kernel branch to use when building for each supported
+ BSP.
+
+ KBUILD_DEFCONFIG
+ When used with the :ref:`kernel-yocto <ref-classes-kernel-yocto>`
+ class, specifies an "in-tree" kernel configuration file for use
+ during a kernel build.
+
+ Typically, when using a ``defconfig`` to configure a kernel during a
+ build, you place the file in your layer in the same manner as you
+ would place patch files and configuration fragment files (i.e.
+ "out-of-tree"). However, if you want to use a ``defconfig`` file that
+ is part of the kernel tree (i.e. "in-tree"), you can use the
+ ``KBUILD_DEFCONFIG`` variable and append the
+ :term:`KMACHINE` variable to point to the
+ ``defconfig`` file.
+
+ To use the variable, set it in the append file for your kernel recipe
+ using the following form:
+ ::
+
+ KBUILD_DEFCONFIG_KMACHINE ?= defconfig_file
+
+ Here is an example from a "raspberrypi2" ``KMACHINE`` build that uses
+ a ``defconfig`` file named "bcm2709_defconfig":
+ ::
+
+ KBUILD_DEFCONFIG_raspberrypi2 = "bcm2709_defconfig"
+
+ As an alternative, you can use the following within your append file:
+ ::
+
+ KBUILD_DEFCONFIG_pn-linux-yocto ?= defconfig_file
+
+ For more
+ information on how to use the ``KBUILD_DEFCONFIG`` variable, see the
+ ":ref:`kernel-dev/kernel-dev-common:using an "in-tree" \`\`defconfig\`\` file`"
+ section in the Yocto Project Linux Kernel Development Manual.
+
+ KERNEL_ALT_IMAGETYPE
+ Specifies an alternate kernel image type for creation in addition to
+ the kernel image type specified using the
+ :term:`KERNEL_IMAGETYPE` variable.
+
+ KERNEL_ARTIFACT_NAME
+ Specifies the name of all of the build artifacts. You can change the
+ name of the artifacts by changing the ``KERNEL_ARTIFACT_NAME``
+ variable.
+
+ The value of ``KERNEL_ARTIFACT_NAME``, which is set in the
+ ``meta/classes/kernel-artifact-names.bbclass`` file, has the
+ following default value:
+ ::
+
+ KERNEL_ARTIFACT_NAME ?= "${PKGE}-${PKGV}-${PKGR}-${MACHINE}${IMAGE_VERSION_SUFFIX}"
+
+ See the :term:`PKGE`, :term:`PKGV`, :term:`PKGR`, and :term:`MACHINE`
+ variables for additional information.
+
+ .. note::
+
+ The IMAGE_VERSION_SUFFIX variable is set to DATETIME.
+
+ KERNEL_CLASSES
+ A list of classes defining kernel image types that the
+ :ref:`kernel <ref-classes-kernel>` class should inherit. You
+ typically append this variable to enable extended image types. An
+ example is the "kernel-fitimage", which enables fitImage support and
+ resides in ``meta/classes/kernel-fitimage.bbclass``. You can register
+ custom kernel image types with the ``kernel`` class using this
+ variable.
+
+ KERNEL_DEVICETREE
+ Specifies the name of the generated Linux kernel device tree (i.e.
+ the ``.dtb``) file.
+
+ .. note::
+
+ Legacy support exists for specifying the full path to the device
+ tree. However, providing just the .dtb file is preferred.
+
+ In order to use this variable, the
+ :ref:`kernel-devicetree <ref-classes-kernel-devicetree>` class must
+ be inherited.
+
+ KERNEL_DTB_LINK_NAME
+ The link name of the kernel device tree binary (DTB). This variable
+ is set in the ``meta/classes/kernel-artifact-names.bbclass`` file as
+ follows:
+ ::
+
+ KERNEL_DTB_LINK_NAME ?= "${KERNEL_ARTIFACT_LINK_NAME}"
+
+ The
+ value of the ``KERNEL_ARTIFACT_LINK_NAME`` variable, which is set in
+ the same file, has the following value:
+ ::
+
+ KERNEL_ARTIFACT_LINK_NAME ?= "${MACHINE}"
+
+ See the :term:`MACHINE` variable for additional
+ information.
+
+ KERNEL_DTB_NAME
+ The base name of the kernel device tree binary (DTB). This variable
+ is set in the ``meta/classes/kernel-artifact-names.bbclass`` file as
+ follows:
+ ::
+
+ KERNEL_DTB_NAME ?= "${KERNEL_ARTIFACT_NAME}"
+
+ The value of the :term:`KERNEL_ARTIFACT_NAME`
+ variable, which is set in the same file, has the following value:
+ ::
+
+ KERNEL_ARTIFACT_NAME ?= "${PKGE}-${PKGV}-${PKGR}-${MACHINE}${IMAGE_VERSION_SUFFIX}"
+
+ KERNEL_EXTRA_ARGS
+ Specifies additional ``make`` command-line arguments the OpenEmbedded
+ build system passes on when compiling the kernel.
+
+ KERNEL_FEATURES
+ Includes additional kernel metadata. In the OpenEmbedded build
+ system, the default Board Support Packages (BSPs)
+ :term:`Metadata` is provided through the
+ :term:`KMACHINE` and :term:`KBRANCH`
+ variables. You can use the ``KERNEL_FEATURES`` variable from within
+ the kernel recipe or kernel append file to further add metadata for
+ all BSPs or specific BSPs.
+
+ The metadata you add through this variable includes config fragments
+ and features descriptions, which usually includes patches as well as
+ config fragments. You typically override the ``KERNEL_FEATURES``
+ variable for a specific machine. In this way, you can provide
+ validated, but optional, sets of kernel configurations and features.
+
+ For example, the following example from the ``linux-yocto-rt_4.12``
+ kernel recipe adds "netfilter" and "taskstats" features to all BSPs
+ as well as "virtio" configurations to all QEMU machines. The last two
+ statements add specific configurations to targeted machine types:
+ ::
+
+ KERNEL_EXTRA_FEATURES ?= "features/netfilter/netfilter.scc features/taskstats/taskstats.scc"
+ KERNEL_FEATURES_append = "${KERNEL_EXTRA_FEATURES}"
+ KERNEL_FEATURES_append_qemuall = "cfg/virtio.scc"
+ KERNEL_FEATURES_append_qemux86 = " cfg/sound.scc cfg/paravirt_kvm.scc"
+ KERNEL_FEATURES_append_qemux86-64 = "cfg/sound.scc"
+
+ KERNEL_FIT_LINK_NAME
+ The link name of the kernel flattened image tree (FIT) image. This
+ variable is set in the ``meta/classes/kernel-artifact-names.bbclass``
+ file as follows:
+ ::
+
+ KERNEL_FIT_LINK_NAME ?= "${KERNEL_ARTIFACT_LINK_NAME}"
+
+ The value of the
+ ``KERNEL_ARTIFACT_LINK_NAME`` variable, which is set in the same
+ file, has the following value:
+ ::
+
+ KERNEL_ARTIFACT_LINK_NAME ?= "${MACHINE}"
+
+ See the :term:`MACHINE` variable for additional
+ information.
+
+ KERNEL_FIT_NAME
+ The base name of the kernel flattened image tree (FIT) image. This
+ variable is set in the ``meta/classes/kernel-artifact-names.bbclass``
+ file as follows:
+ ::
+
+ KERNEL_FIT_NAME ?= "${KERNEL_ARTIFACT_NAME}"
+
+ The value of the :term:`KERNEL_ARTIFACT_NAME`
+ variable, which is set in the same file, has the following value:
+ ::
+
+ KERNEL_ARTIFACT_NAME ?= "${PKGE}-${PKGV}-${PKGR}-${MACHINE}${IMAGE_VERSION_SUFFIX}"
+
+ KERNEL_IMAGE_LINK_NAME
+ The link name for the kernel image. This variable is set in the
+ ``meta/classes/kernel-artifact-names.bbclass`` file as follows:
+ ::
+
+ KERNEL_IMAGE_LINK_NAME ?= "${KERNEL_ARTIFACT_LINK_NAME}"
+
+ The value of
+ the ``KERNEL_ARTIFACT_LINK_NAME`` variable, which is set in the same
+ file, has the following value:
+ ::
+
+ KERNEL_ARTIFACT_LINK_NAME ?= "${MACHINE}"
+
+ See the :term:`MACHINE` variable for additional
+ information.
+
+ KERNEL_IMAGE_MAXSIZE
+ Specifies the maximum size of the kernel image file in kilobytes. If
+ ``KERNEL_IMAGE_MAXSIZE`` is set, the size of the kernel image file is
+ checked against the set value during the
+ :ref:`ref-tasks-sizecheck` task. The task fails if
+ the kernel image file is larger than the setting.
+
+ ``KERNEL_IMAGE_MAXSIZE`` is useful for target devices that have a
+ limited amount of space in which the kernel image must be stored.
+
+ By default, this variable is not set, which means the size of the
+ kernel image is not checked.
+
+ KERNEL_IMAGE_NAME
+ The base name of the kernel image. This variable is set in the
+ ``meta/classes/kernel-artifact-names.bbclass`` file as follows:
+ ::
+
+ KERNEL_IMAGE_NAME ?= "${KERNEL_ARTIFACT_NAME}"
+
+ The value of the
+ :term:`KERNEL_ARTIFACT_NAME` variable,
+ which is set in the same file, has the following value:
+ ::
+
+ KERNEL_ARTIFACT_NAME ?= "${PKGE}-${PKGV}-${PKGR}-${MACHINE}${IMAGE_VERSION_SUFFIX}"
+
+ KERNEL_IMAGETYPE
+ The type of kernel to build for a device, usually set by the machine
+ configuration files and defaults to "zImage". This variable is used
+ when building the kernel and is passed to ``make`` as the target to
+ build.
+
+ If you want to build an alternate kernel image type, use the
+ :term:`KERNEL_ALT_IMAGETYPE` variable.
+
+ KERNEL_MODULE_AUTOLOAD
+ Lists kernel modules that need to be auto-loaded during boot.
+
+ .. note::
+
+ This variable replaces the deprecated
+ module_autoload
+ variable.
+
+ You can use the ``KERNEL_MODULE_AUTOLOAD`` variable anywhere that it
+ can be recognized by the kernel recipe or by an out-of-tree kernel
+ module recipe (e.g. a machine configuration file, a distribution
+ configuration file, an append file for the recipe, or the recipe
+ itself).
+
+ Specify it as follows:
+ ::
+
+ KERNEL_MODULE_AUTOLOAD += "module_name1 module_name2 module_name3"
+
+ Including ``KERNEL_MODULE_AUTOLOAD`` causes the OpenEmbedded build
+ system to populate the ``/etc/modules-load.d/modname.conf`` file with
+ the list of modules to be auto-loaded on boot. The modules appear
+ one-per-line in the file. Here is an example of the most common use
+ case:
+ ::
+
+ KERNEL_MODULE_AUTOLOAD += "module_name"
+
+ For information on how to populate the ``modname.conf`` file with
+ ``modprobe.d`` syntax lines, see the :term:`KERNEL_MODULE_PROBECONF` variable.
+
+ KERNEL_MODULE_PROBECONF
+ Provides a list of modules for which the OpenEmbedded build system
+ expects to find ``module_conf_``\ modname values that specify
+ configuration for each of the modules. For information on how to
+ provide those module configurations, see the
+ :term:`module_conf_* <module_conf>` variable.
+
+ KERNEL_PATH
+ The location of the kernel sources. This variable is set to the value
+ of the :term:`STAGING_KERNEL_DIR` within
+ the :ref:`module <ref-classes-module>` class. For information on
+ how this variable is used, see the
+ ":ref:`kernel-dev/kernel-dev-common:incorporating out-of-tree modules`"
+ section in the Yocto Project Linux Kernel Development Manual.
+
+ To help maximize compatibility with out-of-tree drivers used to build
+ modules, the OpenEmbedded build system also recognizes and uses the
+ :term:`KERNEL_SRC` variable, which is identical to
+ the ``KERNEL_PATH`` variable. Both variables are common variables
+ used by external Makefiles to point to the kernel source directory.
+
+ KERNEL_SRC
+ The location of the kernel sources. This variable is set to the value
+ of the :term:`STAGING_KERNEL_DIR` within
+ the :ref:`module <ref-classes-module>` class. For information on
+ how this variable is used, see the
+ ":ref:`kernel-dev/kernel-dev-common:incorporating out-of-tree modules`"
+ section in the Yocto Project Linux Kernel Development Manual.
+
+ To help maximize compatibility with out-of-tree drivers used to build
+ modules, the OpenEmbedded build system also recognizes and uses the
+ :term:`KERNEL_PATH` variable, which is identical
+ to the ``KERNEL_SRC`` variable. Both variables are common variables
+ used by external Makefiles to point to the kernel source directory.
+
+ KERNEL_VERSION
+ Specifies the version of the kernel as extracted from ``version.h``
+ or ``utsrelease.h`` within the kernel sources. Effects of setting
+ this variable do not take affect until the kernel has been
+ configured. Consequently, attempting to refer to this variable in
+ contexts prior to configuration will not work.
+
+ KERNELDEPMODDEPEND
+ Specifies whether the data referenced through
+ :term:`PKGDATA_DIR` is needed or not. The
+ ``KERNELDEPMODDEPEND`` does not control whether or not that data
+ exists, but simply whether or not it is used. If you do not need to
+ use the data, set the ``KERNELDEPMODDEPEND`` variable in your
+ ``initramfs`` recipe. Setting the variable there when the data is not
+ needed avoids a potential dependency loop.
+
+ KFEATURE_DESCRIPTION
+ Provides a short description of a configuration fragment. You use
+ this variable in the ``.scc`` file that describes a configuration
+ fragment file. Here is the variable used in a file named ``smp.scc``
+ to describe SMP being enabled:
+ ::
+
+ define KFEATURE_DESCRIPTION "Enable SMP"
+
+ KMACHINE
+ The machine as known by the kernel. Sometimes the machine name used
+ by the kernel does not match the machine name used by the
+ OpenEmbedded build system. For example, the machine name that the
+ OpenEmbedded build system understands as ``core2-32-intel-common``
+ goes by a different name in the Linux Yocto kernel. The kernel
+ understands that machine as ``intel-core2-32``. For cases like these,
+ the ``KMACHINE`` variable maps the kernel machine name to the
+ OpenEmbedded build system machine name.
+
+ These mappings between different names occur in the Yocto Linux
+ Kernel's ``meta`` branch. As an example take a look in the
+ ``common/recipes-kernel/linux/linux-yocto_3.19.bbappend`` file:
+ ::
+
+ LINUX_VERSION_core2-32-intel-common = "3.19.0"
+ COMPATIBLE_MACHINE_core2-32-intel-common = "${MACHINE}"
+ SRCREV_meta_core2-32-intel-common = "8897ef68b30e7426bc1d39895e71fb155d694974"
+ SRCREV_machine_core2-32-intel-common = "43b9eced9ba8a57add36af07736344dcc383f711"
+ KMACHINE_core2-32-intel-common = "intel-core2-32"
+ KBRANCH_core2-32-intel-common = "standard/base"
+ KERNEL_FEATURES_append_core2-32-intel-common = "${KERNEL_FEATURES_INTEL_COMMON}"
+
+ The ``KMACHINE`` statement says
+ that the kernel understands the machine name as "intel-core2-32".
+ However, the OpenEmbedded build system understands the machine as
+ "core2-32-intel-common".
+
+ KTYPE
+ Defines the kernel type to be used in assembling the configuration.
+ The linux-yocto recipes define "standard", "tiny", and "preempt-rt"
+ kernel types. See the ":ref:`kernel-dev/kernel-dev-advanced:kernel types`"
+ section in the
+ Yocto Project Linux Kernel Development Manual for more information on
+ kernel types.
+
+ You define the ``KTYPE`` variable in the
+ :ref:`kernel-dev/kernel-dev-advanced:bsp descriptions`. The
+ value you use must match the value used for the
+ :term:`LINUX_KERNEL_TYPE` value used by the
+ kernel recipe.
+
+ LABELS
+ Provides a list of targets for automatic configuration.
+
+ See the :ref:`grub-efi <ref-classes-grub-efi>` class for more
+ information on how this variable is used.
+
+ LAYERDEPENDS
+ Lists the layers, separated by spaces, on which this recipe depends.
+ Optionally, you can specify a specific layer version for a dependency
+ by adding it to the end of the layer name. Here is an example:
+ ::
+
+ LAYERDEPENDS_mylayer = "anotherlayer (=3)"
+
+ In this previous example,
+ version 3 of "anotherlayer" is compared against
+ :term:`LAYERVERSION`\ ``_anotherlayer``.
+
+ An error is produced if any dependency is missing or the version
+ numbers (if specified) do not match exactly. This variable is used in
+ the ``conf/layer.conf`` file and must be suffixed with the name of
+ the specific layer (e.g. ``LAYERDEPENDS_mylayer``).
+
+ LAYERDIR
+ When used inside the ``layer.conf`` configuration file, this variable
+ provides the path of the current layer. This variable is not
+ available outside of ``layer.conf`` and references are expanded
+ immediately when parsing of the file completes.
+
+ LAYERRECOMMENDS
+ Lists the layers, separated by spaces, recommended for use with this
+ layer.
+
+ Optionally, you can specify a specific layer version for a
+ recommendation by adding the version to the end of the layer name.
+ Here is an example:
+ ::
+
+ LAYERRECOMMENDS_mylayer = "anotherlayer (=3)"
+
+ In this previous example, version 3 of "anotherlayer" is compared
+ against ``LAYERVERSION_anotherlayer``.
+
+ This variable is used in the ``conf/layer.conf`` file and must be
+ suffixed with the name of the specific layer (e.g.
+ ``LAYERRECOMMENDS_mylayer``).
+
+ LAYERSERIES_COMPAT
+ Lists the versions of the :term:`OpenEmbedded-Core (OE-Core)` for which
+ a layer is compatible. Using the ``LAYERSERIES_COMPAT`` variable
+ allows the layer maintainer to indicate which combinations of the
+ layer and OE-Core can be expected to work. The variable gives the
+ system a way to detect when a layer has not been tested with new
+ releases of OE-Core (e.g. the layer is not maintained).
+
+ To specify the OE-Core versions for which a layer is compatible, use
+ this variable in your layer's ``conf/layer.conf`` configuration file.
+ For the list, use the Yocto Project
+ :yocto_wiki:`Release Name </wiki/Releases>` (e.g.
+ DISTRO_NAME_NO_CAP). To specify multiple OE-Core versions for the
+ layer, use a space-separated list:
+ ::
+
+ LAYERSERIES_COMPAT_layer_root_name = "DISTRO_NAME_NO_CAP DISTRO_NAME_NO_CAP_MINUS_ONE"
+
+ .. note::
+
+ Setting
+ LAYERSERIES_COMPAT
+ is required by the Yocto Project Compatible version 2 standard.
+ The OpenEmbedded build system produces a warning if the variable
+ is not set for any given layer.
+
+ See the ":ref:`dev-manual/dev-manual-common-tasks:creating your own layer`"
+ section in the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual.
+
+ LAYERVERSION
+ Optionally specifies the version of a layer as a single number. You
+ can use this within :term:`LAYERDEPENDS` for
+ another layer in order to depend on a specific version of the layer.
+ This variable is used in the ``conf/layer.conf`` file and must be
+ suffixed with the name of the specific layer (e.g.
+ ``LAYERVERSION_mylayer``).
+
+ LD
+ The minimal command and arguments used to run the linker.
+
+ LDFLAGS
+ Specifies the flags to pass to the linker. This variable is exported
+ to an environment variable and thus made visible to the software
+ being built during the compilation step.
+
+ Default initialization for ``LDFLAGS`` varies depending on what is
+ being built:
+
+ - :term:`TARGET_LDFLAGS` when building for the
+ target
+
+ - :term:`BUILD_LDFLAGS` when building for the
+ build host (i.e. ``-native``)
+
+ - :term:`BUILDSDK_LDFLAGS` when building for
+ an SDK (i.e. ``nativesdk-``)
+
+ LEAD_SONAME
+ Specifies the lead (or primary) compiled library file (i.e. ``.so``)
+ that the :ref:`debian <ref-classes-debian>` class applies its
+ naming policy to given a recipe that packages multiple libraries.
+
+ This variable works in conjunction with the ``debian`` class.
+
+ LIC_FILES_CHKSUM
+ Checksums of the license text in the recipe source code.
+
+ This variable tracks changes in license text of the source code
+ files. If the license text is changed, it will trigger a build
+ failure, which gives the developer an opportunity to review any
+ license change.
+
+ This variable must be defined for all recipes (unless
+ :term:`LICENSE` is set to "CLOSED").
+
+ For more information, see the ":ref:`usingpoky-configuring-lic_files_chksum`"
+ section in the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual.
+
+ LICENSE
+ The list of source licenses for the recipe. Follow these rules:
+
+ - Do not use spaces within individual license names.
+
+ - Separate license names using \| (pipe) when there is a choice
+ between licenses.
+
+ - Separate license names using & (ampersand) when multiple licenses
+ exist that cover different parts of the source.
+
+ - You can use spaces between license names.
+
+ - For standard licenses, use the names of the files in
+ ``meta/files/common-licenses/`` or the
+ :term:`SPDXLICENSEMAP` flag names defined in
+ ``meta/conf/licenses.conf``.
+
+ Here are some examples:
+ ::
+
+ LICENSE = "LGPLv2.1 | GPLv3"
+ LICENSE = "MPL-1 & LGPLv2.1"
+ LICENSE = "GPLv2+"
+
+ The first example is from the
+ recipes for Qt, which the user may choose to distribute under either
+ the LGPL version 2.1 or GPL version 3. The second example is from
+ Cairo where two licenses cover different parts of the source code.
+ The final example is from ``sysstat``, which presents a single
+ license.
+
+ You can also specify licenses on a per-package basis to handle
+ situations where components of the output have different licenses.
+ For example, a piece of software whose code is licensed under GPLv2
+ but has accompanying documentation licensed under the GNU Free
+ Documentation License 1.2 could be specified as follows:
+ ::
+
+ LICENSE = "GFDL-1.2 & GPLv2"
+ LICENSE_${PN} = "GPLv2"
+ LICENSE_${PN}-doc = "GFDL-1.2"
+
+ LICENSE_CREATE_PACKAGE
+ Setting ``LICENSE_CREATE_PACKAGE`` to "1" causes the OpenEmbedded
+ build system to create an extra package (i.e.
+ ``${``\ :term:`PN`\ ``}-lic``) for each recipe and to add
+ those packages to the
+ :term:`RRECOMMENDS`\ ``_${PN}``.
+
+ The ``${PN}-lic`` package installs a directory in
+ ``/usr/share/licenses`` named ``${PN}``, which is the recipe's base
+ name, and installs files in that directory that contain license and
+ copyright information (i.e. copies of the appropriate license files
+ from ``meta/common-licenses`` that match the licenses specified in
+ the :term:`LICENSE` variable of the recipe metadata
+ and copies of files marked in
+ :term:`LIC_FILES_CHKSUM` as containing
+ license text).
+
+ For related information on providing license text, see the
+ :term:`COPY_LIC_DIRS` variable, the
+ :term:`COPY_LIC_MANIFEST` variable, and the
+ ":ref:`dev-manual/dev-manual-common-tasks:providing license text`"
+ section in the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual.
+
+ LICENSE_FLAGS
+ Specifies additional flags for a recipe you must whitelist through
+ :term:`LICENSE_FLAGS_WHITELIST` in
+ order to allow the recipe to be built. When providing multiple flags,
+ separate them with spaces.
+
+ This value is independent of :term:`LICENSE` and is
+ typically used to mark recipes that might require additional licenses
+ in order to be used in a commercial product. For more information,
+ see the
+ ":ref:`dev-manual/dev-manual-common-tasks:enabling commercially licensed recipes`"
+ section in the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual.
+
+ LICENSE_FLAGS_WHITELIST
+ Lists license flags that when specified in
+ :term:`LICENSE_FLAGS` within a recipe should not
+ prevent that recipe from being built. This practice is otherwise
+ known as "whitelisting" license flags. For more information, see the
+ ":ref:`dev-manual/dev-manual-common-tasks:enabling commercially licensed recipes`"
+ section in the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual.
+
+ LICENSE_PATH
+ Path to additional licenses used during the build. By default, the
+ OpenEmbedded build system uses ``COMMON_LICENSE_DIR`` to define the
+ directory that holds common license text used during the build. The
+ ``LICENSE_PATH`` variable allows you to extend that location to other
+ areas that have additional licenses:
+ ::
+
+ LICENSE_PATH += "path-to-additional-common-licenses"
+
+ LINUX_KERNEL_TYPE
+ Defines the kernel type to be used in assembling the configuration.
+ The linux-yocto recipes define "standard", "tiny", and "preempt-rt"
+ kernel types. See the ":ref:`kernel-dev/kernel-dev-advanced:kernel types`"
+ section in the
+ Yocto Project Linux Kernel Development Manual for more information on
+ kernel types.
+
+ If you do not specify a ``LINUX_KERNEL_TYPE``, it defaults to
+ "standard". Together with :term:`KMACHINE`, the
+ ``LINUX_KERNEL_TYPE`` variable defines the search arguments used by
+ the kernel tools to find the appropriate description within the
+ kernel :term:`Metadata` with which to build out the sources
+ and configuration.
+
+ LINUX_VERSION
+ The Linux version from ``kernel.org`` on which the Linux kernel image
+ being built using the OpenEmbedded build system is based. You define
+ this variable in the kernel recipe. For example, the
+ ``linux-yocto-3.4.bb`` kernel recipe found in
+ ``meta/recipes-kernel/linux`` defines the variables as follows:
+ ::
+
+ LINUX_VERSION ?= "3.4.24"
+
+ The ``LINUX_VERSION`` variable is used to define :term:`PV`
+ for the recipe:
+ ::
+
+ PV = "${LINUX_VERSION}+git${SRCPV}"
+
+ LINUX_VERSION_EXTENSION
+ A string extension compiled into the version string of the Linux
+ kernel built with the OpenEmbedded build system. You define this
+ variable in the kernel recipe. For example, the linux-yocto kernel
+ recipes all define the variable as follows:
+ ::
+
+ LINUX_VERSION_EXTENSION ?= "-yocto-${LINUX_KERNEL_TYPE}"
+
+ Defining this variable essentially sets the Linux kernel
+ configuration item ``CONFIG_LOCALVERSION``, which is visible through
+ the ``uname`` command. Here is an example that shows the extension
+ assuming it was set as previously shown:
+ ::
+
+ $ uname -r
+ 3.7.0-rc8-custom
+
+ LOG_DIR
+ Specifies the directory to which the OpenEmbedded build system writes
+ overall log files. The default directory is ``${TMPDIR}/log``.
+
+ For the directory containing logs specific to each task, see the
+ :term:`T` variable.
+
+ MACHINE
+ Specifies the target device for which the image is built. You define
+ ``MACHINE`` in the ``local.conf`` file found in the
+ :term:`Build Directory`. By default, ``MACHINE`` is set to
+ "qemux86", which is an x86-based architecture machine to be emulated
+ using QEMU:
+ ::
+
+ MACHINE ?= "qemux86"
+
+ The variable corresponds to a machine configuration file of the same
+ name, through which machine-specific configurations are set. Thus,
+ when ``MACHINE`` is set to "qemux86" there exists the corresponding
+ ``qemux86.conf`` machine configuration file, which can be found in
+ the :term:`Source Directory` in
+ ``meta/conf/machine``.
+
+ The list of machines supported by the Yocto Project as shipped
+ include the following:
+ ::
+
+ MACHINE ?= "qemuarm"
+ MACHINE ?= "qemuarm64"
+ MACHINE ?= "qemumips"
+ MACHINE ?= "qemumips64"
+ MACHINE ?= "qemuppc"
+ MACHINE ?= "qemux86"
+ MACHINE ?= "qemux86-64"
+ MACHINE ?= "genericx86"
+ MACHINE ?= "genericx86-64"
+ MACHINE ?= "beaglebone"
+ MACHINE ?= "edgerouter"
+
+ The last five are Yocto Project reference hardware
+ boards, which are provided in the ``meta-yocto-bsp`` layer.
+
+ .. note::
+
+ Adding additional Board Support Package (BSP) layers to your
+ configuration adds new possible settings for
+ MACHINE
+ .
+
+ MACHINE_ARCH
+ Specifies the name of the machine-specific architecture. This
+ variable is set automatically from :term:`MACHINE` or
+ :term:`TUNE_PKGARCH`. You should not hand-edit
+ the ``MACHINE_ARCH`` variable.
+
+ MACHINE_ESSENTIAL_EXTRA_RDEPENDS
+ A list of required machine-specific packages to install as part of
+ the image being built. The build process depends on these packages
+ being present. Furthermore, because this is a "machine-essential"
+ variable, the list of packages are essential for the machine to boot.
+ The impact of this variable affects images based on
+ ``packagegroup-core-boot``, including the ``core-image-minimal``
+ image.
+
+ This variable is similar to the
+ ``MACHINE_ESSENTIAL_EXTRA_RRECOMMENDS`` variable with the exception
+ that the image being built has a build dependency on the variable's
+ list of packages. In other words, the image will not build if a file
+ in this list is not found.
+
+ As an example, suppose the machine for which you are building
+ requires ``example-init`` to be run during boot to initialize the
+ hardware. In this case, you would use the following in the machine's
+ ``.conf`` configuration file:
+ ::
+
+ MACHINE_ESSENTIAL_EXTRA_RDEPENDS += "example-init"
+
+ MACHINE_ESSENTIAL_EXTRA_RRECOMMENDS
+ A list of recommended machine-specific packages to install as part of
+ the image being built. The build process does not depend on these
+ packages being present. However, because this is a
+ "machine-essential" variable, the list of packages are essential for
+ the machine to boot. The impact of this variable affects images based
+ on ``packagegroup-core-boot``, including the ``core-image-minimal``
+ image.
+
+ This variable is similar to the ``MACHINE_ESSENTIAL_EXTRA_RDEPENDS``
+ variable with the exception that the image being built does not have
+ a build dependency on the variable's list of packages. In other
+ words, the image will still build if a package in this list is not
+ found. Typically, this variable is used to handle essential kernel
+ modules, whose functionality may be selected to be built into the
+ kernel rather than as a module, in which case a package will not be
+ produced.
+
+ Consider an example where you have a custom kernel where a specific
+ touchscreen driver is required for the machine to be usable. However,
+ the driver can be built as a module or into the kernel depending on
+ the kernel configuration. If the driver is built as a module, you
+ want it to be installed. But, when the driver is built into the
+ kernel, you still want the build to succeed. This variable sets up a
+ "recommends" relationship so that in the latter case, the build will
+ not fail due to the missing package. To accomplish this, assuming the
+ package for the module was called ``kernel-module-ab123``, you would
+ use the following in the machine's ``.conf`` configuration file:
+ ::
+
+ MACHINE_ESSENTIAL_EXTRA_RRECOMMENDS += "kernel-module-ab123"
+
+ .. note::
+
+ In this example, the
+ kernel-module-ab123
+ recipe needs to explicitly set its
+ PACKAGES
+ variable to ensure that BitBake does not use the kernel recipe's
+ PACKAGES_DYNAMIC
+ variable to satisfy the dependency.
+
+ Some examples of these machine essentials are flash, screen,
+ keyboard, mouse, or touchscreen drivers (depending on the machine).
+
+ MACHINE_EXTRA_RDEPENDS
+ A list of machine-specific packages to install as part of the image
+ being built that are not essential for the machine to boot. However,
+ the build process for more fully-featured images depends on the
+ packages being present.
+
+ This variable affects all images based on ``packagegroup-base``,
+ which does not include the ``core-image-minimal`` or
+ ``core-image-full-cmdline`` images.
+
+ The variable is similar to the ``MACHINE_EXTRA_RRECOMMENDS`` variable
+ with the exception that the image being built has a build dependency
+ on the variable's list of packages. In other words, the image will
+ not build if a file in this list is not found.
+
+ An example is a machine that has WiFi capability but is not essential
+ for the machine to boot the image. However, if you are building a
+ more fully-featured image, you want to enable the WiFi. The package
+ containing the firmware for the WiFi hardware is always expected to
+ exist, so it is acceptable for the build process to depend upon
+ finding the package. In this case, assuming the package for the
+ firmware was called ``wifidriver-firmware``, you would use the
+ following in the ``.conf`` file for the machine:
+ ::
+
+ MACHINE_EXTRA_RDEPENDS += "wifidriver-firmware"
+
+ MACHINE_EXTRA_RRECOMMENDS
+ A list of machine-specific packages to install as part of the image
+ being built that are not essential for booting the machine. The image
+ being built has no build dependency on this list of packages.
+
+ This variable affects only images based on ``packagegroup-base``,
+ which does not include the ``core-image-minimal`` or
+ ``core-image-full-cmdline`` images.
+
+ This variable is similar to the ``MACHINE_EXTRA_RDEPENDS`` variable
+ with the exception that the image being built does not have a build
+ dependency on the variable's list of packages. In other words, the
+ image will build if a file in this list is not found.
+
+ An example is a machine that has WiFi capability but is not essential
+ For the machine to boot the image. However, if you are building a
+ more fully-featured image, you want to enable WiFi. In this case, the
+ package containing the WiFi kernel module will not be produced if the
+ WiFi driver is built into the kernel, in which case you still want
+ the build to succeed instead of failing as a result of the package
+ not being found. To accomplish this, assuming the package for the
+ module was called ``kernel-module-examplewifi``, you would use the
+ following in the ``.conf`` file for the machine:
+ ::
+
+ MACHINE_EXTRA_RRECOMMENDS += "kernel-module-examplewifi"
+
+ MACHINE_FEATURES
+ Specifies the list of hardware features the
+ :term:`MACHINE` is capable of supporting. For related
+ information on enabling features, see the
+ :term:`DISTRO_FEATURES`,
+ :term:`COMBINED_FEATURES`, and
+ :term:`IMAGE_FEATURES` variables.
+
+ For a list of hardware features supported by the Yocto Project as
+ shipped, see the "`Machine Features <#ref-features-machine>`__"
+ section.
+
+ MACHINE_FEATURES_BACKFILL
+ Features to be added to ``MACHINE_FEATURES`` if not also present in
+ ``MACHINE_FEATURES_BACKFILL_CONSIDERED``.
+
+ This variable is set in the ``meta/conf/bitbake.conf`` file. It is
+ not intended to be user-configurable. It is best to just reference
+ the variable to see which machine features are being backfilled for
+ all machine configurations. See the "`Feature
+ Backfilling <#ref-features-backfill>`__" section for more
+ information.
+
+ MACHINE_FEATURES_BACKFILL_CONSIDERED
+ Features from ``MACHINE_FEATURES_BACKFILL`` that should not be
+ backfilled (i.e. added to ``MACHINE_FEATURES``) during the build. See
+ the "`Feature Backfilling <#ref-features-backfill>`__" section for
+ more information.
+
+ MACHINEOVERRIDES
+ A colon-separated list of overrides that apply to the current
+ machine. By default, this list includes the value of
+ :term:`MACHINE`.
+
+ You can extend ``MACHINEOVERRIDES`` to add extra overrides that
+ should apply to a machine. For example, all machines emulated in QEMU
+ (e.g. ``qemuarm``, ``qemux86``, and so forth) include a file named
+ ``meta/conf/machine/include/qemu.inc`` that prepends the following
+ override to ``MACHINEOVERRIDES``:
+ ::
+
+ MACHINEOVERRIDES =. "qemuall:"
+
+ This
+ override allows variables to be overriden for all machines emulated
+ in QEMU, like in the following example from the ``connman-conf``
+ recipe:
+ ::
+
+ SRC_URI_append_qemuall = "file://wired.config \
+ file://wired-setup \
+ "
+
+ The underlying mechanism behind
+ ``MACHINEOVERRIDES`` is simply that it is included in the default
+ value of :term:`OVERRIDES`.
+
+ MAINTAINER
+ The email address of the distribution maintainer.
+
+ MIRRORS
+ Specifies additional paths from which the OpenEmbedded build system
+ gets source code. When the build system searches for source code, it
+ first tries the local download directory. If that location fails, the
+ build system tries locations defined by
+ :term:`PREMIRRORS`, the upstream source, and then
+ locations specified by ``MIRRORS`` in that order.
+
+ Assuming your distribution (:term:`DISTRO`) is "poky",
+ the default value for ``MIRRORS`` is defined in the
+ ``conf/distro/poky.conf`` file in the ``meta-poky`` Git repository.
+
+ MLPREFIX
+ Specifies a prefix has been added to :term:`PN` to create a
+ special version of a recipe or package (i.e. a Multilib version). The
+ variable is used in places where the prefix needs to be added to or
+ removed from a the name (e.g. the :term:`BPN` variable).
+ ``MLPREFIX`` gets set when a prefix has been added to ``PN``.
+
+ .. note::
+
+ The "ML" in
+ MLPREFIX
+ stands for "MultiLib". This representation is historical and comes
+ from a time when
+ nativesdk
+ was a suffix rather than a prefix on the recipe name. When
+ nativesdk
+ was turned into a prefix, it made sense to set
+ MLPREFIX
+ for it as well.
+
+ To help understand when ``MLPREFIX`` might be needed, consider when
+ :term:`BBCLASSEXTEND` is used to provide a
+ ``nativesdk`` version of a recipe in addition to the target version.
+ If that recipe declares build-time dependencies on tasks in other
+ recipes by using :term:`DEPENDS`, then a dependency on
+ "foo" will automatically get rewritten to a dependency on
+ "nativesdk-foo". However, dependencies like the following will not
+ get rewritten automatically:
+ ::
+
+ do_foo[depends] += "recipe:do_foo"
+
+ If you want such a dependency to also get transformed, you can do the
+ following:
+ ::
+
+ do_foo[depends] += "${MLPREFIX}recipe:do_foo"
+
+ module_autoload
+ This variable has been replaced by the ``KERNEL_MODULE_AUTOLOAD``
+ variable. You should replace all occurrences of ``module_autoload``
+ with additions to ``KERNEL_MODULE_AUTOLOAD``, for example:
+ ::
+
+ module_autoload_rfcomm = "rfcomm"
+
+ should now be replaced with:
+ ::
+
+ KERNEL_MODULE_AUTOLOAD += "rfcomm"
+
+ See the :term:`KERNEL_MODULE_AUTOLOAD` variable for more information.
+
+ module_conf
+ Specifies `modprobe.d <http://linux.die.net/man/5/modprobe.d>`_
+ syntax lines for inclusion in the ``/etc/modprobe.d/modname.conf``
+ file.
+
+ You can use this variable anywhere that it can be recognized by the
+ kernel recipe or out-of-tree kernel module recipe (e.g. a machine
+ configuration file, a distribution configuration file, an append file
+ for the recipe, or the recipe itself). If you use this variable, you
+ must also be sure to list the module name in the
+ :term:`KERNEL_MODULE_AUTOLOAD`
+ variable.
+
+ Here is the general syntax:
+ ::
+
+ module_conf_module_name = "modprobe.d-syntax"
+
+ You must use the kernel module name override.
+
+ Run ``man modprobe.d`` in the shell to find out more information on
+ the exact syntax you want to provide with ``module_conf``.
+
+ Including ``module_conf`` causes the OpenEmbedded build system to
+ populate the ``/etc/modprobe.d/modname.conf`` file with
+ ``modprobe.d`` syntax lines. Here is an example that adds the options
+ ``arg1`` and ``arg2`` to a module named ``mymodule``:
+ ::
+
+ module_conf_mymodule = "options mymodule arg1=val1 arg2=val2"
+
+ For information on how to specify kernel modules to auto-load on
+ boot, see the :term:`KERNEL_MODULE_AUTOLOAD` variable.
+
+ MODULE_TARBALL_DEPLOY
+ Controls creation of the ``modules-*.tgz`` file. Set this variable to
+ "0" to disable creation of this file, which contains all of the
+ kernel modules resulting from a kernel build.
+
+ MODULE_TARBALL_LINK_NAME
+ The link name of the kernel module tarball. This variable is set in
+ the ``meta/classes/kernel-artifact-names.bbclass`` file as follows:
+ ::
+
+ MODULE_TARBALL_LINK_NAME ?= "${KERNEL_ARTIFACT_LINK_NAME}"
+
+ The value
+ of the ``KERNEL_ARTIFACT_LINK_NAME`` variable, which is set in the
+ same file, has the following value:
+ ::
+
+ KERNEL_ARTIFACT_LINK_NAME ?= "${MACHINE}"
+
+ See the :term:`MACHINE` variable for additional information.
+
+ MODULE_TARBALL_NAME
+ The base name of the kernel module tarball. This variable is set in
+ the ``meta/classes/kernel-artifact-names.bbclass`` file as follows:
+ ::
+
+ MODULE_TARBALL_NAME ?= "${KERNEL_ARTIFACT_NAME}"
+
+ The value of the :term:`KERNEL_ARTIFACT_NAME` variable,
+ which is set in the same file, has the following value:
+ ::
+
+ KERNEL_ARTIFACT_NAME ?= "${PKGE}-${PKGV}-${PKGR}-${MACHINE}${IMAGE_VERSION_SUFFIX}"
+
+ MULTIMACH_TARGET_SYS
+ Uniquely identifies the type of the target system for which packages
+ are being built. This variable allows output for different types of
+ target systems to be put into different subdirectories of the same
+ output directory.
+
+ The default value of this variable is:
+ ::
+
+ ${PACKAGE_ARCH}${TARGET_VENDOR}-${TARGET_OS}
+
+ Some classes (e.g.
+ :ref:`cross-canadian <ref-classes-cross-canadian>`) modify the
+ ``MULTIMACH_TARGET_SYS`` value.
+
+ See the :term:`STAMP` variable for an example. See the
+ :term:`STAGING_DIR_TARGET` variable for more information.
+
+ NATIVELSBSTRING
+ A string identifying the host distribution. Strings consist of the
+ host distributor ID followed by the release, as reported by the
+ ``lsb_release`` tool or as read from ``/etc/lsb-release``. For
+ example, when running a build on Ubuntu 12.10, the value is
+ "Ubuntu-12.10". If this information is unable to be determined, the
+ value resolves to "Unknown".
+
+ This variable is used by default to isolate native shared state
+ packages for different distributions (e.g. to avoid problems with
+ ``glibc`` version incompatibilities). Additionally, the variable is
+ checked against
+ :term:`SANITY_TESTED_DISTROS` if that
+ variable is set.
+
+ NM
+ The minimal command and arguments to run ``nm``.
+
+ NO_GENERIC_LICENSE
+ Avoids QA errors when you use a non-common, non-CLOSED license in a
+ recipe. Packages exist, such as the linux-firmware package, with many
+ licenses that are not in any way common. Also, new licenses are added
+ occasionally to avoid introducing a lot of common license files,
+ which are only applicable to a specific package.
+ ``NO_GENERIC_LICENSE`` is used to allow copying a license that does
+ not exist in common licenses.
+
+ The following example shows how to add ``NO_GENERIC_LICENSE`` to a
+ recipe:
+ ::
+
+ NO_GENERIC_LICENSE[license_name] = "license_file_in_fetched_source"
+
+ The following is an example that
+ uses the ``LICENSE.Abilis.txt`` file as the license from the fetched
+ source:
+ ::
+
+ NO_GENERIC_LICENSE[Firmware-Abilis] = "LICENSE.Abilis.txt"
+
+ NO_RECOMMENDATIONS
+ Prevents installation of all "recommended-only" packages.
+ Recommended-only packages are packages installed only through the
+ :term:`RRECOMMENDS` variable). Setting the
+ ``NO_RECOMMENDATIONS`` variable to "1" turns this feature on: ::
+
+ NO_RECOMMENDATIONS = "1"
+
+ You can set this variable globally in your ``local.conf`` file or you
+ can attach it to a specific image recipe by using the recipe name
+ override: ::
+
+ NO_RECOMMENDATIONS_pn-target_image = "1"
+
+ It is important to realize that if you choose to not install packages
+ using this variable and some other packages are dependent on them
+ (i.e. listed in a recipe's :term:`RDEPENDS`
+ variable), the OpenEmbedded build system ignores your request and
+ will install the packages to avoid dependency errors.
+
+ .. note::
+
+ Some recommended packages might be required for certain system
+ functionality, such as kernel modules. It is up to you to add
+ packages with the IMAGE_INSTALL variable.
+
+ Support for this variable exists only when using the IPK and RPM
+ packaging backend. Support does not exist for DEB.
+
+ See the :term:`BAD_RECOMMENDATIONS` and
+ the :term:`PACKAGE_EXCLUDE` variables for
+ related information.
+
+ NOAUTOPACKAGEDEBUG
+ Disables auto package from splitting ``.debug`` files. If a recipe
+ requires ``FILES_${PN}-dbg`` to be set manually, the
+ ``NOAUTOPACKAGEDEBUG`` can be defined allowing you to define the
+ content of the debug package. For example:
+ ::
+
+ NOAUTOPACKAGEDEBUG = "1"
+ FILES_${PN}-dev = "${includedir}/${QT_DIR_NAME}/Qt/*"
+ FILES_${PN}-dbg = "/usr/src/debug/"
+ FILES_${QT_BASE_NAME}-demos-doc = "${docdir}/${QT_DIR_NAME}/qch/qt.qch"
+
+ OBJCOPY
+ The minimal command and arguments to run ``objcopy``.
+
+ OBJDUMP
+ The minimal command and arguments to run ``objdump``.
+
+ OE_BINCONFIG_EXTRA_MANGLE
+ When inheriting the :ref:`binconfig <ref-classes-binconfig>` class,
+ this variable specifies additional arguments passed to the "sed"
+ command. The sed command alters any paths in configuration scripts
+ that have been set up during compilation. Inheriting this class
+ results in all paths in these scripts being changed to point into the
+ ``sysroots/`` directory so that all builds that use the script will
+ use the correct directories for the cross compiling layout.
+
+ See the ``meta/classes/binconfig.bbclass`` in the
+ :term:`Source Directory` for details on how this class
+ applies these additional sed command arguments. For general
+ information on the ``binconfig`` class, see the
+ ":ref:`binconfig.bbclass <ref-classes-binconfig>`" section.
+
+ OE_IMPORTS
+ An internal variable used to tell the OpenEmbedded build system what
+ Python modules to import for every Python function run by the system.
+
+ .. note::
+
+ Do not set this variable. It is for internal use only.
+
+ OE_INIT_ENV_SCRIPT
+ The name of the build environment setup script for the purposes of
+ setting up the environment within the extensible SDK. The default
+ value is "oe-init-build-env".
+
+ If you use a custom script to set up your build environment, set the
+ ``OE_INIT_ENV_SCRIPT`` variable to its name.
+
+ OE_TERMINAL
+ Controls how the OpenEmbedded build system spawns interactive
+ terminals on the host development system (e.g. using the BitBake
+ command with the ``-c devshell`` command-line option). For more
+ information, see the ":ref:`platdev-appdev-devshell`" section in
+ the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual.
+
+ You can use the following values for the ``OE_TERMINAL`` variable:
+
+ - auto
+ - gnome
+ - xfce
+ - rxvt
+ - screen
+ - konsole
+ - none
+
+ OEROOT
+ The directory from which the top-level build environment setup script
+ is sourced. The Yocto Project provides a top-level build environment
+ setup script: ````` <#structure-core-script>`__. When you run this
+ script, the ``OEROOT`` variable resolves to the directory that
+ contains the script.
+
+ For additional information on how this variable is used, see the
+ initialization script.
+
+ OLDEST_KERNEL
+ Declares the oldest version of the Linux kernel that the produced
+ binaries must support. This variable is passed into the build of the
+ Embedded GNU C Library (``glibc``).
+
+ The default for this variable comes from the
+ ``meta/conf/bitbake.conf`` configuration file. You can override this
+ default by setting the variable in a custom distribution
+ configuration file.
+
+ OVERRIDES
+ A colon-separated list of overrides that currently apply. Overrides
+ are a BitBake mechanism that allows variables to be selectively
+ overridden at the end of parsing. The set of overrides in
+ ``OVERRIDES`` represents the "state" during building, which includes
+ the current recipe being built, the machine for which it is being
+ built, and so forth.
+
+ As an example, if the string "an-override" appears as an element in
+ the colon-separated list in ``OVERRIDES``, then the following
+ assignment will override ``FOO`` with the value "overridden" at the
+ end of parsing:
+ ::
+
+ FOO_an-override = "overridden"
+
+ See the
+ ":ref:`bitbake:bitbake-user-manual/bitbake-user-manual-metadata:conditional syntax (overrides)`"
+ section in the BitBake User Manual for more information on the
+ overrides mechanism.
+
+ The default value of ``OVERRIDES`` includes the values of the
+ :term:`CLASSOVERRIDE`,
+ :term:`MACHINEOVERRIDES`, and
+ :term:`DISTROOVERRIDES` variables. Another
+ important override included by default is ``pn-${PN}``. This override
+ allows variables to be set for a single recipe within configuration
+ (``.conf``) files. Here is an example:
+ ::
+
+ FOO_pn-myrecipe = "myrecipe-specific value"
+
+ .. note::
+
+ An easy way to see what overrides apply is to search for
+ OVERRIDES
+ in the output of the
+ bitbake -e
+ command. See the "
+ Viewing Variable Values
+ " section in the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual for more
+ information.
+
+ P
+ The recipe name and version. ``P`` is comprised of the following:
+ ::
+
+ ${PN}-${PV}
+
+ PACKAGE_ADD_METADATA
+ This variable defines additional metdata to add to packages.
+
+ You may find you need to inject additional metadata into packages.
+ This variable allows you to do that by setting the injected data as
+ the value. Multiple fields can be added by splitting the content with
+ the literal separator "\n".
+
+ The suffixes '_IPK', '_DEB', or '_RPM' can be applied to the variable
+ to do package type specific settings. It can also be made package
+ specific by using the package name as a suffix.
+
+ You can find out more about applying this variable in the
+ ":ref:`dev-manual/dev-manual-common-tasks:adding custom metadata to packages`"
+ section in the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual.
+
+ PACKAGE_ARCH
+ The architecture of the resulting package or packages.
+
+ By default, the value of this variable is set to
+ :term:`TUNE_PKGARCH` when building for the
+ target, :term:`BUILD_ARCH` when building for the
+ build host, and "${SDK_ARCH}-${SDKPKGSUFFIX}" when building for the
+ SDK.
+
+ .. note::
+
+ See
+ SDK_ARCH
+ for more information.
+
+ However, if your recipe's output packages are built specific to the
+ target machine rather than generally for the architecture of the
+ machine, you should set ``PACKAGE_ARCH`` to the value of
+ :term:`MACHINE_ARCH` in the recipe as follows:
+ ::
+
+ PACKAGE_ARCH = "${MACHINE_ARCH}"
+
+ PACKAGE_ARCHS
+ Specifies a list of architectures compatible with the target machine.
+ This variable is set automatically and should not normally be
+ hand-edited. Entries are separated using spaces and listed in order
+ of priority. The default value for ``PACKAGE_ARCHS`` is "all any
+ noarch ${PACKAGE_EXTRA_ARCHS} ${MACHINE_ARCH}".
+
+ PACKAGE_BEFORE_PN
+ Enables easily adding packages to ``PACKAGES`` before ``${PN}`` so
+ that those added packages can pick up files that would normally be
+ included in the default package.
+
+ PACKAGE_CLASSES
+ This variable, which is set in the ``local.conf`` configuration file
+ found in the ``conf`` folder of the
+ :term:`Build Directory`, specifies the package manager the
+ OpenEmbedded build system uses when packaging data.
+
+ You can provide one or more of the following arguments for the
+ variable: PACKAGE_CLASSES ?= "package_rpm package_deb package_ipk
+ package_tar"
+
+ .. note::
+
+ While it is a legal option, the
+ package_tar
+ class has limited functionality due to no support for package
+ dependencies by that backend. Therefore, it is recommended that
+ you do not use it.
+
+ The build system uses only the first argument in the list as the
+ package manager when creating your image or SDK. However, packages
+ will be created using any additional packaging classes you specify.
+ For example, if you use the following in your ``local.conf`` file:
+ ::
+
+ PACKAGE_CLASSES ?= "package_ipk"
+
+ The OpenEmbedded build system uses
+ the IPK package manager to create your image or SDK.
+
+ For information on packaging and build performance effects as a
+ result of the package manager in use, see the
+ ":ref:`package.bbclass <ref-classes-package>`" section.
+
+ PACKAGE_DEBUG_SPLIT_STYLE
+ Determines how to split up the binary and debug information when
+ creating ``*-dbg`` packages to be used with the GNU Project Debugger
+ (GDB).
+
+ With the ``PACKAGE_DEBUG_SPLIT_STYLE`` variable, you can control
+ where debug information, which can include or exclude source files,
+ is stored:
+
+ - ".debug": Debug symbol files are placed next to the binary in a
+ ``.debug`` directory on the target. For example, if a binary is
+ installed into ``/bin``, the corresponding debug symbol files are
+ installed in ``/bin/.debug``. Source files are placed in
+ ``/usr/src/debug``.
+
+ - "debug-file-directory": Debug symbol files are placed under
+ ``/usr/lib/debug`` on the target, and separated by the path from
+ where the binary is installed. For example, if a binary is
+ installed in ``/bin``, the corresponding debug symbols are
+ installed in ``/usr/lib/debug/bin``. Source files are placed in
+ ``/usr/src/debug``.
+
+ - "debug-without-src": The same behavior as ".debug" previously
+ described with the exception that no source files are installed.
+
+ - "debug-with-srcpkg": The same behavior as ".debug" previously
+ described with the exception that all source files are placed in a
+ separate ``*-src`` pkg. This is the default behavior.
+
+ You can find out more about debugging using GDB by reading the
+ ":ref:`platdev-gdb-remotedebug`" section
+ in the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual.
+
+ PACKAGE_EXCLUDE_COMPLEMENTARY
+ Prevents specific packages from being installed when you are
+ installing complementary packages.
+
+ You might find that you want to prevent installing certain packages
+ when you are installing complementary packages. For example, if you
+ are using :term:`IMAGE_FEATURES` to install
+ ``dev-pkgs``, you might not want to install all packages from a
+ particular multilib. If you find yourself in this situation, you can
+ use the ``PACKAGE_EXCLUDE_COMPLEMENTARY`` variable to specify regular
+ expressions to match the packages you want to exclude.
+
+ PACKAGE_EXCLUDE
+ Lists packages that should not be installed into an image. For
+ example:
+ ::
+
+ PACKAGE_EXCLUDE = "package_name package_name package_name ..."
+
+ You can set this variable globally in your ``local.conf`` file or you
+ can attach it to a specific image recipe by using the recipe name
+ override:
+ ::
+
+ PACKAGE_EXCLUDE_pn-target_image = "package_name"
+
+ If you choose to not install a package using this variable and some
+ other package is dependent on it (i.e. listed in a recipe's
+ :term:`RDEPENDS` variable), the OpenEmbedded build
+ system generates a fatal installation error. Because the build system
+ halts the process with a fatal error, you can use the variable with
+ an iterative development process to remove specific components from a
+ system.
+
+ Support for this variable exists only when using the IPK and RPM
+ packaging backend. Support does not exist for DEB.
+
+ See the :term:`NO_RECOMMENDATIONS` and the
+ :term:`BAD_RECOMMENDATIONS` variables for
+ related information.
+
+ PACKAGE_EXTRA_ARCHS
+ Specifies the list of architectures compatible with the device CPU.
+ This variable is useful when you build for several different devices
+ that use miscellaneous processors such as XScale and ARM926-EJS.
+
+ PACKAGE_FEED_ARCHS
+ Optionally specifies the package architectures used as part of the
+ package feed URIs during the build. When used, the
+ ``PACKAGE_FEED_ARCHS`` variable is appended to the final package feed
+ URI, which is constructed using the
+ :term:`PACKAGE_FEED_URIS` and
+ :term:`PACKAGE_FEED_BASE_PATHS`
+ variables.
+
+ .. note::
+
+ You can use the
+ PACKAGE_FEEDS_ARCHS
+ variable to whitelist specific package architectures. If you do
+ not need to whitelist specific architectures, which is a common
+ case, you can omit this variable. Omitting the variable results in
+ all available architectures for the current machine being included
+ into remote package feeds.
+
+ Consider the following example where the ``PACKAGE_FEED_URIS``,
+ ``PACKAGE_FEED_BASE_PATHS``, and ``PACKAGE_FEED_ARCHS`` variables are
+ defined in your ``local.conf`` file:
+ ::
+
+ PACKAGE_FEED_URIS = "https://example.com/packagerepos/release \
+ https://example.com/packagerepos/updates"
+ PACKAGE_FEED_BASE_PATHS = "rpm rpm-dev"
+ PACKAGE_FEED_ARCHS = "all core2-64"
+
+ Given these settings, the resulting package feeds are as follows:
+ ::
+
+ https://example.com/packagerepos/release/rpm/all
+ https://example.com/packagerepos/release/rpm/core2-64
+ https://example.com/packagerepos/release/rpm-dev/all
+ https://example.com/packagerepos/release/rpm-dev/core2-64
+ https://example.com/packagerepos/updates/rpm/all
+ https://example.com/packagerepos/updates/rpm/core2-64
+ https://example.com/packagerepos/updates/rpm-dev/all
+ https://example.com/packagerepos/updates/rpm-dev/core2-64
+
+ PACKAGE_FEED_BASE_PATHS
+ Specifies the base path used when constructing package feed URIs. The
+ ``PACKAGE_FEED_BASE_PATHS`` variable makes up the middle portion of a
+ package feed URI used by the OpenEmbedded build system. The base path
+ lies between the :term:`PACKAGE_FEED_URIS`
+ and :term:`PACKAGE_FEED_ARCHS` variables.
+
+ Consider the following example where the ``PACKAGE_FEED_URIS``,
+ ``PACKAGE_FEED_BASE_PATHS``, and ``PACKAGE_FEED_ARCHS`` variables are
+ defined in your ``local.conf`` file:
+ ::
+
+ PACKAGE_FEED_URIS = "https://example.com/packagerepos/release \
+ https://example.com/packagerepos/updates"
+ PACKAGE_FEED_BASE_PATHS = "rpm rpm-dev"
+ PACKAGE_FEED_ARCHS = "all core2-64"
+
+ Given these settings, the resulting package feeds are as follows:
+ ::
+
+ https://example.com/packagerepos/release/rpm/all
+ https://example.com/packagerepos/release/rpm/core2-64
+ https://example.com/packagerepos/release/rpm-dev/all
+ https://example.com/packagerepos/release/rpm-dev/core2-64
+ https://example.com/packagerepos/updates/rpm/all
+ https://example.com/packagerepos/updates/rpm/core2-64
+ https://example.com/packagerepos/updates/rpm-dev/all
+ https://example.com/packagerepos/updates/rpm-dev/core2-64
+
+ PACKAGE_FEED_URIS
+ Specifies the front portion of the package feed URI used by the
+ OpenEmbedded build system. Each final package feed URI is comprised
+ of ``PACKAGE_FEED_URIS``,
+ :term:`PACKAGE_FEED_BASE_PATHS`, and
+ :term:`PACKAGE_FEED_ARCHS` variables.
+
+ Consider the following example where the ``PACKAGE_FEED_URIS``,
+ ``PACKAGE_FEED_BASE_PATHS``, and ``PACKAGE_FEED_ARCHS`` variables are
+ defined in your ``local.conf`` file:
+ ::
+
+ PACKAGE_FEED_URIS = "https://example.com/packagerepos/release \
+ https://example.com/packagerepos/updates"
+ PACKAGE_FEED_BASE_PATHS = "rpm rpm-dev"
+ PACKAGE_FEED_ARCHS = "all core2-64"
+
+ Given these settings, the resulting package feeds are as follows:
+ ::
+
+ https://example.com/packagerepos/release/rpm/all
+ https://example.com/packagerepos/release/rpm/core2-64
+ https://example.com/packagerepos/release/rpm-dev/all
+ https://example.com/packagerepos/release/rpm-dev/core2-64
+ https://example.com/packagerepos/updates/rpm/all
+ https://example.com/packagerepos/updates/rpm/core2-64
+ https://example.com/packagerepos/updates/rpm-dev/all
+ https://example.com/packagerepos/updates/rpm-dev/core2-64
+
+ PACKAGE_INSTALL
+ The final list of packages passed to the package manager for
+ installation into the image.
+
+ Because the package manager controls actual installation of all
+ packages, the list of packages passed using ``PACKAGE_INSTALL`` is
+ not the final list of packages that are actually installed. This
+ variable is internal to the image construction code. Consequently, in
+ general, you should use the
+ :term:`IMAGE_INSTALL` variable to specify
+ packages for installation. The exception to this is when working with
+ the
+ ```core-image-minimal-initramfs`` <#images-core-image-minimal-initramfs>`__
+ image. When working with an initial RAM filesystem (initramfs) image,
+ use the ``PACKAGE_INSTALL`` variable. For information on creating an
+ initramfs, see the ":ref:`building-an-initramfs-image`" section
+ in the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual.
+
+ PACKAGE_INSTALL_ATTEMPTONLY
+ Specifies a list of packages the OpenEmbedded build system attempts
+ to install when creating an image. If a listed package fails to
+ install, the build system does not generate an error. This variable
+ is generally not user-defined.
+
+ PACKAGE_PREPROCESS_FUNCS
+ Specifies a list of functions run to pre-process the
+ :term:`PKGD` directory prior to splitting the files out
+ to individual packages.
+
+ PACKAGE_WRITE_DEPS
+ Specifies a list of dependencies for post-installation and
+ pre-installation scripts on native/cross tools. If your
+ post-installation or pre-installation script can execute at rootfs
+ creation time rather than on the target but depends on a native tool
+ in order to execute, you need to list the tools in
+ ``PACKAGE_WRITE_DEPS``.
+
+ For information on running post-installation scripts, see the
+ ":ref:`dev-manual/dev-manual-common-tasks:post-installation scripts`"
+ section in the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual.
+
+ PACKAGECONFIG
+ This variable provides a means of enabling or disabling features of a
+ recipe on a per-recipe basis. ``PACKAGECONFIG`` blocks are defined in
+ recipes when you specify features and then arguments that define
+ feature behaviors. Here is the basic block structure (broken over
+ multiple lines for readability):
+ ::
+
+ PACKAGECONFIG ??= "f1 f2 f3 ..."
+ PACKAGECONFIG[f1] = "\
+ --with-f1, \
+ --without-f1, \
+ build-deps-for-f1, \
+ runtime-deps-for-f1, \
+ runtime-recommends-for-f1, \
+ packageconfig-conflicts-for-f1"
+ PACKAGECONFIG[f2] = "\
+ ... and so on and so on ...
+
+ The ``PACKAGECONFIG`` variable itself specifies a space-separated
+ list of the features to enable. Following the features, you can
+ determine the behavior of each feature by providing up to six
+ order-dependent arguments, which are separated by commas. You can
+ omit any argument you like but must retain the separating commas. The
+ order is important and specifies the following:
+
+ 1. Extra arguments that should be added to the configure script
+ argument list (:term:`EXTRA_OECONF` or
+ :term:`PACKAGECONFIG_CONFARGS`) if
+ the feature is enabled.
+
+ 2. Extra arguments that should be added to ``EXTRA_OECONF`` or
+ ``PACKAGECONFIG_CONFARGS`` if the feature is disabled.
+
+ 3. Additional build dependencies (:term:`DEPENDS`)
+ that should be added if the feature is enabled.
+
+ 4. Additional runtime dependencies (:term:`RDEPENDS`)
+ that should be added if the feature is enabled.
+
+ 5. Additional runtime recommendations
+ (:term:`RRECOMMENDS`) that should be added if
+ the feature is enabled.
+
+ 6. Any conflicting (that is, mutually exclusive) ``PACKAGECONFIG``
+ settings for this feature.
+
+ Consider the following ``PACKAGECONFIG`` block taken from the
+ ``librsvg`` recipe. In this example the feature is ``gtk``, which has
+ three arguments that determine the feature's behavior.
+ ::
+
+ PACKAGECONFIG[gtk] = "--with-gtk3,--without-gtk3,gtk+3"
+
+ The
+ ``--with-gtk3`` and ``gtk+3`` arguments apply only if the feature is
+ enabled. In this case, ``--with-gtk3`` is added to the configure
+ script argument list and ``gtk+3`` is added to ``DEPENDS``. On the
+ other hand, if the feature is disabled say through a ``.bbappend``
+ file in another layer, then the second argument ``--without-gtk3`` is
+ added to the configure script instead.
+
+ The basic ``PACKAGECONFIG`` structure previously described holds true
+ regardless of whether you are creating a block or changing a block.
+ When creating a block, use the structure inside your recipe.
+
+ If you want to change an existing ``PACKAGECONFIG`` block, you can do
+ so one of two ways:
+
+ - *Append file:* Create an append file named
+ recipename\ ``.bbappend`` in your layer and override the value of
+ ``PACKAGECONFIG``. You can either completely override the
+ variable:
+ ::
+
+ PACKAGECONFIG = "f4 f5"
+
+ Or, you can just append the variable:
+ ::
+
+ PACKAGECONFIG_append = " f4"
+
+ - *Configuration file:* This method is identical to changing the
+ block through an append file except you edit your ``local.conf``
+ or ``mydistro.conf`` file. As with append files previously
+ described, you can either completely override the variable:
+ PACKAGECONFIG_pn-recipename = "f4 f5" Or, you can just amend the
+ variable:
+ ::
+
+ PACKAGECONFIG_append_pn-recipename = " f4"
+
+ PACKAGECONFIG_CONFARGS
+ A space-separated list of configuration options generated from the
+ :term:`PACKAGECONFIG` setting.
+
+ Classes such as :ref:`autotools <ref-classes-autotools>` and
+ :ref:`cmake <ref-classes-cmake>` use ``PACKAGECONFIG_CONFARGS`` to
+ pass ``PACKAGECONFIG`` options to ``configure`` and ``cmake``,
+ respectively. If you are using ``PACKAGECONFIG`` but not a class that
+ handles the ``do_configure`` task, then you need to use
+ ``PACKAGECONFIG_CONFARGS`` appropriately.
+
+ PACKAGEGROUP_DISABLE_COMPLEMENTARY
+ For recipes inheriting the
+ :ref:`packagegroup <ref-classes-packagegroup>` class, setting
+ ``PACKAGEGROUP_DISABLE_COMPLEMENTARY`` to "1" specifies that the
+ normal complementary packages (i.e. ``-dev``, ``-dbg``, and so forth)
+ should not be automatically created by the ``packagegroup`` recipe,
+ which is the default behavior.
+
+ PACKAGES
+ The list of packages the recipe creates. The default value is the
+ following:
+ ::
+
+ ${PN}-dbg ${PN}-staticdev ${PN}-dev ${PN}-doc ${PN}-locale ${PACKAGE_BEFORE_PN} ${PN}
+
+ During packaging, the :ref:`ref-tasks-package` task
+ goes through ``PACKAGES`` and uses the :term:`FILES`
+ variable corresponding to each package to assign files to the
+ package. If a file matches the ``FILES`` variable for more than one
+ package in ``PACKAGES``, it will be assigned to the earliest
+ (leftmost) package.
+
+ Packages in the variable's list that are empty (i.e. where none of
+ the patterns in ``FILES_``\ pkg match any files installed by the
+ :ref:`ref-tasks-install` task) are not generated,
+ unless generation is forced through the
+ :term:`ALLOW_EMPTY` variable.
+
+ PACKAGES_DYNAMIC
+ A promise that your recipe satisfies runtime dependencies for
+ optional modules that are found in other recipes.
+ ``PACKAGES_DYNAMIC`` does not actually satisfy the dependencies, it
+ only states that they should be satisfied. For example, if a hard,
+ runtime dependency (:term:`RDEPENDS`) of another
+ package is satisfied at build time through the ``PACKAGES_DYNAMIC``
+ variable, but a package with the module name is never actually
+ produced, then the other package will be broken. Thus, if you attempt
+ to include that package in an image, you will get a dependency
+ failure from the packaging system during the
+ :ref:`ref-tasks-rootfs` task.
+
+ Typically, if there is a chance that such a situation can occur and
+ the package that is not created is valid without the dependency being
+ satisfied, then you should use :term:`RRECOMMENDS`
+ (a soft runtime dependency) instead of ``RDEPENDS``.
+
+ For an example of how to use the ``PACKAGES_DYNAMIC`` variable when
+ you are splitting packages, see the
+ ":ref:`dev-manual/dev-manual-common-tasks:handling optional module packaging`"
+ section in the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual.
+
+ PACKAGESPLITFUNCS
+ Specifies a list of functions run to perform additional splitting of
+ files into individual packages. Recipes can either prepend to this
+ variable or prepend to the ``populate_packages`` function in order to
+ perform additional package splitting. In either case, the function
+ should set :term:`PACKAGES`,
+ :term:`FILES`, :term:`RDEPENDS` and
+ other packaging variables appropriately in order to perform the
+ desired splitting.
+
+ PARALLEL_MAKE
+ Extra options passed to the ``make`` command during the
+ :ref:`ref-tasks-compile` task in order to specify
+ parallel compilation on the local build host. This variable is
+ usually in the form "-j x", where x represents the maximum number of
+ parallel threads ``make`` can run.
+
+ .. note::
+
+ In order for
+ PARALLEL_MAKE
+ to be effective,
+ make
+ must be called with
+ ${
+ EXTRA_OEMAKE
+ }
+ . An easy way to ensure this is to use the
+ oe_runmake
+ function.
+
+ By default, the OpenEmbedded build system automatically sets this
+ variable to be equal to the number of cores the build system uses.
+
+ .. note::
+
+ If the software being built experiences dependency issues during
+ the
+ do_compile
+ task that result in race conditions, you can clear the
+ PARALLEL_MAKE
+ variable within the recipe as a workaround. For information on
+ addressing race conditions, see the "
+ Debugging Parallel Make Races
+ " section in the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual.
+
+ For single socket systems (i.e. one CPU), you should not have to
+ override this variable to gain optimal parallelism during builds.
+ However, if you have very large systems that employ multiple physical
+ CPUs, you might want to make sure the ``PARALLEL_MAKE`` variable is
+ not set higher than "-j 20".
+
+ For more information on speeding up builds, see the
+ ":ref:`dev-manual/dev-manual-common-tasks:speeding up a build`"
+ section in the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual.
+
+ PARALLEL_MAKEINST
+ Extra options passed to the ``make install`` command during the
+ :ref:`ref-tasks-install` task in order to specify
+ parallel installation. This variable defaults to the value of
+ :term:`PARALLEL_MAKE`.
+
+ .. note::
+
+ In order for ``PARALLEL_MAKEINST`` to be effective, ``make`` must
+ be called with
+ ``${``\ :term:`EXTRA_OEMAKE`\ ``}``. An easy
+ way to ensure this is to use the ``oe_runmake`` function.
+
+ If the software being built experiences dependency issues during
+ the ``do_install`` task that result in race conditions, you can
+ clear the ``PARALLEL_MAKEINST`` variable within the recipe as a
+ workaround. For information on addressing race conditions, see the
+ ":ref:`dev-manual/dev-manual-common-tasks:debugging parallel make races`"
+ section in the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual.
+
+ PATCHRESOLVE
+ Determines the action to take when a patch fails. You can set this
+ variable to one of two values: "noop" and "user".
+
+ The default value of "noop" causes the build to simply fail when the
+ OpenEmbedded build system cannot successfully apply a patch. Setting
+ the value to "user" causes the build system to launch a shell and
+ places you in the right location so that you can manually resolve the
+ conflicts.
+
+ Set this variable in your ``local.conf`` file.
+
+ PATCHTOOL
+ Specifies the utility used to apply patches for a recipe during the
+ :ref:`ref-tasks-patch` task. You can specify one of
+ three utilities: "patch", "quilt", or "git". The default utility used
+ is "quilt" except for the quilt-native recipe itself. Because the
+ quilt tool is not available at the time quilt-native is being
+ patched, it uses "patch".
+
+ If you wish to use an alternative patching tool, set the variable in
+ the recipe using one of the following:
+ ::
+
+ PATCHTOOL = "patch"
+ PATCHTOOL = "quilt"
+ PATCHTOOL = "git"
+
+ PE
+ The epoch of the recipe. By default, this variable is unset. The
+ variable is used to make upgrades possible when the versioning scheme
+ changes in some backwards incompatible way.
+
+ ``PE`` is the default value of the :term:`PKGE` variable.
+
+ PF
+ Specifies the recipe or package name and includes all version and
+ revision numbers (i.e. ``glibc-2.13-r20+svnr15508/`` and
+ ``bash-4.2-r1/``). This variable is comprised of the following:
+ ${:term:`PN`}-${:term:`EXTENDPE`}${:term:`PV`}-${:term:`PR`}
+
+ PIXBUF_PACKAGES
+ When inheriting the :ref:`pixbufcache <ref-classes-pixbufcache>`
+ class, this variable identifies packages that contain the pixbuf
+ loaders used with ``gdk-pixbuf``. By default, the ``pixbufcache``
+ class assumes that the loaders are in the recipe's main package (i.e.
+ ``${``\ :term:`PN`\ ``}``). Use this variable if the
+ loaders you need are in a package other than that main package.
+
+ PKG
+ The name of the resulting package created by the OpenEmbedded build
+ system.
+
+ .. note::
+
+ When using the
+ PKG
+ variable, you must use a package name override.
+
+ For example, when the :ref:`debian <ref-classes-debian>` class
+ renames the output package, it does so by setting
+ ``PKG_packagename``.
+
+ PKG_CONFIG_PATH
+ The path to ``pkg-config`` files for the current build context.
+ ``pkg-config`` reads this variable from the environment.
+
+ PKGD
+ Points to the destination directory for files to be packaged before
+ they are split into individual packages. This directory defaults to
+ the following:
+ ::
+
+ ${WORKDIR}/package
+
+ Do not change this default.
+
+ PKGDATA_DIR
+ Points to a shared, global-state directory that holds data generated
+ during the packaging process. During the packaging process, the
+ :ref:`ref-tasks-packagedata` task packages data
+ for each recipe and installs it into this temporary, shared area.
+ This directory defaults to the following, which you should not
+ change:
+ ::
+
+ ${STAGING_DIR_HOST}/pkgdata
+
+ For examples of how this data is used, see the
+ ":ref:`overview-manual/overview-manual-concepts:automatically added runtime dependencies`"
+ section in the Yocto Project Overview and Concepts Manual and the
+ ":ref:`dev-manual/dev-manual-common-tasks:viewing package information with \`\`oe-pkgdata-util\`\``"
+ section in the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual. For more
+ information on the shared, global-state directory, see
+ :term:`STAGING_DIR_HOST`.
+
+ PKGDEST
+ Points to the parent directory for files to be packaged after they
+ have been split into individual packages. This directory defaults to
+ the following:
+ ::
+
+ ${WORKDIR}/packages-split
+
+ Under this directory, the build system creates directories for each
+ package specified in :term:`PACKAGES`. Do not change
+ this default.
+
+ PKGDESTWORK
+ Points to a temporary work area where the
+ :ref:`ref-tasks-package` task saves package metadata.
+ The ``PKGDESTWORK`` location defaults to the following:
+ ::
+
+ ${WORKDIR}/pkgdata
+
+ Do not change this default.
+
+ The :ref:`ref-tasks-packagedata` task copies the
+ package metadata from ``PKGDESTWORK`` to
+ :term:`PKGDATA_DIR` to make it available globally.
+
+ PKGE
+ The epoch of the package(s) built by the recipe. By default, ``PKGE``
+ is set to :term:`PE`.
+
+ PKGR
+ The revision of the package(s) built by the recipe. By default,
+ ``PKGR`` is set to :term:`PR`.
+
+ PKGV
+ The version of the package(s) built by the recipe. By default,
+ ``PKGV`` is set to :term:`PV`.
+
+ PN
+ This variable can have two separate functions depending on the
+ context: a recipe name or a resulting package name.
+
+ ``PN`` refers to a recipe name in the context of a file used by the
+ OpenEmbedded build system as input to create a package. The name is
+ normally extracted from the recipe file name. For example, if the
+ recipe is named ``expat_2.0.1.bb``, then the default value of ``PN``
+ will be "expat".
+
+ The variable refers to a package name in the context of a file
+ created or produced by the OpenEmbedded build system.
+
+ If applicable, the ``PN`` variable also contains any special suffix
+ or prefix. For example, using ``bash`` to build packages for the
+ native machine, ``PN`` is ``bash-native``. Using ``bash`` to build
+ packages for the target and for Multilib, ``PN`` would be ``bash``
+ and ``lib64-bash``, respectively.
+
+ PNBLACKLIST
+ Lists recipes you do not want the OpenEmbedded build system to build.
+ This variable works in conjunction with the
+ :ref:`blacklist <ref-classes-blacklist>` class, which is inherited
+ globally.
+
+ To prevent a recipe from being built, use the ``PNBLACKLIST``
+ variable in your ``local.conf`` file. Here is an example that
+ prevents ``myrecipe`` from being built:
+ ::
+
+ PNBLACKLIST[myrecipe] = "Not supported by our organization."
+
+ POPULATE_SDK_POST_HOST_COMMAND
+ Specifies a list of functions to call once the OpenEmbedded build
+ system has created the host part of the SDK. You can specify
+ functions separated by semicolons:
+ ::
+
+ POPULATE_SDK_POST_HOST_COMMAND += "function; ... "
+
+ If you need to pass the SDK path to a command within a function, you
+ can use ``${SDK_DIR}``, which points to the parent directory used by
+ the OpenEmbedded build system when creating SDK output. See the
+ :term:`SDK_DIR` variable for more information.
+
+ POPULATE_SDK_POST_TARGET_COMMAND
+ Specifies a list of functions to call once the OpenEmbedded build
+ system has created the target part of the SDK. You can specify
+ functions separated by semicolons:
+ ::
+
+ POPULATE_SDK_POST_TARGET_COMMAND += "function; ... "
+
+ If you need to pass the SDK path to a command within a function, you
+ can use ``${SDK_DIR}``, which points to the parent directory used by
+ the OpenEmbedded build system when creating SDK output. See the
+ :term:`SDK_DIR` variable for more information.
+
+ PR
+ The revision of the recipe. The default value for this variable is
+ "r0". Subsequent revisions of the recipe conventionally have the
+ values "r1", "r2", and so forth. When :term:`PV` increases,
+ ``PR`` is conventionally reset to "r0".
+
+ .. note::
+
+ The OpenEmbedded build system does not need the aid of
+ PR
+ to know when to rebuild a recipe. The build system uses the task
+ input checksums
+ along with the
+ stamp
+ and
+ shared state cache
+ mechanisms.
+
+ The ``PR`` variable primarily becomes significant when a package
+ manager dynamically installs packages on an already built image. In
+ this case, ``PR``, which is the default value of
+ :term:`PKGR`, helps the package manager distinguish which
+ package is the most recent one in cases where many packages have the
+ same ``PV`` (i.e. ``PKGV``). A component having many packages with
+ the same ``PV`` usually means that the packages all install the same
+ upstream version, but with later (``PR``) version packages including
+ packaging fixes.
+
+ .. note::
+
+ PR
+ does not need to be increased for changes that do not change the
+ package contents or metadata.
+
+ Because manually managing ``PR`` can be cumbersome and error-prone,
+ an automated solution exists. See the
+ ":ref:`dev-manual/dev-manual-common-tasks:working with a pr service`" section
+ in the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual for more information.
+
+ PREFERRED_PROVIDER
+ If multiple recipes provide the same item, this variable determines
+ which recipe is preferred and thus provides the item (i.e. the
+ preferred provider). You should always suffix this variable with the
+ name of the provided item. And, you should define the variable using
+ the preferred recipe's name (:term:`PN`). Here is a common
+ example:
+ ::
+
+ PREFERRED_PROVIDER_virtual/kernel ?= "linux-yocto"
+
+ In the previous example, multiple recipes are providing "virtual/kernel".
+ The ``PREFERRED_PROVIDER`` variable is set with the name (``PN``) of
+ the recipe you prefer to provide "virtual/kernel".
+
+ Following are more examples:
+ ::
+
+ PREFERRED_PROVIDER_virtual/xserver = "xserver-xf86"
+ PREFERRED_PROVIDER_virtual/libgl ?= "mesa"
+
+ For more
+ information, see the ":ref:`metadata-virtual-providers`"
+ section in the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual.
+
+ .. note::
+
+ If you use a
+ virtual/\*
+ item with
+ PREFERRED_PROVIDER
+ , then any recipe that
+ PROVIDES
+ that item but is not selected (defined) by
+ PREFERRED_PROVIDER
+ is prevented from building, which is usually desirable since this
+ mechanism is designed to select between mutually exclusive
+ alternative providers.
+
+ PREFERRED_VERSION
+ If multiple versions of recipes exist, this variable determines which
+ version is given preference. You must always suffix the variable with
+ the :term:`PN` you want to select, and you should set the
+ :term:`PV` accordingly for precedence.
+
+ The ``PREFERRED_VERSION`` variable supports limited wildcard use
+ through the "``%``" character. You can use the character to match any
+ number of characters, which can be useful when specifying versions
+ that contain long revision numbers that potentially change. Here are
+ two examples:
+ ::
+
+ PREFERRED_VERSION_python = "3.4.0"
+ PREFERRED_VERSION_linux-yocto = "5.0%"
+
+ .. note::
+
+ The use of the "%" character is limited in that it only works at the end of the
+ string. You cannot use the wildcard character in any other
+ location of the string.
+
+ The specified version is matched against :term:`PV`, which
+ does not necessarily match the version part of the recipe's filename.
+ For example, consider two recipes ``foo_1.2.bb`` and ``foo_git.bb``
+ where ``foo_git.bb`` contains the following assignment:
+ ::
+
+ PV = "1.1+git${SRCPV}"
+
+ In this case, the correct way to select
+ ``foo_git.bb`` is by using an assignment such as the following:
+ ::
+
+ PREFERRED_VERSION_foo = "1.1+git%"
+
+ Compare that previous example
+ against the following incorrect example, which does not work:
+ ::
+
+ PREFERRED_VERSION_foo = "git"
+
+ Sometimes the ``PREFERRED_VERSION`` variable can be set by
+ configuration files in a way that is hard to change. You can use
+ :term:`OVERRIDES` to set a machine-specific
+ override. Here is an example:
+ ::
+
+ PREFERRED_VERSION_linux-yocto_qemux86 = "5.0%"
+
+ Although not recommended, worst case, you can also use the
+ "forcevariable" override, which is the strongest override possible.
+ Here is an example:
+ ::
+
+ PREFERRED_VERSION_linux-yocto_forcevariable = "5.0%"
+
+ .. note::
+
+ The \_forcevariable override is not handled specially. This override
+ only works because the default value of OVERRIDES includes "forcevariable".
+
+ PREMIRRORS
+ Specifies additional paths from which the OpenEmbedded build system
+ gets source code. When the build system searches for source code, it
+ first tries the local download directory. If that location fails, the
+ build system tries locations defined by ``PREMIRRORS``, the upstream
+ source, and then locations specified by
+ :term:`MIRRORS` in that order.
+
+ Assuming your distribution (:term:`DISTRO`) is "poky",
+ the default value for ``PREMIRRORS`` is defined in the
+ ``conf/distro/poky.conf`` file in the ``meta-poky`` Git repository.
+
+ Typically, you could add a specific server for the build system to
+ attempt before any others by adding something like the following to
+ the ``local.conf`` configuration file in the
+ :term:`Build Directory`:
+ ::
+
+ PREMIRRORS_prepend = "\
+ git://.*/.* http://www.yoctoproject.org/sources/ \n \
+ ftp://.*/.* http://www.yoctoproject.org/sources/ \n \
+ http://.*/.* http://www.yoctoproject.org/sources/ \n \
+ https://.*/.* http://www.yoctoproject.org/sources/ \n"
+
+ These changes cause the
+ build system to intercept Git, FTP, HTTP, and HTTPS requests and
+ direct them to the ``http://`` sources mirror. You can use
+ ``file://`` URLs to point to local directories or network shares as
+ well.
+
+ PRIORITY
+ Indicates the importance of a package.
+
+ ``PRIORITY`` is considered to be part of the distribution policy
+ because the importance of any given recipe depends on the purpose for
+ which the distribution is being produced. Thus, ``PRIORITY`` is not
+ normally set within recipes.
+
+ You can set ``PRIORITY`` to "required", "standard", "extra", and
+ "optional", which is the default.
+
+ PRIVATE_LIBS
+ Specifies libraries installed within a recipe that should be ignored
+ by the OpenEmbedded build system's shared library resolver. This
+ variable is typically used when software being built by a recipe has
+ its own private versions of a library normally provided by another
+ recipe. In this case, you would not want the package containing the
+ private libraries to be set as a dependency on other unrelated
+ packages that should instead depend on the package providing the
+ standard version of the library.
+
+ Libraries specified in this variable should be specified by their
+ file name. For example, from the Firefox recipe in meta-browser:
+ ::
+
+ PRIVATE_LIBS = "libmozjs.so \
+ libxpcom.so \
+ libnspr4.so \
+ libxul.so \
+ libmozalloc.so \
+ libplc4.so \
+ libplds4.so"
+
+ For more information, see the
+ ":ref:`overview-manual/overview-manual-concepts:automatically added runtime dependencies`"
+ section in the Yocto Project Overview and Concepts Manual.
+
+ PROVIDES
+ A list of aliases by which a particular recipe can be known. By
+ default, a recipe's own ``PN`` is implicitly already in its
+ ``PROVIDES`` list and therefore does not need to mention that it
+ provides itself. If a recipe uses ``PROVIDES``, the additional
+ aliases are synonyms for the recipe and can be useful for satisfying
+ dependencies of other recipes during the build as specified by
+ ``DEPENDS``.
+
+ Consider the following example ``PROVIDES`` statement from the recipe
+ file ``eudev_3.2.9.bb``:
+ ::
+
+ PROVIDES = "udev"
+
+ The ``PROVIDES`` statement
+ results in the "eudev" recipe also being available as simply "udev".
+
+ .. note::
+
+ Given that a recipe's own recipe name is already implicitly in its
+ own
+ PROVIDES
+ list, it is unnecessary to add aliases with the "+=" operator;
+ using a simple assignment will be sufficient. In other words,
+ while you could write:
+ ::
+
+ PROVIDES += "udev"
+
+
+ in the above, the "+=" is overkill and unnecessary.
+
+ In addition to providing recipes under alternate names, the
+ ``PROVIDES`` mechanism is also used to implement virtual targets. A
+ virtual target is a name that corresponds to some particular
+ functionality (e.g. a Linux kernel). Recipes that provide the
+ functionality in question list the virtual target in ``PROVIDES``.
+ Recipes that depend on the functionality in question can include the
+ virtual target in ``DEPENDS`` to leave the choice of provider open.
+
+ Conventionally, virtual targets have names on the form
+ "virtual/function" (e.g. "virtual/kernel"). The slash is simply part
+ of the name and has no syntactical significance.
+
+ The :term:`PREFERRED_PROVIDER` variable is
+ used to select which particular recipe provides a virtual target.
+
+ .. note::
+
+ A corresponding mechanism for virtual runtime dependencies
+ (packages) exists. However, the mechanism does not depend on any
+ special functionality beyond ordinary variable assignments. For
+ example, ``VIRTUAL-RUNTIME_dev_manager`` refers to the package of
+ the component that manages the ``/dev`` directory.
+
+ Setting the "preferred provider" for runtime dependencies is as
+ simple as using the following assignment in a configuration file:
+ ::
+
+ VIRTUAL-RUNTIME_dev_manager = "udev"
+
+
+ PRSERV_HOST
+ The network based :term:`PR` service host and port.
+
+ The ``conf/local.conf.sample.extended`` configuration file in the
+ :term:`Source Directory` shows how the
+ ``PRSERV_HOST`` variable is set:
+ ::
+
+ PRSERV_HOST = "localhost:0"
+
+ You must
+ set the variable if you want to automatically start a local :ref:`PR
+ service <dev-manual/dev-manual-common-tasks:working with a pr service>`. You can
+ set ``PRSERV_HOST`` to other values to use a remote PR service.
+
+ PTEST_ENABLED
+ Specifies whether or not :ref:`Package
+ Test <dev-manual/dev-manual-common-tasks:testing packages with ptest>` (ptest)
+ functionality is enabled when building a recipe. You should not set
+ this variable directly. Enabling and disabling building Package Tests
+ at build time should be done by adding "ptest" to (or removing it
+ from) :term:`DISTRO_FEATURES`.
+
+ PV
+ The version of the recipe. The version is normally extracted from the
+ recipe filename. For example, if the recipe is named
+ ``expat_2.0.1.bb``, then the default value of ``PV`` will be "2.0.1".
+ ``PV`` is generally not overridden within a recipe unless it is
+ building an unstable (i.e. development) version from a source code
+ repository (e.g. Git or Subversion).
+
+ ``PV`` is the default value of the :term:`PKGV` variable.
+
+ PYTHON_ABI
+ When used by recipes that inherit the
+ :ref:`distutils3 <ref-classes-distutils3>`,
+ :ref:`setuptools3 <ref-classes-setuptools3>`,
+ :ref:`distutils <ref-classes-distutils>`, or
+ :ref:`setuptools <ref-classes-setuptools>` classes, denotes the
+ Application Binary Interface (ABI) currently in use for Python. By
+ default, the ABI is "m". You do not have to set this variable as the
+ OpenEmbedded build system sets it for you.
+
+ The OpenEmbedded build system uses the ABI to construct directory
+ names used when installing the Python headers and libraries in
+ sysroot (e.g. ``.../python3.3m/...``).
+
+ Recipes that inherit the ``distutils`` class during cross-builds also
+ use this variable to locate the headers and libraries of the
+ appropriate Python that the extension is targeting.
+
+ PYTHON_PN
+ When used by recipes that inherit the
+ `distutils3 <ref-classes-distutils3>`,
+ :ref:`setuptools3 <ref-classes-setuptools3>`,
+ :ref:`distutils <ref-classes-distutils>`, or
+ :ref:`setuptools <ref-classes-setuptools>` classes, specifies the
+ major Python version being built. For Python 3.x, ``PYTHON_PN`` would
+ be "python3". You do not have to set this variable as the
+ OpenEmbedded build system automatically sets it for you.
+
+ The variable allows recipes to use common infrastructure such as the
+ following:
+ ::
+
+ DEPENDS += "${PYTHON_PN}-native"
+
+ In the previous example,
+ the version of the dependency is ``PYTHON_PN``.
+
+ RANLIB
+ The minimal command and arguments to run ``ranlib``.
+
+ RCONFLICTS
+ The list of packages that conflict with packages. Note that packages
+ will not be installed if conflicting packages are not first removed.
+
+ Like all package-controlling variables, you must always use them in
+ conjunction with a package name override. Here is an example:
+ ::
+
+ RCONFLICTS_${PN} = "another_conflicting_package_name"
+
+ BitBake, which the OpenEmbedded build system uses, supports
+ specifying versioned dependencies. Although the syntax varies
+ depending on the packaging format, BitBake hides these differences
+ from you. Here is the general syntax to specify versions with the
+ ``RCONFLICTS`` variable:
+ ::
+
+ RCONFLICTS_${PN} = "package (operator version)"
+
+ For ``operator``, you can specify the following: = < > <=
+ >= For example, the following sets up a dependency on version 1.2 or
+ greater of the package ``foo``:
+ ::
+
+ RCONFLICTS_${PN} = "foo (>= 1.2)"
+
+ RDEPENDS
+ Lists runtime dependencies of a package. These dependencies are other
+ packages that must be installed in order for the package to function
+ correctly. As an example, the following assignment declares that the
+ package ``foo`` needs the packages ``bar`` and ``baz`` to be
+ installed:
+ ::
+
+ RDEPENDS_foo = "bar baz"
+
+ The most common types of package
+ runtime dependencies are automatically detected and added. Therefore,
+ most recipes do not need to set ``RDEPENDS``. For more information,
+ see the
+ ":ref:`overview-manual/overview-manual-concepts:automatically added runtime dependencies`"
+ section in the Yocto Project Overview and Concepts Manual.
+
+ The practical effect of the above ``RDEPENDS`` assignment is that
+ ``bar`` and ``baz`` will be declared as dependencies inside the
+ package ``foo`` when it is written out by one of the
+ ```do_package_write_*`` <#ref-tasks-package_write_deb>`__ tasks.
+ Exactly how this is done depends on which package format is used,
+ which is determined by
+ :term:`PACKAGE_CLASSES`. When the
+ corresponding package manager installs the package, it will know to
+ also install the packages on which it depends.
+
+ To ensure that the packages ``bar`` and ``baz`` get built, the
+ previous ``RDEPENDS`` assignment also causes a task dependency to be
+ added. This dependency is from the recipe's
+ :ref:`ref-tasks-build` (not to be confused with
+ :ref:`ref-tasks-compile`) task to the
+ ``do_package_write_*`` task of the recipes that build ``bar`` and
+ ``baz``.
+
+ The names of the packages you list within ``RDEPENDS`` must be the
+ names of other packages - they cannot be recipe names. Although
+ package names and recipe names usually match, the important point
+ here is that you are providing package names within the ``RDEPENDS``
+ variable. For an example of the default list of packages created from
+ a recipe, see the :term:`PACKAGES` variable.
+
+ Because the ``RDEPENDS`` variable applies to packages being built,
+ you should always use the variable in a form with an attached package
+ name (remember that a single recipe can build multiple packages). For
+ example, suppose you are building a development package that depends
+ on the ``perl`` package. In this case, you would use the following
+ ``RDEPENDS`` statement:
+ ::
+
+ RDEPENDS_${PN}-dev += "perl"
+
+ In the example,
+ the development package depends on the ``perl`` package. Thus, the
+ ``RDEPENDS`` variable has the ``${PN}-dev`` package name as part of
+ the variable.
+
+ .. note::
+
+ RDEPENDS_${PN}-dev
+ includes
+ ${
+ PN
+ }
+ by default. This default is set in the BitBake configuration file
+ (
+ meta/conf/bitbake.conf
+ ). Be careful not to accidentally remove
+ ${PN}
+ when modifying
+ RDEPENDS_${PN}-dev
+ . Use the "+=" operator rather than the "=" operator.
+
+ The package names you use with ``RDEPENDS`` must appear as they would
+ in the ``PACKAGES`` variable. The :term:`PKG` variable
+ allows a different name to be used for the final package (e.g. the
+ :ref:`debian <ref-classes-debian>` class uses this to rename
+ packages), but this final package name cannot be used with
+ ``RDEPENDS``, which makes sense as ``RDEPENDS`` is meant to be
+ independent of the package format used.
+
+ BitBake, which the OpenEmbedded build system uses, supports
+ specifying versioned dependencies. Although the syntax varies
+ depending on the packaging format, BitBake hides these differences
+ from you. Here is the general syntax to specify versions with the
+ ``RDEPENDS`` variable:
+ ::
+
+ RDEPENDS_${PN} = "package (operator version)"
+
+ For operator, you can specify the following: = < > <= >= For version,
+ provide the version number.
+
+ .. note::
+
+ You can use
+ EXTENDPKGV
+ to provide a full package version specification.
+
+ For example, the following sets up a dependency on version 1.2 or
+ greater of the package ``foo``:
+ ::
+
+ RDEPENDS_${PN} = "foo (>= 1.2)"
+
+ For information on build-time dependencies, see the
+ :term:`DEPENDS` variable. You can also see the
+ ":ref:`Tasks <bitbake:bitbake-user-manual/bitbake-user-manual-metadata:tasks>`" and
+ ":ref:`Dependencies <bitbake:bitbake-user-manual/bitbake-user-manual-execution:dependencies>`" sections in the
+ BitBake User Manual for additional information on tasks and
+ dependencies.
+
+ REQUIRED_DISTRO_FEATURES
+ When inheriting the
+ :ref:`distro_features_check <ref-classes-distro_features_check>`
+ class, this variable identifies distribution features that must exist
+ in the current configuration in order for the OpenEmbedded build
+ system to build the recipe. In other words, if the
+ ``REQUIRED_DISTRO_FEATURES`` variable lists a feature that does not
+ appear in ``DISTRO_FEATURES`` within the current configuration, an
+ error occurs and the build stops.
+
+ RM_WORK_EXCLUDE
+ With ``rm_work`` enabled, this variable specifies a list of recipes
+ whose work directories should not be removed. See the
+ ":ref:`rm_work.bbclass <ref-classes-rm-work>`" section for more
+ details.
+
+ ROOT_HOME
+ Defines the root home directory. By default, this directory is set as
+ follows in the BitBake configuration file:
+ ::
+
+ ROOT_HOME ??= "/home/root"
+
+ .. note::
+
+ This default value is likely used because some embedded solutions
+ prefer to have a read-only root filesystem and prefer to keep
+ writeable data in one place.
+
+ You can override the default by setting the variable in any layer or
+ in the ``local.conf`` file. Because the default is set using a "weak"
+ assignment (i.e. "??="), you can use either of the following forms to
+ define your override:
+ ::
+
+ ROOT_HOME = "/root"
+ ROOT_HOME ?= "/root"
+
+ These
+ override examples use ``/root``, which is probably the most commonly
+ used override.
+
+ ROOTFS
+ Indicates a filesystem image to include as the root filesystem.
+
+ The ``ROOTFS`` variable is an optional variable used with the
+ :ref:`image-live <ref-classes-image-live>` class.
+
+ ROOTFS_POSTINSTALL_COMMAND
+ Specifies a list of functions to call after the OpenEmbedded build
+ system has installed packages. You can specify functions separated by
+ semicolons:
+ ::
+
+ ROOTFS_POSTINSTALL_COMMAND += "function; ... "
+
+ If you need to pass the root filesystem path to a command within a
+ function, you can use ``${IMAGE_ROOTFS}``, which points to the
+ directory that becomes the root filesystem image. See the
+ :term:`IMAGE_ROOTFS` variable for more
+ information.
+
+ ROOTFS_POSTPROCESS_COMMAND
+ Specifies a list of functions to call once the OpenEmbedded build
+ system has created the root filesystem. You can specify functions
+ separated by semicolons:
+ ::
+
+ ROOTFS_POSTPROCESS_COMMAND += "function; ... "
+
+ If you need to pass the root filesystem path to a command within a
+ function, you can use ``${IMAGE_ROOTFS}``, which points to the
+ directory that becomes the root filesystem image. See the
+ :term:`IMAGE_ROOTFS` variable for more
+ information.
+
+ ROOTFS_POSTUNINSTALL_COMMAND
+ Specifies a list of functions to call after the OpenEmbedded build
+ system has removed unnecessary packages. When runtime package
+ management is disabled in the image, several packages are removed
+ including ``base-passwd``, ``shadow``, and ``update-alternatives``.
+ You can specify functions separated by semicolons:
+ ::
+
+ ROOTFS_POSTUNINSTALL_COMMAND += "function; ... "
+
+ If you need to pass the root filesystem path to a command within a
+ function, you can use ``${IMAGE_ROOTFS}``, which points to the
+ directory that becomes the root filesystem image. See the
+ :term:`IMAGE_ROOTFS` variable for more
+ information.
+
+ ROOTFS_PREPROCESS_COMMAND
+ Specifies a list of functions to call before the OpenEmbedded build
+ system has created the root filesystem. You can specify functions
+ separated by semicolons:
+ ::
+
+ ROOTFS_PREPROCESS_COMMAND += "function; ... "
+
+ If you need to pass the root filesystem path to a command within a
+ function, you can use ``${IMAGE_ROOTFS}``, which points to the
+ directory that becomes the root filesystem image. See the
+ :term:`IMAGE_ROOTFS` variable for more
+ information.
+
+ RPROVIDES
+ A list of package name aliases that a package also provides. These
+ aliases are useful for satisfying runtime dependencies of other
+ packages both during the build and on the target (as specified by
+ ``RDEPENDS``).
+
+ .. note::
+
+ A package's own name is implicitly already in its
+ RPROVIDES
+ list.
+
+ As with all package-controlling variables, you must always use the
+ variable in conjunction with a package name override. Here is an
+ example:
+ ::
+
+ RPROVIDES_${PN} = "widget-abi-2"
+
+ RRECOMMENDS
+ A list of packages that extends the usability of a package being
+ built. The package being built does not depend on this list of
+ packages in order to successfully build, but rather uses them for
+ extended usability. To specify runtime dependencies for packages, see
+ the ``RDEPENDS`` variable.
+
+ The package manager will automatically install the ``RRECOMMENDS``
+ list of packages when installing the built package. However, you can
+ prevent listed packages from being installed by using the
+ :term:`BAD_RECOMMENDATIONS`,
+ :term:`NO_RECOMMENDATIONS`, and
+ :term:`PACKAGE_EXCLUDE` variables.
+
+ Packages specified in ``RRECOMMENDS`` need not actually be produced.
+ However, a recipe must exist that provides each package, either
+ through the :term:`PACKAGES` or
+ :term:`PACKAGES_DYNAMIC` variables or the
+ :term:`RPROVIDES` variable, or an error will occur
+ during the build. If such a recipe does exist and the package is not
+ produced, the build continues without error.
+
+ Because the ``RRECOMMENDS`` variable applies to packages being built,
+ you should always attach an override to the variable to specify the
+ particular package whose usability is being extended. For example,
+ suppose you are building a development package that is extended to
+ support wireless functionality. In this case, you would use the
+ following:
+ ::
+
+ RRECOMMENDS_${PN}-dev += "wireless_package_name"
+
+ In the
+ example, the package name (``${PN}-dev``) must appear as it would in
+ the ``PACKAGES`` namespace before any renaming of the output package
+ by classes such as ``debian.bbclass``.
+
+ BitBake, which the OpenEmbedded build system uses, supports
+ specifying versioned recommends. Although the syntax varies depending
+ on the packaging format, BitBake hides these differences from you.
+ Here is the general syntax to specify versions with the
+ ``RRECOMMENDS`` variable:
+ ::
+
+ RRECOMMENDS_${PN} = "package (operator version)"
+
+ For ``operator``, you can specify the following:
+
+ - =
+ - <
+ - >
+ - <=
+ - >=
+
+ For example, the following sets up a recommend on version 1.2 or
+ greater of the package ``foo``:
+ ::
+
+ RRECOMMENDS_${PN} = "foo (>= 1.2)"
+
+ RREPLACES
+ A list of packages replaced by a package. The package manager uses
+ this variable to determine which package should be installed to
+ replace other package(s) during an upgrade. In order to also have the
+ other package(s) removed at the same time, you must add the name of
+ the other package to the ``RCONFLICTS`` variable.
+
+ As with all package-controlling variables, you must use this variable
+ in conjunction with a package name override. Here is an example:
+ ::
+
+ RREPLACES_${PN} = "other_package_being_replaced"
+
+ BitBake, which the OpenEmbedded build system uses, supports
+ specifying versioned replacements. Although the syntax varies
+ depending on the packaging format, BitBake hides these differences
+ from you. Here is the general syntax to specify versions with the
+ ``RREPLACES`` variable:
+ ::
+
+ RREPLACES_${PN} = "package (operator version)"
+
+ For ``operator``, you can specify the following:
+
+ - =
+ - <
+ - >
+ - <=
+ - >=
+
+ For example, the following sets up a replacement using version 1.2
+ or greater of the package ``foo``:
+ ::
+
+ RREPLACES_${PN} = "foo (>= 1.2)"
+
+ RSUGGESTS
+ A list of additional packages that you can suggest for installation
+ by the package manager at the time a package is installed. Not all
+ package managers support this functionality.
+
+ As with all package-controlling variables, you must always use this
+ variable in conjunction with a package name override. Here is an
+ example:
+ ::
+
+ RSUGGESTS_${PN} = "useful_package another_package"
+
+ S
+ The location in the :term:`Build Directory` where
+ unpacked recipe source code resides. By default, this directory is
+ ``${``\ :term:`WORKDIR`\ ``}/${``\ :term:`BPN`\ ``}-${``\ :term:`PV`\ ``}``,
+ where ``${BPN}`` is the base recipe name and ``${PV}`` is the recipe
+ version. If the source tarball extracts the code to a directory named
+ anything other than ``${BPN}-${PV}``, or if the source code is
+ fetched from an SCM such as Git or Subversion, then you must set
+ ``S`` in the recipe so that the OpenEmbedded build system knows where
+ to find the unpacked source.
+
+ As an example, assume a :term:`Source Directory`
+ top-level folder named ``poky`` and a default Build Directory at
+ ``poky/build``. In this case, the work directory the build system
+ uses to keep the unpacked recipe for ``db`` is the following:
+ ::
+
+ poky/build/tmp/work/qemux86-poky-linux/db/5.1.19-r3/db-5.1.19
+
+ The unpacked source code resides in the ``db-5.1.19`` folder.
+
+ This next example assumes a Git repository. By default, Git
+ repositories are cloned to ``${WORKDIR}/git`` during
+ :ref:`ref-tasks-fetch`. Since this path is different
+ from the default value of ``S``, you must set it specifically so the
+ source can be located:
+ ::
+
+ SRC_URI = "git://path/to/repo.git"
+ S = "${WORKDIR}/git"
+
+ SANITY_REQUIRED_UTILITIES
+ Specifies a list of command-line utilities that should be checked for
+ during the initial sanity checking process when running BitBake. If
+ any of the utilities are not installed on the build host, then
+ BitBake immediately exits with an error.
+
+ SANITY_TESTED_DISTROS
+ A list of the host distribution identifiers that the build system has
+ been tested against. Identifiers consist of the host distributor ID
+ followed by the release, as reported by the ``lsb_release`` tool or
+ as read from ``/etc/lsb-release``. Separate the list items with
+ explicit newline characters (``\n``). If ``SANITY_TESTED_DISTROS`` is
+ not empty and the current value of
+ :term:`NATIVELSBSTRING` does not appear in the
+ list, then the build system reports a warning that indicates the
+ current host distribution has not been tested as a build host.
+
+ SDK_ARCH
+ The target architecture for the SDK. Typically, you do not directly
+ set this variable. Instead, use :term:`SDKMACHINE`.
+
+ SDK_DEPLOY
+ The directory set up and used by the
+ :ref:`populate_sdk_base <ref-classes-populate-sdk>` class to which
+ the SDK is deployed. The ``populate_sdk_base`` class defines
+ ``SDK_DEPLOY`` as follows:
+ ::
+
+ SDK_DEPLOY = "${TMPDIR}/deploy/sdk"
+
+ SDK_DIR
+ The parent directory used by the OpenEmbedded build system when
+ creating SDK output. The
+ :ref:`populate_sdk_base <ref-classes-populate-sdk-*>` class defines
+ the variable as follows:
+ ::
+
+ SDK_DIR = "${WORKDIR}/sdk"
+
+ .. note::
+
+ The
+ SDK_DIR
+ directory is a temporary directory as it is part of
+ WORKDIR
+ . The final output directory is
+ SDK_DEPLOY
+ .
+
+ SDK_EXT_TYPE
+ Controls whether or not shared state artifacts are copied into the
+ extensible SDK. The default value of "full" copies all of the
+ required shared state artifacts into the extensible SDK. The value
+ "minimal" leaves these artifacts out of the SDK.
+
+ .. note::
+
+ If you set the variable to "minimal", you need to ensure
+ SSTATE_MIRRORS
+ is set in the SDK's configuration to enable the artifacts to be
+ fetched as needed.
+
+ SDK_HOST_MANIFEST
+ The manifest file for the host part of the SDK. This file lists all
+ the installed packages that make up the host part of the SDK. The
+ file contains package information on a line-per-package basis as
+ follows:
+ ::
+
+ packagename packagearch version
+
+ The :ref:`populate_sdk_base <ref-classes-populate-sdk-*>` class
+ defines the manifest file as follows:
+ ::
+
+ SDK_HOST_MANIFEST = "${SDK_DEPLOY}/${TOOLCHAIN_OUTPUTNAME}.host.manifest"
+
+ The location is derived using the :term:`SDK_DEPLOY` and
+ :term:`TOOLCHAIN_OUTPUTNAME` variables.
+
+ SDK_INCLUDE_PKGDATA
+ When set to "1", specifies to include the packagedata for all recipes
+ in the "world" target in the extensible SDK. Including this data
+ allows the ``devtool search`` command to find these recipes in search
+ results, as well as allows the ``devtool add`` command to map
+ dependencies more effectively.
+
+ .. note::
+
+ Enabling the
+ SDK_INCLUDE_PKGDATA
+ variable significantly increases build time because all of world
+ needs to be built. Enabling the variable also slightly increases
+ the size of the extensible SDK.
+
+ SDK_INCLUDE_TOOLCHAIN
+ When set to "1", specifies to include the toolchain in the extensible
+ SDK. Including the toolchain is useful particularly when
+ :term:`SDK_EXT_TYPE` is set to "minimal" to keep
+ the SDK reasonably small but you still want to provide a usable
+ toolchain. For example, suppose you want to use the toolchain from an
+ IDE or from other tools and you do not want to perform additional
+ steps to install the toolchain.
+
+ The ``SDK_INCLUDE_TOOLCHAIN`` variable defaults to "0" if
+ ``SDK_EXT_TYPE`` is set to "minimal", and defaults to "1" if
+ ``SDK_EXT_TYPE`` is set to "full".
+
+ SDK_INHERIT_BLACKLIST
+ A list of classes to remove from the :term:`INHERIT`
+ value globally within the extensible SDK configuration. The
+ :ref:`populate-sdk-ext <ref-classes-populate-sdk-*>` class sets the
+ default value:
+ ::
+
+ SDK_INHERIT_BLACKLIST ?= "buildhistory icecc"
+
+ Some classes are not generally applicable within the extensible SDK
+ context. You can use this variable to disable those classes.
+
+ For additional information on how to customize the extensible SDK's
+ configuration, see the
+ ":ref:`sdk-manual/sdk-appendix-customizing:configuring the extensible sdk`"
+ section in the Yocto Project Application Development and the
+ Extensible Software Development Kit (eSDK) manual.
+
+ SDK_LOCAL_CONF_BLACKLIST
+ A list of variables not allowed through from the OpenEmbedded build
+ system configuration into the extensible SDK configuration. Usually,
+ these are variables that are specific to the machine on which the
+ build system is running and thus would be potentially problematic
+ within the extensible SDK.
+
+ By default, ``SDK_LOCAL_CONF_BLACKLIST`` is set in the
+ :ref:`populate-sdk-ext <ref-classes-populate-sdk-*>` class and
+ excludes the following variables:
+
+ - :term:`CONF_VERSION`
+ - :term:`BB_NUMBER_THREADS`
+ - :term:`bitbake:BB_NUMBER_PARSE_THREADS`
+ - :term:`PARALLEL_MAKE`
+ - :term:`PRSERV_HOST`
+ - :term:`SSTATE_MIRRORS` :term:`DL_DIR`
+ - :term:`SSTATE_DIR` :term:`TMPDIR`
+ - :term:`BB_SERVER_TIMEOUT`
+
+ For additional information on how to customize the extensible SDK's
+ configuration, see the
+ ":ref:`sdk-manual/sdk-appendix-customizing:configuring the extensible sdk`"
+ section in the Yocto Project Application Development and the
+ Extensible Software Development Kit (eSDK) manual.
+
+ SDK_LOCAL_CONF_WHITELIST
+ A list of variables allowed through from the OpenEmbedded build
+ system configuration into the extensible SDK configuration. By
+ default, the list of variables is empty and is set in the
+ :ref:`populate-sdk-ext <ref-classes-populate-sdk-*>` class.
+
+ This list overrides the variables specified using the
+ :term:`SDK_LOCAL_CONF_BLACKLIST`
+ variable as well as any variables identified by automatic
+ blacklisting due to the "/" character being found at the start of the
+ value, which is usually indicative of being a path and thus might not
+ be valid on the system where the SDK is installed.
+
+ For additional information on how to customize the extensible SDK's
+ configuration, see the
+ ":ref:`sdk-manual/sdk-appendix-customizing:configuring the extensible sdk`"
+ section in the Yocto Project Application Development and the
+ Extensible Software Development Kit (eSDK) manual.
+
+ SDK_NAME
+ The base name for SDK output files. The name is derived from the
+ :term:`DISTRO`, :term:`TCLIBC`,
+ :term:`SDK_ARCH`,
+ :term:`IMAGE_BASENAME`, and
+ :term:`TUNE_PKGARCH` variables:
+ ::
+
+ SDK_NAME = "${DISTRO}-${TCLIBC}-${SDK_ARCH}-${IMAGE_BASENAME}-${TUNE_PKGARCH}"
+
+ SDK_OS
+ Specifies the operating system for which the SDK will be built. The
+ default value is the value of :term:`BUILD_OS`.
+
+ SDK_OUTPUT
+ The location used by the OpenEmbedded build system when creating SDK
+ output. The :ref:`populate_sdk_base <ref-classes-populate-sdk-*>`
+ class defines the variable as follows:
+ ::
+
+ SDK_DIR = "${WORKDIR}/sdk"
+ SDK_OUTPUT = "${SDK_DIR}/image"
+ SDK_DEPLOY = "${DEPLOY_DIR}/sdk"
+
+ .. note::
+
+ The SDK_OUTPUT directory is a temporary directory as it is part of
+ WORKDIR by way of SDK_DIR. The final output directory is
+ SDK_DEPLOY.
+
+ SDK_PACKAGE_ARCHS
+ Specifies a list of architectures compatible with the SDK machine.
+ This variable is set automatically and should not normally be
+ hand-edited. Entries are separated using spaces and listed in order
+ of priority. The default value for ``SDK_PACKAGE_ARCHS`` is "all any
+ noarch ${SDK_ARCH}-${SDKPKGSUFFIX}".
+
+ SDK_POSTPROCESS_COMMAND
+ Specifies a list of functions to call once the OpenEmbedded build
+ system creates the SDK. You can specify functions separated by
+ semicolons: SDK_POSTPROCESS_COMMAND += "function; ... "
+
+ If you need to pass an SDK path to a command within a function, you
+ can use ``${SDK_DIR}``, which points to the parent directory used by
+ the OpenEmbedded build system when creating SDK output. See the
+ :term:`SDK_DIR` variable for more information.
+
+ SDK_PREFIX
+ The toolchain binary prefix used for ``nativesdk`` recipes. The
+ OpenEmbedded build system uses the ``SDK_PREFIX`` value to set the
+ :term:`TARGET_PREFIX` when building
+ ``nativesdk`` recipes. The default value is "${SDK_SYS}-".
+
+ SDK_RECRDEP_TASKS
+ A list of shared state tasks added to the extensible SDK. By default,
+ the following tasks are added:
+
+ - do_populate_lic
+ - do_package_qa
+ - do_populate_sysroot
+ - do_deploy
+
+ Despite the default value of "" for the
+ ``SDK_RECRDEP_TASKS`` variable, the above four tasks are always added
+ to the SDK. To specify tasks beyond these four, you need to use the
+ ``SDK_RECRDEP_TASKS`` variable (e.g. you are defining additional
+ tasks that are needed in order to build
+ :term:`SDK_TARGETS`).
+
+ SDK_SYS
+ Specifies the system, including the architecture and the operating
+ system, for which the SDK will be built.
+
+ The OpenEmbedded build system automatically sets this variable based
+ on :term:`SDK_ARCH`,
+ :term:`SDK_VENDOR`, and
+ :term:`SDK_OS`. You do not need to set the ``SDK_SYS``
+ variable yourself.
+
+ SDK_TARGET_MANIFEST
+ The manifest file for the target part of the SDK. This file lists all
+ the installed packages that make up the target part of the SDK. The
+ file contains package information on a line-per-package basis as
+ follows:
+ ::
+
+ packagename packagearch version
+
+ The :ref:`populate_sdk_base <ref-classes-populate-sdk-*>` class
+ defines the manifest file as follows:
+ ::
+
+ SDK_TARGET_MANIFEST = "${SDK_DEPLOY}/${TOOLCHAIN_OUTPUTNAME}.target.manifest"
+
+ The location is derived using the :term:`SDK_DEPLOY` and
+ :term:`TOOLCHAIN_OUTPUTNAME` variables.
+
+ SDK_TARGETS
+ A list of targets to install from shared state as part of the
+ standard or extensible SDK installation. The default value is "${PN}"
+ (i.e. the image from which the SDK is built).
+
+ The ``SDK_TARGETS`` variable is an internal variable and typically
+ would not be changed.
+
+ SDK_TITLE
+ The title to be printed when running the SDK installer. By default,
+ this title is based on the :term:`DISTRO_NAME` or
+ :term:`DISTRO` variable and is set in the
+ :ref:`populate_sdk_base <ref-classes-populate-sdk-*>` class as
+ follows:
+ ::
+
+ SDK_TITLE ??= "${@d.getVar('DISTRO_NAME') or d.getVar('DISTRO')} SDK"
+
+ For the default distribution "poky",
+ ``SDK_TITLE`` is set to "Poky (Yocto Project Reference Distro)".
+
+ For information on how to change this default title, see the
+ ":ref:`sdk-manual/sdk-appendix-customizing:changing the extensible sdk installer title`"
+ section in the Yocto Project Application Development and the
+ Extensible Software Development Kit (eSDK) manual.
+
+ SDK_UPDATE_URL
+ An optional URL for an update server for the extensible SDK. If set,
+ the value is used as the default update server when running
+ ``devtool sdk-update`` within the extensible SDK.
+
+ SDK_VENDOR
+ Specifies the name of the SDK vendor.
+
+ SDK_VERSION
+ Specifies the version of the SDK. The distribution configuration file
+ (e.g. ``/meta-poky/conf/distro/poky.conf``) defines the
+ ``SDK_VERSION`` as follows:
+ ::
+
+ SDK_VERSION = "${@d.getVar('DISTRO_VERSION').replace('snapshot-${DATE}','snapshot')}"
+
+ For additional information, see the
+ :term:`DISTRO_VERSION` and
+ :term:`DATE` variables.
+
+ SDKEXTPATH
+ The default installation directory for the Extensible SDK. By
+ default, this directory is based on the :term:`DISTRO`
+ variable and is set in the
+ :ref:`populate_sdk_base <ref-classes-populate-sdk-*>` class as
+ follows:
+ ::
+
+ SDKEXTPATH ??= "~/${@d.getVar('DISTRO')}_sdk"
+
+ For the
+ default distribution "poky", the ``SDKEXTPATH`` is set to "poky_sdk".
+
+ For information on how to change this default directory, see the
+ ":ref:`sdk-manual/sdk-appendix-customizing:changing the default sdk installation directory`"
+ section in the Yocto Project Application Development and the
+ Extensible Software Development Kit (eSDK) manual.
+
+ SDKIMAGE_FEATURES
+ Equivalent to ``IMAGE_FEATURES``. However, this variable applies to
+ the SDK generated from an image using the following command:
+ ::
+
+ $ bitbake -c populate_sdk imagename
+
+ SDKMACHINE
+ The machine for which the SDK is built. In other words, the SDK is
+ built such that it runs on the target you specify with the
+ ``SDKMACHINE`` value. The value points to a corresponding ``.conf``
+ file under ``conf/machine-sdk/``.
+
+ You can use "i686" and "x86_64" as possible values for this variable.
+ The variable defaults to "i686" and is set in the local.conf file in
+ the Build Directory.
+ ::
+
+ SDKMACHINE ?= "i686"
+
+ .. note::
+
+ You cannot set the
+ SDKMACHINE
+ variable in your distribution configuration file. If you do, the
+ configuration will not take affect.
+
+ SDKPATH
+ Defines the path offered to the user for installation of the SDK that
+ is generated by the OpenEmbedded build system. The path appears as
+ the default location for installing the SDK when you run the SDK's
+ installation script. You can override the offered path when you run
+ the script.
+
+ SDKTARGETSYSROOT
+ The full path to the sysroot used for cross-compilation within an SDK
+ as it will be when installed into the default
+ :term:`SDKPATH`.
+
+ SECTION
+ The section in which packages should be categorized. Package
+ management utilities can make use of this variable.
+
+ SELECTED_OPTIMIZATION
+ Specifies the optimization flags passed to the C compiler when
+ building for the target. The flags are passed through the default
+ value of the :term:`TARGET_CFLAGS` variable.
+
+ The ``SELECTED_OPTIMIZATION`` variable takes the value of
+ ``FULL_OPTIMIZATION`` unless ``DEBUG_BUILD`` = "1". If that is the
+ case, the value of ``DEBUG_OPTIMIZATION`` is used.
+
+ SERIAL_CONSOLE
+ Defines a serial console (TTY) to enable using
+ `getty <https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Getty_(Unix)>`__. Provide a
+ value that specifies the baud rate followed by the TTY device name
+ separated by a space. You cannot specify more than one TTY device:
+ ::
+
+ SERIAL_CONSOLE = "115200 ttyS0"
+
+ .. note::
+
+ The
+ SERIAL_CONSOLE
+ variable is deprecated. Please use the
+ SERIAL_CONSOLES
+ variable.
+
+ SERIAL_CONSOLES
+ Defines a serial console (TTY) to enable using
+ `getty <https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Getty_(Unix)>`__. Provide a
+ value that specifies the baud rate followed by the TTY device name
+ separated by a semicolon. Use spaces to separate multiple devices:
+ ::
+
+ SERIAL_CONSOLES = "115200;ttyS0 115200;ttyS1"
+
+ SERIAL_CONSOLES_CHECK
+ Specifies serial consoles, which must be listed in
+ :term:`SERIAL_CONSOLES`, to check against
+ ``/proc/console`` before enabling them using getty. This variable
+ allows aliasing in the format: <device>:<alias>. If a device was
+ listed as "sclp_line0" in ``/dev/`` and "ttyS0" was listed in
+ ``/proc/console``, you would do the following: ::
+
+ SERIAL_CONSOLES_CHECK = "slcp_line0:ttyS0"
+
+ This variable is currently only supported with SysVinit (i.e. not
+ with systemd).
+
+ SIGGEN_EXCLUDE_SAFE_RECIPE_DEPS
+ A list of recipe dependencies that should not be used to determine
+ signatures of tasks from one recipe when they depend on tasks from
+ another recipe. For example: ::
+
+ SIGGEN_EXCLUDE_SAFE_RECIPE_DEPS += "intone->mplayer2"
+
+ In the previous example, ``intone`` depends on ``mplayer2``.
+
+ You can use the special token ``"*"`` on the left-hand side of the
+ dependency to match all recipes except the one on the right-hand
+ side. Here is an example: ::
+
+ SIGGEN_EXCLUDE_SAFE_RECIPE_DEPS += "*->quilt-native"
+
+ In the previous example, all recipes except ``quilt-native`` ignore
+ task signatures from the ``quilt-native`` recipe when determining
+ their task signatures.
+
+ Use of this variable is one mechanism to remove dependencies that
+ affect task signatures and thus force rebuilds when a recipe changes.
+
+ .. note::
+
+ If you add an inappropriate dependency for a recipe relationship,
+ the software might break during runtime if the interface of the
+ second recipe was changed after the first recipe had been built.
+
+ SIGGEN_EXCLUDERECIPES_ABISAFE
+ A list of recipes that are completely stable and will never change.
+ The ABI for the recipes in the list are presented by output from the
+ tasks run to build the recipe. Use of this variable is one way to
+ remove dependencies from one recipe on another that affect task
+ signatures and thus force rebuilds when the recipe changes.
+
+ .. note::
+
+ If you add an inappropriate variable to this list, the software
+ might break at runtime if the interface of the recipe was changed
+ after the other had been built.
+
+ SITEINFO_BITS
+ Specifies the number of bits for the target system CPU. The value
+ should be either "32" or "64".
+
+ SITEINFO_ENDIANNESS
+ Specifies the endian byte order of the target system. The value
+ should be either "le" for little-endian or "be" for big-endian.
+
+ SKIP_FILEDEPS
+ Enables removal of all files from the "Provides" section of an RPM
+ package. Removal of these files is required for packages containing
+ prebuilt binaries and libraries such as ``libstdc++`` and ``glibc``.
+
+ To enable file removal, set the variable to "1" in your
+ ``conf/local.conf`` configuration file in your:
+ :term:`Build Directory`.
+ ::
+
+ SKIP_FILEDEPS = "1"
+
+ SOC_FAMILY
+ Groups together machines based upon the same family of SOC (System On
+ Chip). You typically set this variable in a common ``.inc`` file that
+ you include in the configuration files of all the machines.
+
+ .. note::
+
+ You must include
+ conf/machine/include/soc-family.inc
+ for this variable to appear in
+ MACHINEOVERRIDES
+ .
+
+ SOLIBS
+ Defines the suffix for shared libraries used on the target platform.
+ By default, this suffix is ".so.*" for all Linux-based systems and is
+ defined in the ``meta/conf/bitbake.conf`` configuration file.
+
+ You will see this variable referenced in the default values of
+ ``FILES_${PN}``.
+
+ SOLIBSDEV
+ Defines the suffix for the development symbolic link (symlink) for
+ shared libraries on the target platform. By default, this suffix is
+ ".so" for Linux-based systems and is defined in the
+ ``meta/conf/bitbake.conf`` configuration file.
+
+ You will see this variable referenced in the default values of
+ ``FILES_${PN}-dev``.
+
+ SOURCE_MIRROR_FETCH
+ When you are fetching files to create a mirror of sources (i.e.
+ creating a source mirror), setting ``SOURCE_MIRROR_FETCH`` to "1" in
+ your ``local.conf`` configuration file ensures the source for all
+ recipes are fetched regardless of whether or not a recipe is
+ compatible with the configuration. A recipe is considered
+ incompatible with the currently configured machine when either or
+ both the :term:`COMPATIBLE_MACHINE`
+ variable and :term:`COMPATIBLE_HOST` variables
+ specify compatibility with a machine other than that of the current
+ machine or host.
+
+ .. note::
+
+ Do not set the
+ SOURCE_MIRROR_FETCH
+ variable unless you are creating a source mirror. In other words,
+ do not set the variable during a normal build.
+
+ SOURCE_MIRROR_URL
+ Defines your own :term:`PREMIRRORS` from which to
+ first fetch source before attempting to fetch from the upstream
+ specified in :term:`SRC_URI`.
+
+ To use this variable, you must globally inherit the
+ :ref:`own-mirrors <ref-classes-own-mirrors>` class and then provide
+ the URL to your mirrors. Here is the general syntax:
+ ::
+
+ INHERIT += "own-mirrors"
+ SOURCE_MIRROR_URL = "http://example.com/my_source_mirror"
+
+ .. note::
+
+ You can specify only a single URL in
+ SOURCE_MIRROR_URL
+ .
+
+ SPDXLICENSEMAP
+ Maps commonly used license names to their SPDX counterparts found in
+ ``meta/files/common-licenses/``. For the default ``SPDXLICENSEMAP``
+ mappings, see the ``meta/conf/licenses.conf`` file.
+
+ For additional information, see the :term:`LICENSE`
+ variable.
+
+ SPECIAL_PKGSUFFIX
+ A list of prefixes for :term:`PN` used by the OpenEmbedded
+ build system to create variants of recipes or packages. The list
+ specifies the prefixes to strip off during certain circumstances such
+ as the generation of the :term:`BPN` variable.
+
+ SPL_BINARY
+ The file type for the Secondary Program Loader (SPL). Some devices
+ use an SPL from which to boot (e.g. the BeagleBone development
+ board). For such cases, you can declare the file type of the SPL
+ binary in the ``u-boot.inc`` include file, which is used in the
+ U-Boot recipe.
+
+ The SPL file type is set to "null" by default in the ``u-boot.inc``
+ file as follows:
+ ::
+
+ # Some versions of u-boot build an SPL (Second Program Loader) image that
+ # should be packaged along with the u-boot binary as well as placed in the
+ # deploy directory. For those versions they can set the following variables
+ # to allow packaging the SPL.
+ SPL_BINARY ?= ""
+ SPL_BINARYNAME ?= "${@os.path.basename(d.getVar("SPL_BINARY"))}"
+ SPL_IMAGE ?= "${SPL_BINARYNAME}-${MACHINE}-${PV}-${PR}"
+ SPL_SYMLINK ?= "${SPL_BINARYNAME}-${MACHINE}"
+
+ The ``SPL_BINARY`` variable helps form
+ various ``SPL_*`` variables used by the OpenEmbedded build system.
+
+ See the BeagleBone machine configuration example in the
+ ":ref:`dev-manual/dev-manual-common-tasks:adding a layer using the \`\`bitbake-layers\`\` script`"
+ section in the Yocto Project Board Support Package Developer's Guide
+ for additional information.
+
+ SRC_URI
+ The list of source files - local or remote. This variable tells the
+ OpenEmbedded build system which bits to pull in for the build and how
+ to pull them in. For example, if the recipe or append file only needs
+ to fetch a tarball from the Internet, the recipe or append file uses
+ a single ``SRC_URI`` entry. On the other hand, if the recipe or
+ append file needs to fetch a tarball, apply two patches, and include
+ a custom file, the recipe or append file would include four instances
+ of the variable.
+
+ The following list explains the available URI protocols. URI
+ protocols are highly dependent on particular BitBake Fetcher
+ submodules. Depending on the fetcher BitBake uses, various URL
+ parameters are employed. For specifics on the supported Fetchers, see
+ the ":ref:`Fetchers <bitbake:bb-fetchers>`" section in the
+ BitBake User Manual.
+
+ - ``file://`` - Fetches files, which are usually files shipped
+ with the :term:`Metadata`, from the local machine (e.g.
+ :ref:`patch <patching-dev-environment>` files).
+ The path is relative to the :term:`FILESPATH`
+ variable. Thus, the build system searches, in order, from the
+ following directories, which are assumed to be a subdirectories of
+ the directory in which the recipe file (``.bb``) or append file
+ (``.bbappend``) resides:
+
+ - ``${BPN}`` - The base recipe name without any special suffix
+ or version numbers.
+
+ - ``${BP}`` - ``${BPN}-${PV}``. The base recipe name and
+ version but without any special package name suffix.
+
+ - *files -* Files within a directory, which is named ``files``
+ and is also alongside the recipe or append file.
+
+ .. note::
+
+ If you want the build system to pick up files specified through
+ a
+ SRC_URI
+ statement from your append file, you need to be sure to extend
+ the
+ FILESPATH
+ variable by also using the
+ FILESEXTRAPATHS
+ variable from within your append file.
+
+ - ``bzr://`` - Fetches files from a Bazaar revision control
+ repository.
+
+ - ``git://`` - Fetches files from a Git revision control
+ repository.
+
+ - ``osc://`` - Fetches files from an OSC (OpenSUSE Build service)
+ revision control repository.
+
+ - ``repo://`` - Fetches files from a repo (Git) repository.
+
+ - ``ccrc://`` - Fetches files from a ClearCase repository.
+
+ - ``http://`` - Fetches files from the Internet using ``http``.
+
+ - ``https://`` - Fetches files from the Internet using ``https``.
+
+ - ``ftp://`` - Fetches files from the Internet using ``ftp``.
+
+ - ``cvs://`` - Fetches files from a CVS revision control
+ repository.
+
+ - ``hg://`` - Fetches files from a Mercurial (``hg``) revision
+ control repository.
+
+ - ``p4://`` - Fetches files from a Perforce (``p4``) revision
+ control repository.
+
+ - ``ssh://`` - Fetches files from a secure shell.
+
+ - ``svn://`` - Fetches files from a Subversion (``svn``) revision
+ control repository.
+
+ - ``npm://`` - Fetches JavaScript modules from a registry.
+
+ Standard and recipe-specific options for ``SRC_URI`` exist. Here are
+ standard options:
+
+ - ``apply`` - Whether to apply the patch or not. The default
+ action is to apply the patch.
+
+ - ``striplevel`` - Which striplevel to use when applying the
+ patch. The default level is 1.
+
+ - ``patchdir`` - Specifies the directory in which the patch should
+ be applied. The default is ``${``\ :term:`S`\ ``}``.
+
+ Here are options specific to recipes building code from a revision
+ control system:
+
+ - ``mindate`` - Apply the patch only if
+ :term:`SRCDATE` is equal to or greater than
+ ``mindate``.
+
+ - ``maxdate`` - Apply the patch only if ``SRCDATE`` is not later
+ than ``maxdate``.
+
+ - ``minrev`` - Apply the patch only if ``SRCREV`` is equal to or
+ greater than ``minrev``.
+
+ - ``maxrev`` - Apply the patch only if ``SRCREV`` is not later
+ than ``maxrev``.
+
+ - ``rev`` - Apply the patch only if ``SRCREV`` is equal to
+ ``rev``.
+
+ - ``notrev`` - Apply the patch only if ``SRCREV`` is not equal to
+ ``rev``.
+
+ Here are some additional options worth mentioning:
+
+ - ``unpack`` - Controls whether or not to unpack the file if it is
+ an archive. The default action is to unpack the file.
+
+ - ``destsuffix`` - Places the file (or extracts its contents) into
+ the specified subdirectory of :term:`WORKDIR` when
+ the Git fetcher is used.
+
+ - ``subdir`` - Places the file (or extracts its contents) into the
+ specified subdirectory of ``WORKDIR`` when the local (``file://``)
+ fetcher is used.
+
+ - ``localdir`` - Places the file (or extracts its contents) into
+ the specified subdirectory of ``WORKDIR`` when the CVS fetcher is
+ used.
+
+ - ``subpath`` - Limits the checkout to a specific subpath of the
+ tree when using the Git fetcher is used.
+
+ - ``name`` - Specifies a name to be used for association with
+ ``SRC_URI`` checksums when you have more than one file specified
+ in ``SRC_URI``.
+
+ - ``downloadfilename`` - Specifies the filename used when storing
+ the downloaded file.
+
+ SRC_URI_OVERRIDES_PACKAGE_ARCH
+ By default, the OpenEmbedded build system automatically detects
+ whether ``SRC_URI`` contains files that are machine-specific. If so,
+ the build system automatically changes ``PACKAGE_ARCH``. Setting this
+ variable to "0" disables this behavior.
+
+ SRCDATE
+ The date of the source code used to build the package. This variable
+ applies only if the source was fetched from a Source Code Manager
+ (SCM).
+
+ SRCPV
+ Returns the version string of the current package. This string is
+ used to help define the value of :term:`PV`.
+
+ The ``SRCPV`` variable is defined in the ``meta/conf/bitbake.conf``
+ configuration file in the :term:`Source Directory` as
+ follows:
+ ::
+
+ SRCPV = "${@bb.fetch2.get_srcrev(d)}"
+
+ Recipes that need to define ``PV`` do so with the help of the
+ ``SRCPV``. For example, the ``ofono`` recipe (``ofono_git.bb``)
+ located in ``meta/recipes-connectivity`` in the Source Directory
+ defines ``PV`` as follows:
+ ::
+
+ PV = "0.12-git${SRCPV}"
+
+ SRCREV
+ The revision of the source code used to build the package. This
+ variable applies to Subversion, Git, Mercurial, and Bazaar only. Note
+ that if you want to build a fixed revision and you want to avoid
+ performing a query on the remote repository every time BitBake parses
+ your recipe, you should specify a ``SRCREV`` that is a full revision
+ identifier and not just a tag.
+
+ .. note::
+
+ For information on limitations when inheriting the latest revision
+ of software using
+ SRCREV
+ , see the
+ AUTOREV
+ variable description and the "
+ Automatically Incrementing a Binary Package Revision Number
+ " section, which is in the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual.
+
+ SSTATE_DIR
+ The directory for the shared state cache.
+
+ SSTATE_MIRROR_ALLOW_NETWORK
+ If set to "1", allows fetches from mirrors that are specified in
+ :term:`SSTATE_MIRRORS` to work even when
+ fetching from the network is disabled by setting ``BB_NO_NETWORK`` to
+ "1". Using the ``SSTATE_MIRROR_ALLOW_NETWORK`` variable is useful if
+ you have set ``SSTATE_MIRRORS`` to point to an internal server for
+ your shared state cache, but you want to disable any other fetching
+ from the network.
+
+ SSTATE_MIRRORS
+ Configures the OpenEmbedded build system to search other mirror
+ locations for prebuilt cache data objects before building out the
+ data. This variable works like fetcher :term:`MIRRORS`
+ and :term:`PREMIRRORS` and points to the cache
+ locations to check for the shared state (sstate) objects.
+
+ You can specify a filesystem directory or a remote URL such as HTTP
+ or FTP. The locations you specify need to contain the shared state
+ cache (sstate-cache) results from previous builds. The sstate-cache
+ you point to can also be from builds on other machines.
+
+ When pointing to sstate build artifacts on another machine that uses
+ a different GCC version for native builds, you must configure
+ ``SSTATE_MIRRORS`` with a regular expression that maps local search
+ paths to server paths. The paths need to take into account
+ :term:`NATIVELSBSTRING` set by the
+ :ref:`uninative <ref-classes-uninative>` class. For example, the
+ following maps the local search path ``universal-4.9`` to the
+ server-provided path server_url_sstate_path:
+ ::
+
+ SSTATE_MIRRORS ?= "file://universal-4.9/(.*) http://server_url_sstate_path/universal-4.8/\1 \n"
+
+ If a mirror uses the same structure as
+ :term:`SSTATE_DIR`, you need to add "PATH" at the
+ end as shown in the examples below. The build system substitutes the
+ correct path within the directory structure.
+ ::
+
+ SSTATE_MIRRORS ?= "\
+ file://.* http://someserver.tld/share/sstate/PATH;downloadfilename=PATH \n \
+ file://.* file:///some-local-dir/sstate/PATH"
+
+ SSTATE_SCAN_FILES
+ Controls the list of files the OpenEmbedded build system scans for
+ hardcoded installation paths. The variable uses a space-separated
+ list of filenames (not paths) with standard wildcard characters
+ allowed.
+
+ During a build, the OpenEmbedded build system creates a shared state
+ (sstate) object during the first stage of preparing the sysroots.
+ That object is scanned for hardcoded paths for original installation
+ locations. The list of files that are scanned for paths is controlled
+ by the ``SSTATE_SCAN_FILES`` variable. Typically, recipes add files
+ they want to be scanned to the value of ``SSTATE_SCAN_FILES`` rather
+ than the variable being comprehensively set. The
+ :ref:`sstate <ref-classes-sstate>` class specifies the default list
+ of files.
+
+ For details on the process, see the
+ :ref:`staging <ref-classes-staging>` class.
+
+ STAGING_BASE_LIBDIR_NATIVE
+ Specifies the path to the ``/lib`` subdirectory of the sysroot
+ directory for the build host.
+
+ STAGING_BASELIBDIR
+ Specifies the path to the ``/lib`` subdirectory of the sysroot
+ directory for the target for which the current recipe is being built
+ (:term:`STAGING_DIR_HOST`).
+
+ STAGING_BINDIR
+ Specifies the path to the ``/usr/bin`` subdirectory of the sysroot
+ directory for the target for which the current recipe is being built
+ (:term:`STAGING_DIR_HOST`).
+
+ STAGING_BINDIR_CROSS
+ Specifies the path to the directory containing binary configuration
+ scripts. These scripts provide configuration information for other
+ software that wants to make use of libraries or include files
+ provided by the software associated with the script.
+
+ .. note::
+
+ This style of build configuration has been largely replaced by
+ pkg-config
+ . Consequently, if
+ pkg-config
+ is supported by the library to which you are linking, it is
+ recommended you use
+ pkg-config
+ instead of a provided configuration script.
+
+ STAGING_BINDIR_NATIVE
+ Specifies the path to the ``/usr/bin`` subdirectory of the sysroot
+ directory for the build host.
+
+ STAGING_DATADIR
+ Specifies the path to the ``/usr/share`` subdirectory of the sysroot
+ directory for the target for which the current recipe is being built
+ (:term:`STAGING_DIR_HOST`).
+
+ STAGING_DATADIR_NATIVE
+ Specifies the path to the ``/usr/share`` subdirectory of the sysroot
+ directory for the build host.
+
+ STAGING_DIR
+ Helps construct the ``recipe-sysroots`` directory, which is used
+ during packaging.
+
+ For information on how staging for recipe-specific sysroots occurs,
+ see the :ref:`ref-tasks-populate_sysroot`
+ task, the ":ref:`sdk-manual/sdk-extensible:sharing files between recipes`"
+ section in the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual, the
+ ":ref:`configuration-compilation-and-staging-dev-environment`"
+ section in the Yocto Project Overview and Concepts Manual, and the
+ :term:`SYSROOT_DIRS` variable.
+
+ .. note::
+
+ Recipes should never write files directly under the
+ STAGING_DIR
+ directory because the OpenEmbedded build system manages the
+ directory automatically. Instead, files should be installed to
+ ${
+ D
+ }
+ within your recipe's
+ do_install
+ task and then the OpenEmbedded build system will stage a subset of
+ those files into the sysroot.
+
+ STAGING_DIR_HOST
+ Specifies the path to the sysroot directory for the system on which
+ the component is built to run (the system that hosts the component).
+ For most recipes, this sysroot is the one in which that recipe's
+ :ref:`ref-tasks-populate_sysroot` task copies
+ files. Exceptions include ``-native`` recipes, where the
+ ``do_populate_sysroot`` task instead uses
+ :term:`STAGING_DIR_NATIVE`. Depending on
+ the type of recipe and the build target, ``STAGING_DIR_HOST`` can
+ have the following values:
+
+ - For recipes building for the target machine, the value is
+ "${:term:`STAGING_DIR`}/${:term:`MACHINE`}".
+
+ - For native recipes building for the build host, the value is empty
+ given the assumption that when building for the build host, the
+ build host's own directories should be used.
+
+ .. note::
+
+ ``-native`` recipes are not installed into host paths like such
+ as ``/usr``. Rather, these recipes are installed into
+ ``STAGING_DIR_NATIVE``. When compiling ``-native`` recipes,
+ standard build environment variables such as
+ :term:`CPPFLAGS` and
+ :term:`CFLAGS` are set up so that both host paths
+ and ``STAGING_DIR_NATIVE`` are searched for libraries and
+ headers using, for example, GCC's ``-isystem`` option.
+
+ Thus, the emphasis is that the ``STAGING_DIR*`` variables
+ should be viewed as input variables by tasks such as
+ :ref:`ref-tasks-configure`,
+ :ref:`ref-tasks-compile`, and
+ :ref:`ref-tasks-install`. Having the real system
+ root correspond to ``STAGING_DIR_HOST`` makes conceptual sense
+ for ``-native`` recipes, as they make use of host headers and
+ libraries.
+
+ STAGING_DIR_NATIVE
+ Specifies the path to the sysroot directory used when building
+ components that run on the build host itself.
+
+ STAGING_DIR_TARGET
+ Specifies the path to the sysroot used for the system for which the
+ component generates code. For components that do not generate code,
+ which is the majority, ``STAGING_DIR_TARGET`` is set to match
+ :term:`STAGING_DIR_HOST`.
+
+ Some recipes build binaries that can run on the target system but
+ those binaries in turn generate code for another different system
+ (e.g. cross-canadian recipes). Using terminology from GNU, the
+ primary system is referred to as the "HOST" and the secondary, or
+ different, system is referred to as the "TARGET". Thus, the binaries
+ run on the "HOST" system and generate binaries for the "TARGET"
+ system. The ``STAGING_DIR_HOST`` variable points to the sysroot used
+ for the "HOST" system, while ``STAGING_DIR_TARGET`` points to the
+ sysroot used for the "TARGET" system.
+
+ STAGING_ETCDIR_NATIVE
+ Specifies the path to the ``/etc`` subdirectory of the sysroot
+ directory for the build host.
+
+ STAGING_EXECPREFIXDIR
+ Specifies the path to the ``/usr`` subdirectory of the sysroot
+ directory for the target for which the current recipe is being built
+ (:term:`STAGING_DIR_HOST`).
+
+ STAGING_INCDIR
+ Specifies the path to the ``/usr/include`` subdirectory of the
+ sysroot directory for the target for which the current recipe being
+ built (:term:`STAGING_DIR_HOST`).
+
+ STAGING_INCDIR_NATIVE
+ Specifies the path to the ``/usr/include`` subdirectory of the
+ sysroot directory for the build host.
+
+ STAGING_KERNEL_BUILDDIR
+ Points to the directory containing the kernel build artifacts.
+ Recipes building software that needs to access kernel build artifacts
+ (e.g. ``systemtap-uprobes``) can look in the directory specified with
+ the ``STAGING_KERNEL_BUILDDIR`` variable to find these artifacts
+ after the kernel has been built.
+
+ STAGING_KERNEL_DIR
+ The directory with kernel headers that are required to build
+ out-of-tree modules.
+
+ STAGING_LIBDIR
+ Specifies the path to the ``/usr/lib`` subdirectory of the sysroot
+ directory for the target for which the current recipe is being built
+ (:term:`STAGING_DIR_HOST`).
+
+ STAGING_LIBDIR_NATIVE
+ Specifies the path to the ``/usr/lib`` subdirectory of the sysroot
+ directory for the build host.
+
+ STAMP
+ Specifies the base path used to create recipe stamp files. The path
+ to an actual stamp file is constructed by evaluating this string and
+ then appending additional information. Currently, the default
+ assignment for ``STAMP`` as set in the ``meta/conf/bitbake.conf``
+ file is:
+ ::
+
+ STAMP = "${STAMPS_DIR}/${MULTIMACH_TARGET_SYS}/${PN}/${EXTENDPE}${PV}-${PR}"
+
+ For information on how BitBake uses stamp files to determine if a
+ task should be rerun, see the
+ ":ref:`overview-manual/overview-manual-concepts:stamp files and the rerunning of tasks`"
+ section in the Yocto Project Overview and Concepts Manual.
+
+ See :term:`STAMPS_DIR`,
+ :term:`MULTIMACH_TARGET_SYS`,
+ :term:`PN`, :term:`EXTENDPE`,
+ :term:`PV`, and :term:`PR` for related variable
+ information.
+
+ STAMPS_DIR
+ Specifies the base directory in which the OpenEmbedded build system
+ places stamps. The default directory is ``${TMPDIR}/stamps``.
+
+ STRIP
+ The minimal command and arguments to run ``strip``, which is used to
+ strip symbols.
+
+ SUMMARY
+ The short (72 characters or less) summary of the binary package for
+ packaging systems such as ``opkg``, ``rpm``, or ``dpkg``. By default,
+ ``SUMMARY`` is used to define the
+ :term:`DESCRIPTION` variable if ``DESCRIPTION`` is
+ not set in the recipe.
+
+ SVNDIR
+ The directory in which files checked out of a Subversion system are
+ stored.
+
+ SYSLINUX_DEFAULT_CONSOLE
+ Specifies the kernel boot default console. If you want to use a
+ console other than the default, set this variable in your recipe as
+ follows where "X" is the console number you want to use:
+ ::
+
+ SYSLINUX_DEFAULT_CONSOLE = "console=ttyX"
+
+ The :ref:`syslinux <ref-classes-syslinux>` class initially sets
+ this variable to null but then checks for a value later.
+
+ SYSLINUX_OPTS
+ Lists additional options to add to the syslinux file. You need to set
+ this variable in your recipe. If you want to list multiple options,
+ separate the options with a semicolon character (``;``).
+
+ The :ref:`syslinux <ref-classes-syslinux>` class uses this variable
+ to create a set of options.
+
+ SYSLINUX_SERIAL
+ Specifies the alternate serial port or turns it off. To turn off
+ serial, set this variable to an empty string in your recipe. The
+ variable's default value is set in the
+ :ref:`syslinux <ref-classes-syslinux>` class as follows:
+ ::
+
+ SYSLINUX_SERIAL ?= "0 115200"
+
+ The class checks for and uses the variable as needed.
+
+ SYSLINUX_SPLASH
+ An ``.LSS`` file used as the background for the VGA boot menu when
+ you use the boot menu. You need to set this variable in your recipe.
+
+ The :ref:`syslinux <ref-classes-syslinux>` class checks for this
+ variable and if found, the OpenEmbedded build system installs the
+ splash screen.
+
+ SYSLINUX_SERIAL_TTY
+ Specifies the alternate console=tty... kernel boot argument. The
+ variable's default value is set in the
+ :ref:`syslinux <ref-classes-syslinux>` class as follows:
+ ::
+
+ SYSLINUX_SERIAL_TTY ?= "console=ttyS0,115200"
+
+ The class checks for and uses the variable as needed.
+
+ SYSROOT_DESTDIR
+ Points to the temporary directory under the work directory (default
+ "``${``\ :term:`WORKDIR`\ ``}/sysroot-destdir``")
+ where the files populated into the sysroot are assembled during the
+ :ref:`ref-tasks-populate_sysroot` task.
+
+ SYSROOT_DIRS
+ Directories that are staged into the sysroot by the
+ :ref:`ref-tasks-populate_sysroot` task. By
+ default, the following directories are staged:
+ ::
+
+ SYSROOT_DIRS = " \
+ ${includedir} \
+ ${libdir} \
+ ${base_libdir} \
+ ${nonarch_base_libdir} \
+ ${datadir} \
+ "
+
+ SYSROOT_DIRS_BLACKLIST
+ Directories that are not staged into the sysroot by the
+ :ref:`ref-tasks-populate_sysroot` task. You
+ can use this variable to exclude certain subdirectories of
+ directories listed in :term:`SYSROOT_DIRS` from
+ staging. By default, the following directories are not staged:
+ ::
+
+ SYSROOT_DIRS_BLACKLIST = " \
+ ${mandir} \
+ ${docdir} \
+ ${infodir} \
+ ${datadir}/locale \
+ ${datadir}/applications \
+ ${datadir}/fonts \
+ ${datadir}/pixmaps \
+ "
+
+ SYSROOT_DIRS_NATIVE
+ Extra directories staged into the sysroot by the
+ :ref:`ref-tasks-populate_sysroot` task for
+ ``-native`` recipes, in addition to those specified in
+ :term:`SYSROOT_DIRS`. By default, the following
+ extra directories are staged:
+ ::
+
+ SYSROOT_DIRS_NATIVE = " \
+ ${bindir} \
+ ${sbindir} \
+ ${base_bindir} \
+ ${base_sbindir} \
+ ${libexecdir} \
+ ${sysconfdir} \
+ ${localstatedir} \
+ "
+
+ .. note::
+
+ Programs built by
+ -native
+ recipes run directly from the sysroot (
+ STAGING_DIR_NATIVE
+ ), which is why additional directories containing program
+ executables and supporting files need to be staged.
+
+ SYSROOT_PREPROCESS_FUNCS
+ A list of functions to execute after files are staged into the
+ sysroot. These functions are usually used to apply additional
+ processing on the staged files, or to stage additional files.
+
+ SYSTEMD_AUTO_ENABLE
+ When inheriting the :ref:`systemd <ref-classes-systemd>` class,
+ this variable specifies whether the specified service in
+ :term:`SYSTEMD_SERVICE` should start
+ automatically or not. By default, the service is enabled to
+ automatically start at boot time. The default setting is in the
+ :ref:`systemd <ref-classes-systemd>` class as follows:
+ ::
+
+ SYSTEMD_AUTO_ENABLE ??= "enable"
+
+ You can disable the service by setting the variable to "disable".
+
+ SYSTEMD_BOOT_CFG
+ When :term:`EFI_PROVIDER` is set to
+ "systemd-boot", the ``SYSTEMD_BOOT_CFG`` variable specifies the
+ configuration file that should be used. By default, the
+ :ref:`systemd-boot <ref-classes-systemd-boot>` class sets the
+ ``SYSTEMD_BOOT_CFG`` as follows:
+ ::
+
+ SYSTEMD_BOOT_CFG ?= "${:term:`S`}/loader.conf"
+
+ For information on Systemd-boot, see the `Systemd-boot
+ documentation <http://www.freedesktop.org/wiki/Software/systemd/systemd-boot/>`__.
+
+ SYSTEMD_BOOT_ENTRIES
+ When :term:`EFI_PROVIDER` is set to
+ "systemd-boot", the ``SYSTEMD_BOOT_ENTRIES`` variable specifies a
+ list of entry files (``*.conf``) to install that contain one boot
+ entry per file. By default, the
+ :ref:`systemd-boot <ref-classes-systemd-boot>` class sets the
+ ``SYSTEMD_BOOT_ENTRIES`` as follows:
+ ::
+
+ SYSTEMD_BOOT_ENTRIES ?= ""
+
+ For information on Systemd-boot, see the `Systemd-boot
+ documentation <http://www.freedesktop.org/wiki/Software/systemd/systemd-boot/>`__.
+
+ SYSTEMD_BOOT_TIMEOUT
+ When :term:`EFI_PROVIDER` is set to
+ "systemd-boot", the ``SYSTEMD_BOOT_TIMEOUT`` variable specifies the
+ boot menu timeout in seconds. By default, the
+ :ref:`systemd-boot <ref-classes-systemd-boot>` class sets the
+ ``SYSTEMD_BOOT_TIMEOUT`` as follows:
+ ::
+
+ SYSTEMD_BOOT_TIMEOUT ?= "10"
+
+ For information on Systemd-boot, see the `Systemd-boot
+ documentation <http://www.freedesktop.org/wiki/Software/systemd/systemd-boot/>`__.
+
+ SYSTEMD_PACKAGES
+ When inheriting the :ref:`systemd <ref-classes-systemd>` class,
+ this variable locates the systemd unit files when they are not found
+ in the main recipe's package. By default, the ``SYSTEMD_PACKAGES``
+ variable is set such that the systemd unit files are assumed to
+ reside in the recipes main package:
+ ::
+
+ SYSTEMD_PACKAGES ?= "${PN}"
+
+ If these unit files are not in this recipe's main package, you need
+ to use ``SYSTEMD_PACKAGES`` to list the package or packages in which
+ the build system can find the systemd unit files.
+
+ SYSTEMD_SERVICE
+ When inheriting the :ref:`systemd <ref-classes-systemd>` class,
+ this variable specifies the systemd service name for a package.
+
+ When you specify this file in your recipe, use a package name
+ override to indicate the package to which the value applies. Here is
+ an example from the connman recipe:
+ ::
+
+ SYSTEMD_SERVICE_${PN} = "connman.service"
+
+ SYSVINIT_ENABLED_GETTYS
+ When using
+ :ref:`SysVinit <dev-manual/dev-manual-common-tasks:enabling system services>`,
+ specifies a space-separated list of the virtual terminals that should
+ run a `getty <http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Getty_%28Unix%29>`__
+ (allowing login), assuming :term:`USE_VT` is not set to
+ "0".
+
+ The default value for ``SYSVINIT_ENABLED_GETTYS`` is "1" (i.e. only
+ run a getty on the first virtual terminal).
+
+ T
+ This variable points to a directory were BitBake places temporary
+ files, which consist mostly of task logs and scripts, when building a
+ particular recipe. The variable is typically set as follows:
+ ::
+
+ T = "${WORKDIR}/temp"
+
+ The :term:`WORKDIR` is the directory into which
+ BitBake unpacks and builds the recipe. The default ``bitbake.conf``
+ file sets this variable.
+
+ The ``T`` variable is not to be confused with the
+ :term:`TMPDIR` variable, which points to the root of
+ the directory tree where BitBake places the output of an entire
+ build.
+
+ TARGET_ARCH
+ The target machine's architecture. The OpenEmbedded build system
+ supports many architectures. Here is an example list of architectures
+ supported. This list is by no means complete as the architecture is
+ configurable:
+
+ - arm
+ - i586
+ - x86_64
+ - powerpc
+ - powerpc64
+ - mips
+ - mipsel
+
+ For additional information on machine architectures, see the
+ :term:`TUNE_ARCH` variable.
+
+ TARGET_AS_ARCH
+ Specifies architecture-specific assembler flags for the target
+ system. ``TARGET_AS_ARCH`` is initialized from
+ :term:`TUNE_ASARGS` by default in the BitBake
+ configuration file (``meta/conf/bitbake.conf``):
+ ::
+
+ TARGET_AS_ARCH = "${TUNE_ASARGS}"
+
+ TARGET_CC_ARCH
+ Specifies architecture-specific C compiler flags for the target
+ system. ``TARGET_CC_ARCH`` is initialized from
+ :term:`TUNE_CCARGS` by default.
+
+ .. note::
+
+ It is a common workaround to append
+ LDFLAGS
+ to
+ TARGET_CC_ARCH
+ in recipes that build software for the target that would not
+ otherwise respect the exported
+ LDFLAGS
+ variable.
+
+ TARGET_CC_KERNEL_ARCH
+ This is a specific kernel compiler flag for a CPU or Application
+ Binary Interface (ABI) tune. The flag is used rarely and only for
+ cases where a userspace :term:`TUNE_CCARGS` is not
+ compatible with the kernel compilation. The ``TARGET_CC_KERNEL_ARCH``
+ variable allows the kernel (and associated modules) to use a
+ different configuration. See the
+ ``meta/conf/machine/include/arm/feature-arm-thumb.inc`` file in the
+ :term:`Source Directory` for an example.
+
+ TARGET_CFLAGS
+ Specifies the flags to pass to the C compiler when building for the
+ target. When building in the target context,
+ :term:`CFLAGS` is set to the value of this variable by
+ default.
+
+ Additionally, the SDK's environment setup script sets the ``CFLAGS``
+ variable in the environment to the ``TARGET_CFLAGS`` value so that
+ executables built using the SDK also have the flags applied.
+
+ TARGET_CPPFLAGS
+ Specifies the flags to pass to the C pre-processor (i.e. to both the
+ C and the C++ compilers) when building for the target. When building
+ in the target context, :term:`CPPFLAGS` is set to the
+ value of this variable by default.
+
+ Additionally, the SDK's environment setup script sets the
+ ``CPPFLAGS`` variable in the environment to the ``TARGET_CPPFLAGS``
+ value so that executables built using the SDK also have the flags
+ applied.
+
+ TARGET_CXXFLAGS
+ Specifies the flags to pass to the C++ compiler when building for the
+ target. When building in the target context,
+ :term:`CXXFLAGS` is set to the value of this variable
+ by default.
+
+ Additionally, the SDK's environment setup script sets the
+ ``CXXFLAGS`` variable in the environment to the ``TARGET_CXXFLAGS``
+ value so that executables built using the SDK also have the flags
+ applied.
+
+ TARGET_FPU
+ Specifies the method for handling FPU code. For FPU-less targets,
+ which include most ARM CPUs, the variable must be set to "soft". If
+ not, the kernel emulation gets used, which results in a performance
+ penalty.
+
+ TARGET_LD_ARCH
+ Specifies architecture-specific linker flags for the target system.
+ ``TARGET_LD_ARCH`` is initialized from
+ :term:`TUNE_LDARGS` by default in the BitBake
+ configuration file (``meta/conf/bitbake.conf``):
+ ::
+
+ TARGET_LD_ARCH = "${TUNE_LDARGS}"
+
+ TARGET_LDFLAGS
+ Specifies the flags to pass to the linker when building for the
+ target. When building in the target context,
+ :term:`LDFLAGS` is set to the value of this variable
+ by default.
+
+ Additionally, the SDK's environment setup script sets the
+ :term:`LDFLAGS` variable in the environment to the
+ ``TARGET_LDFLAGS`` value so that executables built using the SDK also
+ have the flags applied.
+
+ TARGET_OS
+ Specifies the target's operating system. The variable can be set to
+ "linux" for glibc-based systems (GNU C Library) and to "linux-musl"
+ for musl libc. For ARM/EABI targets, "linux-gnueabi" and
+ "linux-musleabi" possible values exist.
+
+ TARGET_PREFIX
+ Specifies the prefix used for the toolchain binary target tools.
+
+ Depending on the type of recipe and the build target,
+ ``TARGET_PREFIX`` is set as follows:
+
+ - For recipes building for the target machine, the value is
+ "${:term:`TARGET_SYS`}-".
+
+ - For native recipes, the build system sets the variable to the
+ value of ``BUILD_PREFIX``.
+
+ - For native SDK recipes (``nativesdk``), the build system sets the
+ variable to the value of ``SDK_PREFIX``.
+
+ TARGET_SYS
+ Specifies the system, including the architecture and the operating
+ system, for which the build is occurring in the context of the
+ current recipe.
+
+ The OpenEmbedded build system automatically sets this variable based
+ on :term:`TARGET_ARCH`,
+ :term:`TARGET_VENDOR`, and
+ :term:`TARGET_OS` variables.
+
+ .. note::
+
+ You do not need to set the TARGET_SYS variable yourself.
+
+ Consider these two examples:
+
+ - Given a native recipe on a 32-bit, x86 machine running Linux, the
+ value is "i686-linux".
+
+ - Given a recipe being built for a little-endian, MIPS target
+ running Linux, the value might be "mipsel-linux".
+
+ TARGET_VENDOR
+ Specifies the name of the target vendor.
+
+ TCLIBC
+ Specifies the GNU standard C library (``libc``) variant to use during
+ the build process. This variable replaces ``POKYLIBC``, which is no
+ longer supported.
+
+ You can select "glibc", "musl", "newlib", or "baremetal"
+
+ TCLIBCAPPEND
+ Specifies a suffix to be appended onto the
+ :term:`TMPDIR` value. The suffix identifies the
+ ``libc`` variant for building. When you are building for multiple
+ variants with the same :term:`Build Directory`, this
+ mechanism ensures that output for different ``libc`` variants is kept
+ separate to avoid potential conflicts.
+
+ In the ``defaultsetup.conf`` file, the default value of
+ ``TCLIBCAPPEND`` is "-${TCLIBC}". However, distros such as poky,
+ which normally only support one ``libc`` variant, set
+ ``TCLIBCAPPEND`` to "" in their distro configuration file resulting
+ in no suffix being applied.
+
+ TCMODE
+ Specifies the toolchain selector. ``TCMODE`` controls the
+ characteristics of the generated packages and images by telling the
+ OpenEmbedded build system which toolchain profile to use. By default,
+ the OpenEmbedded build system builds its own internal toolchain. The
+ variable's default value is "default", which uses that internal
+ toolchain.
+
+ .. note::
+
+ If
+ TCMODE
+ is set to a value other than "default", then it is your
+ responsibility to ensure that the toolchain is compatible with the
+ default toolchain. Using older or newer versions of these
+ components might cause build problems. See the Release Notes for
+ the Yocto Project release for the specific components with which
+ the toolchain must be compatible. To access the Release Notes, go
+ to the
+ Downloads
+ page on the Yocto Project website and click on the "RELEASE
+ INFORMATION" link for the appropriate release.
+
+ The ``TCMODE`` variable is similar to :term:`TCLIBC`,
+ which controls the variant of the GNU standard C library (``libc``)
+ used during the build process: ``glibc`` or ``musl``.
+
+ With additional layers, it is possible to use a pre-compiled external
+ toolchain. One example is the Sourcery G++ Toolchain. The support for
+ this toolchain resides in the separate Mentor Graphics
+ ``meta-sourcery`` layer at
+ http://github.com/MentorEmbedded/meta-sourcery/.
+
+ The layer's ``README`` file contains information on how to use the
+ Sourcery G++ Toolchain as an external toolchain. In summary, you must
+ be sure to add the layer to your ``bblayers.conf`` file in front of
+ the ``meta`` layer and then set the ``EXTERNAL_TOOLCHAIN`` variable
+ in your ``local.conf`` file to the location in which you installed
+ the toolchain.
+
+ The fundamentals used for this example apply to any external
+ toolchain. You can use ``meta-sourcery`` as a template for adding
+ support for other external toolchains.
+
+ TEST_EXPORT_DIR
+ The location the OpenEmbedded build system uses to export tests when
+ the :term:`TEST_EXPORT_ONLY` variable is set
+ to "1".
+
+ The ``TEST_EXPORT_DIR`` variable defaults to
+ ``"${TMPDIR}/testimage/${PN}"``.
+
+ TEST_EXPORT_ONLY
+ Specifies to export the tests only. Set this variable to "1" if you
+ do not want to run the tests but you want them to be exported in a
+ manner that you to run them outside of the build system.
+
+ TEST_LOG_DIR
+ Holds the SSH log and the boot log for QEMU machines. The
+ ``TEST_LOG_DIR`` variable defaults to ``"${WORKDIR}/testimage"``.
+
+ .. note::
+
+ Actual test results reside in the task log (
+ log.do_testimage
+ ), which is in the
+ ${WORKDIR}/temp/
+ directory.
+
+ TEST_POWERCONTROL_CMD
+ For automated hardware testing, specifies the command to use to
+ control the power of the target machine under test. Typically, this
+ command would point to a script that performs the appropriate action
+ (e.g. interacting with a web-enabled power strip). The specified
+ command should expect to receive as the last argument "off", "on" or
+ "cycle" specifying to power off, on, or cycle (power off and then
+ power on) the device, respectively.
+
+ TEST_POWERCONTROL_EXTRA_ARGS
+ For automated hardware testing, specifies additional arguments to
+ pass through to the command specified in
+ :term:`TEST_POWERCONTROL_CMD`. Setting
+ ``TEST_POWERCONTROL_EXTRA_ARGS`` is optional. You can use it if you
+ wish, for example, to separate the machine-specific and
+ non-machine-specific parts of the arguments.
+
+ TEST_QEMUBOOT_TIMEOUT
+ The time in seconds allowed for an image to boot before automated
+ runtime tests begin to run against an image. The default timeout
+ period to allow the boot process to reach the login prompt is 500
+ seconds. You can specify a different value in the ``local.conf``
+ file.
+
+ For more information on testing images, see the
+ ":ref:`dev-manual/dev-manual-common-tasks:performing automated runtime testing`"
+ section in the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual.
+
+ TEST_SERIALCONTROL_CMD
+ For automated hardware testing, specifies the command to use to
+ connect to the serial console of the target machine under test. This
+ command simply needs to connect to the serial console and forward
+ that connection to standard input and output as any normal terminal
+ program does.
+
+ For example, to use the Picocom terminal program on serial device
+ ``/dev/ttyUSB0`` at 115200bps, you would set the variable as follows:
+ ::
+
+ TEST_SERIALCONTROL_CMD = "picocom /dev/ttyUSB0 -b 115200"
+
+ TEST_SERIALCONTROL_EXTRA_ARGS
+ For automated hardware testing, specifies additional arguments to
+ pass through to the command specified in
+ :term:`TEST_SERIALCONTROL_CMD`. Setting
+ ``TEST_SERIALCONTROL_EXTRA_ARGS`` is optional. You can use it if you
+ wish, for example, to separate the machine-specific and
+ non-machine-specific parts of the command.
+
+ TEST_SERVER_IP
+ The IP address of the build machine (host machine). This IP address
+ is usually automatically detected. However, if detection fails, this
+ variable needs to be set to the IP address of the build machine (i.e.
+ where the build is taking place).
+
+ .. note::
+
+ The
+ TEST_SERVER_IP
+ variable is only used for a small number of tests such as the
+ "dnf" test suite, which needs to download packages from
+ WORKDIR/oe-rootfs-repo
+ .
+
+ TEST_TARGET
+ Specifies the target controller to use when running tests against a
+ test image. The default controller to use is "qemu":
+ ::
+
+ TEST_TARGET = "qemu"
+
+ A target controller is a class that defines how an image gets
+ deployed on a target and how a target is started. A layer can extend
+ the controllers by adding a module in the layer's
+ ``/lib/oeqa/controllers`` directory and by inheriting the
+ ``BaseTarget`` class, which is an abstract class that cannot be used
+ as a value of ``TEST_TARGET``.
+
+ You can provide the following arguments with ``TEST_TARGET``:
+
+ - *"qemu":* Boots a QEMU image and runs the tests. See the
+ ":ref:`qemu-image-enabling-tests`" section
+ in the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual for more
+ information.
+
+ - *"simpleremote":* Runs the tests on target hardware that is
+ already up and running. The hardware can be on the network or it
+ can be a device running an image on QEMU. You must also set
+ :term:`TEST_TARGET_IP` when you use
+ "simpleremote".
+
+ .. note::
+
+ This argument is defined in
+ meta/lib/oeqa/controllers/simpleremote.py
+ .
+
+ For information on running tests on hardware, see the
+ ":ref:`hardware-image-enabling-tests`"
+ section in the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual.
+
+ TEST_TARGET_IP
+ The IP address of your hardware under test. The ``TEST_TARGET_IP``
+ variable has no effect when :term:`TEST_TARGET` is
+ set to "qemu".
+
+ When you specify the IP address, you can also include a port. Here is
+ an example:
+ ::
+
+ TEST_TARGET_IP = "192.168.1.4:2201"
+
+ Specifying a port is
+ useful when SSH is started on a non-standard port or in cases when
+ your hardware under test is behind a firewall or network that is not
+ directly accessible from your host and you need to do port address
+ translation.
+
+ TEST_SUITES
+ An ordered list of tests (modules) to run against an image when
+ performing automated runtime testing.
+
+ The OpenEmbedded build system provides a core set of tests that can
+ be used against images.
+
+ .. note::
+
+ Currently, there is only support for running these tests under
+ QEMU.
+
+ Tests include ``ping``, ``ssh``, ``df`` among others. You can add
+ your own tests to the list of tests by appending ``TEST_SUITES`` as
+ follows:
+ ::
+
+ TEST_SUITES_append = " mytest"
+
+ Alternatively, you can
+ provide the "auto" option to have all applicable tests run against
+ the image.
+ ::
+
+ TEST_SUITES_append = " auto"
+
+ Using this option causes the
+ build system to automatically run tests that are applicable to the
+ image. Tests that are not applicable are skipped.
+
+ The order in which tests are run is important. Tests that depend on
+ another test must appear later in the list than the test on which
+ they depend. For example, if you append the list of tests with two
+ tests (``test_A`` and ``test_B``) where ``test_B`` is dependent on
+ ``test_A``, then you must order the tests as follows:
+ ::
+
+ TEST_SUITES = "test_A test_B"
+
+ For more information on testing images, see the
+ ":ref:`dev-manual/dev-manual-common-tasks:performing automated runtime testing`"
+ section in the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual.
+
+ TESTIMAGE_AUTO
+ Automatically runs the series of automated tests for images when an
+ image is successfully built. Setting ``TESTIMAGE_AUTO`` to "1" causes
+ any image that successfully builds to automatically boot under QEMU.
+ Using the variable also adds in dependencies so that any SDK for
+ which testing is requested is automatically built first.
+
+ These tests are written in Python making use of the ``unittest``
+ module, and the majority of them run commands on the target system
+ over ``ssh``. You can set this variable to "1" in your ``local.conf``
+ file in the :term:`Build Directory` to have the
+ OpenEmbedded build system automatically run these tests after an
+ image successfully builds:
+
+ TESTIMAGE_AUTO = "1"
+
+ For more information
+ on enabling, running, and writing these tests, see the
+ ":ref:`dev-manual/dev-manual-common-tasks:performing automated runtime testing`"
+ section in the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual and the
+ ":ref:`testimage*.bbclass <ref-classes-testimage*>`" section.
+
+ THISDIR
+ The directory in which the file BitBake is currently parsing is
+ located. Do not manually set this variable.
+
+ TIME
+ The time the build was started. Times appear using the hour, minute,
+ and second (HMS) format (e.g. "140159" for one minute and fifty-nine
+ seconds past 1400 hours).
+
+ TMPDIR
+ This variable is the base directory the OpenEmbedded build system
+ uses for all build output and intermediate files (other than the
+ shared state cache). By default, the ``TMPDIR`` variable points to
+ ``tmp`` within the :term:`Build Directory`.
+
+ If you want to establish this directory in a location other than the
+ default, you can uncomment and edit the following statement in the
+ ``conf/local.conf`` file in the :term:`Source Directory`:
+ ::
+
+ #TMPDIR = "${TOPDIR}/tmp"
+
+ An example use for this scenario is to set ``TMPDIR`` to a local disk,
+ which does not use NFS, while having the Build Directory use NFS.
+
+ The filesystem used by ``TMPDIR`` must have standard filesystem
+ semantics (i.e. mixed-case files are unique, POSIX file locking, and
+ persistent inodes). Due to various issues with NFS and bugs in some
+ implementations, NFS does not meet this minimum requirement.
+ Consequently, ``TMPDIR`` cannot be on NFS.
+
+ TOOLCHAIN_HOST_TASK
+ This variable lists packages the OpenEmbedded build system uses when
+ building an SDK, which contains a cross-development environment. The
+ packages specified by this variable are part of the toolchain set
+ that runs on the :term:`SDKMACHINE`, and each
+ package should usually have the prefix ``nativesdk-``. For example,
+ consider the following command when building an SDK:
+ ::
+
+ $ bitbake -c populate_sdk imagename
+
+ In this case, a default list of packages is
+ set in this variable, but you can add additional packages to the
+ list. See the
+ ":ref:`sdk-manual/sdk-appendix-customizing-standard:adding individual packages to the standard sdk`" section
+ in the Yocto Project Application Development and the Extensible
+ Software Development Kit (eSDK) manual for more information.
+
+ For background information on cross-development toolchains in the
+ Yocto Project development environment, see the
+ ":ref:`sdk-manual/sdk-intro:the cross-development toolchain`"
+ section in the Yocto Project Overview and Concepts Manual. For
+ information on setting up a cross-development environment, see the
+ :doc:`../sdk-manual/sdk-manual` manual.
+
+ TOOLCHAIN_OUTPUTNAME
+ This variable defines the name used for the toolchain output. The
+ :ref:`populate_sdk_base <ref-classes-populate-sdk-*>` class sets
+ the ``TOOLCHAIN_OUTPUTNAME`` variable as follows:
+ ::
+
+ TOOLCHAIN_OUTPUTNAME ?= "${SDK_NAME}-toolchain-${SDK_VERSION}"
+
+ See
+ the :term:`SDK_NAME` and
+ :term:`SDK_VERSION` variables for additional
+ information.
+
+ TOOLCHAIN_TARGET_TASK
+ This variable lists packages the OpenEmbedded build system uses when
+ it creates the target part of an SDK (i.e. the part built for the
+ target hardware), which includes libraries and headers. Use this
+ variable to add individual packages to the part of the SDK that runs
+ on the target. See the
+ ":ref:`sdk-manual/sdk-appendix-customizing-standard:adding individual packages to the standard sdk`" section
+ in the Yocto Project Application Development and the Extensible
+ Software Development Kit (eSDK) manual for more information.
+
+ For background information on cross-development toolchains in the
+ Yocto Project development environment, see the
+ ":ref:`sdk-manual/sdk-intro:the cross-development toolchain`"
+ section in the Yocto Project Overview and Concepts Manual. For
+ information on setting up a cross-development environment, see the
+ :doc:`../sdk-manual/sdk-manual` manual.
+
+ TOPDIR
+ The top-level :term:`Build Directory`. BitBake
+ automatically sets this variable when you initialize your build
+ environment using ````` <#structure-core-script>`__.
+
+ TRANSLATED_TARGET_ARCH
+ A sanitized version of :term:`TARGET_ARCH`. This
+ variable is used where the architecture is needed in a value where
+ underscores are not allowed, for example within package filenames. In
+ this case, dash characters replace any underscore characters used in
+ ``TARGET_ARCH``.
+
+ Do not edit this variable.
+
+ TUNE_ARCH
+ The GNU canonical architecture for a specific architecture (i.e.
+ ``arm``, ``armeb``, ``mips``, ``mips64``, and so forth). BitBake uses
+ this value to setup configuration.
+
+ ``TUNE_ARCH`` definitions are specific to a given architecture. The
+ definitions can be a single static definition, or can be dynamically
+ adjusted. You can see details for a given CPU family by looking at
+ the architecture's ``README`` file. For example, the
+ ``meta/conf/machine/include/mips/README`` file in the
+ :term:`Source Directory` provides information for
+ ``TUNE_ARCH`` specific to the ``mips`` architecture.
+
+ ``TUNE_ARCH`` is tied closely to
+ :term:`TARGET_ARCH`, which defines the target
+ machine's architecture. The BitBake configuration file
+ (``meta/conf/bitbake.conf``) sets ``TARGET_ARCH`` as follows:
+ ::
+
+ TARGET_ARCH = "${TUNE_ARCH}"
+
+ The following list, which is by no means complete since architectures
+ are configurable, shows supported machine architectures:
+
+ - arm
+ - i586
+ - x86_64
+ - powerpc
+ - powerpc64
+ - mips
+ - mipsel
+
+ TUNE_ASARGS
+ Specifies architecture-specific assembler flags for the target
+ system. The set of flags is based on the selected tune features.
+ ``TUNE_ASARGS`` is set using the tune include files, which are
+ typically under ``meta/conf/machine/include/`` and are influenced
+ through :term:`TUNE_FEATURES`. For example, the
+ ``meta/conf/machine/include/x86/arch-x86.inc`` file defines the flags
+ for the x86 architecture as follows:
+ ::
+
+ TUNE_ASARGS += "${@bb.utils.contains("TUNE_FEATURES", "mx32", "-x32", "", d)}"
+
+ .. note::
+
+ Board Support Packages (BSPs) select the tune. The selected tune,
+ in turn, affects the tune variables themselves (i.e. the tune can
+ supply its own set of flags).
+
+ TUNE_CCARGS
+ Specifies architecture-specific C compiler flags for the target
+ system. The set of flags is based on the selected tune features.
+ ``TUNE_CCARGS`` is set using the tune include files, which are
+ typically under ``meta/conf/machine/include/`` and are influenced
+ through :term:`TUNE_FEATURES`.
+
+ .. note::
+
+ Board Support Packages (BSPs) select the tune. The selected tune,
+ in turn, affects the tune variables themselves (i.e. the tune can
+ supply its own set of flags).
+
+ TUNE_LDARGS
+ Specifies architecture-specific linker flags for the target system.
+ The set of flags is based on the selected tune features.
+ ``TUNE_LDARGS`` is set using the tune include files, which are
+ typically under ``meta/conf/machine/include/`` and are influenced
+ through :term:`TUNE_FEATURES`. For example, the
+ ``meta/conf/machine/include/x86/arch-x86.inc`` file defines the flags
+ for the x86 architecture as follows:
+ ::
+
+ TUNE_LDARGS += "${@bb.utils.contains("TUNE_FEATURES", "mx32", "-m elf32_x86_64", "", d)}"
+
+ .. note::
+
+ Board Support Packages (BSPs) select the tune. The selected tune,
+ in turn, affects the tune variables themselves (i.e. the tune can
+ supply its own set of flags).
+
+ TUNE_FEATURES
+ Features used to "tune" a compiler for optimal use given a specific
+ processor. The features are defined within the tune files and allow
+ arguments (i.e. ``TUNE_*ARGS``) to be dynamically generated based on
+ the features.
+
+ The OpenEmbedded build system verifies the features to be sure they
+ are not conflicting and that they are supported.
+
+ The BitBake configuration file (``meta/conf/bitbake.conf``) defines
+ ``TUNE_FEATURES`` as follows:
+ ::
+
+ TUNE_FEATURES ??= "${TUNE_FEATURES_tune-${DEFAULTTUNE}}"
+
+ See the :term:`DEFAULTTUNE` variable for more information.
+
+ TUNE_PKGARCH
+ The package architecture understood by the packaging system to define
+ the architecture, ABI, and tuning of output packages. The specific
+ tune is defined using the "_tune" override as follows:
+ ::
+
+ TUNE_PKGARCH_tune-tune = "tune"
+
+ These tune-specific package architectures are defined in the machine
+ include files. Here is an example of the "core2-32" tuning as used in
+ the ``meta/conf/machine/include/tune-core2.inc`` file:
+ ::
+
+ TUNE_PKGARCH_tune-core2-32 = "core2-32"
+
+ TUNEABI
+ An underlying Application Binary Interface (ABI) used by a particular
+ tuning in a given toolchain layer. Providers that use prebuilt
+ libraries can use the ``TUNEABI``,
+ :term:`TUNEABI_OVERRIDE`, and
+ :term:`TUNEABI_WHITELIST` variables to check
+ compatibility of tunings against their selection of libraries.
+
+ If ``TUNEABI`` is undefined, then every tuning is allowed. See the
+ :ref:`sanity <ref-classes-sanity>` class to see how the variable is
+ used.
+
+ TUNEABI_OVERRIDE
+ If set, the OpenEmbedded system ignores the
+ :term:`TUNEABI_WHITELIST` variable.
+ Providers that use prebuilt libraries can use the
+ ``TUNEABI_OVERRIDE``, ``TUNEABI_WHITELIST``, and
+ :term:`TUNEABI` variables to check compatibility of a
+ tuning against their selection of libraries.
+
+ See the :ref:`sanity <ref-classes-sanity>` class to see how the
+ variable is used.
+
+ TUNEABI_WHITELIST
+ A whitelist of permissible :term:`TUNEABI` values. If
+ ``TUNEABI_WHITELIST`` is not set, all tunes are allowed. Providers
+ that use prebuilt libraries can use the ``TUNEABI_WHITELIST``,
+ :term:`TUNEABI_OVERRIDE`, and ``TUNEABI``
+ variables to check compatibility of a tuning against their selection
+ of libraries.
+
+ See the :ref:`sanity <ref-classes-sanity>` class to see how the
+ variable is used.
+
+ TUNECONFLICTS[feature]
+ Specifies CPU or Application Binary Interface (ABI) tuning features
+ that conflict with feature.
+
+ Known tuning conflicts are specified in the machine include files in
+ the :term:`Source Directory`. Here is an example from
+ the ``meta/conf/machine/include/mips/arch-mips.inc`` include file
+ that lists the "o32" and "n64" features as conflicting with the "n32"
+ feature:
+ ::
+
+ TUNECONFLICTS[n32] = "o32 n64"
+
+ TUNEVALID[feature]
+ Specifies a valid CPU or Application Binary Interface (ABI) tuning
+ feature. The specified feature is stored as a flag. Valid features
+ are specified in the machine include files (e.g.
+ ``meta/conf/machine/include/arm/arch-arm.inc``). Here is an example
+ from that file:
+ ::
+
+ TUNEVALID[bigendian] = "Enable big-endian mode."
+
+ See the machine include files in the :term:`Source Directory`
+ for these features.
+
+ UBOOT_CONFIG
+ Configures the :term:`UBOOT_MACHINE` and can
+ also define :term:`IMAGE_FSTYPES` for individual
+ cases.
+
+ Following is an example from the ``meta-fsl-arm`` layer. ::
+
+ UBOOT_CONFIG ??= "sd"
+ UBOOT_CONFIG[sd] = "mx6qsabreauto_config,sdcard"
+ UBOOT_CONFIG[eimnor] = "mx6qsabreauto_eimnor_config"
+ UBOOT_CONFIG[nand] = "mx6qsabreauto_nand_config,ubifs"
+ UBOOT_CONFIG[spinor] = "mx6qsabreauto_spinor_config"
+
+ In this example, "sd" is selected as the configuration of the possible four for the
+ ``UBOOT_MACHINE``. The "sd" configuration defines
+ "mx6qsabreauto_config" as the value for ``UBOOT_MACHINE``, while the
+ "sdcard" specifies the ``IMAGE_FSTYPES`` to use for the U-boot image.
+
+ For more information on how the ``UBOOT_CONFIG`` is handled, see the
+ :ref:`uboot-config <ref-classes-uboot-config>`
+ class.
+
+ UBOOT_DTB_LOADADDRESS
+ Specifies the load address for the dtb image used by U-boot. During FIT
+ image creation, the ``UBOOT_DTB_LOADADDRESS`` variable is used in
+ :ref:`kernel-fitimage <ref-classes-kernel-fitimage>` class to specify
+ the load address to be used in
+ creating the dtb sections of Image Tree Source for the FIT image.
+
+ UBOOT_DTBO_LOADADDRESS
+ Specifies the load address for the dtbo image used by U-boot. During FIT
+ image creation, the ``UBOOT_DTBO_LOADADDRESS`` variable is used in
+ :ref:`kernel-fitimage <ref-classes-kernel-fitimage>` class to specify the load address to be used in
+ creating the dtbo sections of Image Tree Source for the FIT image.
+
+ UBOOT_ENTRYPOINT
+ Specifies the entry point for the U-Boot image. During U-Boot image
+ creation, the ``UBOOT_ENTRYPOINT`` variable is passed as a
+ command-line parameter to the ``uboot-mkimage`` utility.
+
+ UBOOT_LOADADDRESS
+ Specifies the load address for the U-Boot image. During U-Boot image
+ creation, the ``UBOOT_LOADADDRESS`` variable is passed as a
+ command-line parameter to the ``uboot-mkimage`` utility.
+
+ UBOOT_LOCALVERSION
+ Appends a string to the name of the local version of the U-Boot
+ image. For example, assuming the version of the U-Boot image built
+ was "2013.10", the full version string reported by U-Boot would be
+ "2013.10-yocto" given the following statement:
+ ::
+
+ UBOOT_LOCALVERSION = "-yocto"
+
+ UBOOT_MACHINE
+ Specifies the value passed on the ``make`` command line when building
+ a U-Boot image. The value indicates the target platform
+ configuration. You typically set this variable from the machine
+ configuration file (i.e. ``conf/machine/machine_name.conf``).
+
+ Please see the "Selection of Processor Architecture and Board Type"
+ section in the U-Boot README for valid values for this variable.
+
+ UBOOT_MAKE_TARGET
+ Specifies the target called in the ``Makefile``. The default target
+ is "all".
+
+ UBOOT_MKIMAGE_DTCOPTS
+ Options for the device tree compiler passed to mkimage '-D'
+ feature while creating FIT image in :ref:`kernel-fitimage <ref-classes-kernel-fitimage>` class.
+
+ UBOOT_RD_LOADADDRESS
+ Specifies the load address for the RAM disk image.
+ During FIT image creation, the
+ ``UBOOT_RD_LOADADDRESS`` variable is used
+ in :ref:`kernel-fitimage <ref-classes-kernel-fitimage>` class to specify the
+ load address to be used in creating the Image Tree Source for
+ the FIT image.
+
+ UBOOT_RD_ENTRYPOINT
+ Specifies the entrypoint for the RAM disk image.
+ During FIT image creation, the
+ ``UBOOT_RD_ENTRYPOINT`` variable is used
+ in :ref:`kernel-fitimage <ref-classes-kernel-fitimage>` class to specify the
+ entrypoint to be used in creating the Image Tree Source for
+ the FIT image.
+
+ UBOOT_SIGN_ENABLE
+ Enable signing of FIT image. The default value is "0".
+
+ UBOOT_SIGN_KEYDIR
+ Location of the directory containing the RSA key and
+ certificate used for signing FIT image.
+
+ UBOOT_SIGN_KEYNAME
+ The name of keys used for signing U-boot FIT image stored in
+ :term:`UBOOT_SIGN_KEYDIR` directory. For e.g. dev.key key and dev.crt
+ certificate stored in :term:`UBOOT_SIGN_KEYDIR` directory will have
+ :term:`UBOOT_SIGN_KEYNAME` set to "dev".
+
+ UBOOT_SUFFIX
+ Points to the generated U-Boot extension. For example, ``u-boot.sb``
+ has a ``.sb`` extension.
+
+ The default U-Boot extension is ``.bin``
+
+ UBOOT_TARGET
+ Specifies the target used for building U-Boot. The target is passed
+ directly as part of the "make" command (e.g. SPL and AIS). If you do
+ not specifically set this variable, the OpenEmbedded build process
+ passes and uses "all" for the target during the U-Boot building
+ process.
+
+ UNKNOWN_CONFIGURE_WHITELIST
+ Specifies a list of options that, if reported by the configure script
+ as being invalid, should not generate a warning during the
+ :ref:`ref-tasks-configure` task. Normally, invalid
+ configure options are simply not passed to the configure script (e.g.
+ should be removed from :term:`EXTRA_OECONF` or
+ :term:`PACKAGECONFIG_CONFARGS`).
+ However, common options, for example, exist that are passed to all
+ configure scripts at a class level that might not be valid for some
+ configure scripts. It follows that no benefit exists in seeing a
+ warning about these options. For these cases, the options are added
+ to ``UNKNOWN_CONFIGURE_WHITELIST``.
+
+ The configure arguments check that uses
+ ``UNKNOWN_CONFIGURE_WHITELIST`` is part of the
+ :ref:`insane <ref-classes-insane>` class and is only enabled if the
+ recipe inherits the :ref:`autotools <ref-classes-autotools>` class.
+
+ UPDATERCPN
+ For recipes inheriting the
+ :ref:`update-rc.d <ref-classes-update-rc.d>` class, ``UPDATERCPN``
+ specifies the package that contains the initscript that is enabled.
+
+ The default value is "${PN}". Given that almost all recipes that
+ install initscripts package them in the main package for the recipe,
+ you rarely need to set this variable in individual recipes.
+
+ UPSTREAM_CHECK_GITTAGREGEX
+ You can perform a per-recipe check for what the latest upstream
+ source code version is by calling ``bitbake -c checkpkg`` recipe. If
+ the recipe source code is provided from Git repositories, the
+ OpenEmbedded build system determines the latest upstream version by
+ picking the latest tag from the list of all repository tags.
+
+ You can use the ``UPSTREAM_CHECK_GITTAGREGEX`` variable to provide a
+ regular expression to filter only the relevant tags should the
+ default filter not work correctly.
+ ::
+
+ UPSTREAM_CHECK_GITTAGREGEX = "git_tag_regex"
+
+ UPSTREAM_CHECK_REGEX
+ Use the ``UPSTREAM_CHECK_REGEX`` variable to specify a different
+ regular expression instead of the default one when the package
+ checking system is parsing the page found using
+ :term:`UPSTREAM_CHECK_URI`.
+ ::
+
+ UPSTREAM_CHECK_REGEX = "package_regex"
+
+ UPSTREAM_CHECK_URI
+ You can perform a per-recipe check for what the latest upstream
+ source code version is by calling ``bitbake -c checkpkg`` recipe. If
+ the source code is provided from tarballs, the latest version is
+ determined by fetching the directory listing where the tarball is and
+ attempting to find a later tarball. When this approach does not work,
+ you can use ``UPSTREAM_CHECK_URI`` to provide a different URI that
+ contains the link to the latest tarball.
+ ::
+
+ UPSTREAM_CHECK_URI = "recipe_url"
+
+ USE_DEVFS
+ Determines if ``devtmpfs`` is used for ``/dev`` population. The
+ default value used for ``USE_DEVFS`` is "1" when no value is
+ specifically set. Typically, you would set ``USE_DEVFS`` to "0" for a
+ statically populated ``/dev`` directory.
+
+ See the ":ref:`selecting-dev-manager`" section in
+ the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual for information on how to
+ use this variable.
+
+ USE_VT
+ When using
+ :ref:`SysVinit <new-recipe-enabling-system-services>`,
+ determines whether or not to run a
+ `getty <http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Getty_%28Unix%29>`__ on any
+ virtual terminals in order to enable logging in through those
+ terminals.
+
+ The default value used for ``USE_VT`` is "1" when no default value is
+ specifically set. Typically, you would set ``USE_VT`` to "0" in the
+ machine configuration file for machines that do not have a graphical
+ display attached and therefore do not need virtual terminal
+ functionality.
+
+ USER_CLASSES
+ A list of classes to globally inherit. These classes are used by the
+ OpenEmbedded build system to enable extra features (e.g.
+ ``buildstats``, ``image-mklibs``, and so forth).
+
+ The default list is set in your ``local.conf`` file:
+ ::
+
+ USER_CLASSES ?= "buildstats image-mklibs image-prelink"
+
+ For more information, see
+ ``meta-poky/conf/local.conf.sample`` in the :term:`Source Directory`.
+
+ USERADD_ERROR_DYNAMIC
+ If set to ``error``, forces the OpenEmbedded build system to produce
+ an error if the user identification (``uid``) and group
+ identification (``gid``) values are not defined in any of the files
+ listed in :term:`USERADD_UID_TABLES` and
+ :term:`USERADD_GID_TABLES`. If set to
+ ``warn``, a warning will be issued instead.
+
+ The default behavior for the build system is to dynamically apply
+ ``uid`` and ``gid`` values. Consequently, the
+ ``USERADD_ERROR_DYNAMIC`` variable is by default not set. If you plan
+ on using statically assigned ``gid`` and ``uid`` values, you should
+ set the ``USERADD_ERROR_DYNAMIC`` variable in your ``local.conf``
+ file as follows:
+ ::
+
+ USERADD_ERROR_DYNAMIC = "error"
+
+ Overriding the
+ default behavior implies you are going to also take steps to set
+ static ``uid`` and ``gid`` values through use of the
+ :term:`USERADDEXTENSION`,
+ :term:`USERADD_UID_TABLES`, and
+ :term:`USERADD_GID_TABLES` variables.
+
+ .. note::
+
+ There is a difference in behavior between setting
+ USERADD_ERROR_DYNAMIC
+ to
+ error
+ and setting it to
+ warn
+ . When it is set to
+ warn
+ , the build system will report a warning for every undefined
+ uid
+ and
+ gid
+ in any recipe. But when it is set to
+ error
+ , it will only report errors for recipes that are actually built.
+ This saves you from having to add static IDs for recipes that you
+ know will never be built.
+
+ USERADD_GID_TABLES
+ Specifies a password file to use for obtaining static group
+ identification (``gid``) values when the OpenEmbedded build system
+ adds a group to the system during package installation.
+
+ When applying static group identification (``gid``) values, the
+ OpenEmbedded build system looks in :term:`BBPATH` for a
+ ``files/group`` file and then applies those ``uid`` values. Set the
+ variable as follows in your ``local.conf`` file:
+ ::
+
+
+ USERADD_GID_TABLES = "files/group"
+
+ .. note::
+
+ Setting the
+ USERADDEXTENSION
+ variable to "useradd-staticids" causes the build system to use
+ static
+ gid
+ values.
+
+ USERADD_PACKAGES
+ When inheriting the :ref:`useradd <ref-classes-useradd>` class,
+ this variable specifies the individual packages within the recipe
+ that require users and/or groups to be added.
+
+ You must set this variable if the recipe inherits the class. For
+ example, the following enables adding a user for the main package in
+ a recipe:
+ ::
+
+ USERADD_PACKAGES = "${PN}"
+
+ .. note::
+
+ It follows that if you are going to use the
+ USERADD_PACKAGES
+ variable, you need to set one or more of the
+ USERADD_PARAM
+ ,
+ GROUPADD_PARAM
+ , or
+ GROUPMEMS_PARAM
+ variables.
+
+ USERADD_PARAM
+ When inheriting the :ref:`useradd <ref-classes-useradd>` class,
+ this variable specifies for a package what parameters should pass to
+ the ``useradd`` command if you add a user to the system when the
+ package is installed.
+
+ Here is an example from the ``dbus`` recipe:
+ ::
+
+ USERADD_PARAM_${PN} = "--system --home ${localstatedir}/lib/dbus \
+ --no-create-home --shell /bin/false \
+ --user-group messagebus"
+
+ For information on the
+ standard Linux shell command ``useradd``, see
+ http://linux.die.net/man/8/useradd.
+
+ USERADD_UID_TABLES
+ Specifies a password file to use for obtaining static user
+ identification (``uid``) values when the OpenEmbedded build system
+ adds a user to the system during package installation.
+
+ When applying static user identification (``uid``) values, the
+ OpenEmbedded build system looks in :term:`BBPATH` for a
+ ``files/passwd`` file and then applies those ``uid`` values. Set the
+ variable as follows in your ``local.conf`` file:
+ ::
+
+ USERADD_UID_TABLES = "files/passwd"
+
+ .. note::
+
+ Setting the
+ USERADDEXTENSION
+ variable to "useradd-staticids" causes the build system to use
+ static
+ uid
+ values.
+
+ USERADDEXTENSION
+ When set to "useradd-staticids", causes the OpenEmbedded build system
+ to base all user and group additions on a static ``passwd`` and
+ ``group`` files found in :term:`BBPATH`.
+
+ To use static user identification (``uid``) and group identification
+ (``gid``) values, set the variable as follows in your ``local.conf``
+ file: USERADDEXTENSION = "useradd-staticids"
+
+ .. note::
+
+ Setting this variable to use static
+ uid
+ and
+ gid
+ values causes the OpenEmbedded build system to employ the
+ useradd-staticids
+ class.
+
+ If you use static ``uid`` and ``gid`` information, you must also
+ specify the ``files/passwd`` and ``files/group`` files by setting the
+ :term:`USERADD_UID_TABLES` and
+ :term:`USERADD_GID_TABLES` variables.
+ Additionally, you should also set the
+ :term:`USERADD_ERROR_DYNAMIC` variable.
+
+ VOLATILE_LOG_DIR
+ Specifies the persistence of the target's ``/var/log`` directory,
+ which is used to house postinstall target log files.
+
+ By default, ``VOLATILE_LOG_DIR`` is set to "yes", which means the
+ file is not persistent. You can override this setting by setting the
+ variable to "no" to make the log directory persistent.
+
+ WARN_QA
+ Specifies the quality assurance checks whose failures are reported as
+ warnings by the OpenEmbedded build system. You set this variable in
+ your distribution configuration file. For a list of the checks you
+ can control with this variable, see the
+ ":ref:`insane.bbclass <ref-classes-insane>`" section.
+
+ WKS_FILE_DEPENDS
+ When placed in the recipe that builds your image, this variable lists
+ build-time dependencies. The ``WKS_FILE_DEPENDS`` variable is only
+ applicable when Wic images are active (i.e. when
+ :term:`IMAGE_FSTYPES` contains entries related
+ to Wic). If your recipe does not create Wic images, the variable has
+ no effect.
+
+ The ``WKS_FILE_DEPENDS`` variable is similar to the
+ :term:`DEPENDS` variable. When you use the variable in
+ your recipe that builds the Wic image, dependencies you list in the
+ ``WIC_FILE_DEPENDS`` variable are added to the ``DEPENDS`` variable.
+
+ With the ``WKS_FILE_DEPENDS`` variable, you have the possibility to
+ specify a list of additional dependencies (e.g. native tools,
+ bootloaders, and so forth), that are required to build Wic images.
+ Following is an example:
+ ::
+
+ WKS_FILE_DEPENDS = "some-native-tool"
+
+ In the
+ previous example, some-native-tool would be replaced with an actual
+ native tool on which the build would depend.
+
+ WKS_FILE
+ Specifies the location of the Wic kickstart file that is used by the
+ OpenEmbedded build system to create a partitioned image
+ (image\ ``.wic``). For information on how to create a partitioned
+ image, see the
+ ":ref:`dev-manual/dev-manual-common-tasks:creating partitioned images using wic`"
+ section in the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual. For details on
+ the kickstart file format, see the ":doc:`../ref-manual/ref-kickstart`" Chapter.
+
+ WORKDIR
+ The pathname of the work directory in which the OpenEmbedded build
+ system builds a recipe. This directory is located within the
+ :term:`TMPDIR` directory structure and is specific to
+ the recipe being built and the system for which it is being built.
+
+ The ``WORKDIR`` directory is defined as follows:
+ ::
+
+ ${TMPDIR}/work/${MULTIMACH_TARGET_SYS}/${PN}/${EXTENDPE}${PV}-${PR}
+
+ The actual directory depends on several things:
+
+ - TMPDIR
+ : The top-level build output directory
+ - MULTIMACH_TARGET_SYS
+ : The target system identifier
+ - PN
+ : The recipe name
+ - EXTENDPE
+ : The epoch - (if
+ PE
+ is not specified, which is usually the case for most recipes, then
+ EXTENDPE
+ is blank)
+ - PV
+ : The recipe version
+ - PR
+ : The recipe revision
+
+ As an example, assume a Source Directory top-level folder name
+ ``poky``, a default Build Directory at ``poky/build``, and a
+ ``qemux86-poky-linux`` machine target system. Furthermore, suppose
+ your recipe is named ``foo_1.3.0-r0.bb``. In this case, the work
+ directory the build system uses to build the package would be as
+ follows:
+ ::
+
+ poky/build/tmp/work/qemux86-poky-linux/foo/1.3.0-r0
+
+ XSERVER
+ Specifies the packages that should be installed to provide an X
+ server and drivers for the current machine, assuming your image
+ directly includes ``packagegroup-core-x11-xserver`` or, perhaps
+ indirectly, includes "x11-base" in
+ :term:`IMAGE_FEATURES`.
+
+ The default value of ``XSERVER``, if not specified in the machine
+ configuration, is "xserver-xorg xf86-video-fbdev xf86-input-evdev".
+
diff --git a/poky/documentation/ref-manual/ref-varlocality.rst b/poky/documentation/ref-manual/ref-varlocality.rst
new file mode 100644
index 000000000..a95504b57
--- /dev/null
+++ b/poky/documentation/ref-manual/ref-varlocality.rst
@@ -0,0 +1,166 @@
+.. SPDX-License-Identifier: CC-BY-2.0-UK
+
+****************
+Variable Context
+****************
+
+While you can use most variables in almost any context such as
+``.conf``, ``.bbclass``, ``.inc``, and ``.bb`` files, some variables are
+often associated with a particular locality or context. This chapter
+describes some common associations.
+
+.. _ref-varlocality-configuration:
+
+Configuration
+=============
+
+The following subsections provide lists of variables whose context is
+configuration: distribution, machine, and local.
+
+.. _ref-varlocality-config-distro:
+
+Distribution (Distro)
+---------------------
+
+This section lists variables whose configuration context is the
+distribution, or distro.
+
+- :term:`DISTRO`
+
+- :term:`DISTRO_NAME`
+
+- :term:`DISTRO_VERSION`
+
+- :term:`MAINTAINER`
+
+- :term:`PACKAGE_CLASSES`
+
+- :term:`TARGET_OS`
+
+- :term:`TARGET_FPU`
+
+- :term:`TCMODE`
+
+- :term:`TCLIBC`
+
+.. _ref-varlocality-config-machine:
+
+Machine
+-------
+
+This section lists variables whose configuration context is the machine.
+
+- :term:`TARGET_ARCH`
+
+- :term:`SERIAL_CONSOLES`
+
+- :term:`PACKAGE_EXTRA_ARCHS`
+
+- :term:`IMAGE_FSTYPES`
+
+- :term:`MACHINE_FEATURES`
+
+- :term:`MACHINE_EXTRA_RDEPENDS`
+
+- :term:`MACHINE_EXTRA_RRECOMMENDS`
+
+- :term:`MACHINE_ESSENTIAL_EXTRA_RDEPENDS`
+
+- :term:`MACHINE_ESSENTIAL_EXTRA_RRECOMMENDS`
+
+.. _ref-varlocality-config-local:
+
+Local
+-----
+
+This section lists variables whose configuration context is the local
+configuration through the ``local.conf`` file.
+
+- :term:`DISTRO`
+
+- :term:`MACHINE`
+
+- :term:`DL_DIR`
+
+- :term:`BBFILES`
+
+- :term:`EXTRA_IMAGE_FEATURES`
+
+- :term:`PACKAGE_CLASSES`
+
+- :term:`BB_NUMBER_THREADS`
+
+- :term:`BBINCLUDELOGS`
+
+- :term:`ENABLE_BINARY_LOCALE_GENERATION`
+
+.. _ref-varlocality-recipes:
+
+Recipes
+=======
+
+The following subsections provide lists of variables whose context is
+recipes: required, dependencies, path, and extra build information.
+
+.. _ref-varlocality-recipe-required:
+
+Required
+--------
+
+This section lists variables that are required for recipes.
+
+- :term:`LICENSE`
+
+- :term:`LIC_FILES_CHKSUM`
+
+- :term:`SRC_URI` - used in recipes that fetch local or remote files.
+
+.. _ref-varlocality-recipe-dependencies:
+
+Dependencies
+------------
+
+This section lists variables that define recipe dependencies.
+
+- :term:`DEPENDS`
+
+- :term:`RDEPENDS`
+
+- :term:`RRECOMMENDS`
+
+- :term:`RCONFLICTS`
+
+- :term:`RREPLACES`
+
+.. _ref-varlocality-recipe-paths:
+
+Paths
+-----
+
+This section lists variables that define recipe paths.
+
+- :term:`WORKDIR`
+
+- :term:`S`
+
+- :term:`FILES`
+
+.. _ref-varlocality-recipe-build:
+
+Extra Build Information
+-----------------------
+
+This section lists variables that define extra build information for
+recipes.
+
+- :term:`DEFAULT_PREFERENCE`
+
+- :term:`EXTRA_OECMAKE`
+
+- :term:`EXTRA_OECONF`
+
+- :term:`EXTRA_OEMAKE`
+
+- :term:`PACKAGECONFIG_CONFARGS`
+
+- :term:`PACKAGES`
diff --git a/poky/documentation/ref-manual/resources.rst b/poky/documentation/ref-manual/resources.rst
new file mode 100644
index 000000000..2b82b7910
--- /dev/null
+++ b/poky/documentation/ref-manual/resources.rst
@@ -0,0 +1,197 @@
+.. SPDX-License-Identifier: CC-BY-2.0-UK
+
+****************************************
+Contributions and Additional Information
+****************************************
+
+.. _resources-intro:
+
+Introduction
+============
+
+The Yocto Project team is happy for people to experiment with the Yocto
+Project. A number of places exist to find help if you run into
+difficulties or find bugs. This presents information about contributing
+and participating in the Yocto Project.
+
+.. _resources-contributions:
+
+Contributions
+=============
+
+The Yocto Project gladly accepts contributions. You can submit changes
+to the project either by creating and sending pull requests, or by
+submitting patches through email. For information on how to do both as
+well as information on how to identify the maintainer for each area of
+code, see the ":ref:`how-to-submit-a-change`" section in the
+Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual.
+
+.. _resources-bugtracker:
+
+Yocto Project Bugzilla
+======================
+
+The Yocto Project uses its own implementation of
+:yocto_bugs:`Bugzilla <>` to track defects (bugs).
+Implementations of Bugzilla work well for group development because they
+track bugs and code changes, can be used to communicate changes and
+problems with developers, can be used to submit and review patches, and
+can be used to manage quality assurance.
+
+Sometimes it is helpful to submit, investigate, or track a bug against
+the Yocto Project itself (e.g. when discovering an issue with some
+component of the build system that acts contrary to the documentation or
+your expectations).
+
+A general procedure and guidelines exist for when you use Bugzilla to
+submit a bug. For information on how to use Bugzilla to submit a bug
+against the Yocto Project, see the following:
+
+- The ":ref:`dev-manual/dev-manual-common-tasks:submitting a defect against the yocto project`"
+ section in the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual.
+
+- The Yocto Project :yocto_wiki:`Bugzilla wiki page </wiki/Bugzilla_Configuration_and_Bug_Tracking>`
+
+For information on Bugzilla in general, see http://www.bugzilla.org/about/.
+
+.. _resources-mailinglist:
+
+Mailing lists
+=============
+
+A number of mailing lists maintained by the Yocto Project exist as well
+as related OpenEmbedded mailing lists for discussion, patch submission
+and announcements. To subscribe to one of the following mailing lists,
+click on the appropriate URL in the following list and follow the
+instructions:
+
+- https://lists.yoctoproject.org/g/yocto - General Yocto Project
+ discussion mailing list.
+
+- https://lists.openembedded.org/g/openembedded-core - Discussion mailing
+ list about OpenEmbedded-Core (the core metadata).
+
+- https://lists.openembedded.org/g/openembedded-devel - Discussion
+ mailing list about OpenEmbedded.
+
+- https://lists.openembedded.org/g/bitbake-devel - Discussion mailing
+ list about the :term:`BitBake` build tool.
+
+- https://lists.yoctoproject.org/g/poky - Discussion mailing list
+ about `Poky <#poky>`__.
+
+- https://lists.yoctoproject.org/g/yocto-announce - Mailing list to
+ receive official Yocto Project release and milestone announcements.
+
+For more Yocto Project-related mailing lists, see the
+Yocto Project Website
+.
+.. _resources-irc:
+
+Internet Relay Chat (IRC)
+=========================
+
+Two IRC channels on freenode are available for the Yocto Project and
+Poky discussions:
+
+- ``#yocto``
+
+- ``#poky``
+
+.. _resources-links-and-related-documentation:
+
+Links and Related Documentation
+===============================
+
+Here is a list of resources you might find helpful:
+
+- :yocto_home:`The Yocto Project Website <>`\ *:* The home site
+ for the Yocto Project.
+
+- :yocto_wiki:`The Yocto Project Main Wiki Page </wiki/Main_Page>`\ *:* The main wiki page for
+ the Yocto Project. This page contains information about project
+ planning, release engineering, QA & automation, a reference site map,
+ and other resources related to the Yocto Project.
+
+- `OpenEmbedded <http://www.openembedded.org/>`__\ *:* The build system used by the
+ Yocto Project. This project is the upstream, generic, embedded
+ distribution from which the Yocto Project derives its build system
+ (Poky) and to which it contributes.
+
+- `BitBake <http://www.openembedded.org/wiki/BitBake>`__\ *:* The tool
+ used to process metadata.
+
+- :doc:`BitBake User Manual <bitbake:index>`\ *:* A comprehensive
+ guide to the BitBake tool. If you want information on BitBake, see
+ this manual.
+
+- :doc:`../brief-yoctoprojectqs/brief-yoctoprojectqs` *:* This
+ short document lets you experience building an image using the Yocto
+ Project without having to understand any concepts or details.
+
+- :doc:`../overview-manual/overview-manual` *:* This manual provides overview
+ and conceptual information about the Yocto Project.
+
+- :doc:`../dev-manual/dev-manual` *:* This manual is a "how-to" guide
+ that presents procedures useful to both application and system
+ developers who use the Yocto Project.
+
+- :doc:`../sdk-manual/sdk-manual` *manual :* This
+ guide provides information that lets you get going with the standard
+ or extensible SDK. An SDK, with its cross-development toolchains,
+ allows you to develop projects inside or outside of the Yocto Project
+ environment.
+
+- :doc:`../bsp-guide/bsp` *:* This guide defines the structure
+ for BSP components. Having a commonly understood structure encourages
+ standardization.
+
+- :doc:`../kernel-dev/kernel-dev` *:* This manual describes
+ how to work with Linux Yocto kernels as well as provides a bit of
+ conceptual information on the construction of the Yocto Linux kernel
+ tree.
+
+- :doc:`../ref-manual/ref-manual` *:* This
+ manual provides reference material such as variable, task, and class
+ descriptions.
+
+- `Yocto Project Mega-Manual <https://docs.yoctoproject.org/singleindex.html>`__\ *:* This manual
+ is simply a single HTML file comprised of the bulk of the Yocto
+ Project manuals. The Mega-Manual primarily exists as a vehicle by
+ which you can easily search for phrases and terms used in the Yocto
+ Project documentation set.
+
+- :doc:`../profile-manual/profile-manual` *:* This manual presents a set of
+ common and generally useful tracing and profiling schemes along with
+ their applications (as appropriate) to each tool.
+
+- :doc:`../toaster-manual/toaster-manual` *:* This manual
+ introduces and describes how to set up and use Toaster. Toaster is an
+ Application Programming Interface (API) and web-based interface to
+ the :term:`OpenEmbedded Build System`, which uses
+ BitBake, that reports build information.
+
+- :yocto_wiki:`FAQ </wiki/FAQ>`\ *:* A list of commonly asked
+ questions and their answers.
+
+- *Release Notes:* Features, updates and known issues for the current
+ release of the Yocto Project. To access the Release Notes, go to the
+ :yocto_home:`Downloads </software-overview/downloads>` page on
+ the Yocto Project website and click on the "RELEASE INFORMATION" link
+ for the appropriate release.
+
+- `Bugzilla <https://bugzilla.yoctoproject.org>`__\ *:* The bug tracking application
+ the Yocto Project uses. If you find problems with the Yocto Project,
+ you should report them using this application.
+
+- :yocto_wiki:`Bugzilla Configuration and Bug Tracking Wiki Page </wiki/Bugzilla_Configuration_and_Bug_Tracking>`\ *:*
+ Information on how to get set up and use the Yocto Project
+ implementation of Bugzilla for logging and tracking Yocto Project
+ defects.
+
+- *Internet Relay Chat (IRC):* Two IRC channels on freenode are
+ available for Yocto Project and Poky discussions: ``#yocto`` and
+ ``#poky``, respectively.
+
+- `Quick EMUlator (QEMU) <http://wiki.qemu.org/Index.html>`__\ *:* An
+ open-source machine emulator and virtualizer.